graph: Add '--max-depth'.
[jackhill/guix/guix.git] / doc / guix.texi
1 \input texinfo
2 @c -*-texinfo-*-
3
4 @c %**start of header
5 @setfilename guix.info
6 @documentencoding UTF-8
7 @settitle GNU Guix Reference Manual
8 @c %**end of header
9
10 @include version.texi
11
12 @c Identifier of the OpenPGP key used to sign tarballs and such.
13 @set OPENPGP-SIGNING-KEY-ID 27D586A4F8900854329FF09F1260E46482E63562
14 @set OPENPGP-SIGNING-KEY-URL https://sv.gnu.org/people/viewgpg.php?user_id=127547
15
16 @c Base URL for downloads.
17 @set BASE-URL https://ftp.gnu.org/gnu/guix
18
19 @c The official substitute server used by default.
20 @set SUBSTITUTE-SERVER-1 ci.guix.gnu.org
21 @set SUBSTITUTE-SERVER-2 bordeaux.guix.gnu.org
22 @set SUBSTITUTE-URLS https://@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER-1} https://@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER-2}
23
24 @copying
25 Copyright @copyright{} 2012, 2013, 2014, 2015, 2016, 2017, 2018, 2019, 2020, 2021 Ludovic Courtès@*
26 Copyright @copyright{} 2013, 2014, 2016 Andreas Enge@*
27 Copyright @copyright{} 2013 Nikita Karetnikov@*
28 Copyright @copyright{} 2014, 2015, 2016 Alex Kost@*
29 Copyright @copyright{} 2015, 2016 Mathieu Lirzin@*
30 Copyright @copyright{} 2014 Pierre-Antoine Rault@*
31 Copyright @copyright{} 2015 Taylan Ulrich Bayırlı/Kammer@*
32 Copyright @copyright{} 2015, 2016, 2017, 2019, 2020, 2021 Leo Famulari@*
33 Copyright @copyright{} 2015, 2016, 2017, 2018, 2019, 2020 Ricardo Wurmus@*
34 Copyright @copyright{} 2016 Ben Woodcroft@*
35 Copyright @copyright{} 2016, 2017, 2018, 2021 Chris Marusich@*
36 Copyright @copyright{} 2016, 2017, 2018, 2019, 2020, 2021 Efraim Flashner@*
37 Copyright @copyright{} 2016 John Darrington@*
38 Copyright @copyright{} 2016, 2017 Nikita Gillmann@*
39 Copyright @copyright{} 2016, 2017, 2018, 2019, 2020 Jan Nieuwenhuizen@*
40 Copyright @copyright{} 2016, 2017, 2018, 2019, 2020, 2021 Julien Lepiller@*
41 Copyright @copyright{} 2016 Alex ter Weele@*
42 Copyright @copyright{} 2016, 2017, 2018, 2019, 2020, 2021 Christopher Baines@*
43 Copyright @copyright{} 2017, 2018, 2019 Clément Lassieur@*
44 Copyright @copyright{} 2017, 2018, 2020, 2021 Mathieu Othacehe@*
45 Copyright @copyright{} 2017 Federico Beffa@*
46 Copyright @copyright{} 2017, 2018 Carlo Zancanaro@*
47 Copyright @copyright{} 2017 Thomas Danckaert@*
48 Copyright @copyright{} 2017 humanitiesNerd@*
49 Copyright @copyright{} 2017, 2021 Christine Lemmer-Webber@*
50 Copyright @copyright{} 2017, 2018, 2019, 2020, 2021 Marius Bakke@*
51 Copyright @copyright{} 2017, 2019, 2020 Hartmut Goebel@*
52 Copyright @copyright{} 2017, 2019, 2020, 2021 Maxim Cournoyer@*
53 Copyright @copyright{} 2017, 2018, 2019, 2020, 2021 Tobias Geerinckx-Rice@*
54 Copyright @copyright{} 2017 George Clemmer@*
55 Copyright @copyright{} 2017 Andy Wingo@*
56 Copyright @copyright{} 2017, 2018, 2019, 2020 Arun Isaac@*
57 Copyright @copyright{} 2017 nee@*
58 Copyright @copyright{} 2018 Rutger Helling@*
59 Copyright @copyright{} 2018, 2021 Oleg Pykhalov@*
60 Copyright @copyright{} 2018 Mike Gerwitz@*
61 Copyright @copyright{} 2018 Pierre-Antoine Rouby@*
62 Copyright @copyright{} 2018, 2019 Gábor Boskovits@*
63 Copyright @copyright{} 2018, 2019, 2020 Florian Pelz@*
64 Copyright @copyright{} 2018 Laura Lazzati@*
65 Copyright @copyright{} 2018 Alex Vong@*
66 Copyright @copyright{} 2019 Josh Holland@*
67 Copyright @copyright{} 2019, 2020 Diego Nicola Barbato@*
68 Copyright @copyright{} 2019 Ivan Petkov@*
69 Copyright @copyright{} 2019 Jakob L. Kreuze@*
70 Copyright @copyright{} 2019 Kyle Andrews@*
71 Copyright @copyright{} 2019 Alex Griffin@*
72 Copyright @copyright{} 2019, 2020, 2021 Guillaume Le Vaillant@*
73 Copyright @copyright{} 2020 Leo Prikler@*
74 Copyright @copyright{} 2019, 2020 Simon Tournier@*
75 Copyright @copyright{} 2020 Wiktor Żelazny@*
76 Copyright @copyright{} 2020 Damien Cassou@*
77 Copyright @copyright{} 2020 Jakub Kądziołka@*
78 Copyright @copyright{} 2020 Jack Hill@*
79 Copyright @copyright{} 2020 Naga Malleswari@*
80 Copyright @copyright{} 2020, 2021 Brice Waegeneire@*
81 Copyright @copyright{} 2020 R Veera Kumar@*
82 Copyright @copyright{} 2020 Pierre Langlois@*
83 Copyright @copyright{} 2020 pinoaffe@*
84 Copyright @copyright{} 2020 André Batista@*
85 Copyright @copyright{} 2020, 2021 Alexandru-Sergiu Marton@*
86 Copyright @copyright{} 2020 raingloom@*
87 Copyright @copyright{} 2020 Daniel Brooks@*
88 Copyright @copyright{} 2020 John Soo@*
89 Copyright @copyright{} 2020 Jonathan Brielmaier@*
90 Copyright @copyright{} 2020 Edgar Vincent@*
91 Copyright @copyright{} 2021 Maxime Devos@*
92 Copyright @copyright{} 2021 B. Wilson@*
93 Copyright @copyright{} 2021 Xinglu Chen@*
94 Copyright @copyright{} 2021 Raghav Gururajan@*
95 Copyright @copyright{} 2021 Domagoj Stolfa@*
96 Copyright @copyright{} 2021 Hui Lu@*
97 Copyright @copyright{} 2021 pukkamustard@*
98 Copyright @copyright{} 2021 Alice Brenon@*
99
100 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
101 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.3 or
102 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with no
103 Invariant Sections, no Front-Cover Texts, and no Back-Cover Texts. A
104 copy of the license is included in the section entitled ``GNU Free
105 Documentation License''.
106 @end copying
107
108 @dircategory System administration
109 @direntry
110 * Guix: (guix). Manage installed software and system configuration.
111 * guix package: (guix)Invoking guix package. Installing, removing, and upgrading packages.
112 * guix gc: (guix)Invoking guix gc. Reclaiming unused disk space.
113 * guix pull: (guix)Invoking guix pull. Update the list of available packages.
114 * guix system: (guix)Invoking guix system. Manage the operating system configuration.
115 * guix deploy: (guix)Invoking guix deploy. Manage operating system configurations for remote hosts.
116 @end direntry
117
118 @dircategory Software development
119 @direntry
120 * guix environment: (guix)Invoking guix environment. Building development environments with Guix.
121 * guix build: (guix)Invoking guix build. Building packages.
122 * guix pack: (guix)Invoking guix pack. Creating binary bundles.
123 @end direntry
124
125 @titlepage
126 @title GNU Guix Reference Manual
127 @subtitle Using the GNU Guix Functional Package Manager
128 @author The GNU Guix Developers
129
130 @page
131 @vskip 0pt plus 1filll
132 Edition @value{EDITION} @*
133 @value{UPDATED} @*
134
135 @insertcopying
136 @end titlepage
137
138 @contents
139
140 @c *********************************************************************
141 @node Top
142 @top GNU Guix
143
144 This document describes GNU Guix version @value{VERSION}, a functional
145 package management tool written for the GNU system.
146
147 @c TRANSLATORS: You can replace the following paragraph with information on
148 @c how to join your own translation team and how to report issues with the
149 @c translation.
150 This manual is also available in Simplified Chinese (@pxref{Top,,, guix.zh_CN,
151 GNU Guix参考手册}), French (@pxref{Top,,, guix.fr, Manuel de référence de GNU
152 Guix}), German (@pxref{Top,,, guix.de, Referenzhandbuch zu GNU Guix}),
153 Spanish (@pxref{Top,,, guix.es, Manual de referencia de GNU Guix}), and
154 Russian (@pxref{Top,,, guix.ru, Руководство GNU Guix}). If you
155 would like to translate it in your native language, consider joining
156 @uref{https://translate.fedoraproject.org/projects/guix/documentation-manual,
157 Weblate} (@pxref{Translating Guix}).
158
159 @menu
160 * Introduction:: What is Guix about?
161 * Installation:: Installing Guix.
162 * System Installation:: Installing the whole operating system.
163 * Getting Started:: Your first steps.
164 * Package Management:: Package installation, upgrade, etc.
165 * Channels:: Customizing the package collection.
166 * Development:: Guix-aided software development.
167 * Programming Interface:: Using Guix in Scheme.
168 * Utilities:: Package management commands.
169 * System Configuration:: Configuring the operating system.
170 * Documentation:: Browsing software user manuals.
171 * Installing Debugging Files:: Feeding the debugger.
172 * Security Updates:: Deploying security fixes quickly.
173 * Bootstrapping:: GNU/Linux built from scratch.
174 * Porting:: Targeting another platform or kernel.
175 * Contributing:: Your help needed!
176
177 * Acknowledgments:: Thanks!
178 * GNU Free Documentation License:: The license of this manual.
179 * Concept Index:: Concepts.
180 * Programming Index:: Data types, functions, and variables.
181
182 @detailmenu
183 --- The Detailed Node Listing ---
184
185 Introduction
186
187 * Managing Software the Guix Way:: What's special.
188 * GNU Distribution:: The packages and tools.
189
190 Installation
191
192 * Binary Installation:: Getting Guix running in no time!
193 * Requirements:: Software needed to build and run Guix.
194 * Running the Test Suite:: Testing Guix.
195 * Setting Up the Daemon:: Preparing the build daemon's environment.
196 * Invoking guix-daemon:: Running the build daemon.
197 * Application Setup:: Application-specific setup.
198 * Upgrading Guix:: Upgrading Guix and its build daemon.
199
200 Setting Up the Daemon
201
202 * Build Environment Setup:: Preparing the isolated build environment.
203 * Daemon Offload Setup:: Offloading builds to remote machines.
204 * SELinux Support:: Using an SELinux policy for the daemon.
205
206 System Installation
207
208 * Limitations:: What you can expect.
209 * Hardware Considerations:: Supported hardware.
210 * USB Stick and DVD Installation:: Preparing the installation medium.
211 * Preparing for Installation:: Networking, partitioning, etc.
212 * Guided Graphical Installation:: Easy graphical installation.
213 * Manual Installation:: Manual installation for wizards.
214 * After System Installation:: When installation succeeded.
215 * Installing Guix in a VM:: Guix System playground.
216 * Building the Installation Image:: How this comes to be.
217
218 Manual Installation
219
220 * Keyboard Layout and Networking and Partitioning:: Initial setup.
221 * Proceeding with the Installation:: Installing.
222
223 Package Management
224
225 * Features:: How Guix will make your life brighter.
226 * Invoking guix package:: Package installation, removal, etc.
227 * Substitutes:: Downloading pre-built binaries.
228 * Packages with Multiple Outputs:: Single source package, multiple outputs.
229 * Invoking guix gc:: Running the garbage collector.
230 * Invoking guix pull:: Fetching the latest Guix and distribution.
231 * Invoking guix time-machine:: Running an older revision of Guix.
232 * Inferiors:: Interacting with another revision of Guix.
233 * Invoking guix describe:: Display information about your Guix revision.
234 * Invoking guix archive:: Exporting and importing store files.
235
236 Substitutes
237
238 * Official Substitute Servers:: One particular source of substitutes.
239 * Substitute Server Authorization:: How to enable or disable substitutes.
240 * Getting Substitutes from Other Servers:: Substitute diversity.
241 * Substitute Authentication:: How Guix verifies substitutes.
242 * Proxy Settings:: How to get substitutes via proxy.
243 * Substitution Failure:: What happens when substitution fails.
244 * On Trusting Binaries:: How can you trust that binary blob?
245
246 Channels
247
248 * Specifying Additional Channels:: Extending the package collection.
249 * Using a Custom Guix Channel:: Using a customized Guix.
250 * Replicating Guix:: Running the @emph{exact same} Guix.
251 * Channel Authentication:: How Guix verifies what it fetches.
252 * Channels with Substitutes:: Using channels with available substitutes.
253 * Creating a Channel:: How to write your custom channel.
254 * Package Modules in a Sub-directory:: Specifying the channel's package modules location.
255 * Declaring Channel Dependencies:: How to depend on other channels.
256 * Specifying Channel Authorizations:: Defining channel authors authorizations.
257 * Primary URL:: Distinguishing mirror to original.
258 * Writing Channel News:: Communicating information to channel's users.
259
260 Development
261
262 * Invoking guix environment:: Setting up development environments.
263 * Invoking guix pack:: Creating software bundles.
264 * The GCC toolchain:: Working with languages supported by GCC.
265 * Invoking guix git authenticate:: Authenticating Git repositories.
266
267 Programming Interface
268
269 * Package Modules:: Packages from the programmer's viewpoint.
270 * Defining Packages:: Defining new packages.
271 * Defining Package Variants:: Customizing packages.
272 * Build Systems:: Specifying how packages are built.
273 * Build Phases:: Phases of the build process of a package.
274 * Build Utilities:: Helpers for your package definitions and more.
275 * The Store:: Manipulating the package store.
276 * Derivations:: Low-level interface to package derivations.
277 * The Store Monad:: Purely functional interface to the store.
278 * G-Expressions:: Manipulating build expressions.
279 * Invoking guix repl:: Programming Guix in Guile.
280
281 Defining Packages
282
283 * package Reference:: The package data type.
284 * origin Reference:: The origin data type.
285
286 Utilities
287
288 * Invoking guix build:: Building packages from the command line.
289 * Invoking guix edit:: Editing package definitions.
290 * Invoking guix download:: Downloading a file and printing its hash.
291 * Invoking guix hash:: Computing the cryptographic hash of a file.
292 * Invoking guix import:: Importing package definitions.
293 * Invoking guix refresh:: Updating package definitions.
294 * Invoking guix lint:: Finding errors in package definitions.
295 * Invoking guix size:: Profiling disk usage.
296 * Invoking guix graph:: Visualizing the graph of packages.
297 * Invoking guix publish:: Sharing substitutes.
298 * Invoking guix challenge:: Challenging substitute servers.
299 * Invoking guix copy:: Copying to and from a remote store.
300 * Invoking guix container:: Process isolation.
301 * Invoking guix weather:: Assessing substitute availability.
302 * Invoking guix processes:: Listing client processes.
303
304 Invoking @command{guix build}
305
306 * Common Build Options:: Build options for most commands.
307 * Package Transformation Options:: Creating variants of packages.
308 * Additional Build Options:: Options specific to 'guix build'.
309 * Debugging Build Failures:: Real life packaging experience.
310
311 System Configuration
312
313 * Using the Configuration System:: Customizing your GNU system.
314 * operating-system Reference:: Detail of operating-system declarations.
315 * File Systems:: Configuring file system mounts.
316 * Mapped Devices:: Block device extra processing.
317 * User Accounts:: Specifying user accounts.
318 * Keyboard Layout:: How the system interprets key strokes.
319 * Locales:: Language and cultural convention settings.
320 * Services:: Specifying system services.
321 * Setuid Programs:: Programs running with root privileges.
322 * X.509 Certificates:: Authenticating HTTPS servers.
323 * Name Service Switch:: Configuring libc's name service switch.
324 * Initial RAM Disk:: Linux-Libre bootstrapping.
325 * Bootloader Configuration:: Configuring the boot loader.
326 * Invoking guix system:: Instantiating a system configuration.
327 * Invoking guix deploy:: Deploying a system configuration to a remote host.
328 * Running Guix in a VM:: How to run Guix System in a virtual machine.
329 * Defining Services:: Adding new service definitions.
330
331 Services
332
333 * Base Services:: Essential system services.
334 * Scheduled Job Execution:: The mcron service.
335 * Log Rotation:: The rottlog service.
336 * Networking Services:: Network setup, SSH daemon, etc.
337 * Unattended Upgrades:: Automated system upgrades.
338 * X Window:: Graphical display.
339 * Printing Services:: Local and remote printer support.
340 * Desktop Services:: D-Bus and desktop services.
341 * Sound Services:: ALSA and Pulseaudio services.
342 * Database Services:: SQL databases, key-value stores, etc.
343 * Mail Services:: IMAP, POP3, SMTP, and all that.
344 * Messaging Services:: Messaging services.
345 * Telephony Services:: Telephony services.
346 * Monitoring Services:: Monitoring services.
347 * Kerberos Services:: Kerberos services.
348 * LDAP Services:: LDAP services.
349 * Web Services:: Web servers.
350 * Certificate Services:: TLS certificates via Let's Encrypt.
351 * DNS Services:: DNS daemons.
352 * VPN Services:: VPN daemons.
353 * Network File System:: NFS related services.
354 * Continuous Integration:: Cuirass and Laminar services.
355 * Power Management Services:: Extending battery life.
356 * Audio Services:: The MPD.
357 * Virtualization Services:: Virtualization services.
358 * Version Control Services:: Providing remote access to Git repositories.
359 * Game Services:: Game servers.
360 * PAM Mount Service:: Service to mount volumes when logging in.
361 * Guix Services:: Services relating specifically to Guix.
362 * Linux Services:: Services tied to the Linux kernel.
363 * Hurd Services:: Services specific for a Hurd System.
364 * Miscellaneous Services:: Other services.
365
366 Defining Services
367
368 * Service Composition:: The model for composing services.
369 * Service Types and Services:: Types and services.
370 * Service Reference:: API reference.
371 * Shepherd Services:: A particular type of service.
372
373 Installing Debugging Files
374
375 * Separate Debug Info:: Installing 'debug' outputs.
376 * Rebuilding Debug Info:: Building missing debug info.
377
378 Bootstrapping
379
380 * Reduced Binary Seed Bootstrap:: A Bootstrap worthy of GNU.
381 * Preparing to Use the Bootstrap Binaries:: Building that what matters most.
382
383 @end detailmenu
384 @end menu
385
386 @c *********************************************************************
387 @node Introduction
388 @chapter Introduction
389
390 @cindex purpose
391 GNU Guix@footnote{``Guix'' is pronounced like ``geeks'', or ``ɡiːks''
392 using the international phonetic alphabet (IPA).} is a package
393 management tool for and distribution of the GNU system.
394 Guix makes it easy for unprivileged
395 users to install, upgrade, or remove software packages, to roll back to a
396 previous package set, to build packages from source, and generally
397 assists with the creation and maintenance of software environments.
398
399 @cindex Guix System
400 @cindex GuixSD, now Guix System
401 @cindex Guix System Distribution, now Guix System
402 You can install GNU@tie{}Guix on top of an existing GNU/Linux system where it
403 complements the available tools without interference (@pxref{Installation}),
404 or you can use it as a standalone operating system distribution,
405 @dfn{Guix@tie{}System}@footnote{We used to refer to Guix System as ``Guix
406 System Distribution'' or ``GuixSD''. We now consider it makes more sense to
407 group everything under the ``Guix'' banner since, after all, Guix System is
408 readily available through the @command{guix system} command, even if you're
409 using a different distro underneath!}. @xref{GNU Distribution}.
410
411 @menu
412 * Managing Software the Guix Way:: What's special.
413 * GNU Distribution:: The packages and tools.
414 @end menu
415
416 @node Managing Software the Guix Way
417 @section Managing Software the Guix Way
418
419 @cindex user interfaces
420 Guix provides a command-line package management interface
421 (@pxref{Package Management}), tools to help with software development
422 (@pxref{Development}), command-line utilities for more advanced usage
423 (@pxref{Utilities}), as well as Scheme programming interfaces
424 (@pxref{Programming Interface}).
425 @cindex build daemon
426 Its @dfn{build daemon} is responsible for building packages on behalf of
427 users (@pxref{Setting Up the Daemon}) and for downloading pre-built
428 binaries from authorized sources (@pxref{Substitutes}).
429
430 @cindex extensibility of the distribution
431 @cindex customization, of packages
432 Guix includes package definitions for many GNU and non-GNU packages, all
433 of which @uref{https://www.gnu.org/philosophy/free-sw.html, respect the
434 user's computing freedom}. It is @emph{extensible}: users can write
435 their own package definitions (@pxref{Defining Packages}) and make them
436 available as independent package modules (@pxref{Package Modules}). It
437 is also @emph{customizable}: users can @emph{derive} specialized package
438 definitions from existing ones, including from the command line
439 (@pxref{Package Transformation Options}).
440
441 @cindex functional package management
442 @cindex isolation
443 Under the hood, Guix implements the @dfn{functional package management}
444 discipline pioneered by Nix (@pxref{Acknowledgments}).
445 In Guix, the package build and installation process is seen
446 as a @emph{function}, in the mathematical sense. That function takes inputs,
447 such as build scripts, a compiler, and libraries, and
448 returns an installed package. As a pure function, its result depends
449 solely on its inputs---for instance, it cannot refer to software or
450 scripts that were not explicitly passed as inputs. A build function
451 always produces the same result when passed a given set of inputs. It
452 cannot alter the environment of the running system in
453 any way; for instance, it cannot create, modify, or delete files outside
454 of its build and installation directories. This is achieved by running
455 build processes in isolated environments (or @dfn{containers}), where only their
456 explicit inputs are visible.
457
458 @cindex store
459 The result of package build functions is @dfn{cached} in the file
460 system, in a special directory called @dfn{the store} (@pxref{The
461 Store}). Each package is installed in a directory of its own in the
462 store---by default under @file{/gnu/store}. The directory name contains
463 a hash of all the inputs used to build that package; thus, changing an
464 input yields a different directory name.
465
466 This approach is the foundation for the salient features of Guix: support
467 for transactional package upgrade and rollback, per-user installation, and
468 garbage collection of packages (@pxref{Features}).
469
470
471 @node GNU Distribution
472 @section GNU Distribution
473
474 @cindex Guix System
475 Guix comes with a distribution of the GNU system consisting entirely of
476 free software@footnote{The term ``free'' here refers to the
477 @url{https://www.gnu.org/philosophy/free-sw.html,freedom provided to
478 users of that software}.}. The
479 distribution can be installed on its own (@pxref{System Installation}),
480 but it is also possible to install Guix as a package manager on top of
481 an installed GNU/Linux system (@pxref{Installation}). When we need to
482 distinguish between the two, we refer to the standalone distribution as
483 Guix@tie{}System.
484
485 The distribution provides core GNU packages such as GNU libc, GCC, and
486 Binutils, as well as many GNU and non-GNU applications. The complete
487 list of available packages can be browsed
488 @url{https://www.gnu.org/software/guix/packages,on-line} or by
489 running @command{guix package} (@pxref{Invoking guix package}):
490
491 @example
492 guix package --list-available
493 @end example
494
495 Our goal is to provide a practical 100% free software distribution of
496 Linux-based and other variants of GNU, with a focus on the promotion and
497 tight integration of GNU components, and an emphasis on programs and
498 tools that help users exert that freedom.
499
500 Packages are currently available on the following platforms:
501
502 @table @code
503
504 @item x86_64-linux
505 Intel/AMD @code{x86_64} architecture, Linux-Libre kernel.
506
507 @item i686-linux
508 Intel 32-bit architecture (IA32), Linux-Libre kernel.
509
510 @item armhf-linux
511 ARMv7-A architecture with hard float, Thumb-2 and NEON,
512 using the EABI hard-float application binary interface (ABI),
513 and Linux-Libre kernel.
514
515 @item aarch64-linux
516 little-endian 64-bit ARMv8-A processors, Linux-Libre kernel.
517
518 @item i586-gnu
519 @uref{https://hurd.gnu.org, GNU/Hurd} on the Intel 32-bit architecture
520 (IA32).
521
522 This configuration is experimental and under development. The easiest
523 way for you to give it a try is by setting up an instance of
524 @code{hurd-vm-service-type} on your GNU/Linux machine
525 (@pxref{transparent-emulation-qemu, @code{hurd-vm-service-type}}).
526 @xref{Contributing}, on how to help!
527
528 @item mips64el-linux (deprecated)
529 little-endian 64-bit MIPS processors, specifically the Loongson series,
530 n32 ABI, and Linux-Libre kernel. This configuration is no longer fully
531 supported; in particular, there is no ongoing work to ensure that this
532 architecture still works. Should someone decide they wish to revive this
533 architecture then the code is still available.
534
535 @item powerpc64le-linux
536 little-endian 64-bit Power ISA processors, Linux-Libre kernel. This
537 includes POWER9 systems such as the
538 @uref{https://www.fsf.org/news/talos-ii-mainboard-and-talos-ii-lite-mainboard-now-fsf-certified-to-respect-your-freedom,
539 RYF Talos II mainboard}. This platform is available as a "technology
540 preview": although it is supported, substitutes are not yet available
541 from the build farm (@pxref{Substitutes}), and some packages may fail to
542 build (@pxref{Tracking Bugs and Patches}). That said, the Guix
543 community is actively working on improving this support, and now is a
544 great time to try it and get involved!
545
546 @end table
547
548 With Guix@tie{}System, you @emph{declare} all aspects of the operating system
549 configuration and Guix takes care of instantiating the configuration in a
550 transactional, reproducible, and stateless fashion (@pxref{System
551 Configuration}). Guix System uses the Linux-libre kernel, the Shepherd
552 initialization system (@pxref{Introduction,,, shepherd, The GNU Shepherd
553 Manual}), the well-known GNU utilities and tool chain, as well as the
554 graphical environment or system services of your choice.
555
556 Guix System is available on all the above platforms except
557 @code{mips64el-linux} and @code{powerpc64le-linux}.
558
559 @noindent
560 For information on porting to other architectures or kernels,
561 @pxref{Porting}.
562
563 Building this distribution is a cooperative effort, and you are invited
564 to join! @xref{Contributing}, for information about how you can help.
565
566
567 @c *********************************************************************
568 @node Installation
569 @chapter Installation
570
571 @cindex installing Guix
572
573 @quotation Note
574 We recommend the use of this
575 @uref{https://git.savannah.gnu.org/cgit/guix.git/plain/etc/guix-install.sh,
576 shell installer script} to install Guix on top of a running GNU/Linux system,
577 thereafter called a @dfn{foreign distro}.@footnote{This section is concerned
578 with the installation of the package manager, which can be done on top of a
579 running GNU/Linux system. If, instead, you want to install the complete GNU
580 operating system, @pxref{System Installation}.} The script automates the
581 download, installation, and initial configuration of Guix. It should be run
582 as the root user.
583 @end quotation
584
585 @cindex foreign distro
586 @cindex directories related to foreign distro
587 When installed on a foreign distro, GNU@tie{}Guix complements the available
588 tools without interference. Its data lives exclusively in two directories,
589 usually @file{/gnu/store} and @file{/var/guix}; other files on your system,
590 such as @file{/etc}, are left untouched.
591
592 Once installed, Guix can be updated by running @command{guix pull}
593 (@pxref{Invoking guix pull}).
594
595 If you prefer to perform the installation steps manually or want to tweak
596 them, you may find the following subsections useful. They describe the
597 software requirements of Guix, as well as how to install it manually and get
598 ready to use it.
599
600 @menu
601 * Binary Installation:: Getting Guix running in no time!
602 * Requirements:: Software needed to build and run Guix.
603 * Running the Test Suite:: Testing Guix.
604 * Setting Up the Daemon:: Preparing the build daemon's environment.
605 * Invoking guix-daemon:: Running the build daemon.
606 * Application Setup:: Application-specific setup.
607 * Upgrading Guix:: Upgrading Guix and its build daemon.
608 @end menu
609
610 @node Binary Installation
611 @section Binary Installation
612
613 @cindex installing Guix from binaries
614 @cindex installer script
615 This section describes how to install Guix on an arbitrary system from a
616 self-contained tarball providing binaries for Guix and for all its
617 dependencies. This is often quicker than installing from source, which
618 is described in the next sections. The only requirement is to have
619 GNU@tie{}tar and Xz.
620
621 @c Note duplicated from the ``Installation'' node.
622 @quotation Note
623 We recommend the use of this
624 @uref{https://git.savannah.gnu.org/cgit/guix.git/plain/etc/guix-install.sh,
625 shell installer script}. The script automates the download, installation, and
626 initial configuration steps described below. It should be run as the root
627 user. As root, you can thus run this:
628
629 @example
630 cd /tmp
631 wget https://git.savannah.gnu.org/cgit/guix.git/plain/etc/guix-install.sh
632 chmod +x guix-install.sh
633 ./guix-install.sh
634 @end example
635
636 When you're done, @pxref{Application Setup} for extra configuration you
637 might need, and @ref{Getting Started} for your first steps!
638 @end quotation
639
640 Installing goes along these lines:
641
642 @enumerate
643 @item
644 @cindex downloading Guix binary
645 Download the binary tarball from
646 @indicateurl{@value{BASE-URL}/guix-binary-@value{VERSION}.x86_64-linux.tar.xz},
647 where @code{x86_64-linux} can be replaced with @code{i686-linux} for an
648 @code{i686} (32-bits) machine already running the kernel Linux, and so on
649 (@pxref{GNU Distribution}).
650
651 @c The following is somewhat duplicated in ``System Installation''.
652 Make sure to download the associated @file{.sig} file and to verify the
653 authenticity of the tarball against it, along these lines:
654
655 @example
656 $ wget @value{BASE-URL}/guix-binary-@value{VERSION}.x86_64-linux.tar.xz.sig
657 $ gpg --verify guix-binary-@value{VERSION}.x86_64-linux.tar.xz.sig
658 @end example
659
660 If that command fails because you do not have the required public key,
661 then run this command to import it:
662
663 @example
664 $ wget '@value{OPENPGP-SIGNING-KEY-URL}' \
665 -qO - | gpg --import -
666 @end example
667
668 @noindent
669 and rerun the @code{gpg --verify} command.
670
671 Take note that a warning like ``This key is not certified with a trusted
672 signature!'' is normal.
673
674 @c end authentication part
675
676 @item
677 Now, you need to become the @code{root} user. Depending on your distribution,
678 you may have to run @code{su -} or @code{sudo -i}. As @code{root}, run:
679
680 @example
681 # cd /tmp
682 # tar --warning=no-timestamp -xf \
683 /path/to/guix-binary-@value{VERSION}.x86_64-linux.tar.xz
684 # mv var/guix /var/ && mv gnu /
685 @end example
686
687 This creates @file{/gnu/store} (@pxref{The Store}) and @file{/var/guix}.
688 The latter contains a ready-to-use profile for @code{root} (see next
689 step).
690
691 Do @emph{not} unpack the tarball on a working Guix system since that
692 would overwrite its own essential files.
693
694 The @option{--warning=no-timestamp} option makes sure GNU@tie{}tar does
695 not emit warnings about ``implausibly old time stamps'' (such
696 warnings were triggered by GNU@tie{}tar 1.26 and older; recent
697 versions are fine).
698 They stem from the fact that all the
699 files in the archive have their modification time set to 1 (which
700 means January 1st, 1970). This is done on purpose to make sure the
701 archive content is independent of its creation time, thus making it
702 reproducible.
703
704 @item
705 Make the profile available under @file{~root/.config/guix/current}, which is
706 where @command{guix pull} will install updates (@pxref{Invoking guix pull}):
707
708 @example
709 # mkdir -p ~root/.config/guix
710 # ln -sf /var/guix/profiles/per-user/root/current-guix \
711 ~root/.config/guix/current
712 @end example
713
714 Source @file{etc/profile} to augment @env{PATH} and other relevant
715 environment variables:
716
717 @example
718 # GUIX_PROFILE="`echo ~root`/.config/guix/current" ; \
719 source $GUIX_PROFILE/etc/profile
720 @end example
721
722 @item
723 Create the group and user accounts for build users as explained below
724 (@pxref{Build Environment Setup}).
725
726 @item
727 Run the daemon, and set it to automatically start on boot.
728
729 If your host distro uses the systemd init system, this can be achieved
730 with these commands:
731
732 @c Versions of systemd that supported symlinked service files are not
733 @c yet widely deployed, so we should suggest that users copy the service
734 @c files into place.
735 @c
736 @c See this thread for more information:
737 @c https://lists.gnu.org/archive/html/guix-devel/2017-01/msg01199.html
738
739 @example
740 # cp ~root/.config/guix/current/lib/systemd/system/gnu-store.mount \
741 ~root/.config/guix/current/lib/systemd/system/guix-daemon.service \
742 /etc/systemd/system/
743 # systemctl enable --now gnu-store.mount guix-daemon
744 @end example
745
746 You may also want to arrange for @command{guix gc} to run periodically:
747
748 @example
749 # cp ~root/.config/guix/current/lib/systemd/system/guix-gc.service \
750 ~root/.config/guix/current/lib/systemd/system/guix-gc.timer \
751 /etc/systemd/system/
752 # systemctl enable --now guix-gc.timer
753 @end example
754
755 You may want to edit @file{guix-gc.service} to adjust the command line
756 options to fit your needs (@pxref{Invoking guix gc}).
757
758 If your host distro uses the Upstart init system:
759
760 @example
761 # initctl reload-configuration
762 # cp ~root/.config/guix/current/lib/upstart/system/guix-daemon.conf \
763 /etc/init/
764 # start guix-daemon
765 @end example
766
767 Otherwise, you can still start the daemon manually with:
768
769 @example
770 # ~root/.config/guix/current/bin/guix-daemon \
771 --build-users-group=guixbuild
772 @end example
773
774 @item
775 Make the @command{guix} command available to other users on the machine,
776 for instance with:
777
778 @example
779 # mkdir -p /usr/local/bin
780 # cd /usr/local/bin
781 # ln -s /var/guix/profiles/per-user/root/current-guix/bin/guix
782 @end example
783
784 It is also a good idea to make the Info version of this manual available
785 there:
786
787 @example
788 # mkdir -p /usr/local/share/info
789 # cd /usr/local/share/info
790 # for i in /var/guix/profiles/per-user/root/current-guix/share/info/* ;
791 do ln -s $i ; done
792 @end example
793
794 That way, assuming @file{/usr/local/share/info} is in the search path,
795 running @command{info guix} will open this manual (@pxref{Other Info
796 Directories,,, texinfo, GNU Texinfo}, for more details on changing the
797 Info search path).
798
799 @item
800 @cindex substitutes, authorization thereof
801 To use substitutes from @code{@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER-1}},
802 @code{@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER-2}} or a mirror (@pxref{Substitutes}),
803 authorize them:
804
805 @example
806 # guix archive --authorize < \
807 ~root/.config/guix/current/share/guix/@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER-1}.pub
808 # guix archive --authorize < \
809 ~root/.config/guix/current/share/guix/@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER-2}.pub
810 @end example
811
812 @quotation Note
813 If you do not enable substitutes, Guix will end up building
814 @emph{everything} from source on your machine, making each installation
815 and upgrade very expensive. @xref{On Trusting Binaries}, for a
816 discussion of reasons why one might want do disable substitutes.
817 @end quotation
818
819 @item
820 Each user may need to perform a few additional steps to make their Guix
821 environment ready for use, @pxref{Application Setup}.
822 @end enumerate
823
824 Voilà, the installation is complete!
825
826 You can confirm that Guix is working by installing a sample package into
827 the root profile:
828
829 @example
830 # guix install hello
831 @end example
832
833 The binary installation tarball can be (re)produced and verified simply
834 by running the following command in the Guix source tree:
835
836 @example
837 make guix-binary.@var{system}.tar.xz
838 @end example
839
840 @noindent
841 ...@: which, in turn, runs:
842
843 @example
844 guix pack -s @var{system} --localstatedir \
845 --profile-name=current-guix guix
846 @end example
847
848 @xref{Invoking guix pack}, for more info on this handy tool.
849
850 @node Requirements
851 @section Requirements
852
853 This section lists requirements when building Guix from source. The
854 build procedure for Guix is the same as for other GNU software, and is
855 not covered here. Please see the files @file{README} and @file{INSTALL}
856 in the Guix source tree for additional details.
857
858 @cindex official website
859 GNU Guix is available for download from its website at
860 @url{https://www.gnu.org/software/guix/}.
861
862 GNU Guix depends on the following packages:
863
864 @itemize
865 @item @url{https://gnu.org/software/guile/, GNU Guile}, version 3.0.x;
866 @item @url{https://notabug.org/cwebber/guile-gcrypt, Guile-Gcrypt}, version
867 0.1.0 or later;
868 @item
869 @uref{https://gnutls.org/, GnuTLS}, specifically its Guile bindings
870 (@pxref{Guile Preparations, how to install the GnuTLS bindings for
871 Guile,, gnutls-guile, GnuTLS-Guile});
872 @item
873 @uref{https://notabug.org/guile-sqlite3/guile-sqlite3, Guile-SQLite3}, version 0.1.0
874 or later;
875 @item @uref{https://notabug.org/guile-zlib/guile-zlib, Guile-zlib},
876 version 0.1.0 or later;
877 @item @uref{https://notabug.org/guile-lzlib/guile-lzlib, Guile-lzlib};
878 @item @uref{https://www.nongnu.org/guile-avahi/, Guile-Avahi};
879 @item
880 @uref{https://gitlab.com/guile-git/guile-git, Guile-Git}, version 0.5.0
881 or later;
882 @item @uref{https://savannah.nongnu.org/projects/guile-json/, Guile-JSON}
883 4.3.0 or later;
884 @item @url{https://www.gnu.org/software/make/, GNU Make}.
885 @end itemize
886
887 The following dependencies are optional:
888
889 @itemize
890 @item
891 @c Note: We need at least 0.13.0 for #:nodelay.
892 Support for build offloading (@pxref{Daemon Offload Setup}) and
893 @command{guix copy} (@pxref{Invoking guix copy}) depends on
894 @uref{https://github.com/artyom-poptsov/guile-ssh, Guile-SSH},
895 version 0.13.0 or later.
896
897 @item
898 @uref{https://notabug.org/guile-zstd/guile-zstd, Guile-zstd}, for zstd
899 compression and decompression in @command{guix publish} and for
900 substitutes (@pxref{Invoking guix publish}).
901
902 @item
903 @uref{https://ngyro.com/software/guile-semver.html, Guile-Semver} for
904 the @code{crate} importer (@pxref{Invoking guix import}).
905
906 @item
907 @uref{https://www.nongnu.org/guile-lib/doc/ref/htmlprag/, Guile-Lib} for
908 the @code{go} importer (@pxref{Invoking guix import}) and for some of
909 the ``updaters'' (@pxref{Invoking guix refresh}).
910
911 @item
912 When @url{http://www.bzip.org, libbz2} is available,
913 @command{guix-daemon} can use it to compress build logs.
914 @end itemize
915
916 Unless @option{--disable-daemon} was passed to @command{configure}, the
917 following packages are also needed:
918
919 @itemize
920 @item @url{https://gnupg.org/, GNU libgcrypt};
921 @item @url{https://sqlite.org, SQLite 3};
922 @item @url{https://gcc.gnu.org, GCC's g++}, with support for the
923 C++11 standard.
924 @end itemize
925
926 @cindex state directory
927 When configuring Guix on a system that already has a Guix installation,
928 be sure to specify the same state directory as the existing installation
929 using the @option{--localstatedir} option of the @command{configure}
930 script (@pxref{Directory Variables, @code{localstatedir},, standards,
931 GNU Coding Standards}). Usually, this @var{localstatedir} option is
932 set to the value @file{/var}. The @command{configure} script protects
933 against unintended misconfiguration of @var{localstatedir} so you do not
934 inadvertently corrupt your store (@pxref{The Store}).
935
936 @node Running the Test Suite
937 @section Running the Test Suite
938
939 @cindex test suite
940 After a successful @command{configure} and @code{make} run, it is a good
941 idea to run the test suite. It can help catch issues with the setup or
942 environment, or bugs in Guix itself---and really, reporting test
943 failures is a good way to help improve the software. To run the test
944 suite, type:
945
946 @example
947 make check
948 @end example
949
950 Test cases can run in parallel: you can use the @code{-j} option of
951 GNU@tie{}make to speed things up. The first run may take a few minutes
952 on a recent machine; subsequent runs will be faster because the store
953 that is created for test purposes will already have various things in
954 cache.
955
956 It is also possible to run a subset of the tests by defining the
957 @code{TESTS} makefile variable as in this example:
958
959 @example
960 make check TESTS="tests/store.scm tests/cpio.scm"
961 @end example
962
963 By default, tests results are displayed at a file level. In order to
964 see the details of every individual test cases, it is possible to define
965 the @code{SCM_LOG_DRIVER_FLAGS} makefile variable as in this example:
966
967 @example
968 make check TESTS="tests/base64.scm" SCM_LOG_DRIVER_FLAGS="--brief=no"
969 @end example
970
971 The underlying SRFI 64 custom Automake test driver used for the 'check'
972 test suite (located at @file{build-aux/test-driver.scm}) also allows
973 selecting which test cases to run at a finer level, via its
974 @option{--select} and @option{--exclude} options. Here's an example, to
975 run all the test cases from the @file{tests/packages.scm} test file
976 whose names start with ``transaction-upgrade-entry'':
977
978 @example
979 export SCM_LOG_DRIVER_FLAGS="--select=^transaction-upgrade-entry"
980 make check TESTS="tests/packages.scm"
981 @end example
982
983 Those wishing to inspect the results of failed tests directly from the
984 command line can add the @option{--errors-only=yes} option to the
985 @code{SCM_LOG_DRIVER_FLAGS} makefile variable and set the @code{VERBOSE}
986 Automake makefile variable, as in:
987
988 @example
989 make check SCM_LOG_DRIVER_FLAGS="--brief=no --errors-only=yes" VERBOSE=1
990 @end example
991
992 The @option{--show-duration=yes} option can be used to print the
993 duration of the individual test cases, when used in combination with
994 @option{--brief=no}:
995
996 @example
997 make check SCM_LOG_DRIVER_FLAGS="--brief=no --show-duration=yes"
998 @end example
999
1000 @xref{Parallel Test Harness,,,automake,GNU Automake} for more
1001 information about the Automake Parallel Test Harness.
1002
1003 Upon failure, please email @email{bug-guix@@gnu.org} and attach the
1004 @file{test-suite.log} file. Please specify the Guix version being used
1005 as well as version numbers of the dependencies (@pxref{Requirements}) in
1006 your message.
1007
1008 Guix also comes with a whole-system test suite that tests complete
1009 Guix System instances. It can only run on systems where
1010 Guix is already installed, using:
1011
1012 @example
1013 make check-system
1014 @end example
1015
1016 @noindent
1017 or, again, by defining @code{TESTS} to select a subset of tests to run:
1018
1019 @example
1020 make check-system TESTS="basic mcron"
1021 @end example
1022
1023 These system tests are defined in the @code{(gnu tests @dots{})}
1024 modules. They work by running the operating systems under test with
1025 lightweight instrumentation in a virtual machine (VM). They can be
1026 computationally intensive or rather cheap, depending on whether
1027 substitutes are available for their dependencies (@pxref{Substitutes}).
1028 Some of them require a lot of storage space to hold VM images.
1029
1030 Again in case of test failures, please send @email{bug-guix@@gnu.org}
1031 all the details.
1032
1033 @node Setting Up the Daemon
1034 @section Setting Up the Daemon
1035
1036 @cindex daemon
1037 Operations such as building a package or running the garbage collector
1038 are all performed by a specialized process, the @dfn{build daemon}, on
1039 behalf of clients. Only the daemon may access the store and its
1040 associated database. Thus, any operation that manipulates the store
1041 goes through the daemon. For instance, command-line tools such as
1042 @command{guix package} and @command{guix build} communicate with the
1043 daemon (@i{via} remote procedure calls) to instruct it what to do.
1044
1045 The following sections explain how to prepare the build daemon's
1046 environment. See also @ref{Substitutes}, for information on how to allow
1047 the daemon to download pre-built binaries.
1048
1049 @menu
1050 * Build Environment Setup:: Preparing the isolated build environment.
1051 * Daemon Offload Setup:: Offloading builds to remote machines.
1052 * SELinux Support:: Using an SELinux policy for the daemon.
1053 @end menu
1054
1055 @node Build Environment Setup
1056 @subsection Build Environment Setup
1057
1058 @cindex build environment
1059 In a standard multi-user setup, Guix and its daemon---the
1060 @command{guix-daemon} program---are installed by the system
1061 administrator; @file{/gnu/store} is owned by @code{root} and
1062 @command{guix-daemon} runs as @code{root}. Unprivileged users may use
1063 Guix tools to build packages or otherwise access the store, and the
1064 daemon will do it on their behalf, ensuring that the store is kept in a
1065 consistent state, and allowing built packages to be shared among users.
1066
1067 @cindex build users
1068 When @command{guix-daemon} runs as @code{root}, you may not want package
1069 build processes themselves to run as @code{root} too, for obvious
1070 security reasons. To avoid that, a special pool of @dfn{build users}
1071 should be created for use by build processes started by the daemon.
1072 These build users need not have a shell and a home directory: they will
1073 just be used when the daemon drops @code{root} privileges in build
1074 processes. Having several such users allows the daemon to launch
1075 distinct build processes under separate UIDs, which guarantees that they
1076 do not interfere with each other---an essential feature since builds are
1077 regarded as pure functions (@pxref{Introduction}).
1078
1079 On a GNU/Linux system, a build user pool may be created like this (using
1080 Bash syntax and the @code{shadow} commands):
1081
1082 @c See https://lists.gnu.org/archive/html/bug-guix/2013-01/msg00239.html
1083 @c for why `-G' is needed.
1084 @example
1085 # groupadd --system guixbuild
1086 # for i in $(seq -w 1 10);
1087 do
1088 useradd -g guixbuild -G guixbuild \
1089 -d /var/empty -s $(which nologin) \
1090 -c "Guix build user $i" --system \
1091 guixbuilder$i;
1092 done
1093 @end example
1094
1095 @noindent
1096 The number of build users determines how many build jobs may run in
1097 parallel, as specified by the @option{--max-jobs} option
1098 (@pxref{Invoking guix-daemon, @option{--max-jobs}}). To use
1099 @command{guix system vm} and related commands, you may need to add the
1100 build users to the @code{kvm} group so they can access @file{/dev/kvm},
1101 using @code{-G guixbuild,kvm} instead of @code{-G guixbuild}
1102 (@pxref{Invoking guix system}).
1103
1104 The @code{guix-daemon} program may then be run as @code{root} with the
1105 following command@footnote{If your machine uses the systemd init system,
1106 dropping the @file{@var{prefix}/lib/systemd/system/guix-daemon.service}
1107 file in @file{/etc/systemd/system} will ensure that
1108 @command{guix-daemon} is automatically started. Similarly, if your
1109 machine uses the Upstart init system, drop the
1110 @file{@var{prefix}/lib/upstart/system/guix-daemon.conf}
1111 file in @file{/etc/init}.}:
1112
1113 @example
1114 # guix-daemon --build-users-group=guixbuild
1115 @end example
1116
1117 @cindex chroot
1118 @noindent
1119 This way, the daemon starts build processes in a chroot, under one of
1120 the @code{guixbuilder} users. On GNU/Linux, by default, the chroot
1121 environment contains nothing but:
1122
1123 @c Keep this list in sync with libstore/build.cc! -----------------------
1124 @itemize
1125 @item
1126 a minimal @code{/dev} directory, created mostly independently from the
1127 host @code{/dev}@footnote{``Mostly'', because while the set of files
1128 that appear in the chroot's @code{/dev} is fixed, most of these files
1129 can only be created if the host has them.};
1130
1131 @item
1132 the @code{/proc} directory; it only shows the processes of the container
1133 since a separate PID name space is used;
1134
1135 @item
1136 @file{/etc/passwd} with an entry for the current user and an entry for
1137 user @file{nobody};
1138
1139 @item
1140 @file{/etc/group} with an entry for the user's group;
1141
1142 @item
1143 @file{/etc/hosts} with an entry that maps @code{localhost} to
1144 @code{127.0.0.1};
1145
1146 @item
1147 a writable @file{/tmp} directory.
1148 @end itemize
1149
1150 You can influence the directory where the daemon stores build trees
1151 @i{via} the @env{TMPDIR} environment variable. However, the build tree
1152 within the chroot is always called @file{/tmp/guix-build-@var{name}.drv-0},
1153 where @var{name} is the derivation name---e.g., @code{coreutils-8.24}.
1154 This way, the value of @env{TMPDIR} does not leak inside build
1155 environments, which avoids discrepancies in cases where build processes
1156 capture the name of their build tree.
1157
1158 @vindex http_proxy
1159 @vindex https_proxy
1160 The daemon also honors the @env{http_proxy} and @env{https_proxy}
1161 environment variables for HTTP and HTTPS downloads it performs, be it
1162 for fixed-output derivations (@pxref{Derivations}) or for substitutes
1163 (@pxref{Substitutes}).
1164
1165 If you are installing Guix as an unprivileged user, it is still possible
1166 to run @command{guix-daemon} provided you pass @option{--disable-chroot}.
1167 However, build processes will not be isolated from one another, and not
1168 from the rest of the system. Thus, build processes may interfere with
1169 each other, and may access programs, libraries, and other files
1170 available on the system---making it much harder to view them as
1171 @emph{pure} functions.
1172
1173
1174 @node Daemon Offload Setup
1175 @subsection Using the Offload Facility
1176
1177 @cindex offloading
1178 @cindex build hook
1179 When desired, the build daemon can @dfn{offload} derivation builds to
1180 other machines running Guix, using the @code{offload} @dfn{build
1181 hook}@footnote{This feature is available only when
1182 @uref{https://github.com/artyom-poptsov/guile-ssh, Guile-SSH} is
1183 present.}. When that feature is enabled, a list of user-specified build
1184 machines is read from @file{/etc/guix/machines.scm}; every time a build
1185 is requested, for instance via @code{guix build}, the daemon attempts to
1186 offload it to one of the machines that satisfy the constraints of the
1187 derivation, in particular its system types---e.g., @code{x86_64-linux}.
1188 A single machine can have multiple system types, either because its
1189 architecture natively supports it, via emulation
1190 (@pxref{transparent-emulation-qemu, Transparent Emulation with QEMU}),
1191 or both. Missing prerequisites for the build are
1192 copied over SSH to the target machine, which then proceeds with the
1193 build; upon success the output(s) of the build are copied back to the
1194 initial machine. The offload facility comes with a basic scheduler that
1195 attempts to select the best machine. The best machine is chosen among
1196 the available machines based on criteria such as:
1197
1198 @enumerate
1199 @item
1200 The availability of a build slot. A build machine can have as many
1201 build slots (connections) as the value of the @code{parallel-builds}
1202 field of its @code{build-machine} object.
1203
1204 @item
1205 Its relative speed, as defined via the @code{speed} field of its
1206 @code{build-machine} object.
1207
1208 @item
1209 Its load. The normalized machine load must be lower than a threshold
1210 value, configurable via the @code{overload-threshold} field of its
1211 @code{build-machine} object.
1212
1213 @item
1214 Disk space availability. More than a 100 MiB must be available.
1215 @end enumerate
1216
1217 The @file{/etc/guix/machines.scm} file typically looks like this:
1218
1219 @lisp
1220 (list (build-machine
1221 (name "eightysix.example.org")
1222 (systems (list "x86_64-linux" "i686-linux"))
1223 (host-key "ssh-ed25519 AAAAC3Nza@dots{}")
1224 (user "bob")
1225 (speed 2.)) ;incredibly fast!
1226
1227 (build-machine
1228 (name "armeight.example.org")
1229 (systems (list "aarch64-linux"))
1230 (host-key "ssh-rsa AAAAB3Nza@dots{}")
1231 (user "alice")
1232 (private-key
1233 (string-append (getenv "HOME")
1234 "/.ssh/identity-for-guix"))))
1235 @end lisp
1236
1237 @noindent
1238 In the example above we specify a list of two build machines, one for
1239 the @code{x86_64} and @code{i686} architectures and one for the
1240 @code{aarch64} architecture.
1241
1242 In fact, this file is---not surprisingly!---a Scheme file that is
1243 evaluated when the @code{offload} hook is started. Its return value
1244 must be a list of @code{build-machine} objects. While this example
1245 shows a fixed list of build machines, one could imagine, say, using
1246 DNS-SD to return a list of potential build machines discovered in the
1247 local network (@pxref{Introduction, Guile-Avahi,, guile-avahi, Using
1248 Avahi in Guile Scheme Programs}). The @code{build-machine} data type is
1249 detailed below.
1250
1251 @deftp {Data Type} build-machine
1252 This data type represents build machines to which the daemon may offload
1253 builds. The important fields are:
1254
1255 @table @code
1256
1257 @item name
1258 The host name of the remote machine.
1259
1260 @item systems
1261 The system types the remote machine supports---e.g., @code{(list
1262 "x86_64-linux" "i686-linux")}.
1263
1264 @item user
1265 The user account to use when connecting to the remote machine over SSH.
1266 Note that the SSH key pair must @emph{not} be passphrase-protected, to
1267 allow non-interactive logins.
1268
1269 @item host-key
1270 This must be the machine's SSH @dfn{public host key} in OpenSSH format.
1271 This is used to authenticate the machine when we connect to it. It is a
1272 long string that looks like this:
1273
1274 @example
1275 ssh-ed25519 AAAAC3NzaC@dots{}mde+UhL hint@@example.org
1276 @end example
1277
1278 If the machine is running the OpenSSH daemon, @command{sshd}, the host
1279 key can be found in a file such as
1280 @file{/etc/ssh/ssh_host_ed25519_key.pub}.
1281
1282 If the machine is running the SSH daemon of GNU@tie{}lsh,
1283 @command{lshd}, the host key is in @file{/etc/lsh/host-key.pub} or a
1284 similar file. It can be converted to the OpenSSH format using
1285 @command{lsh-export-key} (@pxref{Converting keys,,, lsh, LSH Manual}):
1286
1287 @example
1288 $ lsh-export-key --openssh < /etc/lsh/host-key.pub
1289 ssh-rsa AAAAB3NzaC1yc2EAAAAEOp8FoQAAAQEAs1eB46LV@dots{}
1290 @end example
1291
1292 @end table
1293
1294 A number of optional fields may be specified:
1295
1296 @table @asis
1297
1298 @item @code{port} (default: @code{22})
1299 Port number of SSH server on the machine.
1300
1301 @item @code{private-key} (default: @file{~root/.ssh/id_rsa})
1302 The SSH private key file to use when connecting to the machine, in
1303 OpenSSH format. This key must not be protected with a passphrase.
1304
1305 Note that the default value is the private key @emph{of the root
1306 account}. Make sure it exists if you use the default.
1307
1308 @item @code{compression} (default: @code{"zlib@@openssh.com,zlib"})
1309 @itemx @code{compression-level} (default: @code{3})
1310 The SSH-level compression methods and compression level requested.
1311
1312 Note that offloading relies on SSH compression to reduce bandwidth usage
1313 when transferring files to and from build machines.
1314
1315 @item @code{daemon-socket} (default: @code{"/var/guix/daemon-socket/socket"})
1316 File name of the Unix-domain socket @command{guix-daemon} is listening
1317 to on that machine.
1318
1319 @item @code{overload-threshold} (default: @code{0.6})
1320 The load threshold above which a potential offload machine is
1321 disregarded by the offload scheduler. The value roughly translates to
1322 the total processor usage of the build machine, ranging from 0.0 (0%) to
1323 1.0 (100%). It can also be disabled by setting
1324 @code{overload-threshold} to @code{#f}.
1325
1326 @item @code{parallel-builds} (default: @code{1})
1327 The number of builds that may run in parallel on the machine.
1328
1329 @item @code{speed} (default: @code{1.0})
1330 A ``relative speed factor''. The offload scheduler will tend to prefer
1331 machines with a higher speed factor.
1332
1333 @item @code{features} (default: @code{'()})
1334 A list of strings denoting specific features supported by the machine.
1335 An example is @code{"kvm"} for machines that have the KVM Linux modules
1336 and corresponding hardware support. Derivations can request features by
1337 name, and they will be scheduled on matching build machines.
1338
1339 @end table
1340 @end deftp
1341
1342 The @command{guix} command must be in the search path on the build
1343 machines. You can check whether this is the case by running:
1344
1345 @example
1346 ssh build-machine guix repl --version
1347 @end example
1348
1349 There is one last thing to do once @file{machines.scm} is in place. As
1350 explained above, when offloading, files are transferred back and forth
1351 between the machine stores. For this to work, you first need to
1352 generate a key pair on each machine to allow the daemon to export signed
1353 archives of files from the store (@pxref{Invoking guix archive}):
1354
1355 @example
1356 # guix archive --generate-key
1357 @end example
1358
1359 @noindent
1360 Each build machine must authorize the key of the master machine so that
1361 it accepts store items it receives from the master:
1362
1363 @example
1364 # guix archive --authorize < master-public-key.txt
1365 @end example
1366
1367 @noindent
1368 Likewise, the master machine must authorize the key of each build machine.
1369
1370 All the fuss with keys is here to express pairwise mutual trust
1371 relations between the master and the build machines. Concretely, when
1372 the master receives files from a build machine (and @i{vice versa}), its
1373 build daemon can make sure they are genuine, have not been tampered
1374 with, and that they are signed by an authorized key.
1375
1376 @cindex offload test
1377 To test whether your setup is operational, run this command on the
1378 master node:
1379
1380 @example
1381 # guix offload test
1382 @end example
1383
1384 This will attempt to connect to each of the build machines specified in
1385 @file{/etc/guix/machines.scm}, make sure Guix is
1386 available on each machine, attempt to export to the machine and import
1387 from it, and report any error in the process.
1388
1389 If you want to test a different machine file, just specify it on the
1390 command line:
1391
1392 @example
1393 # guix offload test machines-qualif.scm
1394 @end example
1395
1396 Last, you can test the subset of the machines whose name matches a
1397 regular expression like this:
1398
1399 @example
1400 # guix offload test machines.scm '\.gnu\.org$'
1401 @end example
1402
1403 @cindex offload status
1404 To display the current load of all build hosts, run this command on the
1405 main node:
1406
1407 @example
1408 # guix offload status
1409 @end example
1410
1411
1412 @node SELinux Support
1413 @subsection SELinux Support
1414
1415 @cindex SELinux, daemon policy
1416 @cindex mandatory access control, SELinux
1417 @cindex security, guix-daemon
1418 Guix includes an SELinux policy file at @file{etc/guix-daemon.cil} that
1419 can be installed on a system where SELinux is enabled, in order to label
1420 Guix files and to specify the expected behavior of the daemon. Since
1421 Guix System does not provide an SELinux base policy, the daemon policy cannot
1422 be used on Guix System.
1423
1424 @subsubsection Installing the SELinux policy
1425 @cindex SELinux, policy installation
1426 To install the policy run this command as root:
1427
1428 @example
1429 semodule -i etc/guix-daemon.cil
1430 @end example
1431
1432 Then relabel the file system with @code{restorecon} or by a different
1433 mechanism provided by your system.
1434
1435 Once the policy is installed, the file system has been relabeled, and
1436 the daemon has been restarted, it should be running in the
1437 @code{guix_daemon_t} context. You can confirm this with the following
1438 command:
1439
1440 @example
1441 ps -Zax | grep guix-daemon
1442 @end example
1443
1444 Monitor the SELinux log files as you run a command like @code{guix build
1445 hello} to convince yourself that SELinux permits all necessary
1446 operations.
1447
1448 @subsubsection Limitations
1449 @cindex SELinux, limitations
1450
1451 This policy is not perfect. Here is a list of limitations or quirks
1452 that should be considered when deploying the provided SELinux policy for
1453 the Guix daemon.
1454
1455 @enumerate
1456 @item
1457 @code{guix_daemon_socket_t} isn’t actually used. None of the socket
1458 operations involve contexts that have anything to do with
1459 @code{guix_daemon_socket_t}. It doesn’t hurt to have this unused label,
1460 but it would be preferable to define socket rules for only this label.
1461
1462 @item
1463 @code{guix gc} cannot access arbitrary links to profiles. By design,
1464 the file label of the destination of a symlink is independent of the
1465 file label of the link itself. Although all profiles under
1466 $localstatedir are labelled, the links to these profiles inherit the
1467 label of the directory they are in. For links in the user’s home
1468 directory this will be @code{user_home_t}. But for links from the root
1469 user’s home directory, or @file{/tmp}, or the HTTP server’s working
1470 directory, etc, this won’t work. @code{guix gc} would be prevented from
1471 reading and following these links.
1472
1473 @item
1474 The daemon’s feature to listen for TCP connections might no longer work.
1475 This might require extra rules, because SELinux treats network sockets
1476 differently from files.
1477
1478 @item
1479 Currently all files with a name matching the regular expression
1480 @code{/gnu/store/.+-(guix-.+|profile)/bin/guix-daemon} are assigned the
1481 label @code{guix_daemon_exec_t}; this means that @emph{any} file with
1482 that name in any profile would be permitted to run in the
1483 @code{guix_daemon_t} domain. This is not ideal. An attacker could
1484 build a package that provides this executable and convince a user to
1485 install and run it, which lifts it into the @code{guix_daemon_t} domain.
1486 At that point SELinux could not prevent it from accessing files that are
1487 allowed for processes in that domain.
1488
1489 You will need to relabel the store directory after all upgrades to
1490 @file{guix-daemon}, such as after running @code{guix pull}. Assuming the
1491 store is in @file{/gnu}, you can do this with @code{restorecon -vR /gnu},
1492 or by other means provided by your operating system.
1493
1494 We could generate a much more restrictive policy at installation time,
1495 so that only the @emph{exact} file name of the currently installed
1496 @code{guix-daemon} executable would be labelled with
1497 @code{guix_daemon_exec_t}, instead of using a broad regular expression.
1498 The downside is that root would have to install or upgrade the policy at
1499 installation time whenever the Guix package that provides the
1500 effectively running @code{guix-daemon} executable is upgraded.
1501 @end enumerate
1502
1503 @node Invoking guix-daemon
1504 @section Invoking @command{guix-daemon}
1505
1506 The @command{guix-daemon} program implements all the functionality to
1507 access the store. This includes launching build processes, running the
1508 garbage collector, querying the availability of a build result, etc. It
1509 is normally run as @code{root} like this:
1510
1511 @example
1512 # guix-daemon --build-users-group=guixbuild
1513 @end example
1514
1515 @noindent
1516 For details on how to set it up, @pxref{Setting Up the Daemon}.
1517
1518 @cindex chroot
1519 @cindex container, build environment
1520 @cindex build environment
1521 @cindex reproducible builds
1522 By default, @command{guix-daemon} launches build processes under
1523 different UIDs, taken from the build group specified with
1524 @option{--build-users-group}. In addition, each build process is run in a
1525 chroot environment that only contains the subset of the store that the
1526 build process depends on, as specified by its derivation
1527 (@pxref{Programming Interface, derivation}), plus a set of specific
1528 system directories. By default, the latter contains @file{/dev} and
1529 @file{/dev/pts}. Furthermore, on GNU/Linux, the build environment is a
1530 @dfn{container}: in addition to having its own file system tree, it has
1531 a separate mount name space, its own PID name space, network name space,
1532 etc. This helps achieve reproducible builds (@pxref{Features}).
1533
1534 When the daemon performs a build on behalf of the user, it creates a
1535 build directory under @file{/tmp} or under the directory specified by
1536 its @env{TMPDIR} environment variable. This directory is shared with
1537 the container for the duration of the build, though within the container,
1538 the build tree is always called @file{/tmp/guix-build-@var{name}.drv-0}.
1539
1540 The build directory is automatically deleted upon completion, unless the
1541 build failed and the client specified @option{--keep-failed}
1542 (@pxref{Common Build Options, @option{--keep-failed}}).
1543
1544 The daemon listens for connections and spawns one sub-process for each session
1545 started by a client (one of the @command{guix} sub-commands). The
1546 @command{guix processes} command allows you to get an overview of the activity
1547 on your system by viewing each of the active sessions and clients.
1548 @xref{Invoking guix processes}, for more information.
1549
1550 The following command-line options are supported:
1551
1552 @table @code
1553 @item --build-users-group=@var{group}
1554 Take users from @var{group} to run build processes (@pxref{Setting Up
1555 the Daemon, build users}).
1556
1557 @item --no-substitutes
1558 @cindex substitutes
1559 Do not use substitutes for build products. That is, always build things
1560 locally instead of allowing downloads of pre-built binaries
1561 (@pxref{Substitutes}).
1562
1563 When the daemon runs with @option{--no-substitutes}, clients can still
1564 explicitly enable substitution @i{via} the @code{set-build-options}
1565 remote procedure call (@pxref{The Store}).
1566
1567 @anchor{daemon-substitute-urls}
1568 @item --substitute-urls=@var{urls}
1569 Consider @var{urls} the default whitespace-separated list of substitute
1570 source URLs. When this option is omitted,
1571 @indicateurl{@value{SUBSTITUTE-URLS}} is used.
1572
1573 This means that substitutes may be downloaded from @var{urls}, as long
1574 as they are signed by a trusted signature (@pxref{Substitutes}).
1575
1576 @xref{Getting Substitutes from Other Servers}, for more information on
1577 how to configure the daemon to get substitutes from other servers.
1578
1579 @cindex offloading
1580 @item --no-offload
1581 Do not use offload builds to other machines (@pxref{Daemon Offload
1582 Setup}). That is, always build things locally instead of offloading
1583 builds to remote machines.
1584
1585 @item --cache-failures
1586 Cache build failures. By default, only successful builds are cached.
1587
1588 When this option is used, @command{guix gc --list-failures} can be used
1589 to query the set of store items marked as failed; @command{guix gc
1590 --clear-failures} removes store items from the set of cached failures.
1591 @xref{Invoking guix gc}.
1592
1593 @item --cores=@var{n}
1594 @itemx -c @var{n}
1595 Use @var{n} CPU cores to build each derivation; @code{0} means as many
1596 as available.
1597
1598 The default value is @code{0}, but it may be overridden by clients, such
1599 as the @option{--cores} option of @command{guix build} (@pxref{Invoking
1600 guix build}).
1601
1602 The effect is to define the @env{NIX_BUILD_CORES} environment variable
1603 in the build process, which can then use it to exploit internal
1604 parallelism---for instance, by running @code{make -j$NIX_BUILD_CORES}.
1605
1606 @item --max-jobs=@var{n}
1607 @itemx -M @var{n}
1608 Allow at most @var{n} build jobs in parallel. The default value is
1609 @code{1}. Setting it to @code{0} means that no builds will be performed
1610 locally; instead, the daemon will offload builds (@pxref{Daemon Offload
1611 Setup}), or simply fail.
1612
1613 @item --max-silent-time=@var{seconds}
1614 When the build or substitution process remains silent for more than
1615 @var{seconds}, terminate it and report a build failure.
1616
1617 The default value is @code{0}, which disables the timeout.
1618
1619 The value specified here can be overridden by clients (@pxref{Common
1620 Build Options, @option{--max-silent-time}}).
1621
1622 @item --timeout=@var{seconds}
1623 Likewise, when the build or substitution process lasts for more than
1624 @var{seconds}, terminate it and report a build failure.
1625
1626 The default value is @code{0}, which disables the timeout.
1627
1628 The value specified here can be overridden by clients (@pxref{Common
1629 Build Options, @option{--timeout}}).
1630
1631 @item --rounds=@var{N}
1632 Build each derivation @var{n} times in a row, and raise an error if
1633 consecutive build results are not bit-for-bit identical. Note that this
1634 setting can be overridden by clients such as @command{guix build}
1635 (@pxref{Invoking guix build}).
1636
1637 When used in conjunction with @option{--keep-failed}, the differing
1638 output is kept in the store, under @file{/gnu/store/@dots{}-check}.
1639 This makes it easy to look for differences between the two results.
1640
1641 @item --debug
1642 Produce debugging output.
1643
1644 This is useful to debug daemon start-up issues, but then it may be
1645 overridden by clients, for example the @option{--verbosity} option of
1646 @command{guix build} (@pxref{Invoking guix build}).
1647
1648 @item --chroot-directory=@var{dir}
1649 Add @var{dir} to the build chroot.
1650
1651 Doing this may change the result of build processes---for instance if
1652 they use optional dependencies found in @var{dir} when it is available,
1653 and not otherwise. For that reason, it is not recommended to do so.
1654 Instead, make sure that each derivation declares all the inputs that it
1655 needs.
1656
1657 @item --disable-chroot
1658 Disable chroot builds.
1659
1660 Using this option is not recommended since, again, it would allow build
1661 processes to gain access to undeclared dependencies. It is necessary,
1662 though, when @command{guix-daemon} is running under an unprivileged user
1663 account.
1664
1665 @item --log-compression=@var{type}
1666 Compress build logs according to @var{type}, one of @code{gzip},
1667 @code{bzip2}, or @code{none}.
1668
1669 Unless @option{--lose-logs} is used, all the build logs are kept in the
1670 @var{localstatedir}. To save space, the daemon automatically compresses
1671 them with Bzip2 by default.
1672
1673 @item --discover[=yes|no]
1674 Whether to discover substitute servers on the local network using mDNS
1675 and DNS-SD.
1676
1677 This feature is still experimental. However, here are a few
1678 considerations.
1679
1680 @enumerate
1681 @item
1682 It might be faster/less expensive than fetching from remote servers;
1683 @item
1684 There are no security risks, only genuine substitutes will be used
1685 (@pxref{Substitute Authentication});
1686 @item
1687 An attacker advertising @command{guix publish} on your LAN cannot serve
1688 you malicious binaries, but they can learn what software you’re
1689 installing;
1690 @item
1691 Servers may serve substitute over HTTP, unencrypted, so anyone on the
1692 LAN can see what software you’re installing.
1693 @end enumerate
1694
1695 It is also possible to enable or disable substitute server discovery at
1696 run-time by running:
1697
1698 @example
1699 herd discover guix-daemon on
1700 herd discover guix-daemon off
1701 @end example
1702
1703 @item --disable-deduplication
1704 @cindex deduplication
1705 Disable automatic file ``deduplication'' in the store.
1706
1707 By default, files added to the store are automatically ``deduplicated'':
1708 if a newly added file is identical to another one found in the store,
1709 the daemon makes the new file a hard link to the other file. This can
1710 noticeably reduce disk usage, at the expense of slightly increased
1711 input/output load at the end of a build process. This option disables
1712 this optimization.
1713
1714 @item --gc-keep-outputs[=yes|no]
1715 Tell whether the garbage collector (GC) must keep outputs of live
1716 derivations.
1717
1718 @cindex GC roots
1719 @cindex garbage collector roots
1720 When set to @code{yes}, the GC will keep the outputs of any live
1721 derivation available in the store---the @file{.drv} files. The default
1722 is @code{no}, meaning that derivation outputs are kept only if they are
1723 reachable from a GC root. @xref{Invoking guix gc}, for more on GC
1724 roots.
1725
1726 @item --gc-keep-derivations[=yes|no]
1727 Tell whether the garbage collector (GC) must keep derivations
1728 corresponding to live outputs.
1729
1730 When set to @code{yes}, as is the case by default, the GC keeps
1731 derivations---i.e., @file{.drv} files---as long as at least one of their
1732 outputs is live. This allows users to keep track of the origins of
1733 items in their store. Setting it to @code{no} saves a bit of disk
1734 space.
1735
1736 In this way, setting @option{--gc-keep-derivations} to @code{yes} causes
1737 liveness to flow from outputs to derivations, and setting
1738 @option{--gc-keep-outputs} to @code{yes} causes liveness to flow from
1739 derivations to outputs. When both are set to @code{yes}, the effect is
1740 to keep all the build prerequisites (the sources, compiler, libraries,
1741 and other build-time tools) of live objects in the store, regardless of
1742 whether these prerequisites are reachable from a GC root. This is
1743 convenient for developers since it saves rebuilds or downloads.
1744
1745 @item --impersonate-linux-2.6
1746 On Linux-based systems, impersonate Linux 2.6. This means that the
1747 kernel's @command{uname} system call will report 2.6 as the release number.
1748
1749 This might be helpful to build programs that (usually wrongfully) depend
1750 on the kernel version number.
1751
1752 @item --lose-logs
1753 Do not keep build logs. By default they are kept under
1754 @file{@var{localstatedir}/guix/log}.
1755
1756 @item --system=@var{system}
1757 Assume @var{system} as the current system type. By default it is the
1758 architecture/kernel pair found at configure time, such as
1759 @code{x86_64-linux}.
1760
1761 @item --listen=@var{endpoint}
1762 Listen for connections on @var{endpoint}. @var{endpoint} is interpreted
1763 as the file name of a Unix-domain socket if it starts with
1764 @code{/} (slash sign). Otherwise, @var{endpoint} is interpreted as a
1765 host name or host name and port to listen to. Here are a few examples:
1766
1767 @table @code
1768 @item --listen=/gnu/var/daemon
1769 Listen for connections on the @file{/gnu/var/daemon} Unix-domain socket,
1770 creating it if needed.
1771
1772 @item --listen=localhost
1773 @cindex daemon, remote access
1774 @cindex remote access to the daemon
1775 @cindex daemon, cluster setup
1776 @cindex clusters, daemon setup
1777 Listen for TCP connections on the network interface corresponding to
1778 @code{localhost}, on port 44146.
1779
1780 @item --listen=128.0.0.42:1234
1781 Listen for TCP connections on the network interface corresponding to
1782 @code{128.0.0.42}, on port 1234.
1783 @end table
1784
1785 This option can be repeated multiple times, in which case
1786 @command{guix-daemon} accepts connections on all the specified
1787 endpoints. Users can tell client commands what endpoint to connect to
1788 by setting the @env{GUIX_DAEMON_SOCKET} environment variable
1789 (@pxref{The Store, @env{GUIX_DAEMON_SOCKET}}).
1790
1791 @quotation Note
1792 The daemon protocol is @emph{unauthenticated and unencrypted}. Using
1793 @option{--listen=@var{host}} is suitable on local networks, such as
1794 clusters, where only trusted nodes may connect to the build daemon. In
1795 other cases where remote access to the daemon is needed, we recommend
1796 using Unix-domain sockets along with SSH.
1797 @end quotation
1798
1799 When @option{--listen} is omitted, @command{guix-daemon} listens for
1800 connections on the Unix-domain socket located at
1801 @file{@var{localstatedir}/guix/daemon-socket/socket}.
1802 @end table
1803
1804
1805 @node Application Setup
1806 @section Application Setup
1807
1808 @cindex foreign distro
1809 When using Guix on top of GNU/Linux distribution other than Guix System---a
1810 so-called @dfn{foreign distro}---a few additional steps are needed to
1811 get everything in place. Here are some of them.
1812
1813 @subsection Locales
1814
1815 @anchor{locales-and-locpath}
1816 @cindex locales, when not on Guix System
1817 @vindex LOCPATH
1818 @vindex GUIX_LOCPATH
1819 Packages installed @i{via} Guix will not use the locale data of the
1820 host system. Instead, you must first install one of the locale packages
1821 available with Guix and then define the @env{GUIX_LOCPATH} environment
1822 variable:
1823
1824 @example
1825 $ guix install glibc-locales
1826 $ export GUIX_LOCPATH=$HOME/.guix-profile/lib/locale
1827 @end example
1828
1829 Note that the @code{glibc-locales} package contains data for all the
1830 locales supported by the GNU@tie{}libc and weighs in at around
1831 917@tie{}MiB@. Alternatively, the @code{glibc-utf8-locales} is smaller but
1832 limited to a few UTF-8 locales.
1833
1834 The @env{GUIX_LOCPATH} variable plays a role similar to @env{LOCPATH}
1835 (@pxref{Locale Names, @env{LOCPATH},, libc, The GNU C Library Reference
1836 Manual}). There are two important differences though:
1837
1838 @enumerate
1839 @item
1840 @env{GUIX_LOCPATH} is honored only by the libc in Guix, and not by the libc
1841 provided by foreign distros. Thus, using @env{GUIX_LOCPATH} allows you
1842 to make sure the programs of the foreign distro will not end up loading
1843 incompatible locale data.
1844
1845 @item
1846 libc suffixes each entry of @env{GUIX_LOCPATH} with @code{/X.Y}, where
1847 @code{X.Y} is the libc version---e.g., @code{2.22}. This means that,
1848 should your Guix profile contain a mixture of programs linked against
1849 different libc version, each libc version will only try to load locale
1850 data in the right format.
1851 @end enumerate
1852
1853 This is important because the locale data format used by different libc
1854 versions may be incompatible.
1855
1856 @subsection Name Service Switch
1857
1858 @cindex name service switch, glibc
1859 @cindex NSS (name service switch), glibc
1860 @cindex nscd (name service caching daemon)
1861 @cindex name service caching daemon (nscd)
1862 When using Guix on a foreign distro, we @emph{strongly recommend} that
1863 the system run the GNU C library's @dfn{name service cache daemon},
1864 @command{nscd}, which should be listening on the
1865 @file{/var/run/nscd/socket} socket. Failing to do that, applications
1866 installed with Guix may fail to look up host names or user accounts, or
1867 may even crash. The next paragraphs explain why.
1868
1869 @cindex @file{nsswitch.conf}
1870 The GNU C library implements a @dfn{name service switch} (NSS), which is
1871 an extensible mechanism for ``name lookups'' in general: host name
1872 resolution, user accounts, and more (@pxref{Name Service Switch,,, libc,
1873 The GNU C Library Reference Manual}).
1874
1875 @cindex Network information service (NIS)
1876 @cindex NIS (Network information service)
1877 Being extensible, the NSS supports @dfn{plugins}, which provide new name
1878 lookup implementations: for example, the @code{nss-mdns} plugin allow
1879 resolution of @code{.local} host names, the @code{nis} plugin allows
1880 user account lookup using the Network information service (NIS), and so
1881 on. These extra ``lookup services'' are configured system-wide in
1882 @file{/etc/nsswitch.conf}, and all the programs running on the system
1883 honor those settings (@pxref{NSS Configuration File,,, libc, The GNU C
1884 Reference Manual}).
1885
1886 When they perform a name lookup---for instance by calling the
1887 @code{getaddrinfo} function in C---applications first try to connect to
1888 the nscd; on success, nscd performs name lookups on their behalf. If
1889 the nscd is not running, then they perform the name lookup by
1890 themselves, by loading the name lookup services into their own address
1891 space and running it. These name lookup services---the
1892 @file{libnss_*.so} files---are @code{dlopen}'d, but they may come from
1893 the host system's C library, rather than from the C library the
1894 application is linked against (the C library coming from Guix).
1895
1896 And this is where the problem is: if your application is linked against
1897 Guix's C library (say, glibc 2.24) and tries to load NSS plugins from
1898 another C library (say, @code{libnss_mdns.so} for glibc 2.22), it will
1899 likely crash or have its name lookups fail unexpectedly.
1900
1901 Running @command{nscd} on the system, among other advantages, eliminates
1902 this binary incompatibility problem because those @code{libnss_*.so}
1903 files are loaded in the @command{nscd} process, not in applications
1904 themselves.
1905
1906 @subsection X11 Fonts
1907
1908 @cindex fonts
1909 The majority of graphical applications use Fontconfig to locate and
1910 load fonts and perform X11-client-side rendering. The @code{fontconfig}
1911 package in Guix looks for fonts in @file{$HOME/.guix-profile}
1912 by default. Thus, to allow graphical applications installed with Guix
1913 to display fonts, you have to install fonts with Guix as well.
1914 Essential font packages include @code{gs-fonts}, @code{font-dejavu}, and
1915 @code{font-gnu-freefont}.
1916
1917 @cindex @code{fc-cache}
1918 @cindex font cache
1919 Once you have installed or removed fonts, or when you notice an
1920 application that does not find fonts, you may need to install Fontconfig
1921 and to force an update of its font cache by running:
1922
1923 @example
1924 guix install fontconfig
1925 fc-cache -rv
1926 @end example
1927
1928 To display text written in Chinese languages, Japanese, or Korean in
1929 graphical applications, consider installing
1930 @code{font-adobe-source-han-sans} or @code{font-wqy-zenhei}. The former
1931 has multiple outputs, one per language family (@pxref{Packages with
1932 Multiple Outputs}). For instance, the following command installs fonts
1933 for Chinese languages:
1934
1935 @example
1936 guix install font-adobe-source-han-sans:cn
1937 @end example
1938
1939 @cindex @code{xterm}
1940 Older programs such as @command{xterm} do not use Fontconfig and instead
1941 rely on server-side font rendering. Such programs require to specify a
1942 full name of a font using XLFD (X Logical Font Description), like this:
1943
1944 @example
1945 -*-dejavu sans-medium-r-normal-*-*-100-*-*-*-*-*-1
1946 @end example
1947
1948 To be able to use such full names for the TrueType fonts installed in
1949 your Guix profile, you need to extend the font path of the X server:
1950
1951 @c Note: 'xset' does not accept symlinks so the trick below arranges to
1952 @c get at the real directory. See <https://bugs.gnu.org/30655>.
1953 @example
1954 xset +fp $(dirname $(readlink -f ~/.guix-profile/share/fonts/truetype/fonts.dir))
1955 @end example
1956
1957 @cindex @code{xlsfonts}
1958 After that, you can run @code{xlsfonts} (from @code{xlsfonts} package)
1959 to make sure your TrueType fonts are listed there.
1960
1961
1962 @subsection X.509 Certificates
1963
1964 @cindex @code{nss-certs}
1965 The @code{nss-certs} package provides X.509 certificates, which allow
1966 programs to authenticate Web servers accessed over HTTPS.
1967
1968 When using Guix on a foreign distro, you can install this package and
1969 define the relevant environment variables so that packages know where to
1970 look for certificates. @xref{X.509 Certificates}, for detailed
1971 information.
1972
1973 @subsection Emacs Packages
1974
1975 @cindex @code{emacs}
1976 When you install Emacs packages with Guix, the Elisp files are placed
1977 under the @file{share/emacs/site-lisp/} directory of the profile in
1978 which they are installed. The Elisp libraries are made available to
1979 Emacs through the @env{EMACSLOADPATH} environment variable, which is
1980 set when installing Emacs itself.
1981
1982 Additionally, autoload definitions are automatically evaluated at the
1983 initialization of Emacs, by the Guix-specific
1984 @code{guix-emacs-autoload-packages} procedure. If, for some reason, you
1985 want to avoid auto-loading the Emacs packages installed with Guix, you
1986 can do so by running Emacs with the @option{--no-site-file} option
1987 (@pxref{Init File,,, emacs, The GNU Emacs Manual}).
1988
1989
1990 @node Upgrading Guix
1991 @section Upgrading Guix
1992
1993 @cindex Upgrading Guix, on a foreign distro
1994
1995 To upgrade Guix, run:
1996
1997 @example
1998 guix pull
1999 @end example
2000
2001 @xref{Invoking guix pull}, for more information.
2002
2003 @cindex upgrading Guix for the root user, on a foreign distro
2004 @cindex upgrading the Guix daemon, on a foreign distro
2005 @cindex @command{guix pull} for the root user, on a foreign distro
2006
2007 On a foreign distro, you can upgrade the build daemon by running:
2008
2009 @example
2010 sudo -i guix pull
2011 @end example
2012
2013 @noindent
2014 followed by (assuming your distro uses the systemd service management
2015 tool):
2016
2017 @example
2018 systemctl restart guix-daemon.service
2019 @end example
2020
2021 On Guix System, upgrading the daemon is achieved by reconfiguring the
2022 system (@pxref{Invoking guix system, @code{guix system reconfigure}}).
2023
2024 @c TODO What else?
2025
2026 @c *********************************************************************
2027 @node System Installation
2028 @chapter System Installation
2029
2030 @cindex installing Guix System
2031 @cindex Guix System, installation
2032 This section explains how to install Guix System
2033 on a machine. Guix, as a package manager, can
2034 also be installed on top of a running GNU/Linux system,
2035 @pxref{Installation}.
2036
2037 @ifinfo
2038 @quotation Note
2039 @c This paragraph is for people reading this from tty2 of the
2040 @c installation image.
2041 You are reading this documentation with an Info reader. For details on
2042 how to use it, hit the @key{RET} key (``return'' or ``enter'') on the
2043 link that follows: @pxref{Top, Info reader,, info-stnd, Stand-alone GNU
2044 Info}. Hit @kbd{l} afterwards to come back here.
2045
2046 Alternatively, run @command{info info} in another tty to keep the manual
2047 available.
2048 @end quotation
2049 @end ifinfo
2050
2051 @menu
2052 * Limitations:: What you can expect.
2053 * Hardware Considerations:: Supported hardware.
2054 * USB Stick and DVD Installation:: Preparing the installation medium.
2055 * Preparing for Installation:: Networking, partitioning, etc.
2056 * Guided Graphical Installation:: Easy graphical installation.
2057 * Manual Installation:: Manual installation for wizards.
2058 * After System Installation:: When installation succeeded.
2059 * Installing Guix in a VM:: Guix System playground.
2060 * Building the Installation Image:: How this comes to be.
2061 @end menu
2062
2063 @node Limitations
2064 @section Limitations
2065
2066 We consider Guix System to be ready for a wide range of ``desktop'' and server
2067 use cases. The reliability guarantees it provides---transactional upgrades
2068 and rollbacks, reproducibility---make it a solid foundation.
2069
2070 Nevertheless, before you proceed with the installation, be aware of the
2071 following noteworthy limitations applicable to version @value{VERSION}:
2072
2073 @itemize
2074 @item
2075 More and more system services are provided (@pxref{Services}), but some
2076 may be missing.
2077
2078 @item
2079 GNOME, Xfce, LXDE, and Enlightenment are available (@pxref{Desktop Services}),
2080 as well as a number of X11 window managers. However, KDE is currently
2081 missing.
2082 @end itemize
2083
2084 More than a disclaimer, this is an invitation to report issues (and success
2085 stories!), and to join us in improving it. @xref{Contributing}, for more
2086 info.
2087
2088
2089 @node Hardware Considerations
2090 @section Hardware Considerations
2091
2092 @cindex hardware support on Guix System
2093 GNU@tie{}Guix focuses on respecting the user's computing freedom. It
2094 builds around the kernel Linux-libre, which means that only hardware for
2095 which free software drivers and firmware exist is supported. Nowadays,
2096 a wide range of off-the-shelf hardware is supported on
2097 GNU/Linux-libre---from keyboards to graphics cards to scanners and
2098 Ethernet controllers. Unfortunately, there are still areas where
2099 hardware vendors deny users control over their own computing, and such
2100 hardware is not supported on Guix System.
2101
2102 @cindex WiFi, hardware support
2103 One of the main areas where free drivers or firmware are lacking is WiFi
2104 devices. WiFi devices known to work include those using Atheros chips
2105 (AR9271 and AR7010), which corresponds to the @code{ath9k} Linux-libre
2106 driver, and those using Broadcom/AirForce chips (BCM43xx with
2107 Wireless-Core Revision 5), which corresponds to the @code{b43-open}
2108 Linux-libre driver. Free firmware exists for both and is available
2109 out-of-the-box on Guix System, as part of @code{%base-firmware}
2110 (@pxref{operating-system Reference, @code{firmware}}).
2111
2112 @cindex RYF, Respects Your Freedom
2113 The @uref{https://www.fsf.org/, Free Software Foundation} runs
2114 @uref{https://www.fsf.org/ryf, @dfn{Respects Your Freedom}} (RYF), a
2115 certification program for hardware products that respect your freedom
2116 and your privacy and ensure that you have control over your device. We
2117 encourage you to check the list of RYF-certified devices.
2118
2119 Another useful resource is the @uref{https://www.h-node.org/, H-Node}
2120 web site. It contains a catalog of hardware devices with information
2121 about their support in GNU/Linux.
2122
2123
2124 @node USB Stick and DVD Installation
2125 @section USB Stick and DVD Installation
2126
2127 An ISO-9660 installation image that can be written to a USB stick or
2128 burnt to a DVD can be downloaded from
2129 @indicateurl{@value{BASE-URL}/guix-system-install-@value{VERSION}.x86_64-linux.iso},
2130 where you can replace @code{x86_64-linux} with one of:
2131
2132 @table @code
2133 @item x86_64-linux
2134 for a GNU/Linux system on Intel/AMD-compatible 64-bit CPUs;
2135
2136 @item i686-linux
2137 for a 32-bit GNU/Linux system on Intel-compatible CPUs.
2138 @end table
2139
2140 @c start duplication of authentication part from ``Binary Installation''
2141 Make sure to download the associated @file{.sig} file and to verify the
2142 authenticity of the image against it, along these lines:
2143
2144 @example
2145 $ wget @value{BASE-URL}/guix-system-install-@value{VERSION}.x86_64-linux.iso.sig
2146 $ gpg --verify guix-system-install-@value{VERSION}.x86_64-linux.iso.sig
2147 @end example
2148
2149 If that command fails because you do not have the required public key,
2150 then run this command to import it:
2151
2152 @example
2153 $ wget @value{OPENPGP-SIGNING-KEY-URL} \
2154 -qO - | gpg --import -
2155 @end example
2156
2157 @noindent
2158 and rerun the @code{gpg --verify} command.
2159
2160 Take note that a warning like ``This key is not certified with a trusted
2161 signature!'' is normal.
2162
2163 @c end duplication
2164
2165 This image contains the tools necessary for an installation.
2166 It is meant to be copied @emph{as is} to a large-enough USB stick or DVD.
2167
2168 @unnumberedsubsec Copying to a USB Stick
2169
2170 Insert a USB stick of 1@tie{}GiB or more into your machine, and determine
2171 its device name. Assuming that the USB stick is known as @file{/dev/sdX},
2172 copy the image with:
2173
2174 @example
2175 dd if=guix-system-install-@value{VERSION}.x86_64-linux.iso of=/dev/sdX status=progress
2176 sync
2177 @end example
2178
2179 Access to @file{/dev/sdX} usually requires root privileges.
2180
2181 @unnumberedsubsec Burning on a DVD
2182
2183 Insert a blank DVD into your machine, and determine
2184 its device name. Assuming that the DVD drive is known as @file{/dev/srX},
2185 copy the image with:
2186
2187 @example
2188 growisofs -dvd-compat -Z /dev/srX=guix-system-install-@value{VERSION}.x86_64-linux.iso
2189 @end example
2190
2191 Access to @file{/dev/srX} usually requires root privileges.
2192
2193 @unnumberedsubsec Booting
2194
2195 Once this is done, you should be able to reboot the system and boot from
2196 the USB stick or DVD@. The latter usually requires you to get in the
2197 BIOS or UEFI boot menu, where you can choose to boot from the USB stick.
2198 In order to boot from Libreboot, switch to the command mode by pressing
2199 the @kbd{c} key and type @command{search_grub usb}.
2200
2201 @xref{Installing Guix in a VM}, if, instead, you would like to install
2202 Guix System in a virtual machine (VM).
2203
2204
2205 @node Preparing for Installation
2206 @section Preparing for Installation
2207
2208 Once you have booted, you can use the guided graphical installer, which makes
2209 it easy to get started (@pxref{Guided Graphical Installation}). Alternatively,
2210 if you are already familiar with GNU/Linux and if you want more control than
2211 what the graphical installer provides, you can choose the ``manual''
2212 installation process (@pxref{Manual Installation}).
2213
2214 The graphical installer is available on TTY1. You can obtain root shells on
2215 TTYs 3 to 6 by hitting @kbd{ctrl-alt-f3}, @kbd{ctrl-alt-f4}, etc. TTY2 shows
2216 this documentation and you can reach it with @kbd{ctrl-alt-f2}. Documentation
2217 is browsable using the Info reader commands (@pxref{Top,,, info-stnd,
2218 Stand-alone GNU Info}). The installation system runs the GPM mouse daemon,
2219 which allows you to select text with the left mouse button and to paste it
2220 with the middle button.
2221
2222 @quotation Note
2223 Installation requires access to the Internet so that any missing
2224 dependencies of your system configuration can be downloaded. See the
2225 ``Networking'' section below.
2226 @end quotation
2227
2228 @node Guided Graphical Installation
2229 @section Guided Graphical Installation
2230
2231 The graphical installer is a text-based user interface. It will guide you,
2232 with dialog boxes, through the steps needed to install GNU@tie{}Guix System.
2233
2234 The first dialog boxes allow you to set up the system as you use it during the
2235 installation: you can choose the language, keyboard layout, and set up
2236 networking, which will be used during the installation. The image below shows
2237 the networking dialog.
2238
2239 @image{images/installer-network,5in,, networking setup with the graphical installer}
2240
2241 Later steps allow you to partition your hard disk, as shown in the image
2242 below, to choose whether or not to use encrypted file systems, to enter the
2243 host name and root password, and to create an additional account, among other
2244 things.
2245
2246 @image{images/installer-partitions,5in,, partitioning with the graphical installer}
2247
2248 Note that, at any time, the installer allows you to exit the current
2249 installation step and resume at a previous step, as show in the image below.
2250
2251 @image{images/installer-resume,5in,, resuming the installation process}
2252
2253 Once you're done, the installer produces an operating system configuration and
2254 displays it (@pxref{Using the Configuration System}). At that point you can
2255 hit ``OK'' and installation will proceed. On success, you can reboot into the
2256 new system and enjoy. @xref{After System Installation}, for what's next!
2257
2258
2259 @node Manual Installation
2260 @section Manual Installation
2261
2262 This section describes how you would ``manually'' install GNU@tie{}Guix System
2263 on your machine. This option requires familiarity with GNU/Linux, with the
2264 shell, and with common administration tools. If you think this is not for
2265 you, consider using the guided graphical installer (@pxref{Guided Graphical
2266 Installation}).
2267
2268 The installation system provides root shells on TTYs 3 to 6; press
2269 @kbd{ctrl-alt-f3}, @kbd{ctrl-alt-f4}, and so on to reach them. It includes
2270 many common tools needed to install the system. But it is also a full-blown
2271 Guix System, which means that you can install additional packages, should you
2272 need it, using @command{guix package} (@pxref{Invoking guix package}).
2273
2274 @menu
2275 * Keyboard Layout and Networking and Partitioning:: Initial setup.
2276 * Proceeding with the Installation:: Installing.
2277 @end menu
2278
2279 @node Keyboard Layout and Networking and Partitioning
2280 @subsection Keyboard Layout, Networking, and Partitioning
2281
2282 Before you can install the system, you may want to adjust the keyboard layout,
2283 set up networking, and partition your target hard disk. This section will
2284 guide you through this.
2285
2286 @subsubsection Keyboard Layout
2287
2288 @cindex keyboard layout
2289 The installation image uses the US qwerty keyboard layout. If you want
2290 to change it, you can use the @command{loadkeys} command. For example,
2291 the following command selects the Dvorak keyboard layout:
2292
2293 @example
2294 loadkeys dvorak
2295 @end example
2296
2297 See the files under @file{/run/current-system/profile/share/keymaps} for
2298 a list of available keyboard layouts. Run @command{man loadkeys} for
2299 more information.
2300
2301 @subsubsection Networking
2302
2303 Run the following command to see what your network interfaces are called:
2304
2305 @example
2306 ifconfig -a
2307 @end example
2308
2309 @noindent
2310 @dots{} or, using the GNU/Linux-specific @command{ip} command:
2311
2312 @example
2313 ip address
2314 @end example
2315
2316 @c https://cgit.freedesktop.org/systemd/systemd/tree/src/udev/udev-builtin-net_id.c#n20
2317 Wired interfaces have a name starting with @samp{e}; for example, the
2318 interface corresponding to the first on-board Ethernet controller is
2319 called @samp{eno1}. Wireless interfaces have a name starting with
2320 @samp{w}, like @samp{w1p2s0}.
2321
2322 @table @asis
2323 @item Wired connection
2324 To configure a wired network run the following command, substituting
2325 @var{interface} with the name of the wired interface you want to use.
2326
2327 @example
2328 ifconfig @var{interface} up
2329 @end example
2330
2331 @noindent
2332 @dots{} or, using the GNU/Linux-specific @command{ip} command:
2333
2334 @example
2335 ip link set @var{interface} up
2336 @end example
2337
2338 @item Wireless connection
2339 @cindex wireless
2340 @cindex WiFi
2341 To configure wireless networking, you can create a configuration file
2342 for the @command{wpa_supplicant} configuration tool (its location is not
2343 important) using one of the available text editors such as
2344 @command{nano}:
2345
2346 @example
2347 nano wpa_supplicant.conf
2348 @end example
2349
2350 As an example, the following stanza can go to this file and will work
2351 for many wireless networks, provided you give the actual SSID and
2352 passphrase for the network you are connecting to:
2353
2354 @example
2355 network=@{
2356 ssid="@var{my-ssid}"
2357 key_mgmt=WPA-PSK
2358 psk="the network's secret passphrase"
2359 @}
2360 @end example
2361
2362 Start the wireless service and run it in the background with the
2363 following command (substitute @var{interface} with the name of the
2364 network interface you want to use):
2365
2366 @example
2367 wpa_supplicant -c wpa_supplicant.conf -i @var{interface} -B
2368 @end example
2369
2370 Run @command{man wpa_supplicant} for more information.
2371 @end table
2372
2373 @cindex DHCP
2374 At this point, you need to acquire an IP address. On a network where IP
2375 addresses are automatically assigned @i{via} DHCP, you can run:
2376
2377 @example
2378 dhclient -v @var{interface}
2379 @end example
2380
2381 Try to ping a server to see if networking is up and running:
2382
2383 @example
2384 ping -c 3 gnu.org
2385 @end example
2386
2387 Setting up network access is almost always a requirement because the
2388 image does not contain all the software and tools that may be needed.
2389
2390 @cindex proxy, during system installation
2391 If you need HTTP and HTTPS access to go through a proxy, run the
2392 following command:
2393
2394 @example
2395 herd set-http-proxy guix-daemon @var{URL}
2396 @end example
2397
2398 @noindent
2399 where @var{URL} is the proxy URL, for example
2400 @code{http://example.org:8118}.
2401
2402 @cindex installing over SSH
2403 If you want to, you can continue the installation remotely by starting
2404 an SSH server:
2405
2406 @example
2407 herd start ssh-daemon
2408 @end example
2409
2410 Make sure to either set a password with @command{passwd}, or configure
2411 OpenSSH public key authentication before logging in.
2412
2413 @subsubsection Disk Partitioning
2414
2415 Unless this has already been done, the next step is to partition, and
2416 then format the target partition(s).
2417
2418 The installation image includes several partitioning tools, including
2419 Parted (@pxref{Overview,,, parted, GNU Parted User Manual}),
2420 @command{fdisk}, and @command{cfdisk}. Run it and set up your disk with
2421 the partition layout you want:
2422
2423 @example
2424 cfdisk
2425 @end example
2426
2427 If your disk uses the GUID Partition Table (GPT) format and you plan to
2428 install BIOS-based GRUB (which is the default), make sure a BIOS Boot
2429 Partition is available (@pxref{BIOS installation,,, grub, GNU GRUB
2430 manual}).
2431
2432 @cindex EFI, installation
2433 @cindex UEFI, installation
2434 @cindex ESP, EFI system partition
2435 If you instead wish to use EFI-based GRUB, a FAT32 @dfn{EFI System Partition}
2436 (ESP) is required. This partition can be mounted at @file{/boot/efi} for
2437 instance and must have the @code{esp} flag set. E.g., for @command{parted}:
2438
2439 @example
2440 parted /dev/sda set 1 esp on
2441 @end example
2442
2443 @quotation Note
2444 @vindex grub-bootloader
2445 @vindex grub-efi-bootloader
2446 Unsure whether to use EFI- or BIOS-based GRUB? If the directory
2447 @file{/sys/firmware/efi} exists in the installation image, then you should
2448 probably perform an EFI installation, using @code{grub-efi-bootloader}.
2449 Otherwise you should use the BIOS-based GRUB, known as
2450 @code{grub-bootloader}. @xref{Bootloader Configuration}, for more info on
2451 bootloaders.
2452 @end quotation
2453
2454 Once you are done partitioning the target hard disk drive, you have to
2455 create a file system on the relevant partition(s)@footnote{Currently
2456 Guix System only supports ext4, btrfs, JFS, and F2FS file systems. In
2457 particular, code that reads file system UUIDs and labels only works for these
2458 file system types.}. For the ESP, if you have one and assuming it is
2459 @file{/dev/sda1}, run:
2460
2461 @example
2462 mkfs.fat -F32 /dev/sda1
2463 @end example
2464
2465 For the root file system, ext4 is the most widely used format. Other
2466 file systems, such as Btrfs, support compression, which is reported to
2467 nicely complement file deduplication that the daemon performs
2468 independently of the file system (@pxref{Invoking guix-daemon,
2469 deduplication}).
2470
2471 Preferably, assign file systems a label so that you can easily and
2472 reliably refer to them in @code{file-system} declarations (@pxref{File
2473 Systems}). This is typically done using the @code{-L} option of
2474 @command{mkfs.ext4} and related commands. So, assuming the target root
2475 partition lives at @file{/dev/sda2}, a file system with the label
2476 @code{my-root} can be created with:
2477
2478 @example
2479 mkfs.ext4 -L my-root /dev/sda2
2480 @end example
2481
2482 @cindex encrypted disk
2483 If you are instead planning to encrypt the root partition, you can use
2484 the Cryptsetup/LUKS utilities to do that (see @inlinefmtifelse{html,
2485 @uref{https://linux.die.net/man/8/cryptsetup, @code{man cryptsetup}},
2486 @code{man cryptsetup}} for more information). Assuming you want to
2487 store the root partition on @file{/dev/sda2}, the command sequence would
2488 be along these lines:
2489
2490 @example
2491 cryptsetup luksFormat /dev/sda2
2492 cryptsetup open --type luks /dev/sda2 my-partition
2493 mkfs.ext4 -L my-root /dev/mapper/my-partition
2494 @end example
2495
2496 Once that is done, mount the target file system under @file{/mnt}
2497 with a command like (again, assuming @code{my-root} is the label of the
2498 root file system):
2499
2500 @example
2501 mount LABEL=my-root /mnt
2502 @end example
2503
2504 Also mount any other file systems you would like to use on the target
2505 system relative to this path. If you have opted for @file{/boot/efi} as an
2506 EFI mount point for example, mount it at @file{/mnt/boot/efi} now so it is
2507 found by @code{guix system init} afterwards.
2508
2509 Finally, if you plan to use one or more swap partitions (@pxref{Memory
2510 Concepts, swap space,, libc, The GNU C Library Reference Manual}), make
2511 sure to initialize them with @command{mkswap}. Assuming you have one
2512 swap partition on @file{/dev/sda3}, you would run:
2513
2514 @example
2515 mkswap /dev/sda3
2516 swapon /dev/sda3
2517 @end example
2518
2519 Alternatively, you may use a swap file. For example, assuming that in
2520 the new system you want to use the file @file{/swapfile} as a swap file,
2521 you would run@footnote{This example will work for many types of file
2522 systems (e.g., ext4). However, for copy-on-write file systems (e.g.,
2523 btrfs), the required steps may be different. For details, see the
2524 manual pages for @command{mkswap} and @command{swapon}.}:
2525
2526 @example
2527 # This is 10 GiB of swap space. Adjust "count" to change the size.
2528 dd if=/dev/zero of=/mnt/swapfile bs=1MiB count=10240
2529 # For security, make the file readable and writable only by root.
2530 chmod 600 /mnt/swapfile
2531 mkswap /mnt/swapfile
2532 swapon /mnt/swapfile
2533 @end example
2534
2535 Note that if you have encrypted the root partition and created a swap
2536 file in its file system as described above, then the encryption also
2537 protects the swap file, just like any other file in that file system.
2538
2539 @node Proceeding with the Installation
2540 @subsection Proceeding with the Installation
2541
2542 With the target partitions ready and the target root mounted on
2543 @file{/mnt}, we're ready to go. First, run:
2544
2545 @example
2546 herd start cow-store /mnt
2547 @end example
2548
2549 This makes @file{/gnu/store} copy-on-write, such that packages added to it
2550 during the installation phase are written to the target disk on @file{/mnt}
2551 rather than kept in memory. This is necessary because the first phase of
2552 the @command{guix system init} command (see below) entails downloads or
2553 builds to @file{/gnu/store} which, initially, is an in-memory file system.
2554
2555 Next, you have to edit a file and
2556 provide the declaration of the operating system to be installed. To
2557 that end, the installation system comes with three text editors. We
2558 recommend GNU nano (@pxref{Top,,, nano, GNU nano Manual}), which
2559 supports syntax highlighting and parentheses matching; other editors
2560 include mg (an Emacs clone), and
2561 nvi (a clone of the original BSD @command{vi} editor).
2562 We strongly recommend storing that file on the target root file system, say,
2563 as @file{/mnt/etc/config.scm}. Failing to do that, you will have lost your
2564 configuration file once you have rebooted into the newly-installed system.
2565
2566 @xref{Using the Configuration System}, for an overview of the
2567 configuration file. The example configurations discussed in that
2568 section are available under @file{/etc/configuration} in the
2569 installation image. Thus, to get started with a system configuration
2570 providing a graphical display server (a ``desktop'' system), you can run
2571 something along these lines:
2572
2573 @example
2574 # mkdir /mnt/etc
2575 # cp /etc/configuration/desktop.scm /mnt/etc/config.scm
2576 # nano /mnt/etc/config.scm
2577 @end example
2578
2579 You should pay attention to what your configuration file contains, and
2580 in particular:
2581
2582 @itemize
2583 @item
2584 Make sure the @code{bootloader-configuration} form refers to the targets
2585 you want to install GRUB on. It should mention @code{grub-bootloader}
2586 if you are installing GRUB in the legacy way, or
2587 @code{grub-efi-bootloader} for newer UEFI systems. For legacy systems,
2588 the @code{targets} field contain the names of the devices, like
2589 @code{(list "/dev/sda")}; for UEFI systems it names the paths to mounted
2590 EFI partitions, like @code{(list "/boot/efi")}; do make sure the paths
2591 are currently mounted and a @code{file-system} entry is specified in
2592 your configuration.
2593
2594 @item
2595 Be sure that your file system labels match the value of their respective
2596 @code{device} fields in your @code{file-system} configuration, assuming
2597 your @code{file-system} configuration uses the @code{file-system-label}
2598 procedure in its @code{device} field.
2599
2600 @item
2601 If there are encrypted or RAID partitions, make sure to add a
2602 @code{mapped-devices} field to describe them (@pxref{Mapped Devices}).
2603 @end itemize
2604
2605 Once you are done preparing the configuration file, the new system must
2606 be initialized (remember that the target root file system is mounted
2607 under @file{/mnt}):
2608
2609 @example
2610 guix system init /mnt/etc/config.scm /mnt
2611 @end example
2612
2613 @noindent
2614 This copies all the necessary files and installs GRUB on
2615 @file{/dev/sdX}, unless you pass the @option{--no-bootloader} option. For
2616 more information, @pxref{Invoking guix system}. This command may trigger
2617 downloads or builds of missing packages, which can take some time.
2618
2619 Once that command has completed---and hopefully succeeded!---you can run
2620 @command{reboot} and boot into the new system. The @code{root} password
2621 in the new system is initially empty; other users' passwords need to be
2622 initialized by running the @command{passwd} command as @code{root},
2623 unless your configuration specifies otherwise
2624 (@pxref{user-account-password, user account passwords}).
2625 @xref{After System Installation}, for what's next!
2626
2627
2628 @node After System Installation
2629 @section After System Installation
2630
2631 Success, you've now booted into Guix System! From then on, you can update the
2632 system whenever you want by running, say:
2633
2634 @example
2635 guix pull
2636 sudo guix system reconfigure /etc/config.scm
2637 @end example
2638
2639 @noindent
2640 This builds a new system generation with the latest packages and services
2641 (@pxref{Invoking guix system}). We recommend doing that regularly so that
2642 your system includes the latest security updates (@pxref{Security Updates}).
2643
2644 @c See <https://lists.gnu.org/archive/html/guix-devel/2019-01/msg00268.html>.
2645 @quotation Note
2646 @cindex sudo vs. @command{guix pull}
2647 Note that @command{sudo guix} runs your user's @command{guix} command and
2648 @emph{not} root's, because @command{sudo} leaves @env{PATH} unchanged. To
2649 explicitly run root's @command{guix}, type @command{sudo -i guix @dots{}}.
2650
2651 The difference matters here, because @command{guix pull} updates
2652 the @command{guix} command and package definitions only for the user it is run
2653 as. This means that if you choose to use @command{guix system reconfigure} in
2654 root's login shell, you'll need to @command{guix pull} separately.
2655 @end quotation
2656
2657 Now, @pxref{Getting Started}, and
2658 join us on @code{#guix} on the Libera Chat IRC network or on
2659 @email{guix-devel@@gnu.org} to share your experience!
2660
2661
2662 @node Installing Guix in a VM
2663 @section Installing Guix in a Virtual Machine
2664
2665 @cindex virtual machine, Guix System installation
2666 @cindex virtual private server (VPS)
2667 @cindex VPS (virtual private server)
2668 If you'd like to install Guix System in a virtual machine (VM) or on a
2669 virtual private server (VPS) rather than on your beloved machine, this
2670 section is for you.
2671
2672 To boot a @uref{https://qemu.org/,QEMU} VM for installing Guix System in a
2673 disk image, follow these steps:
2674
2675 @enumerate
2676 @item
2677 First, retrieve and decompress the Guix system installation image as
2678 described previously (@pxref{USB Stick and DVD Installation}).
2679
2680 @item
2681 Create a disk image that will hold the installed system. To make a
2682 qcow2-formatted disk image, use the @command{qemu-img} command:
2683
2684 @example
2685 qemu-img create -f qcow2 guix-system.img 50G
2686 @end example
2687
2688 The resulting file will be much smaller than 50 GB (typically less than
2689 1 MB), but it will grow as the virtualized storage device is filled up.
2690
2691 @item
2692 Boot the USB installation image in an VM:
2693
2694 @example
2695 qemu-system-x86_64 -m 1024 -smp 1 -enable-kvm \
2696 -nic user,model=virtio-net-pci -boot menu=on,order=d \
2697 -drive file=guix-system.img \
2698 -drive media=cdrom,file=guix-system-install-@value{VERSION}.@var{system}.iso
2699 @end example
2700
2701 @code{-enable-kvm} is optional, but significantly improves performance,
2702 @pxref{Running Guix in a VM}.
2703
2704 @item
2705 You're now root in the VM, proceed with the installation process.
2706 @xref{Preparing for Installation}, and follow the instructions.
2707 @end enumerate
2708
2709 Once installation is complete, you can boot the system that's on your
2710 @file{guix-system.img} image. @xref{Running Guix in a VM}, for how to do
2711 that.
2712
2713 @node Building the Installation Image
2714 @section Building the Installation Image
2715
2716 @cindex installation image
2717 The installation image described above was built using the @command{guix
2718 system} command, specifically:
2719
2720 @example
2721 guix system image -t iso9660 gnu/system/install.scm
2722 @end example
2723
2724 Have a look at @file{gnu/system/install.scm} in the source tree,
2725 and see also @ref{Invoking guix system} for more information
2726 about the installation image.
2727
2728 @section Building the Installation Image for ARM Boards
2729
2730 Many ARM boards require a specific variant of the
2731 @uref{https://www.denx.de/wiki/U-Boot/, U-Boot} bootloader.
2732
2733 If you build a disk image and the bootloader is not available otherwise
2734 (on another boot drive etc), it's advisable to build an image that
2735 includes the bootloader, specifically:
2736
2737 @example
2738 guix system image --system=armhf-linux -e '((@@ (gnu system install) os-with-u-boot) (@@ (gnu system install) installation-os) "A20-OLinuXino-Lime2")'
2739 @end example
2740
2741 @code{A20-OLinuXino-Lime2} is the name of the board. If you specify an invalid
2742 board, a list of possible boards will be printed.
2743
2744 @c *********************************************************************
2745 @node Getting Started
2746 @chapter Getting Started
2747
2748 Presumably, you've reached this section because either you have
2749 installed Guix on top of another distribution (@pxref{Installation}), or
2750 you've installed the standalone Guix System (@pxref{System
2751 Installation}). It's time for you to get started using Guix and this
2752 section aims to help you do that and give you a feel of what it's like.
2753
2754 Guix is about installing software, so probably the first thing you'll
2755 want to do is to actually look for software. Let's say you're looking
2756 for a text editor, you can run:
2757
2758 @example
2759 guix search text editor
2760 @end example
2761
2762 This command shows you a number of matching @dfn{packages}, each time
2763 showing the package's name, version, a description, and additional info.
2764 Once you've found out the one you want to use, let's say Emacs (ah ha!),
2765 you can go ahead and install it (run this command as a regular user,
2766 @emph{no need for root privileges}!):
2767
2768 @example
2769 guix install emacs
2770 @end example
2771
2772 @cindex profile
2773 You've installed your first package, congrats! The package is now
2774 visible in your default @dfn{profile}, @file{$HOME/.guix-profile}---a
2775 profile is a directory containing installed packages.
2776 In the process, you've
2777 probably noticed that Guix downloaded pre-built binaries; or, if you
2778 explicitly chose to @emph{not} use pre-built binaries, then probably
2779 Guix is still building software (@pxref{Substitutes}, for more info).
2780
2781 Unless you're using Guix System, the @command{guix install} command must
2782 have printed this hint:
2783
2784 @example
2785 hint: Consider setting the necessary environment variables by running:
2786
2787 GUIX_PROFILE="$HOME/.guix-profile"
2788 . "$GUIX_PROFILE/etc/profile"
2789
2790 Alternately, see `guix package --search-paths -p "$HOME/.guix-profile"'.
2791 @end example
2792
2793 Indeed, you must now tell your shell where @command{emacs} and other
2794 programs installed with Guix are to be found. Pasting the two lines
2795 above will do just that: it will add
2796 @code{$HOME/.guix-profile/bin}---which is where the installed package
2797 is---to the @code{PATH} environment variable. You can paste these two
2798 lines in your shell so they take effect right away, but more importantly
2799 you should add them to @file{~/.bash_profile} (or equivalent file if you
2800 do not use Bash) so that environment variables are set next time you
2801 spawn a shell. You only need to do this once and other search paths
2802 environment variables will be taken care of similarly---e.g., if you
2803 eventually install @code{python} and Python libraries, @code{PYTHONPATH}
2804 will be defined.
2805
2806 You can go on installing packages at your will. To list installed
2807 packages, run:
2808
2809 @example
2810 guix package --list-installed
2811 @end example
2812
2813 To remove a package, you would unsurprisingly run @command{guix remove}.
2814 A distinguishing feature is the ability to @dfn{roll back} any operation
2815 you made---installation, removal, upgrade---by simply typing:
2816
2817 @example
2818 guix package --roll-back
2819 @end example
2820
2821 This is because each operation is in fact a @dfn{transaction} that
2822 creates a new @dfn{generation}. These generations and the difference
2823 between them can be displayed by running:
2824
2825 @example
2826 guix package --list-generations
2827 @end example
2828
2829 Now you know the basics of package management!
2830
2831 @quotation Going further
2832 @xref{Package Management}, for more about package management. You may
2833 like @dfn{declarative} package management with @command{guix package
2834 --manifest}, managing separate @dfn{profiles} with @option{--profile},
2835 deleting old generations, collecting garbage, and other nifty features
2836 that will come in handy as you become more familiar with Guix. If you
2837 are a developer, @pxref{Development} for additional tools. And if
2838 you're curious, @pxref{Features}, to peek under the hood.
2839 @end quotation
2840
2841 Once you've installed a set of packages, you will want to periodically
2842 @emph{upgrade} them to the latest and greatest version. To do that, you
2843 will first pull the latest revision of Guix and its package collection:
2844
2845 @example
2846 guix pull
2847 @end example
2848
2849 The end result is a new @command{guix} command, under
2850 @file{~/.config/guix/current/bin}. Unless you're on Guix System, the
2851 first time you run @command{guix pull}, be sure to follow the hint that
2852 the command prints and, similar to what we saw above, paste these two
2853 lines in your terminal and @file{.bash_profile}:
2854
2855 @example
2856 GUIX_PROFILE="$HOME/.config/guix/current"
2857 . "$GUIX_PROFILE/etc/profile"
2858 @end example
2859
2860 @noindent
2861 You must also instruct your shell to point to this new @command{guix}:
2862
2863 @example
2864 hash guix
2865 @end example
2866
2867 At this point, you're running a brand new Guix. You can thus go ahead
2868 and actually upgrade all the packages you previously installed:
2869
2870 @example
2871 guix upgrade
2872 @end example
2873
2874 As you run this command, you will see that binaries are downloaded (or
2875 perhaps some packages are built), and eventually you end up with the
2876 upgraded packages. Should one of these upgraded packages not be to your
2877 liking, remember you can always roll back!
2878
2879 You can display the exact revision of Guix you're currently using by
2880 running:
2881
2882 @example
2883 guix describe
2884 @end example
2885
2886 The information it displays is @emph{all it takes to reproduce the exact
2887 same Guix}, be it at a different point in time or on a different
2888 machine.
2889
2890 @quotation Going further
2891 @xref{Invoking guix pull}, for more information. @xref{Channels}, on
2892 how to specify additional @dfn{channels} to pull packages from, how to
2893 replicate Guix, and more. You may also find @command{time-machine}
2894 handy (@pxref{Invoking guix time-machine}).
2895 @end quotation
2896
2897 If you installed Guix System, one of the first things you'll want to do
2898 is to upgrade your system. Once you've run @command{guix pull} to get
2899 the latest Guix, you can upgrade the system like this:
2900
2901 @example
2902 sudo guix system reconfigure /etc/config.scm
2903 @end example
2904
2905 Upon completion, the system runs the latest versions of its software
2906 packages. When you eventually reboot, you'll notice a sub-menu in the
2907 bootloader that reads ``Old system generations'': it's what allows you
2908 to boot @emph{an older generation of your system}, should the latest
2909 generation be ``broken'' or otherwise unsatisfying. Just like for
2910 packages, you can always @emph{roll back} to a previous generation
2911 @emph{of the whole system}:
2912
2913 @example
2914 sudo guix system roll-back
2915 @end example
2916
2917 There are many things you'll probably want to tweak on your system:
2918 adding new user accounts, adding new system services, fiddling with the
2919 configuration of those services, etc. The system configuration is
2920 @emph{entirely} described in the @file{/etc/config.scm} file.
2921 @xref{Using the Configuration System}, to learn how to change it.
2922
2923 Now you know enough to get started!
2924
2925 @quotation Resources
2926 The rest of this manual provides a reference for all things Guix. Here
2927 are some additional resources you may find useful:
2928
2929 @itemize
2930 @item
2931 @xref{Top,,, guix-cookbook, The GNU Guix Cookbook}, for a list of
2932 ``how-to'' style of recipes for a variety of applications.
2933
2934 @item
2935 The @uref{https://guix.gnu.org/guix-refcard.pdf, GNU Guix Reference
2936 Card} lists in two pages most of the commands and options you'll ever
2937 need.
2938
2939 @item
2940 The web site contains @uref{https://guix.gnu.org/en/videos/,
2941 instructional videos} covering topics such as everyday use of Guix, how
2942 to get help, and how to become a contributor.
2943
2944 @item
2945 @xref{Documentation}, to learn how to access documentation on your
2946 computer.
2947 @end itemize
2948
2949 We hope you will enjoy Guix as much as the community enjoys building it!
2950 @end quotation
2951
2952 @c *********************************************************************
2953 @node Package Management
2954 @chapter Package Management
2955
2956 @cindex packages
2957 The purpose of GNU Guix is to allow users to easily install, upgrade, and
2958 remove software packages, without having to know about their build
2959 procedures or dependencies. Guix also goes beyond this obvious set of
2960 features.
2961
2962 This chapter describes the main features of Guix, as well as the
2963 package management tools it provides. Along with the command-line
2964 interface described below (@pxref{Invoking guix package, @code{guix
2965 package}}), you may also use the Emacs-Guix interface (@pxref{Top,,,
2966 emacs-guix, The Emacs-Guix Reference Manual}), after installing
2967 @code{emacs-guix} package (run @kbd{M-x guix-help} command to start
2968 with it):
2969
2970 @example
2971 guix install emacs-guix
2972 @end example
2973
2974 @menu
2975 * Features:: How Guix will make your life brighter.
2976 * Invoking guix package:: Package installation, removal, etc.
2977 * Substitutes:: Downloading pre-built binaries.
2978 * Packages with Multiple Outputs:: Single source package, multiple outputs.
2979 * Invoking guix gc:: Running the garbage collector.
2980 * Invoking guix pull:: Fetching the latest Guix and distribution.
2981 * Invoking guix time-machine:: Running an older revision of Guix.
2982 * Inferiors:: Interacting with another revision of Guix.
2983 * Invoking guix describe:: Display information about your Guix revision.
2984 * Invoking guix archive:: Exporting and importing store files.
2985 @end menu
2986
2987 @node Features
2988 @section Features
2989
2990 Here we assume you've already made your first steps with Guix
2991 (@pxref{Getting Started}) and would like to get an overview about what's
2992 going on under the hood.
2993
2994 When using Guix, each package ends up in the @dfn{package store}, in its
2995 own directory---something that resembles
2996 @file{/gnu/store/xxx-package-1.2}, where @code{xxx} is a base32 string.
2997
2998 Instead of referring to these directories, users have their own
2999 @dfn{profile}, which points to the packages that they actually want to
3000 use. These profiles are stored within each user's home directory, at
3001 @code{$HOME/.guix-profile}.
3002
3003 For example, @code{alice} installs GCC 4.7.2. As a result,
3004 @file{/home/alice/.guix-profile/bin/gcc} points to
3005 @file{/gnu/store/@dots{}-gcc-4.7.2/bin/gcc}. Now, on the same machine,
3006 @code{bob} had already installed GCC 4.8.0. The profile of @code{bob}
3007 simply continues to point to
3008 @file{/gnu/store/@dots{}-gcc-4.8.0/bin/gcc}---i.e., both versions of GCC
3009 coexist on the same system without any interference.
3010
3011 The @command{guix package} command is the central tool to manage
3012 packages (@pxref{Invoking guix package}). It operates on the per-user
3013 profiles, and can be used @emph{with normal user privileges}.
3014
3015 @cindex transactions
3016 The command provides the obvious install, remove, and upgrade
3017 operations. Each invocation is actually a @emph{transaction}: either
3018 the specified operation succeeds, or nothing happens. Thus, if the
3019 @command{guix package} process is terminated during the transaction,
3020 or if a power outage occurs during the transaction, then the user's
3021 profile remains in its previous state, and remains usable.
3022
3023 In addition, any package transaction may be @emph{rolled back}. So, if,
3024 for example, an upgrade installs a new version of a package that turns
3025 out to have a serious bug, users may roll back to the previous instance
3026 of their profile, which was known to work well. Similarly, the global
3027 system configuration on Guix is subject to
3028 transactional upgrades and roll-back
3029 (@pxref{Using the Configuration System}).
3030
3031 All packages in the package store may be @emph{garbage-collected}.
3032 Guix can determine which packages are still referenced by user
3033 profiles, and remove those that are provably no longer referenced
3034 (@pxref{Invoking guix gc}). Users may also explicitly remove old
3035 generations of their profile so that the packages they refer to can be
3036 collected.
3037
3038 @cindex reproducibility
3039 @cindex reproducible builds
3040 Guix takes a @dfn{purely functional} approach to package
3041 management, as described in the introduction (@pxref{Introduction}).
3042 Each @file{/gnu/store} package directory name contains a hash of all the
3043 inputs that were used to build that package---compiler, libraries, build
3044 scripts, etc. This direct correspondence allows users to make sure a
3045 given package installation matches the current state of their
3046 distribution. It also helps maximize @dfn{build reproducibility}:
3047 thanks to the isolated build environments that are used, a given build
3048 is likely to yield bit-identical files when performed on different
3049 machines (@pxref{Invoking guix-daemon, container}).
3050
3051 @cindex substitutes
3052 This foundation allows Guix to support @dfn{transparent binary/source
3053 deployment}. When a pre-built binary for a @file{/gnu/store} item is
3054 available from an external source---a @dfn{substitute}, Guix just
3055 downloads it and unpacks it;
3056 otherwise, it builds the package from source, locally
3057 (@pxref{Substitutes}). Because build results are usually bit-for-bit
3058 reproducible, users do not have to trust servers that provide
3059 substitutes: they can force a local build and @emph{challenge} providers
3060 (@pxref{Invoking guix challenge}).
3061
3062 Control over the build environment is a feature that is also useful for
3063 developers. The @command{guix environment} command allows developers of
3064 a package to quickly set up the right development environment for their
3065 package, without having to manually install the dependencies of the
3066 package into their profile (@pxref{Invoking guix environment}).
3067
3068 @cindex replication, of software environments
3069 @cindex provenance tracking, of software artifacts
3070 All of Guix and its package definitions is version-controlled, and
3071 @command{guix pull} allows you to ``travel in time'' on the history of Guix
3072 itself (@pxref{Invoking guix pull}). This makes it possible to replicate a
3073 Guix instance on a different machine or at a later point in time, which in
3074 turn allows you to @emph{replicate complete software environments}, while
3075 retaining precise @dfn{provenance tracking} of the software.
3076
3077 @node Invoking guix package
3078 @section Invoking @command{guix package}
3079
3080 @cindex installing packages
3081 @cindex removing packages
3082 @cindex package installation
3083 @cindex package removal
3084 @cindex profile
3085 The @command{guix package} command is the tool that allows users to
3086 install, upgrade, and remove packages, as well as rolling back to
3087 previous configurations. These operations work on a user
3088 @dfn{profile}---a directory of installed packages. Each user has a
3089 default profile in @file{$HOME/.guix-profile}.
3090 The command operates only on the user's own profile,
3091 and works with normal user privileges (@pxref{Features}). Its syntax
3092 is:
3093
3094 @example
3095 guix package @var{options}
3096 @end example
3097
3098 @cindex transactions
3099 Primarily, @var{options} specifies the operations to be performed during
3100 the transaction. Upon completion, a new profile is created, but
3101 previous @dfn{generations} of the profile remain available, should the user
3102 want to roll back.
3103
3104 For example, to remove @code{lua} and install @code{guile} and
3105 @code{guile-cairo} in a single transaction:
3106
3107 @example
3108 guix package -r lua -i guile guile-cairo
3109 @end example
3110
3111 @cindex aliases, for @command{guix package}
3112 For your convenience, we also provide the following aliases:
3113
3114 @itemize
3115 @item
3116 @command{guix search} is an alias for @command{guix package -s},
3117 @item
3118 @command{guix install} is an alias for @command{guix package -i},
3119 @item
3120 @command{guix remove} is an alias for @command{guix package -r},
3121 @item
3122 @command{guix upgrade} is an alias for @command{guix package -u},
3123 @item
3124 and @command{guix show} is an alias for @command{guix package --show=}.
3125 @end itemize
3126
3127 These aliases are less expressive than @command{guix package} and provide
3128 fewer options, so in some cases you'll probably want to use @command{guix
3129 package} directly.
3130
3131 @command{guix package} also supports a @dfn{declarative approach}
3132 whereby the user specifies the exact set of packages to be available and
3133 passes it @i{via} the @option{--manifest} option
3134 (@pxref{profile-manifest, @option{--manifest}}).
3135
3136 @cindex profile
3137 For each user, a symlink to the user's default profile is automatically
3138 created in @file{$HOME/.guix-profile}. This symlink always points to the
3139 current generation of the user's default profile. Thus, users can add
3140 @file{$HOME/.guix-profile/bin} to their @env{PATH} environment
3141 variable, and so on.
3142 @cindex search paths
3143 If you are not using Guix System, consider adding the
3144 following lines to your @file{~/.bash_profile} (@pxref{Bash Startup
3145 Files,,, bash, The GNU Bash Reference Manual}) so that newly-spawned
3146 shells get all the right environment variable definitions:
3147
3148 @example
3149 GUIX_PROFILE="$HOME/.guix-profile" ; \
3150 source "$GUIX_PROFILE/etc/profile"
3151 @end example
3152
3153 In a multi-user setup, user profiles are stored in a place registered as
3154 a @dfn{garbage-collector root}, which @file{$HOME/.guix-profile} points
3155 to (@pxref{Invoking guix gc}). That directory is normally
3156 @code{@var{localstatedir}/guix/profiles/per-user/@var{user}}, where
3157 @var{localstatedir} is the value passed to @code{configure} as
3158 @option{--localstatedir}, and @var{user} is the user name. The
3159 @file{per-user} directory is created when @command{guix-daemon} is
3160 started, and the @var{user} sub-directory is created by @command{guix
3161 package}.
3162
3163 The @var{options} can be among the following:
3164
3165 @table @code
3166
3167 @item --install=@var{package} @dots{}
3168 @itemx -i @var{package} @dots{}
3169 Install the specified @var{package}s.
3170
3171 Each @var{package} may specify either a simple package name, such as
3172 @code{guile}, or a package name followed by an at-sign and version number,
3173 such as @code{guile@@1.8.8} or simply @code{guile@@1.8} (in the latter
3174 case, the newest version prefixed by @code{1.8} is selected).
3175
3176 If no version number is specified, the
3177 newest available version will be selected. In addition, @var{package}
3178 may contain a colon, followed by the name of one of the outputs of the
3179 package, as in @code{gcc:doc} or @code{binutils@@2.22:lib}
3180 (@pxref{Packages with Multiple Outputs}). Packages with a corresponding
3181 name (and optionally version) are searched for among the GNU
3182 distribution modules (@pxref{Package Modules}).
3183
3184 @cindex propagated inputs
3185 Sometimes packages have @dfn{propagated inputs}: these are dependencies
3186 that automatically get installed along with the required package
3187 (@pxref{package-propagated-inputs, @code{propagated-inputs} in
3188 @code{package} objects}, for information about propagated inputs in
3189 package definitions).
3190
3191 @anchor{package-cmd-propagated-inputs}
3192 An example is the GNU MPC library: its C header files refer to those of
3193 the GNU MPFR library, which in turn refer to those of the GMP library.
3194 Thus, when installing MPC, the MPFR and GMP libraries also get installed
3195 in the profile; removing MPC also removes MPFR and GMP---unless they had
3196 also been explicitly installed by the user.
3197
3198 Besides, packages sometimes rely on the definition of environment
3199 variables for their search paths (see explanation of
3200 @option{--search-paths} below). Any missing or possibly incorrect
3201 environment variable definitions are reported here.
3202
3203 @item --install-from-expression=@var{exp}
3204 @itemx -e @var{exp}
3205 Install the package @var{exp} evaluates to.
3206
3207 @var{exp} must be a Scheme expression that evaluates to a
3208 @code{<package>} object. This option is notably useful to disambiguate
3209 between same-named variants of a package, with expressions such as
3210 @code{(@@ (gnu packages base) guile-final)}.
3211
3212 Note that this option installs the first output of the specified
3213 package, which may be insufficient when needing a specific output of a
3214 multiple-output package.
3215
3216 @item --install-from-file=@var{file}
3217 @itemx -f @var{file}
3218 Install the package that the code within @var{file} evaluates to.
3219
3220 As an example, @var{file} might contain a definition like this
3221 (@pxref{Defining Packages}):
3222
3223 @lisp
3224 @include package-hello.scm
3225 @end lisp
3226
3227 Developers may find it useful to include such a @file{guix.scm} file
3228 in the root of their project source tree that can be used to test
3229 development snapshots and create reproducible development environments
3230 (@pxref{Invoking guix environment}).
3231
3232 The @var{file} may also contain a JSON representation of one or more
3233 package definitions. Running @code{guix package -f} on
3234 @file{hello.json} with the following contents would result in installing
3235 the package @code{greeter} after building @code{myhello}:
3236
3237 @example
3238 @verbatiminclude package-hello.json
3239 @end example
3240
3241 @item --remove=@var{package} @dots{}
3242 @itemx -r @var{package} @dots{}
3243 Remove the specified @var{package}s.
3244
3245 As for @option{--install}, each @var{package} may specify a version number
3246 and/or output name in addition to the package name. For instance,
3247 @samp{-r glibc:debug} would remove the @code{debug} output of
3248 @code{glibc}.
3249
3250 @item --upgrade[=@var{regexp} @dots{}]
3251 @itemx -u [@var{regexp} @dots{}]
3252 @cindex upgrading packages
3253 Upgrade all the installed packages. If one or more @var{regexp}s are
3254 specified, upgrade only installed packages whose name matches a
3255 @var{regexp}. Also see the @option{--do-not-upgrade} option below.
3256
3257 Note that this upgrades package to the latest version of packages found
3258 in the distribution currently installed. To update your distribution,
3259 you should regularly run @command{guix pull} (@pxref{Invoking guix
3260 pull}).
3261
3262 @cindex package transformations, upgrades
3263 When upgrading, package transformations that were originally applied
3264 when creating the profile are automatically re-applied (@pxref{Package
3265 Transformation Options}). For example, assume you first installed Emacs
3266 from the tip of its development branch with:
3267
3268 @example
3269 guix install emacs-next --with-branch=emacs-next=master
3270 @end example
3271
3272 Next time you run @command{guix upgrade}, Guix will again pull the tip
3273 of the Emacs development branch and build @code{emacs-next} from that
3274 checkout.
3275
3276 Note that transformation options such as @option{--with-branch} and
3277 @option{--with-source} depend on external state; it is up to you to
3278 ensure that they work as expected. You can also discard a
3279 transformations that apply to a package by running:
3280
3281 @example
3282 guix install @var{package}
3283 @end example
3284
3285 @item --do-not-upgrade[=@var{regexp} @dots{}]
3286 When used together with the @option{--upgrade} option, do @emph{not}
3287 upgrade any packages whose name matches a @var{regexp}. For example, to
3288 upgrade all packages in the current profile except those containing the
3289 substring ``emacs'':
3290
3291 @example
3292 $ guix package --upgrade . --do-not-upgrade emacs
3293 @end example
3294
3295 @item @anchor{profile-manifest}--manifest=@var{file}
3296 @itemx -m @var{file}
3297 @cindex profile declaration
3298 @cindex profile manifest
3299 Create a new generation of the profile from the manifest object
3300 returned by the Scheme code in @var{file}. This option can be repeated
3301 several times, in which case the manifests are concatenated.
3302
3303 This allows you to @emph{declare} the profile's contents rather than
3304 constructing it through a sequence of @option{--install} and similar
3305 commands. The advantage is that @var{file} can be put under version
3306 control, copied to different machines to reproduce the same profile, and
3307 so on.
3308
3309 @c FIXME: Add reference to (guix profile) documentation when available.
3310 @var{file} must return a @dfn{manifest} object, which is roughly a list
3311 of packages:
3312
3313 @findex packages->manifest
3314 @lisp
3315 (use-package-modules guile emacs)
3316
3317 (packages->manifest
3318 (list emacs
3319 guile-2.0
3320 ;; Use a specific package output.
3321 (list guile-2.0 "debug")))
3322 @end lisp
3323
3324 @findex specifications->manifest
3325 In this example we have to know which modules define the @code{emacs}
3326 and @code{guile-2.0} variables to provide the right
3327 @code{use-package-modules} line, which can be cumbersome. We can
3328 instead provide regular package specifications and let
3329 @code{specifications->manifest} look up the corresponding package
3330 objects, like this:
3331
3332 @lisp
3333 (specifications->manifest
3334 '("emacs" "guile@@2.2" "guile@@2.2:debug"))
3335 @end lisp
3336
3337 @xref{export-manifest, @option{--export-manifest}}, to learn how to
3338 obtain a manifest file from an existing profile.
3339
3340 @item --roll-back
3341 @cindex rolling back
3342 @cindex undoing transactions
3343 @cindex transactions, undoing
3344 Roll back to the previous @dfn{generation} of the profile---i.e., undo
3345 the last transaction.
3346
3347 When combined with options such as @option{--install}, roll back occurs
3348 before any other actions.
3349
3350 When rolling back from the first generation that actually contains
3351 installed packages, the profile is made to point to the @dfn{zeroth
3352 generation}, which contains no files apart from its own metadata.
3353
3354 After having rolled back, installing, removing, or upgrading packages
3355 overwrites previous future generations. Thus, the history of the
3356 generations in a profile is always linear.
3357
3358 @item --switch-generation=@var{pattern}
3359 @itemx -S @var{pattern}
3360 @cindex generations
3361 Switch to a particular generation defined by @var{pattern}.
3362
3363 @var{pattern} may be either a generation number or a number prefixed
3364 with ``+'' or ``-''. The latter means: move forward/backward by a
3365 specified number of generations. For example, if you want to return to
3366 the latest generation after @option{--roll-back}, use
3367 @option{--switch-generation=+1}.
3368
3369 The difference between @option{--roll-back} and
3370 @option{--switch-generation=-1} is that @option{--switch-generation} will
3371 not make a zeroth generation, so if a specified generation does not
3372 exist, the current generation will not be changed.
3373
3374 @item --search-paths[=@var{kind}]
3375 @cindex search paths
3376 Report environment variable definitions, in Bash syntax, that may be
3377 needed in order to use the set of installed packages. These environment
3378 variables are used to specify @dfn{search paths} for files used by some
3379 of the installed packages.
3380
3381 For example, GCC needs the @env{CPATH} and @env{LIBRARY_PATH}
3382 environment variables to be defined so it can look for headers and
3383 libraries in the user's profile (@pxref{Environment Variables,,, gcc,
3384 Using the GNU Compiler Collection (GCC)}). If GCC and, say, the C
3385 library are installed in the profile, then @option{--search-paths} will
3386 suggest setting these variables to @file{@var{profile}/include} and
3387 @file{@var{profile}/lib}, respectively.
3388
3389 The typical use case is to define these environment variables in the
3390 shell:
3391
3392 @example
3393 $ eval `guix package --search-paths`
3394 @end example
3395
3396 @var{kind} may be one of @code{exact}, @code{prefix}, or @code{suffix},
3397 meaning that the returned environment variable definitions will either
3398 be exact settings, or prefixes or suffixes of the current value of these
3399 variables. When omitted, @var{kind} defaults to @code{exact}.
3400
3401 This option can also be used to compute the @emph{combined} search paths
3402 of several profiles. Consider this example:
3403
3404 @example
3405 $ guix package -p foo -i guile
3406 $ guix package -p bar -i guile-json
3407 $ guix package -p foo -p bar --search-paths
3408 @end example
3409
3410 The last command above reports about the @env{GUILE_LOAD_PATH}
3411 variable, even though, taken individually, neither @file{foo} nor
3412 @file{bar} would lead to that recommendation.
3413
3414
3415 @cindex profile, choosing
3416 @item --profile=@var{profile}
3417 @itemx -p @var{profile}
3418 Use @var{profile} instead of the user's default profile.
3419
3420 @var{profile} must be the name of a file that will be created upon
3421 completion. Concretely, @var{profile} will be a mere symbolic link
3422 (``symlink'') pointing to the actual profile where packages are
3423 installed:
3424
3425 @example
3426 $ guix install hello -p ~/code/my-profile
3427 @dots{}
3428 $ ~/code/my-profile/bin/hello
3429 Hello, world!
3430 @end example
3431
3432 All it takes to get rid of the profile is to remove this symlink and its
3433 siblings that point to specific generations:
3434
3435 @example
3436 $ rm ~/code/my-profile ~/code/my-profile-*-link
3437 @end example
3438
3439 @item --list-profiles
3440 List all the user's profiles:
3441
3442 @example
3443 $ guix package --list-profiles
3444 /home/charlie/.guix-profile
3445 /home/charlie/code/my-profile
3446 /home/charlie/code/devel-profile
3447 /home/charlie/tmp/test
3448 @end example
3449
3450 When running as root, list all the profiles of all the users.
3451
3452 @cindex collisions, in a profile
3453 @cindex colliding packages in profiles
3454 @cindex profile collisions
3455 @item --allow-collisions
3456 Allow colliding packages in the new profile. Use at your own risk!
3457
3458 By default, @command{guix package} reports as an error @dfn{collisions}
3459 in the profile. Collisions happen when two or more different versions
3460 or variants of a given package end up in the profile.
3461
3462 @item --bootstrap
3463 Use the bootstrap Guile to build the profile. This option is only
3464 useful to distribution developers.
3465
3466 @end table
3467
3468 In addition to these actions, @command{guix package} supports the
3469 following options to query the current state of a profile, or the
3470 availability of packages:
3471
3472 @table @option
3473
3474 @item --search=@var{regexp}
3475 @itemx -s @var{regexp}
3476 @anchor{guix-search}
3477 @cindex searching for packages
3478 List the available packages whose name, synopsis, or description matches
3479 @var{regexp} (in a case-insensitive fashion), sorted by relevance.
3480 Print all the metadata of matching packages in
3481 @code{recutils} format (@pxref{Top, GNU recutils databases,, recutils,
3482 GNU recutils manual}).
3483
3484 This allows specific fields to be extracted using the @command{recsel}
3485 command, for instance:
3486
3487 @example
3488 $ guix package -s malloc | recsel -p name,version,relevance
3489 name: jemalloc
3490 version: 4.5.0
3491 relevance: 6
3492
3493 name: glibc
3494 version: 2.25
3495 relevance: 1
3496
3497 name: libgc
3498 version: 7.6.0
3499 relevance: 1
3500 @end example
3501
3502 Similarly, to show the name of all the packages available under the
3503 terms of the GNU@tie{}LGPL version 3:
3504
3505 @example
3506 $ guix package -s "" | recsel -p name -e 'license ~ "LGPL 3"'
3507 name: elfutils
3508
3509 name: gmp
3510 @dots{}
3511 @end example
3512
3513 It is also possible to refine search results using several @code{-s} flags to
3514 @command{guix package}, or several arguments to @command{guix search}. For
3515 example, the following command returns a list of board games (this time using
3516 the @command{guix search} alias):
3517
3518 @example
3519 $ guix search '\<board\>' game | recsel -p name
3520 name: gnubg
3521 @dots{}
3522 @end example
3523
3524 If we were to omit @code{-s game}, we would also get software packages
3525 that deal with printed circuit boards; removing the angle brackets
3526 around @code{board} would further add packages that have to do with
3527 keyboards.
3528
3529 And now for a more elaborate example. The following command searches
3530 for cryptographic libraries, filters out Haskell, Perl, Python, and Ruby
3531 libraries, and prints the name and synopsis of the matching packages:
3532
3533 @example
3534 $ guix search crypto library | \
3535 recsel -e '! (name ~ "^(ghc|perl|python|ruby)")' -p name,synopsis
3536 @end example
3537
3538 @noindent
3539 @xref{Selection Expressions,,, recutils, GNU recutils manual}, for more
3540 information on @dfn{selection expressions} for @code{recsel -e}.
3541
3542 @item --show=@var{package}
3543 Show details about @var{package}, taken from the list of available packages, in
3544 @code{recutils} format (@pxref{Top, GNU recutils databases,, recutils, GNU
3545 recutils manual}).
3546
3547 @example
3548 $ guix package --show=python | recsel -p name,version
3549 name: python
3550 version: 2.7.6
3551
3552 name: python
3553 version: 3.3.5
3554 @end example
3555
3556 You may also specify the full name of a package to only get details about a
3557 specific version of it (this time using the @command{guix show} alias):
3558 @example
3559 $ guix show python@@3.4 | recsel -p name,version
3560 name: python
3561 version: 3.4.3
3562 @end example
3563
3564
3565
3566 @item --list-installed[=@var{regexp}]
3567 @itemx -I [@var{regexp}]
3568 List the currently installed packages in the specified profile, with the
3569 most recently installed packages shown last. When @var{regexp} is
3570 specified, list only installed packages whose name matches @var{regexp}.
3571
3572 For each installed package, print the following items, separated by
3573 tabs: the package name, its version string, the part of the package that
3574 is installed (for instance, @code{out} for the default output,
3575 @code{include} for its headers, etc.), and the path of this package in
3576 the store.
3577
3578 @item --list-available[=@var{regexp}]
3579 @itemx -A [@var{regexp}]
3580 List packages currently available in the distribution for this system
3581 (@pxref{GNU Distribution}). When @var{regexp} is specified, list only
3582 available packages whose name matches @var{regexp}.
3583
3584 For each package, print the following items separated by tabs: its name,
3585 its version string, the parts of the package (@pxref{Packages with
3586 Multiple Outputs}), and the source location of its definition.
3587
3588 @item --list-generations[=@var{pattern}]
3589 @itemx -l [@var{pattern}]
3590 @cindex generations
3591 Return a list of generations along with their creation dates; for each
3592 generation, show the installed packages, with the most recently
3593 installed packages shown last. Note that the zeroth generation is never
3594 shown.
3595
3596 For each installed package, print the following items, separated by
3597 tabs: the name of a package, its version string, the part of the package
3598 that is installed (@pxref{Packages with Multiple Outputs}), and the
3599 location of this package in the store.
3600
3601 When @var{pattern} is used, the command returns only matching
3602 generations. Valid patterns include:
3603
3604 @itemize
3605 @item @emph{Integers and comma-separated integers}. Both patterns denote
3606 generation numbers. For instance, @option{--list-generations=1} returns
3607 the first one.
3608
3609 And @option{--list-generations=1,8,2} outputs three generations in the
3610 specified order. Neither spaces nor trailing commas are allowed.
3611
3612 @item @emph{Ranges}. @option{--list-generations=2..9} prints the
3613 specified generations and everything in between. Note that the start of
3614 a range must be smaller than its end.
3615
3616 It is also possible to omit the endpoint. For example,
3617 @option{--list-generations=2..}, returns all generations starting from the
3618 second one.
3619
3620 @item @emph{Durations}. You can also get the last @emph{N}@tie{}days, weeks,
3621 or months by passing an integer along with the first letter of the
3622 duration. For example, @option{--list-generations=20d} lists generations
3623 that are up to 20 days old.
3624 @end itemize
3625
3626 @item --delete-generations[=@var{pattern}]
3627 @itemx -d [@var{pattern}]
3628 When @var{pattern} is omitted, delete all generations except the current
3629 one.
3630
3631 This command accepts the same patterns as @option{--list-generations}.
3632 When @var{pattern} is specified, delete the matching generations. When
3633 @var{pattern} specifies a duration, generations @emph{older} than the
3634 specified duration match. For instance, @option{--delete-generations=1m}
3635 deletes generations that are more than one month old.
3636
3637 If the current generation matches, it is @emph{not} deleted. Also, the
3638 zeroth generation is never deleted.
3639
3640 Note that deleting generations prevents rolling back to them.
3641 Consequently, this command must be used with care.
3642
3643 @cindex manifest, exporting
3644 @anchor{export-manifest}
3645 @item --export-manifest
3646 Write to standard output a manifest suitable for @option{--manifest}
3647 corresponding to the chosen profile(s).
3648
3649 This option is meant to help you migrate from the ``imperative''
3650 operating mode---running @command{guix install}, @command{guix upgrade},
3651 etc.---to the declarative mode that @option{--manifest} offers.
3652
3653 Be aware that the resulting manifest @emph{approximates} what your
3654 profile actually contains; for instance, depending on how your profile
3655 was created, it can refer to packages or package versions that are not
3656 exactly what you specified.
3657
3658 Keep in mind that a manifest is purely symbolic: it only contains
3659 package names and possibly versions, and their meaning varies over time.
3660 If you wish to ``pin'' channels to the revisions that were used to build
3661 the profile(s), see @option{--export-channels} below.
3662
3663 @cindex pinning, channel revisions of a profile
3664 @item --export-channels
3665 Write to standard output the list of channels used by the chosen
3666 profile(s), in a format suitable for @command{guix pull --channels} or
3667 @command{guix time-machine --channels} (@pxref{Channels}).
3668
3669 Together with @option{--export-manifest}, this option provides
3670 information allowing you to replicate the current profile
3671 (@pxref{Replicating Guix}).
3672
3673 However, note that the output of this command @emph{approximates} what
3674 was actually used to build this profile. In particular, a single
3675 profile might have been built from several different revisions of the
3676 same channel. In that case, @option{--export-manifest} chooses the last
3677 one and writes the list of other revisions in a comment. If you really
3678 need to pick packages from different channel revisions, you can use
3679 inferiors in your manifest to do so (@pxref{Inferiors}).
3680
3681 Together with @option{--export-manifest}, this is a good starting point
3682 if you are willing to migrate from the ``imperative'' model to the fully
3683 declarative model consisting of a manifest file along with a channels
3684 file pinning the exact channel revision(s) you want.
3685 @end table
3686
3687 Finally, since @command{guix package} may actually start build
3688 processes, it supports all the common build options (@pxref{Common Build
3689 Options}). It also supports package transformation options, such as
3690 @option{--with-source}, and preserves them across upgrades
3691 (@pxref{Package Transformation Options}).
3692
3693 @node Substitutes
3694 @section Substitutes
3695
3696 @cindex substitutes
3697 @cindex pre-built binaries
3698 Guix supports transparent source/binary deployment, which means that it
3699 can either build things locally, or download pre-built items from a
3700 server, or both. We call these pre-built items @dfn{substitutes}---they
3701 are substitutes for local build results. In many cases, downloading a
3702 substitute is much faster than building things locally.
3703
3704 Substitutes can be anything resulting from a derivation build
3705 (@pxref{Derivations}). Of course, in the common case, they are
3706 pre-built package binaries, but source tarballs, for instance, which
3707 also result from derivation builds, can be available as substitutes.
3708
3709 @menu
3710 * Official Substitute Servers:: One particular source of substitutes.
3711 * Substitute Server Authorization:: How to enable or disable substitutes.
3712 * Getting Substitutes from Other Servers:: Substitute diversity.
3713 * Substitute Authentication:: How Guix verifies substitutes.
3714 * Proxy Settings:: How to get substitutes via proxy.
3715 * Substitution Failure:: What happens when substitution fails.
3716 * On Trusting Binaries:: How can you trust that binary blob?
3717 @end menu
3718
3719 @node Official Substitute Servers
3720 @subsection Official Substitute Servers
3721
3722 @cindex build farm
3723 @code{@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER-1}} and
3724 @code{@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER-2}} are both front-ends to official build
3725 farms that build packages from Guix continuously for some architectures,
3726 and make them available as substitutes. These are the default source of
3727 substitutes; which can be overridden by passing the
3728 @option{--substitute-urls} option either to @command{guix-daemon}
3729 (@pxref{daemon-substitute-urls,, @code{guix-daemon --substitute-urls}})
3730 or to client tools such as @command{guix package}
3731 (@pxref{client-substitute-urls,, client @option{--substitute-urls}
3732 option}).
3733
3734 Substitute URLs can be either HTTP or HTTPS.
3735 HTTPS is recommended because communications are encrypted; conversely,
3736 using HTTP makes all communications visible to an eavesdropper, who
3737 could use the information gathered to determine, for instance, whether
3738 your system has unpatched security vulnerabilities.
3739
3740 Substitutes from the official build farms are enabled by default when
3741 using Guix System (@pxref{GNU Distribution}). However,
3742 they are disabled by default when using Guix on a foreign distribution,
3743 unless you have explicitly enabled them via one of the recommended
3744 installation steps (@pxref{Installation}). The following paragraphs
3745 describe how to enable or disable substitutes for the official build
3746 farm; the same procedure can also be used to enable substitutes for any
3747 other substitute server.
3748
3749 @node Substitute Server Authorization
3750 @subsection Substitute Server Authorization
3751
3752 @cindex security
3753 @cindex substitutes, authorization thereof
3754 @cindex access control list (ACL), for substitutes
3755 @cindex ACL (access control list), for substitutes
3756 To allow Guix to download substitutes from @code{@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER-1}}, @code{@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER-2}} or a mirror, you
3757 must add the relevant public key to the access control list (ACL) of archive
3758 imports, using the @command{guix archive} command (@pxref{Invoking guix
3759 archive}). Doing so implies that you trust the substitute server to not
3760 be compromised and to serve genuine substitutes.
3761
3762 @quotation Note
3763 If you are using Guix System, you can skip this section: Guix System
3764 authorizes substitutes from @code{@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER-1}} and
3765 @code{@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER-2}} by default.
3766 @end quotation
3767
3768 The public keys for each of the project maintained substitute servers
3769 are installed along with Guix, in @code{@var{prefix}/share/guix/}, where
3770 @var{prefix} is the installation prefix of Guix. If you installed Guix
3771 from source, make sure you checked the GPG signature of
3772 @file{guix-@value{VERSION}.tar.gz}, which contains this public key file.
3773 Then, you can run something like this:
3774
3775 @example
3776 # guix archive --authorize < @var{prefix}/share/guix/@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER-1}.pub
3777 # guix archive --authorize < @var{prefix}/share/guix/@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER-2}.pub
3778 @end example
3779
3780 Once this is in place, the output of a command like @code{guix build}
3781 should change from something like:
3782
3783 @example
3784 $ guix build emacs --dry-run
3785 The following derivations would be built:
3786 /gnu/store/yr7bnx8xwcayd6j95r2clmkdl1qh688w-emacs-24.3.drv
3787 /gnu/store/x8qsh1hlhgjx6cwsjyvybnfv2i37z23w-dbus-1.6.4.tar.gz.drv
3788 /gnu/store/1ixwp12fl950d15h2cj11c73733jay0z-alsa-lib-1.0.27.1.tar.bz2.drv
3789 /gnu/store/nlma1pw0p603fpfiqy7kn4zm105r5dmw-util-linux-2.21.drv
3790 @dots{}
3791 @end example
3792
3793 @noindent
3794 to something like:
3795
3796 @example
3797 $ guix build emacs --dry-run
3798 112.3 MB would be downloaded:
3799 /gnu/store/pk3n22lbq6ydamyymqkkz7i69wiwjiwi-emacs-24.3
3800 /gnu/store/2ygn4ncnhrpr61rssa6z0d9x22si0va3-libjpeg-8d
3801 /gnu/store/71yz6lgx4dazma9dwn2mcjxaah9w77jq-cairo-1.12.16
3802 /gnu/store/7zdhgp0n1518lvfn8mb96sxqfmvqrl7v-libxrender-0.9.7
3803 @dots{}
3804 @end example
3805
3806 @noindent
3807 The text changed from ``The following derivations would be built'' to
3808 ``112.3 MB would be downloaded''. This indicates that substitutes from
3809 the configured substitute servers are usable and will be downloaded,
3810 when possible, for future builds.
3811
3812 @cindex substitutes, how to disable
3813 The substitute mechanism can be disabled globally by running
3814 @code{guix-daemon} with @option{--no-substitutes} (@pxref{Invoking
3815 guix-daemon}). It can also be disabled temporarily by passing the
3816 @option{--no-substitutes} option to @command{guix package},
3817 @command{guix build}, and other command-line tools.
3818
3819 @node Getting Substitutes from Other Servers
3820 @subsection Getting Substitutes from Other Servers
3821
3822 @cindex substitute servers, adding more
3823 Guix can look up and fetch substitutes from several servers. This is
3824 useful when you are using packages from additional channels for which
3825 the official server does not have substitutes but another server
3826 provides them. Another situation where this is useful is when you would
3827 prefer to download from your organization's substitute server, resorting
3828 to the official server only as a fallback or dismissing it altogether.
3829
3830 You can give Guix a list of substitute server URLs and it will check
3831 them in the specified order. You also need to explicitly authorize the
3832 public keys of substitute servers to instruct Guix to accept the
3833 substitutes they sign.
3834
3835 On Guix System, this is achieved by modifying the configuration of the
3836 @code{guix} service. Since the @code{guix} service is part of the
3837 default lists of services, @code{%base-services} and
3838 @code{%desktop-services}, you can use @code{modify-services} to change
3839 its configuration and add the URLs and substitute keys that you want
3840 (@pxref{Service Reference, @code{modify-services}}).
3841
3842 As an example, suppose you want to fetch substitutes from
3843 @code{guix.example.org} and to authorize the signing key of that server,
3844 in addition to the default @code{@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER-1}} and
3845 @code{@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER-2}}. The resulting operating system
3846 configuration will look something like:
3847
3848 @lisp
3849 (operating-system
3850 ;; @dots{}
3851 (services
3852 ;; Assume we're starting from '%desktop-services'. Replace it
3853 ;; with the list of services you're actually using.
3854 (modify-services %desktop-services
3855 (guix-service-type config =>
3856 (guix-configuration
3857 (inherit config)
3858 (substitute-urls
3859 (append (list "https://guix.example.org")
3860 %default-substitute-urls))
3861 (authorized-keys
3862 (append (list (local-file "./key.pub"))
3863 %default-authorized-guix-keys)))))))
3864 @end lisp
3865
3866 This assumes that the file @file{key.pub} contains the signing key of
3867 @code{guix.example.org}. With this change in place in your operating
3868 system configuration file (say @file{/etc/config.scm}), you can
3869 reconfigure and restart the @code{guix-daemon} service or reboot so the
3870 changes take effect:
3871
3872 @example
3873 $ sudo guix system reconfigure /etc/config.scm
3874 $ sudo herd restart guix-daemon
3875 @end example
3876
3877 If you're running Guix on a ``foreign distro'', you would instead take
3878 the following steps to get substitutes from additional servers:
3879
3880 @enumerate
3881 @item
3882 Edit the service configuration file for @code{guix-daemon}; when using
3883 systemd, this is normally
3884 @file{/etc/systemd/system/guix-daemon.service}. Add the
3885 @option{--substitute-urls} option on the @command{guix-daemon} command
3886 line and list the URLs of interest (@pxref{daemon-substitute-urls,
3887 @code{guix-daemon --substitute-urls}}):
3888
3889 @example
3890 @dots{} --substitute-urls='https://guix.example.org @value{SUBSTITUTE-URLS}'
3891 @end example
3892
3893 @item
3894 Restart the daemon. For systemd, it goes like this:
3895
3896 @example
3897 systemctl daemon-reload
3898 systemctl restart guix-daemon.service
3899 @end example
3900
3901 @item
3902 Authorize the key of the new server (@pxref{Invoking guix archive}):
3903
3904 @example
3905 guix archive --authorize < key.pub
3906 @end example
3907
3908 Again this assumes @file{key.pub} contains the public key that
3909 @code{guix.example.org} uses to sign substitutes.
3910 @end enumerate
3911
3912 Now you're all set! Substitutes will be preferably taken from
3913 @code{https://guix.example.org}, using
3914 @code{@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER-1}} then
3915 @code{@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER-2}} as fallback options. Of course you
3916 can list as many substitute servers as you like, with the caveat that
3917 substitute lookup can be slowed down if too many servers need to be
3918 contacted.
3919
3920 Note that there are also situations where one may want to add the URL of
3921 a substitute server @emph{without} authorizing its key.
3922 @xref{Substitute Authentication}, to understand this fine point.
3923
3924 @node Substitute Authentication
3925 @subsection Substitute Authentication
3926
3927 @cindex digital signatures
3928 Guix detects and raises an error when attempting to use a substitute
3929 that has been tampered with. Likewise, it ignores substitutes that are
3930 not signed, or that are not signed by one of the keys listed in the ACL.
3931
3932 There is one exception though: if an unauthorized server provides
3933 substitutes that are @emph{bit-for-bit identical} to those provided by
3934 an authorized server, then the unauthorized server becomes eligible for
3935 downloads. For example, assume we have chosen two substitute servers
3936 with this option:
3937
3938 @example
3939 --substitute-urls="https://a.example.org https://b.example.org"
3940 @end example
3941
3942 @noindent
3943 @cindex reproducible builds
3944 If the ACL contains only the key for @samp{b.example.org}, and if
3945 @samp{a.example.org} happens to serve the @emph{exact same} substitutes,
3946 then Guix will download substitutes from @samp{a.example.org} because it
3947 comes first in the list and can be considered a mirror of
3948 @samp{b.example.org}. In practice, independent build machines usually
3949 produce the same binaries, thanks to bit-reproducible builds (see
3950 below).
3951
3952 When using HTTPS, the server's X.509 certificate is @emph{not} validated
3953 (in other words, the server is not authenticated), contrary to what
3954 HTTPS clients such as Web browsers usually do. This is because Guix
3955 authenticates substitute information itself, as explained above, which
3956 is what we care about (whereas X.509 certificates are about
3957 authenticating bindings between domain names and public keys).
3958
3959 @node Proxy Settings
3960 @subsection Proxy Settings
3961
3962 @vindex http_proxy
3963 @vindex https_proxy
3964 Substitutes are downloaded over HTTP or HTTPS@. The @env{http_proxy} and
3965 @env{https_proxy} environment variables can be set in the environment of
3966 @command{guix-daemon} and are honored for downloads of substitutes.
3967 Note that the value of those environment variables in the environment
3968 where @command{guix build}, @command{guix package}, and other client
3969 commands are run has @emph{absolutely no effect}.
3970
3971 @node Substitution Failure
3972 @subsection Substitution Failure
3973
3974 Even when a substitute for a derivation is available, sometimes the
3975 substitution attempt will fail. This can happen for a variety of
3976 reasons: the substitute server might be offline, the substitute may
3977 recently have been deleted, the connection might have been interrupted,
3978 etc.
3979
3980 When substitutes are enabled and a substitute for a derivation is
3981 available, but the substitution attempt fails, Guix will attempt to
3982 build the derivation locally depending on whether or not
3983 @option{--fallback} was given (@pxref{fallback-option,, common build
3984 option @option{--fallback}}). Specifically, if @option{--fallback} was
3985 omitted, then no local build will be performed, and the derivation is
3986 considered to have failed. However, if @option{--fallback} was given,
3987 then Guix will attempt to build the derivation locally, and the success
3988 or failure of the derivation depends on the success or failure of the
3989 local build. Note that when substitutes are disabled or no substitute
3990 is available for the derivation in question, a local build will
3991 @emph{always} be performed, regardless of whether or not
3992 @option{--fallback} was given.
3993
3994 To get an idea of how many substitutes are available right now, you can
3995 try running the @command{guix weather} command (@pxref{Invoking guix
3996 weather}). This command provides statistics on the substitutes provided
3997 by a server.
3998
3999 @node On Trusting Binaries
4000 @subsection On Trusting Binaries
4001
4002 @cindex trust, of pre-built binaries
4003 Today, each individual's control over their own computing is at the
4004 mercy of institutions, corporations, and groups with enough power and
4005 determination to subvert the computing infrastructure and exploit its
4006 weaknesses. While using substitutes can be convenient, we encourage
4007 users to also build on their own, or even run their own build farm, such
4008 that the project run substitute servers are less of an interesting
4009 target. One way to help is by publishing the software you build using
4010 @command{guix publish} so that others have one more choice of server to
4011 download substitutes from (@pxref{Invoking guix publish}).
4012
4013 Guix has the foundations to maximize build reproducibility
4014 (@pxref{Features}). In most cases, independent builds of a given
4015 package or derivation should yield bit-identical results. Thus, through
4016 a diverse set of independent package builds, we can strengthen the
4017 integrity of our systems. The @command{guix challenge} command aims to
4018 help users assess substitute servers, and to assist developers in
4019 finding out about non-deterministic package builds (@pxref{Invoking guix
4020 challenge}). Similarly, the @option{--check} option of @command{guix
4021 build} allows users to check whether previously-installed substitutes
4022 are genuine by rebuilding them locally (@pxref{build-check,
4023 @command{guix build --check}}).
4024
4025 In the future, we want Guix to have support to publish and retrieve
4026 binaries to/from other users, in a peer-to-peer fashion. If you would
4027 like to discuss this project, join us on @email{guix-devel@@gnu.org}.
4028
4029 @node Packages with Multiple Outputs
4030 @section Packages with Multiple Outputs
4031
4032 @cindex multiple-output packages
4033 @cindex package outputs
4034 @cindex outputs
4035
4036 Often, packages defined in Guix have a single @dfn{output}---i.e., the
4037 source package leads to exactly one directory in the store. When running
4038 @command{guix install glibc}, one installs the default output of the
4039 GNU libc package; the default output is called @code{out}, but its name
4040 can be omitted as shown in this command. In this particular case, the
4041 default output of @code{glibc} contains all the C header files, shared
4042 libraries, static libraries, Info documentation, and other supporting
4043 files.
4044
4045 Sometimes it is more appropriate to separate the various types of files
4046 produced from a single source package into separate outputs. For
4047 instance, the GLib C library (used by GTK+ and related packages)
4048 installs more than 20 MiB of reference documentation as HTML pages.
4049 To save space for users who do not need it, the documentation goes to a
4050 separate output, called @code{doc}. To install the main GLib output,
4051 which contains everything but the documentation, one would run:
4052
4053 @example
4054 guix install glib
4055 @end example
4056
4057 @cindex documentation
4058 The command to install its documentation is:
4059
4060 @example
4061 guix install glib:doc
4062 @end example
4063
4064 Some packages install programs with different ``dependency footprints''.
4065 For instance, the WordNet package installs both command-line tools and
4066 graphical user interfaces (GUIs). The former depend solely on the C
4067 library, whereas the latter depend on Tcl/Tk and the underlying X
4068 libraries. In this case, we leave the command-line tools in the default
4069 output, whereas the GUIs are in a separate output. This allows users
4070 who do not need the GUIs to save space. The @command{guix size} command
4071 can help find out about such situations (@pxref{Invoking guix size}).
4072 @command{guix graph} can also be helpful (@pxref{Invoking guix graph}).
4073
4074 There are several such multiple-output packages in the GNU distribution.
4075 Other conventional output names include @code{lib} for libraries and
4076 possibly header files, @code{bin} for stand-alone programs, and
4077 @code{debug} for debugging information (@pxref{Installing Debugging
4078 Files}). The outputs of a packages are listed in the third column of
4079 the output of @command{guix package --list-available} (@pxref{Invoking
4080 guix package}).
4081
4082
4083 @node Invoking guix gc
4084 @section Invoking @command{guix gc}
4085
4086 @cindex garbage collector
4087 @cindex disk space
4088 Packages that are installed, but not used, may be @dfn{garbage-collected}.
4089 The @command{guix gc} command allows users to explicitly run the garbage
4090 collector to reclaim space from the @file{/gnu/store} directory. It is
4091 the @emph{only} way to remove files from @file{/gnu/store}---removing
4092 files or directories manually may break it beyond repair!
4093
4094 @cindex GC roots
4095 @cindex garbage collector roots
4096 The garbage collector has a set of known @dfn{roots}: any file under
4097 @file{/gnu/store} reachable from a root is considered @dfn{live} and
4098 cannot be deleted; any other file is considered @dfn{dead} and may be
4099 deleted. The set of garbage collector roots (``GC roots'' for short)
4100 includes default user profiles; by default, the symlinks under
4101 @file{/var/guix/gcroots} represent these GC roots. New GC roots can be
4102 added with @command{guix build --root}, for example (@pxref{Invoking
4103 guix build}). The @command{guix gc --list-roots} command lists them.
4104
4105 Prior to running @code{guix gc --collect-garbage} to make space, it is
4106 often useful to remove old generations from user profiles; that way, old
4107 package builds referenced by those generations can be reclaimed. This
4108 is achieved by running @code{guix package --delete-generations}
4109 (@pxref{Invoking guix package}).
4110
4111 Our recommendation is to run a garbage collection periodically, or when
4112 you are short on disk space. For instance, to guarantee that at least
4113 5@tie{}GB are available on your disk, simply run:
4114
4115 @example
4116 guix gc -F 5G
4117 @end example
4118
4119 It is perfectly safe to run as a non-interactive periodic job
4120 (@pxref{Scheduled Job Execution}, for how to set up such a job).
4121 Running @command{guix gc} with no arguments will collect as
4122 much garbage as it can, but that is often inconvenient: you may find
4123 yourself having to rebuild or re-download software that is ``dead'' from
4124 the GC viewpoint but that is necessary to build other pieces of
4125 software---e.g., the compiler tool chain.
4126
4127 The @command{guix gc} command has three modes of operation: it can be
4128 used to garbage-collect any dead files (the default), to delete specific
4129 files (the @option{--delete} option), to print garbage-collector
4130 information, or for more advanced queries. The garbage collection
4131 options are as follows:
4132
4133 @table @code
4134 @item --collect-garbage[=@var{min}]
4135 @itemx -C [@var{min}]
4136 Collect garbage---i.e., unreachable @file{/gnu/store} files and
4137 sub-directories. This is the default operation when no option is
4138 specified.
4139
4140 When @var{min} is given, stop once @var{min} bytes have been collected.
4141 @var{min} may be a number of bytes, or it may include a unit as a
4142 suffix, such as @code{MiB} for mebibytes and @code{GB} for gigabytes
4143 (@pxref{Block size, size specifications,, coreutils, GNU Coreutils}).
4144
4145 When @var{min} is omitted, collect all the garbage.
4146
4147 @item --free-space=@var{free}
4148 @itemx -F @var{free}
4149 Collect garbage until @var{free} space is available under
4150 @file{/gnu/store}, if possible; @var{free} denotes storage space, such
4151 as @code{500MiB}, as described above.
4152
4153 When @var{free} or more is already available in @file{/gnu/store}, do
4154 nothing and exit immediately.
4155
4156 @item --delete-generations[=@var{duration}]
4157 @itemx -d [@var{duration}]
4158 Before starting the garbage collection process, delete all the generations
4159 older than @var{duration}, for all the user profiles; when run as root, this
4160 applies to all the profiles @emph{of all the users}.
4161
4162 For example, this command deletes all the generations of all your profiles
4163 that are older than 2 months (except generations that are current), and then
4164 proceeds to free space until at least 10 GiB are available:
4165
4166 @example
4167 guix gc -d 2m -F 10G
4168 @end example
4169
4170 @item --delete
4171 @itemx -D
4172 Attempt to delete all the store files and directories specified as
4173 arguments. This fails if some of the files are not in the store, or if
4174 they are still live.
4175
4176 @item --list-failures
4177 List store items corresponding to cached build failures.
4178
4179 This prints nothing unless the daemon was started with
4180 @option{--cache-failures} (@pxref{Invoking guix-daemon,
4181 @option{--cache-failures}}).
4182
4183 @item --list-roots
4184 List the GC roots owned by the user; when run as root, list @emph{all} the GC
4185 roots.
4186
4187 @item --list-busy
4188 List store items in use by currently running processes. These store
4189 items are effectively considered GC roots: they cannot be deleted.
4190
4191 @item --clear-failures
4192 Remove the specified store items from the failed-build cache.
4193
4194 Again, this option only makes sense when the daemon is started with
4195 @option{--cache-failures}. Otherwise, it does nothing.
4196
4197 @item --list-dead
4198 Show the list of dead files and directories still present in the
4199 store---i.e., files and directories no longer reachable from any root.
4200
4201 @item --list-live
4202 Show the list of live store files and directories.
4203
4204 @end table
4205
4206 In addition, the references among existing store files can be queried:
4207
4208 @table @code
4209
4210 @item --references
4211 @itemx --referrers
4212 @cindex package dependencies
4213 List the references (respectively, the referrers) of store files given
4214 as arguments.
4215
4216 @item --requisites
4217 @itemx -R
4218 @cindex closure
4219 List the requisites of the store files passed as arguments. Requisites
4220 include the store files themselves, their references, and the references
4221 of these, recursively. In other words, the returned list is the
4222 @dfn{transitive closure} of the store files.
4223
4224 @xref{Invoking guix size}, for a tool to profile the size of the closure
4225 of an element. @xref{Invoking guix graph}, for a tool to visualize
4226 the graph of references.
4227
4228 @item --derivers
4229 @cindex derivation
4230 Return the derivation(s) leading to the given store items
4231 (@pxref{Derivations}).
4232
4233 For example, this command:
4234
4235 @example
4236 guix gc --derivers $(guix package -I ^emacs$ | cut -f4)
4237 @end example
4238
4239 @noindent
4240 returns the @file{.drv} file(s) leading to the @code{emacs} package
4241 installed in your profile.
4242
4243 Note that there may be zero matching @file{.drv} files, for instance
4244 because these files have been garbage-collected. There can also be more
4245 than one matching @file{.drv} due to fixed-output derivations.
4246 @end table
4247
4248 Lastly, the following options allow you to check the integrity of the
4249 store and to control disk usage.
4250
4251 @table @option
4252
4253 @item --verify[=@var{options}]
4254 @cindex integrity, of the store
4255 @cindex integrity checking
4256 Verify the integrity of the store.
4257
4258 By default, make sure that all the store items marked as valid in the
4259 database of the daemon actually exist in @file{/gnu/store}.
4260
4261 When provided, @var{options} must be a comma-separated list containing one
4262 or more of @code{contents} and @code{repair}.
4263
4264 When passing @option{--verify=contents}, the daemon computes the
4265 content hash of each store item and compares it against its hash in the
4266 database. Hash mismatches are reported as data corruptions. Because it
4267 traverses @emph{all the files in the store}, this command can take a
4268 long time, especially on systems with a slow disk drive.
4269
4270 @cindex repairing the store
4271 @cindex corruption, recovering from
4272 Using @option{--verify=repair} or @option{--verify=contents,repair}
4273 causes the daemon to try to repair corrupt store items by fetching
4274 substitutes for them (@pxref{Substitutes}). Because repairing is not
4275 atomic, and thus potentially dangerous, it is available only to the
4276 system administrator. A lightweight alternative, when you know exactly
4277 which items in the store are corrupt, is @command{guix build --repair}
4278 (@pxref{Invoking guix build}).
4279
4280 @item --optimize
4281 @cindex deduplication
4282 Optimize the store by hard-linking identical files---this is
4283 @dfn{deduplication}.
4284
4285 The daemon performs deduplication after each successful build or archive
4286 import, unless it was started with @option{--disable-deduplication}
4287 (@pxref{Invoking guix-daemon, @option{--disable-deduplication}}). Thus,
4288 this option is primarily useful when the daemon was running with
4289 @option{--disable-deduplication}.
4290
4291 @end table
4292
4293 @node Invoking guix pull
4294 @section Invoking @command{guix pull}
4295
4296 @cindex upgrading Guix
4297 @cindex updating Guix
4298 @cindex @command{guix pull}
4299 @cindex pull
4300 @cindex security, @command{guix pull}
4301 @cindex authenticity, of code obtained with @command{guix pull}
4302 Packages are installed or upgraded to the latest version available in
4303 the distribution currently available on your local machine. To update
4304 that distribution, along with the Guix tools, you must run @command{guix
4305 pull}: the command downloads the latest Guix source code and package
4306 descriptions, and deploys it. Source code is downloaded from a
4307 @uref{https://git-scm.com, Git} repository, by default the official
4308 GNU@tie{}Guix repository, though this can be customized. @command{guix
4309 pull} ensures that the code it downloads is @emph{authentic} by
4310 verifying that commits are signed by Guix developers.
4311
4312 Specifically, @command{guix pull} downloads code from the @dfn{channels}
4313 (@pxref{Channels}) specified by one of the followings, in this order:
4314
4315 @enumerate
4316 @item
4317 the @option{--channels} option;
4318 @item
4319 the user's @file{~/.config/guix/channels.scm} file;
4320 @item
4321 the system-wide @file{/etc/guix/channels.scm} file;
4322 @item
4323 the built-in default channels specified in the @code{%default-channels}
4324 variable.
4325 @end enumerate
4326
4327 On completion, @command{guix package} will use packages and package
4328 versions from this just-retrieved copy of Guix. Not only that, but all
4329 the Guix commands and Scheme modules will also be taken from that latest
4330 version. New @command{guix} sub-commands added by the update also
4331 become available.
4332
4333 Any user can update their Guix copy using @command{guix pull}, and the
4334 effect is limited to the user who ran @command{guix pull}. For
4335 instance, when user @code{root} runs @command{guix pull}, this has no
4336 effect on the version of Guix that user @code{alice} sees, and vice
4337 versa.
4338
4339 The result of running @command{guix pull} is a @dfn{profile} available
4340 under @file{~/.config/guix/current} containing the latest Guix. Thus,
4341 make sure to add it to the beginning of your search path so that you use
4342 the latest version, and similarly for the Info manual
4343 (@pxref{Documentation}):
4344
4345 @example
4346 export PATH="$HOME/.config/guix/current/bin:$PATH"
4347 export INFOPATH="$HOME/.config/guix/current/share/info:$INFOPATH"
4348 @end example
4349
4350 The @option{--list-generations} or @option{-l} option lists past generations
4351 produced by @command{guix pull}, along with details about their provenance:
4352
4353 @example
4354 $ guix pull -l
4355 Generation 1 Jun 10 2018 00:18:18
4356 guix 65956ad
4357 repository URL: https://git.savannah.gnu.org/git/guix.git
4358 branch: origin/master
4359 commit: 65956ad3526ba09e1f7a40722c96c6ef7c0936fe
4360
4361 Generation 2 Jun 11 2018 11:02:49
4362 guix e0cc7f6
4363 repository URL: https://git.savannah.gnu.org/git/guix.git
4364 branch: origin/master
4365 commit: e0cc7f669bec22c37481dd03a7941c7d11a64f1d
4366 2 new packages: keepalived, libnfnetlink
4367 6 packages upgraded: emacs-nix-mode@@2.0.4,
4368 guile2.0-guix@@0.14.0-12.77a1aac, guix@@0.14.0-12.77a1aac,
4369 heimdal@@7.5.0, milkytracker@@1.02.00, nix@@2.0.4
4370
4371 Generation 3 Jun 13 2018 23:31:07 (current)
4372 guix 844cc1c
4373 repository URL: https://git.savannah.gnu.org/git/guix.git
4374 branch: origin/master
4375 commit: 844cc1c8f394f03b404c5bb3aee086922373490c
4376 28 new packages: emacs-helm-ls-git, emacs-helm-mu, @dots{}
4377 69 packages upgraded: borg@@1.1.6, cheese@@3.28.0, @dots{}
4378 @end example
4379
4380 @xref{Invoking guix describe, @command{guix describe}}, for other ways to
4381 describe the current status of Guix.
4382
4383 This @code{~/.config/guix/current} profile works exactly like the profiles
4384 created by @command{guix package} (@pxref{Invoking guix package}). That
4385 is, you can list generations, roll back to the previous
4386 generation---i.e., the previous Guix---and so on:
4387
4388 @example
4389 $ guix pull --roll-back
4390 switched from generation 3 to 2
4391 $ guix pull --delete-generations=1
4392 deleting /var/guix/profiles/per-user/charlie/current-guix-1-link
4393 @end example
4394
4395 You can also use @command{guix package} (@pxref{Invoking guix package})
4396 to manage the profile by naming it explicitly:
4397 @example
4398 $ guix package -p ~/.config/guix/current --roll-back
4399 switched from generation 3 to 2
4400 $ guix package -p ~/.config/guix/current --delete-generations=1
4401 deleting /var/guix/profiles/per-user/charlie/current-guix-1-link
4402 @end example
4403
4404 The @command{guix pull} command is usually invoked with no arguments,
4405 but it supports the following options:
4406
4407 @table @code
4408 @item --url=@var{url}
4409 @itemx --commit=@var{commit}
4410 @itemx --branch=@var{branch}
4411 Download code for the @code{guix} channel from the specified @var{url}, at the
4412 given @var{commit} (a valid Git commit ID represented as a hexadecimal
4413 string), or @var{branch}.
4414
4415 @cindex @file{channels.scm}, configuration file
4416 @cindex configuration file for channels
4417 These options are provided for convenience, but you can also specify your
4418 configuration in the @file{~/.config/guix/channels.scm} file or using the
4419 @option{--channels} option (see below).
4420
4421 @item --channels=@var{file}
4422 @itemx -C @var{file}
4423 Read the list of channels from @var{file} instead of
4424 @file{~/.config/guix/channels.scm} or @file{/etc/guix/channels.scm}.
4425 @var{file} must contain Scheme code that
4426 evaluates to a list of channel objects. @xref{Channels}, for more
4427 information.
4428
4429 @cindex channel news
4430 @item --news
4431 @itemx -N
4432 Display the list of packages added or upgraded since the previous
4433 generation, as well as, occasionally, news written by channel authors
4434 for their users (@pxref{Channels, Writing Channel News}).
4435
4436 The package information is the same as displayed upon @command{guix
4437 pull} completion, but without ellipses; it is also similar to the output
4438 of @command{guix pull -l} for the last generation (see below).
4439
4440 @item --list-generations[=@var{pattern}]
4441 @itemx -l [@var{pattern}]
4442 List all the generations of @file{~/.config/guix/current} or, if @var{pattern}
4443 is provided, the subset of generations that match @var{pattern}.
4444 The syntax of @var{pattern} is the same as with @code{guix package
4445 --list-generations} (@pxref{Invoking guix package}).
4446
4447 @item --roll-back
4448 @cindex rolling back
4449 @cindex undoing transactions
4450 @cindex transactions, undoing
4451 Roll back to the previous @dfn{generation} of @file{~/.config/guix/current}---i.e.,
4452 undo the last transaction.
4453
4454 @item --switch-generation=@var{pattern}
4455 @itemx -S @var{pattern}
4456 @cindex generations
4457 Switch to a particular generation defined by @var{pattern}.
4458
4459 @var{pattern} may be either a generation number or a number prefixed
4460 with ``+'' or ``-''. The latter means: move forward/backward by a
4461 specified number of generations. For example, if you want to return to
4462 the latest generation after @option{--roll-back}, use
4463 @option{--switch-generation=+1}.
4464
4465 @item --delete-generations[=@var{pattern}]
4466 @itemx -d [@var{pattern}]
4467 When @var{pattern} is omitted, delete all generations except the current
4468 one.
4469
4470 This command accepts the same patterns as @option{--list-generations}.
4471 When @var{pattern} is specified, delete the matching generations. When
4472 @var{pattern} specifies a duration, generations @emph{older} than the
4473 specified duration match. For instance, @option{--delete-generations=1m}
4474 deletes generations that are more than one month old.
4475
4476 If the current generation matches, it is @emph{not} deleted.
4477
4478 Note that deleting generations prevents rolling back to them.
4479 Consequently, this command must be used with care.
4480
4481 @xref{Invoking guix describe}, for a way to display information about the
4482 current generation only.
4483
4484 @item --profile=@var{profile}
4485 @itemx -p @var{profile}
4486 Use @var{profile} instead of @file{~/.config/guix/current}.
4487
4488 @item --dry-run
4489 @itemx -n
4490 Show which channel commit(s) would be used and what would be built or
4491 substituted but do not actually do it.
4492
4493 @item --allow-downgrades
4494 Allow pulling older or unrelated revisions of channels than those
4495 currently in use.
4496
4497 @cindex downgrade attacks, protection against
4498 By default, @command{guix pull} protects against so-called ``downgrade
4499 attacks'' whereby the Git repository of a channel would be reset to an
4500 earlier or unrelated revision of itself, potentially leading you to
4501 install older, known-vulnerable versions of software packages.
4502
4503 @quotation Note
4504 Make sure you understand its security implications before using
4505 @option{--allow-downgrades}.
4506 @end quotation
4507
4508 @item --disable-authentication
4509 Allow pulling channel code without authenticating it.
4510
4511 @cindex authentication, of channel code
4512 By default, @command{guix pull} authenticates code downloaded from
4513 channels by verifying that its commits are signed by authorized
4514 developers, and raises an error if this is not the case. This option
4515 instructs it to not perform any such verification.
4516
4517 @quotation Note
4518 Make sure you understand its security implications before using
4519 @option{--disable-authentication}.
4520 @end quotation
4521
4522 @item --system=@var{system}
4523 @itemx -s @var{system}
4524 Attempt to build for @var{system}---e.g., @code{i686-linux}---instead of
4525 the system type of the build host.
4526
4527 @item --bootstrap
4528 Use the bootstrap Guile to build the latest Guix. This option is only
4529 useful to Guix developers.
4530 @end table
4531
4532 The @dfn{channel} mechanism allows you to instruct @command{guix pull} which
4533 repository and branch to pull from, as well as @emph{additional} repositories
4534 containing package modules that should be deployed. @xref{Channels}, for more
4535 information.
4536
4537 In addition, @command{guix pull} supports all the common build options
4538 (@pxref{Common Build Options}).
4539
4540 @node Invoking guix time-machine
4541 @section Invoking @command{guix time-machine}
4542
4543 @cindex @command{guix time-machine}
4544 @cindex pinning, channels
4545 @cindex replicating Guix
4546 @cindex reproducibility, of Guix
4547
4548 The @command{guix time-machine} command provides access to other
4549 revisions of Guix, for example to install older versions of packages,
4550 or to reproduce a computation in an identical environment. The revision
4551 of Guix to be used is defined by a commit or by a channel
4552 description file created by @command{guix describe}
4553 (@pxref{Invoking guix describe}).
4554
4555 The general syntax is:
4556
4557 @example
4558 guix time-machine @var{options}@dots{} -- @var{command} @var {arg}@dots{}
4559 @end example
4560
4561 where @var{command} and @var{arg}@dots{} are passed unmodified to the
4562 @command{guix} command of the specified revision. The @var{options} that define
4563 this revision are the same as for @command{guix pull} (@pxref{Invoking guix pull}):
4564
4565 @table @code
4566 @item --url=@var{url}
4567 @itemx --commit=@var{commit}
4568 @itemx --branch=@var{branch}
4569 Use the @code{guix} channel from the specified @var{url}, at the
4570 given @var{commit} (a valid Git commit ID represented as a hexadecimal
4571 string), or @var{branch}.
4572
4573 @item --channels=@var{file}
4574 @itemx -C @var{file}
4575 Read the list of channels from @var{file}. @var{file} must contain
4576 Scheme code that evaluates to a list of channel objects.
4577 @xref{Channels} for more information.
4578 @end table
4579
4580 As for @command{guix pull}, the absence of any options means that the
4581 latest commit on the master branch will be used. The command
4582
4583 @example
4584 guix time-machine -- build hello
4585 @end example
4586
4587 will thus build the package @code{hello} as defined in the master branch,
4588 which is in general a newer revision of Guix than you have installed.
4589 Time travel works in both directions!
4590
4591 Note that @command{guix time-machine} can trigger builds of channels and
4592 their dependencies, and these are controlled by the standard build
4593 options (@pxref{Common Build Options}).
4594
4595 @node Inferiors
4596 @section Inferiors
4597
4598 @c TODO: Remove this once we're more confident about API stability.
4599 @quotation Note
4600 The functionality described here is a ``technology preview'' as of version
4601 @value{VERSION}. As such, the interface is subject to change.
4602 @end quotation
4603
4604 @cindex inferiors
4605 @cindex composition of Guix revisions
4606 Sometimes you might need to mix packages from the revision of Guix you're
4607 currently running with packages available in a different revision of Guix.
4608 Guix @dfn{inferiors} allow you to achieve that by composing different Guix
4609 revisions in arbitrary ways.
4610
4611 @cindex inferior packages
4612 Technically, an ``inferior'' is essentially a separate Guix process connected
4613 to your main Guix process through a REPL (@pxref{Invoking guix repl}). The
4614 @code{(guix inferior)} module allows you to create inferiors and to
4615 communicate with them. It also provides a high-level interface to browse and
4616 manipulate the packages that an inferior provides---@dfn{inferior packages}.
4617
4618 When combined with channels (@pxref{Channels}), inferiors provide a simple way
4619 to interact with a separate revision of Guix. For example, let's assume you
4620 want to install in your profile the current @code{guile} package, along with
4621 the @code{guile-json} as it existed in an older revision of Guix---perhaps
4622 because the newer @code{guile-json} has an incompatible API and you want to
4623 run your code against the old API@. To do that, you could write a manifest for
4624 use by @code{guix package --manifest} (@pxref{Invoking guix package}); in that
4625 manifest, you would create an inferior for that old Guix revision you care
4626 about, and you would look up the @code{guile-json} package in the inferior:
4627
4628 @lisp
4629 (use-modules (guix inferior) (guix channels)
4630 (srfi srfi-1)) ;for 'first'
4631
4632 (define channels
4633 ;; This is the old revision from which we want to
4634 ;; extract guile-json.
4635 (list (channel
4636 (name 'guix)
4637 (url "https://git.savannah.gnu.org/git/guix.git")
4638 (commit
4639 "65956ad3526ba09e1f7a40722c96c6ef7c0936fe"))))
4640
4641 (define inferior
4642 ;; An inferior representing the above revision.
4643 (inferior-for-channels channels))
4644
4645 ;; Now create a manifest with the current "guile" package
4646 ;; and the old "guile-json" package.
4647 (packages->manifest
4648 (list (first (lookup-inferior-packages inferior "guile-json"))
4649 (specification->package "guile")))
4650 @end lisp
4651
4652 On its first run, @command{guix package --manifest} might have to build the
4653 channel you specified before it can create the inferior; subsequent runs will
4654 be much faster because the Guix revision will be cached.
4655
4656 The @code{(guix inferior)} module provides the following procedures to open an
4657 inferior:
4658
4659 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} inferior-for-channels @var{channels} @
4660 [#:cache-directory] [#:ttl]
4661 Return an inferior for @var{channels}, a list of channels. Use the cache at
4662 @var{cache-directory}, where entries can be reclaimed after @var{ttl} seconds.
4663 This procedure opens a new connection to the build daemon.
4664
4665 As a side effect, this procedure may build or substitute binaries for
4666 @var{channels}, which can take time.
4667 @end deffn
4668
4669 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} open-inferior @var{directory} @
4670 [#:command "bin/guix"]
4671 Open the inferior Guix in @var{directory}, running
4672 @code{@var{directory}/@var{command} repl} or equivalent. Return @code{#f} if
4673 the inferior could not be launched.
4674 @end deffn
4675
4676 @cindex inferior packages
4677 The procedures listed below allow you to obtain and manipulate inferior
4678 packages.
4679
4680 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} inferior-packages @var{inferior}
4681 Return the list of packages known to @var{inferior}.
4682 @end deffn
4683
4684 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} lookup-inferior-packages @var{inferior} @var{name} @
4685 [@var{version}]
4686 Return the sorted list of inferior packages matching @var{name} in
4687 @var{inferior}, with highest version numbers first. If @var{version} is true,
4688 return only packages with a version number prefixed by @var{version}.
4689 @end deffn
4690
4691 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} inferior-package? @var{obj}
4692 Return true if @var{obj} is an inferior package.
4693 @end deffn
4694
4695 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} inferior-package-name @var{package}
4696 @deffnx {Scheme Procedure} inferior-package-version @var{package}
4697 @deffnx {Scheme Procedure} inferior-package-synopsis @var{package}
4698 @deffnx {Scheme Procedure} inferior-package-description @var{package}
4699 @deffnx {Scheme Procedure} inferior-package-home-page @var{package}
4700 @deffnx {Scheme Procedure} inferior-package-location @var{package}
4701 @deffnx {Scheme Procedure} inferior-package-inputs @var{package}
4702 @deffnx {Scheme Procedure} inferior-package-native-inputs @var{package}
4703 @deffnx {Scheme Procedure} inferior-package-propagated-inputs @var{package}
4704 @deffnx {Scheme Procedure} inferior-package-transitive-propagated-inputs @var{package}
4705 @deffnx {Scheme Procedure} inferior-package-native-search-paths @var{package}
4706 @deffnx {Scheme Procedure} inferior-package-transitive-native-search-paths @var{package}
4707 @deffnx {Scheme Procedure} inferior-package-search-paths @var{package}
4708 These procedures are the counterpart of package record accessors
4709 (@pxref{package Reference}). Most of them work by querying the inferior
4710 @var{package} comes from, so the inferior must still be live when you call
4711 these procedures.
4712 @end deffn
4713
4714 Inferior packages can be used transparently like any other package or
4715 file-like object in G-expressions (@pxref{G-Expressions}). They are also
4716 transparently handled by the @code{packages->manifest} procedure, which is
4717 commonly used in manifests (@pxref{Invoking guix package, the
4718 @option{--manifest} option of @command{guix package}}). Thus you can insert
4719 an inferior package pretty much anywhere you would insert a regular package:
4720 in manifests, in the @code{packages} field of your @code{operating-system}
4721 declaration, and so on.
4722
4723 @node Invoking guix describe
4724 @section Invoking @command{guix describe}
4725
4726 @cindex reproducibility
4727 @cindex replicating Guix
4728 Often you may want to answer questions like: ``Which revision of Guix am I
4729 using?'' or ``Which channels am I using?'' This is useful information in many
4730 situations: if you want to @emph{replicate} an environment on a different
4731 machine or user account, if you want to report a bug or to determine what
4732 change in the channels you are using caused it, or if you want to record your
4733 system state for reproducibility purposes. The @command{guix describe}
4734 command answers these questions.
4735
4736 When run from a @command{guix pull}ed @command{guix}, @command{guix describe}
4737 displays the channel(s) that it was built from, including their repository URL
4738 and commit IDs (@pxref{Channels}):
4739
4740 @example
4741 $ guix describe
4742 Generation 10 Sep 03 2018 17:32:44 (current)
4743 guix e0fa68c
4744 repository URL: https://git.savannah.gnu.org/git/guix.git
4745 branch: master
4746 commit: e0fa68c7718fffd33d81af415279d6ddb518f727
4747 @end example
4748
4749 If you're familiar with the Git version control system, this is similar in
4750 spirit to @command{git describe}; the output is also similar to that of
4751 @command{guix pull --list-generations}, but limited to the current generation
4752 (@pxref{Invoking guix pull, the @option{--list-generations} option}). Because
4753 the Git commit ID shown above unambiguously refers to a snapshot of Guix, this
4754 information is all it takes to describe the revision of Guix you're using, and
4755 also to replicate it.
4756
4757 To make it easier to replicate Guix, @command{guix describe} can also be asked
4758 to return a list of channels instead of the human-readable description above:
4759
4760 @example
4761 $ guix describe -f channels
4762 (list (channel
4763 (name 'guix)
4764 (url "https://git.savannah.gnu.org/git/guix.git")
4765 (commit
4766 "e0fa68c7718fffd33d81af415279d6ddb518f727")
4767 (introduction
4768 (make-channel-introduction
4769 "9edb3f66fd807b096b48283debdcddccfea34bad"
4770 (openpgp-fingerprint
4771 "BBB0 2DDF 2CEA F6A8 0D1D E643 A2A0 6DF2 A33A 54FA")))))
4772 @end example
4773
4774 @noindent
4775 You can save this to a file and feed it to @command{guix pull -C} on some
4776 other machine or at a later point in time, which will instantiate @emph{this
4777 exact Guix revision} (@pxref{Invoking guix pull, the @option{-C} option}).
4778 From there on, since you're able to deploy the same revision of Guix, you can
4779 just as well @emph{replicate a complete software environment}. We humbly
4780 think that this is @emph{awesome}, and we hope you'll like it too!
4781
4782 The details of the options supported by @command{guix describe} are as
4783 follows:
4784
4785 @table @code
4786 @item --format=@var{format}
4787 @itemx -f @var{format}
4788 Produce output in the specified @var{format}, one of:
4789
4790 @table @code
4791 @item human
4792 produce human-readable output;
4793 @item channels
4794 produce a list of channel specifications that can be passed to @command{guix
4795 pull -C} or installed as @file{~/.config/guix/channels.scm} (@pxref{Invoking
4796 guix pull});
4797 @item channels-sans-intro
4798 like @code{channels}, but omit the @code{introduction} field; use it to
4799 produce a channel specification suitable for Guix version 1.1.0 or
4800 earlier---the @code{introduction} field has to do with channel
4801 authentication (@pxref{Channels, Channel Authentication}) and is not
4802 supported by these older versions;
4803 @item json
4804 @cindex JSON
4805 produce a list of channel specifications in JSON format;
4806 @item recutils
4807 produce a list of channel specifications in Recutils format.
4808 @end table
4809
4810 @item --list-formats
4811 Display available formats for @option{--format} option.
4812
4813 @item --profile=@var{profile}
4814 @itemx -p @var{profile}
4815 Display information about @var{profile}.
4816 @end table
4817
4818 @node Invoking guix archive
4819 @section Invoking @command{guix archive}
4820
4821 @cindex @command{guix archive}
4822 @cindex archive
4823 The @command{guix archive} command allows users to @dfn{export} files
4824 from the store into a single archive, and to later @dfn{import} them on
4825 a machine that runs Guix.
4826 In particular, it allows store files to be transferred from one machine
4827 to the store on another machine.
4828
4829 @quotation Note
4830 If you're looking for a way to produce archives in a format suitable for
4831 tools other than Guix, @pxref{Invoking guix pack}.
4832 @end quotation
4833
4834 @cindex exporting store items
4835 To export store files as an archive to standard output, run:
4836
4837 @example
4838 guix archive --export @var{options} @var{specifications}...
4839 @end example
4840
4841 @var{specifications} may be either store file names or package
4842 specifications, as for @command{guix package} (@pxref{Invoking guix
4843 package}). For instance, the following command creates an archive
4844 containing the @code{gui} output of the @code{git} package and the main
4845 output of @code{emacs}:
4846
4847 @example
4848 guix archive --export git:gui /gnu/store/...-emacs-24.3 > great.nar
4849 @end example
4850
4851 If the specified packages are not built yet, @command{guix archive}
4852 automatically builds them. The build process may be controlled with the
4853 common build options (@pxref{Common Build Options}).
4854
4855 To transfer the @code{emacs} package to a machine connected over SSH,
4856 one would run:
4857
4858 @example
4859 guix archive --export -r emacs | ssh the-machine guix archive --import
4860 @end example
4861
4862 @noindent
4863 Similarly, a complete user profile may be transferred from one machine
4864 to another like this:
4865
4866 @example
4867 guix archive --export -r $(readlink -f ~/.guix-profile) | \
4868 ssh the-machine guix archive --import
4869 @end example
4870
4871 @noindent
4872 However, note that, in both examples, all of @code{emacs} and the
4873 profile as well as all of their dependencies are transferred (due to
4874 @option{-r}), regardless of what is already available in the store on
4875 the target machine. The @option{--missing} option can help figure out
4876 which items are missing from the target store. The @command{guix copy}
4877 command simplifies and optimizes this whole process, so this is probably
4878 what you should use in this case (@pxref{Invoking guix copy}).
4879
4880 @cindex nar, archive format
4881 @cindex normalized archive (nar)
4882 @cindex nar bundle, archive format
4883 Each store item is written in the @dfn{normalized archive} or @dfn{nar}
4884 format (described below), and the output of @command{guix archive
4885 --export} (and input of @command{guix archive --import}) is a @dfn{nar
4886 bundle}.
4887
4888 The nar format is
4889 comparable in spirit to `tar', but with differences
4890 that make it more appropriate for our purposes. First, rather than
4891 recording all Unix metadata for each file, the nar format only mentions
4892 the file type (regular, directory, or symbolic link); Unix permissions
4893 and owner/group are dismissed. Second, the order in which directory
4894 entries are stored always follows the order of file names according to
4895 the C locale collation order. This makes archive production fully
4896 deterministic.
4897
4898 That nar bundle format is essentially the concatenation of zero or more
4899 nars along with metadata for each store item it contains: its file name,
4900 references, corresponding derivation, and a digital signature.
4901
4902 When exporting, the daemon digitally signs the contents of the archive,
4903 and that digital signature is appended. When importing, the daemon
4904 verifies the signature and rejects the import in case of an invalid
4905 signature or if the signing key is not authorized.
4906 @c FIXME: Add xref to daemon doc about signatures.
4907
4908 The main options are:
4909
4910 @table @code
4911 @item --export
4912 Export the specified store files or packages (see below). Write the
4913 resulting archive to the standard output.
4914
4915 Dependencies are @emph{not} included in the output, unless
4916 @option{--recursive} is passed.
4917
4918 @item -r
4919 @itemx --recursive
4920 When combined with @option{--export}, this instructs @command{guix archive}
4921 to include dependencies of the given items in the archive. Thus, the
4922 resulting archive is self-contained: it contains the closure of the
4923 exported store items.
4924
4925 @item --import
4926 Read an archive from the standard input, and import the files listed
4927 therein into the store. Abort if the archive has an invalid digital
4928 signature, or if it is signed by a public key not among the authorized
4929 keys (see @option{--authorize} below).
4930
4931 @item --missing
4932 Read a list of store file names from the standard input, one per line,
4933 and write on the standard output the subset of these files missing from
4934 the store.
4935
4936 @item --generate-key[=@var{parameters}]
4937 @cindex signing, archives
4938 Generate a new key pair for the daemon. This is a prerequisite before
4939 archives can be exported with @option{--export}. This
4940 operation is usually instantaneous but it can take time if the system's
4941 entropy pool needs to be refilled. On Guix System,
4942 @code{guix-service-type} takes care of generating this key pair the
4943 first boot.
4944
4945 The generated key pair is typically stored under @file{/etc/guix}, in
4946 @file{signing-key.pub} (public key) and @file{signing-key.sec} (private
4947 key, which must be kept secret). When @var{parameters} is omitted,
4948 an ECDSA key using the Ed25519 curve is generated, or, for Libgcrypt
4949 versions before 1.6.0, it is a 4096-bit RSA key.
4950 Alternatively, @var{parameters} can specify
4951 @code{genkey} parameters suitable for Libgcrypt (@pxref{General
4952 public-key related Functions, @code{gcry_pk_genkey},, gcrypt, The
4953 Libgcrypt Reference Manual}).
4954
4955 @item --authorize
4956 @cindex authorizing, archives
4957 Authorize imports signed by the public key passed on standard input.
4958 The public key must be in ``s-expression advanced format''---i.e., the
4959 same format as the @file{signing-key.pub} file.
4960
4961 The list of authorized keys is kept in the human-editable file
4962 @file{/etc/guix/acl}. The file contains
4963 @url{https://people.csail.mit.edu/rivest/Sexp.txt, ``advanced-format
4964 s-expressions''} and is structured as an access-control list in the
4965 @url{https://theworld.com/~cme/spki.txt, Simple Public-Key Infrastructure
4966 (SPKI)}.
4967
4968 @item --extract=@var{directory}
4969 @itemx -x @var{directory}
4970 Read a single-item archive as served by substitute servers
4971 (@pxref{Substitutes}) and extract it to @var{directory}. This is a
4972 low-level operation needed in only very narrow use cases; see below.
4973
4974 For example, the following command extracts the substitute for Emacs
4975 served by @code{@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER-1}} to @file{/tmp/emacs}:
4976
4977 @example
4978 $ wget -O - \
4979 https://@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER-1}/nar/gzip/@dots{}-emacs-24.5 \
4980 | gunzip | guix archive -x /tmp/emacs
4981 @end example
4982
4983 Single-item archives are different from multiple-item archives produced
4984 by @command{guix archive --export}; they contain a single store item,
4985 and they do @emph{not} embed a signature. Thus this operation does
4986 @emph{no} signature verification and its output should be considered
4987 unsafe.
4988
4989 The primary purpose of this operation is to facilitate inspection of
4990 archive contents coming from possibly untrusted substitute servers
4991 (@pxref{Invoking guix challenge}).
4992
4993 @item --list
4994 @itemx -t
4995 Read a single-item archive as served by substitute servers
4996 (@pxref{Substitutes}) and print the list of files it contains, as in
4997 this example:
4998
4999 @example
5000 $ wget -O - \
5001 https://@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER-1}/nar/lzip/@dots{}-emacs-26.3 \
5002 | lzip -d | guix archive -t
5003 @end example
5004
5005 @end table
5006
5007 @c *********************************************************************
5008 @node Channels
5009 @chapter Channels
5010
5011 @cindex channels
5012 @cindex @file{channels.scm}, configuration file
5013 @cindex configuration file for channels
5014 @cindex @command{guix pull}, configuration file
5015 @cindex configuration of @command{guix pull}
5016 Guix and its package collection are updated by running @command{guix pull}
5017 (@pxref{Invoking guix pull}). By default @command{guix pull} downloads and
5018 deploys Guix itself from the official GNU@tie{}Guix repository. This can be
5019 customized by defining @dfn{channels} in the
5020 @file{~/.config/guix/channels.scm} file. A channel specifies a URL and branch
5021 of a Git repository to be deployed, and @command{guix pull} can be instructed
5022 to pull from one or more channels. In other words, channels can be used
5023 to @emph{customize} and to @emph{extend} Guix, as we will see below.
5024 Guix is able to take into account security concerns and deal with authenticated
5025 updates.
5026
5027 @menu
5028 * Specifying Additional Channels:: Extending the package collection.
5029 * Using a Custom Guix Channel:: Using a customized Guix.
5030 * Replicating Guix:: Running the @emph{exact same} Guix.
5031 * Channel Authentication:: How Guix verifies what it fetches.
5032 * Channels with Substitutes:: Using channels with available substitutes.
5033 * Creating a Channel:: How to write your custom channel.
5034 * Package Modules in a Sub-directory:: Specifying the channel's package modules location.
5035 * Declaring Channel Dependencies:: How to depend on other channels.
5036 * Specifying Channel Authorizations:: Defining channel authors authorizations.
5037 * Primary URL:: Distinguishing mirror to original.
5038 * Writing Channel News:: Communicating information to channel's users.
5039 @end menu
5040
5041 @node Specifying Additional Channels
5042 @section Specifying Additional Channels
5043
5044 @cindex extending the package collection (channels)
5045 @cindex variant packages (channels)
5046 You can specify @emph{additional channels} to pull from. To use a channel, write
5047 @code{~/.config/guix/channels.scm} to instruct @command{guix pull} to pull from it
5048 @emph{in addition} to the default Guix channel(s):
5049
5050 @vindex %default-channels
5051 @lisp
5052 ;; Add variant packages to those Guix provides.
5053 (cons (channel
5054 (name 'variant-packages)
5055 (url "https://example.org/variant-packages.git"))
5056 %default-channels)
5057 @end lisp
5058
5059 @noindent
5060 Note that the snippet above is (as always!)@: Scheme code; we use @code{cons} to
5061 add a channel the list of channels that the variable @code{%default-channels}
5062 is bound to (@pxref{Pairs, @code{cons} and lists,, guile, GNU Guile Reference
5063 Manual}). With this file in place, @command{guix pull} builds not only Guix
5064 but also the package modules from your own repository. The result in
5065 @file{~/.config/guix/current} is the union of Guix with your own package
5066 modules:
5067
5068 @example
5069 $ guix pull --list-generations
5070 @dots{}
5071 Generation 19 Aug 27 2018 16:20:48
5072 guix d894ab8
5073 repository URL: https://git.savannah.gnu.org/git/guix.git
5074 branch: master
5075 commit: d894ab8e9bfabcefa6c49d9ba2e834dd5a73a300
5076 variant-packages dd3df5e
5077 repository URL: https://example.org/variant-packages.git
5078 branch: master
5079 commit: dd3df5e2c8818760a8fc0bd699e55d3b69fef2bb
5080 11 new packages: variant-gimp, variant-emacs-with-cool-features, @dots{}
5081 4 packages upgraded: emacs-racket-mode@@0.0.2-2.1b78827, @dots{}
5082 @end example
5083
5084 @noindent
5085 The output of @command{guix pull} above shows that Generation@tie{}19 includes
5086 both Guix and packages from the @code{variant-personal-packages} channel. Among
5087 the new and upgraded packages that are listed, some like @code{variant-gimp} and
5088 @code{variant-emacs-with-cool-features} might come from
5089 @code{variant-packages}, while others come from the Guix default channel.
5090
5091 @node Using a Custom Guix Channel
5092 @section Using a Custom Guix Channel
5093
5094 The channel called @code{guix} specifies where Guix itself---its command-line
5095 tools as well as its package collection---should be downloaded. For instance,
5096 suppose you want to update from another copy of the Guix repository at
5097 @code{example.org}, and specifically the @code{super-hacks} branch, you can
5098 write in @code{~/.config/guix/channels.scm} this specification:
5099
5100 @lisp
5101 ;; Tell 'guix pull' to use another repo.
5102 (list (channel
5103 (name 'guix)
5104 (url "https://example.org/another-guix.git")
5105 (branch "super-hacks")))
5106 @end lisp
5107
5108 @noindent
5109 From there on, @command{guix pull} will fetch code from the @code{super-hacks}
5110 branch of the repository at @code{example.org}. The authentication concern is
5111 addressed below ((@pxref{Channel Authentication}).
5112
5113 @node Replicating Guix
5114 @section Replicating Guix
5115
5116 @cindex pinning, channels
5117 @cindex replicating Guix
5118 @cindex reproducibility, of Guix
5119 The @command{guix pull --list-generations} output above shows precisely which
5120 commits were used to build this instance of Guix. We can thus replicate it,
5121 say, on another machine, by providing a channel specification in
5122 @file{~/.config/guix/channels.scm} that is ``pinned'' to these commits:
5123
5124 @lisp
5125 ;; Deploy specific commits of my channels of interest.
5126 (list (channel
5127 (name 'guix)
5128 (url "https://git.savannah.gnu.org/git/guix.git")
5129 (commit "6298c3ffd9654d3231a6f25390b056483e8f407c"))
5130 (channel
5131 (name 'variant-packages)
5132 (url "https://example.org/variant-packages.git")
5133 (commit "dd3df5e2c8818760a8fc0bd699e55d3b69fef2bb")))
5134 @end lisp
5135
5136 The @command{guix describe --format=channels} command can even generate this
5137 list of channels directly (@pxref{Invoking guix describe}). The resulting
5138 file can be used with the -C options of @command{guix pull}
5139 (@pxref{Invoking guix pull}) or @command{guix time-machine}
5140 (@pxref{Invoking guix time-machine}).
5141
5142 At this point the two machines run the @emph{exact same Guix}, with access to
5143 the @emph{exact same packages}. The output of @command{guix build gimp} on
5144 one machine will be exactly the same, bit for bit, as the output of the same
5145 command on the other machine. It also means both machines have access to all
5146 the source code of Guix and, transitively, to all the source code of every
5147 package it defines.
5148
5149 This gives you super powers, allowing you to track the provenance of binary
5150 artifacts with very fine grain, and to reproduce software environments at
5151 will---some sort of ``meta reproducibility'' capabilities, if you will.
5152 @xref{Inferiors}, for another way to take advantage of these super powers.
5153
5154 @node Channel Authentication
5155 @section Channel Authentication
5156
5157 @anchor{channel-authentication}
5158 @cindex authentication, of channel code
5159 The @command{guix pull} and @command{guix time-machine} commands
5160 @dfn{authenticate} the code retrieved from channels: they make sure each
5161 commit that is fetched is signed by an authorized developer. The goal
5162 is to protect from unauthorized modifications to the channel that would
5163 lead users to run malicious code.
5164
5165 As a user, you must provide a @dfn{channel introduction} in your
5166 channels file so that Guix knows how to authenticate its first commit.
5167 A channel specification, including its introduction, looks something
5168 along these lines:
5169
5170 @lisp
5171 (channel
5172 (name 'some-channel)
5173 (url "https://example.org/some-channel.git")
5174 (introduction
5175 (make-channel-introduction
5176 "6f0d8cc0d88abb59c324b2990bfee2876016bb86"
5177 (openpgp-fingerprint
5178 "CABB A931 C0FF EEC6 900D 0CFB 090B 1199 3D9A EBB5"))))
5179 @end lisp
5180
5181 The specification above shows the name and URL of the channel. The call
5182 to @code{make-channel-introduction} above specifies that authentication
5183 of this channel starts at commit @code{6f0d8cc@dots{}}, which is signed
5184 by the OpenPGP key with fingerprint @code{CABB A931@dots{}}.
5185
5186 For the main channel, called @code{guix}, you automatically get that
5187 information from your Guix installation. For other channels, include
5188 the channel introduction provided by the channel authors in your
5189 @file{channels.scm} file. Make sure you retrieve the channel
5190 introduction from a trusted source since that is the root of your trust.
5191
5192 If you're curious about the authentication mechanics, read on!
5193
5194 @node Channels with Substitutes
5195 @section Channels with Substitutes
5196
5197 When running @command{guix pull}, Guix will first compile the
5198 definitions of every available package. This is an expensive operation
5199 for which substitutes (@pxref{Substitutes}) may be available. The
5200 following snippet in @file{channels.scm} will ensure that @command{guix
5201 pull} uses the latest commit with available substitutes for the package
5202 definitions: this is done by querying the continuous integration
5203 server at @url{https://ci.guix.gnu.org}.
5204
5205 @lisp
5206 (use-modules (guix ci))
5207
5208 (list (channel-with-substitutes-available
5209 %default-guix-channel
5210 "https://ci.guix.gnu.org"))
5211 @end lisp
5212
5213 Note that this does not mean that all the packages that you will
5214 install after running @command{guix pull} will have available
5215 substitutes. It only ensures that @command{guix pull} will not try to
5216 compile package definitions. This is particularly useful when using
5217 machines with limited resources.
5218
5219 @node Creating a Channel
5220 @section Creating a Channel
5221
5222 @cindex personal packages (channels)
5223 @cindex channels, for personal packages
5224 Let's say you have a bunch of custom package variants or personal packages
5225 that you think would make little sense to contribute to the Guix project, but
5226 would like to have these packages transparently available to you at the
5227 command line. You would first write modules containing those package
5228 definitions (@pxref{Package Modules}), maintain them in a Git repository, and
5229 then you and anyone else can use it as an additional channel to get packages
5230 from. Neat, no?
5231
5232 @c What follows stems from discussions at
5233 @c <https://debbugs.gnu.org/cgi/bugreport.cgi?bug=22629#134> as well as
5234 @c earlier discussions on guix-devel@gnu.org.
5235 @quotation Warning
5236 Before you, dear user, shout---``woow this is @emph{soooo coool}!''---and
5237 publish your personal channel to the world, we would like to share a few words
5238 of caution:
5239
5240 @itemize
5241 @item
5242 Before publishing a channel, please consider contributing your package
5243 definitions to Guix proper (@pxref{Contributing}). Guix as a project is open
5244 to free software of all sorts, and packages in Guix proper are readily
5245 available to all Guix users and benefit from the project's quality assurance
5246 process.
5247
5248 @item
5249 When you maintain package definitions outside Guix, we, Guix developers,
5250 consider that @emph{the compatibility burden is on you}. Remember that
5251 package modules and package definitions are just Scheme code that uses various
5252 programming interfaces (APIs). We want to remain free to change these APIs to
5253 keep improving Guix, possibly in ways that break your channel. We never
5254 change APIs gratuitously, but we will @emph{not} commit to freezing APIs
5255 either.
5256
5257 @item
5258 Corollary: if you're using an external channel and that channel breaks, please
5259 @emph{report the issue to the channel authors}, not to the Guix project.
5260 @end itemize
5261
5262 You've been warned! Having said this, we believe external channels are a
5263 practical way to exert your freedom to augment Guix' package collection and to
5264 share your improvements, which are basic tenets of
5265 @uref{https://www.gnu.org/philosophy/free-sw.html, free software}. Please
5266 email us at @email{guix-devel@@gnu.org} if you'd like to discuss this.
5267 @end quotation
5268
5269 To create a channel, create a Git repository containing your own package
5270 modules and make it available. The repository can contain anything, but a
5271 useful channel will contain Guile modules that export packages. Once you
5272 start using a channel, Guix will behave as if the root directory of that
5273 channel's Git repository has been added to the Guile load path (@pxref{Load
5274 Paths,,, guile, GNU Guile Reference Manual}). For example, if your channel
5275 contains a file at @file{my-packages/my-tools.scm} that defines a Guile
5276 module, then the module will be available under the name @code{(my-packages
5277 my-tools)}, and you will be able to use it like any other module
5278 (@pxref{Modules,,, guile, GNU Guile Reference Manual}).
5279
5280 As a channel author, consider bundling authentication material with your
5281 channel so that users can authenticate it. @xref{Channel
5282 Authentication}, and @ref{Specifying Channel Authorizations}, for info
5283 on how to do it.
5284
5285
5286 @node Package Modules in a Sub-directory
5287 @section Package Modules in a Sub-directory
5288
5289 @cindex subdirectory, channels
5290 As a channel author, you may want to keep your channel modules in a
5291 sub-directory. If your modules are in the sub-directory @file{guix}, you must
5292 add a meta-data file @file{.guix-channel} that contains:
5293
5294 @lisp
5295 (channel
5296 (version 0)
5297 (directory "guix"))
5298 @end lisp
5299
5300 @node Declaring Channel Dependencies
5301 @section Declaring Channel Dependencies
5302
5303 @cindex dependencies, channels
5304 @cindex meta-data, channels
5305 Channel authors may decide to augment a package collection provided by other
5306 channels. They can declare their channel to be dependent on other channels in
5307 a meta-data file @file{.guix-channel}, which is to be placed in the root of
5308 the channel repository.
5309
5310 The meta-data file should contain a simple S-expression like this:
5311
5312 @lisp
5313 (channel
5314 (version 0)
5315 (dependencies
5316 (channel
5317 (name some-collection)
5318 (url "https://example.org/first-collection.git")
5319
5320 ;; The 'introduction' bit below is optional: you would
5321 ;; provide it for dependencies that can be authenticated.
5322 (introduction
5323 (channel-introduction
5324 (version 0)
5325 (commit "a8883b58dc82e167c96506cf05095f37c2c2c6cd")
5326 (signer "CABB A931 C0FF EEC6 900D 0CFB 090B 1199 3D9A EBB5"))))
5327 (channel
5328 (name some-other-collection)
5329 (url "https://example.org/second-collection.git")
5330 (branch "testing"))))
5331 @end lisp
5332
5333 In the above example this channel is declared to depend on two other channels,
5334 which will both be fetched automatically. The modules provided by the channel
5335 will be compiled in an environment where the modules of all these declared
5336 channels are available.
5337
5338 For the sake of reliability and maintainability, you should avoid dependencies
5339 on channels that you don't control, and you should aim to keep the number of
5340 dependencies to a minimum.
5341
5342 @node Specifying Channel Authorizations
5343 @section Specifying Channel Authorizations
5344
5345 @cindex channel authorizations
5346 @anchor{channel-authorizations}
5347 As we saw above, Guix ensures the source code it pulls from channels
5348 comes from authorized developers. As a channel author, you need to
5349 specify the list of authorized developers in the
5350 @file{.guix-authorizations} file in the channel's Git repository. The
5351 authentication rule is simple: each commit must be signed by a key
5352 listed in the @file{.guix-authorizations} file of its parent
5353 commit(s)@footnote{Git commits form a @dfn{directed acyclic graph}
5354 (DAG). Each commit can have zero or more parents; ``regular'' commits
5355 have one parent and merge commits have two parent commits. Read
5356 @uref{https://eagain.net/articles/git-for-computer-scientists/, @i{Git
5357 for Computer Scientists}} for a great overview.} The
5358 @file{.guix-authorizations} file looks like this:
5359
5360 @lisp
5361 ;; Example '.guix-authorizations' file.
5362
5363 (authorizations
5364 (version 0) ;current file format version
5365
5366 (("AD17 A21E F8AE D8F1 CC02 DBD9 F8AE D8F1 765C 61E3"
5367 (name "alice"))
5368 ("2A39 3FFF 68F4 EF7A 3D29 12AF 68F4 EF7A 22FB B2D5"
5369 (name "bob"))
5370 ("CABB A931 C0FF EEC6 900D 0CFB 090B 1199 3D9A EBB5"
5371 (name "charlie"))))
5372 @end lisp
5373
5374 Each fingerprint is followed by optional key/value pairs, as in the
5375 example above. Currently these key/value pairs are ignored.
5376
5377 This authentication rule creates a chicken-and-egg issue: how do we
5378 authenticate the first commit? Related to that: how do we deal with
5379 channels whose repository history contains unsigned commits and lack
5380 @file{.guix-authorizations}? And how do we fork existing channels?
5381
5382 @cindex channel introduction
5383 Channel introductions answer these questions by describing the first
5384 commit of a channel that should be authenticated. The first time a
5385 channel is fetched with @command{guix pull} or @command{guix
5386 time-machine}, the command looks up the introductory commit and verifies
5387 that it is signed by the specified OpenPGP key. From then on, it
5388 authenticates commits according to the rule above.
5389
5390 Additionally, your channel must provide all the OpenPGP keys that were
5391 ever mentioned in @file{.guix-authorizations}, stored as @file{.key}
5392 files, which can be either binary or ``ASCII-armored''. By default,
5393 those @file{.key} files are searched for in the branch named
5394 @code{keyring} but you can specify a different branch name in
5395 @code{.guix-channel} like so:
5396
5397 @lisp
5398 (channel
5399 (version 0)
5400 (keyring-reference "my-keyring-branch"))
5401 @end lisp
5402
5403 To summarize, as the author of a channel, there are three things you have
5404 to do to allow users to authenticate your code:
5405
5406 @enumerate
5407 @item
5408 Export the OpenPGP keys of past and present committers with @command{gpg
5409 --export} and store them in @file{.key} files, by default in a branch
5410 named @code{keyring} (we recommend making it an @dfn{orphan branch}).
5411
5412 @item
5413 Introduce an initial @file{.guix-authorizations} in the channel's
5414 repository. Do that in a signed commit (@pxref{Commit Access}, for
5415 information on how to sign Git commits.)
5416
5417 @item
5418 Advertise the channel introduction, for instance on your channel's web
5419 page. The channel introduction, as we saw above, is the commit/key
5420 pair---i.e., the commit that introduced @file{.guix-authorizations}, and
5421 the fingerprint of the OpenPGP used to sign it.
5422 @end enumerate
5423
5424 Before pushing to your public Git repository, you can run @command{guix
5425 git-authenticate} to verify that you did sign all the commits you are
5426 about to push with an authorized key:
5427
5428 @example
5429 guix git authenticate @var{commit} @var{signer}
5430 @end example
5431
5432 @noindent
5433 where @var{commit} and @var{signer} are your channel introduction.
5434 @xref{Invoking guix git authenticate}, for details.
5435
5436 Publishing a signed channel requires discipline: any mistake, such as an
5437 unsigned commit or a commit signed by an unauthorized key, will prevent
5438 users from pulling from your channel---well, that's the whole point of
5439 authentication! Pay attention to merges in particular: merge commits
5440 are considered authentic if and only if they are signed by a key present
5441 in the @file{.guix-authorizations} file of @emph{both} branches.
5442
5443 @node Primary URL
5444 @section Primary URL
5445
5446 @cindex primary URL, channels
5447 Channel authors can indicate the primary URL of their channel's Git
5448 repository in the @file{.guix-channel} file, like so:
5449
5450 @lisp
5451 (channel
5452 (version 0)
5453 (url "https://example.org/guix.git"))
5454 @end lisp
5455
5456 This allows @command{guix pull} to determine whether it is pulling code
5457 from a mirror of the channel; when that is the case, it warns the user
5458 that the mirror might be stale and displays the primary URL@. That way,
5459 users cannot be tricked into fetching code from a stale mirror that does
5460 not receive security updates.
5461
5462 This feature only makes sense for authenticated repositories, such as
5463 the official @code{guix} channel, for which @command{guix pull} ensures
5464 the code it fetches is authentic.
5465
5466 @node Writing Channel News
5467 @section Writing Channel News
5468
5469 @cindex news, for channels
5470 Channel authors may occasionally want to communicate to their users
5471 information about important changes in the channel. You'd send them all
5472 an email, but that's not convenient.
5473
5474 Instead, channels can provide a @dfn{news file}; when the channel users
5475 run @command{guix pull}, that news file is automatically read and
5476 @command{guix pull --news} can display the announcements that correspond
5477 to the new commits that have been pulled, if any.
5478
5479 To do that, channel authors must first declare the name of the news file
5480 in their @file{.guix-channel} file:
5481
5482 @lisp
5483 (channel
5484 (version 0)
5485 (news-file "etc/news.txt"))
5486 @end lisp
5487
5488 The news file itself, @file{etc/news.txt} in this example, must look
5489 something like this:
5490
5491 @lisp
5492 (channel-news
5493 (version 0)
5494 (entry (tag "the-bug-fix")
5495 (title (en "Fixed terrible bug")
5496 (fr "Oh la la"))
5497 (body (en "@@emph@{Good news@}! It's fixed!")
5498 (eo "Certe ĝi pli bone funkcias nun!")))
5499 (entry (commit "bdcabe815cd28144a2d2b4bc3c5057b051fa9906")
5500 (title (en "Added a great package")
5501 (ca "Què vol dir guix?"))
5502 (body (en "Don't miss the @@code@{hello@} package!"))))
5503 @end lisp
5504
5505 While the news file is using the Scheme syntax, avoid naming it with a
5506 @file{.scm} extension or else it will get picked up when building the
5507 channel and yield an error since it is not a valid module.
5508 Alternatively, you can move the channel module to a subdirectory and
5509 store the news file in another directory.
5510
5511 The file consists of a list of @dfn{news entries}. Each entry is
5512 associated with a commit or tag: it describes changes made in this
5513 commit, possibly in preceding commits as well. Users see entries only
5514 the first time they obtain the commit the entry refers to.
5515
5516 The @code{title} field should be a one-line summary while @code{body}
5517 can be arbitrarily long, and both can contain Texinfo markup
5518 (@pxref{Overview,,, texinfo, GNU Texinfo}). Both the title and body are
5519 a list of language tag/message tuples, which allows @command{guix pull}
5520 to display news in the language that corresponds to the user's locale.
5521
5522 If you want to translate news using a gettext-based workflow, you can
5523 extract translatable strings with @command{xgettext} (@pxref{xgettext
5524 Invocation,,, gettext, GNU Gettext Utilities}). For example, assuming
5525 you write news entries in English first, the command below creates a PO
5526 file containing the strings to translate:
5527
5528 @example
5529 xgettext -o news.po -l scheme -ken etc/news.txt
5530 @end example
5531
5532 To sum up, yes, you could use your channel as a blog. But beware, this
5533 is @emph{not quite} what your users might expect.
5534
5535 @c *********************************************************************
5536 @node Development
5537 @chapter Development
5538
5539 @cindex software development
5540 If you are a software developer, Guix provides tools that you should find
5541 helpful---independently of the language you're developing in. This is what
5542 this chapter is about.
5543
5544 The @command{guix environment} command provides a convenient way to set up
5545 @dfn{development environments} containing all the dependencies and tools
5546 necessary to work on the software package of your choice. The @command{guix
5547 pack} command allows you to create @dfn{application bundles} that can be
5548 easily distributed to users who do not run Guix.
5549
5550 @menu
5551 * Invoking guix environment:: Setting up development environments.
5552 * Invoking guix pack:: Creating software bundles.
5553 * The GCC toolchain:: Working with languages supported by GCC.
5554 * Invoking guix git authenticate:: Authenticating Git repositories.
5555 @end menu
5556
5557 @node Invoking guix environment
5558 @section Invoking @command{guix environment}
5559
5560 @cindex reproducible build environments
5561 @cindex development environments
5562 @cindex @command{guix environment}
5563 @cindex environment, package build environment
5564 The purpose of @command{guix environment} is to assist hackers in
5565 creating reproducible development environments without polluting their
5566 package profile. The @command{guix environment} tool takes one or more
5567 packages, builds all of their inputs, and creates a shell
5568 environment to use them.
5569
5570 The general syntax is:
5571
5572 @example
5573 guix environment @var{options} @var{package}@dots{}
5574 @end example
5575
5576 The following example spawns a new shell set up for the development of
5577 GNU@tie{}Guile:
5578
5579 @example
5580 guix environment guile
5581 @end example
5582
5583 If the needed dependencies are not built yet, @command{guix environment}
5584 automatically builds them. The environment of the new shell is an
5585 augmented version of the environment that @command{guix environment} was
5586 run in. It contains the necessary search paths for building the given
5587 package added to the existing environment variables. To create
5588 a ``pure'' environment, in which the original environment variables have
5589 been unset, use the @option{--pure} option@footnote{Users sometimes
5590 wrongfully augment environment variables such as @env{PATH} in their
5591 @file{~/.bashrc} file. As a consequence, when @command{guix
5592 environment} launches it, Bash may read @file{~/.bashrc}, thereby
5593 introducing ``impurities'' in these environment variables. It is an
5594 error to define such environment variables in @file{.bashrc}; instead,
5595 they should be defined in @file{.bash_profile}, which is sourced only by
5596 log-in shells. @xref{Bash Startup Files,,, bash, The GNU Bash Reference
5597 Manual}, for details on Bash start-up files.}.
5598
5599 Exiting from a Guix environment is the same as exiting from the shell,
5600 and will place the user back in the old environment before @command{guix
5601 environment} was invoked. The next garbage collection (@pxref{Invoking
5602 guix gc}) will clean up packages that were installed from within the
5603 environment and are no longer used outside of it.
5604
5605 @vindex GUIX_ENVIRONMENT
5606 @command{guix environment} defines the @env{GUIX_ENVIRONMENT}
5607 variable in the shell it spawns; its value is the file name of the
5608 profile of this environment. This allows users to, say, define a
5609 specific prompt for development environments in their @file{.bashrc}
5610 (@pxref{Bash Startup Files,,, bash, The GNU Bash Reference Manual}):
5611
5612 @example
5613 if [ -n "$GUIX_ENVIRONMENT" ]
5614 then
5615 export PS1="\u@@\h \w [dev]\$ "
5616 fi
5617 @end example
5618
5619 @noindent
5620 ...@: or to browse the profile:
5621
5622 @example
5623 $ ls "$GUIX_ENVIRONMENT/bin"
5624 @end example
5625
5626 Additionally, more than one package may be specified, in which case the
5627 union of the inputs for the given packages are used. For example, the
5628 command below spawns a shell where all of the dependencies of both Guile
5629 and Emacs are available:
5630
5631 @example
5632 guix environment guile emacs
5633 @end example
5634
5635 Sometimes an interactive shell session is not desired. An arbitrary
5636 command may be invoked by placing the @code{--} token to separate the
5637 command from the rest of the arguments:
5638
5639 @example
5640 guix environment guile -- make -j4
5641 @end example
5642
5643 In other situations, it is more convenient to specify the list of
5644 packages needed in the environment. For example, the following command
5645 runs @command{python} from an environment containing Python@tie{}2.7 and
5646 NumPy:
5647
5648 @example
5649 guix environment --ad-hoc python2-numpy python-2.7 -- python
5650 @end example
5651
5652 Furthermore, one might want the dependencies of a package and also some
5653 additional packages that are not build-time or runtime dependencies, but
5654 are useful when developing nonetheless. Because of this, the
5655 @option{--ad-hoc} flag is positional. Packages appearing before
5656 @option{--ad-hoc} are interpreted as packages whose dependencies will be
5657 added to the environment. Packages appearing after are interpreted as
5658 packages that will be added to the environment directly. For example,
5659 the following command creates a Guix development environment that
5660 additionally includes Git and strace:
5661
5662 @example
5663 guix environment --pure guix --ad-hoc git strace
5664 @end example
5665
5666 @cindex container
5667 Sometimes it is desirable to isolate the environment as much as
5668 possible, for maximal purity and reproducibility. In particular, when
5669 using Guix on a host distro that is not Guix System, it is desirable to
5670 prevent access to @file{/usr/bin} and other system-wide resources from
5671 the development environment. For example, the following command spawns
5672 a Guile REPL in a ``container'' where only the store and the current
5673 working directory are mounted:
5674
5675 @example
5676 guix environment --ad-hoc --container guile -- guile
5677 @end example
5678
5679 @quotation Note
5680 The @option{--container} option requires Linux-libre 3.19 or newer.
5681 @end quotation
5682
5683 @cindex certificates
5684 Another typical use case for containers is to run security-sensitive
5685 applications such as a web browser. To run Eolie, we must expose and
5686 share some files and directories; we include @code{nss-certs} and expose
5687 @file{/etc/ssl/certs/} for HTTPS authentication; finally we preserve the
5688 @env{DISPLAY} environment variable since containerized graphical
5689 applications won't display without it.
5690
5691 @example
5692 guix environment --preserve='^DISPLAY$' --container --network \
5693 --expose=/etc/machine-id \
5694 --expose=/etc/ssl/certs/ \
5695 --share=$HOME/.local/share/eolie/=$HOME/.local/share/eolie/ \
5696 --ad-hoc eolie nss-certs dbus -- eolie
5697 @end example
5698
5699 The available options are summarized below.
5700
5701 @table @code
5702 @item --root=@var{file}
5703 @itemx -r @var{file}
5704 @cindex persistent environment
5705 @cindex garbage collector root, for environments
5706 Make @var{file} a symlink to the profile for this environment, and
5707 register it as a garbage collector root.
5708
5709 This is useful if you want to protect your environment from garbage
5710 collection, to make it ``persistent''.
5711
5712 When this option is omitted, the environment is protected from garbage
5713 collection only for the duration of the @command{guix environment}
5714 session. This means that next time you recreate the same environment,
5715 you could have to rebuild or re-download packages. @xref{Invoking guix
5716 gc}, for more on GC roots.
5717
5718 @item --expression=@var{expr}
5719 @itemx -e @var{expr}
5720 Create an environment for the package or list of packages that
5721 @var{expr} evaluates to.
5722
5723 For example, running:
5724
5725 @example
5726 guix environment -e '(@@ (gnu packages maths) petsc-openmpi)'
5727 @end example
5728
5729 starts a shell with the environment for this specific variant of the
5730 PETSc package.
5731
5732 Running:
5733
5734 @example
5735 guix environment --ad-hoc -e '(@@ (gnu) %base-packages)'
5736 @end example
5737
5738 starts a shell with all the base system packages available.
5739
5740 The above commands only use the default output of the given packages.
5741 To select other outputs, two element tuples can be specified:
5742
5743 @example
5744 guix environment --ad-hoc -e '(list (@@ (gnu packages bash) bash) "include")'
5745 @end example
5746
5747 @item --load=@var{file}
5748 @itemx -l @var{file}
5749 Create an environment for the package or list of packages that the code
5750 within @var{file} evaluates to.
5751
5752 As an example, @var{file} might contain a definition like this
5753 (@pxref{Defining Packages}):
5754
5755 @lisp
5756 @verbatiminclude environment-gdb.scm
5757 @end lisp
5758
5759 @item --manifest=@var{file}
5760 @itemx -m @var{file}
5761 Create an environment for the packages contained in the manifest object
5762 returned by the Scheme code in @var{file}. This option can be repeated
5763 several times, in which case the manifests are concatenated.
5764
5765 This is similar to the same-named option in @command{guix package}
5766 (@pxref{profile-manifest, @option{--manifest}}) and uses the same
5767 manifest files.
5768
5769 @item --ad-hoc
5770 Include all specified packages in the resulting environment, as if an
5771 @i{ad hoc} package were defined with them as inputs. This option is
5772 useful for quickly creating an environment without having to write a
5773 package expression to contain the desired inputs.
5774
5775 For instance, the command:
5776
5777 @example
5778 guix environment --ad-hoc guile guile-sdl -- guile
5779 @end example
5780
5781 runs @command{guile} in an environment where Guile and Guile-SDL are
5782 available.
5783
5784 Note that this example implicitly asks for the default output of
5785 @code{guile} and @code{guile-sdl}, but it is possible to ask for a
5786 specific output---e.g., @code{glib:bin} asks for the @code{bin} output
5787 of @code{glib} (@pxref{Packages with Multiple Outputs}).
5788
5789 This option may be composed with the default behavior of @command{guix
5790 environment}. Packages appearing before @option{--ad-hoc} are
5791 interpreted as packages whose dependencies will be added to the
5792 environment, the default behavior. Packages appearing after are
5793 interpreted as packages that will be added to the environment directly.
5794
5795 @item --pure
5796 Unset existing environment variables when building the new environment, except
5797 those specified with @option{--preserve} (see below). This has the effect of
5798 creating an environment in which search paths only contain package inputs.
5799
5800 @item --preserve=@var{regexp}
5801 @itemx -E @var{regexp}
5802 When used alongside @option{--pure}, preserve the environment variables
5803 matching @var{regexp}---in other words, put them on a ``white list'' of
5804 environment variables that must be preserved. This option can be repeated
5805 several times.
5806
5807 @example
5808 guix environment --pure --preserve=^SLURM --ad-hoc openmpi @dots{} \
5809 -- mpirun @dots{}
5810 @end example
5811
5812 This example runs @command{mpirun} in a context where the only environment
5813 variables defined are @env{PATH}, environment variables whose name starts
5814 with @samp{SLURM}, as well as the usual ``precious'' variables (@env{HOME},
5815 @env{USER}, etc.).
5816
5817 @item --search-paths
5818 Display the environment variable definitions that make up the
5819 environment.
5820
5821 @item --system=@var{system}
5822 @itemx -s @var{system}
5823 Attempt to build for @var{system}---e.g., @code{i686-linux}.
5824
5825 @item --container
5826 @itemx -C
5827 @cindex container
5828 Run @var{command} within an isolated container. The current working
5829 directory outside the container is mapped inside the container.
5830 Additionally, unless overridden with @option{--user}, a dummy home
5831 directory is created that matches the current user's home directory, and
5832 @file{/etc/passwd} is configured accordingly.
5833
5834 The spawned process runs as the current user outside the container. Inside
5835 the container, it has the same UID and GID as the current user, unless
5836 @option{--user} is passed (see below).
5837
5838 @item --network
5839 @itemx -N
5840 For containers, share the network namespace with the host system.
5841 Containers created without this flag only have access to the loopback
5842 device.
5843
5844 @item --link-profile
5845 @itemx -P
5846 For containers, link the environment profile to @file{~/.guix-profile}
5847 within the container and set @code{GUIX_ENVIRONMENT} to that.
5848 This is equivalent to making @file{~/.guix-profile} a symlink to the
5849 actual profile within the container.
5850 Linking will fail and abort the environment if the directory already
5851 exists, which will certainly be the case if @command{guix environment}
5852 was invoked in the user's home directory.
5853
5854 Certain packages are configured to look in @file{~/.guix-profile} for
5855 configuration files and data;@footnote{For example, the
5856 @code{fontconfig} package inspects @file{~/.guix-profile/share/fonts}
5857 for additional fonts.} @option{--link-profile} allows these programs to
5858 behave as expected within the environment.
5859
5860 @item --user=@var{user}
5861 @itemx -u @var{user}
5862 For containers, use the username @var{user} in place of the current
5863 user. The generated @file{/etc/passwd} entry within the container will
5864 contain the name @var{user}, the home directory will be
5865 @file{/home/@var{user}}, and no user GECOS data will be copied. Furthermore,
5866 the UID and GID inside the container are 1000. @var{user}
5867 need not exist on the system.
5868
5869 Additionally, any shared or exposed path (see @option{--share} and
5870 @option{--expose} respectively) whose target is within the current user's
5871 home directory will be remapped relative to @file{/home/USER}; this
5872 includes the automatic mapping of the current working directory.
5873
5874 @example
5875 # will expose paths as /home/foo/wd, /home/foo/test, and /home/foo/target
5876 cd $HOME/wd
5877 guix environment --container --user=foo \
5878 --expose=$HOME/test \
5879 --expose=/tmp/target=$HOME/target
5880 @end example
5881
5882 While this will limit the leaking of user identity through home paths
5883 and each of the user fields, this is only one useful component of a
5884 broader privacy/anonymity solution---not one in and of itself.
5885
5886 @item --no-cwd
5887 For containers, the default behavior is to share the current working
5888 directory with the isolated container and immediately change to that
5889 directory within the container. If this is undesirable,
5890 @option{--no-cwd} will cause the current working directory to @emph{not}
5891 be automatically shared and will change to the user's home directory
5892 within the container instead. See also @option{--user}.
5893
5894 @item --expose=@var{source}[=@var{target}]
5895 @itemx --share=@var{source}[=@var{target}]
5896 For containers, @option{--expose} (resp. @option{--share}) exposes the
5897 file system @var{source} from the host system as the read-only
5898 (resp. writable) file system @var{target} within the container. If
5899 @var{target} is not specified, @var{source} is used as the target mount
5900 point in the container.
5901
5902 The example below spawns a Guile REPL in a container in which the user's
5903 home directory is accessible read-only via the @file{/exchange}
5904 directory:
5905
5906 @example
5907 guix environment --container --expose=$HOME=/exchange --ad-hoc guile -- guile
5908 @end example
5909
5910 @end table
5911
5912 @command{guix environment}
5913 also supports all of the common build options that @command{guix
5914 build} supports (@pxref{Common Build Options}) as well as package
5915 transformation options (@pxref{Package Transformation Options}).
5916
5917 @node Invoking guix pack
5918 @section Invoking @command{guix pack}
5919
5920 Occasionally you want to pass software to people who are not (yet!)
5921 lucky enough to be using Guix. You'd tell them to run @command{guix
5922 package -i @var{something}}, but that's not possible in this case. This
5923 is where @command{guix pack} comes in.
5924
5925 @quotation Note
5926 If you are looking for ways to exchange binaries among machines that
5927 already run Guix, @pxref{Invoking guix copy}, @ref{Invoking guix
5928 publish}, and @ref{Invoking guix archive}.
5929 @end quotation
5930
5931 @cindex pack
5932 @cindex bundle
5933 @cindex application bundle
5934 @cindex software bundle
5935 The @command{guix pack} command creates a shrink-wrapped @dfn{pack} or
5936 @dfn{software bundle}: it creates a tarball or some other archive
5937 containing the binaries of the software you're interested in, and all
5938 its dependencies. The resulting archive can be used on any machine that
5939 does not have Guix, and people can run the exact same binaries as those
5940 you have with Guix. The pack itself is created in a bit-reproducible
5941 fashion, so anyone can verify that it really contains the build results
5942 that you pretend to be shipping.
5943
5944 For example, to create a bundle containing Guile, Emacs, Geiser, and all
5945 their dependencies, you can run:
5946
5947 @example
5948 $ guix pack guile emacs emacs-geiser
5949 @dots{}
5950 /gnu/store/@dots{}-pack.tar.gz
5951 @end example
5952
5953 The result here is a tarball containing a @file{/gnu/store} directory
5954 with all the relevant packages. The resulting tarball contains a
5955 @dfn{profile} with the three packages of interest; the profile is the
5956 same as would be created by @command{guix package -i}. It is this
5957 mechanism that is used to create Guix's own standalone binary tarball
5958 (@pxref{Binary Installation}).
5959
5960 Users of this pack would have to run
5961 @file{/gnu/store/@dots{}-profile/bin/guile} to run Guile, which you may
5962 find inconvenient. To work around it, you can create, say, a
5963 @file{/opt/gnu/bin} symlink to the profile:
5964
5965 @example
5966 guix pack -S /opt/gnu/bin=bin guile emacs emacs-geiser
5967 @end example
5968
5969 @noindent
5970 That way, users can happily type @file{/opt/gnu/bin/guile} and enjoy.
5971
5972 @cindex relocatable binaries, with @command{guix pack}
5973 What if the recipient of your pack does not have root privileges on
5974 their machine, and thus cannot unpack it in the root file system? In
5975 that case, you will want to use the @option{--relocatable} option (see
5976 below). This option produces @dfn{relocatable binaries}, meaning they
5977 they can be placed anywhere in the file system hierarchy: in the example
5978 above, users can unpack your tarball in their home directory and
5979 directly run @file{./opt/gnu/bin/guile}.
5980
5981 @cindex Docker, build an image with guix pack
5982 Alternatively, you can produce a pack in the Docker image format using
5983 the following command:
5984
5985 @example
5986 guix pack -f docker -S /bin=bin guile guile-readline
5987 @end example
5988
5989 @noindent
5990 The result is a tarball that can be passed to the @command{docker load}
5991 command, followed by @code{docker run}:
5992
5993 @example
5994 docker load < @var{file}
5995 docker run -ti guile-guile-readline /bin/guile
5996 @end example
5997
5998 @noindent
5999 where @var{file} is the image returned by @var{guix pack}, and
6000 @code{guile-guile-readline} is its ``image tag''. See the
6001 @uref{https://docs.docker.com/engine/reference/commandline/load/, Docker
6002 documentation} for more information.
6003
6004 @cindex Singularity, build an image with guix pack
6005 @cindex SquashFS, build an image with guix pack
6006 Yet another option is to produce a SquashFS image with the following
6007 command:
6008
6009 @example
6010 guix pack -f squashfs bash guile emacs emacs-geiser
6011 @end example
6012
6013 @noindent
6014 The result is a SquashFS file system image that can either be mounted or
6015 directly be used as a file system container image with the
6016 @uref{https://www.sylabs.io/docs/, Singularity container execution
6017 environment}, using commands like @command{singularity shell} or
6018 @command{singularity exec}.
6019
6020 Several command-line options allow you to customize your pack:
6021
6022 @table @code
6023 @item --format=@var{format}
6024 @itemx -f @var{format}
6025 Produce a pack in the given @var{format}.
6026
6027 The available formats are:
6028
6029 @table @code
6030 @item tarball
6031 This is the default format. It produces a tarball containing all the
6032 specified binaries and symlinks.
6033
6034 @item docker
6035 This produces a tarball that follows the
6036 @uref{https://github.com/docker/docker/blob/master/image/spec/v1.2.md,
6037 Docker Image Specification}. The ``repository name'' as it appears in
6038 the output of the @command{docker images} command is computed from
6039 package names passed on the command line or in the manifest file.
6040
6041 @item squashfs
6042 This produces a SquashFS image containing all the specified binaries and
6043 symlinks, as well as empty mount points for virtual file systems like
6044 procfs.
6045
6046 @quotation Note
6047 Singularity @emph{requires} you to provide @file{/bin/sh} in the image.
6048 For that reason, @command{guix pack -f squashfs} always implies @code{-S
6049 /bin=bin}. Thus, your @command{guix pack} invocation must always start
6050 with something like:
6051
6052 @example
6053 guix pack -f squashfs bash @dots{}
6054 @end example
6055
6056 If you forget the @code{bash} (or similar) package, @command{singularity
6057 run} and @command{singularity exec} will fail with an unhelpful ``no
6058 such file or directory'' message.
6059 @end quotation
6060
6061 @item deb
6062 This produces a Debian archive (a package with the @samp{.deb} file
6063 extension) containing all the specified binaries and symbolic links,
6064 that can be installed on top of any dpkg-based GNU(/Linux) distribution.
6065 Advanced options can be revealed via the @option{--help-deb-format}
6066 option. They allow embedding control files for more fine-grained
6067 control, such as activating specific triggers or providing a maintainer
6068 configure script to run arbitrary setup code upon installation.
6069
6070 @example
6071 guix pack -f deb -C xz -S /usr/bin/hello=bin/hello hello
6072 @end example
6073
6074 @quotation Note
6075 Because archives produced with @command{guix pack} contain a collection
6076 of store items and because each @command{dpkg} package must not have
6077 conflicting files, in practice that means you likely won't be able to
6078 install more than one such archive on a given system.
6079 @end quotation
6080
6081 @quotation Warning
6082 @command{dpkg} will assume ownership of any files contained in the pack
6083 that it does @emph{not} know about. It is unwise to install
6084 Guix-produced @samp{.deb} files on a system where @file{/gnu/store} is
6085 shared by other software, such as a Guix installation or other, non-deb
6086 packs.
6087 @end quotation
6088
6089 @end table
6090
6091 @cindex relocatable binaries
6092 @item --relocatable
6093 @itemx -R
6094 Produce @dfn{relocatable binaries}---i.e., binaries that can be placed
6095 anywhere in the file system hierarchy and run from there.
6096
6097 When this option is passed once, the resulting binaries require support for
6098 @dfn{user namespaces} in the kernel Linux; when passed
6099 @emph{twice}@footnote{Here's a trick to memorize it: @code{-RR}, which adds
6100 PRoot support, can be thought of as the abbreviation of ``Really
6101 Relocatable''. Neat, isn't it?}, relocatable binaries fall to back to
6102 other techniques if user namespaces are unavailable, and essentially
6103 work anywhere---see below for the implications.
6104
6105 For example, if you create a pack containing Bash with:
6106
6107 @example
6108 guix pack -RR -S /mybin=bin bash
6109 @end example
6110
6111 @noindent
6112 ...@: you can copy that pack to a machine that lacks Guix, and from your
6113 home directory as a normal user, run:
6114
6115 @example
6116 tar xf pack.tar.gz
6117 ./mybin/sh
6118 @end example
6119
6120 @noindent
6121 In that shell, if you type @code{ls /gnu/store}, you'll notice that
6122 @file{/gnu/store} shows up and contains all the dependencies of
6123 @code{bash}, even though the machine actually lacks @file{/gnu/store}
6124 altogether! That is probably the simplest way to deploy Guix-built
6125 software on a non-Guix machine.
6126
6127 @quotation Note
6128 By default, relocatable binaries rely on the @dfn{user namespace} feature of
6129 the kernel Linux, which allows unprivileged users to mount or change root.
6130 Old versions of Linux did not support it, and some GNU/Linux distributions
6131 turn it off.
6132
6133 To produce relocatable binaries that work even in the absence of user
6134 namespaces, pass @option{--relocatable} or @option{-R} @emph{twice}. In that
6135 case, binaries will try user namespace support and fall back to another
6136 @dfn{execution engine} if user namespaces are not supported. The
6137 following execution engines are supported:
6138
6139 @table @code
6140 @item default
6141 Try user namespaces and fall back to PRoot if user namespaces are not
6142 supported (see below).
6143
6144 @item performance
6145 Try user namespaces and fall back to Fakechroot if user namespaces are
6146 not supported (see below).
6147
6148 @item userns
6149 Run the program through user namespaces and abort if they are not
6150 supported.
6151
6152 @item proot
6153 Run through PRoot. The @uref{https://proot-me.github.io/, PRoot} program
6154 provides the necessary
6155 support for file system virtualization. It achieves that by using the
6156 @code{ptrace} system call on the running program. This approach has the
6157 advantage to work without requiring special kernel support, but it incurs
6158 run-time overhead every time a system call is made.
6159
6160 @item fakechroot
6161 Run through Fakechroot. @uref{https://github.com/dex4er/fakechroot/,
6162 Fakechroot} virtualizes file system accesses by intercepting calls to C
6163 library functions such as @code{open}, @code{stat}, @code{exec}, and so
6164 on. Unlike PRoot, it incurs very little overhead. However, it does not
6165 always work: for example, some file system accesses made from within the
6166 C library are not intercepted, and file system accesses made @i{via}
6167 direct syscalls are not intercepted either, leading to erratic behavior.
6168 @end table
6169
6170 @vindex GUIX_EXECUTION_ENGINE
6171 When running a wrapped program, you can explicitly request one of the
6172 execution engines listed above by setting the
6173 @env{GUIX_EXECUTION_ENGINE} environment variable accordingly.
6174 @end quotation
6175
6176 @cindex entry point, for Docker images
6177 @item --entry-point=@var{command}
6178 Use @var{command} as the @dfn{entry point} of the resulting pack, if the pack
6179 format supports it---currently @code{docker} and @code{squashfs} (Singularity)
6180 support it. @var{command} must be relative to the profile contained in the
6181 pack.
6182
6183 The entry point specifies the command that tools like @code{docker run} or
6184 @code{singularity run} automatically start by default. For example, you can
6185 do:
6186
6187 @example
6188 guix pack -f docker --entry-point=bin/guile guile
6189 @end example
6190
6191 The resulting pack can easily be loaded and @code{docker run} with no extra
6192 arguments will spawn @code{bin/guile}:
6193
6194 @example
6195 docker load -i pack.tar.gz
6196 docker run @var{image-id}
6197 @end example
6198
6199 @item --expression=@var{expr}
6200 @itemx -e @var{expr}
6201 Consider the package @var{expr} evaluates to.
6202
6203 This has the same purpose as the same-named option in @command{guix
6204 build} (@pxref{Additional Build Options, @option{--expression} in
6205 @command{guix build}}).
6206
6207 @item --manifest=@var{file}
6208 @itemx -m @var{file}
6209 Use the packages contained in the manifest object returned by the Scheme
6210 code in @var{file}. This option can be repeated several times, in which
6211 case the manifests are concatenated.
6212
6213 This has a similar purpose as the same-named option in @command{guix
6214 package} (@pxref{profile-manifest, @option{--manifest}}) and uses the
6215 same manifest files. It allows you to define a collection of packages
6216 once and use it both for creating profiles and for creating archives
6217 for use on machines that do not have Guix installed. Note that you can
6218 specify @emph{either} a manifest file @emph{or} a list of packages,
6219 but not both.
6220
6221 @item --system=@var{system}
6222 @itemx -s @var{system}
6223 Attempt to build for @var{system}---e.g., @code{i686-linux}---instead of
6224 the system type of the build host.
6225
6226 @item --target=@var{triplet}
6227 @cindex cross-compilation
6228 Cross-build for @var{triplet}, which must be a valid GNU triplet, such
6229 as @code{"aarch64-linux-gnu"} (@pxref{Specifying target triplets, GNU
6230 configuration triplets,, autoconf, Autoconf}).
6231
6232 @item --compression=@var{tool}
6233 @itemx -C @var{tool}
6234 Compress the resulting tarball using @var{tool}---one of @code{gzip},
6235 @code{zstd}, @code{bzip2}, @code{xz}, @code{lzip}, or @code{none} for no
6236 compression.
6237
6238 @item --symlink=@var{spec}
6239 @itemx -S @var{spec}
6240 Add the symlinks specified by @var{spec} to the pack. This option can
6241 appear several times.
6242
6243 @var{spec} has the form @code{@var{source}=@var{target}}, where
6244 @var{source} is the symlink that will be created and @var{target} is the
6245 symlink target.
6246
6247 For instance, @code{-S /opt/gnu/bin=bin} creates a @file{/opt/gnu/bin}
6248 symlink pointing to the @file{bin} sub-directory of the profile.
6249
6250 @item --save-provenance
6251 Save provenance information for the packages passed on the command line.
6252 Provenance information includes the URL and commit of the channels in use
6253 (@pxref{Channels}).
6254
6255 Provenance information is saved in the
6256 @file{/gnu/store/@dots{}-profile/manifest} file in the pack, along with the
6257 usual package metadata---the name and version of each package, their
6258 propagated inputs, and so on. It is useful information to the recipient of
6259 the pack, who then knows how the pack was (supposedly) obtained.
6260
6261 This option is not enabled by default because, like timestamps, provenance
6262 information contributes nothing to the build process. In other words, there
6263 is an infinity of channel URLs and commit IDs that can lead to the same pack.
6264 Recording such ``silent'' metadata in the output thus potentially breaks the
6265 source-to-binary bitwise reproducibility property.
6266
6267 @item --root=@var{file}
6268 @itemx -r @var{file}
6269 @cindex garbage collector root, for packs
6270 Make @var{file} a symlink to the resulting pack, and register it as a garbage
6271 collector root.
6272
6273 @item --localstatedir
6274 @itemx --profile-name=@var{name}
6275 Include the ``local state directory'', @file{/var/guix}, in the resulting
6276 pack, and notably the @file{/var/guix/profiles/per-user/root/@var{name}}
6277 profile---by default @var{name} is @code{guix-profile}, which corresponds to
6278 @file{~root/.guix-profile}.
6279
6280 @file{/var/guix} contains the store database (@pxref{The Store}) as well
6281 as garbage-collector roots (@pxref{Invoking guix gc}). Providing it in
6282 the pack means that the store is ``complete'' and manageable by Guix;
6283 not providing it pack means that the store is ``dead'': items cannot be
6284 added to it or removed from it after extraction of the pack.
6285
6286 One use case for this is the Guix self-contained binary tarball
6287 (@pxref{Binary Installation}).
6288
6289 @item --derivation
6290 @itemx -d
6291 Print the name of the derivation that builds the pack.
6292
6293 @item --bootstrap
6294 Use the bootstrap binaries to build the pack. This option is only
6295 useful to Guix developers.
6296 @end table
6297
6298 In addition, @command{guix pack} supports all the common build options
6299 (@pxref{Common Build Options}) and all the package transformation
6300 options (@pxref{Package Transformation Options}).
6301
6302
6303 @node The GCC toolchain
6304 @section The GCC toolchain
6305
6306 @cindex GCC
6307 @cindex ld-wrapper
6308 @cindex linker wrapper
6309 @cindex toolchain, for C development
6310 @cindex toolchain, for Fortran development
6311
6312 If you need a complete toolchain for compiling and linking C or C++
6313 source code, use the @code{gcc-toolchain} package. This package
6314 provides a complete GCC toolchain for C/C++ development, including GCC
6315 itself, the GNU C Library (headers and binaries, plus debugging symbols
6316 in the @code{debug} output), Binutils, and a linker wrapper.
6317
6318 The wrapper's purpose is to inspect the @code{-L} and @code{-l} switches
6319 passed to the linker, add corresponding @code{-rpath} arguments, and
6320 invoke the actual linker with this new set of arguments. You can instruct the
6321 wrapper to refuse to link against libraries not in the store by setting the
6322 @env{GUIX_LD_WRAPPER_ALLOW_IMPURITIES} environment variable to @code{no}.
6323
6324 The package @code{gfortran-toolchain} provides a complete GCC toolchain
6325 for Fortran development. For other languages, please use
6326 @samp{guix search gcc toolchain} (@pxref{guix-search,, Invoking guix package}).
6327
6328
6329 @node Invoking guix git authenticate
6330 @section Invoking @command{guix git authenticate}
6331
6332 The @command{guix git authenticate} command authenticates a Git checkout
6333 following the same rule as for channels (@pxref{channel-authentication,
6334 channel authentication}). That is, starting from a given commit, it
6335 ensures that all subsequent commits are signed by an OpenPGP key whose
6336 fingerprint appears in the @file{.guix-authorizations} file of its
6337 parent commit(s).
6338
6339 You will find this command useful if you maintain a channel. But in
6340 fact, this authentication mechanism is useful in a broader context, so
6341 you might want to use it for Git repositories that have nothing to do
6342 with Guix.
6343
6344 The general syntax is:
6345
6346 @example
6347 guix git authenticate @var{commit} @var{signer} [@var{options}@dots{}]
6348 @end example
6349
6350 By default, this command authenticates the Git checkout in the current
6351 directory; it outputs nothing and exits with exit code zero on success
6352 and non-zero on failure. @var{commit} above denotes the first commit
6353 where authentication takes place, and @var{signer} is the OpenPGP
6354 fingerprint of public key used to sign @var{commit}. Together, they
6355 form a ``channel introduction'' (@pxref{channel-authentication, channel
6356 introduction}). The options below allow you to fine-tune the process.
6357
6358 @table @code
6359 @item --repository=@var{directory}
6360 @itemx -r @var{directory}
6361 Open the Git repository in @var{directory} instead of the current
6362 directory.
6363
6364 @item --keyring=@var{reference}
6365 @itemx -k @var{reference}
6366 Load OpenPGP keyring from @var{reference}, the reference of a branch
6367 such as @code{origin/keyring} or @code{my-keyring}. The branch must
6368 contain OpenPGP public keys in @file{.key} files, either in binary form
6369 or ``ASCII-armored''. By default the keyring is loaded from the branch
6370 named @code{keyring}.
6371
6372 @item --stats
6373 Display commit signing statistics upon completion.
6374
6375 @item --cache-key=@var{key}
6376 Previously-authenticated commits are cached in a file under
6377 @file{~/.cache/guix/authentication}. This option forces the cache to be
6378 stored in file @var{key} in that directory.
6379
6380 @item --historical-authorizations=@var{file}
6381 By default, any commit whose parent commit(s) lack the
6382 @file{.guix-authorizations} file is considered inauthentic. In
6383 contrast, this option considers the authorizations in @var{file} for any
6384 commit that lacks @file{.guix-authorizations}. The format of @var{file}
6385 is the same as that of @file{.guix-authorizations}
6386 (@pxref{channel-authorizations, @file{.guix-authorizations} format}).
6387 @end table
6388
6389
6390 @c *********************************************************************
6391 @node Programming Interface
6392 @chapter Programming Interface
6393
6394 GNU Guix provides several Scheme programming interfaces (APIs) to
6395 define, build, and query packages. The first interface allows users to
6396 write high-level package definitions. These definitions refer to
6397 familiar packaging concepts, such as the name and version of a package,
6398 its build system, and its dependencies. These definitions can then be
6399 turned into concrete build actions.
6400
6401 Build actions are performed by the Guix daemon, on behalf of users. In a
6402 standard setup, the daemon has write access to the store---the
6403 @file{/gnu/store} directory---whereas users do not. The recommended
6404 setup also has the daemon perform builds in chroots, under specific
6405 build users, to minimize interference with the rest of the system.
6406
6407 @cindex derivation
6408 Lower-level APIs are available to interact with the daemon and the
6409 store. To instruct the daemon to perform a build action, users actually
6410 provide it with a @dfn{derivation}. A derivation is a low-level
6411 representation of the build actions to be taken, and the environment in
6412 which they should occur---derivations are to package definitions what
6413 assembly is to C programs. The term ``derivation'' comes from the fact
6414 that build results @emph{derive} from them.
6415
6416 This chapter describes all these APIs in turn, starting from high-level
6417 package definitions.
6418
6419 @menu
6420 * Package Modules:: Packages from the programmer's viewpoint.
6421 * Defining Packages:: Defining new packages.
6422 * Defining Package Variants:: Customizing packages.
6423 * Build Systems:: Specifying how packages are built.
6424 * Build Phases:: Phases of the build process of a package.
6425 * Build Utilities:: Helpers for your package definitions and more.
6426 * The Store:: Manipulating the package store.
6427 * Derivations:: Low-level interface to package derivations.
6428 * The Store Monad:: Purely functional interface to the store.
6429 * G-Expressions:: Manipulating build expressions.
6430 * Invoking guix repl:: Programming Guix in Guile
6431 @end menu
6432
6433 @node Package Modules
6434 @section Package Modules
6435
6436 From a programming viewpoint, the package definitions of the
6437 GNU distribution are provided by Guile modules in the @code{(gnu packages
6438 @dots{})} name space@footnote{Note that packages under the @code{(gnu
6439 packages @dots{})} module name space are not necessarily ``GNU
6440 packages''. This module naming scheme follows the usual Guile module
6441 naming convention: @code{gnu} means that these modules are distributed
6442 as part of the GNU system, and @code{packages} identifies modules that
6443 define packages.} (@pxref{Modules, Guile modules,, guile, GNU Guile
6444 Reference Manual}). For instance, the @code{(gnu packages emacs)}
6445 module exports a variable named @code{emacs}, which is bound to a
6446 @code{<package>} object (@pxref{Defining Packages}).
6447
6448 The @code{(gnu packages @dots{})} module name space is
6449 automatically scanned for packages by the command-line tools. For
6450 instance, when running @code{guix install emacs}, all the @code{(gnu
6451 packages @dots{})} modules are scanned until one that exports a package
6452 object whose name is @code{emacs} is found. This package search
6453 facility is implemented in the @code{(gnu packages)} module.
6454
6455 @cindex customization, of packages
6456 @cindex package module search path
6457 Users can store package definitions in modules with different
6458 names---e.g., @code{(my-packages emacs)}@footnote{Note that the file
6459 name and module name must match. For instance, the @code{(my-packages
6460 emacs)} module must be stored in a @file{my-packages/emacs.scm} file
6461 relative to the load path specified with @option{--load-path} or
6462 @env{GUIX_PACKAGE_PATH}. @xref{Modules and the File System,,,
6463 guile, GNU Guile Reference Manual}, for details.}. There are two ways to make
6464 these package definitions visible to the user interfaces:
6465
6466 @enumerate
6467 @item
6468 By adding the directory containing your package modules to the search path
6469 with the @code{-L} flag of @command{guix package} and other commands
6470 (@pxref{Common Build Options}), or by setting the @env{GUIX_PACKAGE_PATH}
6471 environment variable described below.
6472
6473 @item
6474 By defining a @dfn{channel} and configuring @command{guix pull} so that it
6475 pulls from it. A channel is essentially a Git repository containing package
6476 modules. @xref{Channels}, for more information on how to define and use
6477 channels.
6478 @end enumerate
6479
6480 @env{GUIX_PACKAGE_PATH} works similarly to other search path variables:
6481
6482 @defvr {Environment Variable} GUIX_PACKAGE_PATH
6483 This is a colon-separated list of directories to search for additional
6484 package modules. Directories listed in this variable take precedence
6485 over the own modules of the distribution.
6486 @end defvr
6487
6488 The distribution is fully @dfn{bootstrapped} and @dfn{self-contained}:
6489 each package is built based solely on other packages in the
6490 distribution. The root of this dependency graph is a small set of
6491 @dfn{bootstrap binaries}, provided by the @code{(gnu packages
6492 bootstrap)} module. For more information on bootstrapping,
6493 @pxref{Bootstrapping}.
6494
6495 @node Defining Packages
6496 @section Defining Packages
6497
6498 The high-level interface to package definitions is implemented in the
6499 @code{(guix packages)} and @code{(guix build-system)} modules. As an
6500 example, the package definition, or @dfn{recipe}, for the GNU Hello
6501 package looks like this:
6502
6503 @lisp
6504 (define-module (gnu packages hello)
6505 #:use-module (guix packages)
6506 #:use-module (guix download)
6507 #:use-module (guix build-system gnu)
6508 #:use-module (guix licenses)
6509 #:use-module (gnu packages gawk))
6510
6511 (define-public hello
6512 (package
6513 (name "hello")
6514 (version "2.10")
6515 (source (origin
6516 (method url-fetch)
6517 (uri (string-append "mirror://gnu/hello/hello-" version
6518 ".tar.gz"))
6519 (sha256
6520 (base32
6521 "0ssi1wpaf7plaswqqjwigppsg5fyh99vdlb9kzl7c9lng89ndq1i"))))
6522 (build-system gnu-build-system)
6523 (arguments '(#:configure-flags '("--enable-silent-rules")))
6524 (inputs `(("gawk" ,gawk)))
6525 (synopsis "Hello, GNU world: An example GNU package")
6526 (description "Guess what GNU Hello prints!")
6527 (home-page "https://www.gnu.org/software/hello/")
6528 (license gpl3+)))
6529 @end lisp
6530
6531 @noindent
6532 Without being a Scheme expert, the reader may have guessed the meaning
6533 of the various fields here. This expression binds the variable
6534 @code{hello} to a @code{<package>} object, which is essentially a record
6535 (@pxref{SRFI-9, Scheme records,, guile, GNU Guile Reference Manual}).
6536 This package object can be inspected using procedures found in the
6537 @code{(guix packages)} module; for instance, @code{(package-name hello)}
6538 returns---surprise!---@code{"hello"}.
6539
6540 With luck, you may be able to import part or all of the definition of
6541 the package you are interested in from another repository, using the
6542 @code{guix import} command (@pxref{Invoking guix import}).
6543
6544 In the example above, @code{hello} is defined in a module of its own,
6545 @code{(gnu packages hello)}. Technically, this is not strictly
6546 necessary, but it is convenient to do so: all the packages defined in
6547 modules under @code{(gnu packages @dots{})} are automatically known to
6548 the command-line tools (@pxref{Package Modules}).
6549
6550 There are a few points worth noting in the above package definition:
6551
6552 @itemize
6553 @item
6554 The @code{source} field of the package is an @code{<origin>} object
6555 (@pxref{origin Reference}, for the complete reference).
6556 Here, the @code{url-fetch} method from @code{(guix download)} is used,
6557 meaning that the source is a file to be downloaded over FTP or HTTP.
6558
6559 The @code{mirror://gnu} prefix instructs @code{url-fetch} to use one of
6560 the GNU mirrors defined in @code{(guix download)}.
6561
6562 The @code{sha256} field specifies the expected SHA256 hash of the file
6563 being downloaded. It is mandatory, and allows Guix to check the
6564 integrity of the file. The @code{(base32 @dots{})} form introduces the
6565 base32 representation of the hash. You can obtain this information with
6566 @code{guix download} (@pxref{Invoking guix download}) and @code{guix
6567 hash} (@pxref{Invoking guix hash}).
6568
6569 @cindex patches
6570 When needed, the @code{origin} form can also have a @code{patches} field
6571 listing patches to be applied, and a @code{snippet} field giving a
6572 Scheme expression to modify the source code.
6573
6574 @item
6575 @cindex GNU Build System
6576 The @code{build-system} field specifies the procedure to build the
6577 package (@pxref{Build Systems}). Here, @code{gnu-build-system}
6578 represents the familiar GNU Build System, where packages may be
6579 configured, built, and installed with the usual @code{./configure &&
6580 make && make check && make install} command sequence.
6581
6582 When you start packaging non-trivial software, you may need tools to
6583 manipulate those build phases, manipulate files, and so on. @xref{Build
6584 Utilities}, for more on this.
6585
6586 @item
6587 The @code{arguments} field specifies options for the build system
6588 (@pxref{Build Systems}). Here it is interpreted by
6589 @code{gnu-build-system} as a request run @file{configure} with the
6590 @option{--enable-silent-rules} flag.
6591
6592 @cindex quote
6593 @cindex quoting
6594 @findex '
6595 @findex quote
6596 What about these quote (@code{'}) characters? They are Scheme syntax to
6597 introduce a literal list; @code{'} is synonymous with @code{quote}.
6598 @xref{Expression Syntax, quoting,, guile, GNU Guile Reference Manual},
6599 for details. Here the value of the @code{arguments} field is a list of
6600 arguments passed to the build system down the road, as with @code{apply}
6601 (@pxref{Fly Evaluation, @code{apply},, guile, GNU Guile Reference
6602 Manual}).
6603
6604 The hash-colon (@code{#:}) sequence defines a Scheme @dfn{keyword}
6605 (@pxref{Keywords,,, guile, GNU Guile Reference Manual}), and
6606 @code{#:configure-flags} is a keyword used to pass a keyword argument
6607 to the build system (@pxref{Coding With Keywords,,, guile, GNU Guile
6608 Reference Manual}).
6609
6610 @item
6611 The @code{inputs} field specifies inputs to the build process---i.e.,
6612 build-time or run-time dependencies of the package. Here, we define an
6613 input called @code{"gawk"} whose value is that of the @code{gawk}
6614 variable; @code{gawk} is itself bound to a @code{<package>} object.
6615
6616 @cindex backquote (quasiquote)
6617 @findex `
6618 @findex quasiquote
6619 @cindex comma (unquote)
6620 @findex ,
6621 @findex unquote
6622 @findex ,@@
6623 @findex unquote-splicing
6624 Again, @code{`} (a backquote, synonymous with @code{quasiquote}) allows
6625 us to introduce a literal list in the @code{inputs} field, while
6626 @code{,} (a comma, synonymous with @code{unquote}) allows us to insert a
6627 value in that list (@pxref{Expression Syntax, unquote,, guile, GNU Guile
6628 Reference Manual}).
6629
6630 Note that GCC, Coreutils, Bash, and other essential tools do not need to
6631 be specified as inputs here. Instead, @code{gnu-build-system} takes care
6632 of ensuring that they are present (@pxref{Build Systems}).
6633
6634 However, any other dependencies need to be specified in the
6635 @code{inputs} field. Any dependency not specified here will simply be
6636 unavailable to the build process, possibly leading to a build failure.
6637 @end itemize
6638
6639 @xref{package Reference}, for a full description of possible fields.
6640
6641 Once a package definition is in place, the
6642 package may actually be built using the @code{guix build} command-line
6643 tool (@pxref{Invoking guix build}), troubleshooting any build failures
6644 you encounter (@pxref{Debugging Build Failures}). You can easily jump back to the
6645 package definition using the @command{guix edit} command
6646 (@pxref{Invoking guix edit}).
6647 @xref{Packaging Guidelines}, for
6648 more information on how to test package definitions, and
6649 @ref{Invoking guix lint}, for information on how to check a definition
6650 for style conformance.
6651 @vindex GUIX_PACKAGE_PATH
6652 Lastly, @pxref{Channels}, for information
6653 on how to extend the distribution by adding your own package definitions
6654 in a ``channel''.
6655
6656 Finally, updating the package definition to a new upstream version
6657 can be partly automated by the @command{guix refresh} command
6658 (@pxref{Invoking guix refresh}).
6659
6660 Behind the scenes, a derivation corresponding to the @code{<package>}
6661 object is first computed by the @code{package-derivation} procedure.
6662 That derivation is stored in a @file{.drv} file under @file{/gnu/store}.
6663 The build actions it prescribes may then be realized by using the
6664 @code{build-derivations} procedure (@pxref{The Store}).
6665
6666 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} package-derivation @var{store} @var{package} [@var{system}]
6667 Return the @code{<derivation>} object of @var{package} for @var{system}
6668 (@pxref{Derivations}).
6669
6670 @var{package} must be a valid @code{<package>} object, and @var{system}
6671 must be a string denoting the target system type---e.g.,
6672 @code{"x86_64-linux"} for an x86_64 Linux-based GNU system. @var{store}
6673 must be a connection to the daemon, which operates on the store
6674 (@pxref{The Store}).
6675 @end deffn
6676
6677 @noindent
6678 @cindex cross-compilation
6679 Similarly, it is possible to compute a derivation that cross-builds a
6680 package for some other system:
6681
6682 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} package-cross-derivation @var{store} @
6683 @var{package} @var{target} [@var{system}]
6684 Return the @code{<derivation>} object of @var{package} cross-built from
6685 @var{system} to @var{target}.
6686
6687 @var{target} must be a valid GNU triplet denoting the target hardware
6688 and operating system, such as @code{"aarch64-linux-gnu"}
6689 (@pxref{Specifying Target Triplets,,, autoconf, Autoconf}).
6690 @end deffn
6691
6692 Once you have package definitions, you can easily define @emph{variants}
6693 of those packages. @xref{Defining Package Variants}, for more on that.
6694
6695 @menu
6696 * package Reference:: The package data type.
6697 * origin Reference:: The origin data type.
6698 @end menu
6699
6700
6701 @node package Reference
6702 @subsection @code{package} Reference
6703
6704 This section summarizes all the options available in @code{package}
6705 declarations (@pxref{Defining Packages}).
6706
6707 @deftp {Data Type} package
6708 This is the data type representing a package recipe.
6709
6710 @table @asis
6711 @item @code{name}
6712 The name of the package, as a string.
6713
6714 @item @code{version}
6715 The version of the package, as a string. @xref{Version Numbers}, for
6716 guidelines.
6717
6718 @item @code{source}
6719 An object telling how the source code for the package should be
6720 acquired. Most of the time, this is an @code{origin} object, which
6721 denotes a file fetched from the Internet (@pxref{origin Reference}). It
6722 can also be any other ``file-like'' object such as a @code{local-file},
6723 which denotes a file from the local file system (@pxref{G-Expressions,
6724 @code{local-file}}).
6725
6726 @item @code{build-system}
6727 The build system that should be used to build the package (@pxref{Build
6728 Systems}).
6729
6730 @item @code{arguments} (default: @code{'()})
6731 The arguments that should be passed to the build system. This is a
6732 list, typically containing sequential keyword-value pairs.
6733
6734 @item @code{inputs} (default: @code{'()})
6735 @itemx @code{native-inputs} (default: @code{'()})
6736 @itemx @code{propagated-inputs} (default: @code{'()})
6737 @cindex inputs, of packages
6738 These fields list dependencies of the package. Each one is a list of
6739 tuples, where each tuple has a label for the input (a string) as its
6740 first element, a package, origin, or derivation as its second element,
6741 and optionally the name of the output thereof that should be used, which
6742 defaults to @code{"out"} (@pxref{Packages with Multiple Outputs}, for
6743 more on package outputs). For example, the list below specifies three
6744 inputs:
6745
6746 @lisp
6747 `(("libffi" ,libffi)
6748 ("libunistring" ,libunistring)
6749 ("glib:bin" ,glib "bin")) ;the "bin" output of Glib
6750 @end lisp
6751
6752 @cindex cross compilation, package dependencies
6753 The distinction between @code{native-inputs} and @code{inputs} is
6754 necessary when considering cross-compilation. When cross-compiling,
6755 dependencies listed in @code{inputs} are built for the @emph{target}
6756 architecture; conversely, dependencies listed in @code{native-inputs}
6757 are built for the architecture of the @emph{build} machine.
6758
6759 @code{native-inputs} is typically used to list tools needed at
6760 build time, but not at run time, such as Autoconf, Automake, pkg-config,
6761 Gettext, or Bison. @command{guix lint} can report likely mistakes in
6762 this area (@pxref{Invoking guix lint}).
6763
6764 @anchor{package-propagated-inputs}
6765 Lastly, @code{propagated-inputs} is similar to @code{inputs}, but the
6766 specified packages will be automatically installed to profiles
6767 (@pxref{Features, the role of profiles in Guix}) alongside the package
6768 they belong to (@pxref{package-cmd-propagated-inputs, @command{guix
6769 package}}, for information on how @command{guix package} deals with
6770 propagated inputs).
6771
6772 For example this is necessary when packaging a C/C++ library that needs
6773 headers of another library to compile, or when a pkg-config file refers
6774 to another one @i{via} its @code{Requires} field.
6775
6776 Another example where @code{propagated-inputs} is useful is for languages
6777 that lack a facility to record the run-time search path akin to the
6778 @code{RUNPATH} of ELF files; this includes Guile, Python, Perl, and
6779 more. When packaging libraries written in those languages, ensure they
6780 can find library code they depend on at run time by listing run-time
6781 dependencies in @code{propagated-inputs} rather than @code{inputs}.
6782
6783 @item @code{outputs} (default: @code{'("out")})
6784 The list of output names of the package. @xref{Packages with Multiple
6785 Outputs}, for typical uses of additional outputs.
6786
6787 @item @code{native-search-paths} (default: @code{'()})
6788 @itemx @code{search-paths} (default: @code{'()})
6789 A list of @code{search-path-specification} objects describing
6790 search-path environment variables honored by the package.
6791
6792 @item @code{replacement} (default: @code{#f})
6793 This must be either @code{#f} or a package object that will be used as a
6794 @dfn{replacement} for this package. @xref{Security Updates, grafts},
6795 for details.
6796
6797 @item @code{synopsis}
6798 A one-line description of the package.
6799
6800 @item @code{description}
6801 A more elaborate description of the package.
6802
6803 @item @code{license}
6804 @cindex license, of packages
6805 The license of the package; a value from @code{(guix licenses)},
6806 or a list of such values.
6807
6808 @item @code{home-page}
6809 The URL to the home-page of the package, as a string.
6810
6811 @item @code{supported-systems} (default: @code{%supported-systems})
6812 The list of systems supported by the package, as strings of the form
6813 @code{architecture-kernel}, for example @code{"x86_64-linux"}.
6814
6815 @item @code{location} (default: source location of the @code{package} form)
6816 The source location of the package. It is useful to override this when
6817 inheriting from another package, in which case this field is not
6818 automatically corrected.
6819 @end table
6820 @end deftp
6821
6822 @deffn {Scheme Syntax} this-package
6823 When used in the @emph{lexical scope} of a package field definition, this
6824 identifier resolves to the package being defined.
6825
6826 The example below shows how to add a package as a native input of itself when
6827 cross-compiling:
6828
6829 @lisp
6830 (package
6831 (name "guile")
6832 ;; ...
6833
6834 ;; When cross-compiled, Guile, for example, depends on
6835 ;; a native version of itself. Add it here.
6836 (native-inputs (if (%current-target-system)
6837 `(("self" ,this-package))
6838 '())))
6839 @end lisp
6840
6841 It is an error to refer to @code{this-package} outside a package definition.
6842 @end deffn
6843
6844 Because packages are regular Scheme objects that capture a complete
6845 dependency graph and associated build procedures, it is often useful to
6846 write procedures that take a package and return a modified version
6847 thereof according to some parameters. Below are a few examples.
6848
6849 @cindex tool chain, choosing a package's tool chain
6850 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} package-with-c-toolchain @var{package} @var{toolchain}
6851 Return a variant of @var{package} that uses @var{toolchain} instead of
6852 the default GNU C/C++ toolchain. @var{toolchain} must be a list of
6853 inputs (label/package tuples) providing equivalent functionality, such
6854 as the @code{gcc-toolchain} package.
6855
6856 The example below returns a variant of the @code{hello} package built
6857 with GCC@tie{}10.x and the rest of the GNU tool chain (Binutils and the
6858 GNU C Library) instead of the default tool chain:
6859
6860 @lisp
6861 (let ((toolchain (specification->package "gcc-toolchain@@10")))
6862 (package-with-c-toolchain hello `(("toolchain" ,toolchain))))
6863 @end lisp
6864
6865 The build tool chain is part of the @dfn{implicit inputs} of
6866 packages---it's usually not listed as part of the various ``inputs''
6867 fields and is instead pulled in by the build system. Consequently, this
6868 procedure works by changing the build system of @var{package} so that it
6869 pulls in @var{toolchain} instead of the defaults. @ref{Build Systems},
6870 for more on build systems.
6871 @end deffn
6872
6873 @node origin Reference
6874 @subsection @code{origin} Reference
6875
6876 This section documents @dfn{origins}. An @code{origin} declaration
6877 specifies data that must be ``produced''---downloaded, usually---and
6878 whose content hash is known in advance. Origins are primarily used to
6879 represent the source code of packages (@pxref{Defining Packages}). For
6880 that reason, the @code{origin} form allows you to declare patches to
6881 apply to the original source code as well as code snippets to modify it.
6882
6883 @deftp {Data Type} origin
6884 This is the data type representing a source code origin.
6885
6886 @table @asis
6887 @item @code{uri}
6888 An object containing the URI of the source. The object type depends on
6889 the @code{method} (see below). For example, when using the
6890 @var{url-fetch} method of @code{(guix download)}, the valid @code{uri}
6891 values are: a URL represented as a string, or a list thereof.
6892
6893 @cindex fixed-output derivations, for download
6894 @item @code{method}
6895 A monadic procedure that handles the given URI@. The procedure must
6896 accept at least three arguments: the value of the @code{uri} field and
6897 the hash algorithm and hash value specified by the @code{hash} field.
6898 It must return a store item or a derivation in the store monad
6899 (@pxref{The Store Monad}); most methods return a fixed-output derivation
6900 (@pxref{Derivations}).
6901
6902 Commonly used methods include @code{url-fetch}, which fetches data from
6903 a URL, and @code{git-fetch}, which fetches data from a Git repository
6904 (see below).
6905
6906 @item @code{sha256}
6907 A bytevector containing the SHA-256 hash of the source. This is
6908 equivalent to providing a @code{content-hash} SHA256 object in the
6909 @code{hash} field described below.
6910
6911 @item @code{hash}
6912 The @code{content-hash} object of the source---see below for how to use
6913 @code{content-hash}.
6914
6915 You can obtain this information using @code{guix download}
6916 (@pxref{Invoking guix download}) or @code{guix hash} (@pxref{Invoking
6917 guix hash}).
6918
6919 @item @code{file-name} (default: @code{#f})
6920 The file name under which the source code should be saved. When this is
6921 @code{#f}, a sensible default value will be used in most cases. In case
6922 the source is fetched from a URL, the file name from the URL will be
6923 used. For version control checkouts, it is recommended to provide the
6924 file name explicitly because the default is not very descriptive.
6925
6926 @item @code{patches} (default: @code{'()})
6927 A list of file names, origins, or file-like objects (@pxref{G-Expressions,
6928 file-like objects}) pointing to patches to be applied to the source.
6929
6930 This list of patches must be unconditional. In particular, it cannot
6931 depend on the value of @code{%current-system} or
6932 @code{%current-target-system}.
6933
6934 @item @code{snippet} (default: @code{#f})
6935 A G-expression (@pxref{G-Expressions}) or S-expression that will be run
6936 in the source directory. This is a convenient way to modify the source,
6937 sometimes more convenient than a patch.
6938
6939 @item @code{patch-flags} (default: @code{'("-p1")})
6940 A list of command-line flags that should be passed to the @code{patch}
6941 command.
6942
6943 @item @code{patch-inputs} (default: @code{#f})
6944 Input packages or derivations to the patching process. When this is
6945 @code{#f}, the usual set of inputs necessary for patching are provided,
6946 such as GNU@tie{}Patch.
6947
6948 @item @code{modules} (default: @code{'()})
6949 A list of Guile modules that should be loaded during the patching
6950 process and while running the code in the @code{snippet} field.
6951
6952 @item @code{patch-guile} (default: @code{#f})
6953 The Guile package that should be used in the patching process. When
6954 this is @code{#f}, a sensible default is used.
6955 @end table
6956 @end deftp
6957
6958 @deftp {Data Type} content-hash @var{value} [@var{algorithm}]
6959 Construct a content hash object for the given @var{algorithm}, and with
6960 @var{value} as its hash value. When @var{algorithm} is omitted, assume
6961 it is @code{sha256}.
6962
6963 @var{value} can be a literal string, in which case it is base32-decoded,
6964 or it can be a bytevector.
6965
6966 The following forms are all equivalent:
6967
6968 @lisp
6969 (content-hash "05zxkyz9bv3j9h0xyid1rhvh3klhsmrpkf3bcs6frvlgyr2gwilj")
6970 (content-hash "05zxkyz9bv3j9h0xyid1rhvh3klhsmrpkf3bcs6frvlgyr2gwilj"
6971 sha256)
6972 (content-hash (base32
6973 "05zxkyz9bv3j9h0xyid1rhvh3klhsmrpkf3bcs6frvlgyr2gwilj"))
6974 (content-hash (base64 "kkb+RPaP7uyMZmu4eXPVkM4BN8yhRd8BTHLslb6f/Rc=")
6975 sha256)
6976 @end lisp
6977
6978 Technically, @code{content-hash} is currently implemented as a macro.
6979 It performs sanity checks at macro-expansion time, when possible, such
6980 as ensuring that @var{value} has the right size for @var{algorithm}.
6981 @end deftp
6982
6983 As we have seen above, how exactly the data an origin refers to is
6984 retrieved is determined by its @code{method} field. The @code{(guix
6985 download)} module provides the most common method, @code{url-fetch},
6986 described below.
6987
6988 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} url-fetch @var{url} @var{hash-algo} @var{hash} @
6989 [name] [#:executable? #f]
6990 Return a fixed-output derivation that fetches data from @var{url} (a
6991 string, or a list of strings denoting alternate URLs), which is expected
6992 to have hash @var{hash} of type @var{hash-algo} (a symbol). By default,
6993 the file name is the base name of URL; optionally, @var{name} can
6994 specify a different file name. When @var{executable?} is true, make the
6995 downloaded file executable.
6996
6997 When one of the URL starts with @code{mirror://}, then its host part is
6998 interpreted as the name of a mirror scheme, taken from @file{%mirror-file}.
6999
7000 Alternatively, when URL starts with @code{file://}, return the
7001 corresponding file name in the store.
7002 @end deffn
7003
7004 Likewise, the @code{(guix git-download)} module defines the
7005 @code{git-fetch} origin method, which fetches data from a Git version
7006 control repository, and the @code{git-reference} data type to describe
7007 the repository and revision to fetch.
7008
7009 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} git-fetch @var{ref} @var{hash-algo} @var{hash}
7010 Return a fixed-output derivation that fetches @var{ref}, a
7011 @code{<git-reference>} object. The output is expected to have recursive
7012 hash @var{hash} of type @var{hash-algo} (a symbol). Use @var{name} as
7013 the file name, or a generic name if @code{#f}.
7014 @end deffn
7015
7016 @deftp {Data Type} git-reference
7017 This data type represents a Git reference for @code{git-fetch} to
7018 retrieve.
7019
7020 @table @asis
7021 @item @code{url}
7022 The URL of the Git repository to clone.
7023
7024 @item @code{commit}
7025 This string denotes either the commit to fetch (a hexadecimal string),
7026 or the tag to fetch. You can also use a ``short'' commit ID or a
7027 @command{git describe} style identifier such as
7028 @code{v1.0.1-10-g58d7909c97}.
7029
7030 @item @code{recursive?} (default: @code{#f})
7031 This Boolean indicates whether to recursively fetch Git sub-modules.
7032 @end table
7033
7034 The example below denotes the @code{v2.10} tag of the GNU@tie{}Hello
7035 repository:
7036
7037 @lisp
7038 (git-reference
7039 (url "https://git.savannah.gnu.org/git/hello.git")
7040 (commit "v2.10"))
7041 @end lisp
7042
7043 This is equivalent to the reference below, which explicitly names the
7044 commit:
7045
7046 @lisp
7047 (git-reference
7048 (url "https://git.savannah.gnu.org/git/hello.git")
7049 (commit "dc7dc56a00e48fe6f231a58f6537139fe2908fb9"))
7050 @end lisp
7051 @end deftp
7052
7053 For Mercurial repositories, the module @code{(guix hg-download)} defines
7054 the @code{hg-fetch} origin method and @code{hg-reference} data type for
7055 support of the Mercurial version control system.
7056
7057 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} hg-fetch @var{ref} @var{hash-algo} @var{hash} @
7058 [name]
7059 Return a fixed-output derivation that fetches @var{ref}, a
7060 @code{<hg-reference>} object. The output is expected to have recursive
7061 hash @var{hash} of type @var{hash-algo} (a symbol). Use @var{name} as
7062 the file name, or a generic name if @code{#false}.
7063 @end deffn
7064
7065 @node Defining Package Variants
7066 @section Defining Package Variants
7067
7068 @cindex customizing packages
7069 @cindex variants, of packages
7070 One of the nice things with Guix is that, given a package definition,
7071 you can easily @emph{derive} variants of that package---for a different
7072 upstream version, with different dependencies, different compilation
7073 options, and so on. Some of these custom packages can be defined
7074 straight from the command line (@pxref{Package Transformation Options}).
7075 This section describes how to define package variants in code. This can
7076 be useful in ``manifests'' (@pxref{profile-manifest,
7077 @option{--manifest}}) and in your own package collection
7078 (@pxref{Creating a Channel}), among others!
7079
7080 @cindex inherit, for package definitions
7081 As discussed earlier, packages are first-class objects in the Scheme
7082 language. The @code{(guix packages)} module provides the @code{package}
7083 construct to define new package objects (@pxref{package Reference}).
7084 The easiest way to define a package variant is using the @code{inherit}
7085 keyword together with @code{package}. This allows you to inherit from a
7086 package definition while overriding the fields you want.
7087
7088 For example, given the @code{hello} variable, which contains a
7089 definition for the current version of GNU@tie{}Hello, here's how you
7090 would define a variant for version 2.2 (released in 2006, it's
7091 vintage!):
7092
7093 @lisp
7094 (use-modules (gnu packages base)) ;for 'hello'
7095
7096 (define hello-2.2
7097 (package
7098 (inherit hello)
7099 (version "2.2")
7100 (source (origin
7101 (method url-fetch)
7102 (uri (string-append "mirror://gnu/hello/hello-" version
7103 ".tar.gz"))
7104 (sha256
7105 (base32
7106 "0lappv4slgb5spyqbh6yl5r013zv72yqg2pcl30mginf3wdqd8k9"))))))
7107 @end lisp
7108
7109 The example above corresponds to what the @option{--with-source} package
7110 transformation option does. Essentially @code{hello-2.2} preserves all
7111 the fields of @code{hello}, except @code{version} and @code{source},
7112 which it overrides. Note that the original @code{hello} variable is
7113 still there, in the @code{(gnu packages base)} module, unchanged. When
7114 you define a custom package like this, you are really @emph{adding} a
7115 new package definition; the original one remains available.
7116
7117 You can just as well define variants with a different set of
7118 dependencies than the original package. For example, the default
7119 @code{gdb} package depends on @code{guile}, but since that is an
7120 optional dependency, you can define a variant that removes that
7121 dependency like so:
7122
7123 @lisp
7124 (use-modules (gnu packages gdb) ;for 'gdb'
7125 (srfi srfi-1)) ;for 'alist-delete'
7126
7127 (define gdb-sans-guile
7128 (package
7129 (inherit gdb)
7130 (inputs (alist-delete "guile"
7131 (package-inputs gdb)))))
7132 @end lisp
7133
7134 The @code{alist-delete} call above removes the tuple from the
7135 @code{inputs} field that has @code{"guile"} as its first element
7136 (@pxref{SRFI-1 Association Lists,,, guile, GNU Guile Reference
7137 Manual}).
7138
7139 In some cases, you may find it useful to write functions
7140 (``procedures'', in Scheme parlance) that return a package based on some
7141 parameters. For example, consider the @code{luasocket} library for the
7142 Lua programming language. We want to create @code{luasocket} packages
7143 for major versions of Lua. One way to do that is to define a procedure
7144 that takes a Lua package and returns a @code{luasocket} package that
7145 depends on it:
7146
7147 @lisp
7148 (define (make-lua-socket name lua)
7149 ;; Return a luasocket package built with LUA.
7150 (package
7151 (name name)
7152 (version "3.0")
7153 ;; several fields omitted
7154 (inputs
7155 `(("lua" ,lua)))
7156 (synopsis "Socket library for Lua")))
7157
7158 (define-public lua5.1-socket
7159 (make-lua-socket "lua5.1-socket" lua-5.1))
7160
7161 (define-public lua5.2-socket
7162 (make-lua-socket "lua5.2-socket" lua-5.2))
7163 @end lisp
7164
7165 Here we have defined packages @code{lua5.1-socket} and
7166 @code{lua5.2-socket} by calling @code{make-lua-socket} with different
7167 arguments. @xref{Procedures,,, guile, GNU Guile Reference Manual}, for
7168 more info on procedures. Having top-level public definitions for these
7169 two packages means that they can be referred to from the command line
7170 (@pxref{Package Modules}).
7171
7172 @cindex package transformations
7173 These are pretty simple package variants. As a convenience, the
7174 @code{(guix transformations)} module provides a high-level interface
7175 that directly maps to the more sophisticated package transformation
7176 options (@pxref{Package Transformation Options}):
7177
7178 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} options->transformation @var{opts}
7179 Return a procedure that, when passed an object to build (package,
7180 derivation, etc.), applies the transformations specified by @var{opts} and returns
7181 the resulting objects. @var{opts} must be a list of symbol/string pairs such as:
7182
7183 @lisp
7184 ((with-branch . "guile-gcrypt=master")
7185 (without-tests . "libgcrypt"))
7186 @end lisp
7187
7188 Each symbol names a transformation and the corresponding string is an argument
7189 to that transformation.
7190 @end deffn
7191
7192 For instance, a manifest equivalent to this command:
7193
7194 @example
7195 guix build guix \
7196 --with-branch=guile-gcrypt=master \
7197 --with-debug-info=zlib
7198 @end example
7199
7200 @noindent
7201 ... would look like this:
7202
7203 @lisp
7204 (use-modules (guix transformations))
7205
7206 (define transform
7207 ;; The package transformation procedure.
7208 (options->transformation
7209 '((with-branch . "guile-gcrypt=master")
7210 (with-debug-info . "zlib"))))
7211
7212 (packages->manifest
7213 (list (transform (specification->package "guix"))))
7214 @end lisp
7215
7216 @cindex input rewriting
7217 @cindex dependency graph rewriting
7218 The @code{options->transformation} procedure is convenient, but it's
7219 perhaps also not as flexible as you may like. How is it implemented?
7220 The astute reader probably noticed that most package transformation
7221 options go beyond the superficial changes shown in the first examples of
7222 this section: they involve @dfn{input rewriting}, whereby the dependency
7223 graph of a package is rewritten by replacing specific inputs by others.
7224
7225 Dependency graph rewriting, for the purposes of swapping packages in the
7226 graph, is what the @code{package-input-rewriting} procedure in
7227 @code{(guix packages)} implements.
7228
7229 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} package-input-rewriting @var{replacements} @
7230 [@var{rewrite-name}] [#:deep? #t]
7231 Return a procedure that, when passed a package, replaces its direct and
7232 indirect dependencies, including implicit inputs when @var{deep?} is
7233 true, according to @var{replacements}. @var{replacements} is a list of
7234 package pairs; the first element of each pair is the package to replace,
7235 and the second one is the replacement.
7236
7237 Optionally, @var{rewrite-name} is a one-argument procedure that takes
7238 the name of a package and returns its new name after rewrite.
7239 @end deffn
7240
7241 @noindent
7242 Consider this example:
7243
7244 @lisp
7245 (define libressl-instead-of-openssl
7246 ;; This is a procedure to replace OPENSSL by LIBRESSL,
7247 ;; recursively.
7248 (package-input-rewriting `((,openssl . ,libressl))))
7249
7250 (define git-with-libressl
7251 (libressl-instead-of-openssl git))
7252 @end lisp
7253
7254 @noindent
7255 Here we first define a rewriting procedure that replaces @var{openssl}
7256 with @var{libressl}. Then we use it to define a @dfn{variant} of the
7257 @var{git} package that uses @var{libressl} instead of @var{openssl}.
7258 This is exactly what the @option{--with-input} command-line option does
7259 (@pxref{Package Transformation Options, @option{--with-input}}).
7260
7261 The following variant of @code{package-input-rewriting} can match packages to
7262 be replaced by name rather than by identity.
7263
7264 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} package-input-rewriting/spec @var{replacements} [#:deep? #t]
7265 Return a procedure that, given a package, applies the given
7266 @var{replacements} to all the package graph, including implicit inputs
7267 unless @var{deep?} is false. @var{replacements} is a list of
7268 spec/procedures pair; each spec is a package specification such as
7269 @code{"gcc"} or @code{"guile@@2"}, and each procedure takes a matching
7270 package and returns a replacement for that package.
7271 @end deffn
7272
7273 The example above could be rewritten this way:
7274
7275 @lisp
7276 (define libressl-instead-of-openssl
7277 ;; Replace all the packages called "openssl" with LibreSSL.
7278 (package-input-rewriting/spec `(("openssl" . ,(const libressl)))))
7279 @end lisp
7280
7281 The key difference here is that, this time, packages are matched by spec and
7282 not by identity. In other words, any package in the graph that is called
7283 @code{openssl} will be replaced.
7284
7285 A more generic procedure to rewrite a package dependency graph is
7286 @code{package-mapping}: it supports arbitrary changes to nodes in the
7287 graph.
7288
7289 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} package-mapping @var{proc} [@var{cut?}] [#:deep? #f]
7290 Return a procedure that, given a package, applies @var{proc} to all the packages
7291 depended on and returns the resulting package. The procedure stops recursion
7292 when @var{cut?} returns true for a given package. When @var{deep?} is true, @var{proc} is
7293 applied to implicit inputs as well.
7294 @end deffn
7295
7296
7297 @node Build Systems
7298 @section Build Systems
7299
7300 @cindex build system
7301 Each package definition specifies a @dfn{build system} and arguments for
7302 that build system (@pxref{Defining Packages}). This @code{build-system}
7303 field represents the build procedure of the package, as well as implicit
7304 dependencies of that build procedure.
7305
7306 Build systems are @code{<build-system>} objects. The interface to
7307 create and manipulate them is provided by the @code{(guix build-system)}
7308 module, and actual build systems are exported by specific modules.
7309
7310 @cindex bag (low-level package representation)
7311 Under the hood, build systems first compile package objects to
7312 @dfn{bags}. A @dfn{bag} is like a package, but with less
7313 ornamentation---in other words, a bag is a lower-level representation of
7314 a package, which includes all the inputs of that package, including some
7315 that were implicitly added by the build system. This intermediate
7316 representation is then compiled to a derivation (@pxref{Derivations}).
7317 The @code{package-with-c-toolchain} is an example of a way to change the
7318 implicit inputs that a package's build system pulls in (@pxref{package
7319 Reference, @code{package-with-c-toolchain}}).
7320
7321 Build systems accept an optional list of @dfn{arguments}. In package
7322 definitions, these are passed @i{via} the @code{arguments} field
7323 (@pxref{Defining Packages}). They are typically keyword arguments
7324 (@pxref{Optional Arguments, keyword arguments in Guile,, guile, GNU
7325 Guile Reference Manual}). The value of these arguments is usually
7326 evaluated in the @dfn{build stratum}---i.e., by a Guile process launched
7327 by the daemon (@pxref{Derivations}).
7328
7329 The main build system is @code{gnu-build-system}, which implements the
7330 standard build procedure for GNU and many other packages. It
7331 is provided by the @code{(guix build-system gnu)} module.
7332
7333 @defvr {Scheme Variable} gnu-build-system
7334 @code{gnu-build-system} represents the GNU Build System, and variants
7335 thereof (@pxref{Configuration, configuration and makefile conventions,,
7336 standards, GNU Coding Standards}).
7337
7338 @cindex build phases
7339 In a nutshell, packages using it are configured, built, and installed with
7340 the usual @code{./configure && make && make check && make install}
7341 command sequence. In practice, a few additional steps are often needed.
7342 All these steps are split up in separate @dfn{phases}.
7343 @xref{Build Phases}, for more info on build phases and ways to customize
7344 them.
7345
7346 In addition, this build system ensures that the ``standard'' environment
7347 for GNU packages is available. This includes tools such as GCC, libc,
7348 Coreutils, Bash, Make, Diffutils, grep, and sed (see the @code{(guix
7349 build-system gnu)} module for a complete list). We call these the
7350 @dfn{implicit inputs} of a package, because package definitions do not
7351 have to mention them.
7352
7353 This build system supports a number of keyword arguments, which can be
7354 passed @i{via} the @code{arguments} field of a package. Here are some
7355 of the main parameters:
7356
7357 @table @code
7358 @item #:phases
7359 This argument specifies build-side code that evaluates to an alist of
7360 build phases. @xref{Build Phases}, for more information.
7361
7362 @item #:configure-flags
7363 This is a list of flags (strings) passed to the @command{configure}
7364 script. @xref{Defining Packages}, for an example.
7365
7366 @item #:make-flags
7367 This list of strings contains flags passed as arguments to
7368 @command{make} invocations in the @code{build}, @code{check}, and
7369 @code{install} phases.
7370
7371 @item #:out-of-source?
7372 This Boolean, @code{#f} by default, indicates whether to run builds in a
7373 build directory separate from the source tree.
7374
7375 When it is true, the @code{configure} phase creates a separate build
7376 directory, changes to that directory, and runs the @code{configure}
7377 script from there. This is useful for packages that require it, such as
7378 @code{glibc}.
7379
7380 @item #:tests?
7381 This Boolean, @code{#t} by default, indicates whether the @code{check}
7382 phase should run the package's test suite.
7383
7384 @item #:test-target
7385 This string, @code{"check"} by default, gives the name of the makefile
7386 target used by the @code{check} phase.
7387
7388 @item #:parallel-build?
7389 @itemx #:parallel-tests?
7390 These Boolean values specify whether to build, respectively run the test
7391 suite, in parallel, with the @code{-j} flag of @command{make}. When
7392 they are true, @code{make} is passed @code{-j@var{n}}, where @var{n} is
7393 the number specified as the @option{--cores} option of
7394 @command{guix-daemon} or that of the @command{guix} client command
7395 (@pxref{Common Build Options, @option{--cores}}).
7396
7397 @cindex RUNPATH, validation
7398 @item #:validate-runpath?
7399 This Boolean, @code{#t} by default, determines whether to ``validate''
7400 the @code{RUNPATH} of ELF binaries (@code{.so} shared libraries as well
7401 as executables) previously installed by the @code{install} phase.
7402
7403 This validation step consists in making sure that all the shared
7404 libraries needed by an ELF binary, which are listed as
7405 @code{DT_NEEDED} entries in its @code{PT_DYNAMIC} segment, appear in the
7406 @code{DT_RUNPATH} entry of that binary. In other words, it ensures that
7407 running or using those binaries will not result in a ``file not found''
7408 error at run time. @xref{Options, @option{-rpath},, ld, The GNU
7409 Linker}, for more information on @code{RUNPATH}.
7410
7411 @item #:substitutable?
7412 This Boolean, @code{#t} by default, tells whether the package outputs
7413 should be substitutable---i.e., whether users should be able to obtain
7414 substitutes for them instead of building locally (@pxref{Substitutes}).
7415
7416 @item #:allowed-references
7417 @itemx #:disallowed-references
7418 When true, these arguments must be a list of dependencies that must not
7419 appear among the references of the build results. If, upon build
7420 completion, some of these references are retained, the build process
7421 fails.
7422
7423 This is useful to ensure that a package does not erroneously keep a
7424 reference to some of it build-time inputs, in cases where doing so
7425 would, for example, unnecessarily increase its size (@pxref{Invoking
7426 guix size}).
7427 @end table
7428
7429 Most other build systems support these keyword arguments.
7430 @end defvr
7431
7432 Other @code{<build-system>} objects are defined to support other
7433 conventions and tools used by free software packages. They inherit most
7434 of @code{gnu-build-system}, and differ mainly in the set of inputs
7435 implicitly added to the build process, and in the list of phases
7436 executed. Some of these build systems are listed below.
7437
7438 @defvr {Scheme Variable} ant-build-system
7439 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system ant)}. It
7440 implements the build procedure for Java packages that can be built with
7441 @url{https://ant.apache.org/, Ant build tool}.
7442
7443 It adds both @code{ant} and the @dfn{Java Development Kit} (JDK) as
7444 provided by the @code{icedtea} package to the set of inputs. Different
7445 packages can be specified with the @code{#:ant} and @code{#:jdk}
7446 parameters, respectively.
7447
7448 When the original package does not provide a suitable Ant build file,
7449 the parameter @code{#:jar-name} can be used to generate a minimal Ant
7450 build file @file{build.xml} with tasks to build the specified jar
7451 archive. In this case the parameter @code{#:source-dir} can be used to
7452 specify the source sub-directory, defaulting to ``src''.
7453
7454 The @code{#:main-class} parameter can be used with the minimal ant
7455 buildfile to specify the main class of the resulting jar. This makes the
7456 jar file executable. The @code{#:test-include} parameter can be used to
7457 specify the list of junit tests to run. It defaults to
7458 @code{(list "**/*Test.java")}. The @code{#:test-exclude} can be used to
7459 disable some tests. It defaults to @code{(list "**/Abstract*.java")},
7460 because abstract classes cannot be run as tests.
7461
7462 The parameter @code{#:build-target} can be used to specify the Ant task
7463 that should be run during the @code{build} phase. By default the
7464 ``jar'' task will be run.
7465
7466 @end defvr
7467
7468 @defvr {Scheme Variable} android-ndk-build-system
7469 @cindex Android distribution
7470 @cindex Android NDK build system
7471 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system android-ndk)}. It
7472 implements a build procedure for Android NDK (native development kit)
7473 packages using a Guix-specific build process.
7474
7475 The build system assumes that packages install their public interface
7476 (header) files to the subdirectory @file{include} of the @code{out} output and
7477 their libraries to the subdirectory @file{lib} the @code{out} output.
7478
7479 It's also assumed that the union of all the dependencies of a package
7480 has no conflicting files.
7481
7482 For the time being, cross-compilation is not supported - so right now
7483 the libraries and header files are assumed to be host tools.
7484
7485 @end defvr
7486
7487 @defvr {Scheme Variable} asdf-build-system/source
7488 @defvrx {Scheme Variable} asdf-build-system/sbcl
7489 @defvrx {Scheme Variable} asdf-build-system/ecl
7490
7491 These variables, exported by @code{(guix build-system asdf)}, implement
7492 build procedures for Common Lisp packages using
7493 @url{https://common-lisp.net/project/asdf/, ``ASDF''}. ASDF is a system
7494 definition facility for Common Lisp programs and libraries.
7495
7496 The @code{asdf-build-system/source} system installs the packages in
7497 source form, and can be loaded using any common lisp implementation, via
7498 ASDF@. The others, such as @code{asdf-build-system/sbcl}, install binary
7499 systems in the format which a particular implementation understands.
7500 These build systems can also be used to produce executable programs, or
7501 lisp images which contain a set of packages pre-loaded.
7502
7503 The build system uses naming conventions. For binary packages, the
7504 package name should be prefixed with the lisp implementation, such as
7505 @code{sbcl-} for @code{asdf-build-system/sbcl}.
7506
7507 Additionally, the corresponding source package should be labeled using
7508 the same convention as python packages (see @ref{Python Modules}), using
7509 the @code{cl-} prefix.
7510
7511 In order to create executable programs and images, the build-side
7512 procedures @code{build-program} and @code{build-image} can be used.
7513 They should be called in a build phase after the
7514 @code{create-asdf-configuration} phase, so that the system which was
7515 just built can be used within the resulting image. @code{build-program}
7516 requires a list of Common Lisp expressions to be passed as the
7517 @code{#:entry-program} argument.
7518
7519 By default, all the @file{.asd} files present in the sources are read to
7520 find system definitions. The @code{#:asd-files} parameter can be used
7521 to specify the list of @file{.asd} files to read. Furthermore, if the
7522 package defines a system for its tests in a separate file, it will be
7523 loaded before the tests are run if it is specified by the
7524 @code{#:test-asd-file} parameter. If it is not set, the files
7525 @code{<system>-tests.asd}, @code{<system>-test.asd}, @code{tests.asd},
7526 and @code{test.asd} will be tried if they exist.
7527
7528 If for some reason the package must be named in a different way than the
7529 naming conventions suggest, or if several systems must be compiled, the
7530 @code{#:asd-systems} parameter can be used to specify the list of system
7531 names.
7532
7533 @end defvr
7534
7535 @defvr {Scheme Variable} cargo-build-system
7536 @cindex Rust programming language
7537 @cindex Cargo (Rust build system)
7538 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system cargo)}. It
7539 supports builds of packages using Cargo, the build tool of the
7540 @uref{https://www.rust-lang.org, Rust programming language}.
7541
7542 It adds @code{rustc} and @code{cargo} to the set of inputs.
7543 A different Rust package can be specified with the @code{#:rust} parameter.
7544
7545 Regular cargo dependencies should be added to the package definition similarly
7546 to other packages; those needed only at build time to native-inputs, others to
7547 inputs. If you need to add source-only crates then you should add them to via
7548 the @code{#:cargo-inputs} parameter as a list of name and spec pairs, where the
7549 spec can be a package or a source definition. Note that the spec must
7550 evaluate to a path to a gzipped tarball which includes a @code{Cargo.toml}
7551 file at its root, or it will be ignored. Similarly, cargo dev-dependencies
7552 should be added to the package definition via the
7553 @code{#:cargo-development-inputs} parameter.
7554
7555 In its @code{configure} phase, this build system will make any source inputs
7556 specified in the @code{#:cargo-inputs} and @code{#:cargo-development-inputs}
7557 parameters available to cargo. It will also remove an included
7558 @code{Cargo.lock} file to be recreated by @code{cargo} during the
7559 @code{build} phase. The @code{package} phase will run @code{cargo package}
7560 to create a source crate for future use. The @code{install} phase installs
7561 the binaries defined by the crate. Unless @code{install-source? #f} is
7562 defined it will also install a source crate repository of itself and unpacked
7563 sources, to ease in future hacking on rust packages.
7564 @end defvr
7565
7566 @defvr {Scheme Variable} chicken-build-system
7567 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system chicken)}. It
7568 builds @uref{https://call-cc.org/, CHICKEN Scheme} modules, also called
7569 ``eggs'' or ``extensions''. CHICKEN generates C source code, which then
7570 gets compiled by a C compiler, in this case GCC.
7571
7572 This build system adds @code{chicken} to the package inputs, as well as
7573 the packages of @code{gnu-build-system}.
7574
7575 The build system can't (yet) deduce the egg's name automatically, so just like
7576 with @code{go-build-system} and its @code{#:import-path}, you should define
7577 @code{#:egg-name} in the package's @code{arguments} field.
7578
7579 For example, if you are packaging the @code{srfi-1} egg:
7580
7581 @lisp
7582 (arguments '(#:egg-name "srfi-1"))
7583 @end lisp
7584
7585 Egg dependencies must be defined in @code{propagated-inputs}, not @code{inputs}
7586 because CHICKEN doesn't embed absolute references in compiled eggs.
7587 Test dependencies should go to @code{native-inputs}, as usual.
7588 @end defvr
7589
7590 @defvr {Scheme Variable} copy-build-system
7591 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system copy)}. It
7592 supports builds of simple packages that don't require much compiling,
7593 mostly just moving files around.
7594
7595 It adds much of the @code{gnu-build-system} packages to the set of
7596 inputs. Because of this, the @code{copy-build-system} does not require
7597 all the boilerplate code often needed for the
7598 @code{trivial-build-system}.
7599
7600 To further simplify the file installation process, an
7601 @code{#:install-plan} argument is exposed to let the packager specify
7602 which files go where. The install plan is a list of @code{(@var{source}
7603 @var{target} [@var{filters}])}. @var{filters} are optional.
7604
7605 @itemize
7606 @item When @var{source} matches a file or directory without trailing slash, install it to @var{target}.
7607 @itemize
7608 @item If @var{target} has a trailing slash, install @var{source} basename beneath @var{target}.
7609 @item Otherwise install @var{source} as @var{target}.
7610 @end itemize
7611
7612 @item When @var{source} is a directory with a trailing slash, or when @var{filters} are used,
7613 the trailing slash of @var{target} is implied with the same meaning
7614 as above.
7615 @itemize
7616 @item Without @var{filters}, install the full @var{source} @emph{content} to @var{target}.
7617 @item With @var{filters} among @code{#:include}, @code{#:include-regexp}, @code{#:exclude},
7618 @code{#:exclude-regexp}, only select files are installed depending on
7619 the filters. Each filters is specified by a list of strings.
7620 @itemize
7621 @item With @code{#:include}, install all the files which the path suffix matches
7622 at least one of the elements in the given list.
7623 @item With @code{#:include-regexp}, install all the files which the
7624 subpaths match at least one of the regular expressions in the given
7625 list.
7626 @item The @code{#:exclude} and @code{#:exclude-regexp} filters
7627 are the complement of their inclusion counterpart. Without @code{#:include} flags,
7628 install all files but those matching the exclusion filters.
7629 If both inclusions and exclusions are specified, the exclusions are done
7630 on top of the inclusions.
7631 @end itemize
7632 @end itemize
7633 In all cases, the paths relative to @var{source} are preserved within
7634 @var{target}.
7635 @end itemize
7636
7637 Examples:
7638
7639 @itemize
7640 @item @code{("foo/bar" "share/my-app/")}: Install @file{bar} to @file{share/my-app/bar}.
7641 @item @code{("foo/bar" "share/my-app/baz")}: Install @file{bar} to @file{share/my-app/baz}.
7642 @item @code{("foo/" "share/my-app")}: Install the content of @file{foo} inside @file{share/my-app},
7643 e.g., install @file{foo/sub/file} to @file{share/my-app/sub/file}.
7644 @item @code{("foo/" "share/my-app" #:include ("sub/file"))}: Install only @file{foo/sub/file} to
7645 @file{share/my-app/sub/file}.
7646 @item @code{("foo/sub" "share/my-app" #:include ("file"))}: Install @file{foo/sub/file} to
7647 @file{share/my-app/file}.
7648 @end itemize
7649 @end defvr
7650
7651
7652 @cindex Clojure (programming language)
7653 @cindex simple Clojure build system
7654 @defvr {Scheme Variable} clojure-build-system
7655 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system clojure)}. It implements
7656 a simple build procedure for @uref{https://clojure.org/, Clojure} packages
7657 using plain old @code{compile} in Clojure. Cross-compilation is not supported
7658 yet.
7659
7660 It adds @code{clojure}, @code{icedtea} and @code{zip} to the set of inputs.
7661 Different packages can be specified with the @code{#:clojure}, @code{#:jdk} and
7662 @code{#:zip} parameters, respectively.
7663
7664 A list of source directories, test directories and jar names can be specified
7665 with the @code{#:source-dirs}, @code{#:test-dirs} and @code{#:jar-names}
7666 parameters, respectively. Compile directory and main class can be specified
7667 with the @code{#:compile-dir} and @code{#:main-class} parameters, respectively.
7668 Other parameters are documented below.
7669
7670 This build system is an extension of @code{ant-build-system}, but with the
7671 following phases changed:
7672
7673 @table @code
7674
7675 @item build
7676 This phase calls @code{compile} in Clojure to compile source files and runs
7677 @command{jar} to create jars from both source files and compiled files
7678 according to the include list and exclude list specified in
7679 @code{#:aot-include} and @code{#:aot-exclude}, respectively. The exclude list
7680 has priority over the include list. These lists consist of symbols
7681 representing Clojure libraries or the special keyword @code{#:all} representing
7682 all Clojure libraries found under the source directories. The parameter
7683 @code{#:omit-source?} decides if source should be included into the jars.
7684
7685 @item check
7686 This phase runs tests according to the include list and exclude list specified
7687 in @code{#:test-include} and @code{#:test-exclude}, respectively. Their
7688 meanings are analogous to that of @code{#:aot-include} and
7689 @code{#:aot-exclude}, except that the special keyword @code{#:all} now
7690 stands for all Clojure libraries found under the test directories. The
7691 parameter @code{#:tests?} decides if tests should be run.
7692
7693 @item install
7694 This phase installs all jars built previously.
7695 @end table
7696
7697 Apart from the above, this build system also contains an additional phase:
7698
7699 @table @code
7700
7701 @item install-doc
7702 This phase installs all top-level files with base name matching
7703 @code{%doc-regex}. A different regex can be specified with the
7704 @code{#:doc-regex} parameter. All files (recursively) inside the documentation
7705 directories specified in @code{#:doc-dirs} are installed as well.
7706 @end table
7707 @end defvr
7708
7709 @defvr {Scheme Variable} cmake-build-system
7710 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system cmake)}. It
7711 implements the build procedure for packages using the
7712 @url{https://www.cmake.org, CMake build tool}.
7713
7714 It automatically adds the @code{cmake} package to the set of inputs.
7715 Which package is used can be specified with the @code{#:cmake}
7716 parameter.
7717
7718 The @code{#:configure-flags} parameter is taken as a list of flags
7719 passed to the @command{cmake} command. The @code{#:build-type}
7720 parameter specifies in abstract terms the flags passed to the compiler;
7721 it defaults to @code{"RelWithDebInfo"} (short for ``release mode with
7722 debugging information''), which roughly means that code is compiled with
7723 @code{-O2 -g}, as is the case for Autoconf-based packages by default.
7724 @end defvr
7725
7726 @defvr {Scheme Variable} dune-build-system
7727 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system dune)}. It
7728 supports builds of packages using @uref{https://dune.build/, Dune}, a build
7729 tool for the OCaml programming language. It is implemented as an extension
7730 of the @code{ocaml-build-system} which is described below. As such, the
7731 @code{#:ocaml} and @code{#:findlib} parameters can be passed to this build
7732 system.
7733
7734 It automatically adds the @code{dune} package to the set of inputs.
7735 Which package is used can be specified with the @code{#:dune}
7736 parameter.
7737
7738 There is no @code{configure} phase because dune packages typically don't
7739 need to be configured. The @code{#:build-flags} parameter is taken as a
7740 list of flags passed to the @code{dune} command during the build.
7741
7742 The @code{#:jbuild?} parameter can be passed to use the @code{jbuild}
7743 command instead of the more recent @code{dune} command while building
7744 a package. Its default value is @code{#f}.
7745
7746 The @code{#:package} parameter can be passed to specify a package name, which
7747 is useful when a package contains multiple packages and you want to build
7748 only one of them. This is equivalent to passing the @code{-p} argument to
7749 @code{dune}.
7750
7751 @end defvr
7752
7753 @defvr {Scheme Variable} go-build-system
7754 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system go)}. It
7755 implements a build procedure for Go packages using the standard
7756 @url{https://golang.org/cmd/go/#hdr-Compile_packages_and_dependencies,
7757 Go build mechanisms}.
7758
7759 The user is expected to provide a value for the key @code{#:import-path}
7760 and, in some cases, @code{#:unpack-path}. The
7761 @url{https://golang.org/doc/code.html#ImportPaths, import path}
7762 corresponds to the file system path expected by the package's build
7763 scripts and any referring packages, and provides a unique way to
7764 refer to a Go package. It is typically based on a combination of the
7765 package source code's remote URI and file system hierarchy structure. In
7766 some cases, you will need to unpack the package's source code to a
7767 different directory structure than the one indicated by the import path,
7768 and @code{#:unpack-path} should be used in such cases.
7769
7770 Packages that provide Go libraries should install their source code into
7771 the built output. The key @code{#:install-source?}, which defaults to
7772 @code{#t}, controls whether or not the source code is installed. It can
7773 be set to @code{#f} for packages that only provide executable files.
7774
7775 Packages can be cross-built, and if a specific architecture or operating
7776 system is desired then the keywords @code{#:goarch} and @code{#:goos}
7777 can be used to force the package to be built for that architecture and
7778 operating system. The combinations known to Go can be found
7779 @url{"https://golang.org/doc/install/source#environment", in their
7780 documentation}.
7781 @end defvr
7782
7783 @defvr {Scheme Variable} glib-or-gtk-build-system
7784 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system glib-or-gtk)}. It
7785 is intended for use with packages making use of GLib or GTK+.
7786
7787 This build system adds the following two phases to the ones defined by
7788 @code{gnu-build-system}:
7789
7790 @table @code
7791 @item glib-or-gtk-wrap
7792 The phase @code{glib-or-gtk-wrap} ensures that programs in
7793 @file{bin/} are able to find GLib ``schemas'' and
7794 @uref{https://developer.gnome.org/gtk3/stable/gtk-running.html, GTK+
7795 modules}. This is achieved by wrapping the programs in launch scripts
7796 that appropriately set the @env{XDG_DATA_DIRS} and @env{GTK_PATH}
7797 environment variables.
7798
7799 It is possible to exclude specific package outputs from that wrapping
7800 process by listing their names in the
7801 @code{#:glib-or-gtk-wrap-excluded-outputs} parameter. This is useful
7802 when an output is known not to contain any GLib or GTK+ binaries, and
7803 where wrapping would gratuitously add a dependency of that output on
7804 GLib and GTK+.
7805
7806 @item glib-or-gtk-compile-schemas
7807 The phase @code{glib-or-gtk-compile-schemas} makes sure that all
7808 @uref{https://developer.gnome.org/gio/stable/glib-compile-schemas.html,
7809 GSettings schemas} of GLib are compiled. Compilation is performed by the
7810 @command{glib-compile-schemas} program. It is provided by the package
7811 @code{glib:bin} which is automatically imported by the build system.
7812 The @code{glib} package providing @command{glib-compile-schemas} can be
7813 specified with the @code{#:glib} parameter.
7814 @end table
7815
7816 Both phases are executed after the @code{install} phase.
7817 @end defvr
7818
7819 @defvr {Scheme Variable} guile-build-system
7820 This build system is for Guile packages that consist exclusively of Scheme
7821 code and that are so lean that they don't even have a makefile, let alone a
7822 @file{configure} script. It compiles Scheme code using @command{guild
7823 compile} (@pxref{Compilation,,, guile, GNU Guile Reference Manual}) and
7824 installs the @file{.scm} and @file{.go} files in the right place. It also
7825 installs documentation.
7826
7827 This build system supports cross-compilation by using the
7828 @option{--target} option of @samp{guild compile}.
7829
7830 Packages built with @code{guile-build-system} must provide a Guile package in
7831 their @code{native-inputs} field.
7832 @end defvr
7833
7834 @defvr {Scheme Variable} julia-build-system
7835 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system julia)}. It
7836 implements the build procedure used by @uref{https://julialang.org/,
7837 julia} packages, which essentially is similar to running @samp{julia -e
7838 'using Pkg; Pkg.add(package)'} in an environment where
7839 @env{JULIA_LOAD_PATH} contains the paths to all Julia package inputs.
7840 Tests are run by calling @code{/test/runtests.jl}.
7841
7842 The Julia package name is read from the file @file{Project.toml}. This
7843 value can be overridden by passing the argument @code{#:julia-package-name}
7844 (which must be correctly capitalized).
7845
7846 Julia packages usually manage their binary dependencies via
7847 @code{JLLWrappers.jl}, a Julia package that creates a module (named
7848 after the wrapped library followed by @code{_jll.jl}.
7849
7850 To add the binary path @code{_jll.jl} packages, you need to patch the
7851 files under @file{src/wrappers/}, replacing the call to the macro
7852 @code{JLLWrappers.@@generate_wrapper_header}, adding as a second
7853 argument containing the store path the binary.
7854
7855 As an example, in the MbedTLS Julia package, we add a build phase
7856 (@pxref{Build Phases}) to insert the absolute file name of the wrapped
7857 MbedTLS package:
7858
7859 @lisp
7860 (add-after 'unpack 'override-binary-path
7861 (lambda* (#:key inputs #:allow-other-keys)
7862 (for-each (lambda (wrapper)
7863 (substitute* wrapper
7864 (("generate_wrapper_header.*")
7865 (string-append
7866 "generate_wrapper_header(\"MbedTLS\", \""
7867 (assoc-ref inputs "mbedtls-apache") "\")\n"))))
7868 ;; There's a Julia file for each platform, override them all.
7869 (find-files "src/wrappers/" "\\.jl$"))))
7870 @end lisp
7871
7872 Some older packages that aren't using @file{Package.toml} yet, will require
7873 this file to be created, too. The function @code{julia-create-package-toml}
7874 helps creating the file. You need to pass the outputs and the source of the
7875 package, its name (the same as the @code{file-name} parameter), the package
7876 uuid, the package version, and a list of dependencies specified by their name
7877 and their uuid.
7878 @end defvr
7879
7880 @defvr {Scheme Variable} maven-build-system
7881 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system maven)}. It implements
7882 a build procedure for @uref{https://maven.apache.org, Maven} packages. Maven
7883 is a dependency and lifecycle management tool for Java. A user of Maven
7884 specifies dependencies and plugins in a @file{pom.xml} file that Maven reads.
7885 When Maven does not have one of the dependencies or plugins in its repository,
7886 it will download them and use them to build the package.
7887
7888 The maven build system ensures that maven will not try to download any
7889 dependency by running in offline mode. Maven will fail if a dependency is
7890 missing. Before running Maven, the @file{pom.xml} (and subprojects) are
7891 modified to specify the version of dependencies and plugins that match the
7892 versions available in the guix build environment. Dependencies and plugins
7893 must be installed in the fake maven repository at @file{lib/m2}, and are
7894 symlinked into a proper repository before maven is run. Maven is instructed
7895 to use that repository for the build and installs built artifacts there.
7896 Changed files are copied to the @file{lib/m2} directory of the package output.
7897
7898 You can specify a @file{pom.xml} file with the @code{#:pom-file} argument,
7899 or let the build system use the default @file{pom.xml} file in the sources.
7900
7901 In case you need to specify a dependency's version manually, you can use the
7902 @code{#:local-packages} argument. It takes an association list where the key
7903 is the groupId of the package and its value is an association list where the
7904 key is the artifactId of the package and its value is the version you want to
7905 override in the @file{pom.xml}.
7906
7907 Some packages use dependencies or plugins that are not useful at runtime nor
7908 at build time in Guix. You can alter the @file{pom.xml} file to remove them
7909 using the @code{#:exclude} argument. Its value is an association list where
7910 the key is the groupId of the plugin or dependency you want to remove, and
7911 the value is a list of artifactId you want to remove.
7912
7913 You can override the default @code{jdk} and @code{maven} packages with the
7914 corresponding argument, @code{#:jdk} and @code{#:maven}.
7915
7916 The @code{#:maven-plugins} argument is a list of maven plugins used during
7917 the build, with the same format as the @code{inputs} fields of the package
7918 declaration. Its default value is @code{(default-maven-plugins)} which is
7919 also exported.
7920 @end defvr
7921
7922 @defvr {Scheme Variable} minetest-mod-build-system
7923 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system minetest)}. It
7924 implements a build procedure for @uref{https://www.minetest.net, Minetest}
7925 mods, which consists of copying Lua code, images and other resources to
7926 the location Minetest searches for mods. The build system also minimises
7927 PNG images and verifies that Minetest can load the mod without errors.
7928 @end defvr
7929
7930 @defvr {Scheme Variable} minify-build-system
7931 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system minify)}. It
7932 implements a minification procedure for simple JavaScript packages.
7933
7934 It adds @code{uglify-js} to the set of inputs and uses it to compress
7935 all JavaScript files in the @file{src} directory. A different minifier
7936 package can be specified with the @code{#:uglify-js} parameter, but it
7937 is expected that the package writes the minified code to the standard
7938 output.
7939
7940 When the input JavaScript files are not all located in the @file{src}
7941 directory, the parameter @code{#:javascript-files} can be used to
7942 specify a list of file names to feed to the minifier.
7943 @end defvr
7944
7945 @defvr {Scheme Variable} ocaml-build-system
7946 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system ocaml)}. It implements
7947 a build procedure for @uref{https://ocaml.org, OCaml} packages, which consists
7948 of choosing the correct set of commands to run for each package. OCaml
7949 packages can expect many different commands to be run. This build system will
7950 try some of them.
7951
7952 When the package has a @file{setup.ml} file present at the top-level, it will
7953 run @code{ocaml setup.ml -configure}, @code{ocaml setup.ml -build} and
7954 @code{ocaml setup.ml -install}. The build system will assume that this file
7955 was generated by @uref{http://oasis.forge.ocamlcore.org/, OASIS} and will take
7956 care of setting the prefix and enabling tests if they are not disabled. You
7957 can pass configure and build flags with the @code{#:configure-flags} and
7958 @code{#:build-flags}. The @code{#:test-flags} key can be passed to change the
7959 set of flags used to enable tests. The @code{#:use-make?} key can be used to
7960 bypass this system in the build and install phases.
7961
7962 When the package has a @file{configure} file, it is assumed that it is a
7963 hand-made configure script that requires a different argument format than
7964 in the @code{gnu-build-system}. You can add more flags with the
7965 @code{#:configure-flags} key.
7966
7967 When the package has a @file{Makefile} file (or @code{#:use-make?} is
7968 @code{#t}), it will be used and more flags can be passed to the build and
7969 install phases with the @code{#:make-flags} key.
7970
7971 Finally, some packages do not have these files and use a somewhat standard
7972 location for its build system. In that case, the build system will run
7973 @code{ocaml pkg/pkg.ml} or @code{ocaml pkg/build.ml} and take care of
7974 providing the path to the required findlib module. Additional flags can
7975 be passed via the @code{#:build-flags} key. Install is taken care of by
7976 @command{opam-installer}. In this case, the @code{opam} package must
7977 be added to the @code{native-inputs} field of the package definition.
7978
7979 Note that most OCaml packages assume they will be installed in the same
7980 directory as OCaml, which is not what we want in guix. In particular, they
7981 will install @file{.so} files in their module's directory, which is usually
7982 fine because it is in the OCaml compiler directory. In guix though, these
7983 libraries cannot be found and we use @env{CAML_LD_LIBRARY_PATH}. This
7984 variable points to @file{lib/ocaml/site-lib/stubslibs} and this is where
7985 @file{.so} libraries should be installed.
7986 @end defvr
7987
7988 @defvr {Scheme Variable} python-build-system
7989 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system python)}. It
7990 implements the more or less standard build procedure used by Python
7991 packages, which consists in running @code{python setup.py build} and
7992 then @code{python setup.py install --prefix=/gnu/store/@dots{}}.
7993
7994 For packages that install stand-alone Python programs under @code{bin/},
7995 it takes care of wrapping these programs so that their @env{PYTHONPATH}
7996 environment variable points to all the Python libraries they depend on.
7997
7998 Which Python package is used to perform the build can be specified with
7999 the @code{#:python} parameter. This is a useful way to force a package
8000 to be built for a specific version of the Python interpreter, which
8001 might be necessary if the package is only compatible with a single
8002 interpreter version.
8003
8004 By default guix calls @code{setup.py} under control of
8005 @code{setuptools}, much like @command{pip} does. Some packages are not
8006 compatible with setuptools (and pip), thus you can disable this by
8007 setting the @code{#:use-setuptools?} parameter to @code{#f}.
8008 @end defvr
8009
8010 @defvr {Scheme Variable} perl-build-system
8011 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system perl)}. It
8012 implements the standard build procedure for Perl packages, which either
8013 consists in running @code{perl Build.PL --prefix=/gnu/store/@dots{}},
8014 followed by @code{Build} and @code{Build install}; or in running
8015 @code{perl Makefile.PL PREFIX=/gnu/store/@dots{}}, followed by
8016 @code{make} and @code{make install}, depending on which of
8017 @code{Build.PL} or @code{Makefile.PL} is present in the package
8018 distribution. Preference is given to the former if both @code{Build.PL}
8019 and @code{Makefile.PL} exist in the package distribution. This
8020 preference can be reversed by specifying @code{#t} for the
8021 @code{#:make-maker?} parameter.
8022
8023 The initial @code{perl Makefile.PL} or @code{perl Build.PL} invocation
8024 passes flags specified by the @code{#:make-maker-flags} or
8025 @code{#:module-build-flags} parameter, respectively.
8026
8027 Which Perl package is used can be specified with @code{#:perl}.
8028 @end defvr
8029
8030 @defvr {Scheme Variable} renpy-build-system
8031 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system renpy)}. It implements
8032 the more or less standard build procedure used by Ren'py games, which consists
8033 of loading @code{#:game} once, thereby creating bytecode for it.
8034
8035 It further creates a wrapper script in @code{bin/} and a desktop entry in
8036 @code{share/applications}, both of which can be used to launch the game.
8037
8038 Which Ren'py package is used can be specified with @code{#:renpy}.
8039 Games can also be installed in outputs other than ``out'' by using
8040 @code{#:output}.
8041 @end defvr
8042
8043 @defvr {Scheme Variable} qt-build-system
8044 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system qt)}. It
8045 is intended for use with applications using Qt or KDE.
8046
8047 This build system adds the following two phases to the ones defined by
8048 @code{cmake-build-system}:
8049
8050 @table @code
8051 @item check-setup
8052 The phase @code{check-setup} prepares the environment for running
8053 the checks as commonly used by Qt test programs.
8054 For now this only sets some environment variables:
8055 @code{QT_QPA_PLATFORM=offscreen},
8056 @code{DBUS_FATAL_WARNINGS=0} and
8057 @code{CTEST_OUTPUT_ON_FAILURE=1}.
8058
8059 This phase is added before the @code{check} phase.
8060 It's a separate phase to ease adjusting if necessary.
8061
8062 @item qt-wrap
8063 The phase @code{qt-wrap}
8064 searches for Qt5 plugin paths, QML paths and some XDG in the inputs
8065 and output. In case some path is found, all programs in the output's
8066 @file{bin/}, @file{sbin/}, @file{libexec/} and @file{lib/libexec/} directories
8067 are wrapped in scripts defining the necessary environment variables.
8068
8069 It is possible to exclude specific package outputs from that wrapping process
8070 by listing their names in the @code{#:qt-wrap-excluded-outputs} parameter.
8071 This is useful when an output is known not to contain any Qt binaries, and
8072 where wrapping would gratuitously add a dependency of that output on Qt, KDE,
8073 or such.
8074
8075 This phase is added after the @code{install} phase.
8076 @end table
8077 @end defvr
8078
8079 @defvr {Scheme Variable} r-build-system
8080 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system r)}. It
8081 implements the build procedure used by @uref{https://r-project.org, R}
8082 packages, which essentially is little more than running @samp{R CMD
8083 INSTALL --library=/gnu/store/@dots{}} in an environment where
8084 @env{R_LIBS_SITE} contains the paths to all R package inputs. Tests are
8085 run after installation using the R function
8086 @code{tools::testInstalledPackage}.
8087 @end defvr
8088
8089 @defvr {Scheme Variable} rakudo-build-system
8090 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system rakudo)}. It
8091 implements the build procedure used by @uref{https://rakudo.org/,
8092 Rakudo} for @uref{https://perl6.org/, Perl6} packages. It installs the
8093 package to @code{/gnu/store/@dots{}/NAME-VERSION/share/perl6} and
8094 installs the binaries, library files and the resources, as well as wrap
8095 the files under the @code{bin/} directory. Tests can be skipped by
8096 passing @code{#f} to the @code{tests?} parameter.
8097
8098 Which rakudo package is used can be specified with @code{rakudo}.
8099 Which perl6-tap-harness package used for the tests can be specified with
8100 @code{#:prove6} or removed by passing @code{#f} to the
8101 @code{with-prove6?} parameter.
8102 Which perl6-zef package used for tests and installing can be specified
8103 with @code{#:zef} or removed by passing @code{#f} to the
8104 @code{with-zef?} parameter.
8105 @end defvr
8106
8107 @defvr {Scheme Variable} texlive-build-system
8108 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system texlive)}. It is
8109 used to build TeX packages in batch mode with a specified engine. The
8110 build system sets the @env{TEXINPUTS} variable to find all TeX source
8111 files in the inputs.
8112
8113 By default it runs @code{luatex} on all files ending on @code{ins}. A
8114 different engine and format can be specified with the
8115 @code{#:tex-format} argument. Different build targets can be specified
8116 with the @code{#:build-targets} argument, which expects a list of file
8117 names. The build system adds only @code{texlive-bin} and
8118 @code{texlive-latex-base} (both from @code{(gnu packages tex}) to the
8119 inputs. Both can be overridden with the arguments @code{#:texlive-bin}
8120 and @code{#:texlive-latex-base}, respectively.
8121
8122 The @code{#:tex-directory} parameter tells the build system where to
8123 install the built files under the texmf tree.
8124 @end defvr
8125
8126 @defvr {Scheme Variable} ruby-build-system
8127 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system ruby)}. It
8128 implements the RubyGems build procedure used by Ruby packages, which
8129 involves running @code{gem build} followed by @code{gem install}.
8130
8131 The @code{source} field of a package that uses this build system
8132 typically references a gem archive, since this is the format that Ruby
8133 developers use when releasing their software. The build system unpacks
8134 the gem archive, potentially patches the source, runs the test suite,
8135 repackages the gem, and installs it. Additionally, directories and
8136 tarballs may be referenced to allow building unreleased gems from Git or
8137 a traditional source release tarball.
8138
8139 Which Ruby package is used can be specified with the @code{#:ruby}
8140 parameter. A list of additional flags to be passed to the @command{gem}
8141 command can be specified with the @code{#:gem-flags} parameter.
8142 @end defvr
8143
8144 @defvr {Scheme Variable} waf-build-system
8145 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system waf)}. It
8146 implements a build procedure around the @code{waf} script. The common
8147 phases---@code{configure}, @code{build}, and @code{install}---are
8148 implemented by passing their names as arguments to the @code{waf}
8149 script.
8150
8151 The @code{waf} script is executed by the Python interpreter. Which
8152 Python package is used to run the script can be specified with the
8153 @code{#:python} parameter.
8154 @end defvr
8155
8156 @defvr {Scheme Variable} scons-build-system
8157 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system scons)}. It
8158 implements the build procedure used by the SCons software construction
8159 tool. This build system runs @code{scons} to build the package,
8160 @code{scons test} to run tests, and then @code{scons install} to install
8161 the package.
8162
8163 Additional flags to be passed to @code{scons} can be specified with the
8164 @code{#:scons-flags} parameter. The default build and install targets
8165 can be overridden with @code{#:build-targets} and
8166 @code{#:install-targets} respectively. The version of Python used to
8167 run SCons can be specified by selecting the appropriate SCons package
8168 with the @code{#:scons} parameter.
8169 @end defvr
8170
8171 @defvr {Scheme Variable} haskell-build-system
8172 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system haskell)}. It
8173 implements the Cabal build procedure used by Haskell packages, which
8174 involves running @code{runhaskell Setup.hs configure
8175 --prefix=/gnu/store/@dots{}} and @code{runhaskell Setup.hs build}.
8176 Instead of installing the package by running @code{runhaskell Setup.hs
8177 install}, to avoid trying to register libraries in the read-only
8178 compiler store directory, the build system uses @code{runhaskell
8179 Setup.hs copy}, followed by @code{runhaskell Setup.hs register}. In
8180 addition, the build system generates the package documentation by
8181 running @code{runhaskell Setup.hs haddock}, unless @code{#:haddock? #f}
8182 is passed. Optional Haddock parameters can be passed with the help of
8183 the @code{#:haddock-flags} parameter. If the file @code{Setup.hs} is
8184 not found, the build system looks for @code{Setup.lhs} instead.
8185
8186 Which Haskell compiler is used can be specified with the @code{#:haskell}
8187 parameter which defaults to @code{ghc}.
8188 @end defvr
8189
8190 @defvr {Scheme Variable} dub-build-system
8191 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system dub)}. It
8192 implements the Dub build procedure used by D packages, which
8193 involves running @code{dub build} and @code{dub run}.
8194 Installation is done by copying the files manually.
8195
8196 Which D compiler is used can be specified with the @code{#:ldc}
8197 parameter which defaults to @code{ldc}.
8198 @end defvr
8199
8200 @anchor{emacs-build-system}
8201 @defvr {Scheme Variable} emacs-build-system
8202 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system emacs)}. It
8203 implements an installation procedure similar to the packaging system
8204 of Emacs itself (@pxref{Packages,,, emacs, The GNU Emacs Manual}).
8205
8206 It first creates the @code{@code{package}-autoloads.el} file, then it
8207 byte compiles all Emacs Lisp files. Differently from the Emacs
8208 packaging system, the Info documentation files are moved to the standard
8209 documentation directory and the @file{dir} file is deleted. The Elisp
8210 package files are installed directly under @file{share/emacs/site-lisp}.
8211 @end defvr
8212
8213 @defvr {Scheme Variable} font-build-system
8214 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system font)}. It
8215 implements an installation procedure for font packages where upstream
8216 provides pre-compiled TrueType, OpenType, etc.@: font files that merely
8217 need to be copied into place. It copies font files to standard
8218 locations in the output directory.
8219 @end defvr
8220
8221 @defvr {Scheme Variable} meson-build-system
8222 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system meson)}. It
8223 implements the build procedure for packages that use
8224 @url{https://mesonbuild.com, Meson} as their build system.
8225
8226 It adds both Meson and @uref{https://ninja-build.org/, Ninja} to the set
8227 of inputs, and they can be changed with the parameters @code{#:meson}
8228 and @code{#:ninja} if needed. The default Meson is
8229 @code{meson-for-build}, which is special because it doesn't clear the
8230 @code{RUNPATH} of binaries and libraries when they are installed.
8231
8232 This build system is an extension of @code{gnu-build-system}, but with the
8233 following phases changed to some specific for Meson:
8234
8235 @table @code
8236
8237 @item configure
8238 The phase runs @code{meson} with the flags specified in
8239 @code{#:configure-flags}. The flag @option{--buildtype} is always set to
8240 @code{debugoptimized} unless something else is specified in
8241 @code{#:build-type}.
8242
8243 @item build
8244 The phase runs @code{ninja} to build the package in parallel by default, but
8245 this can be changed with @code{#:parallel-build?}.
8246
8247 @item check
8248 The phase runs @code{ninja} with the target specified in @code{#:test-target},
8249 which is @code{"test"} by default.
8250
8251 @item install
8252 The phase runs @code{ninja install} and can not be changed.
8253 @end table
8254
8255 Apart from that, the build system also adds the following phases:
8256
8257 @table @code
8258
8259 @item fix-runpath
8260 This phase ensures that all binaries can find the libraries they need.
8261 It searches for required libraries in subdirectories of the package being
8262 built, and adds those to @code{RUNPATH} where needed. It also removes
8263 references to libraries left over from the build phase by
8264 @code{meson-for-build}, such as test dependencies, that aren't actually
8265 required for the program to run.
8266
8267 @item glib-or-gtk-wrap
8268 This phase is the phase provided by @code{glib-or-gtk-build-system}, and it
8269 is not enabled by default. It can be enabled with @code{#:glib-or-gtk?}.
8270
8271 @item glib-or-gtk-compile-schemas
8272 This phase is the phase provided by @code{glib-or-gtk-build-system}, and it
8273 is not enabled by default. It can be enabled with @code{#:glib-or-gtk?}.
8274 @end table
8275 @end defvr
8276
8277 @defvr {Scheme Variable} linux-module-build-system
8278 @code{linux-module-build-system} allows building Linux kernel modules.
8279
8280 @cindex build phases
8281 This build system is an extension of @code{gnu-build-system}, but with the
8282 following phases changed:
8283
8284 @table @code
8285
8286 @item configure
8287 This phase configures the environment so that the Linux kernel's Makefile
8288 can be used to build the external kernel module.
8289
8290 @item build
8291 This phase uses the Linux kernel's Makefile in order to build the external
8292 kernel module.
8293
8294 @item install
8295 This phase uses the Linux kernel's Makefile in order to install the external
8296 kernel module.
8297 @end table
8298
8299 It is possible and useful to specify the Linux kernel to use for building
8300 the module (in the @code{arguments} form of a package using the
8301 @code{linux-module-build-system}, use the key @code{#:linux} to specify it).
8302 @end defvr
8303
8304 @defvr {Scheme Variable} node-build-system
8305 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system node)}. It
8306 implements the build procedure used by @uref{https://nodejs.org,
8307 Node.js}, which implements an approximation of the @code{npm install}
8308 command, followed by an @code{npm test} command.
8309
8310 Which Node.js package is used to interpret the @code{npm} commands can
8311 be specified with the @code{#:node} parameter which defaults to
8312 @code{node}.
8313 @end defvr
8314
8315 Lastly, for packages that do not need anything as sophisticated, a
8316 ``trivial'' build system is provided. It is trivial in the sense that
8317 it provides basically no support: it does not pull any implicit inputs,
8318 and does not have a notion of build phases.
8319
8320 @defvr {Scheme Variable} trivial-build-system
8321 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system trivial)}.
8322
8323 This build system requires a @code{#:builder} argument. This argument
8324 must be a Scheme expression that builds the package output(s)---as
8325 with @code{build-expression->derivation} (@pxref{Derivations,
8326 @code{build-expression->derivation}}).
8327 @end defvr
8328
8329 @node Build Phases
8330 @section Build Phases
8331
8332 @cindex build phases, for packages
8333 Almost all package build systems implement a notion @dfn{build phases}:
8334 a sequence of actions that the build system executes, when you build the
8335 package, leading to the installed byproducts in the store. A notable
8336 exception is the ``bare-bones'' @code{trivial-build-system}
8337 (@pxref{Build Systems}).
8338
8339 As discussed in the previous section, those build systems provide a
8340 standard list of phases. For @code{gnu-build-system}, the main build
8341 phases are the following:
8342
8343 @table @code
8344 @item unpack
8345 Unpack the source tarball, and change the current directory to the
8346 extracted source tree. If the source is actually a directory, copy it
8347 to the build tree, and enter that directory.
8348
8349 @item patch-source-shebangs
8350 Patch shebangs encountered in source files so they refer to the right
8351 store file names. For instance, this changes @code{#!/bin/sh} to
8352 @code{#!/gnu/store/@dots{}-bash-4.3/bin/sh}.
8353
8354 @item configure
8355 Run the @file{configure} script with a number of default options, such
8356 as @option{--prefix=/gnu/store/@dots{}}, as well as the options specified
8357 by the @code{#:configure-flags} argument.
8358
8359 @item build
8360 Run @code{make} with the list of flags specified with
8361 @code{#:make-flags}. If the @code{#:parallel-build?} argument is true
8362 (the default), build with @code{make -j}.
8363
8364 @item check
8365 Run @code{make check}, or some other target specified with
8366 @code{#:test-target}, unless @code{#:tests? #f} is passed. If the
8367 @code{#:parallel-tests?} argument is true (the default), run @code{make
8368 check -j}.
8369
8370 @item install
8371 Run @code{make install} with the flags listed in @code{#:make-flags}.
8372
8373 @item patch-shebangs
8374 Patch shebangs on the installed executable files.
8375
8376 @item strip
8377 Strip debugging symbols from ELF files (unless @code{#:strip-binaries?}
8378 is false), copying them to the @code{debug} output when available
8379 (@pxref{Installing Debugging Files}).
8380 @end table
8381
8382 Other build systems have similar phases, with some variations. For
8383 example, @code{cmake-build-system} has same-named phases but its
8384 @code{configure} phases runs @code{cmake} instead of @code{./configure}.
8385 Others, such as @code{python-build-system}, have a wholly different list
8386 of standard phases. All this code runs on the @dfn{build side}: it is
8387 evaluated when you actually build the package, in a dedicated build
8388 process spawned by the build daemon (@pxref{Invoking guix-daemon}).
8389
8390 Build phases are represented as association lists or ``alists''
8391 (@pxref{Association Lists,,, guile, GNU Guile Reference Manual}) where
8392 each key is a symbol for the name of the phase and the associated value
8393 is a procedure that accepts an arbitrary number of arguments. By
8394 convention, those procedures receive information about the build in the
8395 form of @dfn{keyword parameters}, which they can use or ignore.
8396
8397 @vindex %standard-phases
8398 For example, here is how @code{(guix build gnu-build-system)} defines
8399 @code{%standard-phases}, the variable holding its alist of build
8400 phases@footnote{We present a simplified view of those build phases, but
8401 do take a look at @code{(guix build gnu-build-system)} to see all the
8402 details!}:
8403
8404 @lisp
8405 ;; The build phases of 'gnu-build-system'.
8406
8407 (define* (unpack #:key source #:allow-other-keys)
8408 ;; Extract the source tarball.
8409 (invoke "tar" "xvf" source))
8410
8411 (define* (configure #:key outputs #:allow-other-keys)
8412 ;; Run the 'configure' script. Install to output "out".
8413 (let ((out (assoc-ref outputs "out")))
8414 (invoke "./configure"
8415 (string-append "--prefix=" out))))
8416
8417 (define* (build #:allow-other-keys)
8418 ;; Compile.
8419 (invoke "make"))
8420
8421 (define* (check #:key (test-target "check") (tests? #true)
8422 #:allow-other-keys)
8423 ;; Run the test suite.
8424 (if tests?
8425 (invoke "make" test-target)
8426 (display "test suite not run\n")))
8427
8428 (define* (install #:allow-other-keys)
8429 ;; Install files to the prefix 'configure' specified.
8430 (invoke "make" "install"))
8431
8432 (define %standard-phases
8433 ;; The list of standard phases (quite a few are omitted
8434 ;; for brevity). Each element is a symbol/procedure pair.
8435 (list (cons 'unpack unpack)
8436 (cons 'configure configure)
8437 (cons 'build build)
8438 (cons 'check check)
8439 (cons 'install install)))
8440 @end lisp
8441
8442 This shows how @code{%standard-phases} is defined as a list of
8443 symbol/procedure pairs (@pxref{Pairs,,, guile, GNU Guile Reference
8444 Manual}). The first pair associates the @code{unpack} procedure with
8445 the @code{unpack} symbol---a name; the second pair defines the
8446 @code{configure} phase similarly, and so on. When building a package
8447 that uses @code{gnu-build-system} with its default list of phases, those
8448 phases are executed sequentially. You can see the name of each phase
8449 started and completed in the build log of packages that you build.
8450
8451 Let's now look at the procedures themselves. Each one is defined with
8452 @code{define*}: @code{#:key} lists keyword parameters the procedure
8453 accepts, possibly with a default value, and @code{#:allow-other-keys}
8454 specifies that other keyword parameters are ignored (@pxref{Optional
8455 Arguments,,, guile, GNU Guile Reference Manual}).
8456
8457 The @code{unpack} procedure honors the @code{source} parameter, which
8458 the build system uses to pass the file name of the source tarball (or
8459 version control checkout), and it ignores other parameters. The
8460 @code{configure} phase only cares about the @code{outputs} parameter, an
8461 alist mapping package output names to their store file name
8462 (@pxref{Packages with Multiple Outputs}). It extracts the file name of
8463 for @code{out}, the default output, and passes it to
8464 @command{./configure} as the installation prefix, meaning that
8465 @command{make install} will eventually copy all the files in that
8466 directory (@pxref{Configuration, configuration and makefile
8467 conventions,, standards, GNU Coding Standards}). @code{build} and
8468 @code{install} ignore all their arguments. @code{check} honors the
8469 @code{test-target} argument, which specifies the name of the Makefile
8470 target to run tests; it prints a message and skips tests when
8471 @code{tests?} is false.
8472
8473 @cindex build phases, customizing
8474 The list of phases used for a particular package can be changed with the
8475 @code{#:phases} parameter of the build system. Changing the set of
8476 build phases boils down to building a new alist of phases based on the
8477 @code{%standard-phases} alist described above. This can be done with
8478 standard alist procedures such as @code{alist-delete} (@pxref{SRFI-1
8479 Association Lists,,, guile, GNU Guile Reference Manual}); however, it is
8480 more convenient to do so with @code{modify-phases} (@pxref{Build
8481 Utilities, @code{modify-phases}}).
8482
8483 Here is an example of a package definition that removes the
8484 @code{configure} phase of @code{%standard-phases} and inserts a new
8485 phase before the @code{build} phase, called
8486 @code{set-prefix-in-makefile}:
8487
8488 @lisp
8489 (define-public example
8490 (package
8491 (name "example")
8492 ;; other fields omitted
8493 (build-system gnu-build-system)
8494 (arguments
8495 '(#:phases (modify-phases %standard-phases
8496 (delete 'configure)
8497 (add-before 'build 'set-prefix-in-makefile
8498 (lambda* (#:key outputs #:allow-other-keys)
8499 ;; Modify the makefile so that its
8500 ;; 'PREFIX' variable points to "out".
8501 (let ((out (assoc-ref outputs "out")))
8502 (substitute* "Makefile"
8503 (("PREFIX =.*")
8504 (string-append "PREFIX = "
8505 out "\n")))
8506 #true))))))))
8507 @end lisp
8508
8509 The new phase that is inserted is written as an anonymous procedure,
8510 introduced with @code{lambda*}; it honors the @code{outputs} parameter
8511 we have seen before. @xref{Build Utilities}, for more about the helpers
8512 used by this phase, and for more examples of @code{modify-phases}.
8513
8514 @cindex code staging
8515 @cindex staging, of code
8516 Keep in mind that build phases are code evaluated at the time the
8517 package is actually built. This explains why the whole
8518 @code{modify-phases} expression above is quoted (it comes after the
8519 @code{'} or apostrophe): it is @dfn{staged} for later execution.
8520 @xref{G-Expressions}, for an explanation of code staging and the
8521 @dfn{code strata} involved.
8522
8523 @node Build Utilities
8524 @section Build Utilities
8525
8526 As soon as you start writing non-trivial package definitions
8527 (@pxref{Defining Packages}) or other build actions
8528 (@pxref{G-Expressions}), you will likely start looking for helpers for
8529 ``shell-like'' actions---creating directories, copying and deleting
8530 files recursively, manipulating build phases, and so on. The
8531 @code{(guix build utils)} module provides such utility procedures.
8532
8533 Most build systems load @code{(guix build utils)} (@pxref{Build
8534 Systems}). Thus, when writing custom build phases for your package
8535 definitions, you can usually assume those procedures are in scope.
8536
8537 When writing G-expressions, you can import @code{(guix build utils)} on
8538 the ``build side'' using @code{with-imported-modules} and then put it in
8539 scope with the @code{use-modules} form (@pxref{Using Guile Modules,,,
8540 guile, GNU Guile Reference Manual}):
8541
8542 @lisp
8543 (with-imported-modules '((guix build utils)) ;import it
8544 (computed-file "empty-tree"
8545 #~(begin
8546 ;; Put it in scope.
8547 (use-modules (guix build utils))
8548
8549 ;; Happily use its 'mkdir-p' procedure.
8550 (mkdir-p (string-append #$output "/a/b/c")))))
8551 @end lisp
8552
8553 The remainder of this section is the reference for most of the utility
8554 procedures provided by @code{(guix build utils)}.
8555
8556 @c TODO Document what's missing.
8557
8558 @subsection Dealing with Store File Names
8559
8560 This section documents procedures that deal with store file names.
8561
8562 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} %store-directory
8563 Return the directory name of the store.
8564 @end deffn
8565
8566 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} store-file-name? @var{file}
8567 Return true if @var{file} is in the store.
8568 @end deffn
8569
8570 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} strip-store-file-name @var{file}
8571 Strip the @file{/gnu/store} and hash from @var{file}, a store file name.
8572 The result is typically a @code{"@var{package}-@var{version}"} string.
8573 @end deffn
8574
8575 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} package-name->name+version @var{name}
8576 Given @var{name}, a package name like @code{"foo-0.9.1b"}, return two
8577 values: @code{"foo"} and @code{"0.9.1b"}. When the version part is
8578 unavailable, @var{name} and @code{#f} are returned. The first hyphen
8579 followed by a digit is considered to introduce the version part.
8580 @end deffn
8581
8582 @subsection File Types
8583
8584 The procedures below deal with files and file types.
8585
8586 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} directory-exists? @var{dir}
8587 Return @code{#t} if @var{dir} exists and is a directory.
8588 @end deffn
8589
8590 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} executable-file? @var{file}
8591 Return @code{#t} if @var{file} exists and is executable.
8592 @end deffn
8593
8594 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} symbolic-link? @var{file}
8595 Return @code{#t} if @var{file} is a symbolic link (aka. a ``symlink'').
8596 @end deffn
8597
8598 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} elf-file? @var{file}
8599 @deffnx {Scheme Procedure} ar-file? @var{file}
8600 @deffnx {Scheme Procedure} gzip-file? @var{file}
8601 Return @code{#t} if @var{file} is, respectively, an ELF file, an
8602 @code{ar} archive (such as a @file{.a} static library), or a gzip file.
8603 @end deffn
8604
8605 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} reset-gzip-timestamp @var{file} [#:keep-mtime? #t]
8606 If @var{file} is a gzip file, reset its embedded timestamp (as with
8607 @command{gzip --no-name}) and return true. Otherwise return @code{#f}.
8608 When @var{keep-mtime?} is true, preserve @var{file}'s modification time.
8609 @end deffn
8610
8611 @subsection File Manipulation
8612
8613 The following procedures and macros help create, modify, and delete
8614 files. They provide functionality comparable to common shell utilities
8615 such as @command{mkdir -p}, @command{cp -r}, @command{rm -r}, and
8616 @command{sed}. They complement Guile's extensive, but low-level, file
8617 system interface (@pxref{POSIX,,, guile, GNU Guile Reference Manual}).
8618
8619 @deffn {Scheme Syntax} with-directory-excursion @var{directory} @var{body}@dots{}
8620 Run @var{body} with @var{directory} as the process's current directory.
8621
8622 Essentially, this macro changes the current directory to @var{directory}
8623 before evaluating @var{body}, using @code{chdir} (@pxref{Processes,,,
8624 guile, GNU Guile Reference Manual}). It changes back to the initial
8625 directory when the dynamic extent of @var{body} is left, be it @i{via}
8626 normal procedure return or @i{via} a non-local exit such as an
8627 exception.
8628 @end deffn
8629
8630 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} mkdir-p @var{dir}
8631 Create directory @var{dir} and all its ancestors.
8632 @end deffn
8633
8634 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} install-file @var{file} @var{directory}
8635 Create @var{directory} if it does not exist and copy @var{file} in there
8636 under the same name.
8637 @end deffn
8638
8639 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} make-file-writable @var{file}
8640 Make @var{file} writable for its owner.
8641 @end deffn
8642
8643 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} copy-recursively @var{source} @var{destination} @
8644 [#:log (current-output-port)] [#:follow-symlinks? #f] [#:keep-mtime? #f]
8645 Copy @var{source} directory to @var{destination}. Follow symlinks if
8646 @var{follow-symlinks?} is true; otherwise, just preserve them. When
8647 @var{keep-mtime?} is true, keep the modification time of the files in
8648 @var{source} on those of @var{destination}. Write verbose output to the
8649 @var{log} port.
8650 @end deffn
8651
8652 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} delete-file-recursively @var{dir} @
8653 [#:follow-mounts? #f]
8654 Delete @var{dir} recursively, like @command{rm -rf}, without following
8655 symlinks. Don't follow mount points either, unless @var{follow-mounts?}
8656 is true. Report but ignore errors.
8657 @end deffn
8658
8659 @deffn {Scheme Syntax} substitute* @var{file} @
8660 ((@var{regexp} @var{match-var}@dots{}) @var{body}@dots{}) @dots{}
8661 Substitute @var{regexp} in @var{file} by the string returned by
8662 @var{body}. @var{body} is evaluated with each @var{match-var} bound to
8663 the corresponding positional regexp sub-expression. For example:
8664
8665 @lisp
8666 (substitute* file
8667 (("hello")
8668 "good morning\n")
8669 (("foo([a-z]+)bar(.*)$" all letters end)
8670 (string-append "baz" letter end)))
8671 @end lisp
8672
8673 Here, anytime a line of @var{file} contains @code{hello}, it is replaced
8674 by @code{good morning}. Anytime a line of @var{file} matches the second
8675 regexp, @code{all} is bound to the complete match, @code{letters} is bound
8676 to the first sub-expression, and @code{end} is bound to the last one.
8677
8678 When one of the @var{match-var} is @code{_}, no variable is bound to the
8679 corresponding match substring.
8680
8681 Alternatively, @var{file} may be a list of file names, in which case
8682 they are all subject to the substitutions.
8683
8684 Be careful about using @code{$} to match the end of a line; by itself it
8685 won't match the terminating newline of a line.
8686 @end deffn
8687
8688 @subsection File Search
8689
8690 @cindex file, searching
8691 This section documents procedures to search and filter files.
8692
8693 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} file-name-predicate @var{regexp}
8694 Return a predicate that returns true when passed a file name whose base
8695 name matches @var{regexp}.
8696 @end deffn
8697
8698 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} find-files @var{dir} [@var{pred}] @
8699 [#:stat lstat] [#:directories? #f] [#:fail-on-error? #f]
8700 Return the lexicographically sorted list of files under @var{dir} for
8701 which @var{pred} returns true. @var{pred} is passed two arguments: the
8702 absolute file name, and its stat buffer; the default predicate always
8703 returns true. @var{pred} can also be a regular expression, in which
8704 case it is equivalent to @code{(file-name-predicate @var{pred})}.
8705 @var{stat} is used to obtain file information; using @code{lstat} means
8706 that symlinks are not followed. If @var{directories?} is true, then
8707 directories will also be included. If @var{fail-on-error?} is true,
8708 raise an exception upon error.
8709 @end deffn
8710
8711 Here are a few examples where we assume that the current directory is
8712 the root of the Guix source tree:
8713
8714 @lisp
8715 ;; List all the regular files in the current directory.
8716 (find-files ".")
8717 @result{} ("./.dir-locals.el" "./.gitignore" @dots{})
8718
8719 ;; List all the .scm files under gnu/services.
8720 (find-files "gnu/services" "\\.scm$")
8721 @result{} ("gnu/services/admin.scm" "gnu/services/audio.scm" @dots{})
8722
8723 ;; List ar files in the current directory.
8724 (find-files "." (lambda (file stat) (ar-file? file)))
8725 @result{} ("./libformat.a" "./libstore.a" @dots{})
8726 @end lisp
8727
8728 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} which @var{program}
8729 Return the complete file name for @var{program} as found in
8730 @code{$PATH}, or @code{#f} if @var{program} could not be found.
8731 @end deffn
8732
8733 @subsection Build Phases
8734
8735 @cindex build phases
8736 The @code{(guix build utils)} also contains tools to manipulate build
8737 phases as used by build systems (@pxref{Build Systems}). Build phases
8738 are represented as association lists or ``alists'' (@pxref{Association
8739 Lists,,, guile, GNU Guile Reference Manual}) where each key is a symbol
8740 naming the phase and the associated value is a procedure (@pxref{Build
8741 Phases}).
8742
8743 Guile core and the @code{(srfi srfi-1)} module both provide tools to
8744 manipulate alists. The @code{(guix build utils)} module complements
8745 those with tools written with build phases in mind.
8746
8747 @cindex build phases, modifying
8748 @deffn {Scheme Syntax} modify-phases @var{phases} @var{clause}@dots{}
8749 Modify @var{phases} sequentially as per each @var{clause}, which may
8750 have one of the following forms:
8751
8752 @lisp
8753 (delete @var{old-phase-name})
8754 (replace @var{old-phase-name} @var{new-phase})
8755 (add-before @var{old-phase-name} @var{new-phase-name} @var{new-phase})
8756 (add-after @var{old-phase-name} @var{new-phase-name} @var{new-phase})
8757 @end lisp
8758
8759 Where every @var{phase-name} above is an expression evaluating to a
8760 symbol, and @var{new-phase} an expression evaluating to a procedure.
8761 @end deffn
8762
8763 The example below is taken from the definition of the @code{grep}
8764 package. It adds a phase to run after the @code{install} phase, called
8765 @code{fix-egrep-and-fgrep}. That phase is a procedure (@code{lambda*}
8766 is for anonymous procedures) that takes a @code{#:outputs} keyword
8767 argument and ignores extra keyword arguments (@pxref{Optional
8768 Arguments,,, guile, GNU Guile Reference Manual}, for more on
8769 @code{lambda*} and optional and keyword arguments.) The phase uses
8770 @code{substitute*} to modify the installed @file{egrep} and @file{fgrep}
8771 scripts so that they refer to @code{grep} by its absolute file name:
8772
8773 @lisp
8774 (modify-phases %standard-phases
8775 (add-after 'install 'fix-egrep-and-fgrep
8776 ;; Patch 'egrep' and 'fgrep' to execute 'grep' via its
8777 ;; absolute file name instead of searching for it in $PATH.
8778 (lambda* (#:key outputs #:allow-other-keys)
8779 (let* ((out (assoc-ref outputs "out"))
8780 (bin (string-append out "/bin")))
8781 (substitute* (list (string-append bin "/egrep")
8782 (string-append bin "/fgrep"))
8783 (("^exec grep")
8784 (string-append "exec " bin "/grep")))
8785 #t))))
8786 @end lisp
8787
8788 In the example below, phases are modified in two ways: the standard
8789 @code{configure} phase is deleted, presumably because the package does
8790 not have a @file{configure} script or anything similar, and the default
8791 @code{install} phase is replaced by one that manually copies the
8792 executable files to be installed:
8793
8794 @lisp
8795 (modify-phases %standard-phases
8796 (delete 'configure) ;no 'configure' script
8797 (replace 'install
8798 (lambda* (#:key outputs #:allow-other-keys)
8799 ;; The package's Makefile doesn't provide an "install"
8800 ;; rule so do it by ourselves.
8801 (let ((bin (string-append (assoc-ref outputs "out")
8802 "/bin")))
8803 (install-file "footswitch" bin)
8804 (install-file "scythe" bin)
8805 #t))))
8806 @end lisp
8807
8808 @c TODO: Add more examples.
8809
8810 @node The Store
8811 @section The Store
8812
8813 @cindex store
8814 @cindex store items
8815 @cindex store paths
8816
8817 Conceptually, the @dfn{store} is the place where derivations that have
8818 been built successfully are stored---by default, @file{/gnu/store}.
8819 Sub-directories in the store are referred to as @dfn{store items} or
8820 sometimes @dfn{store paths}. The store has an associated database that
8821 contains information such as the store paths referred to by each store
8822 path, and the list of @emph{valid} store items---results of successful
8823 builds. This database resides in @file{@var{localstatedir}/guix/db},
8824 where @var{localstatedir} is the state directory specified @i{via}
8825 @option{--localstatedir} at configure time, usually @file{/var}.
8826
8827 The store is @emph{always} accessed by the daemon on behalf of its clients
8828 (@pxref{Invoking guix-daemon}). To manipulate the store, clients
8829 connect to the daemon over a Unix-domain socket, send requests to it,
8830 and read the result---these are remote procedure calls, or RPCs.
8831
8832 @quotation Note
8833 Users must @emph{never} modify files under @file{/gnu/store} directly.
8834 This would lead to inconsistencies and break the immutability
8835 assumptions of Guix's functional model (@pxref{Introduction}).
8836
8837 @xref{Invoking guix gc, @command{guix gc --verify}}, for information on
8838 how to check the integrity of the store and attempt recovery from
8839 accidental modifications.
8840 @end quotation
8841
8842 The @code{(guix store)} module provides procedures to connect to the
8843 daemon, and to perform RPCs. These are described below. By default,
8844 @code{open-connection}, and thus all the @command{guix} commands,
8845 connect to the local daemon or to the URI specified by the
8846 @env{GUIX_DAEMON_SOCKET} environment variable.
8847
8848 @defvr {Environment Variable} GUIX_DAEMON_SOCKET
8849 When set, the value of this variable should be a file name or a URI
8850 designating the daemon endpoint. When it is a file name, it denotes a
8851 Unix-domain socket to connect to. In addition to file names, the
8852 supported URI schemes are:
8853
8854 @table @code
8855 @item file
8856 @itemx unix
8857 These are for Unix-domain sockets.
8858 @code{file:///var/guix/daemon-socket/socket} is equivalent to
8859 @file{/var/guix/daemon-socket/socket}.
8860
8861 @item guix
8862 @cindex daemon, remote access
8863 @cindex remote access to the daemon
8864 @cindex daemon, cluster setup
8865 @cindex clusters, daemon setup
8866 These URIs denote connections over TCP/IP, without encryption nor
8867 authentication of the remote host. The URI must specify the host name
8868 and optionally a port number (by default port 44146 is used):
8869
8870 @example
8871 guix://master.guix.example.org:1234
8872 @end example
8873
8874 This setup is suitable on local networks, such as clusters, where only
8875 trusted nodes may connect to the build daemon at
8876 @code{master.guix.example.org}.
8877
8878 The @option{--listen} option of @command{guix-daemon} can be used to
8879 instruct it to listen for TCP connections (@pxref{Invoking guix-daemon,
8880 @option{--listen}}).
8881
8882 @item ssh
8883 @cindex SSH access to build daemons
8884 These URIs allow you to connect to a remote daemon over SSH@. This
8885 feature requires Guile-SSH (@pxref{Requirements}) and a working
8886 @command{guile} binary in @env{PATH} on the destination machine. It
8887 supports public key and GSSAPI authentication. A typical URL might look
8888 like this:
8889
8890 @example
8891 ssh://charlie@@guix.example.org:22
8892 @end example
8893
8894 As for @command{guix copy}, the usual OpenSSH client configuration files
8895 are honored (@pxref{Invoking guix copy}).
8896 @end table
8897
8898 Additional URI schemes may be supported in the future.
8899
8900 @c XXX: Remove this note when the protocol incurs fewer round trips
8901 @c and when (guix derivations) no longer relies on file system access.
8902 @quotation Note
8903 The ability to connect to remote build daemons is considered
8904 experimental as of @value{VERSION}. Please get in touch with us to
8905 share any problems or suggestions you may have (@pxref{Contributing}).
8906 @end quotation
8907 @end defvr
8908
8909 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} open-connection [@var{uri}] [#:reserve-space? #t]
8910 Connect to the daemon over the Unix-domain socket at @var{uri} (a string). When
8911 @var{reserve-space?} is true, instruct it to reserve a little bit of
8912 extra space on the file system so that the garbage collector can still
8913 operate should the disk become full. Return a server object.
8914
8915 @var{file} defaults to @code{%default-socket-path}, which is the normal
8916 location given the options that were passed to @command{configure}.
8917 @end deffn
8918
8919 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} close-connection @var{server}
8920 Close the connection to @var{server}.
8921 @end deffn
8922
8923 @defvr {Scheme Variable} current-build-output-port
8924 This variable is bound to a SRFI-39 parameter, which refers to the port
8925 where build and error logs sent by the daemon should be written.
8926 @end defvr
8927
8928 Procedures that make RPCs all take a server object as their first
8929 argument.
8930
8931 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} valid-path? @var{server} @var{path}
8932 @cindex invalid store items
8933 Return @code{#t} when @var{path} designates a valid store item and
8934 @code{#f} otherwise (an invalid item may exist on disk but still be
8935 invalid, for instance because it is the result of an aborted or failed
8936 build).
8937
8938 A @code{&store-protocol-error} condition is raised if @var{path} is not
8939 prefixed by the store directory (@file{/gnu/store}).
8940 @end deffn
8941
8942 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} add-text-to-store @var{server} @var{name} @var{text} [@var{references}]
8943 Add @var{text} under file @var{name} in the store, and return its store
8944 path. @var{references} is the list of store paths referred to by the
8945 resulting store path.
8946 @end deffn
8947
8948 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} build-derivations @var{store} @var{derivations} @
8949 [@var{mode}]
8950 Build @var{derivations}, a list of @code{<derivation>} objects, @file{.drv}
8951 file names, or derivation/output pairs, using the specified
8952 @var{mode}---@code{(build-mode normal)} by default.
8953 @end deffn
8954
8955 Note that the @code{(guix monads)} module provides a monad as well as
8956 monadic versions of the above procedures, with the goal of making it
8957 more convenient to work with code that accesses the store (@pxref{The
8958 Store Monad}).
8959
8960 @c FIXME
8961 @i{This section is currently incomplete.}
8962
8963 @node Derivations
8964 @section Derivations
8965
8966 @cindex derivations
8967 Low-level build actions and the environment in which they are performed
8968 are represented by @dfn{derivations}. A derivation contains the
8969 following pieces of information:
8970
8971 @itemize
8972 @item
8973 The outputs of the derivation---derivations produce at least one file or
8974 directory in the store, but may produce more.
8975
8976 @item
8977 @cindex build-time dependencies
8978 @cindex dependencies, build-time
8979 The inputs of the derivations---i.e., its build-time dependencies---which may
8980 be other derivations or plain files in the store (patches, build scripts,
8981 etc.).
8982
8983 @item
8984 The system type targeted by the derivation---e.g., @code{x86_64-linux}.
8985
8986 @item
8987 The file name of a build script in the store, along with the arguments
8988 to be passed.
8989
8990 @item
8991 A list of environment variables to be defined.
8992
8993 @end itemize
8994
8995 @cindex derivation path
8996 Derivations allow clients of the daemon to communicate build actions to
8997 the store. They exist in two forms: as an in-memory representation,
8998 both on the client- and daemon-side, and as files in the store whose
8999 name end in @file{.drv}---these files are referred to as @dfn{derivation
9000 paths}. Derivations paths can be passed to the @code{build-derivations}
9001 procedure to perform the build actions they prescribe (@pxref{The
9002 Store}).
9003
9004 @cindex fixed-output derivations
9005 Operations such as file downloads and version-control checkouts for
9006 which the expected content hash is known in advance are modeled as
9007 @dfn{fixed-output derivations}. Unlike regular derivations, the outputs
9008 of a fixed-output derivation are independent of its inputs---e.g., a
9009 source code download produces the same result regardless of the download
9010 method and tools being used.
9011
9012 @cindex references
9013 @cindex run-time dependencies
9014 @cindex dependencies, run-time
9015 The outputs of derivations---i.e., the build results---have a set of
9016 @dfn{references}, as reported by the @code{references} RPC or the
9017 @command{guix gc --references} command (@pxref{Invoking guix gc}). References
9018 are the set of run-time dependencies of the build results. References are a
9019 subset of the inputs of the derivation; this subset is automatically computed
9020 by the build daemon by scanning all the files in the outputs.
9021
9022 The @code{(guix derivations)} module provides a representation of
9023 derivations as Scheme objects, along with procedures to create and
9024 otherwise manipulate derivations. The lowest-level primitive to create
9025 a derivation is the @code{derivation} procedure:
9026
9027 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} derivation @var{store} @var{name} @var{builder} @
9028 @var{args} [#:outputs '("out")] [#:hash #f] [#:hash-algo #f] @
9029 [#:recursive? #f] [#:inputs '()] [#:env-vars '()] @
9030 [#:system (%current-system)] [#:references-graphs #f] @
9031 [#:allowed-references #f] [#:disallowed-references #f] @
9032 [#:leaked-env-vars #f] [#:local-build? #f] @
9033 [#:substitutable? #t] [#:properties '()]
9034 Build a derivation with the given arguments, and return the resulting
9035 @code{<derivation>} object.
9036
9037 When @var{hash} and @var{hash-algo} are given, a
9038 @dfn{fixed-output derivation} is created---i.e., one whose result is
9039 known in advance, such as a file download. If, in addition,
9040 @var{recursive?} is true, then that fixed output may be an executable
9041 file or a directory and @var{hash} must be the hash of an archive
9042 containing this output.
9043
9044 When @var{references-graphs} is true, it must be a list of file
9045 name/store path pairs. In that case, the reference graph of each store
9046 path is exported in the build environment in the corresponding file, in
9047 a simple text format.
9048
9049 When @var{allowed-references} is true, it must be a list of store items
9050 or outputs that the derivation's output may refer to. Likewise,
9051 @var{disallowed-references}, if true, must be a list of things the
9052 outputs may @emph{not} refer to.
9053
9054 When @var{leaked-env-vars} is true, it must be a list of strings
9055 denoting environment variables that are allowed to ``leak'' from the
9056 daemon's environment to the build environment. This is only applicable
9057 to fixed-output derivations---i.e., when @var{hash} is true. The main
9058 use is to allow variables such as @code{http_proxy} to be passed to
9059 derivations that download files.
9060
9061 When @var{local-build?} is true, declare that the derivation is not a
9062 good candidate for offloading and should rather be built locally
9063 (@pxref{Daemon Offload Setup}). This is the case for small derivations
9064 where the costs of data transfers would outweigh the benefits.
9065
9066 When @var{substitutable?} is false, declare that substitutes of the
9067 derivation's output should not be used (@pxref{Substitutes}). This is
9068 useful, for instance, when building packages that capture details of the
9069 host CPU instruction set.
9070
9071 @var{properties} must be an association list describing ``properties'' of the
9072 derivation. It is kept as-is, uninterpreted, in the derivation.
9073 @end deffn
9074
9075 @noindent
9076 Here's an example with a shell script as its builder, assuming
9077 @var{store} is an open connection to the daemon, and @var{bash} points
9078 to a Bash executable in the store:
9079
9080 @lisp
9081 (use-modules (guix utils)
9082 (guix store)
9083 (guix derivations))
9084
9085 (let ((builder ; add the Bash script to the store
9086 (add-text-to-store store "my-builder.sh"
9087 "echo hello world > $out\n" '())))
9088 (derivation store "foo"
9089 bash `("-e" ,builder)
9090 #:inputs `((,bash) (,builder))
9091 #:env-vars '(("HOME" . "/homeless"))))
9092 @result{} #<derivation /gnu/store/@dots{}-foo.drv => /gnu/store/@dots{}-foo>
9093 @end lisp
9094
9095 As can be guessed, this primitive is cumbersome to use directly. A
9096 better approach is to write build scripts in Scheme, of course! The
9097 best course of action for that is to write the build code as a
9098 ``G-expression'', and to pass it to @code{gexp->derivation}. For more
9099 information, @pxref{G-Expressions}.
9100
9101 Once upon a time, @code{gexp->derivation} did not exist and constructing
9102 derivations with build code written in Scheme was achieved with
9103 @code{build-expression->derivation}, documented below. This procedure
9104 is now deprecated in favor of the much nicer @code{gexp->derivation}.
9105
9106 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} build-expression->derivation @var{store} @
9107 @var{name} @var{exp} @
9108 [#:system (%current-system)] [#:inputs '()] @
9109 [#:outputs '("out")] [#:hash #f] [#:hash-algo #f] @
9110 [#:recursive? #f] [#:env-vars '()] [#:modules '()] @
9111 [#:references-graphs #f] [#:allowed-references #f] @
9112 [#:disallowed-references #f] @
9113 [#:local-build? #f] [#:substitutable? #t] [#:guile-for-build #f]
9114 Return a derivation that executes Scheme expression @var{exp} as a
9115 builder for derivation @var{name}. @var{inputs} must be a list of
9116 @code{(name drv-path sub-drv)} tuples; when @var{sub-drv} is omitted,
9117 @code{"out"} is assumed. @var{modules} is a list of names of Guile
9118 modules from the current search path to be copied in the store,
9119 compiled, and made available in the load path during the execution of
9120 @var{exp}---e.g., @code{((guix build utils) (guix build
9121 gnu-build-system))}.
9122
9123 @var{exp} is evaluated in an environment where @code{%outputs} is bound
9124 to a list of output/path pairs, and where @code{%build-inputs} is bound
9125 to a list of string/output-path pairs made from @var{inputs}.
9126 Optionally, @var{env-vars} is a list of string pairs specifying the name
9127 and value of environment variables visible to the builder. The builder
9128 terminates by passing the result of @var{exp} to @code{exit}; thus, when
9129 @var{exp} returns @code{#f}, the build is considered to have failed.
9130
9131 @var{exp} is built using @var{guile-for-build} (a derivation). When
9132 @var{guile-for-build} is omitted or is @code{#f}, the value of the
9133 @code{%guile-for-build} fluid is used instead.
9134
9135 See the @code{derivation} procedure for the meaning of
9136 @var{references-graphs}, @var{allowed-references},
9137 @var{disallowed-references}, @var{local-build?}, and
9138 @var{substitutable?}.
9139 @end deffn
9140
9141 @noindent
9142 Here's an example of a single-output derivation that creates a directory
9143 containing one file:
9144
9145 @lisp
9146 (let ((builder '(let ((out (assoc-ref %outputs "out")))
9147 (mkdir out) ; create /gnu/store/@dots{}-goo
9148 (call-with-output-file (string-append out "/test")
9149 (lambda (p)
9150 (display '(hello guix) p))))))
9151 (build-expression->derivation store "goo" builder))
9152
9153 @result{} #<derivation /gnu/store/@dots{}-goo.drv => @dots{}>
9154 @end lisp
9155
9156
9157 @node The Store Monad
9158 @section The Store Monad
9159
9160 @cindex monad
9161
9162 The procedures that operate on the store described in the previous
9163 sections all take an open connection to the build daemon as their first
9164 argument. Although the underlying model is functional, they either have
9165 side effects or depend on the current state of the store.
9166
9167 The former is inconvenient: the connection to the build daemon has to be
9168 carried around in all those functions, making it impossible to compose
9169 functions that do not take that parameter with functions that do. The
9170 latter can be problematic: since store operations have side effects
9171 and/or depend on external state, they have to be properly sequenced.
9172
9173 @cindex monadic values
9174 @cindex monadic functions
9175 This is where the @code{(guix monads)} module comes in. This module
9176 provides a framework for working with @dfn{monads}, and a particularly
9177 useful monad for our uses, the @dfn{store monad}. Monads are a
9178 construct that allows two things: associating ``context'' with values
9179 (in our case, the context is the store), and building sequences of
9180 computations (here computations include accesses to the store). Values
9181 in a monad---values that carry this additional context---are called
9182 @dfn{monadic values}; procedures that return such values are called
9183 @dfn{monadic procedures}.
9184
9185 Consider this ``normal'' procedure:
9186
9187 @lisp
9188 (define (sh-symlink store)
9189 ;; Return a derivation that symlinks the 'bash' executable.
9190 (let* ((drv (package-derivation store bash))
9191 (out (derivation->output-path drv))
9192 (sh (string-append out "/bin/bash")))
9193 (build-expression->derivation store "sh"
9194 `(symlink ,sh %output))))
9195 @end lisp
9196
9197 Using @code{(guix monads)} and @code{(guix gexp)}, it may be rewritten
9198 as a monadic function:
9199
9200 @lisp
9201 (define (sh-symlink)
9202 ;; Same, but return a monadic value.
9203 (mlet %store-monad ((drv (package->derivation bash)))
9204 (gexp->derivation "sh"
9205 #~(symlink (string-append #$drv "/bin/bash")
9206 #$output))))
9207 @end lisp
9208
9209 There are several things to note in the second version: the @code{store}
9210 parameter is now implicit and is ``threaded'' in the calls to the
9211 @code{package->derivation} and @code{gexp->derivation} monadic
9212 procedures, and the monadic value returned by @code{package->derivation}
9213 is @dfn{bound} using @code{mlet} instead of plain @code{let}.
9214
9215 As it turns out, the call to @code{package->derivation} can even be
9216 omitted since it will take place implicitly, as we will see later
9217 (@pxref{G-Expressions}):
9218
9219 @lisp
9220 (define (sh-symlink)
9221 (gexp->derivation "sh"
9222 #~(symlink (string-append #$bash "/bin/bash")
9223 #$output)))
9224 @end lisp
9225
9226 @c See
9227 @c <https://syntaxexclamation.wordpress.com/2014/06/26/escaping-continuations/>
9228 @c for the funny quote.
9229 Calling the monadic @code{sh-symlink} has no effect. As someone once
9230 said, ``you exit a monad like you exit a building on fire: by running''.
9231 So, to exit the monad and get the desired effect, one must use
9232 @code{run-with-store}:
9233
9234 @lisp
9235 (run-with-store (open-connection) (sh-symlink))
9236 @result{} /gnu/store/...-sh-symlink
9237 @end lisp
9238
9239 Note that the @code{(guix monad-repl)} module extends the Guile REPL with
9240 new ``meta-commands'' to make it easier to deal with monadic procedures:
9241 @code{run-in-store}, and @code{enter-store-monad}. The former is used
9242 to ``run'' a single monadic value through the store:
9243
9244 @example
9245 scheme@@(guile-user)> ,run-in-store (package->derivation hello)
9246 $1 = #<derivation /gnu/store/@dots{}-hello-2.9.drv => @dots{}>
9247 @end example
9248
9249 The latter enters a recursive REPL, where all the return values are
9250 automatically run through the store:
9251
9252 @example
9253 scheme@@(guile-user)> ,enter-store-monad
9254 store-monad@@(guile-user) [1]> (package->derivation hello)
9255 $2 = #<derivation /gnu/store/@dots{}-hello-2.9.drv => @dots{}>
9256 store-monad@@(guile-user) [1]> (text-file "foo" "Hello!")
9257 $3 = "/gnu/store/@dots{}-foo"
9258 store-monad@@(guile-user) [1]> ,q
9259 scheme@@(guile-user)>
9260 @end example
9261
9262 @noindent
9263 Note that non-monadic values cannot be returned in the
9264 @code{store-monad} REPL.
9265
9266 The main syntactic forms to deal with monads in general are provided by
9267 the @code{(guix monads)} module and are described below.
9268
9269 @deffn {Scheme Syntax} with-monad @var{monad} @var{body} ...
9270 Evaluate any @code{>>=} or @code{return} forms in @var{body} as being
9271 in @var{monad}.
9272 @end deffn
9273
9274 @deffn {Scheme Syntax} return @var{val}
9275 Return a monadic value that encapsulates @var{val}.
9276 @end deffn
9277
9278 @deffn {Scheme Syntax} >>= @var{mval} @var{mproc} ...
9279 @dfn{Bind} monadic value @var{mval}, passing its ``contents'' to monadic
9280 procedures @var{mproc}@dots{}@footnote{This operation is commonly
9281 referred to as ``bind'', but that name denotes an unrelated procedure in
9282 Guile. Thus we use this somewhat cryptic symbol inherited from the
9283 Haskell language.}. There can be one @var{mproc} or several of them, as
9284 in this example:
9285
9286 @lisp
9287 (run-with-state
9288 (with-monad %state-monad
9289 (>>= (return 1)
9290 (lambda (x) (return (+ 1 x)))
9291 (lambda (x) (return (* 2 x)))))
9292 'some-state)
9293
9294 @result{} 4
9295 @result{} some-state
9296 @end lisp
9297 @end deffn
9298
9299 @deffn {Scheme Syntax} mlet @var{monad} ((@var{var} @var{mval}) ...) @
9300 @var{body} ...
9301 @deffnx {Scheme Syntax} mlet* @var{monad} ((@var{var} @var{mval}) ...) @
9302 @var{body} ...
9303 Bind the variables @var{var} to the monadic values @var{mval} in
9304 @var{body}, which is a sequence of expressions. As with the bind
9305 operator, this can be thought of as ``unpacking'' the raw, non-monadic
9306 value ``contained'' in @var{mval} and making @var{var} refer to that
9307 raw, non-monadic value within the scope of the @var{body}. The form
9308 (@var{var} -> @var{val}) binds @var{var} to the ``normal'' value
9309 @var{val}, as per @code{let}. The binding operations occur in sequence
9310 from left to right. The last expression of @var{body} must be a monadic
9311 expression, and its result will become the result of the @code{mlet} or
9312 @code{mlet*} when run in the @var{monad}.
9313
9314 @code{mlet*} is to @code{mlet} what @code{let*} is to @code{let}
9315 (@pxref{Local Bindings,,, guile, GNU Guile Reference Manual}).
9316 @end deffn
9317
9318 @deffn {Scheme System} mbegin @var{monad} @var{mexp} ...
9319 Bind @var{mexp} and the following monadic expressions in sequence,
9320 returning the result of the last expression. Every expression in the
9321 sequence must be a monadic expression.
9322
9323 This is akin to @code{mlet}, except that the return values of the
9324 monadic expressions are ignored. In that sense, it is analogous to
9325 @code{begin}, but applied to monadic expressions.
9326 @end deffn
9327
9328 @deffn {Scheme System} mwhen @var{condition} @var{mexp0} @var{mexp*} ...
9329 When @var{condition} is true, evaluate the sequence of monadic
9330 expressions @var{mexp0}..@var{mexp*} as in an @code{mbegin}. When
9331 @var{condition} is false, return @code{*unspecified*} in the current
9332 monad. Every expression in the sequence must be a monadic expression.
9333 @end deffn
9334
9335 @deffn {Scheme System} munless @var{condition} @var{mexp0} @var{mexp*} ...
9336 When @var{condition} is false, evaluate the sequence of monadic
9337 expressions @var{mexp0}..@var{mexp*} as in an @code{mbegin}. When
9338 @var{condition} is true, return @code{*unspecified*} in the current
9339 monad. Every expression in the sequence must be a monadic expression.
9340 @end deffn
9341
9342 @cindex state monad
9343 The @code{(guix monads)} module provides the @dfn{state monad}, which
9344 allows an additional value---the state---to be @emph{threaded} through
9345 monadic procedure calls.
9346
9347 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %state-monad
9348 The state monad. Procedures in the state monad can access and change
9349 the state that is threaded.
9350
9351 Consider the example below. The @code{square} procedure returns a value
9352 in the state monad. It returns the square of its argument, but also
9353 increments the current state value:
9354
9355 @lisp
9356 (define (square x)
9357 (mlet %state-monad ((count (current-state)))
9358 (mbegin %state-monad
9359 (set-current-state (+ 1 count))
9360 (return (* x x)))))
9361
9362 (run-with-state (sequence %state-monad (map square (iota 3))) 0)
9363 @result{} (0 1 4)
9364 @result{} 3
9365 @end lisp
9366
9367 When ``run'' through @code{%state-monad}, we obtain that additional state
9368 value, which is the number of @code{square} calls.
9369 @end defvr
9370
9371 @deffn {Monadic Procedure} current-state
9372 Return the current state as a monadic value.
9373 @end deffn
9374
9375 @deffn {Monadic Procedure} set-current-state @var{value}
9376 Set the current state to @var{value} and return the previous state as a
9377 monadic value.
9378 @end deffn
9379
9380 @deffn {Monadic Procedure} state-push @var{value}
9381 Push @var{value} to the current state, which is assumed to be a list,
9382 and return the previous state as a monadic value.
9383 @end deffn
9384
9385 @deffn {Monadic Procedure} state-pop
9386 Pop a value from the current state and return it as a monadic value.
9387 The state is assumed to be a list.
9388 @end deffn
9389
9390 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} run-with-state @var{mval} [@var{state}]
9391 Run monadic value @var{mval} starting with @var{state} as the initial
9392 state. Return two values: the resulting value, and the resulting state.
9393 @end deffn
9394
9395 The main interface to the store monad, provided by the @code{(guix
9396 store)} module, is as follows.
9397
9398 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %store-monad
9399 The store monad---an alias for @code{%state-monad}.
9400
9401 Values in the store monad encapsulate accesses to the store. When its
9402 effect is needed, a value of the store monad must be ``evaluated'' by
9403 passing it to the @code{run-with-store} procedure (see below).
9404 @end defvr
9405
9406 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} run-with-store @var{store} @var{mval} [#:guile-for-build] [#:system (%current-system)]
9407 Run @var{mval}, a monadic value in the store monad, in @var{store}, an
9408 open store connection.
9409 @end deffn
9410
9411 @deffn {Monadic Procedure} text-file @var{name} @var{text} [@var{references}]
9412 Return as a monadic value the absolute file name in the store of the file
9413 containing @var{text}, a string. @var{references} is a list of store items that the
9414 resulting text file refers to; it defaults to the empty list.
9415 @end deffn
9416
9417 @deffn {Monadic Procedure} binary-file @var{name} @var{data} [@var{references}]
9418 Return as a monadic value the absolute file name in the store of the file
9419 containing @var{data}, a bytevector. @var{references} is a list of store
9420 items that the resulting binary file refers to; it defaults to the empty list.
9421 @end deffn
9422
9423 @deffn {Monadic Procedure} interned-file @var{file} [@var{name}] @
9424 [#:recursive? #t] [#:select? (const #t)]
9425 Return the name of @var{file} once interned in the store. Use
9426 @var{name} as its store name, or the basename of @var{file} if
9427 @var{name} is omitted.
9428
9429 When @var{recursive?} is true, the contents of @var{file} are added
9430 recursively; if @var{file} designates a flat file and @var{recursive?}
9431 is true, its contents are added, and its permission bits are kept.
9432
9433 When @var{recursive?} is true, call @code{(@var{select?} @var{file}
9434 @var{stat})} for each directory entry, where @var{file} is the entry's
9435 absolute file name and @var{stat} is the result of @code{lstat}; exclude
9436 entries for which @var{select?} does not return true.
9437
9438 The example below adds a file to the store, under two different names:
9439
9440 @lisp
9441 (run-with-store (open-connection)
9442 (mlet %store-monad ((a (interned-file "README"))
9443 (b (interned-file "README" "LEGU-MIN")))
9444 (return (list a b))))
9445
9446 @result{} ("/gnu/store/rwm@dots{}-README" "/gnu/store/44i@dots{}-LEGU-MIN")
9447 @end lisp
9448
9449 @end deffn
9450
9451 The @code{(guix packages)} module exports the following package-related
9452 monadic procedures:
9453
9454 @deffn {Monadic Procedure} package-file @var{package} [@var{file}] @
9455 [#:system (%current-system)] [#:target #f] @
9456 [#:output "out"]
9457 Return as a monadic
9458 value in the absolute file name of @var{file} within the @var{output}
9459 directory of @var{package}. When @var{file} is omitted, return the name
9460 of the @var{output} directory of @var{package}. When @var{target} is
9461 true, use it as a cross-compilation target triplet.
9462
9463 Note that this procedure does @emph{not} build @var{package}. Thus, the
9464 result might or might not designate an existing file. We recommend not
9465 using this procedure unless you know what you are doing.
9466 @end deffn
9467
9468 @deffn {Monadic Procedure} package->derivation @var{package} [@var{system}]
9469 @deffnx {Monadic Procedure} package->cross-derivation @var{package} @
9470 @var{target} [@var{system}]
9471 Monadic version of @code{package-derivation} and
9472 @code{package-cross-derivation} (@pxref{Defining Packages}).
9473 @end deffn
9474
9475
9476 @node G-Expressions
9477 @section G-Expressions
9478
9479 @cindex G-expression
9480 @cindex build code quoting
9481 So we have ``derivations'', which represent a sequence of build actions
9482 to be performed to produce an item in the store (@pxref{Derivations}).
9483 These build actions are performed when asking the daemon to actually
9484 build the derivations; they are run by the daemon in a container
9485 (@pxref{Invoking guix-daemon}).
9486
9487 @cindex code staging
9488 @cindex staging, of code
9489 @cindex strata of code
9490 It should come as no surprise that we like to write these build actions
9491 in Scheme. When we do that, we end up with two @dfn{strata} of Scheme
9492 code@footnote{The term @dfn{stratum} in this context was coined by
9493 Manuel Serrano et al.@: in the context of their work on Hop. Oleg
9494 Kiselyov, who has written insightful
9495 @url{http://okmij.org/ftp/meta-programming/#meta-scheme, essays and code
9496 on this topic}, refers to this kind of code generation as
9497 @dfn{staging}.}: the ``host code''---code that defines packages, talks
9498 to the daemon, etc.---and the ``build code''---code that actually
9499 performs build actions, such as making directories, invoking
9500 @command{make}, and so on (@pxref{Build Phases}).
9501
9502 To describe a derivation and its build actions, one typically needs to
9503 embed build code inside host code. It boils down to manipulating build
9504 code as data, and the homoiconicity of Scheme---code has a direct
9505 representation as data---comes in handy for that. But we need more than
9506 the normal @code{quasiquote} mechanism in Scheme to construct build
9507 expressions.
9508
9509 The @code{(guix gexp)} module implements @dfn{G-expressions}, a form of
9510 S-expressions adapted to build expressions. G-expressions, or
9511 @dfn{gexps}, consist essentially of three syntactic forms: @code{gexp},
9512 @code{ungexp}, and @code{ungexp-splicing} (or simply: @code{#~},
9513 @code{#$}, and @code{#$@@}), which are comparable to
9514 @code{quasiquote}, @code{unquote}, and @code{unquote-splicing},
9515 respectively (@pxref{Expression Syntax, @code{quasiquote},, guile,
9516 GNU Guile Reference Manual}). However, there are major differences:
9517
9518 @itemize
9519 @item
9520 Gexps are meant to be written to a file and run or manipulated by other
9521 processes.
9522
9523 @item
9524 When a high-level object such as a package or derivation is unquoted
9525 inside a gexp, the result is as if its output file name had been
9526 introduced.
9527
9528 @item
9529 Gexps carry information about the packages or derivations they refer to,
9530 and these dependencies are automatically added as inputs to the build
9531 processes that use them.
9532 @end itemize
9533
9534 @cindex lowering, of high-level objects in gexps
9535 This mechanism is not limited to package and derivation
9536 objects: @dfn{compilers} able to ``lower'' other high-level objects to
9537 derivations or files in the store can be defined,
9538 such that these objects can also be inserted
9539 into gexps. For example, a useful type of high-level objects that can be
9540 inserted in a gexp is ``file-like objects'', which make it easy to
9541 add files to the store and to refer to them in
9542 derivations and such (see @code{local-file} and @code{plain-file}
9543 below).
9544
9545 To illustrate the idea, here is an example of a gexp:
9546
9547 @lisp
9548 (define build-exp
9549 #~(begin
9550 (mkdir #$output)
9551 (chdir #$output)
9552 (symlink (string-append #$coreutils "/bin/ls")
9553 "list-files")))
9554 @end lisp
9555
9556 This gexp can be passed to @code{gexp->derivation}; we obtain a
9557 derivation that builds a directory containing exactly one symlink to
9558 @file{/gnu/store/@dots{}-coreutils-8.22/bin/ls}:
9559
9560 @lisp
9561 (gexp->derivation "the-thing" build-exp)
9562 @end lisp
9563
9564 As one would expect, the @code{"/gnu/store/@dots{}-coreutils-8.22"} string is
9565 substituted to the reference to the @var{coreutils} package in the
9566 actual build code, and @var{coreutils} is automatically made an input to
9567 the derivation. Likewise, @code{#$output} (equivalent to @code{(ungexp
9568 output)}) is replaced by a string containing the directory name of the
9569 output of the derivation.
9570
9571 @cindex cross compilation
9572 In a cross-compilation context, it is useful to distinguish between
9573 references to the @emph{native} build of a package---that can run on the
9574 host---versus references to cross builds of a package. To that end, the
9575 @code{#+} plays the same role as @code{#$}, but is a reference to a
9576 native package build:
9577
9578 @lisp
9579 (gexp->derivation "vi"
9580 #~(begin
9581 (mkdir #$output)
9582 (mkdir (string-append #$output "/bin"))
9583 (system* (string-append #+coreutils "/bin/ln")
9584 "-s"
9585 (string-append #$emacs "/bin/emacs")
9586 (string-append #$output "/bin/vi")))
9587 #:target "aarch64-linux-gnu")
9588 @end lisp
9589
9590 @noindent
9591 In the example above, the native build of @var{coreutils} is used, so
9592 that @command{ln} can actually run on the host; but then the
9593 cross-compiled build of @var{emacs} is referenced.
9594
9595 @cindex imported modules, for gexps
9596 @findex with-imported-modules
9597 Another gexp feature is @dfn{imported modules}: sometimes you want to be
9598 able to use certain Guile modules from the ``host environment'' in the
9599 gexp, so those modules should be imported in the ``build environment''.
9600 The @code{with-imported-modules} form allows you to express that:
9601
9602 @lisp
9603 (let ((build (with-imported-modules '((guix build utils))
9604 #~(begin
9605 (use-modules (guix build utils))
9606 (mkdir-p (string-append #$output "/bin"))))))
9607 (gexp->derivation "empty-dir"
9608 #~(begin
9609 #$build
9610 (display "success!\n")
9611 #t)))
9612 @end lisp
9613
9614 @noindent
9615 In this example, the @code{(guix build utils)} module is automatically
9616 pulled into the isolated build environment of our gexp, such that
9617 @code{(use-modules (guix build utils))} works as expected.
9618
9619 @cindex module closure
9620 @findex source-module-closure
9621 Usually you want the @emph{closure} of the module to be imported---i.e.,
9622 the module itself and all the modules it depends on---rather than just
9623 the module; failing to do that, attempts to use the module will fail
9624 because of missing dependent modules. The @code{source-module-closure}
9625 procedure computes the closure of a module by looking at its source file
9626 headers, which comes in handy in this case:
9627
9628 @lisp
9629 (use-modules (guix modules)) ;for 'source-module-closure'
9630
9631 (with-imported-modules (source-module-closure
9632 '((guix build utils)
9633 (gnu build vm)))
9634 (gexp->derivation "something-with-vms"
9635 #~(begin
9636 (use-modules (guix build utils)
9637 (gnu build vm))
9638 @dots{})))
9639 @end lisp
9640
9641 @cindex extensions, for gexps
9642 @findex with-extensions
9643 In the same vein, sometimes you want to import not just pure-Scheme
9644 modules, but also ``extensions'' such as Guile bindings to C libraries
9645 or other ``full-blown'' packages. Say you need the @code{guile-json}
9646 package available on the build side, here's how you would do it:
9647
9648 @lisp
9649 (use-modules (gnu packages guile)) ;for 'guile-json'
9650
9651 (with-extensions (list guile-json)
9652 (gexp->derivation "something-with-json"
9653 #~(begin
9654 (use-modules (json))
9655 @dots{})))
9656 @end lisp
9657
9658 The syntactic form to construct gexps is summarized below.
9659
9660 @deffn {Scheme Syntax} #~@var{exp}
9661 @deffnx {Scheme Syntax} (gexp @var{exp})
9662 Return a G-expression containing @var{exp}. @var{exp} may contain one
9663 or more of the following forms:
9664
9665 @table @code
9666 @item #$@var{obj}
9667 @itemx (ungexp @var{obj})
9668 Introduce a reference to @var{obj}. @var{obj} may have one of the
9669 supported types, for example a package or a
9670 derivation, in which case the @code{ungexp} form is replaced by its
9671 output file name---e.g., @code{"/gnu/store/@dots{}-coreutils-8.22}.
9672
9673 If @var{obj} is a list, it is traversed and references to supported
9674 objects are substituted similarly.
9675
9676 If @var{obj} is another gexp, its contents are inserted and its
9677 dependencies are added to those of the containing gexp.
9678
9679 If @var{obj} is another kind of object, it is inserted as is.
9680
9681 @item #$@var{obj}:@var{output}
9682 @itemx (ungexp @var{obj} @var{output})
9683 This is like the form above, but referring explicitly to the
9684 @var{output} of @var{obj}---this is useful when @var{obj} produces
9685 multiple outputs (@pxref{Packages with Multiple Outputs}).
9686
9687 @item #+@var{obj}
9688 @itemx #+@var{obj}:output
9689 @itemx (ungexp-native @var{obj})
9690 @itemx (ungexp-native @var{obj} @var{output})
9691 Same as @code{ungexp}, but produces a reference to the @emph{native}
9692 build of @var{obj} when used in a cross compilation context.
9693
9694 @item #$output[:@var{output}]
9695 @itemx (ungexp output [@var{output}])
9696 Insert a reference to derivation output @var{output}, or to the main
9697 output when @var{output} is omitted.
9698
9699 This only makes sense for gexps passed to @code{gexp->derivation}.
9700
9701 @item #$@@@var{lst}
9702 @itemx (ungexp-splicing @var{lst})
9703 Like the above, but splices the contents of @var{lst} inside the
9704 containing list.
9705
9706 @item #+@@@var{lst}
9707 @itemx (ungexp-native-splicing @var{lst})
9708 Like the above, but refers to native builds of the objects listed in
9709 @var{lst}.
9710
9711 @end table
9712
9713 G-expressions created by @code{gexp} or @code{#~} are run-time objects
9714 of the @code{gexp?} type (see below).
9715 @end deffn
9716
9717 @deffn {Scheme Syntax} with-imported-modules @var{modules} @var{body}@dots{}
9718 Mark the gexps defined in @var{body}@dots{} as requiring @var{modules}
9719 in their execution environment.
9720
9721 Each item in @var{modules} can be the name of a module, such as
9722 @code{(guix build utils)}, or it can be a module name, followed by an
9723 arrow, followed by a file-like object:
9724
9725 @lisp
9726 `((guix build utils)
9727 (guix gcrypt)
9728 ((guix config) => ,(scheme-file "config.scm"
9729 #~(define-module @dots{}))))
9730 @end lisp
9731
9732 @noindent
9733 In the example above, the first two modules are taken from the search
9734 path, and the last one is created from the given file-like object.
9735
9736 This form has @emph{lexical} scope: it has an effect on the gexps
9737 directly defined in @var{body}@dots{}, but not on those defined, say, in
9738 procedures called from @var{body}@dots{}.
9739 @end deffn
9740
9741 @deffn {Scheme Syntax} with-extensions @var{extensions} @var{body}@dots{}
9742 Mark the gexps defined in @var{body}@dots{} as requiring
9743 @var{extensions} in their build and execution environment.
9744 @var{extensions} is typically a list of package objects such as those
9745 defined in the @code{(gnu packages guile)} module.
9746
9747 Concretely, the packages listed in @var{extensions} are added to the
9748 load path while compiling imported modules in @var{body}@dots{}; they
9749 are also added to the load path of the gexp returned by
9750 @var{body}@dots{}.
9751 @end deffn
9752
9753 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} gexp? @var{obj}
9754 Return @code{#t} if @var{obj} is a G-expression.
9755 @end deffn
9756
9757 G-expressions are meant to be written to disk, either as code building
9758 some derivation, or as plain files in the store. The monadic procedures
9759 below allow you to do that (@pxref{The Store Monad}, for more
9760 information about monads).
9761
9762 @deffn {Monadic Procedure} gexp->derivation @var{name} @var{exp} @
9763 [#:system (%current-system)] [#:target #f] [#:graft? #t] @
9764 [#:hash #f] [#:hash-algo #f] @
9765 [#:recursive? #f] [#:env-vars '()] [#:modules '()] @
9766 [#:module-path @code{%load-path}] @
9767 [#:effective-version "2.2"] @
9768 [#:references-graphs #f] [#:allowed-references #f] @
9769 [#:disallowed-references #f] @
9770 [#:leaked-env-vars #f] @
9771 [#:script-name (string-append @var{name} "-builder")] @
9772 [#:deprecation-warnings #f] @
9773 [#:local-build? #f] [#:substitutable? #t] @
9774 [#:properties '()] [#:guile-for-build #f]
9775 Return a derivation @var{name} that runs @var{exp} (a gexp) with
9776 @var{guile-for-build} (a derivation) on @var{system}; @var{exp} is
9777 stored in a file called @var{script-name}. When @var{target} is true,
9778 it is used as the cross-compilation target triplet for packages referred
9779 to by @var{exp}.
9780
9781 @var{modules} is deprecated in favor of @code{with-imported-modules}.
9782 Its meaning is to
9783 make @var{modules} available in the evaluation context of @var{exp};
9784 @var{modules} is a list of names of Guile modules searched in
9785 @var{module-path} to be copied in the store, compiled, and made available in
9786 the load path during the execution of @var{exp}---e.g., @code{((guix
9787 build utils) (guix build gnu-build-system))}.
9788
9789 @var{effective-version} determines the string to use when adding extensions of
9790 @var{exp} (see @code{with-extensions}) to the search path---e.g., @code{"2.2"}.
9791
9792 @var{graft?} determines whether packages referred to by @var{exp} should be grafted when
9793 applicable.
9794
9795 When @var{references-graphs} is true, it must be a list of tuples of one of the
9796 following forms:
9797
9798 @example
9799 (@var{file-name} @var{package})
9800 (@var{file-name} @var{package} @var{output})
9801 (@var{file-name} @var{derivation})
9802 (@var{file-name} @var{derivation} @var{output})
9803 (@var{file-name} @var{store-item})
9804 @end example
9805
9806 The right-hand-side of each element of @var{references-graphs} is automatically made
9807 an input of the build process of @var{exp}. In the build environment, each
9808 @var{file-name} contains the reference graph of the corresponding item, in a simple
9809 text format.
9810
9811 @var{allowed-references} must be either @code{#f} or a list of output names and packages.
9812 In the latter case, the list denotes store items that the result is allowed to
9813 refer to. Any reference to another store item will lead to a build error.
9814 Similarly for @var{disallowed-references}, which can list items that must not be
9815 referenced by the outputs.
9816
9817 @var{deprecation-warnings} determines whether to show deprecation warnings while
9818 compiling modules. It can be @code{#f}, @code{#t}, or @code{'detailed}.
9819
9820 The other arguments are as for @code{derivation} (@pxref{Derivations}).
9821 @end deffn
9822
9823 @cindex file-like objects
9824 The @code{local-file}, @code{plain-file}, @code{computed-file},
9825 @code{program-file}, and @code{scheme-file} procedures below return
9826 @dfn{file-like objects}. That is, when unquoted in a G-expression,
9827 these objects lead to a file in the store. Consider this G-expression:
9828
9829 @lisp
9830 #~(system* #$(file-append glibc "/sbin/nscd") "-f"
9831 #$(local-file "/tmp/my-nscd.conf"))
9832 @end lisp
9833
9834 The effect here is to ``intern'' @file{/tmp/my-nscd.conf} by copying it
9835 to the store. Once expanded, for instance @i{via}
9836 @code{gexp->derivation}, the G-expression refers to that copy under
9837 @file{/gnu/store}; thus, modifying or removing the file in @file{/tmp}
9838 does not have any effect on what the G-expression does.
9839 @code{plain-file} can be used similarly; it differs in that the file
9840 content is directly passed as a string.
9841
9842 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} local-file @var{file} [@var{name}] @
9843 [#:recursive? #f] [#:select? (const #t)]
9844 Return an object representing local file @var{file} to add to the store;
9845 this object can be used in a gexp. If @var{file} is a literal string
9846 denoting a relative file name, it is looked up relative to the source
9847 file where it appears; if @var{file} is not a literal string, it is
9848 looked up relative to the current working directory at run time.
9849 @var{file} will be added to the store under @var{name}--by default the
9850 base name of @var{file}.
9851
9852 When @var{recursive?} is true, the contents of @var{file} are added recursively; if @var{file}
9853 designates a flat file and @var{recursive?} is true, its contents are added, and its
9854 permission bits are kept.
9855
9856 When @var{recursive?} is true, call @code{(@var{select?} @var{file}
9857 @var{stat})} for each directory entry, where @var{file} is the entry's
9858 absolute file name and @var{stat} is the result of @code{lstat}; exclude
9859 entries for which @var{select?} does not return true.
9860
9861 This is the declarative counterpart of the @code{interned-file} monadic
9862 procedure (@pxref{The Store Monad, @code{interned-file}}).
9863 @end deffn
9864
9865 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} plain-file @var{name} @var{content}
9866 Return an object representing a text file called @var{name} with the given
9867 @var{content} (a string or a bytevector) to be added to the store.
9868
9869 This is the declarative counterpart of @code{text-file}.
9870 @end deffn
9871
9872 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} computed-file @var{name} @var{gexp} @
9873 [#:local-build? #t]
9874 [#:options '()]
9875 Return an object representing the store item @var{name}, a file or
9876 directory computed by @var{gexp}. When @var{local-build?} is true (the
9877 default), the derivation is built locally. @var{options} is a list of
9878 additional arguments to pass to @code{gexp->derivation}.
9879
9880 This is the declarative counterpart of @code{gexp->derivation}.
9881 @end deffn
9882
9883 @deffn {Monadic Procedure} gexp->script @var{name} @var{exp} @
9884 [#:guile (default-guile)] [#:module-path %load-path] @
9885 [#:system (%current-system)] [#:target #f]
9886 Return an executable script @var{name} that runs @var{exp} using
9887 @var{guile}, with @var{exp}'s imported modules in its search path.
9888 Look up @var{exp}'s modules in @var{module-path}.
9889
9890 The example below builds a script that simply invokes the @command{ls}
9891 command:
9892
9893 @lisp
9894 (use-modules (guix gexp) (gnu packages base))
9895
9896 (gexp->script "list-files"
9897 #~(execl #$(file-append coreutils "/bin/ls")
9898 "ls"))
9899 @end lisp
9900
9901 When ``running'' it through the store (@pxref{The Store Monad,
9902 @code{run-with-store}}), we obtain a derivation that produces an
9903 executable file @file{/gnu/store/@dots{}-list-files} along these lines:
9904
9905 @example
9906 #!/gnu/store/@dots{}-guile-2.0.11/bin/guile -ds
9907 !#
9908 (execl "/gnu/store/@dots{}-coreutils-8.22"/bin/ls" "ls")
9909 @end example
9910 @end deffn
9911
9912 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} program-file @var{name} @var{exp} @
9913 [#:guile #f] [#:module-path %load-path]
9914 Return an object representing the executable store item @var{name} that
9915 runs @var{gexp}. @var{guile} is the Guile package used to execute that
9916 script. Imported modules of @var{gexp} are looked up in @var{module-path}.
9917
9918 This is the declarative counterpart of @code{gexp->script}.
9919 @end deffn
9920
9921 @deffn {Monadic Procedure} gexp->file @var{name} @var{exp} @
9922 [#:set-load-path? #t] [#:module-path %load-path] @
9923 [#:splice? #f] @
9924 [#:guile (default-guile)]
9925 Return a derivation that builds a file @var{name} containing @var{exp}.
9926 When @var{splice?} is true, @var{exp} is considered to be a list of
9927 expressions that will be spliced in the resulting file.
9928
9929 When @var{set-load-path?} is true, emit code in the resulting file to
9930 set @code{%load-path} and @code{%load-compiled-path} to honor
9931 @var{exp}'s imported modules. Look up @var{exp}'s modules in
9932 @var{module-path}.
9933
9934 The resulting file holds references to all the dependencies of @var{exp}
9935 or a subset thereof.
9936 @end deffn
9937
9938 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} scheme-file @var{name} @var{exp} @
9939 [#:splice? #f] [#:set-load-path? #t]
9940 Return an object representing the Scheme file @var{name} that contains
9941 @var{exp}.
9942
9943 This is the declarative counterpart of @code{gexp->file}.
9944 @end deffn
9945
9946 @deffn {Monadic Procedure} text-file* @var{name} @var{text} @dots{}
9947 Return as a monadic value a derivation that builds a text file
9948 containing all of @var{text}. @var{text} may list, in addition to
9949 strings, objects of any type that can be used in a gexp: packages,
9950 derivations, local file objects, etc. The resulting store file holds
9951 references to all these.
9952
9953 This variant should be preferred over @code{text-file} anytime the file
9954 to create will reference items from the store. This is typically the
9955 case when building a configuration file that embeds store file names,
9956 like this:
9957
9958 @lisp
9959 (define (profile.sh)
9960 ;; Return the name of a shell script in the store that
9961 ;; initializes the 'PATH' environment variable.
9962 (text-file* "profile.sh"
9963 "export PATH=" coreutils "/bin:"
9964 grep "/bin:" sed "/bin\n"))
9965 @end lisp
9966
9967 In this example, the resulting @file{/gnu/store/@dots{}-profile.sh} file
9968 will reference @var{coreutils}, @var{grep}, and @var{sed}, thereby
9969 preventing them from being garbage-collected during its lifetime.
9970 @end deffn
9971
9972 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} mixed-text-file @var{name} @var{text} @dots{}
9973 Return an object representing store file @var{name} containing
9974 @var{text}. @var{text} is a sequence of strings and file-like objects,
9975 as in:
9976
9977 @lisp
9978 (mixed-text-file "profile"
9979 "export PATH=" coreutils "/bin:" grep "/bin")
9980 @end lisp
9981
9982 This is the declarative counterpart of @code{text-file*}.
9983 @end deffn
9984
9985 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} file-union @var{name} @var{files}
9986 Return a @code{<computed-file>} that builds a directory containing all of @var{files}.
9987 Each item in @var{files} must be a two-element list where the first element is the
9988 file name to use in the new directory, and the second element is a gexp
9989 denoting the target file. Here's an example:
9990
9991 @lisp
9992 (file-union "etc"
9993 `(("hosts" ,(plain-file "hosts"
9994 "127.0.0.1 localhost"))
9995 ("bashrc" ,(plain-file "bashrc"
9996 "alias ls='ls --color=auto'"))))
9997 @end lisp
9998
9999 This yields an @code{etc} directory containing these two files.
10000 @end deffn
10001
10002 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} directory-union @var{name} @var{things}
10003 Return a directory that is the union of @var{things}, where @var{things} is a list of
10004 file-like objects denoting directories. For example:
10005
10006 @lisp
10007 (directory-union "guile+emacs" (list guile emacs))
10008 @end lisp
10009
10010 yields a directory that is the union of the @code{guile} and @code{emacs} packages.
10011 @end deffn
10012
10013 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} file-append @var{obj} @var{suffix} @dots{}
10014 Return a file-like object that expands to the concatenation of @var{obj}
10015 and @var{suffix}, where @var{obj} is a lowerable object and each
10016 @var{suffix} is a string.
10017
10018 As an example, consider this gexp:
10019
10020 @lisp
10021 (gexp->script "run-uname"
10022 #~(system* #$(file-append coreutils
10023 "/bin/uname")))
10024 @end lisp
10025
10026 The same effect could be achieved with:
10027
10028 @lisp
10029 (gexp->script "run-uname"
10030 #~(system* (string-append #$coreutils
10031 "/bin/uname")))
10032 @end lisp
10033
10034 There is one difference though: in the @code{file-append} case, the
10035 resulting script contains the absolute file name as a string, whereas in
10036 the second case, the resulting script contains a @code{(string-append
10037 @dots{})} expression to construct the file name @emph{at run time}.
10038 @end deffn
10039
10040 @deffn {Scheme Syntax} let-system @var{system} @var{body}@dots{}
10041 @deffnx {Scheme Syntax} let-system (@var{system} @var{target}) @var{body}@dots{}
10042 Bind @var{system} to the currently targeted system---e.g.,
10043 @code{"x86_64-linux"}---within @var{body}.
10044
10045 In the second case, additionally bind @var{target} to the current
10046 cross-compilation target---a GNU triplet such as
10047 @code{"arm-linux-gnueabihf"}---or @code{#f} if we are not
10048 cross-compiling.
10049
10050 @code{let-system} is useful in the occasional case where the object
10051 spliced into the gexp depends on the target system, as in this example:
10052
10053 @lisp
10054 #~(system*
10055 #+(let-system system
10056 (cond ((string-prefix? "armhf-" system)
10057 (file-append qemu "/bin/qemu-system-arm"))
10058 ((string-prefix? "x86_64-" system)
10059 (file-append qemu "/bin/qemu-system-x86_64"))
10060 (else
10061 (error "dunno!"))))
10062 "-net" "user" #$image)
10063 @end lisp
10064 @end deffn
10065
10066 @deffn {Scheme Syntax} with-parameters ((@var{parameter} @var{value}) @dots{}) @var{exp}
10067 This macro is similar to the @code{parameterize} form for
10068 dynamically-bound @dfn{parameters} (@pxref{Parameters,,, guile, GNU
10069 Guile Reference Manual}). The key difference is that it takes effect
10070 when the file-like object returned by @var{exp} is lowered to a
10071 derivation or store item.
10072
10073 A typical use of @code{with-parameters} is to force the system in effect
10074 for a given object:
10075
10076 @lisp
10077 (with-parameters ((%current-system "i686-linux"))
10078 coreutils)
10079 @end lisp
10080
10081 The example above returns an object that corresponds to the i686 build
10082 of Coreutils, regardless of the current value of @code{%current-system}.
10083 @end deffn
10084
10085
10086 Of course, in addition to gexps embedded in ``host'' code, there are
10087 also modules containing build tools. To make it clear that they are
10088 meant to be used in the build stratum, these modules are kept in the
10089 @code{(guix build @dots{})} name space.
10090
10091 @cindex lowering, of high-level objects in gexps
10092 Internally, high-level objects are @dfn{lowered}, using their compiler,
10093 to either derivations or store items. For instance, lowering a package
10094 yields a derivation, and lowering a @code{plain-file} yields a store
10095 item. This is achieved using the @code{lower-object} monadic procedure.
10096
10097 @deffn {Monadic Procedure} lower-object @var{obj} [@var{system}] @
10098 [#:target #f]
10099 Return as a value in @code{%store-monad} the derivation or store item
10100 corresponding to @var{obj} for @var{system}, cross-compiling for
10101 @var{target} if @var{target} is true. @var{obj} must be an object that
10102 has an associated gexp compiler, such as a @code{<package>}.
10103 @end deffn
10104
10105 @deffn {Procedure} gexp->approximate-sexp @var{gexp}
10106 Sometimes, it may be useful to convert a G-exp into a S-exp. For
10107 example, some linters (@pxref{Invoking guix lint}) peek into the build
10108 phases of a package to detect potential problems. This conversion can
10109 be achieved with this procedure. However, some information can be lost
10110 in the process. More specifically, lowerable objects will be silently
10111 replaced with some arbitrary object -- currently the list
10112 @code{(*approximate*)}, but this may change.
10113 @end deffn
10114
10115 @node Invoking guix repl
10116 @section Invoking @command{guix repl}
10117
10118 @cindex REPL, read-eval-print loop, script
10119 The @command{guix repl} command makes it easier to program Guix in Guile
10120 by launching a Guile @dfn{read-eval-print loop} (REPL) for interactive
10121 programming (@pxref{Using Guile Interactively,,, guile,
10122 GNU Guile Reference Manual}), or by running Guile scripts
10123 (@pxref{Running Guile Scripts,,, guile,
10124 GNU Guile Reference Manual}).
10125 Compared to just launching the @command{guile}
10126 command, @command{guix repl} guarantees that all the Guix modules and all its
10127 dependencies are available in the search path.
10128
10129 The general syntax is:
10130
10131 @example
10132 guix repl @var{options} [@var{file} @var{args}]
10133 @end example
10134
10135 When a @var{file} argument is provided, @var{file} is
10136 executed as a Guile scripts:
10137
10138 @example
10139 guix repl my-script.scm
10140 @end example
10141
10142 To pass arguments to the script, use @code{--} to prevent them from
10143 being interpreted as arguments to @command{guix repl} itself:
10144
10145 @example
10146 guix repl -- my-script.scm --input=foo.txt
10147 @end example
10148
10149 To make a script executable directly from the shell, using the guix
10150 executable that is on the user's search path, add the following two
10151 lines at the top of the script:
10152
10153 @example
10154 @code{#!/usr/bin/env -S guix repl --}
10155 @code{!#}
10156 @end example
10157
10158 Without a file name argument, a Guile REPL is started:
10159
10160 @example
10161 $ guix repl
10162 scheme@@(guile-user)> ,use (gnu packages base)
10163 scheme@@(guile-user)> coreutils
10164 $1 = #<package coreutils@@8.29 gnu/packages/base.scm:327 3e28300>
10165 @end example
10166
10167 @cindex inferiors
10168 In addition, @command{guix repl} implements a simple machine-readable REPL
10169 protocol for use by @code{(guix inferior)}, a facility to interact with
10170 @dfn{inferiors}, separate processes running a potentially different revision
10171 of Guix.
10172
10173 The available options are as follows:
10174
10175 @table @code
10176 @item --type=@var{type}
10177 @itemx -t @var{type}
10178 Start a REPL of the given @var{TYPE}, which can be one of the following:
10179
10180 @table @code
10181 @item guile
10182 This is default, and it spawns a standard full-featured Guile REPL.
10183 @item machine
10184 Spawn a REPL that uses the machine-readable protocol. This is the protocol
10185 that the @code{(guix inferior)} module speaks.
10186 @end table
10187
10188 @item --listen=@var{endpoint}
10189 By default, @command{guix repl} reads from standard input and writes to
10190 standard output. When this option is passed, it will instead listen for
10191 connections on @var{endpoint}. Here are examples of valid options:
10192
10193 @table @code
10194 @item --listen=tcp:37146
10195 Accept connections on localhost on port 37146.
10196
10197 @item --listen=unix:/tmp/socket
10198 Accept connections on the Unix-domain socket @file{/tmp/socket}.
10199 @end table
10200
10201 @item --load-path=@var{directory}
10202 @itemx -L @var{directory}
10203 Add @var{directory} to the front of the package module search path
10204 (@pxref{Package Modules}).
10205
10206 This allows users to define their own packages and make them visible to
10207 the script or REPL.
10208
10209 @item -q
10210 Inhibit loading of the @file{~/.guile} file. By default, that
10211 configuration file is loaded when spawning a @code{guile} REPL.
10212 @end table
10213
10214 @c *********************************************************************
10215 @node Utilities
10216 @chapter Utilities
10217
10218 This section describes Guix command-line utilities. Some of them are
10219 primarily targeted at developers and users who write new package
10220 definitions, while others are more generally useful. They complement
10221 the Scheme programming interface of Guix in a convenient way.
10222
10223 @menu
10224 * Invoking guix build:: Building packages from the command line.
10225 * Invoking guix edit:: Editing package definitions.
10226 * Invoking guix download:: Downloading a file and printing its hash.
10227 * Invoking guix hash:: Computing the cryptographic hash of a file.
10228 * Invoking guix import:: Importing package definitions.
10229 * Invoking guix refresh:: Updating package definitions.
10230 * Invoking guix lint:: Finding errors in package definitions.
10231 * Invoking guix size:: Profiling disk usage.
10232 * Invoking guix graph:: Visualizing the graph of packages.
10233 * Invoking guix publish:: Sharing substitutes.
10234 * Invoking guix challenge:: Challenging substitute servers.
10235 * Invoking guix copy:: Copying to and from a remote store.
10236 * Invoking guix container:: Process isolation.
10237 * Invoking guix weather:: Assessing substitute availability.
10238 * Invoking guix processes:: Listing client processes.
10239 @end menu
10240
10241 @node Invoking guix build
10242 @section Invoking @command{guix build}
10243
10244 @cindex package building
10245 @cindex @command{guix build}
10246 The @command{guix build} command builds packages or derivations and
10247 their dependencies, and prints the resulting store paths. Note that it
10248 does not modify the user's profile---this is the job of the
10249 @command{guix package} command (@pxref{Invoking guix package}). Thus,
10250 it is mainly useful for distribution developers.
10251
10252 The general syntax is:
10253
10254 @example
10255 guix build @var{options} @var{package-or-derivation}@dots{}
10256 @end example
10257
10258 As an example, the following command builds the latest versions of Emacs
10259 and of Guile, displays their build logs, and finally displays the
10260 resulting directories:
10261
10262 @example
10263 guix build emacs guile
10264 @end example
10265
10266 Similarly, the following command builds all the available packages:
10267
10268 @example
10269 guix build --quiet --keep-going \
10270 $(guix package -A | awk '@{ print $1 "@@" $2 @}')
10271 @end example
10272
10273 @var{package-or-derivation} may be either the name of a package found in
10274 the software distribution such as @code{coreutils} or
10275 @code{coreutils@@8.20}, or a derivation such as
10276 @file{/gnu/store/@dots{}-coreutils-8.19.drv}. In the former case, a
10277 package with the corresponding name (and optionally version) is searched
10278 for among the GNU distribution modules (@pxref{Package Modules}).
10279
10280 Alternatively, the @option{--expression} option may be used to specify a
10281 Scheme expression that evaluates to a package; this is useful when
10282 disambiguating among several same-named packages or package variants is
10283 needed.
10284
10285 There may be zero or more @var{options}. The available options are
10286 described in the subsections below.
10287
10288 @menu
10289 * Common Build Options:: Build options for most commands.
10290 * Package Transformation Options:: Creating variants of packages.
10291 * Additional Build Options:: Options specific to 'guix build'.
10292 * Debugging Build Failures:: Real life packaging experience.
10293 @end menu
10294
10295 @node Common Build Options
10296 @subsection Common Build Options
10297
10298 A number of options that control the build process are common to
10299 @command{guix build} and other commands that can spawn builds, such as
10300 @command{guix package} or @command{guix archive}. These are the
10301 following:
10302
10303 @table @code
10304
10305 @item --load-path=@var{directory}
10306 @itemx -L @var{directory}
10307 Add @var{directory} to the front of the package module search path
10308 (@pxref{Package Modules}).
10309
10310 This allows users to define their own packages and make them visible to
10311 the command-line tools.
10312
10313 @item --keep-failed
10314 @itemx -K
10315 Keep the build tree of failed builds. Thus, if a build fails, its build
10316 tree is kept under @file{/tmp}, in a directory whose name is shown at
10317 the end of the build log. This is useful when debugging build issues.
10318 @xref{Debugging Build Failures}, for tips and tricks on how to debug
10319 build issues.
10320
10321 This option implies @option{--no-offload}, and it has no effect when
10322 connecting to a remote daemon with a @code{guix://} URI (@pxref{The
10323 Store, the @env{GUIX_DAEMON_SOCKET} variable}).
10324
10325 @item --keep-going
10326 @itemx -k
10327 Keep going when some of the derivations fail to build; return only once
10328 all the builds have either completed or failed.
10329
10330 The default behavior is to stop as soon as one of the specified
10331 derivations has failed.
10332
10333 @item --dry-run
10334 @itemx -n
10335 Do not build the derivations.
10336
10337 @anchor{fallback-option}
10338 @item --fallback
10339 When substituting a pre-built binary fails, fall back to building
10340 packages locally (@pxref{Substitution Failure}).
10341
10342 @item --substitute-urls=@var{urls}
10343 @anchor{client-substitute-urls}
10344 Consider @var{urls} the whitespace-separated list of substitute source
10345 URLs, overriding the default list of URLs of @command{guix-daemon}
10346 (@pxref{daemon-substitute-urls,, @command{guix-daemon} URLs}).
10347
10348 This means that substitutes may be downloaded from @var{urls}, provided
10349 they are signed by a key authorized by the system administrator
10350 (@pxref{Substitutes}).
10351
10352 When @var{urls} is the empty string, substitutes are effectively
10353 disabled.
10354
10355 @item --no-substitutes
10356 Do not use substitutes for build products. That is, always build things
10357 locally instead of allowing downloads of pre-built binaries
10358 (@pxref{Substitutes}).
10359
10360 @item --no-grafts
10361 Do not ``graft'' packages. In practice, this means that package updates
10362 available as grafts are not applied. @xref{Security Updates}, for more
10363 information on grafts.
10364
10365 @item --rounds=@var{n}
10366 Build each derivation @var{n} times in a row, and raise an error if
10367 consecutive build results are not bit-for-bit identical.
10368
10369 This is a useful way to detect non-deterministic builds processes.
10370 Non-deterministic build processes are a problem because they make it
10371 practically impossible for users to @emph{verify} whether third-party
10372 binaries are genuine. @xref{Invoking guix challenge}, for more.
10373
10374 When used in conjunction with @option{--keep-failed}, the differing
10375 output is kept in the store, under @file{/gnu/store/@dots{}-check}.
10376 This makes it easy to look for differences between the two results.
10377
10378 @item --no-offload
10379 Do not use offload builds to other machines (@pxref{Daemon Offload
10380 Setup}). That is, always build things locally instead of offloading
10381 builds to remote machines.
10382
10383 @item --max-silent-time=@var{seconds}
10384 When the build or substitution process remains silent for more than
10385 @var{seconds}, terminate it and report a build failure.
10386
10387 By default, the daemon's setting is honored (@pxref{Invoking
10388 guix-daemon, @option{--max-silent-time}}).
10389
10390 @item --timeout=@var{seconds}
10391 Likewise, when the build or substitution process lasts for more than
10392 @var{seconds}, terminate it and report a build failure.
10393
10394 By default, the daemon's setting is honored (@pxref{Invoking
10395 guix-daemon, @option{--timeout}}).
10396
10397 @c Note: This option is actually not part of %standard-build-options but
10398 @c most programs honor it.
10399 @cindex verbosity, of the command-line tools
10400 @cindex build logs, verbosity
10401 @item -v @var{level}
10402 @itemx --verbosity=@var{level}
10403 Use the given verbosity @var{level}, an integer. Choosing 0 means that
10404 no output is produced, 1 is for quiet output; 2 is similar to 1 but it
10405 additionally displays download URLs; 3 shows all the build log output on
10406 standard error.
10407
10408 @item --cores=@var{n}
10409 @itemx -c @var{n}
10410 Allow the use of up to @var{n} CPU cores for the build. The special
10411 value @code{0} means to use as many CPU cores as available.
10412
10413 @item --max-jobs=@var{n}
10414 @itemx -M @var{n}
10415 Allow at most @var{n} build jobs in parallel. @xref{Invoking
10416 guix-daemon, @option{--max-jobs}}, for details about this option and the
10417 equivalent @command{guix-daemon} option.
10418
10419 @item --debug=@var{level}
10420 Produce debugging output coming from the build daemon. @var{level} must be an
10421 integer between 0 and 5; higher means more verbose output. Setting a level of
10422 4 or more may be helpful when debugging setup issues with the build daemon.
10423
10424 @end table
10425
10426 Behind the scenes, @command{guix build} is essentially an interface to
10427 the @code{package-derivation} procedure of the @code{(guix packages)}
10428 module, and to the @code{build-derivations} procedure of the @code{(guix
10429 derivations)} module.
10430
10431 In addition to options explicitly passed on the command line,
10432 @command{guix build} and other @command{guix} commands that support
10433 building honor the @env{GUIX_BUILD_OPTIONS} environment variable.
10434
10435 @defvr {Environment Variable} GUIX_BUILD_OPTIONS
10436 Users can define this variable to a list of command line options that
10437 will automatically be used by @command{guix build} and other
10438 @command{guix} commands that can perform builds, as in the example
10439 below:
10440
10441 @example
10442 $ export GUIX_BUILD_OPTIONS="--no-substitutes -c 2 -L /foo/bar"
10443 @end example
10444
10445 These options are parsed independently, and the result is appended to
10446 the parsed command-line options.
10447 @end defvr
10448
10449
10450 @node Package Transformation Options
10451 @subsection Package Transformation Options
10452
10453 @cindex package variants
10454 Another set of command-line options supported by @command{guix build}
10455 and also @command{guix package} are @dfn{package transformation
10456 options}. These are options that make it possible to define @dfn{package
10457 variants}---for instance, packages built from different source code.
10458 This is a convenient way to create customized packages on the fly
10459 without having to type in the definitions of package variants
10460 (@pxref{Defining Packages}).
10461
10462 Package transformation options are preserved across upgrades:
10463 @command{guix upgrade} attempts to apply transformation options
10464 initially used when creating the profile to the upgraded packages.
10465
10466 The available options are listed below. Most commands support them and
10467 also support a @option{--help-transform} option that lists all the
10468 available options and a synopsis (these options are not shown in the
10469 @option{--help} output for brevity).
10470
10471 @table @code
10472
10473 @item --with-source=@var{source}
10474 @itemx --with-source=@var{package}=@var{source}
10475 @itemx --with-source=@var{package}@@@var{version}=@var{source}
10476 Use @var{source} as the source of @var{package}, and @var{version} as
10477 its version number.
10478 @var{source} must be a file name or a URL, as for @command{guix
10479 download} (@pxref{Invoking guix download}).
10480
10481 When @var{package} is omitted,
10482 it is taken to be the package name specified on the
10483 command line that matches the base of @var{source}---e.g.,
10484 if @var{source} is @code{/src/guile-2.0.10.tar.gz}, the corresponding
10485 package is @code{guile}.
10486
10487 Likewise, when @var{version} is omitted, the version string is inferred from
10488 @var{source}; in the previous example, it is @code{2.0.10}.
10489
10490 This option allows users to try out versions of packages other than the
10491 one provided by the distribution. The example below downloads
10492 @file{ed-1.7.tar.gz} from a GNU mirror and uses that as the source for
10493 the @code{ed} package:
10494
10495 @example
10496 guix build ed --with-source=mirror://gnu/ed/ed-1.7.tar.gz
10497 @end example
10498
10499 As a developer, @option{--with-source} makes it easy to test release
10500 candidates:
10501
10502 @example
10503 guix build guile --with-source=../guile-2.0.9.219-e1bb7.tar.xz
10504 @end example
10505
10506 @dots{} or to build from a checkout in a pristine environment:
10507
10508 @example
10509 $ git clone git://git.sv.gnu.org/guix.git
10510 $ guix build guix --with-source=guix@@1.0=./guix
10511 @end example
10512
10513 @item --with-input=@var{package}=@var{replacement}
10514 Replace dependency on @var{package} by a dependency on
10515 @var{replacement}. @var{package} must be a package name, and
10516 @var{replacement} must be a package specification such as @code{guile}
10517 or @code{guile@@1.8}.
10518
10519 For instance, the following command builds Guix, but replaces its
10520 dependency on the current stable version of Guile with a dependency on
10521 the legacy version of Guile, @code{guile@@2.0}:
10522
10523 @example
10524 guix build --with-input=guile=guile@@2.0 guix
10525 @end example
10526
10527 This is a recursive, deep replacement. So in this example, both
10528 @code{guix} and its dependency @code{guile-json} (which also depends on
10529 @code{guile}) get rebuilt against @code{guile@@2.0}.
10530
10531 This is implemented using the @code{package-input-rewriting} Scheme
10532 procedure (@pxref{Defining Packages, @code{package-input-rewriting}}).
10533
10534 @item --with-graft=@var{package}=@var{replacement}
10535 This is similar to @option{--with-input} but with an important difference:
10536 instead of rebuilding the whole dependency chain, @var{replacement} is
10537 built and then @dfn{grafted} onto the binaries that were initially
10538 referring to @var{package}. @xref{Security Updates}, for more
10539 information on grafts.
10540
10541 For example, the command below grafts version 3.5.4 of GnuTLS onto Wget
10542 and all its dependencies, replacing references to the version of GnuTLS
10543 they currently refer to:
10544
10545 @example
10546 guix build --with-graft=gnutls=gnutls@@3.5.4 wget
10547 @end example
10548
10549 This has the advantage of being much faster than rebuilding everything.
10550 But there is a caveat: it works if and only if @var{package} and
10551 @var{replacement} are strictly compatible---for example, if they provide
10552 a library, the application binary interface (ABI) of those libraries
10553 must be compatible. If @var{replacement} is somehow incompatible with
10554 @var{package}, then the resulting package may be unusable. Use with
10555 care!
10556
10557 @cindex debugging info, rebuilding
10558 @item --with-debug-info=@var{package}
10559 Build @var{package} in a way that preserves its debugging info and graft
10560 it onto packages that depend on it. This is useful if @var{package}
10561 does not already provide debugging info as a @code{debug} output
10562 (@pxref{Installing Debugging Files}).
10563
10564 For example, suppose you're experiencing a crash in Inkscape and would
10565 like to see what's up in GLib, a library deep down in Inkscape's
10566 dependency graph. GLib lacks a @code{debug} output, so debugging is
10567 tough. Fortunately, you rebuild GLib with debugging info and tack it on
10568 Inkscape:
10569
10570 @example
10571 guix install inkscape --with-debug-info=glib
10572 @end example
10573
10574 Only GLib needs to be recompiled so this takes a reasonable amount of
10575 time. @xref{Installing Debugging Files}, for more info.
10576
10577 @quotation Note
10578 Under the hood, this option works by passing the @samp{#:strip-binaries?
10579 #f} to the build system of the package of interest (@pxref{Build
10580 Systems}). Most build systems support that option but some do not. In
10581 that case, an error is raised.
10582
10583 Likewise, if a C/C++ package is built without @code{-g} (which is rarely
10584 the case), debugging info will remain unavailable even when
10585 @code{#:strip-binaries?} is false.
10586 @end quotation
10587
10588 @cindex tool chain, changing the build tool chain of a package
10589 @item --with-c-toolchain=@var{package}=@var{toolchain}
10590 This option changes the compilation of @var{package} and everything that
10591 depends on it so that they get built with @var{toolchain} instead of the
10592 default GNU tool chain for C/C++.
10593
10594 Consider this example:
10595
10596 @example
10597 guix build octave-cli \
10598 --with-c-toolchain=fftw=gcc-toolchain@@10 \
10599 --with-c-toolchain=fftwf=gcc-toolchain@@10
10600 @end example
10601
10602 The command above builds a variant of the @code{fftw} and @code{fftwf}
10603 packages using version 10 of @code{gcc-toolchain} instead of the default
10604 tool chain, and then builds a variant of the GNU@tie{}Octave
10605 command-line interface using them. GNU@tie{}Octave itself is also built
10606 with @code{gcc-toolchain@@10}.
10607
10608 This other example builds the Hardware Locality (@code{hwloc}) library
10609 and its dependents up to @code{intel-mpi-benchmarks} with the Clang C
10610 compiler:
10611
10612 @example
10613 guix build --with-c-toolchain=hwloc=clang-toolchain \
10614 intel-mpi-benchmarks
10615 @end example
10616
10617 @quotation Note
10618 There can be application binary interface (ABI) incompatibilities among
10619 tool chains. This is particularly true of the C++ standard library and
10620 run-time support libraries such as that of OpenMP@. By rebuilding all
10621 dependents with the same tool chain, @option{--with-c-toolchain} minimizes
10622 the risks of incompatibility but cannot entirely eliminate them. Choose
10623 @var{package} wisely.
10624 @end quotation
10625
10626 @item --with-git-url=@var{package}=@var{url}
10627 @cindex Git, using the latest commit
10628 @cindex latest commit, building
10629 Build @var{package} from the latest commit of the @code{master} branch of the
10630 Git repository at @var{url}. Git sub-modules of the repository are fetched,
10631 recursively.
10632
10633 For example, the following command builds the NumPy Python library against the
10634 latest commit of the master branch of Python itself:
10635
10636 @example
10637 guix build python-numpy \
10638 --with-git-url=python=https://github.com/python/cpython
10639 @end example
10640
10641 This option can also be combined with @option{--with-branch} or
10642 @option{--with-commit} (see below).
10643
10644 @cindex continuous integration
10645 Obviously, since it uses the latest commit of the given branch, the result of
10646 such a command varies over time. Nevertheless it is a convenient way to
10647 rebuild entire software stacks against the latest commit of one or more
10648 packages. This is particularly useful in the context of continuous
10649 integration (CI).
10650
10651 Checkouts are kept in a cache under @file{~/.cache/guix/checkouts} to speed up
10652 consecutive accesses to the same repository. You may want to clean it up once
10653 in a while to save disk space.
10654
10655 @item --with-branch=@var{package}=@var{branch}
10656 Build @var{package} from the latest commit of @var{branch}. If the
10657 @code{source} field of @var{package} is an origin with the @code{git-fetch}
10658 method (@pxref{origin Reference}) or a @code{git-checkout} object, the
10659 repository URL is taken from that @code{source}. Otherwise you have to use
10660 @option{--with-git-url} to specify the URL of the Git repository.
10661
10662 For instance, the following command builds @code{guile-sqlite3} from the
10663 latest commit of its @code{master} branch, and then builds @code{guix} (which
10664 depends on it) and @code{cuirass} (which depends on @code{guix}) against this
10665 specific @code{guile-sqlite3} build:
10666
10667 @example
10668 guix build --with-branch=guile-sqlite3=master cuirass
10669 @end example
10670
10671 @item --with-commit=@var{package}=@var{commit}
10672 This is similar to @option{--with-branch}, except that it builds from
10673 @var{commit} rather than the tip of a branch. @var{commit} must be a valid
10674 Git commit SHA1 identifier, a tag, or a @command{git describe} style
10675 identifier such as @code{1.0-3-gabc123}.
10676
10677 @item --with-patch=@var{package}=@var{file}
10678 Add @var{file} to the list of patches applied to @var{package}, where
10679 @var{package} is a spec such as @code{python@@3.8} or @code{glibc}.
10680 @var{file} must contain a patch; it is applied with the flags specified
10681 in the @code{origin} of @var{package} (@pxref{origin Reference}), which
10682 by default includes @code{-p1} (@pxref{patch Directories,,, diffutils,
10683 Comparing and Merging Files}).
10684
10685 As an example, the command below rebuilds Coreutils with the GNU C
10686 Library (glibc) patched with the given patch:
10687
10688 @example
10689 guix build coreutils --with-patch=glibc=./glibc-frob.patch
10690 @end example
10691
10692 In this example, glibc itself as well as everything that leads to
10693 Coreutils in the dependency graph is rebuilt.
10694
10695 @cindex upstream, latest version
10696 @item --with-latest=@var{package}
10697 So you like living on the bleeding edge? This option is for you! It
10698 replaces occurrences of @var{package} in the dependency graph with its
10699 latest upstream version, as reported by @command{guix refresh}
10700 (@pxref{Invoking guix refresh}).
10701
10702 It does so by determining the latest upstream release of @var{package}
10703 (if possible), downloading it, and authenticating it @emph{if} it comes
10704 with an OpenPGP signature.
10705
10706 As an example, the command below builds Guix against the latest version
10707 of Guile-JSON:
10708
10709 @example
10710 guix build guix --with-latest=guile-json
10711 @end example
10712
10713 There are limitations. First, in cases where the tool cannot or does
10714 not know how to authenticate source code, you are at risk of running
10715 malicious code; a warning is emitted in this case. Second, this option
10716 simply changes the source used in the existing package definitions,
10717 which is not always sufficient: there might be additional dependencies
10718 that need to be added, patches to apply, and more generally the quality
10719 assurance work that Guix developers normally do will be missing.
10720
10721 You've been warned! In all the other cases, it's a snappy way to stay
10722 on top. We encourage you to submit patches updating the actual package
10723 definitions once you have successfully tested an upgrade
10724 (@pxref{Contributing}).
10725
10726 @cindex test suite, skipping
10727 @item --without-tests=@var{package}
10728 Build @var{package} without running its tests. This can be useful in
10729 situations where you want to skip the lengthy test suite of a
10730 intermediate package, or if a package's test suite fails in a
10731 non-deterministic fashion. It should be used with care because running
10732 the test suite is a good way to ensure a package is working as intended.
10733
10734 Turning off tests leads to a different store item. Consequently, when
10735 using this option, anything that depends on @var{package} must be
10736 rebuilt, as in this example:
10737
10738 @example
10739 guix install --without-tests=python python-notebook
10740 @end example
10741
10742 The command above installs @code{python-notebook} on top of
10743 @code{python} built without running its test suite. To do so, it also
10744 rebuilds everything that depends on @code{python}, including
10745 @code{python-notebook} itself.
10746
10747 Internally, @option{--without-tests} relies on changing the
10748 @code{#:tests?} option of a package's @code{check} phase (@pxref{Build
10749 Systems}). Note that some packages use a customized @code{check} phase
10750 that does not respect a @code{#:tests? #f} setting. Therefore,
10751 @option{--without-tests} has no effect on these packages.
10752
10753 @end table
10754
10755 Wondering how to achieve the same effect using Scheme code, for example
10756 in your manifest, or how to write your own package transformation?
10757 @xref{Defining Package Variants}, for an overview of the programming
10758 interfaces available.
10759
10760 @node Additional Build Options
10761 @subsection Additional Build Options
10762
10763 The command-line options presented below are specific to @command{guix
10764 build}.
10765
10766 @table @code
10767
10768 @item --quiet
10769 @itemx -q
10770 Build quietly, without displaying the build log; this is equivalent to
10771 @option{--verbosity=0}. Upon completion, the build log is kept in @file{/var}
10772 (or similar) and can always be retrieved using the @option{--log-file} option.
10773
10774 @item --file=@var{file}
10775 @itemx -f @var{file}
10776 Build the package, derivation, or other file-like object that the code within
10777 @var{file} evaluates to (@pxref{G-Expressions, file-like objects}).
10778
10779 As an example, @var{file} might contain a package definition like this
10780 (@pxref{Defining Packages}):
10781
10782 @lisp
10783 @include package-hello.scm
10784 @end lisp
10785
10786 The @var{file} may also contain a JSON representation of one or more
10787 package definitions. Running @code{guix build -f} on @file{hello.json}
10788 with the following contents would result in building the packages
10789 @code{myhello} and @code{greeter}:
10790
10791 @example
10792 @verbatiminclude package-hello.json
10793 @end example
10794
10795 @item --manifest=@var{manifest}
10796 @itemx -m @var{manifest}
10797 Build all packages listed in the given @var{manifest}
10798 (@pxref{profile-manifest, @option{--manifest}}).
10799
10800 @item --expression=@var{expr}
10801 @itemx -e @var{expr}
10802 Build the package or derivation @var{expr} evaluates to.
10803
10804 For example, @var{expr} may be @code{(@@ (gnu packages guile)
10805 guile-1.8)}, which unambiguously designates this specific variant of
10806 version 1.8 of Guile.
10807
10808 Alternatively, @var{expr} may be a G-expression, in which case it is used
10809 as a build program passed to @code{gexp->derivation}
10810 (@pxref{G-Expressions}).
10811
10812 Lastly, @var{expr} may refer to a zero-argument monadic procedure
10813 (@pxref{The Store Monad}). The procedure must return a derivation as a
10814 monadic value, which is then passed through @code{run-with-store}.
10815
10816 @item --source
10817 @itemx -S
10818 Build the source derivations of the packages, rather than the packages
10819 themselves.
10820
10821 For instance, @code{guix build -S gcc} returns something like
10822 @file{/gnu/store/@dots{}-gcc-4.7.2.tar.bz2}, which is the GCC
10823 source tarball.
10824
10825 The returned source tarball is the result of applying any patches and
10826 code snippets specified in the package @code{origin} (@pxref{Defining
10827 Packages}).
10828
10829 @cindex source, verification
10830 As with other derivations, the result of building a source derivation
10831 can be verified using the @option{--check} option (@pxref{build-check}).
10832 This is useful to validate that a (potentially already built or
10833 substituted, thus cached) package source matches against its declared
10834 hash.
10835
10836 Note that @command{guix build -S} compiles the sources only of the
10837 specified packages. They do not include the sources of statically
10838 linked dependencies and by themselves are insufficient for reproducing
10839 the packages.
10840
10841 @item --sources
10842 Fetch and return the source of @var{package-or-derivation} and all their
10843 dependencies, recursively. This is a handy way to obtain a local copy
10844 of all the source code needed to build @var{packages}, allowing you to
10845 eventually build them even without network access. It is an extension
10846 of the @option{--source} option and can accept one of the following
10847 optional argument values:
10848
10849 @table @code
10850 @item package
10851 This value causes the @option{--sources} option to behave in the same way
10852 as the @option{--source} option.
10853
10854 @item all
10855 Build the source derivations of all packages, including any source that
10856 might be listed as @code{inputs}. This is the default value.
10857
10858 @example
10859 $ guix build --sources tzdata
10860 The following derivations will be built:
10861 /gnu/store/@dots{}-tzdata2015b.tar.gz.drv
10862 /gnu/store/@dots{}-tzcode2015b.tar.gz.drv
10863 @end example
10864
10865 @item transitive
10866 Build the source derivations of all packages, as well of all transitive
10867 inputs to the packages. This can be used e.g.@: to
10868 prefetch package source for later offline building.
10869
10870 @example
10871 $ guix build --sources=transitive tzdata
10872 The following derivations will be built:
10873 /gnu/store/@dots{}-tzcode2015b.tar.gz.drv
10874 /gnu/store/@dots{}-findutils-4.4.2.tar.xz.drv
10875 /gnu/store/@dots{}-grep-2.21.tar.xz.drv
10876 /gnu/store/@dots{}-coreutils-8.23.tar.xz.drv
10877 /gnu/store/@dots{}-make-4.1.tar.xz.drv
10878 /gnu/store/@dots{}-bash-4.3.tar.xz.drv
10879 @dots{}
10880 @end example
10881
10882 @end table
10883
10884 @item --system=@var{system}
10885 @itemx -s @var{system}
10886 Attempt to build for @var{system}---e.g., @code{i686-linux}---instead of
10887 the system type of the build host. The @command{guix build} command allows
10888 you to repeat this option several times, in which case it builds for all the
10889 specified systems; other commands ignore extraneous @option{-s} options.
10890
10891 @quotation Note
10892 The @option{--system} flag is for @emph{native} compilation and must not
10893 be confused with cross-compilation. See @option{--target} below for
10894 information on cross-compilation.
10895 @end quotation
10896
10897 An example use of this is on Linux-based systems, which can emulate
10898 different personalities. For instance, passing
10899 @option{--system=i686-linux} on an @code{x86_64-linux} system or
10900 @option{--system=armhf-linux} on an @code{aarch64-linux} system allows
10901 you to build packages in a complete 32-bit environment.
10902
10903 @quotation Note
10904 Building for an @code{armhf-linux} system is unconditionally enabled on
10905 @code{aarch64-linux} machines, although certain aarch64 chipsets do not
10906 allow for this functionality, notably the ThunderX.
10907 @end quotation
10908
10909 Similarly, when transparent emulation with QEMU and @code{binfmt_misc}
10910 is enabled (@pxref{Virtualization Services,
10911 @code{qemu-binfmt-service-type}}), you can build for any system for
10912 which a QEMU @code{binfmt_misc} handler is installed.
10913
10914 Builds for a system other than that of the machine you are using can
10915 also be offloaded to a remote machine of the right architecture.
10916 @xref{Daemon Offload Setup}, for more information on offloading.
10917
10918 @item --target=@var{triplet}
10919 @cindex cross-compilation
10920 Cross-build for @var{triplet}, which must be a valid GNU triplet, such
10921 as @code{"aarch64-linux-gnu"} (@pxref{Specifying Target Triplets, GNU
10922 configuration triplets,, autoconf, Autoconf}).
10923
10924 @anchor{build-check}
10925 @item --check
10926 @cindex determinism, checking
10927 @cindex reproducibility, checking
10928 Rebuild @var{package-or-derivation}, which are already available in the
10929 store, and raise an error if the build results are not bit-for-bit
10930 identical.
10931
10932 This mechanism allows you to check whether previously installed
10933 substitutes are genuine (@pxref{Substitutes}), or whether the build result
10934 of a package is deterministic. @xref{Invoking guix challenge}, for more
10935 background information and tools.
10936
10937 When used in conjunction with @option{--keep-failed}, the differing
10938 output is kept in the store, under @file{/gnu/store/@dots{}-check}.
10939 This makes it easy to look for differences between the two results.
10940
10941 @item --repair
10942 @cindex repairing store items
10943 @cindex corruption, recovering from
10944 Attempt to repair the specified store items, if they are corrupt, by
10945 re-downloading or rebuilding them.
10946
10947 This operation is not atomic and thus restricted to @code{root}.
10948
10949 @item --derivations
10950 @itemx -d
10951 Return the derivation paths, not the output paths, of the given
10952 packages.
10953
10954 @item --root=@var{file}
10955 @itemx -r @var{file}
10956 @cindex GC roots, adding
10957 @cindex garbage collector roots, adding
10958 Make @var{file} a symlink to the result, and register it as a garbage
10959 collector root.
10960
10961 Consequently, the results of this @command{guix build} invocation are
10962 protected from garbage collection until @var{file} is removed. When
10963 that option is omitted, build results are eligible for garbage
10964 collection as soon as the build completes. @xref{Invoking guix gc}, for
10965 more on GC roots.
10966
10967 @item --log-file
10968 @cindex build logs, access
10969 Return the build log file names or URLs for the given
10970 @var{package-or-derivation}, or raise an error if build logs are
10971 missing.
10972
10973 This works regardless of how packages or derivations are specified. For
10974 instance, the following invocations are equivalent:
10975
10976 @example
10977 guix build --log-file $(guix build -d guile)
10978 guix build --log-file $(guix build guile)
10979 guix build --log-file guile
10980 guix build --log-file -e '(@@ (gnu packages guile) guile-2.0)'
10981 @end example
10982
10983 If a log is unavailable locally, and unless @option{--no-substitutes} is
10984 passed, the command looks for a corresponding log on one of the
10985 substitute servers (as specified with @option{--substitute-urls}).
10986
10987 So for instance, imagine you want to see the build log of GDB on MIPS,
10988 but you are actually on an @code{x86_64} machine:
10989
10990 @example
10991 $ guix build --log-file gdb -s aarch64-linux
10992 https://@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER-1}/log/@dots{}-gdb-7.10
10993 @end example
10994
10995 You can freely access a huge library of build logs!
10996 @end table
10997
10998 @node Debugging Build Failures
10999 @subsection Debugging Build Failures
11000
11001 @cindex build failures, debugging
11002 When defining a new package (@pxref{Defining Packages}), you will
11003 probably find yourself spending some time debugging and tweaking the
11004 build until it succeeds. To do that, you need to operate the build
11005 commands yourself in an environment as close as possible to the one the
11006 build daemon uses.
11007
11008 To that end, the first thing to do is to use the @option{--keep-failed}
11009 or @option{-K} option of @command{guix build}, which will keep the
11010 failed build tree in @file{/tmp} or whatever directory you specified as
11011 @env{TMPDIR} (@pxref{Common Build Options, @option{--keep-failed}}).
11012
11013 From there on, you can @command{cd} to the failed build tree and source
11014 the @file{environment-variables} file, which contains all the
11015 environment variable definitions that were in place when the build
11016 failed. So let's say you're debugging a build failure in package
11017 @code{foo}; a typical session would look like this:
11018
11019 @example
11020 $ guix build foo -K
11021 @dots{} @i{build fails}
11022 $ cd /tmp/guix-build-foo.drv-0
11023 $ source ./environment-variables
11024 $ cd foo-1.2
11025 @end example
11026
11027 Now, you can invoke commands as if you were the daemon (almost) and
11028 troubleshoot your build process.
11029
11030 Sometimes it happens that, for example, a package's tests pass when you
11031 run them manually but they fail when the daemon runs them. This can
11032 happen because the daemon runs builds in containers where, unlike in our
11033 environment above, network access is missing, @file{/bin/sh} does not
11034 exist, etc. (@pxref{Build Environment Setup}).
11035
11036 In such cases, you may need to run inspect the build process from within
11037 a container similar to the one the build daemon creates:
11038
11039 @example
11040 $ guix build -K foo
11041 @dots{}
11042 $ cd /tmp/guix-build-foo.drv-0
11043 $ guix environment --no-grafts -C foo --ad-hoc strace gdb
11044 [env]# source ./environment-variables
11045 [env]# cd foo-1.2
11046 @end example
11047
11048 Here, @command{guix environment -C} creates a container and spawns a new
11049 shell in it (@pxref{Invoking guix environment}). The @command{--ad-hoc
11050 strace gdb} part adds the @command{strace} and @command{gdb} commands to
11051 the container, which you may find handy while debugging. The
11052 @option{--no-grafts} option makes sure we get the exact same
11053 environment, with ungrafted packages (@pxref{Security Updates}, for more
11054 info on grafts).
11055
11056 To get closer to a container like that used by the build daemon, we can
11057 remove @file{/bin/sh}:
11058
11059 @example
11060 [env]# rm /bin/sh
11061 @end example
11062
11063 (Don't worry, this is harmless: this is all happening in the throw-away
11064 container created by @command{guix environment}.)
11065
11066 The @command{strace} command is probably not in the search path, but we
11067 can run:
11068
11069 @example
11070 [env]# $GUIX_ENVIRONMENT/bin/strace -f -o log make check
11071 @end example
11072
11073 In this way, not only you will have reproduced the environment variables
11074 the daemon uses, you will also be running the build process in a container
11075 similar to the one the daemon uses.
11076
11077
11078 @node Invoking guix edit
11079 @section Invoking @command{guix edit}
11080
11081 @cindex @command{guix edit}
11082 @cindex package definition, editing
11083 So many packages, so many source files! The @command{guix edit} command
11084 facilitates the life of users and packagers by pointing their editor at
11085 the source file containing the definition of the specified packages.
11086 For instance:
11087
11088 @example
11089 guix edit gcc@@4.9 vim
11090 @end example
11091
11092 @noindent
11093 launches the program specified in the @env{VISUAL} or in the
11094 @env{EDITOR} environment variable to view the recipe of GCC@tie{}4.9.3
11095 and that of Vim.
11096
11097 If you are using a Guix Git checkout (@pxref{Building from Git}), or
11098 have created your own packages on @env{GUIX_PACKAGE_PATH}
11099 (@pxref{Package Modules}), you will be able to edit the package
11100 recipes. In other cases, you will be able to examine the read-only recipes
11101 for packages currently in the store.
11102
11103 Instead of @env{GUIX_PACKAGE_PATH}, the command-line option
11104 @option{--load-path=@var{directory}} (or in short @option{-L
11105 @var{directory}}) allows you to add @var{directory} to the front of the
11106 package module search path and so make your own packages visible.
11107
11108 @node Invoking guix download
11109 @section Invoking @command{guix download}
11110
11111 @cindex @command{guix download}
11112 @cindex downloading package sources
11113 When writing a package definition, developers typically need to download
11114 a source tarball, compute its SHA256 hash, and write that
11115 hash in the package definition (@pxref{Defining Packages}). The
11116 @command{guix download} tool helps with this task: it downloads a file
11117 from the given URI, adds it to the store, and prints both its file name
11118 in the store and its SHA256 hash.
11119
11120 The fact that the downloaded file is added to the store saves bandwidth:
11121 when the developer eventually tries to build the newly defined package
11122 with @command{guix build}, the source tarball will not have to be
11123 downloaded again because it is already in the store. It is also a
11124 convenient way to temporarily stash files, which may be deleted
11125 eventually (@pxref{Invoking guix gc}).
11126
11127 The @command{guix download} command supports the same URIs as used in
11128 package definitions. In particular, it supports @code{mirror://} URIs.
11129 @code{https} URIs (HTTP over TLS) are supported @emph{provided} the
11130 Guile bindings for GnuTLS are available in the user's environment; when
11131 they are not available, an error is raised. @xref{Guile Preparations,
11132 how to install the GnuTLS bindings for Guile,, gnutls-guile,
11133 GnuTLS-Guile}, for more information.
11134
11135 @command{guix download} verifies HTTPS server certificates by loading
11136 the certificates of X.509 authorities from the directory pointed to by
11137 the @env{SSL_CERT_DIR} environment variable (@pxref{X.509
11138 Certificates}), unless @option{--no-check-certificate} is used.
11139
11140 The following options are available:
11141
11142 @table @code
11143 @item --hash=@var{algorithm}
11144 @itemx -H @var{algorithm}
11145 Compute a hash using the specified @var{algorithm}. @xref{Invoking guix
11146 hash}, for more information.
11147
11148 @item --format=@var{fmt}
11149 @itemx -f @var{fmt}
11150 Write the hash in the format specified by @var{fmt}. For more
11151 information on the valid values for @var{fmt}, @pxref{Invoking guix hash}.
11152
11153 @item --no-check-certificate
11154 Do not validate the X.509 certificates of HTTPS servers.
11155
11156 When using this option, you have @emph{absolutely no guarantee} that you
11157 are communicating with the authentic server responsible for the given
11158 URL, which makes you vulnerable to ``man-in-the-middle'' attacks.
11159
11160 @item --output=@var{file}
11161 @itemx -o @var{file}
11162 Save the downloaded file to @var{file} instead of adding it to the
11163 store.
11164 @end table
11165
11166 @node Invoking guix hash
11167 @section Invoking @command{guix hash}
11168
11169 @cindex @command{guix hash}
11170 The @command{guix hash} command computes the hash of a file.
11171 It is primarily a convenience tool for anyone contributing to the
11172 distribution: it computes the cryptographic hash of a file, which can be
11173 used in the definition of a package (@pxref{Defining Packages}).
11174
11175 The general syntax is:
11176
11177 @example
11178 guix hash @var{option} @var{file}
11179 @end example
11180
11181 When @var{file} is @code{-} (a hyphen), @command{guix hash} computes the
11182 hash of data read from standard input. @command{guix hash} has the
11183 following options:
11184
11185 @table @code
11186
11187 @item --hash=@var{algorithm}
11188 @itemx -H @var{algorithm}
11189 Compute a hash using the specified @var{algorithm}, @code{sha256} by
11190 default.
11191
11192 @var{algorithm} must the name of a cryptographic hash algorithm
11193 supported by Libgcrypt @i{via} Guile-Gcrypt---e.g., @code{sha512} or
11194 @code{sha3-256} (@pxref{Hash Functions,,, guile-gcrypt, Guile-Gcrypt
11195 Reference Manual}).
11196
11197 @item --format=@var{fmt}
11198 @itemx -f @var{fmt}
11199 Write the hash in the format specified by @var{fmt}.
11200
11201 Supported formats: @code{base64}, @code{nix-base32}, @code{base32}, @code{base16}
11202 (@code{hex} and @code{hexadecimal} can be used as well).
11203
11204 If the @option{--format} option is not specified, @command{guix hash}
11205 will output the hash in @code{nix-base32}. This representation is used
11206 in the definitions of packages.
11207
11208 @item --recursive
11209 @itemx -r
11210 Compute the hash on @var{file} recursively.
11211
11212 In this case, the hash is computed on an archive containing @var{file},
11213 including its children if it is a directory. Some of the metadata of
11214 @var{file} is part of the archive; for instance, when @var{file} is a
11215 regular file, the hash is different depending on whether @var{file} is
11216 executable or not. Metadata such as time stamps has no impact on the
11217 hash (@pxref{Invoking guix archive}).
11218 @c FIXME: Replace xref above with xref to an ``Archive'' section when
11219 @c it exists.
11220
11221 @item --exclude-vcs
11222 @itemx -x
11223 When combined with @option{--recursive}, exclude version control system
11224 directories (@file{.bzr}, @file{.git}, @file{.hg}, etc.).
11225
11226 @vindex git-fetch
11227 As an example, here is how you would compute the hash of a Git checkout,
11228 which is useful when using the @code{git-fetch} method (@pxref{origin
11229 Reference}):
11230
11231 @example
11232 $ git clone http://example.org/foo.git
11233 $ cd foo
11234 $ guix hash -rx .
11235 @end example
11236 @end table
11237
11238 @node Invoking guix import
11239 @section Invoking @command{guix import}
11240
11241 @cindex importing packages
11242 @cindex package import
11243 @cindex package conversion
11244 @cindex Invoking @command{guix import}
11245 The @command{guix import} command is useful for people who would like to
11246 add a package to the distribution with as little work as
11247 possible---a legitimate demand. The command knows of a few
11248 repositories from which it can ``import'' package metadata. The result
11249 is a package definition, or a template thereof, in the format we know
11250 (@pxref{Defining Packages}).
11251
11252 The general syntax is:
11253
11254 @example
11255 guix import @var{importer} @var{options}@dots{}
11256 @end example
11257
11258 @var{importer} specifies the source from which to import package
11259 metadata, and @var{options} specifies a package identifier and other
11260 options specific to @var{importer}.
11261
11262 Some of the importers rely on the ability to run the @command{gpgv} command.
11263 For these, GnuPG must be installed and in @code{$PATH}; run @code{guix install
11264 gnupg} if needed.
11265
11266 Currently, the available ``importers'' are:
11267
11268 @table @code
11269 @item gnu
11270 Import metadata for the given GNU package. This provides a template
11271 for the latest version of that GNU package, including the hash of its
11272 source tarball, and its canonical synopsis and description.
11273
11274 Additional information such as the package dependencies and its
11275 license needs to be figured out manually.
11276
11277 For example, the following command returns a package definition for
11278 GNU@tie{}Hello:
11279
11280 @example
11281 guix import gnu hello
11282 @end example
11283
11284 Specific command-line options are:
11285
11286 @table @code
11287 @item --key-download=@var{policy}
11288 As for @command{guix refresh}, specify the policy to handle missing
11289 OpenPGP keys when verifying the package signature. @xref{Invoking guix
11290 refresh, @option{--key-download}}.
11291 @end table
11292
11293 @item pypi
11294 @cindex pypi
11295 Import metadata from the @uref{https://pypi.python.org/, Python Package
11296 Index}. Information is taken from the JSON-formatted description
11297 available at @code{pypi.python.org} and usually includes all the relevant
11298 information, including package dependencies. For maximum efficiency, it
11299 is recommended to install the @command{unzip} utility, so that the
11300 importer can unzip Python wheels and gather data from them.
11301
11302 The command below imports metadata for the @code{itsdangerous} Python
11303 package:
11304
11305 @example
11306 guix import pypi itsdangerous
11307 @end example
11308
11309 @table @code
11310 @item --recursive
11311 @itemx -r
11312 Traverse the dependency graph of the given upstream package recursively
11313 and generate package expressions for all those packages that are not yet
11314 in Guix.
11315 @end table
11316
11317 @item gem
11318 @cindex gem
11319 Import metadata from @uref{https://rubygems.org/, RubyGems}. Information
11320 is taken from the JSON-formatted description available at
11321 @code{rubygems.org} and includes most relevant information, including
11322 runtime dependencies. There are some caveats, however. The metadata
11323 doesn't distinguish between synopses and descriptions, so the same string
11324 is used for both fields. Additionally, the details of non-Ruby
11325 dependencies required to build native extensions is unavailable and left
11326 as an exercise to the packager.
11327
11328 The command below imports metadata for the @code{rails} Ruby package:
11329
11330 @example
11331 guix import gem rails
11332 @end example
11333
11334 @table @code
11335 @item --recursive
11336 @itemx -r
11337 Traverse the dependency graph of the given upstream package recursively
11338 and generate package expressions for all those packages that are not yet
11339 in Guix.
11340 @end table
11341
11342 @item minetest
11343 @cindex minetest
11344 @cindex ContentDB
11345 Import metadata from @uref{https://content.minetest.net, ContentDB}.
11346 Information is taken from the JSON-formatted metadata provided through
11347 @uref{https://content.minetest.net/help/api/, ContentDB's API} and
11348 includes most relevant information, including dependencies. There are
11349 some caveats, however. The license information is often incomplete.
11350 The commit hash is sometimes missing. The descriptions are in the
11351 Markdown format, but Guix uses Texinfo instead. Texture packs and
11352 subgames are unsupported.
11353
11354 The command below imports metadata for the Mesecons mod by Jeija:
11355
11356 @example
11357 guix import minetest Jeija/mesecons
11358 @end example
11359
11360 The author name can also be left out:
11361
11362 @example
11363 guix import minetest mesecons
11364 @end example
11365
11366 @table @code
11367 @item --recursive
11368 @itemx -r
11369 Traverse the dependency graph of the given upstream package recursively
11370 and generate package expressions for all those packages that are not yet
11371 in Guix.
11372 @end table
11373
11374 @item cpan
11375 @cindex CPAN
11376 Import metadata from @uref{https://www.metacpan.org/, MetaCPAN}.
11377 Information is taken from the JSON-formatted metadata provided through
11378 @uref{https://fastapi.metacpan.org/, MetaCPAN's API} and includes most
11379 relevant information, such as module dependencies. License information
11380 should be checked closely. If Perl is available in the store, then the
11381 @code{corelist} utility will be used to filter core modules out of the
11382 list of dependencies.
11383
11384 The command command below imports metadata for the Acme::Boolean Perl
11385 module:
11386
11387 @example
11388 guix import cpan Acme::Boolean
11389 @end example
11390
11391 @item cran
11392 @cindex CRAN
11393 @cindex Bioconductor
11394 Import metadata from @uref{https://cran.r-project.org/, CRAN}, the
11395 central repository for the @uref{https://r-project.org, GNU@tie{}R
11396 statistical and graphical environment}.
11397
11398 Information is extracted from the @file{DESCRIPTION} file of the package.
11399
11400 The command command below imports metadata for the Cairo R package:
11401
11402 @example
11403 guix import cran Cairo
11404 @end example
11405
11406 When @option{--recursive} is added, the importer will traverse the
11407 dependency graph of the given upstream package recursively and generate
11408 package expressions for all those packages that are not yet in Guix.
11409
11410 When @option{--style=specification} is added, the importer will generate
11411 package definitions whose inputs are package specifications instead of
11412 references to package variables. This is useful when generated package
11413 definitions are to be appended to existing user modules, as the list of
11414 used package modules need not be changed. The default is
11415 @option{--style=variable}.
11416
11417 When @option{--archive=bioconductor} is added, metadata is imported from
11418 @uref{https://www.bioconductor.org/, Bioconductor}, a repository of R
11419 packages for the analysis and comprehension of high-throughput
11420 genomic data in bioinformatics.
11421
11422 Information is extracted from the @file{DESCRIPTION} file contained in the
11423 package archive.
11424
11425 The command below imports metadata for the GenomicRanges R package:
11426
11427 @example
11428 guix import cran --archive=bioconductor GenomicRanges
11429 @end example
11430
11431 Finally, you can also import R packages that have not yet been published on
11432 CRAN or Bioconductor as long as they are in a git repository. Use
11433 @option{--archive=git} followed by the URL of the git repository:
11434
11435 @example
11436 guix import cran --archive=git https://github.com/immunogenomics/harmony
11437 @end example
11438
11439 @item texlive
11440 @cindex TeX Live
11441 @cindex CTAN
11442 Import metadata from @uref{https://www.ctan.org/, CTAN}, the
11443 comprehensive TeX archive network for TeX packages that are part of the
11444 @uref{https://www.tug.org/texlive/, TeX Live distribution}.
11445
11446 Information about the package is obtained through the XML API provided
11447 by CTAN, while the source code is downloaded from the SVN repository of
11448 the Tex Live project. This is done because the CTAN does not keep
11449 versioned archives.
11450
11451 The command command below imports metadata for the @code{fontspec}
11452 TeX package:
11453
11454 @example
11455 guix import texlive fontspec
11456 @end example
11457
11458 When @option{--archive=@var{directory}} is added, the source code is
11459 downloaded not from the @file{latex} sub-directory of the
11460 @file{texmf-dist/source} tree in the TeX Live SVN repository, but from
11461 the specified sibling @var{directory} under the same root.
11462
11463 The command below imports metadata for the @code{ifxetex} package from
11464 CTAN while fetching the sources from the directory
11465 @file{texmf/source/generic}:
11466
11467 @example
11468 guix import texlive --archive=generic ifxetex
11469 @end example
11470
11471 @item json
11472 @cindex JSON, import
11473 Import package metadata from a local JSON file. Consider the following
11474 example package definition in JSON format:
11475
11476 @example
11477 @{
11478 "name": "hello",
11479 "version": "2.10",
11480 "source": "mirror://gnu/hello/hello-2.10.tar.gz",
11481 "build-system": "gnu",
11482 "home-page": "https://www.gnu.org/software/hello/",
11483 "synopsis": "Hello, GNU world: An example GNU package",
11484 "description": "GNU Hello prints a greeting.",
11485 "license": "GPL-3.0+",
11486 "native-inputs": ["gettext"]
11487 @}
11488 @end example
11489
11490 The field names are the same as for the @code{<package>} record
11491 (@xref{Defining Packages}). References to other packages are provided
11492 as JSON lists of quoted package specification strings such as
11493 @code{guile} or @code{guile@@2.0}.
11494
11495 The importer also supports a more explicit source definition using the
11496 common fields for @code{<origin>} records:
11497
11498 @example
11499 @{
11500 @dots{}
11501 "source": @{
11502 "method": "url-fetch",
11503 "uri": "mirror://gnu/hello/hello-2.10.tar.gz",
11504 "sha256": @{
11505 "base32": "0ssi1wpaf7plaswqqjwigppsg5fyh99vdlb9kzl7c9lng89ndq1i"
11506 @}
11507 @}
11508 @dots{}
11509 @}
11510 @end example
11511
11512 The command below reads metadata from the JSON file @code{hello.json}
11513 and outputs a package expression:
11514
11515 @example
11516 guix import json hello.json
11517 @end example
11518
11519 @item hackage
11520 @cindex hackage
11521 Import metadata from the Haskell community's central package archive
11522 @uref{https://hackage.haskell.org/, Hackage}. Information is taken from
11523 Cabal files and includes all the relevant information, including package
11524 dependencies.
11525
11526 Specific command-line options are:
11527
11528 @table @code
11529 @item --stdin
11530 @itemx -s
11531 Read a Cabal file from standard input.
11532 @item --no-test-dependencies
11533 @itemx -t
11534 Do not include dependencies required only by the test suites.
11535 @item --cabal-environment=@var{alist}
11536 @itemx -e @var{alist}
11537 @var{alist} is a Scheme alist defining the environment in which the
11538 Cabal conditionals are evaluated. The accepted keys are: @code{os},
11539 @code{arch}, @code{impl} and a string representing the name of a flag.
11540 The value associated with a flag has to be either the symbol
11541 @code{true} or @code{false}. The value associated with other keys
11542 has to conform to the Cabal file format definition. The default value
11543 associated with the keys @code{os}, @code{arch} and @code{impl} is
11544 @samp{linux}, @samp{x86_64} and @samp{ghc}, respectively.
11545 @item --recursive
11546 @itemx -r
11547 Traverse the dependency graph of the given upstream package recursively
11548 and generate package expressions for all those packages that are not yet
11549 in Guix.
11550 @end table
11551
11552 The command below imports metadata for the latest version of the
11553 HTTP Haskell package without including test dependencies and
11554 specifying the value of the flag @samp{network-uri} as @code{false}:
11555
11556 @example
11557 guix import hackage -t -e "'((\"network-uri\" . false))" HTTP
11558 @end example
11559
11560 A specific package version may optionally be specified by following the
11561 package name by an at-sign and a version number as in the following example:
11562
11563 @example
11564 guix import hackage mtl@@2.1.3.1
11565 @end example
11566
11567 @item stackage
11568 @cindex stackage
11569 The @code{stackage} importer is a wrapper around the @code{hackage} one.
11570 It takes a package name, looks up the package version included in a
11571 long-term support (LTS) @uref{https://www.stackage.org, Stackage}
11572 release and uses the @code{hackage} importer to retrieve its metadata.
11573 Note that it is up to you to select an LTS release compatible with the
11574 GHC compiler used by Guix.
11575
11576 Specific command-line options are:
11577
11578 @table @code
11579 @item --no-test-dependencies
11580 @itemx -t
11581 Do not include dependencies required only by the test suites.
11582 @item --lts-version=@var{version}
11583 @itemx -l @var{version}
11584 @var{version} is the desired LTS release version. If omitted the latest
11585 release is used.
11586 @item --recursive
11587 @itemx -r
11588 Traverse the dependency graph of the given upstream package recursively
11589 and generate package expressions for all those packages that are not yet
11590 in Guix.
11591 @end table
11592
11593 The command below imports metadata for the HTTP Haskell package
11594 included in the LTS Stackage release version 7.18:
11595
11596 @example
11597 guix import stackage --lts-version=7.18 HTTP
11598 @end example
11599
11600 @item elpa
11601 @cindex elpa
11602 Import metadata from an Emacs Lisp Package Archive (ELPA) package
11603 repository (@pxref{Packages,,, emacs, The GNU Emacs Manual}).
11604
11605 Specific command-line options are:
11606
11607 @table @code
11608 @item --archive=@var{repo}
11609 @itemx -a @var{repo}
11610 @var{repo} identifies the archive repository from which to retrieve the
11611 information. Currently the supported repositories and their identifiers
11612 are:
11613 @itemize -
11614 @item
11615 @uref{https://elpa.gnu.org/packages, GNU}, selected by the @code{gnu}
11616 identifier. This is the default.
11617
11618 Packages from @code{elpa.gnu.org} are signed with one of the keys
11619 contained in the GnuPG keyring at
11620 @file{share/emacs/25.1/etc/package-keyring.gpg} (or similar) in the
11621 @code{emacs} package (@pxref{Package Installation, ELPA package
11622 signatures,, emacs, The GNU Emacs Manual}).
11623
11624 @item
11625 @uref{https://elpa.nongnu.org/nongnu/, NonGNU}, selected by the
11626 @code{nongnu} identifier.
11627
11628 @item
11629 @uref{https://stable.melpa.org/packages, MELPA-Stable}, selected by the
11630 @code{melpa-stable} identifier.
11631
11632 @item
11633 @uref{https://melpa.org/packages, MELPA}, selected by the @code{melpa}
11634 identifier.
11635 @end itemize
11636
11637 @item --recursive
11638 @itemx -r
11639 Traverse the dependency graph of the given upstream package recursively
11640 and generate package expressions for all those packages that are not yet
11641 in Guix.
11642 @end table
11643
11644 @item crate
11645 @cindex crate
11646 Import metadata from the crates.io Rust package repository
11647 @uref{https://crates.io, crates.io}, as in this example:
11648
11649 @example
11650 guix import crate blake2-rfc
11651 @end example
11652
11653 The crate importer also allows you to specify a version string:
11654
11655 @example
11656 guix import crate constant-time-eq@@0.1.0
11657 @end example
11658
11659 Additional options include:
11660
11661 @table @code
11662 @item --recursive
11663 @itemx -r
11664 Traverse the dependency graph of the given upstream package recursively
11665 and generate package expressions for all those packages that are not yet
11666 in Guix.
11667 @end table
11668
11669 @item opam
11670 @cindex OPAM
11671 @cindex OCaml
11672 Import metadata from the @uref{https://opam.ocaml.org/, OPAM} package
11673 repository used by the OCaml community.
11674
11675 Additional options include:
11676
11677 @table @code
11678 @item --recursive
11679 @itemx -r
11680 Traverse the dependency graph of the given upstream package recursively
11681 and generate package expressions for all those packages that are not yet
11682 in Guix.
11683 @item --repo
11684 By default, packages are searched in the official OPAM repository. This
11685 option, which can be used more than once, lets you add other repositories
11686 which will be searched for packages. It accepts as valid arguments:
11687
11688 @itemize
11689 @item the name of a known repository - can be one of @code{opam},
11690 @code{coq} (equivalent to @code{coq-released}),
11691 @code{coq-core-dev}, @code{coq-extra-dev} or @code{grew}.
11692 @item the URL of a repository as expected by the
11693 @code{opam repository add} command (for instance, the URL equivalent
11694 of the above @code{opam} name would be
11695 @uref{https://opam.ocaml.org}).
11696 @item the path to a local copy of a repository (a directory containing a
11697 @file{packages/} sub-directory).
11698 @end itemize
11699
11700 Repositories are assumed to be passed to this option by order of
11701 preference. The additional repositories will not replace the default
11702 @code{opam} repository, which is always kept as a fallback.
11703
11704 Also, please note that versions are not compared accross repositories.
11705 The first repository (from left to right) that has at least one version
11706 of a given package will prevail over any others, and the version
11707 imported will be the latest one found @emph{in this repository only}.
11708
11709 @end table
11710
11711 @item go
11712 @cindex go
11713 Import metadata for a Go module using
11714 @uref{https://proxy.golang.org, proxy.golang.org}.
11715
11716 @example
11717 guix import go gopkg.in/yaml.v2
11718 @end example
11719
11720 It is possible to use a package specification with a @code{@@VERSION}
11721 suffix to import a specific version.
11722
11723 Additional options include:
11724
11725 @table @code
11726 @item --recursive
11727 @itemx -r
11728 Traverse the dependency graph of the given upstream package recursively
11729 and generate package expressions for all those packages that are not yet
11730 in Guix.
11731 @item --pin-versions
11732 When using this option, the importer preserves the exact versions of the
11733 Go modules dependencies instead of using their latest available
11734 versions. This can be useful when attempting to import packages that
11735 recursively depend on former versions of themselves to build. When
11736 using this mode, the symbol of the package is made by appending the
11737 version to its name, so that multiple versions of the same package can
11738 coexist.
11739 @end table
11740
11741 @item egg
11742 @cindex egg
11743 Import metadata for @uref{https://wiki.call-cc.org/eggs, CHICKEN eggs}.
11744 The information is taken from @file{PACKAGE.egg} files found in the
11745 @uref{git://code.call-cc.org/eggs-5-latest, eggs-5-latest} Git
11746 repository. However, it does not provide all the information that we
11747 need, there is no ``description'' field, and the licenses used are not
11748 always precise (BSD is often used instead of BSD-N).
11749
11750 @example
11751 guix import egg sourcehut
11752 @end example
11753
11754 Additional options include:
11755 @table @code
11756 @item --recursive
11757 @itemx -r
11758 Traverse the dependency graph of the given upstream package recursively
11759 and generate package expressions for all those packages that are not yet
11760 in Guix.
11761 @end table
11762 @end table
11763
11764 The structure of the @command{guix import} code is modular. It would be
11765 useful to have more importers for other package formats, and your help
11766 is welcome here (@pxref{Contributing}).
11767
11768 @node Invoking guix refresh
11769 @section Invoking @command{guix refresh}
11770
11771 @cindex @command {guix refresh}
11772 The primary audience of the @command{guix refresh} command is packagers.
11773 As a user, you may be interested in the @option{--with-latest} option,
11774 which can bring you package update superpowers built upon @command{guix
11775 refresh} (@pxref{Package Transformation Options,
11776 @option{--with-latest}}). By default, @command{guix refresh} reports
11777 any packages provided by the distribution that are outdated compared to
11778 the latest upstream version, like this:
11779
11780 @example
11781 $ guix refresh
11782 gnu/packages/gettext.scm:29:13: gettext would be upgraded from 0.18.1.1 to 0.18.2.1
11783 gnu/packages/glib.scm:77:12: glib would be upgraded from 2.34.3 to 2.37.0
11784 @end example
11785
11786 Alternatively, one can specify packages to consider, in which case a
11787 warning is emitted for packages that lack an updater:
11788
11789 @example
11790 $ guix refresh coreutils guile guile-ssh
11791 gnu/packages/ssh.scm:205:2: warning: no updater for guile-ssh
11792 gnu/packages/guile.scm:136:12: guile would be upgraded from 2.0.12 to 2.0.13
11793 @end example
11794
11795 @command{guix refresh} browses the upstream repository of each package and determines
11796 the highest version number of the releases therein. The command
11797 knows how to update specific types of packages: GNU packages, ELPA
11798 packages, etc.---see the documentation for @option{--type} below. There
11799 are many packages, though, for which it lacks a method to determine
11800 whether a new upstream release is available. However, the mechanism is
11801 extensible, so feel free to get in touch with us to add a new method!
11802
11803 @table @code
11804
11805 @item --recursive
11806 Consider the packages specified, and all the packages upon which they depend.
11807
11808 @example
11809 $ guix refresh --recursive coreutils
11810 gnu/packages/acl.scm:40:13: acl would be upgraded from 2.2.53 to 2.3.1
11811 gnu/packages/m4.scm:30:12: 1.4.18 is already the latest version of m4
11812 gnu/packages/xml.scm:68:2: warning: no updater for expat
11813 gnu/packages/multiprecision.scm:40:12: 6.1.2 is already the latest version of gmp
11814 @dots{}
11815 @end example
11816
11817 @end table
11818
11819 Sometimes the upstream name differs from the package name used in Guix,
11820 and @command{guix refresh} needs a little help. Most updaters honor the
11821 @code{upstream-name} property in package definitions, which can be used
11822 to that effect:
11823
11824 @lisp
11825 (define-public network-manager
11826 (package
11827 (name "network-manager")
11828 ;; @dots{}
11829 (properties '((upstream-name . "NetworkManager")))))
11830 @end lisp
11831
11832 When passed @option{--update}, it modifies distribution source files to
11833 update the version numbers and source tarball hashes of those package
11834 recipes (@pxref{Defining Packages}). This is achieved by downloading
11835 each package's latest source tarball and its associated OpenPGP
11836 signature, authenticating the downloaded tarball against its signature
11837 using @command{gpgv}, and finally computing its hash---note that GnuPG must be
11838 installed and in @code{$PATH}; run @code{guix install gnupg} if needed.
11839
11840 When the public
11841 key used to sign the tarball is missing from the user's keyring, an
11842 attempt is made to automatically retrieve it from a public key server;
11843 when this is successful, the key is added to the user's keyring; otherwise,
11844 @command{guix refresh} reports an error.
11845
11846 The following options are supported:
11847
11848 @table @code
11849
11850 @item --expression=@var{expr}
11851 @itemx -e @var{expr}
11852 Consider the package @var{expr} evaluates to.
11853
11854 This is useful to precisely refer to a package, as in this example:
11855
11856 @example
11857 guix refresh -l -e '(@@@@ (gnu packages commencement) glibc-final)'
11858 @end example
11859
11860 This command lists the dependents of the ``final'' libc (essentially all
11861 the packages).
11862
11863 @item --update
11864 @itemx -u
11865 Update distribution source files (package recipes) in place. This is
11866 usually run from a checkout of the Guix source tree (@pxref{Running
11867 Guix Before It Is Installed}):
11868
11869 @example
11870 $ ./pre-inst-env guix refresh -s non-core -u
11871 @end example
11872
11873 @xref{Defining Packages}, for more information on package definitions.
11874
11875 @item --select=[@var{subset}]
11876 @itemx -s @var{subset}
11877 Select all the packages in @var{subset}, one of @code{core} or
11878 @code{non-core}.
11879
11880 The @code{core} subset refers to all the packages at the core of the
11881 distribution---i.e., packages that are used to build ``everything
11882 else''. This includes GCC, libc, Binutils, Bash, etc. Usually,
11883 changing one of these packages in the distribution entails a rebuild of
11884 all the others. Thus, such updates are an inconvenience to users in
11885 terms of build time or bandwidth used to achieve the upgrade.
11886
11887 The @code{non-core} subset refers to the remaining packages. It is
11888 typically useful in cases where an update of the core packages would be
11889 inconvenient.
11890
11891 @item --manifest=@var{file}
11892 @itemx -m @var{file}
11893 Select all the packages from the manifest in @var{file}. This is useful to
11894 check if any packages of the user manifest can be updated.
11895
11896 @item --type=@var{updater}
11897 @itemx -t @var{updater}
11898 Select only packages handled by @var{updater} (may be a comma-separated
11899 list of updaters). Currently, @var{updater} may be one of:
11900
11901 @table @code
11902 @item gnu
11903 the updater for GNU packages;
11904 @item savannah
11905 the updater for packages hosted at @uref{https://savannah.gnu.org, Savannah};
11906 @item sourceforge
11907 the updater for packages hosted at @uref{https://sourceforge.net, SourceForge};
11908 @item gnome
11909 the updater for GNOME packages;
11910 @item kde
11911 the updater for KDE packages;
11912 @item xorg
11913 the updater for X.org packages;
11914 @item kernel.org
11915 the updater for packages hosted on kernel.org;
11916 @item egg
11917 the updater for @uref{https://wiki.call-cc.org/eggs/, Egg} packages;
11918 @item elpa
11919 the updater for @uref{https://elpa.gnu.org/, ELPA} packages;
11920 @item cran
11921 the updater for @uref{https://cran.r-project.org/, CRAN} packages;
11922 @item bioconductor
11923 the updater for @uref{https://www.bioconductor.org/, Bioconductor} R packages;
11924 @item cpan
11925 the updater for @uref{https://www.cpan.org/, CPAN} packages;
11926 @item pypi
11927 the updater for @uref{https://pypi.python.org, PyPI} packages.
11928 @item gem
11929 the updater for @uref{https://rubygems.org, RubyGems} packages.
11930 @item github
11931 the updater for @uref{https://github.com, GitHub} packages.
11932 @item hackage
11933 the updater for @uref{https://hackage.haskell.org, Hackage} packages.
11934 @item stackage
11935 the updater for @uref{https://www.stackage.org, Stackage} packages.
11936 @item crate
11937 the updater for @uref{https://crates.io, Crates} packages.
11938 @item launchpad
11939 the updater for @uref{https://launchpad.net, Launchpad} packages.
11940 @item generic-html
11941 a generic updater that crawls the HTML page where the source tarball of
11942 the package is hosted, when applicable.
11943
11944 @item generic-git
11945 a generic updater for packages hosted on Git repositories. It tries to
11946 be smart about parsing Git tag names, but if it is not able to parse the
11947 tag name and compare tags correctly, users can define the following
11948 properties for a package.
11949
11950 @itemize
11951 @item @code{release-tag-prefix}: a regular expression for matching a prefix of
11952 the tag name.
11953
11954 @item @code{release-tag-suffix}: a regular expression for matching a suffix of
11955 the tag name.
11956
11957 @item @code{release-tag-version-delimiter}: a string used as the delimiter in
11958 the tag name for separating the numbers of the version.
11959
11960 @item @code{accept-pre-releases}: by default, the updater will ignore
11961 pre-releases; to make it also look for pre-releases, set the this
11962 property to @code{#t}.
11963
11964 @end itemize
11965
11966 @lisp
11967 (package
11968 (name "foo")
11969 ;; ...
11970 (properties
11971 '((release-tag-prefix . "^release0-")
11972 (release-tag-suffix . "[a-z]?$")
11973 (release-tag-version-delimiter . ":"))))
11974 @end lisp
11975
11976
11977 @end table
11978
11979 For instance, the following command only checks for updates of Emacs
11980 packages hosted at @code{elpa.gnu.org} and for updates of CRAN packages:
11981
11982 @example
11983 $ guix refresh --type=elpa,cran
11984 gnu/packages/statistics.scm:819:13: r-testthat would be upgraded from 0.10.0 to 0.11.0
11985 gnu/packages/emacs.scm:856:13: emacs-auctex would be upgraded from 11.88.6 to 11.88.9
11986 @end example
11987
11988 @item --list-updaters
11989 @itemx -L
11990 List available updaters and exit (see @option{--type} above).
11991
11992 For each updater, display the fraction of packages it covers; at the
11993 end, display the fraction of packages covered by all these updaters.
11994 @end table
11995
11996 In addition, @command{guix refresh} can be passed one or more package
11997 names, as in this example:
11998
11999 @example
12000 $ ./pre-inst-env guix refresh -u emacs idutils gcc@@4.8
12001 @end example
12002
12003 @noindent
12004 The command above specifically updates the @code{emacs} and
12005 @code{idutils} packages. The @option{--select} option would have no
12006 effect in this case. You might also want to update definitions that
12007 correspond to the packages installed in your profile:
12008
12009 @example
12010 $ ./pre-inst-env guix refresh -u \
12011 $(guix package --list-installed | cut -f1)
12012 @end example
12013
12014 When considering whether to upgrade a package, it is sometimes
12015 convenient to know which packages would be affected by the upgrade and
12016 should be checked for compatibility. For this the following option may
12017 be used when passing @command{guix refresh} one or more package names:
12018
12019 @table @code
12020
12021 @item --list-dependent
12022 @itemx -l
12023 List top-level dependent packages that would need to be rebuilt as a
12024 result of upgrading one or more packages.
12025
12026 @xref{Invoking guix graph, the @code{reverse-package} type of
12027 @command{guix graph}}, for information on how to visualize the list of
12028 dependents of a package.
12029
12030 @end table
12031
12032 Be aware that the @option{--list-dependent} option only
12033 @emph{approximates} the rebuilds that would be required as a result of
12034 an upgrade. More rebuilds might be required under some circumstances.
12035
12036 @example
12037 $ guix refresh --list-dependent flex
12038 Building the following 120 packages would ensure 213 dependent packages are rebuilt:
12039 hop@@2.4.0 emacs-geiser@@0.13 notmuch@@0.18 mu@@0.9.9.5 cflow@@1.4 idutils@@4.6 @dots{}
12040 @end example
12041
12042 The command above lists a set of packages that could be built to check
12043 for compatibility with an upgraded @code{flex} package.
12044
12045 @table @code
12046
12047 @item --list-transitive
12048 List all the packages which one or more packages depend upon.
12049
12050 @example
12051 $ guix refresh --list-transitive flex
12052 flex@@2.6.4 depends on the following 25 packages: perl@@5.28.0 help2man@@1.47.6
12053 bison@@3.0.5 indent@@2.2.10 tar@@1.30 gzip@@1.9 bzip2@@1.0.6 xz@@5.2.4 file@@5.33 @dots{}
12054 @end example
12055
12056 @end table
12057
12058 The command above lists a set of packages which, when changed, would cause
12059 @code{flex} to be rebuilt.
12060
12061 The following options can be used to customize GnuPG operation:
12062
12063 @table @code
12064
12065 @item --gpg=@var{command}
12066 Use @var{command} as the GnuPG 2.x command. @var{command} is searched
12067 for in @code{$PATH}.
12068
12069 @item --keyring=@var{file}
12070 Use @var{file} as the keyring for upstream keys. @var{file} must be in the
12071 @dfn{keybox format}. Keybox files usually have a name ending in @file{.kbx}
12072 and the GNU@tie{}Privacy Guard (GPG) can manipulate these files
12073 (@pxref{kbxutil, @command{kbxutil},, gnupg, Using the GNU Privacy Guard}, for
12074 information on a tool to manipulate keybox files).
12075
12076 When this option is omitted, @command{guix refresh} uses
12077 @file{~/.config/guix/upstream/trustedkeys.kbx} as the keyring for upstream
12078 signing keys. OpenPGP signatures are checked against keys from this keyring;
12079 missing keys are downloaded to this keyring as well (see
12080 @option{--key-download} below).
12081
12082 You can export keys from your default GPG keyring into a keybox file using
12083 commands like this one:
12084
12085 @example
12086 gpg --export rms@@gnu.org | kbxutil --import-openpgp >> mykeyring.kbx
12087 @end example
12088
12089 Likewise, you can fetch keys to a specific keybox file like this:
12090
12091 @example
12092 gpg --no-default-keyring --keyring mykeyring.kbx \
12093 --recv-keys @value{OPENPGP-SIGNING-KEY-ID}
12094 @end example
12095
12096 @xref{GPG Configuration Options, @option{--keyring},, gnupg, Using the GNU
12097 Privacy Guard}, for more information on GPG's @option{--keyring} option.
12098
12099 @item --key-download=@var{policy}
12100 Handle missing OpenPGP keys according to @var{policy}, which may be one
12101 of:
12102
12103 @table @code
12104 @item always
12105 Always download missing OpenPGP keys from the key server, and add them
12106 to the user's GnuPG keyring.
12107
12108 @item never
12109 Never try to download missing OpenPGP keys. Instead just bail out.
12110
12111 @item interactive
12112 When a package signed with an unknown OpenPGP key is encountered, ask
12113 the user whether to download it or not. This is the default behavior.
12114 @end table
12115
12116 @item --key-server=@var{host}
12117 Use @var{host} as the OpenPGP key server when importing a public key.
12118
12119 @item --load-path=@var{directory}
12120 Add @var{directory} to the front of the package module search path
12121 (@pxref{Package Modules}).
12122
12123 This allows users to define their own packages and make them visible to
12124 the command-line tools.
12125
12126 @end table
12127
12128 The @code{github} updater uses the
12129 @uref{https://developer.github.com/v3/, GitHub API} to query for new
12130 releases. When used repeatedly e.g.@: when refreshing all packages,
12131 GitHub will eventually refuse to answer any further API requests. By
12132 default 60 API requests per hour are allowed, and a full refresh on all
12133 GitHub packages in Guix requires more than this. Authentication with
12134 GitHub through the use of an API token alleviates these limits. To use
12135 an API token, set the environment variable @env{GUIX_GITHUB_TOKEN} to a
12136 token procured from @uref{https://github.com/settings/tokens} or
12137 otherwise.
12138
12139
12140 @node Invoking guix lint
12141 @section Invoking @command{guix lint}
12142
12143 @cindex @command{guix lint}
12144 @cindex package, checking for errors
12145 The @command{guix lint} command is meant to help package developers avoid
12146 common errors and use a consistent style. It runs a number of checks on
12147 a given set of packages in order to find common mistakes in their
12148 definitions. Available @dfn{checkers} include (see
12149 @option{--list-checkers} for a complete list):
12150
12151 @table @code
12152 @item synopsis
12153 @itemx description
12154 Validate certain typographical and stylistic rules about package
12155 descriptions and synopses.
12156
12157 @item inputs-should-be-native
12158 Identify inputs that should most likely be native inputs.
12159
12160 @item source
12161 @itemx home-page
12162 @itemx mirror-url
12163 @itemx github-url
12164 @itemx source-file-name
12165 Probe @code{home-page} and @code{source} URLs and report those that are
12166 invalid. Suggest a @code{mirror://} URL when applicable. If the
12167 @code{source} URL redirects to a GitHub URL, recommend usage of the GitHub
12168 URL@. Check that the source file name is meaningful, e.g.@: is not just a
12169 version number or ``git-checkout'', without a declared @code{file-name}
12170 (@pxref{origin Reference}).
12171
12172 @item source-unstable-tarball
12173 Parse the @code{source} URL to determine if a tarball from GitHub is
12174 autogenerated or if it is a release tarball. Unfortunately GitHub's
12175 autogenerated tarballs are sometimes regenerated.
12176
12177 @item derivation
12178 Check that the derivation of the given packages can be successfully
12179 computed for all the supported systems (@pxref{Derivations}).
12180
12181 @item profile-collisions
12182 Check whether installing the given packages in a profile would lead to
12183 collisions. Collisions occur when several packages with the same name
12184 but a different version or a different store file name are propagated.
12185 @xref{package Reference, @code{propagated-inputs}}, for more information
12186 on propagated inputs.
12187
12188 @item archival
12189 @cindex Software Heritage, source code archive
12190 @cindex archival of source code, Software Heritage
12191 Checks whether the package's source code is archived at
12192 @uref{https://www.softwareheritage.org, Software Heritage}.
12193
12194 When the source code that is not archived comes from a version-control system
12195 (VCS)---e.g., it's obtained with @code{git-fetch}, send Software Heritage a
12196 ``save'' request so that it eventually archives it. This ensures that the
12197 source will remain available in the long term, and that Guix can fall back to
12198 Software Heritage should the source code disappear from its original host.
12199 The status of recent ``save'' requests can be
12200 @uref{https://archive.softwareheritage.org/save/#requests, viewed on-line}.
12201
12202 When source code is a tarball obtained with @code{url-fetch}, simply print a
12203 message when it is not archived. As of this writing, Software Heritage does
12204 not allow requests to save arbitrary tarballs; we are working on ways to
12205 ensure that non-VCS source code is also archived.
12206
12207 Software Heritage
12208 @uref{https://archive.softwareheritage.org/api/#rate-limiting, limits the
12209 request rate per IP address}. When the limit is reached, @command{guix lint}
12210 prints a message and the @code{archival} checker stops doing anything until
12211 that limit has been reset.
12212
12213 @item cve
12214 @cindex security vulnerabilities
12215 @cindex CVE, Common Vulnerabilities and Exposures
12216 Report known vulnerabilities found in the Common Vulnerabilities and
12217 Exposures (CVE) databases of the current and past year
12218 @uref{https://nvd.nist.gov/vuln/data-feeds, published by the US
12219 NIST}.
12220
12221 To view information about a particular vulnerability, visit pages such as:
12222
12223 @itemize
12224 @item
12225 @indicateurl{https://web.nvd.nist.gov/view/vuln/detail?vulnId=CVE-YYYY-ABCD}
12226 @item
12227 @indicateurl{https://cve.mitre.org/cgi-bin/cvename.cgi?name=CVE-YYYY-ABCD}
12228 @end itemize
12229
12230 @noindent
12231 where @code{CVE-YYYY-ABCD} is the CVE identifier---e.g.,
12232 @code{CVE-2015-7554}.
12233
12234 Package developers can specify in package recipes the
12235 @uref{https://nvd.nist.gov/products/cpe,Common Platform Enumeration (CPE)}
12236 name and version of the package when they differ from the name or version
12237 that Guix uses, as in this example:
12238
12239 @lisp
12240 (package
12241 (name "grub")
12242 ;; @dots{}
12243 ;; CPE calls this package "grub2".
12244 (properties '((cpe-name . "grub2")
12245 (cpe-version . "2.3"))))
12246 @end lisp
12247
12248 @c See <https://www.openwall.com/lists/oss-security/2017/03/15/3>.
12249 Some entries in the CVE database do not specify which version of a
12250 package they apply to, and would thus ``stick around'' forever. Package
12251 developers who found CVE alerts and verified they can be ignored can
12252 declare them as in this example:
12253
12254 @lisp
12255 (package
12256 (name "t1lib")
12257 ;; @dots{}
12258 ;; These CVEs no longer apply and can be safely ignored.
12259 (properties `((lint-hidden-cve . ("CVE-2011-0433"
12260 "CVE-2011-1553"
12261 "CVE-2011-1554"
12262 "CVE-2011-5244")))))
12263 @end lisp
12264
12265 @item formatting
12266 Warn about obvious source code formatting issues: trailing white space,
12267 use of tabulations, etc.
12268 @end table
12269
12270 The general syntax is:
12271
12272 @example
12273 guix lint @var{options} @var{package}@dots{}
12274 @end example
12275
12276 If no package is given on the command line, then all packages are checked.
12277 The @var{options} may be zero or more of the following:
12278
12279 @table @code
12280 @item --list-checkers
12281 @itemx -l
12282 List and describe all the available checkers that will be run on packages
12283 and exit.
12284
12285 @item --checkers
12286 @itemx -c
12287 Only enable the checkers specified in a comma-separated list using the
12288 names returned by @option{--list-checkers}.
12289
12290 @item --exclude
12291 @itemx -x
12292 Only disable the checkers specified in a comma-separated list using the
12293 names returned by @option{--list-checkers}.
12294
12295 @item --no-network
12296 @itemx -n
12297 Only enable the checkers that do not depend on Internet access.
12298
12299 @item --load-path=@var{directory}
12300 @itemx -L @var{directory}
12301 Add @var{directory} to the front of the package module search path
12302 (@pxref{Package Modules}).
12303
12304 This allows users to define their own packages and make them visible to
12305 the command-line tools.
12306
12307 @end table
12308
12309 @node Invoking guix size
12310 @section Invoking @command{guix size}
12311
12312 @cindex size
12313 @cindex package size
12314 @cindex closure
12315 @cindex @command{guix size}
12316 The @command{guix size} command helps package developers profile the
12317 disk usage of packages. It is easy to overlook the impact of an
12318 additional dependency added to a package, or the impact of using a
12319 single output for a package that could easily be split (@pxref{Packages
12320 with Multiple Outputs}). Such are the typical issues that
12321 @command{guix size} can highlight.
12322
12323 The command can be passed one or more package specifications
12324 such as @code{gcc@@4.8}
12325 or @code{guile:debug}, or a file name in the store. Consider this
12326 example:
12327
12328 @example
12329 $ guix size coreutils
12330 store item total self
12331 /gnu/store/@dots{}-gcc-5.5.0-lib 60.4 30.1 38.1%
12332 /gnu/store/@dots{}-glibc-2.27 30.3 28.8 36.6%
12333 /gnu/store/@dots{}-coreutils-8.28 78.9 15.0 19.0%
12334 /gnu/store/@dots{}-gmp-6.1.2 63.1 2.7 3.4%
12335 /gnu/store/@dots{}-bash-static-4.4.12 1.5 1.5 1.9%
12336 /gnu/store/@dots{}-acl-2.2.52 61.1 0.4 0.5%
12337 /gnu/store/@dots{}-attr-2.4.47 60.6 0.2 0.3%
12338 /gnu/store/@dots{}-libcap-2.25 60.5 0.2 0.2%
12339 total: 78.9 MiB
12340 @end example
12341
12342 @cindex closure
12343 The store items listed here constitute the @dfn{transitive closure} of
12344 Coreutils---i.e., Coreutils and all its dependencies, recursively---as
12345 would be returned by:
12346
12347 @example
12348 $ guix gc -R /gnu/store/@dots{}-coreutils-8.23
12349 @end example
12350
12351 Here the output shows three columns next to store items. The first column,
12352 labeled ``total'', shows the size in mebibytes (MiB) of the closure of
12353 the store item---that is, its own size plus the size of all its
12354 dependencies. The next column, labeled ``self'', shows the size of the
12355 item itself. The last column shows the ratio of the size of the item
12356 itself to the space occupied by all the items listed here.
12357
12358 In this example, we see that the closure of Coreutils weighs in at
12359 79@tie{}MiB, most of which is taken by libc and GCC's run-time support
12360 libraries. (That libc and GCC's libraries represent a large fraction of
12361 the closure is not a problem @i{per se} because they are always available
12362 on the system anyway.)
12363
12364 Since the command also accepts store file names, assessing the size of
12365 a build result is straightforward:
12366
12367 @example
12368 guix size $(guix system build config.scm)
12369 @end example
12370
12371 When the package(s) passed to @command{guix size} are available in the
12372 store@footnote{More precisely, @command{guix size} looks for the
12373 @emph{ungrafted} variant of the given package(s), as returned by
12374 @code{guix build @var{package} --no-grafts}. @xref{Security Updates},
12375 for information on grafts.}, @command{guix size} queries the daemon to determine its
12376 dependencies, and measures its size in the store, similar to @command{du
12377 -ms --apparent-size} (@pxref{du invocation,,, coreutils, GNU
12378 Coreutils}).
12379
12380 When the given packages are @emph{not} in the store, @command{guix size}
12381 reports information based on the available substitutes
12382 (@pxref{Substitutes}). This makes it possible it to profile disk usage of
12383 store items that are not even on disk, only available remotely.
12384
12385 You can also specify several package names:
12386
12387 @example
12388 $ guix size coreutils grep sed bash
12389 store item total self
12390 /gnu/store/@dots{}-coreutils-8.24 77.8 13.8 13.4%
12391 /gnu/store/@dots{}-grep-2.22 73.1 0.8 0.8%
12392 /gnu/store/@dots{}-bash-4.3.42 72.3 4.7 4.6%
12393 /gnu/store/@dots{}-readline-6.3 67.6 1.2 1.2%
12394 @dots{}
12395 total: 102.3 MiB
12396 @end example
12397
12398 @noindent
12399 In this example we see that the combination of the four packages takes
12400 102.3@tie{}MiB in total, which is much less than the sum of each closure
12401 since they have a lot of dependencies in common.
12402
12403 When looking at the profile returned by @command{guix size}, you may
12404 find yourself wondering why a given package shows up in the profile at
12405 all. To understand it, you can use @command{guix graph --path -t
12406 references} to display the shortest path between the two packages
12407 (@pxref{Invoking guix graph}).
12408
12409 The available options are:
12410
12411 @table @option
12412
12413 @item --substitute-urls=@var{urls}
12414 Use substitute information from @var{urls}.
12415 @xref{client-substitute-urls, the same option for @code{guix build}}.
12416
12417 @item --sort=@var{key}
12418 Sort lines according to @var{key}, one of the following options:
12419
12420 @table @code
12421 @item self
12422 the size of each item (the default);
12423 @item closure
12424 the total size of the item's closure.
12425 @end table
12426
12427 @item --map-file=@var{file}
12428 Write a graphical map of disk usage in PNG format to @var{file}.
12429
12430 For the example above, the map looks like this:
12431
12432 @image{images/coreutils-size-map,5in,, map of Coreutils disk usage
12433 produced by @command{guix size}}
12434
12435 This option requires that
12436 @uref{https://wingolog.org/software/guile-charting/, Guile-Charting} be
12437 installed and visible in Guile's module search path. When that is not
12438 the case, @command{guix size} fails as it tries to load it.
12439
12440 @item --system=@var{system}
12441 @itemx -s @var{system}
12442 Consider packages for @var{system}---e.g., @code{x86_64-linux}.
12443
12444 @item --load-path=@var{directory}
12445 @itemx -L @var{directory}
12446 Add @var{directory} to the front of the package module search path
12447 (@pxref{Package Modules}).
12448
12449 This allows users to define their own packages and make them visible to
12450 the command-line tools.
12451 @end table
12452
12453 @node Invoking guix graph
12454 @section Invoking @command{guix graph}
12455
12456 @cindex DAG
12457 @cindex @command{guix graph}
12458 @cindex package dependencies
12459 Packages and their dependencies form a @dfn{graph}, specifically a
12460 directed acyclic graph (DAG). It can quickly become difficult to have a
12461 mental model of the package DAG, so the @command{guix graph} command
12462 provides a visual representation of the DAG@. By default,
12463 @command{guix graph} emits a DAG representation in the input format of
12464 @uref{https://www.graphviz.org/, Graphviz}, so its output can be passed
12465 directly to the @command{dot} command of Graphviz. It can also emit an
12466 HTML page with embedded JavaScript code to display a ``chord diagram''
12467 in a Web browser, using the @uref{https://d3js.org/, d3.js} library, or
12468 emit Cypher queries to construct a graph in a graph database supporting
12469 the @uref{https://www.opencypher.org/, openCypher} query language. With
12470 @option{--path}, it simply displays the shortest path between two
12471 packages. The general syntax is:
12472
12473 @example
12474 guix graph @var{options} @var{package}@dots{}
12475 @end example
12476
12477 For example, the following command generates a PDF file representing the
12478 package DAG for the GNU@tie{}Core Utilities, showing its build-time
12479 dependencies:
12480
12481 @example
12482 guix graph coreutils | dot -Tpdf > dag.pdf
12483 @end example
12484
12485 The output looks like this:
12486
12487 @image{images/coreutils-graph,2in,,Dependency graph of the GNU Coreutils}
12488
12489 Nice little graph, no?
12490
12491 You may find it more pleasant to navigate the graph interactively with
12492 @command{xdot} (from the @code{xdot} package):
12493
12494 @example
12495 guix graph coreutils | xdot -
12496 @end example
12497
12498 But there is more than one graph! The one above is concise: it is the
12499 graph of package objects, omitting implicit inputs such as GCC, libc,
12500 grep, etc. It is often useful to have such a concise graph, but
12501 sometimes one may want to see more details. @command{guix graph} supports
12502 several types of graphs, allowing you to choose the level of detail:
12503
12504 @table @code
12505 @item package
12506 This is the default type used in the example above. It shows the DAG of
12507 package objects, excluding implicit dependencies. It is concise, but
12508 filters out many details.
12509
12510 @item reverse-package
12511 This shows the @emph{reverse} DAG of packages. For example:
12512
12513 @example
12514 guix graph --type=reverse-package ocaml
12515 @end example
12516
12517 ...@: yields the graph of packages that @emph{explicitly} depend on OCaml (if
12518 you are also interested in cases where OCaml is an implicit dependency, see
12519 @code{reverse-bag} below).
12520
12521 Note that for core packages this can yield huge graphs. If all you want
12522 is to know the number of packages that depend on a given package, use
12523 @command{guix refresh --list-dependent} (@pxref{Invoking guix refresh,
12524 @option{--list-dependent}}).
12525
12526 @item bag-emerged
12527 This is the package DAG, @emph{including} implicit inputs.
12528
12529 For instance, the following command:
12530
12531 @example
12532 guix graph --type=bag-emerged coreutils
12533 @end example
12534
12535 ...@: yields this bigger graph:
12536
12537 @image{images/coreutils-bag-graph,,5in,Detailed dependency graph of the GNU Coreutils}
12538
12539 At the bottom of the graph, we see all the implicit inputs of
12540 @var{gnu-build-system} (@pxref{Build Systems, @code{gnu-build-system}}).
12541
12542 Now, note that the dependencies of these implicit inputs---that is, the
12543 @dfn{bootstrap dependencies} (@pxref{Bootstrapping})---are not shown
12544 here, for conciseness.
12545
12546 @item bag
12547 Similar to @code{bag-emerged}, but this time including all the bootstrap
12548 dependencies.
12549
12550 @item bag-with-origins
12551 Similar to @code{bag}, but also showing origins and their dependencies.
12552
12553 @item reverse-bag
12554 This shows the @emph{reverse} DAG of packages. Unlike @code{reverse-package},
12555 it also takes implicit dependencies into account. For example:
12556
12557 @example
12558 guix graph -t reverse-bag dune
12559 @end example
12560
12561 @noindent
12562 ...@: yields the graph of all packages that depend on Dune, directly or
12563 indirectly. Since Dune is an @emph{implicit} dependency of many packages
12564 @i{via} @code{dune-build-system}, this shows a large number of packages,
12565 whereas @code{reverse-package} would show very few if any.
12566
12567 @item derivation
12568 This is the most detailed representation: It shows the DAG of
12569 derivations (@pxref{Derivations}) and plain store items. Compared to
12570 the above representation, many additional nodes are visible, including
12571 build scripts, patches, Guile modules, etc.
12572
12573 For this type of graph, it is also possible to pass a @file{.drv} file
12574 name instead of a package name, as in:
12575
12576 @example
12577 guix graph -t derivation $(guix system build -d my-config.scm)
12578 @end example
12579
12580 @item module
12581 This is the graph of @dfn{package modules} (@pxref{Package Modules}).
12582 For example, the following command shows the graph for the package
12583 module that defines the @code{guile} package:
12584
12585 @example
12586 guix graph -t module guile | xdot -
12587 @end example
12588 @end table
12589
12590 All the types above correspond to @emph{build-time dependencies}. The
12591 following graph type represents the @emph{run-time dependencies}:
12592
12593 @table @code
12594 @item references
12595 This is the graph of @dfn{references} of a package output, as returned
12596 by @command{guix gc --references} (@pxref{Invoking guix gc}).
12597
12598 If the given package output is not available in the store, @command{guix
12599 graph} attempts to obtain dependency information from substitutes.
12600
12601 Here you can also pass a store file name instead of a package name. For
12602 example, the command below produces the reference graph of your profile
12603 (which can be big!):
12604
12605 @example
12606 guix graph -t references $(readlink -f ~/.guix-profile)
12607 @end example
12608
12609 @item referrers
12610 This is the graph of the @dfn{referrers} of a store item, as returned by
12611 @command{guix gc --referrers} (@pxref{Invoking guix gc}).
12612
12613 This relies exclusively on local information from your store. For
12614 instance, let us suppose that the current Inkscape is available in 10
12615 profiles on your machine; @command{guix graph -t referrers inkscape}
12616 will show a graph rooted at Inkscape and with those 10 profiles linked
12617 to it.
12618
12619 It can help determine what is preventing a store item from being garbage
12620 collected.
12621
12622 @end table
12623
12624 @cindex shortest path, between packages
12625 Often, the graph of the package you are interested in does not fit on
12626 your screen, and anyway all you want to know is @emph{why} that package
12627 actually depends on some seemingly unrelated package. The
12628 @option{--path} option instructs @command{guix graph} to display the
12629 shortest path between two packages (or derivations, or store items,
12630 etc.):
12631
12632 @example
12633 $ guix graph --path emacs libunistring
12634 emacs@@26.3
12635 mailutils@@3.9
12636 libunistring@@0.9.10
12637 $ guix graph --path -t derivation emacs libunistring
12638 /gnu/store/@dots{}-emacs-26.3.drv
12639 /gnu/store/@dots{}-mailutils-3.9.drv
12640 /gnu/store/@dots{}-libunistring-0.9.10.drv
12641 $ guix graph --path -t references emacs libunistring
12642 /gnu/store/@dots{}-emacs-26.3
12643 /gnu/store/@dots{}-libidn2-2.2.0
12644 /gnu/store/@dots{}-libunistring-0.9.10
12645 @end example
12646
12647 Sometimes you still want to visualize the graph but would like to trim
12648 it so it can actually be displayed. One way to do it is via the
12649 @option{--max-depth} (or @option{-M}) option, which lets you specify the
12650 maximum depth of the graph. In the example below, we visualize only
12651 @code{libreoffice} and the nodes whose distance to @code{libreoffice} is
12652 at most 2:
12653
12654 @example
12655 guix graph -M 2 libreoffice | xdot -f fdp -
12656 @end example
12657
12658 Mind you, that's still a big ball of spaghetti, but at least
12659 @command{dot} can render it quickly and it can be browsed somewhat.
12660
12661 The available options are the following:
12662
12663 @table @option
12664 @item --type=@var{type}
12665 @itemx -t @var{type}
12666 Produce a graph output of @var{type}, where @var{type} must be one of
12667 the values listed above.
12668
12669 @item --list-types
12670 List the supported graph types.
12671
12672 @item --backend=@var{backend}
12673 @itemx -b @var{backend}
12674 Produce a graph using the selected @var{backend}.
12675
12676 @item --list-backends
12677 List the supported graph backends.
12678
12679 Currently, the available backends are Graphviz and d3.js.
12680
12681 @item --path
12682 Display the shortest path between two nodes of the type specified by
12683 @option{--type}. The example below shows the shortest path between
12684 @code{libreoffice} and @code{llvm} according to the references of
12685 @code{libreoffice}:
12686
12687 @example
12688 $ guix graph --path -t references libreoffice llvm
12689 /gnu/store/@dots{}-libreoffice-6.4.2.2
12690 /gnu/store/@dots{}-libepoxy-1.5.4
12691 /gnu/store/@dots{}-mesa-19.3.4
12692 /gnu/store/@dots{}-llvm-9.0.1
12693 @end example
12694
12695 @item --expression=@var{expr}
12696 @itemx -e @var{expr}
12697 Consider the package @var{expr} evaluates to.
12698
12699 This is useful to precisely refer to a package, as in this example:
12700
12701 @example
12702 guix graph -e '(@@@@ (gnu packages commencement) gnu-make-final)'
12703 @end example
12704
12705 @item --system=@var{system}
12706 @itemx -s @var{system}
12707 Display the graph for @var{system}---e.g., @code{i686-linux}.
12708
12709 The package dependency graph is largely architecture-independent, but there
12710 are some architecture-dependent bits that this option allows you to visualize.
12711
12712 @item --load-path=@var{directory}
12713 @itemx -L @var{directory}
12714 Add @var{directory} to the front of the package module search path
12715 (@pxref{Package Modules}).
12716
12717 This allows users to define their own packages and make them visible to
12718 the command-line tools.
12719 @end table
12720
12721 On top of that, @command{guix graph} supports all the usual package
12722 transformation options (@pxref{Package Transformation Options}). This
12723 makes it easy to view the effect of a graph-rewriting transformation
12724 such as @option{--with-input}. For example, the command below outputs
12725 the graph of @code{git} once @code{openssl} has been replaced by
12726 @code{libressl} everywhere in the graph:
12727
12728 @example
12729 guix graph git --with-input=openssl=libressl
12730 @end example
12731
12732 So many possibilities, so much fun!
12733
12734 @node Invoking guix publish
12735 @section Invoking @command{guix publish}
12736
12737 @cindex @command{guix publish}
12738 The purpose of @command{guix publish} is to enable users to easily share
12739 their store with others, who can then use it as a substitute server
12740 (@pxref{Substitutes}).
12741
12742 When @command{guix publish} runs, it spawns an HTTP server which allows
12743 anyone with network access to obtain substitutes from it. This means
12744 that any machine running Guix can also act as if it were a build farm,
12745 since the HTTP interface is compatible with Cuirass, the software behind
12746 the @code{@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER-1}} build farm.
12747
12748 For security, each substitute is signed, allowing recipients to check
12749 their authenticity and integrity (@pxref{Substitutes}). Because
12750 @command{guix publish} uses the signing key of the system, which is only
12751 readable by the system administrator, it must be started as root; the
12752 @option{--user} option makes it drop root privileges early on.
12753
12754 The signing key pair must be generated before @command{guix publish} is
12755 launched, using @command{guix archive --generate-key} (@pxref{Invoking
12756 guix archive}).
12757
12758 When the @option{--advertise} option is passed, the server advertises
12759 its availability on the local network using multicast DNS (mDNS) and DNS
12760 service discovery (DNS-SD), currently @i{via} Guile-Avahi (@pxref{Top,,,
12761 guile-avahi, Using Avahi in Guile Scheme Programs}).
12762
12763 The general syntax is:
12764
12765 @example
12766 guix publish @var{options}@dots{}
12767 @end example
12768
12769 Running @command{guix publish} without any additional arguments will
12770 spawn an HTTP server on port 8080:
12771
12772 @example
12773 guix publish
12774 @end example
12775
12776 Once a publishing server has been authorized, the daemon may download
12777 substitutes from it. @xref{Getting Substitutes from Other Servers}.
12778
12779 By default, @command{guix publish} compresses archives on the fly as it
12780 serves them. This ``on-the-fly'' mode is convenient in that it requires
12781 no setup and is immediately available. However, when serving lots of
12782 clients, we recommend using the @option{--cache} option, which enables
12783 caching of the archives before they are sent to clients---see below for
12784 details. The @command{guix weather} command provides a handy way to
12785 check what a server provides (@pxref{Invoking guix weather}).
12786
12787 As a bonus, @command{guix publish} also serves as a content-addressed
12788 mirror for source files referenced in @code{origin} records
12789 (@pxref{origin Reference}). For instance, assuming @command{guix
12790 publish} is running on @code{example.org}, the following URL returns the
12791 raw @file{hello-2.10.tar.gz} file with the given SHA256 hash
12792 (represented in @code{nix-base32} format, @pxref{Invoking guix hash}):
12793
12794 @example
12795 http://example.org/file/hello-2.10.tar.gz/sha256/0ssi1@dots{}ndq1i
12796 @end example
12797
12798 Obviously, these URLs only work for files that are in the store; in
12799 other cases, they return 404 (``Not Found'').
12800
12801 @cindex build logs, publication
12802 Build logs are available from @code{/log} URLs like:
12803
12804 @example
12805 http://example.org/log/gwspk@dots{}-guile-2.2.3
12806 @end example
12807
12808 @noindent
12809 When @command{guix-daemon} is configured to save compressed build logs,
12810 as is the case by default (@pxref{Invoking guix-daemon}), @code{/log}
12811 URLs return the compressed log as-is, with an appropriate
12812 @code{Content-Type} and/or @code{Content-Encoding} header. We recommend
12813 running @command{guix-daemon} with @option{--log-compression=gzip} since
12814 Web browsers can automatically decompress it, which is not the case with
12815 Bzip2 compression.
12816
12817 The following options are available:
12818
12819 @table @code
12820 @item --port=@var{port}
12821 @itemx -p @var{port}
12822 Listen for HTTP requests on @var{port}.
12823
12824 @item --listen=@var{host}
12825 Listen on the network interface for @var{host}. The default is to
12826 accept connections from any interface.
12827
12828 @item --user=@var{user}
12829 @itemx -u @var{user}
12830 Change privileges to @var{user} as soon as possible---i.e., once the
12831 server socket is open and the signing key has been read.
12832
12833 @item --compression[=@var{method}[:@var{level}]]
12834 @itemx -C [@var{method}[:@var{level}]]
12835 Compress data using the given @var{method} and @var{level}. @var{method} is
12836 one of @code{lzip}, @code{zstd}, and @code{gzip}; when @var{method} is
12837 omitted, @code{gzip} is used.
12838
12839 When @var{level} is zero, disable compression. The range 1 to 9 corresponds
12840 to different compression levels: 1 is the fastest, and 9 is the best
12841 (CPU-intensive). The default is 3.
12842
12843 Usually, @code{lzip} compresses noticeably better than @code{gzip} for a
12844 small increase in CPU usage; see
12845 @uref{https://nongnu.org/lzip/lzip_benchmark.html,benchmarks on the lzip
12846 Web page}. However, @code{lzip} achieves low decompression throughput
12847 (on the order of 50@tie{}MiB/s on modern hardware), which can be a
12848 bottleneck for someone who downloads over a fast network connection.
12849
12850 The compression ratio of @code{zstd} is between that of @code{lzip} and
12851 that of @code{gzip}; its main advantage is a
12852 @uref{https://facebook.github.io/zstd/,high decompression speed}.
12853
12854 Unless @option{--cache} is used, compression occurs on the fly and
12855 the compressed streams are not
12856 cached. Thus, to reduce load on the machine that runs @command{guix
12857 publish}, it may be a good idea to choose a low compression level, to
12858 run @command{guix publish} behind a caching proxy, or to use
12859 @option{--cache}. Using @option{--cache} has the advantage that it
12860 allows @command{guix publish} to add @code{Content-Length} HTTP header
12861 to its responses.
12862
12863 This option can be repeated, in which case every substitute gets compressed
12864 using all the selected methods, and all of them are advertised. This is
12865 useful when users may not support all the compression methods: they can select
12866 the one they support.
12867
12868 @item --cache=@var{directory}
12869 @itemx -c @var{directory}
12870 Cache archives and meta-data (@code{.narinfo} URLs) to @var{directory}
12871 and only serve archives that are in cache.
12872
12873 When this option is omitted, archives and meta-data are created
12874 on-the-fly. This can reduce the available bandwidth, especially when
12875 compression is enabled, since this may become CPU-bound. Another
12876 drawback of the default mode is that the length of archives is not known
12877 in advance, so @command{guix publish} does not add a
12878 @code{Content-Length} HTTP header to its responses, which in turn
12879 prevents clients from knowing the amount of data being downloaded.
12880
12881 Conversely, when @option{--cache} is used, the first request for a store
12882 item (@i{via} a @code{.narinfo} URL) triggers a
12883 background process to @dfn{bake} the archive---computing its
12884 @code{.narinfo} and compressing the archive, if needed. Once the
12885 archive is cached in @var{directory}, subsequent requests succeed and
12886 are served directly from the cache, which guarantees that clients get
12887 the best possible bandwidth.
12888
12889 That first @code{.narinfo} request nonetheless returns 200, provided the
12890 requested store item is ``small enough'', below the cache bypass
12891 threshold---see @option{--cache-bypass-threshold} below. That way,
12892 clients do not have to wait until the archive is baked. For larger
12893 store items, the first @code{.narinfo} request returns 404, meaning that
12894 clients have to wait until the archive is baked.
12895
12896 The ``baking'' process is performed by worker threads. By default, one
12897 thread per CPU core is created, but this can be customized. See
12898 @option{--workers} below.
12899
12900 When @option{--ttl} is used, cached entries are automatically deleted
12901 when they have expired.
12902
12903 @item --workers=@var{N}
12904 When @option{--cache} is used, request the allocation of @var{N} worker
12905 threads to ``bake'' archives.
12906
12907 @item --ttl=@var{ttl}
12908 Produce @code{Cache-Control} HTTP headers that advertise a time-to-live
12909 (TTL) of @var{ttl}. @var{ttl} must denote a duration: @code{5d} means 5
12910 days, @code{1m} means 1 month, and so on.
12911
12912 This allows the user's Guix to keep substitute information in cache for
12913 @var{ttl}. However, note that @code{guix publish} does not itself
12914 guarantee that the store items it provides will indeed remain available
12915 for as long as @var{ttl}.
12916
12917 Additionally, when @option{--cache} is used, cached entries that have
12918 not been accessed for @var{ttl} and that no longer have a corresponding
12919 item in the store, may be deleted.
12920
12921 @item --negative-ttl=@var{ttl}
12922 Similarly produce @code{Cache-Control} HTTP headers to advertise the
12923 time-to-live (TTL) of @emph{negative} lookups---missing store items, for
12924 which the HTTP 404 code is returned. By default, no negative TTL is
12925 advertised.
12926
12927 This parameter can help adjust server load and substitute latency by
12928 instructing cooperating clients to be more or less patient when a store
12929 item is missing.
12930
12931 @item --cache-bypass-threshold=@var{size}
12932 When used in conjunction with @option{--cache}, store items smaller than
12933 @var{size} are immediately available, even when they are not yet in
12934 cache. @var{size} is a size in bytes, or it can be suffixed by @code{M}
12935 for megabytes and so on. The default is @code{10M}.
12936
12937 ``Cache bypass'' allows you to reduce the publication delay for clients
12938 at the expense of possibly additional I/O and CPU use on the server
12939 side: depending on the client access patterns, those store items can end
12940 up being baked several times until a copy is available in cache.
12941
12942 Increasing the threshold may be useful for sites that have few users, or
12943 to guarantee that users get substitutes even for store items that are
12944 not popular.
12945
12946 @item --nar-path=@var{path}
12947 Use @var{path} as the prefix for the URLs of ``nar'' files
12948 (@pxref{Invoking guix archive, normalized archives}).
12949
12950 By default, nars are served at a URL such as
12951 @code{/nar/gzip/@dots{}-coreutils-8.25}. This option allows you to
12952 change the @code{/nar} part to @var{path}.
12953
12954 @item --public-key=@var{file}
12955 @itemx --private-key=@var{file}
12956 Use the specific @var{file}s as the public/private key pair used to sign
12957 the store items being published.
12958
12959 The files must correspond to the same key pair (the private key is used
12960 for signing and the public key is merely advertised in the signature
12961 metadata). They must contain keys in the canonical s-expression format
12962 as produced by @command{guix archive --generate-key} (@pxref{Invoking
12963 guix archive}). By default, @file{/etc/guix/signing-key.pub} and
12964 @file{/etc/guix/signing-key.sec} are used.
12965
12966 @item --repl[=@var{port}]
12967 @itemx -r [@var{port}]
12968 Spawn a Guile REPL server (@pxref{REPL Servers,,, guile, GNU Guile
12969 Reference Manual}) on @var{port} (37146 by default). This is used
12970 primarily for debugging a running @command{guix publish} server.
12971 @end table
12972
12973 Enabling @command{guix publish} on Guix System is a one-liner: just
12974 instantiate a @code{guix-publish-service-type} service in the @code{services} field
12975 of the @code{operating-system} declaration (@pxref{guix-publish-service-type,
12976 @code{guix-publish-service-type}}).
12977
12978 If you are instead running Guix on a ``foreign distro'', follow these
12979 instructions:
12980
12981 @itemize
12982 @item
12983 If your host distro uses the systemd init system:
12984
12985 @example
12986 # ln -s ~root/.guix-profile/lib/systemd/system/guix-publish.service \
12987 /etc/systemd/system/
12988 # systemctl start guix-publish && systemctl enable guix-publish
12989 @end example
12990
12991 @item
12992 If your host distro uses the Upstart init system:
12993
12994 @example
12995 # ln -s ~root/.guix-profile/lib/upstart/system/guix-publish.conf /etc/init/
12996 # start guix-publish
12997 @end example
12998
12999 @item
13000 Otherwise, proceed similarly with your distro's init system.
13001 @end itemize
13002
13003 @node Invoking guix challenge
13004 @section Invoking @command{guix challenge}
13005
13006 @cindex reproducible builds
13007 @cindex verifiable builds
13008 @cindex @command{guix challenge}
13009 @cindex challenge
13010 Do the binaries provided by this server really correspond to the source
13011 code it claims to build? Is a package build process deterministic?
13012 These are the questions the @command{guix challenge} command attempts to
13013 answer.
13014
13015 The former is obviously an important question: Before using a substitute
13016 server (@pxref{Substitutes}), one had better @emph{verify} that it
13017 provides the right binaries, and thus @emph{challenge} it. The latter
13018 is what enables the former: If package builds are deterministic, then
13019 independent builds of the package should yield the exact same result,
13020 bit for bit; if a server provides a binary different from the one
13021 obtained locally, it may be either corrupt or malicious.
13022
13023 We know that the hash that shows up in @file{/gnu/store} file names is
13024 the hash of all the inputs of the process that built the file or
13025 directory---compilers, libraries, build scripts,
13026 etc. (@pxref{Introduction}). Assuming deterministic build processes,
13027 one store file name should map to exactly one build output.
13028 @command{guix challenge} checks whether there is, indeed, a single
13029 mapping by comparing the build outputs of several independent builds of
13030 any given store item.
13031
13032 The command output looks like this:
13033
13034 @smallexample
13035 $ guix challenge --substitute-urls="https://@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER-1} https://guix.example.org"
13036 updating list of substitutes from 'https://@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER-1}'... 100.0%
13037 updating list of substitutes from 'https://guix.example.org'... 100.0%
13038 /gnu/store/@dots{}-openssl-1.0.2d contents differ:
13039 local hash: 0725l22r5jnzazaacncwsvp9kgf42266ayyp814v7djxs7nk963q
13040 https://@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER-1}/nar/@dots{}-openssl-1.0.2d: 0725l22r5jnzazaacncwsvp9kgf42266ayyp814v7djxs7nk963q
13041 https://guix.example.org/nar/@dots{}-openssl-1.0.2d: 1zy4fmaaqcnjrzzajkdn3f5gmjk754b43qkq47llbyak9z0qjyim
13042 differing files:
13043 /lib/libcrypto.so.1.1
13044 /lib/libssl.so.1.1
13045
13046 /gnu/store/@dots{}-git-2.5.0 contents differ:
13047 local hash: 00p3bmryhjxrhpn2gxs2fy0a15lnip05l97205pgbk5ra395hyha
13048 https://@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER-1}/nar/@dots{}-git-2.5.0: 069nb85bv4d4a6slrwjdy8v1cn4cwspm3kdbmyb81d6zckj3nq9f
13049 https://guix.example.org/nar/@dots{}-git-2.5.0: 0mdqa9w1p6cmli6976v4wi0sw9r4p5prkj7lzfd1877wk11c9c73
13050 differing file:
13051 /libexec/git-core/git-fsck
13052
13053 /gnu/store/@dots{}-pius-2.1.1 contents differ:
13054 local hash: 0k4v3m9z1zp8xzzizb7d8kjj72f9172xv078sq4wl73vnq9ig3ax
13055 https://@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER-1}/nar/@dots{}-pius-2.1.1: 0k4v3m9z1zp8xzzizb7d8kjj72f9172xv078sq4wl73vnq9ig3ax
13056 https://guix.example.org/nar/@dots{}-pius-2.1.1: 1cy25x1a4fzq5rk0pmvc8xhwyffnqz95h2bpvqsz2mpvlbccy0gs
13057 differing file:
13058 /share/man/man1/pius.1.gz
13059
13060 @dots{}
13061
13062 6,406 store items were analyzed:
13063 - 4,749 (74.1%) were identical
13064 - 525 (8.2%) differed
13065 - 1,132 (17.7%) were inconclusive
13066 @end smallexample
13067
13068 @noindent
13069 In this example, @command{guix challenge} first scans the store to
13070 determine the set of locally-built derivations---as opposed to store
13071 items that were downloaded from a substitute server---and then queries
13072 all the substitute servers. It then reports those store items for which
13073 the servers obtained a result different from the local build.
13074
13075 @cindex non-determinism, in package builds
13076 As an example, @code{guix.example.org} always gets a different answer.
13077 Conversely, @code{@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER-1}} agrees with local builds, except in the
13078 case of Git. This might indicate that the build process of Git is
13079 non-deterministic, meaning that its output varies as a function of
13080 various things that Guix does not fully control, in spite of building
13081 packages in isolated environments (@pxref{Features}). Most common
13082 sources of non-determinism include the addition of timestamps in build
13083 results, the inclusion of random numbers, and directory listings sorted
13084 by inode number. See @uref{https://reproducible-builds.org/docs/}, for
13085 more information.
13086
13087 To find out what is wrong with this Git binary, the easiest approach is
13088 to run:
13089
13090 @example
13091 guix challenge git \
13092 --diff=diffoscope \
13093 --substitute-urls="https://@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER-1} https://guix.example.org"
13094 @end example
13095
13096 This automatically invokes @command{diffoscope}, which displays detailed
13097 information about files that differ.
13098
13099 Alternatively, we can do something along these lines (@pxref{Invoking guix
13100 archive}):
13101
13102 @example
13103 $ wget -q -O - https://@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER-1}/nar/lzip/@dots{}-git-2.5.0 \
13104 | lzip -d | guix archive -x /tmp/git
13105 $ diff -ur --no-dereference /gnu/store/@dots{}-git.2.5.0 /tmp/git
13106 @end example
13107
13108 This command shows the difference between the files resulting from the
13109 local build, and the files resulting from the build on
13110 @code{@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER-1}} (@pxref{Overview, Comparing and Merging Files,,
13111 diffutils, Comparing and Merging Files}). The @command{diff} command
13112 works great for text files. When binary files differ, a better option
13113 is @uref{https://diffoscope.org/, Diffoscope}, a tool that helps
13114 visualize differences for all kinds of files.
13115
13116 Once you have done that work, you can tell whether the differences are due
13117 to a non-deterministic build process or to a malicious server. We try
13118 hard to remove sources of non-determinism in packages to make it easier
13119 to verify substitutes, but of course, this is a process that
13120 involves not just Guix, but a large part of the free software community.
13121 In the meantime, @command{guix challenge} is one tool to help address
13122 the problem.
13123
13124 If you are writing packages for Guix, you are encouraged to check
13125 whether @code{@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER-1}} and other substitute servers obtain the
13126 same build result as you did with:
13127
13128 @example
13129 $ guix challenge @var{package}
13130 @end example
13131
13132 @noindent
13133 where @var{package} is a package specification such as
13134 @code{guile@@2.0} or @code{glibc:debug}.
13135
13136 The general syntax is:
13137
13138 @example
13139 guix challenge @var{options} [@var{packages}@dots{}]
13140 @end example
13141
13142 When a difference is found between the hash of a locally-built item and
13143 that of a server-provided substitute, or among substitutes provided by
13144 different servers, the command displays it as in the example above and
13145 its exit code is 2 (other non-zero exit codes denote other kinds of
13146 errors).
13147
13148 The one option that matters is:
13149
13150 @table @code
13151
13152 @item --substitute-urls=@var{urls}
13153 Consider @var{urls} the whitespace-separated list of substitute source
13154 URLs to compare to.
13155
13156 @item --diff=@var{mode}
13157 Upon mismatches, show differences according to @var{mode}, one of:
13158
13159 @table @asis
13160 @item @code{simple} (the default)
13161 Show the list of files that differ.
13162
13163 @item @code{diffoscope}
13164 @itemx @var{command}
13165 Invoke @uref{https://diffoscope.org/, Diffoscope}, passing it
13166 two directories whose contents do not match.
13167
13168 When @var{command} is an absolute file name, run @var{command} instead
13169 of Diffoscope.
13170
13171 @item @code{none}
13172 Do not show further details about the differences.
13173 @end table
13174
13175 Thus, unless @option{--diff=none} is passed, @command{guix challenge}
13176 downloads the store items from the given substitute servers so that it
13177 can compare them.
13178
13179 @item --verbose
13180 @itemx -v
13181 Show details about matches (identical contents) in addition to
13182 information about mismatches.
13183
13184 @end table
13185
13186 @node Invoking guix copy
13187 @section Invoking @command{guix copy}
13188
13189 @cindex copy, of store items, over SSH
13190 @cindex SSH, copy of store items
13191 @cindex sharing store items across machines
13192 @cindex transferring store items across machines
13193 The @command{guix copy} command copies items from the store of one
13194 machine to that of another machine over a secure shell (SSH)
13195 connection@footnote{This command is available only when Guile-SSH was
13196 found. @xref{Requirements}, for details.}. For example, the following
13197 command copies the @code{coreutils} package, the user's profile, and all
13198 their dependencies over to @var{host}, logged in as @var{user}:
13199
13200 @example
13201 guix copy --to=@var{user}@@@var{host} \
13202 coreutils $(readlink -f ~/.guix-profile)
13203 @end example
13204
13205 If some of the items to be copied are already present on @var{host},
13206 they are not actually sent.
13207
13208 The command below retrieves @code{libreoffice} and @code{gimp} from
13209 @var{host}, assuming they are available there:
13210
13211 @example
13212 guix copy --from=@var{host} libreoffice gimp
13213 @end example
13214
13215 The SSH connection is established using the Guile-SSH client, which is
13216 compatible with OpenSSH: it honors @file{~/.ssh/known_hosts} and
13217 @file{~/.ssh/config}, and uses the SSH agent for authentication.
13218
13219 The key used to sign items that are sent must be accepted by the remote
13220 machine. Likewise, the key used by the remote machine to sign items you
13221 are retrieving must be in @file{/etc/guix/acl} so it is accepted by your
13222 own daemon. @xref{Invoking guix archive}, for more information about
13223 store item authentication.
13224
13225 The general syntax is:
13226
13227 @example
13228 guix copy [--to=@var{spec}|--from=@var{spec}] @var{items}@dots{}
13229 @end example
13230
13231 You must always specify one of the following options:
13232
13233 @table @code
13234 @item --to=@var{spec}
13235 @itemx --from=@var{spec}
13236 Specify the host to send to or receive from. @var{spec} must be an SSH
13237 spec such as @code{example.org}, @code{charlie@@example.org}, or
13238 @code{charlie@@example.org:2222}.
13239 @end table
13240
13241 The @var{items} can be either package names, such as @code{gimp}, or
13242 store items, such as @file{/gnu/store/@dots{}-idutils-4.6}.
13243
13244 When specifying the name of a package to send, it is first built if
13245 needed, unless @option{--dry-run} was specified. Common build options
13246 are supported (@pxref{Common Build Options}).
13247
13248
13249 @node Invoking guix container
13250 @section Invoking @command{guix container}
13251 @cindex container
13252 @cindex @command{guix container}
13253 @quotation Note
13254 As of version @value{VERSION}, this tool is experimental. The interface
13255 is subject to radical change in the future.
13256 @end quotation
13257
13258 The purpose of @command{guix container} is to manipulate processes
13259 running within an isolated environment, commonly known as a
13260 ``container'', typically created by the @command{guix environment}
13261 (@pxref{Invoking guix environment}) and @command{guix system container}
13262 (@pxref{Invoking guix system}) commands.
13263
13264 The general syntax is:
13265
13266 @example
13267 guix container @var{action} @var{options}@dots{}
13268 @end example
13269
13270 @var{action} specifies the operation to perform with a container, and
13271 @var{options} specifies the context-specific arguments for the action.
13272
13273 The following actions are available:
13274
13275 @table @code
13276 @item exec
13277 Execute a command within the context of a running container.
13278
13279 The syntax is:
13280
13281 @example
13282 guix container exec @var{pid} @var{program} @var{arguments}@dots{}
13283 @end example
13284
13285 @var{pid} specifies the process ID of the running container.
13286 @var{program} specifies an executable file name within the root file
13287 system of the container. @var{arguments} are the additional options that
13288 will be passed to @var{program}.
13289
13290 The following command launches an interactive login shell inside a
13291 Guix system container, started by @command{guix system container}, and whose
13292 process ID is 9001:
13293
13294 @example
13295 guix container exec 9001 /run/current-system/profile/bin/bash --login
13296 @end example
13297
13298 Note that the @var{pid} cannot be the parent process of a container. It
13299 must be PID 1 of the container or one of its child processes.
13300
13301 @end table
13302
13303 @node Invoking guix weather
13304 @section Invoking @command{guix weather}
13305
13306 Occasionally you're grumpy because substitutes are lacking and you end
13307 up building packages by yourself (@pxref{Substitutes}). The
13308 @command{guix weather} command reports on substitute availability on the
13309 specified servers so you can have an idea of whether you'll be grumpy
13310 today. It can sometimes be useful info as a user, but it is primarily
13311 useful to people running @command{guix publish} (@pxref{Invoking guix
13312 publish}).
13313
13314 @cindex statistics, for substitutes
13315 @cindex availability of substitutes
13316 @cindex substitute availability
13317 @cindex weather, substitute availability
13318 Here's a sample run:
13319
13320 @example
13321 $ guix weather --substitute-urls=https://guix.example.org
13322 computing 5,872 package derivations for x86_64-linux...
13323 looking for 6,128 store items on https://guix.example.org..
13324 updating list of substitutes from 'https://guix.example.org'... 100.0%
13325 https://guix.example.org
13326 43.4% substitutes available (2,658 out of 6,128)
13327 7,032.5 MiB of nars (compressed)
13328 19,824.2 MiB on disk (uncompressed)
13329 0.030 seconds per request (182.9 seconds in total)
13330 33.5 requests per second
13331
13332 9.8% (342 out of 3,470) of the missing items are queued
13333 867 queued builds
13334 x86_64-linux: 518 (59.7%)
13335 i686-linux: 221 (25.5%)
13336 aarch64-linux: 128 (14.8%)
13337 build rate: 23.41 builds per hour
13338 x86_64-linux: 11.16 builds per hour
13339 i686-linux: 6.03 builds per hour
13340 aarch64-linux: 6.41 builds per hour
13341 @end example
13342
13343 @cindex continuous integration, statistics
13344 As you can see, it reports the fraction of all the packages for which
13345 substitutes are available on the server---regardless of whether
13346 substitutes are enabled, and regardless of whether this server's signing
13347 key is authorized. It also reports the size of the compressed archives
13348 (``nars'') provided by the server, the size the corresponding store
13349 items occupy in the store (assuming deduplication is turned off), and
13350 the server's throughput. The second part gives continuous integration
13351 (CI) statistics, if the server supports it. In addition, using the
13352 @option{--coverage} option, @command{guix weather} can list ``important''
13353 package substitutes missing on the server (see below).
13354
13355 To achieve that, @command{guix weather} queries over HTTP(S) meta-data
13356 (@dfn{narinfos}) for all the relevant store items. Like @command{guix
13357 challenge}, it ignores signatures on those substitutes, which is
13358 innocuous since the command only gathers statistics and cannot install
13359 those substitutes.
13360
13361 The general syntax is:
13362
13363 @example
13364 guix weather @var{options}@dots{} [@var{packages}@dots{}]
13365 @end example
13366
13367 When @var{packages} is omitted, @command{guix weather} checks the availability
13368 of substitutes for @emph{all} the packages, or for those specified with
13369 @option{--manifest}; otherwise it only considers the specified packages. It
13370 is also possible to query specific system types with @option{--system}.
13371 @command{guix weather} exits with a non-zero code when the fraction of
13372 available substitutes is below 100%.
13373
13374 The available options are listed below.
13375
13376 @table @code
13377 @item --substitute-urls=@var{urls}
13378 @var{urls} is the space-separated list of substitute server URLs to
13379 query. When this option is omitted, the default set of substitute
13380 servers is queried.
13381
13382 @item --system=@var{system}
13383 @itemx -s @var{system}
13384 Query substitutes for @var{system}---e.g., @code{aarch64-linux}. This
13385 option can be repeated, in which case @command{guix weather} will query
13386 substitutes for several system types.
13387
13388 @item --manifest=@var{file}
13389 Instead of querying substitutes for all the packages, only ask for those
13390 specified in @var{file}. @var{file} must contain a @dfn{manifest}, as
13391 with the @code{-m} option of @command{guix package} (@pxref{Invoking
13392 guix package}).
13393
13394 This option can be repeated several times, in which case the manifests
13395 are concatenated.
13396
13397 @item --coverage[=@var{count}]
13398 @itemx -c [@var{count}]
13399 Report on substitute coverage for packages: list packages with at least
13400 @var{count} dependents (zero by default) for which substitutes are
13401 unavailable. Dependent packages themselves are not listed: if @var{b} depends
13402 on @var{a} and @var{a} has no substitutes, only @var{a} is listed, even though
13403 @var{b} usually lacks substitutes as well. The result looks like this:
13404
13405 @example
13406 $ guix weather --substitute-urls=@value{SUBSTITUTE-URLS} -c 10
13407 computing 8,983 package derivations for x86_64-linux...
13408 looking for 9,343 store items on @value{SUBSTITUTE-URLS}...
13409 updating substitutes from '@value{SUBSTITUTE-URLS}'... 100.0%
13410 @value{SUBSTITUTE-URLS}
13411 64.7% substitutes available (6,047 out of 9,343)
13412 @dots{}
13413 2502 packages are missing from '@value{SUBSTITUTE-URLS}' for 'x86_64-linux', among which:
13414 58 kcoreaddons@@5.49.0 /gnu/store/@dots{}-kcoreaddons-5.49.0
13415 46 qgpgme@@1.11.1 /gnu/store/@dots{}-qgpgme-1.11.1
13416 37 perl-http-cookiejar@@0.008 /gnu/store/@dots{}-perl-http-cookiejar-0.008
13417 @dots{}
13418 @end example
13419
13420 What this example shows is that @code{kcoreaddons} and presumably the 58
13421 packages that depend on it have no substitutes at
13422 @code{@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER-1}}; likewise for @code{qgpgme} and the 46
13423 packages that depend on it.
13424
13425 If you are a Guix developer, or if you are taking care of this build farm,
13426 you'll probably want to have a closer look at these packages: they may simply
13427 fail to build.
13428
13429 @item --display-missing
13430 Display the list of store items for which substitutes are missing.
13431 @end table
13432
13433 @node Invoking guix processes
13434 @section Invoking @command{guix processes}
13435
13436 The @command{guix processes} command can be useful to developers and system
13437 administrators, especially on multi-user machines and on build farms: it lists
13438 the current sessions (connections to the daemon), as well as information about
13439 the processes involved@footnote{Remote sessions, when @command{guix-daemon} is
13440 started with @option{--listen} specifying a TCP endpoint, are @emph{not}
13441 listed.}. Here's an example of the information it returns:
13442
13443 @example
13444 $ sudo guix processes
13445 SessionPID: 19002
13446 ClientPID: 19090
13447 ClientCommand: guix environment --ad-hoc python
13448
13449 SessionPID: 19402
13450 ClientPID: 19367
13451 ClientCommand: guix publish -u guix-publish -p 3000 -C 9 @dots{}
13452
13453 SessionPID: 19444
13454 ClientPID: 19419
13455 ClientCommand: cuirass --cache-directory /var/cache/cuirass @dots{}
13456 LockHeld: /gnu/store/@dots{}-perl-ipc-cmd-0.96.lock
13457 LockHeld: /gnu/store/@dots{}-python-six-bootstrap-1.11.0.lock
13458 LockHeld: /gnu/store/@dots{}-libjpeg-turbo-2.0.0.lock
13459 ChildPID: 20495
13460 ChildCommand: guix offload x86_64-linux 7200 1 28800
13461 ChildPID: 27733
13462 ChildCommand: guix offload x86_64-linux 7200 1 28800
13463 ChildPID: 27793
13464 ChildCommand: guix offload x86_64-linux 7200 1 28800
13465 @end example
13466
13467 In this example we see that @command{guix-daemon} has three clients:
13468 @command{guix environment}, @command{guix publish}, and the Cuirass continuous
13469 integration tool; their process identifier (PID) is given by the
13470 @code{ClientPID} field. The @code{SessionPID} field gives the PID of the
13471 @command{guix-daemon} sub-process of this particular session.
13472
13473 The @code{LockHeld} fields show which store items are currently locked
13474 by this session, which corresponds to store items being built or
13475 substituted (the @code{LockHeld} field is not displayed when
13476 @command{guix processes} is not running as root). Last, by looking at
13477 the @code{ChildPID} and @code{ChildCommand} fields, we understand that
13478 these three builds are being offloaded (@pxref{Daemon Offload Setup}).
13479
13480 The output is in Recutils format so we can use the handy @command{recsel}
13481 command to select sessions of interest (@pxref{Selection Expressions,,,
13482 recutils, GNU recutils manual}). As an example, the command shows the command
13483 line and PID of the client that triggered the build of a Perl package:
13484
13485 @example
13486 $ sudo guix processes | \
13487 recsel -p ClientPID,ClientCommand -e 'LockHeld ~ "perl"'
13488 ClientPID: 19419
13489 ClientCommand: cuirass --cache-directory /var/cache/cuirass @dots{}
13490 @end example
13491
13492 Additional options are listed below.
13493
13494 @table @code
13495 @item --format=@var{format}
13496 @itemx -f @var{format}
13497 Produce output in the specified @var{format}, one of:
13498
13499 @table @code
13500 @item recutils
13501 The default option. It outputs a set of Session recutils records
13502 that include each @code{ChildProcess} as a field.
13503
13504 @item normalized
13505 Normalize the output records into record sets (@pxref{Record Sets,,,
13506 recutils, GNU recutils manual}). Normalizing into record sets allows
13507 joins across record types. The example below lists the PID of each
13508 @code{ChildProcess} and the associated PID for @code{Session} that
13509 spawned the @code{ChildProcess} where the @code{Session} was started
13510 using @command{guix build}.
13511
13512 @example
13513 $ guix processes --format=normalized | \
13514 recsel \
13515 -j Session \
13516 -t ChildProcess \
13517 -p Session.PID,PID \
13518 -e 'Session.ClientCommand ~ "guix build"'
13519 PID: 4435
13520 Session_PID: 4278
13521
13522 PID: 4554
13523 Session_PID: 4278
13524
13525 PID: 4646
13526 Session_PID: 4278
13527 @end example
13528 @end table
13529 @end table
13530
13531 @node System Configuration
13532 @chapter System Configuration
13533
13534 @cindex system configuration
13535 Guix System supports a consistent whole-system configuration
13536 mechanism. By that we mean that all aspects of the global system
13537 configuration---such as the available system services, timezone and
13538 locale settings, user accounts---are declared in a single place. Such
13539 a @dfn{system configuration} can be @dfn{instantiated}---i.e., effected.
13540
13541 One of the advantages of putting all the system configuration under the
13542 control of Guix is that it supports transactional system upgrades, and
13543 makes it possible to roll back to a previous system instantiation,
13544 should something go wrong with the new one (@pxref{Features}). Another
13545 advantage is that it makes it easy to replicate the exact same configuration
13546 across different machines, or at different points in time, without
13547 having to resort to additional administration tools layered on top of
13548 the own tools of the system.
13549 @c Yes, we're talking of Puppet, Chef, & co. here. ↑
13550
13551 This section describes this mechanism. First we focus on the system
13552 administrator's viewpoint---explaining how the system is configured and
13553 instantiated. Then we show how this mechanism can be extended, for
13554 instance to support new system services.
13555
13556 @menu
13557 * Using the Configuration System:: Customizing your GNU system.
13558 * operating-system Reference:: Detail of operating-system declarations.
13559 * File Systems:: Configuring file system mounts.
13560 * Mapped Devices:: Block device extra processing.
13561 * User Accounts:: Specifying user accounts.
13562 * Keyboard Layout:: How the system interprets key strokes.
13563 * Locales:: Language and cultural convention settings.
13564 * Services:: Specifying system services.
13565 * Setuid Programs:: Programs running with root privileges.
13566 * X.509 Certificates:: Authenticating HTTPS servers.
13567 * Name Service Switch:: Configuring libc's name service switch.
13568 * Initial RAM Disk:: Linux-Libre bootstrapping.
13569 * Bootloader Configuration:: Configuring the boot loader.
13570 * Invoking guix system:: Instantiating a system configuration.
13571 * Invoking guix deploy:: Deploying a system configuration to a remote host.
13572 * Running Guix in a VM:: How to run Guix System in a virtual machine.
13573 * Defining Services:: Adding new service definitions.
13574 @end menu
13575
13576 @node Using the Configuration System
13577 @section Using the Configuration System
13578
13579 The operating system is configured by providing an
13580 @code{operating-system} declaration in a file that can then be passed to
13581 the @command{guix system} command (@pxref{Invoking guix system}). A
13582 simple setup, with the default system services, the default Linux-Libre
13583 kernel, initial RAM disk, and boot loader looks like this:
13584
13585 @findex operating-system
13586 @lisp
13587 @include os-config-bare-bones.texi
13588 @end lisp
13589
13590 This example should be self-describing. Some of the fields defined
13591 above, such as @code{host-name} and @code{bootloader}, are mandatory.
13592 Others, such as @code{packages} and @code{services}, can be omitted, in
13593 which case they get a default value.
13594
13595 Below we discuss the effect of some of the most important fields
13596 (@pxref{operating-system Reference}, for details about all the available
13597 fields), and how to @dfn{instantiate} the operating system using
13598 @command{guix system}.
13599
13600 @unnumberedsubsec Bootloader
13601
13602 @cindex legacy boot, on Intel machines
13603 @cindex BIOS boot, on Intel machines
13604 @cindex UEFI boot
13605 @cindex EFI boot
13606 The @code{bootloader} field describes the method that will be used to boot
13607 your system. Machines based on Intel processors can boot in ``legacy'' BIOS
13608 mode, as in the example above. However, more recent machines rely instead on
13609 the @dfn{Unified Extensible Firmware Interface} (UEFI) to boot. In that case,
13610 the @code{bootloader} field should contain something along these lines:
13611
13612 @lisp
13613 (bootloader-configuration
13614 (bootloader grub-efi-bootloader)
13615 (targets '("/boot/efi")))
13616 @end lisp
13617
13618 @xref{Bootloader Configuration}, for more information on the available
13619 configuration options.
13620
13621 @unnumberedsubsec Globally-Visible Packages
13622
13623 @vindex %base-packages
13624 The @code{packages} field lists packages that will be globally visible
13625 on the system, for all user accounts---i.e., in every user's @env{PATH}
13626 environment variable---in addition to the per-user profiles
13627 (@pxref{Invoking guix package}). The @code{%base-packages} variable
13628 provides all the tools one would expect for basic user and administrator
13629 tasks---including the GNU Core Utilities, the GNU Networking Utilities,
13630 the @command{mg} lightweight text editor, @command{find}, @command{grep},
13631 etc. The example above adds GNU@tie{}Screen to those,
13632 taken from the @code{(gnu packages screen)}
13633 module (@pxref{Package Modules}). The
13634 @code{(list package output)} syntax can be used to add a specific output
13635 of a package:
13636
13637 @lisp
13638 (use-modules (gnu packages))
13639 (use-modules (gnu packages dns))
13640
13641 (operating-system
13642 ;; ...
13643 (packages (cons (list isc-bind "utils")
13644 %base-packages)))
13645 @end lisp
13646
13647 @findex specification->package
13648 Referring to packages by variable name, like @code{isc-bind} above, has
13649 the advantage of being unambiguous; it also allows typos and such to be
13650 diagnosed right away as ``unbound variables''. The downside is that one
13651 needs to know which module defines which package, and to augment the
13652 @code{use-package-modules} line accordingly. To avoid that, one can use
13653 the @code{specification->package} procedure of the @code{(gnu packages)}
13654 module, which returns the best package for a given name or name and
13655 version:
13656
13657 @lisp
13658 (use-modules (gnu packages))
13659
13660 (operating-system
13661 ;; ...
13662 (packages (append (map specification->package
13663 '("tcpdump" "htop" "gnupg@@2.0"))
13664 %base-packages)))
13665 @end lisp
13666
13667 @unnumberedsubsec System Services
13668
13669 @cindex services
13670 @vindex %base-services
13671 The @code{services} field lists @dfn{system services} to be made
13672 available when the system starts (@pxref{Services}).
13673 The @code{operating-system} declaration above specifies that, in
13674 addition to the basic services, we want the OpenSSH secure shell
13675 daemon listening on port 2222 (@pxref{Networking Services,
13676 @code{openssh-service-type}}). Under the hood,
13677 @code{openssh-service-type} arranges so that @command{sshd} is started with the
13678 right command-line options, possibly with supporting configuration files
13679 generated as needed (@pxref{Defining Services}).
13680
13681 @cindex customization, of services
13682 @findex modify-services
13683 Occasionally, instead of using the base services as is, you will want to
13684 customize them. To do this, use @code{modify-services} (@pxref{Service
13685 Reference, @code{modify-services}}) to modify the list.
13686
13687 @anchor{auto-login to TTY} For example, suppose you want to modify
13688 @code{guix-daemon} and Mingetty (the console log-in) in the
13689 @code{%base-services} list (@pxref{Base Services,
13690 @code{%base-services}}). To do that, you can write the following in
13691 your operating system declaration:
13692
13693 @lisp
13694 (define %my-services
13695 ;; My very own list of services.
13696 (modify-services %base-services
13697 (guix-service-type config =>
13698 (guix-configuration
13699 (inherit config)
13700 ;; Fetch substitutes from example.org.
13701 (substitute-urls
13702 (list "https://example.org/guix"
13703 "https://ci.guix.gnu.org"))))
13704 (mingetty-service-type config =>
13705 (mingetty-configuration
13706 (inherit config)
13707 ;; Automatially log in as "guest".
13708 (auto-login "guest")))))
13709
13710 (operating-system
13711 ;; @dots{}
13712 (services %my-services))
13713 @end lisp
13714
13715 This changes the configuration---i.e., the service parameters---of the
13716 @code{guix-service-type} instance, and that of all the
13717 @code{mingetty-service-type} instances in the @code{%base-services} list
13718 (@pxref{Auto-Login to a Specific TTY, see the cookbook for how to
13719 auto-login one user to a specific TTY,, guix-cookbook, GNU Guix Cookbook})).
13720 Observe how this is accomplished: first, we arrange for the original
13721 configuration to be bound to the identifier @code{config} in the
13722 @var{body}, and then we write the @var{body} so that it evaluates to the
13723 desired configuration. In particular, notice how we use @code{inherit}
13724 to create a new configuration which has the same values as the old
13725 configuration, but with a few modifications.
13726
13727 @cindex encrypted disk
13728 The configuration for a typical ``desktop'' usage, with an encrypted
13729 root partition, the X11 display
13730 server, GNOME and Xfce (users can choose which of these desktop
13731 environments to use at the log-in screen by pressing @kbd{F1}), network
13732 management, power management, and more, would look like this:
13733
13734 @lisp
13735 @include os-config-desktop.texi
13736 @end lisp
13737
13738 A graphical system with a choice of lightweight window managers
13739 instead of full-blown desktop environments would look like this:
13740
13741 @lisp
13742 @include os-config-lightweight-desktop.texi
13743 @end lisp
13744
13745 This example refers to the @file{/boot/efi} file system by its UUID,
13746 @code{1234-ABCD}. Replace this UUID with the right UUID on your system,
13747 as returned by the @command{blkid} command.
13748
13749 @xref{Desktop Services}, for the exact list of services provided by
13750 @code{%desktop-services}. @xref{X.509 Certificates}, for background
13751 information about the @code{nss-certs} package that is used here.
13752
13753 Again, @code{%desktop-services} is just a list of service objects. If
13754 you want to remove services from there, you can do so using the
13755 procedures for list filtering (@pxref{SRFI-1 Filtering and
13756 Partitioning,,, guile, GNU Guile Reference Manual}). For instance, the
13757 following expression returns a list that contains all the services in
13758 @code{%desktop-services} minus the Avahi service:
13759
13760 @lisp
13761 (remove (lambda (service)
13762 (eq? (service-kind service) avahi-service-type))
13763 %desktop-services)
13764 @end lisp
13765
13766 Alternatively, the @code{modify-services} macro can be used:
13767
13768 @lisp
13769 (modify-services %desktop-services
13770 (delete avahi-service-type))
13771 @end lisp
13772
13773
13774 @unnumberedsubsec Instantiating the System
13775
13776 Assuming the @code{operating-system} declaration
13777 is stored in the @file{my-system-config.scm}
13778 file, the @command{guix system reconfigure my-system-config.scm} command
13779 instantiates that configuration, and makes it the default GRUB boot
13780 entry (@pxref{Invoking guix system}).
13781
13782 The normal way to change the system configuration is by updating this
13783 file and re-running @command{guix system reconfigure}. One should never
13784 have to touch files in @file{/etc} or to run commands that modify the
13785 system state such as @command{useradd} or @command{grub-install}. In
13786 fact, you must avoid that since that would not only void your warranty
13787 but also prevent you from rolling back to previous versions of your
13788 system, should you ever need to.
13789
13790 @cindex roll-back, of the operating system
13791 Speaking of roll-back, each time you run @command{guix system
13792 reconfigure}, a new @dfn{generation} of the system is created---without
13793 modifying or deleting previous generations. Old system generations get
13794 an entry in the bootloader boot menu, allowing you to boot them in case
13795 something went wrong with the latest generation. Reassuring, no? The
13796 @command{guix system list-generations} command lists the system
13797 generations available on disk. It is also possible to roll back the
13798 system via the commands @command{guix system roll-back} and
13799 @command{guix system switch-generation}.
13800
13801 Although the @command{guix system reconfigure} command will not modify
13802 previous generations, you must take care when the current generation is not
13803 the latest (e.g., after invoking @command{guix system roll-back}), since
13804 the operation might overwrite a later generation (@pxref{Invoking guix
13805 system}).
13806
13807 @unnumberedsubsec The Programming Interface
13808
13809 At the Scheme level, the bulk of an @code{operating-system} declaration
13810 is instantiated with the following monadic procedure (@pxref{The Store
13811 Monad}):
13812
13813 @deffn {Monadic Procedure} operating-system-derivation os
13814 Return a derivation that builds @var{os}, an @code{operating-system}
13815 object (@pxref{Derivations}).
13816
13817 The output of the derivation is a single directory that refers to all
13818 the packages, configuration files, and other supporting files needed to
13819 instantiate @var{os}.
13820 @end deffn
13821
13822 This procedure is provided by the @code{(gnu system)} module. Along
13823 with @code{(gnu services)} (@pxref{Services}), this module contains the
13824 guts of Guix System. Make sure to visit it!
13825
13826
13827 @node operating-system Reference
13828 @section @code{operating-system} Reference
13829
13830 This section summarizes all the options available in
13831 @code{operating-system} declarations (@pxref{Using the Configuration
13832 System}).
13833
13834 @deftp {Data Type} operating-system
13835 This is the data type representing an operating system configuration.
13836 By that, we mean all the global system configuration, not per-user
13837 configuration (@pxref{Using the Configuration System}).
13838
13839 @table @asis
13840 @item @code{kernel} (default: @code{linux-libre})
13841 The package object of the operating system kernel to
13842 use@footnote{Currently only the Linux-libre kernel is fully supported.
13843 Using GNU@tie{}mach with the GNU@tie{}Hurd is experimental and only
13844 available when building a virtual machine disk image.}.
13845
13846 @cindex hurd
13847 @item @code{hurd} (default: @code{#f})
13848 The package object of the Hurd to be started by the kernel. When this
13849 field is set, produce a GNU/Hurd operating system. In that case,
13850 @code{kernel} must also be set to the @code{gnumach} package---the
13851 microkernel the Hurd runs on.
13852
13853 @quotation Warning
13854 This feature is experimental and only supported for disk images.
13855 @end quotation
13856
13857 @item @code{kernel-loadable-modules} (default: '())
13858 A list of objects (usually packages) to collect loadable kernel modules
13859 from--e.g. @code{(list ddcci-driver-linux)}.
13860
13861 @item @code{kernel-arguments} (default: @code{%default-kernel-arguments})
13862 List of strings or gexps representing additional arguments to pass on
13863 the command-line of the kernel---e.g., @code{("console=ttyS0")}.
13864
13865 @item @code{bootloader}
13866 The system bootloader configuration object. @xref{Bootloader Configuration}.
13867
13868 @item @code{label}
13869 This is the label (a string) as it appears in the bootloader's menu entry.
13870 The default label includes the kernel name and version.
13871
13872 @item @code{keyboard-layout} (default: @code{#f})
13873 This field specifies the keyboard layout to use in the console. It can be
13874 either @code{#f}, in which case the default keyboard layout is used (usually
13875 US English), or a @code{<keyboard-layout>} record. @xref{Keyboard Layout},
13876 for more information.
13877
13878 This keyboard layout is in effect as soon as the kernel has booted. For
13879 instance, it is the keyboard layout in effect when you type a passphrase if
13880 your root file system is on a @code{luks-device-mapping} mapped device
13881 (@pxref{Mapped Devices}).
13882
13883 @quotation Note
13884 This does @emph{not} specify the keyboard layout used by the bootloader, nor
13885 that used by the graphical display server. @xref{Bootloader Configuration},
13886 for information on how to specify the bootloader's keyboard layout. @xref{X
13887 Window}, for information on how to specify the keyboard layout used by the X
13888 Window System.
13889 @end quotation
13890
13891 @item @code{initrd-modules} (default: @code{%base-initrd-modules})
13892 @cindex initrd
13893 @cindex initial RAM disk
13894 The list of Linux kernel modules that need to be available in the
13895 initial RAM disk. @xref{Initial RAM Disk}.
13896
13897 @item @code{initrd} (default: @code{base-initrd})
13898 A procedure that returns an initial RAM disk for the Linux
13899 kernel. This field is provided to support low-level customization and
13900 should rarely be needed for casual use. @xref{Initial RAM Disk}.
13901
13902 @item @code{firmware} (default: @code{%base-firmware})
13903 @cindex firmware
13904 List of firmware packages loadable by the operating system kernel.
13905
13906 The default includes firmware needed for Atheros- and Broadcom-based
13907 WiFi devices (Linux-libre modules @code{ath9k} and @code{b43-open},
13908 respectively). @xref{Hardware Considerations}, for more info on
13909 supported hardware.
13910
13911 @item @code{host-name}
13912 The host name.
13913
13914 @item @code{hosts-file}
13915 @cindex hosts file
13916 A file-like object (@pxref{G-Expressions, file-like objects}) for use as
13917 @file{/etc/hosts} (@pxref{Host Names,,, libc, The GNU C Library
13918 Reference Manual}). The default is a file with entries for
13919 @code{localhost} and @var{host-name}.
13920
13921 @item @code{mapped-devices} (default: @code{'()})
13922 A list of mapped devices. @xref{Mapped Devices}.
13923
13924 @item @code{file-systems}
13925 A list of file systems. @xref{File Systems}.
13926
13927 @cindex swap devices
13928 @cindex swap space
13929 @item @code{swap-devices} (default: @code{'()})
13930 A list of UUIDs, file system labels, or strings identifying devices or
13931 files to be used for ``swap
13932 space'' (@pxref{Memory Concepts,,, libc, The GNU C Library Reference
13933 Manual}). Here are some examples:
13934
13935 @table @code
13936 @item (list (uuid "4dab5feb-d176-45de-b287-9b0a6e4c01cb"))
13937 Use the swap partition with the given UUID@. You can learn the UUID of a
13938 Linux swap partition by running @command{swaplabel @var{device}}, where
13939 @var{device} is the @file{/dev} file name of that partition.
13940
13941 @item (list (file-system-label "swap"))
13942 Use the partition with label @code{swap}. Again, the
13943 @command{swaplabel} command allows you to view and change the label of a
13944 Linux swap partition.
13945
13946 @item (list "/swapfile")
13947 Use the file @file{/swapfile} as swap space.
13948
13949 @item (list "/dev/sda3" "/dev/sdb2")
13950 Use the @file{/dev/sda3} and @file{/dev/sdb2} partitions as swap space.
13951 We recommend referring to swap devices by UUIDs or labels as shown above
13952 instead.
13953 @end table
13954
13955 It is possible to specify a swap file in a file system on a mapped
13956 device (under @file{/dev/mapper}), provided that the necessary device
13957 mapping and file system are also specified. @xref{Mapped Devices} and
13958 @ref{File Systems}.
13959
13960 @item @code{users} (default: @code{%base-user-accounts})
13961 @itemx @code{groups} (default: @code{%base-groups})
13962 List of user accounts and groups. @xref{User Accounts}.
13963
13964 If the @code{users} list lacks a user account with UID@tie{}0, a
13965 ``root'' account with UID@tie{}0 is automatically added.
13966
13967 @item @code{skeletons} (default: @code{(default-skeletons)})
13968 A list of target file name/file-like object tuples (@pxref{G-Expressions,
13969 file-like objects}). These are the skeleton files that will be added to
13970 the home directory of newly-created user accounts.
13971
13972 For instance, a valid value may look like this:
13973
13974 @lisp
13975 `((".bashrc" ,(plain-file "bashrc" "echo Hello\n"))
13976 (".guile" ,(plain-file "guile"
13977 "(use-modules (ice-9 readline))
13978 (activate-readline)")))
13979 @end lisp
13980
13981 @item @code{issue} (default: @code{%default-issue})
13982 A string denoting the contents of the @file{/etc/issue} file, which is
13983 displayed when users log in on a text console.
13984
13985 @item @code{packages} (default: @code{%base-packages})
13986 A list of packages to be installed in the global profile, which is accessible
13987 at @file{/run/current-system/profile}. Each element is either a package
13988 variable or a package/output tuple. Here's a simple example of both:
13989
13990 @lisp
13991 (cons* git ; the default "out" output
13992 (list git "send-email") ; another output of git
13993 %base-packages) ; the default set
13994 @end lisp
13995
13996 The default set includes core utilities and it is good practice to
13997 install non-core utilities in user profiles (@pxref{Invoking guix
13998 package}).
13999
14000 @item @code{timezone}
14001 A timezone identifying string---e.g., @code{"Europe/Paris"}.
14002
14003 You can run the @command{tzselect} command to find out which timezone
14004 string corresponds to your region. Choosing an invalid timezone name
14005 causes @command{guix system} to fail.
14006
14007 @item @code{locale} (default: @code{"en_US.utf8"})
14008 The name of the default locale (@pxref{Locale Names,,, libc, The GNU C
14009 Library Reference Manual}). @xref{Locales}, for more information.
14010
14011 @item @code{locale-definitions} (default: @code{%default-locale-definitions})
14012 The list of locale definitions to be compiled and that may be used at
14013 run time. @xref{Locales}.
14014
14015 @item @code{locale-libcs} (default: @code{(list @var{glibc})})
14016 The list of GNU@tie{}libc packages whose locale data and tools are used
14017 to build the locale definitions. @xref{Locales}, for compatibility
14018 considerations that justify this option.
14019
14020 @item @code{name-service-switch} (default: @code{%default-nss})
14021 Configuration of the libc name service switch (NSS)---a
14022 @code{<name-service-switch>} object. @xref{Name Service Switch}, for
14023 details.
14024
14025 @item @code{services} (default: @code{%base-services})
14026 A list of service objects denoting system services. @xref{Services}.
14027
14028 @cindex essential services
14029 @item @code{essential-services} (default: ...)
14030 The list of ``essential services''---i.e., things like instances of
14031 @code{system-service-type} and @code{host-name-service-type} (@pxref{Service
14032 Reference}), which are derived from the operating system definition itself.
14033 As a user you should @emph{never} need to touch this field.
14034
14035 @item @code{pam-services} (default: @code{(base-pam-services)})
14036 @cindex PAM
14037 @cindex pluggable authentication modules
14038 Linux @dfn{pluggable authentication module} (PAM) services.
14039 @c FIXME: Add xref to PAM services section.
14040
14041 @item @code{setuid-programs} (default: @code{%setuid-programs})
14042 List of @code{<setuid-program>}. @xref{Setuid Programs}, for more
14043 information.
14044
14045 @item @code{sudoers-file} (default: @code{%sudoers-specification})
14046 @cindex sudoers file
14047 The contents of the @file{/etc/sudoers} file as a file-like object
14048 (@pxref{G-Expressions, @code{local-file} and @code{plain-file}}).
14049
14050 This file specifies which users can use the @command{sudo} command, what
14051 they are allowed to do, and what privileges they may gain. The default
14052 is that only @code{root} and members of the @code{wheel} group may use
14053 @code{sudo}.
14054
14055 @end table
14056
14057 @deffn {Scheme Syntax} this-operating-system
14058 When used in the @emph{lexical scope} of an operating system field definition,
14059 this identifier resolves to the operating system being defined.
14060
14061 The example below shows how to refer to the operating system being defined in
14062 the definition of the @code{label} field:
14063
14064 @lisp
14065 (use-modules (gnu) (guix))
14066
14067 (operating-system
14068 ;; ...
14069 (label (package-full-name
14070 (operating-system-kernel this-operating-system))))
14071 @end lisp
14072
14073 It is an error to refer to @code{this-operating-system} outside an operating
14074 system definition.
14075 @end deffn
14076
14077 @end deftp
14078
14079 @node File Systems
14080 @section File Systems
14081
14082 The list of file systems to be mounted is specified in the
14083 @code{file-systems} field of the operating system declaration
14084 (@pxref{Using the Configuration System}). Each file system is declared
14085 using the @code{file-system} form, like this:
14086
14087 @lisp
14088 (file-system
14089 (mount-point "/home")
14090 (device "/dev/sda3")
14091 (type "ext4"))
14092 @end lisp
14093
14094 As usual, some of the fields are mandatory---those shown in the example
14095 above---while others can be omitted. These are described below.
14096
14097 @deftp {Data Type} file-system
14098 Objects of this type represent file systems to be mounted. They
14099 contain the following members:
14100
14101 @table @asis
14102 @item @code{type}
14103 This is a string specifying the type of the file system---e.g.,
14104 @code{"ext4"}.
14105
14106 @item @code{mount-point}
14107 This designates the place where the file system is to be mounted.
14108
14109 @item @code{device}
14110 This names the ``source'' of the file system. It can be one of three
14111 things: a file system label, a file system UUID, or the name of a
14112 @file{/dev} node. Labels and UUIDs offer a way to refer to file
14113 systems without having to hard-code their actual device
14114 name@footnote{Note that, while it is tempting to use
14115 @file{/dev/disk/by-uuid} and similar device names to achieve the same
14116 result, this is not recommended: These special device nodes are created
14117 by the udev daemon and may be unavailable at the time the device is
14118 mounted.}.
14119
14120 @findex file-system-label
14121 File system labels are created using the @code{file-system-label}
14122 procedure, UUIDs are created using @code{uuid}, and @file{/dev} node are
14123 plain strings. Here's an example of a file system referred to by its
14124 label, as shown by the @command{e2label} command:
14125
14126 @lisp
14127 (file-system
14128 (mount-point "/home")
14129 (type "ext4")
14130 (device (file-system-label "my-home")))
14131 @end lisp
14132
14133 @findex uuid
14134 UUIDs are converted from their string representation (as shown by the
14135 @command{tune2fs -l} command) using the @code{uuid} form@footnote{The
14136 @code{uuid} form expects 16-byte UUIDs as defined in
14137 @uref{https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4122, RFC@tie{}4122}. This is the
14138 form of UUID used by the ext2 family of file systems and others, but it
14139 is different from ``UUIDs'' found in FAT file systems, for instance.},
14140 like this:
14141
14142 @lisp
14143 (file-system
14144 (mount-point "/home")
14145 (type "ext4")
14146 (device (uuid "4dab5feb-d176-45de-b287-9b0a6e4c01cb")))
14147 @end lisp
14148
14149 When the source of a file system is a mapped device (@pxref{Mapped
14150 Devices}), its @code{device} field @emph{must} refer to the mapped
14151 device name---e.g., @file{"/dev/mapper/root-partition"}.
14152 This is required so that
14153 the system knows that mounting the file system depends on having the
14154 corresponding device mapping established.
14155
14156 @item @code{flags} (default: @code{'()})
14157 This is a list of symbols denoting mount flags. Recognized flags
14158 include @code{read-only}, @code{bind-mount}, @code{no-dev} (disallow
14159 access to special files), @code{no-suid} (ignore setuid and setgid
14160 bits), @code{no-atime} (do not update file access times),
14161 @code{strict-atime} (update file access time), @code{lazy-time} (only
14162 update time on the in-memory version of the file inode), and
14163 @code{no-exec} (disallow program execution).
14164 @xref{Mount-Unmount-Remount,,, libc, The GNU C Library Reference
14165 Manual}, for more information on these flags.
14166
14167 @item @code{options} (default: @code{#f})
14168 This is either @code{#f}, or a string denoting mount options passed to
14169 the file system driver. @xref{Mount-Unmount-Remount,,, libc, The GNU C
14170 Library Reference Manual}, for details and run @command{man 8 mount} for
14171 options for various file systems. Note that the
14172 @code{file-system-options->alist} and @code{alist->file-system-options}
14173 procedures from @code{(gnu system file-systems)} can be used to convert
14174 file system options given as an association list to the string
14175 representation, and vice-versa.
14176
14177 @item @code{mount?} (default: @code{#t})
14178 This value indicates whether to automatically mount the file system when
14179 the system is brought up. When set to @code{#f}, the file system gets
14180 an entry in @file{/etc/fstab} (read by the @command{mount} command) but
14181 is not automatically mounted.
14182
14183 @item @code{needed-for-boot?} (default: @code{#f})
14184 This Boolean value indicates whether the file system is needed when
14185 booting. If that is true, then the file system is mounted when the
14186 initial RAM disk (initrd) is loaded. This is always the case, for
14187 instance, for the root file system.
14188
14189 @item @code{check?} (default: @code{#t})
14190 This Boolean indicates whether the file system needs to be checked for
14191 errors before being mounted.
14192
14193 @item @code{create-mount-point?} (default: @code{#f})
14194 When true, the mount point is created if it does not exist yet.
14195
14196 @item @code{mount-may-fail?} (default: @code{#f})
14197 When true, this indicates that mounting this file system can fail but
14198 that should not be considered an error. This is useful in unusual
14199 cases; an example of this is @code{efivarfs}, a file system that can
14200 only be mounted on EFI/UEFI systems.
14201
14202 @item @code{dependencies} (default: @code{'()})
14203 This is a list of @code{<file-system>} or @code{<mapped-device>} objects
14204 representing file systems that must be mounted or mapped devices that
14205 must be opened before (and unmounted or closed after) this one.
14206
14207 As an example, consider a hierarchy of mounts: @file{/sys/fs/cgroup} is
14208 a dependency of @file{/sys/fs/cgroup/cpu} and
14209 @file{/sys/fs/cgroup/memory}.
14210
14211 Another example is a file system that depends on a mapped device, for
14212 example for an encrypted partition (@pxref{Mapped Devices}).
14213 @end table
14214 @end deftp
14215
14216 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} file-system-label @var{str}
14217 This procedure returns an opaque file system label from @var{str}, a
14218 string:
14219
14220 @lisp
14221 (file-system-label "home")
14222 @result{} #<file-system-label "home">
14223 @end lisp
14224
14225 File system labels are used to refer to file systems by label rather
14226 than by device name. See above for examples.
14227 @end deffn
14228
14229 The @code{(gnu system file-systems)} exports the following useful
14230 variables.
14231
14232 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %base-file-systems
14233 These are essential file systems that are required on normal systems,
14234 such as @code{%pseudo-terminal-file-system} and @code{%immutable-store} (see
14235 below). Operating system declarations should always contain at least
14236 these.
14237 @end defvr
14238
14239 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %pseudo-terminal-file-system
14240 This is the file system to be mounted as @file{/dev/pts}. It supports
14241 @dfn{pseudo-terminals} created @i{via} @code{openpty} and similar
14242 functions (@pxref{Pseudo-Terminals,,, libc, The GNU C Library Reference
14243 Manual}). Pseudo-terminals are used by terminal emulators such as
14244 @command{xterm}.
14245 @end defvr
14246
14247 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %shared-memory-file-system
14248 This file system is mounted as @file{/dev/shm} and is used to support
14249 memory sharing across processes (@pxref{Memory-mapped I/O,
14250 @code{shm_open},, libc, The GNU C Library Reference Manual}).
14251 @end defvr
14252
14253 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %immutable-store
14254 This file system performs a read-only ``bind mount'' of
14255 @file{/gnu/store}, making it read-only for all the users including
14256 @code{root}. This prevents against accidental modification by software
14257 running as @code{root} or by system administrators.
14258
14259 The daemon itself is still able to write to the store: it remounts it
14260 read-write in its own ``name space.''
14261 @end defvr
14262
14263 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %binary-format-file-system
14264 The @code{binfmt_misc} file system, which allows handling of arbitrary
14265 executable file types to be delegated to user space. This requires the
14266 @code{binfmt.ko} kernel module to be loaded.
14267 @end defvr
14268
14269 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %fuse-control-file-system
14270 The @code{fusectl} file system, which allows unprivileged users to mount
14271 and unmount user-space FUSE file systems. This requires the
14272 @code{fuse.ko} kernel module to be loaded.
14273 @end defvr
14274
14275 The @code{(gnu system uuid)} module provides tools to deal with file
14276 system ``unique identifiers'' (UUIDs).
14277
14278 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} uuid @var{str} [@var{type}]
14279 Return an opaque UUID (unique identifier) object of the given @var{type}
14280 (a symbol) by parsing @var{str} (a string):
14281
14282 @lisp
14283 (uuid "4dab5feb-d176-45de-b287-9b0a6e4c01cb")
14284 @result{} #<<uuid> type: dce bv: @dots{}>
14285
14286 (uuid "1234-ABCD" 'fat)
14287 @result{} #<<uuid> type: fat bv: @dots{}>
14288 @end lisp
14289
14290 @var{type} may be one of @code{dce}, @code{iso9660}, @code{fat},
14291 @code{ntfs}, or one of the commonly found synonyms for these.
14292
14293 UUIDs are another way to unambiguously refer to file systems in
14294 operating system configuration. See the examples above.
14295 @end deffn
14296
14297
14298 @node Btrfs file system
14299 @subsection Btrfs file system
14300
14301 The Btrfs has special features, such as subvolumes, that merit being
14302 explained in more details. The following section attempts to cover
14303 basic as well as complex uses of a Btrfs file system with the Guix
14304 System.
14305
14306 In its simplest usage, a Btrfs file system can be described, for
14307 example, by:
14308
14309 @lisp
14310 (file-system
14311 (mount-point "/home")
14312 (type "btrfs")
14313 (device (file-system-label "my-home")))
14314 @end lisp
14315
14316 The example below is more complex, as it makes use of a Btrfs
14317 subvolume, named @code{rootfs}. The parent Btrfs file system is labeled
14318 @code{my-btrfs-pool}, and is located on an encrypted device (hence the
14319 dependency on @code{mapped-devices}):
14320
14321 @lisp
14322 (file-system
14323 (device (file-system-label "my-btrfs-pool"))
14324 (mount-point "/")
14325 (type "btrfs")
14326 (options "subvol=rootfs")
14327 (dependencies mapped-devices))
14328 @end lisp
14329
14330 Some bootloaders, for example GRUB, only mount a Btrfs partition at its
14331 top level during the early boot, and rely on their configuration to
14332 refer to the correct subvolume path within that top level. The
14333 bootloaders operating in this way typically produce their configuration
14334 on a running system where the Btrfs partitions are already mounted and
14335 where the subvolume information is readily available. As an example,
14336 @command{grub-mkconfig}, the configuration generator command shipped
14337 with GRUB, reads @file{/proc/self/mountinfo} to determine the top-level
14338 path of a subvolume.
14339
14340 The Guix System produces a bootloader configuration using the operating
14341 system configuration as its sole input; it is therefore necessary to
14342 extract the subvolume name on which @file{/gnu/store} lives (if any)
14343 from that operating system configuration. To better illustrate,
14344 consider a subvolume named 'rootfs' which contains the root file system
14345 data. In such situation, the GRUB bootloader would only see the top
14346 level of the root Btrfs partition, e.g.:
14347
14348 @example
14349 / (top level)
14350 ├── rootfs (subvolume directory)
14351 ├── gnu (normal directory)
14352 ├── store (normal directory)
14353 [...]
14354 @end example
14355
14356 Thus, the subvolume name must be prepended to the @file{/gnu/store} path
14357 of the kernel, initrd binaries and any other files referred to in the
14358 GRUB configuration that must be found during the early boot.
14359
14360 The next example shows a nested hierarchy of subvolumes and
14361 directories:
14362
14363 @example
14364 / (top level)
14365 ├── rootfs (subvolume)
14366 ├── gnu (normal directory)
14367 ├── store (subvolume)
14368 [...]
14369 @end example
14370
14371 This scenario would work without mounting the 'store' subvolume.
14372 Mounting 'rootfs' is sufficient, since the subvolume name matches its
14373 intended mount point in the file system hierarchy. Alternatively, the
14374 'store' subvolume could be referred to by setting the @code{subvol}
14375 option to either @code{/rootfs/gnu/store} or @code{rootfs/gnu/store}.
14376
14377 Finally, a more contrived example of nested subvolumes:
14378
14379 @example
14380 / (top level)
14381 ├── root-snapshots (subvolume)
14382 ├── root-current (subvolume)
14383 ├── guix-store (subvolume)
14384 [...]
14385 @end example
14386
14387 Here, the 'guix-store' subvolume doesn't match its intended mount point,
14388 so it is necessary to mount it. The subvolume must be fully specified,
14389 by passing its file name to the @code{subvol} option. To illustrate,
14390 the 'guix-store' subvolume could be mounted on @file{/gnu/store} by using
14391 a file system declaration such as:
14392
14393 @lisp
14394 (file-system
14395 (device (file-system-label "btrfs-pool-1"))
14396 (mount-point "/gnu/store")
14397 (type "btrfs")
14398 (options "subvol=root-snapshots/root-current/guix-store,\
14399 compress-force=zstd,space_cache=v2"))
14400 @end lisp
14401
14402 @node Mapped Devices
14403 @section Mapped Devices
14404
14405 @cindex device mapping
14406 @cindex mapped devices
14407 The Linux kernel has a notion of @dfn{device mapping}: a block device,
14408 such as a hard disk partition, can be @dfn{mapped} into another device,
14409 usually in @code{/dev/mapper/},
14410 with additional processing over the data that flows through
14411 it@footnote{Note that the GNU@tie{}Hurd makes no difference between the
14412 concept of a ``mapped device'' and that of a file system: both boil down
14413 to @emph{translating} input/output operations made on a file to
14414 operations on its backing store. Thus, the Hurd implements mapped
14415 devices, like file systems, using the generic @dfn{translator} mechanism
14416 (@pxref{Translators,,, hurd, The GNU Hurd Reference Manual}).}. A
14417 typical example is encryption device mapping: all writes to the mapped
14418 device are encrypted, and all reads are deciphered, transparently.
14419 Guix extends this notion by considering any device or set of devices that
14420 are @dfn{transformed} in some way to create a new device; for instance,
14421 RAID devices are obtained by @dfn{assembling} several other devices, such
14422 as hard disks or partitions, into a new one that behaves as one partition.
14423
14424 Mapped devices are declared using the @code{mapped-device} form,
14425 defined as follows; for examples, see below.
14426
14427 @deftp {Data Type} mapped-device
14428 Objects of this type represent device mappings that will be made when
14429 the system boots up.
14430
14431 @table @code
14432 @item source
14433 This is either a string specifying the name of the block device to be mapped,
14434 such as @code{"/dev/sda3"}, or a list of such strings when several devices
14435 need to be assembled for creating a new one. In case of LVM this is a
14436 string specifying name of the volume group to be mapped.
14437
14438 @item target
14439 This string specifies the name of the resulting mapped device. For
14440 kernel mappers such as encrypted devices of type @code{luks-device-mapping},
14441 specifying @code{"my-partition"} leads to the creation of
14442 the @code{"/dev/mapper/my-partition"} device.
14443 For RAID devices of type @code{raid-device-mapping}, the full device name
14444 such as @code{"/dev/md0"} needs to be given.
14445 LVM logical volumes of type @code{lvm-device-mapping} need to
14446 be specified as @code{"VGNAME-LVNAME"}.
14447
14448 @item targets
14449 This list of strings specifies names of the resulting mapped devices in case
14450 there are several. The format is identical to @var{target}.
14451
14452 @item type
14453 This must be a @code{mapped-device-kind} object, which specifies how
14454 @var{source} is mapped to @var{target}.
14455 @end table
14456 @end deftp
14457
14458 @defvr {Scheme Variable} luks-device-mapping
14459 This defines LUKS block device encryption using the @command{cryptsetup}
14460 command from the package with the same name. It relies on the
14461 @code{dm-crypt} Linux kernel module.
14462 @end defvr
14463
14464 @defvr {Scheme Variable} raid-device-mapping
14465 This defines a RAID device, which is assembled using the @code{mdadm}
14466 command from the package with the same name. It requires a Linux kernel
14467 module for the appropriate RAID level to be loaded, such as @code{raid456}
14468 for RAID-4, RAID-5 or RAID-6, or @code{raid10} for RAID-10.
14469 @end defvr
14470
14471 @cindex LVM, logical volume manager
14472 @defvr {Scheme Variable} lvm-device-mapping
14473 This defines one or more logical volumes for the Linux
14474 @uref{https://www.sourceware.org/lvm2/, Logical Volume Manager (LVM)}.
14475 The volume group is activated by the @command{vgchange} command from the
14476 @code{lvm2} package.
14477 @end defvr
14478
14479 @cindex disk encryption
14480 @cindex LUKS
14481 The following example specifies a mapping from @file{/dev/sda3} to
14482 @file{/dev/mapper/home} using LUKS---the
14483 @url{https://gitlab.com/cryptsetup/cryptsetup,Linux Unified Key Setup}, a
14484 standard mechanism for disk encryption.
14485 The @file{/dev/mapper/home}
14486 device can then be used as the @code{device} of a @code{file-system}
14487 declaration (@pxref{File Systems}).
14488
14489 @lisp
14490 (mapped-device
14491 (source "/dev/sda3")
14492 (target "home")
14493 (type luks-device-mapping))
14494 @end lisp
14495
14496 Alternatively, to become independent of device numbering, one may obtain
14497 the LUKS UUID (@dfn{unique identifier}) of the source device by a
14498 command like:
14499
14500 @example
14501 cryptsetup luksUUID /dev/sda3
14502 @end example
14503
14504 and use it as follows:
14505
14506 @lisp
14507 (mapped-device
14508 (source (uuid "cb67fc72-0d54-4c88-9d4b-b225f30b0f44"))
14509 (target "home")
14510 (type luks-device-mapping))
14511 @end lisp
14512
14513 @cindex swap encryption
14514 It is also desirable to encrypt swap space, since swap space may contain
14515 sensitive data. One way to accomplish that is to use a swap file in a
14516 file system on a device mapped via LUKS encryption. In this way, the
14517 swap file is encrypted because the entire device is encrypted.
14518 @xref{Preparing for Installation,,Disk Partitioning}, for an example.
14519
14520 A RAID device formed of the partitions @file{/dev/sda1} and @file{/dev/sdb1}
14521 may be declared as follows:
14522
14523 @lisp
14524 (mapped-device
14525 (source (list "/dev/sda1" "/dev/sdb1"))
14526 (target "/dev/md0")
14527 (type raid-device-mapping))
14528 @end lisp
14529
14530 The @file{/dev/md0} device can then be used as the @code{device} of a
14531 @code{file-system} declaration (@pxref{File Systems}).
14532 Note that the RAID level need not be given; it is chosen during the
14533 initial creation and formatting of the RAID device and is determined
14534 automatically later.
14535
14536 LVM logical volumes ``alpha'' and ``beta'' from volume group ``vg0'' can
14537 be declared as follows:
14538
14539 @lisp
14540 (mapped-device
14541 (source "vg0")
14542 (targets (list "vg0-alpha" "vg0-beta"))
14543 (type lvm-device-mapping))
14544 @end lisp
14545
14546 Devices @file{/dev/mapper/vg0-alpha} and @file{/dev/mapper/vg0-beta} can
14547 then be used as the @code{device} of a @code{file-system} declaration
14548 (@pxref{File Systems}).
14549
14550 @node User Accounts
14551 @section User Accounts
14552
14553 @cindex users
14554 @cindex accounts
14555 @cindex user accounts
14556 User accounts and groups are entirely managed through the
14557 @code{operating-system} declaration. They are specified with the
14558 @code{user-account} and @code{user-group} forms:
14559
14560 @lisp
14561 (user-account
14562 (name "alice")
14563 (group "users")
14564 (supplementary-groups '("wheel" ;allow use of sudo, etc.
14565 "audio" ;sound card
14566 "video" ;video devices such as webcams
14567 "cdrom")) ;the good ol' CD-ROM
14568 (comment "Bob's sister"))
14569 @end lisp
14570
14571 Here's a user account that uses a different shell and a custom home
14572 directory (the default would be @file{"/home/bob"}):
14573
14574 @lisp
14575 (user-account
14576 (name "bob")
14577 (group "users")
14578 (comment "Alice's bro")
14579 (shell (file-append zsh "/bin/zsh"))
14580 (home-directory "/home/robert"))
14581 @end lisp
14582
14583 When booting or upon completion of @command{guix system reconfigure},
14584 the system ensures that only the user accounts and groups specified in
14585 the @code{operating-system} declaration exist, and with the specified
14586 properties. Thus, account or group creations or modifications made by
14587 directly invoking commands such as @command{useradd} are lost upon
14588 reconfiguration or reboot. This ensures that the system remains exactly
14589 as declared.
14590
14591 @deftp {Data Type} user-account
14592 Objects of this type represent user accounts. The following members may
14593 be specified:
14594
14595 @table @asis
14596 @item @code{name}
14597 The name of the user account.
14598
14599 @item @code{group}
14600 @cindex groups
14601 This is the name (a string) or identifier (a number) of the user group
14602 this account belongs to.
14603
14604 @item @code{supplementary-groups} (default: @code{'()})
14605 Optionally, this can be defined as a list of group names that this
14606 account belongs to.
14607
14608 @item @code{uid} (default: @code{#f})
14609 This is the user ID for this account (a number), or @code{#f}. In the
14610 latter case, a number is automatically chosen by the system when the
14611 account is created.
14612
14613 @item @code{comment} (default: @code{""})
14614 A comment about the account, such as the account owner's full name.
14615
14616 @item @code{home-directory}
14617 This is the name of the home directory for the account.
14618
14619 @item @code{create-home-directory?} (default: @code{#t})
14620 Indicates whether the home directory of this account should be created
14621 if it does not exist yet.
14622
14623 @item @code{shell} (default: Bash)
14624 This is a G-expression denoting the file name of a program to be used as
14625 the shell (@pxref{G-Expressions}). For example, you would refer to the
14626 Bash executable like this:
14627
14628 @lisp
14629 (file-append bash "/bin/bash")
14630 @end lisp
14631
14632 @noindent
14633 ... and to the Zsh executable like that:
14634
14635 @lisp
14636 (file-append zsh "/bin/zsh")
14637 @end lisp
14638
14639 @item @code{system?} (default: @code{#f})
14640 This Boolean value indicates whether the account is a ``system''
14641 account. System accounts are sometimes treated specially; for instance,
14642 graphical login managers do not list them.
14643
14644 @anchor{user-account-password}
14645 @cindex password, for user accounts
14646 @item @code{password} (default: @code{#f})
14647 You would normally leave this field to @code{#f}, initialize user
14648 passwords as @code{root} with the @command{passwd} command, and then let
14649 users change it with @command{passwd}. Passwords set with
14650 @command{passwd} are of course preserved across reboot and
14651 reconfiguration.
14652
14653 If you @emph{do} want to set an initial password for an account, then
14654 this field must contain the encrypted password, as a string. You can use the
14655 @code{crypt} procedure for this purpose:
14656
14657 @lisp
14658 (user-account
14659 (name "charlie")
14660 (group "users")
14661
14662 ;; Specify a SHA-512-hashed initial password.
14663 (password (crypt "InitialPassword!" "$6$abc")))
14664 @end lisp
14665
14666 @quotation Note
14667 The hash of this initial password will be available in a file in
14668 @file{/gnu/store}, readable by all the users, so this method must be used with
14669 care.
14670 @end quotation
14671
14672 @xref{Passphrase Storage,,, libc, The GNU C Library Reference Manual}, for
14673 more information on password encryption, and @ref{Encryption,,, guile, GNU
14674 Guile Reference Manual}, for information on Guile's @code{crypt} procedure.
14675
14676 @end table
14677 @end deftp
14678
14679 @cindex groups
14680 User group declarations are even simpler:
14681
14682 @lisp
14683 (user-group (name "students"))
14684 @end lisp
14685
14686 @deftp {Data Type} user-group
14687 This type is for, well, user groups. There are just a few fields:
14688
14689 @table @asis
14690 @item @code{name}
14691 The name of the group.
14692
14693 @item @code{id} (default: @code{#f})
14694 The group identifier (a number). If @code{#f}, a new number is
14695 automatically allocated when the group is created.
14696
14697 @item @code{system?} (default: @code{#f})
14698 This Boolean value indicates whether the group is a ``system'' group.
14699 System groups have low numerical IDs.
14700
14701 @item @code{password} (default: @code{#f})
14702 What, user groups can have a password? Well, apparently yes. Unless
14703 @code{#f}, this field specifies the password of the group.
14704
14705 @end table
14706 @end deftp
14707
14708 For convenience, a variable lists all the basic user groups one may
14709 expect:
14710
14711 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %base-groups
14712 This is the list of basic user groups that users and/or packages expect
14713 to be present on the system. This includes groups such as ``root'',
14714 ``wheel'', and ``users'', as well as groups used to control access to
14715 specific devices such as ``audio'', ``disk'', and ``cdrom''.
14716 @end defvr
14717
14718 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %base-user-accounts
14719 This is the list of basic system accounts that programs may expect to
14720 find on a GNU/Linux system, such as the ``nobody'' account.
14721
14722 Note that the ``root'' account is not included here. It is a
14723 special-case and is automatically added whether or not it is specified.
14724 @end defvr
14725
14726 @node Keyboard Layout
14727 @section Keyboard Layout
14728
14729 @cindex keyboard layout
14730 @cindex keymap
14731 To specify what each key of your keyboard does, you need to tell the operating
14732 system what @dfn{keyboard layout} you want to use. The default, when nothing
14733 is specified, is the US English QWERTY layout for 105-key PC keyboards.
14734 However, German speakers will usually prefer the German QWERTZ layout, French
14735 speakers will want the AZERTY layout, and so on; hackers might prefer Dvorak
14736 or bépo, and they might even want to further customize the effect of some of
14737 the keys. This section explains how to get that done.
14738
14739 @cindex keyboard layout, definition
14740 There are three components that will want to know about your keyboard layout:
14741
14742 @itemize
14743 @item
14744 The @emph{bootloader} may want to know what keyboard layout you want to use
14745 (@pxref{Bootloader Configuration, @code{keyboard-layout}}). This is useful if
14746 you want, for instance, to make sure that you can type the passphrase of your
14747 encrypted root partition using the right layout.
14748
14749 @item
14750 The @emph{operating system kernel}, Linux, will need that so that the console
14751 is properly configured (@pxref{operating-system Reference,
14752 @code{keyboard-layout}}).
14753
14754 @item
14755 The @emph{graphical display server}, usually Xorg, also has its own idea of
14756 the keyboard layout (@pxref{X Window, @code{keyboard-layout}}).
14757 @end itemize
14758
14759 Guix allows you to configure all three separately but, fortunately, it allows
14760 you to share the same keyboard layout for all three components.
14761
14762 @cindex XKB, keyboard layouts
14763 Keyboard layouts are represented by records created by the
14764 @code{keyboard-layout} procedure of @code{(gnu system keyboard)}. Following
14765 the X Keyboard extension (XKB), each layout has four attributes: a name (often
14766 a language code such as ``fi'' for Finnish or ``jp'' for Japanese), an
14767 optional variant name, an optional keyboard model name, and a possibly empty
14768 list of additional options. In most cases the layout name is all you care
14769 about.
14770
14771 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} keyboard-layout @var{name} [@var{variant}] @
14772 [#:model] [#:options '()]
14773 Return a new keyboard layout with the given @var{name} and @var{variant}.
14774
14775 @var{name} must be a string such as @code{"fr"}; @var{variant} must be a
14776 string such as @code{"bepo"} or @code{"nodeadkeys"}. See the
14777 @code{xkeyboard-config} package for valid options.
14778 @end deffn
14779
14780 Here are a few examples:
14781
14782 @lisp
14783 ;; The German QWERTZ layout. Here we assume a standard
14784 ;; "pc105" keyboard model.
14785 (keyboard-layout "de")
14786
14787 ;; The bépo variant of the French layout.
14788 (keyboard-layout "fr" "bepo")
14789
14790 ;; The Catalan layout.
14791 (keyboard-layout "es" "cat")
14792
14793 ;; Arabic layout with "Alt-Shift" to switch to US layout.
14794 (keyboard-layout "ar,us" #:options '("grp:alt_shift_toggle"))
14795
14796 ;; The Latin American Spanish layout. In addition, the
14797 ;; "Caps Lock" key is used as an additional "Ctrl" key,
14798 ;; and the "Menu" key is used as a "Compose" key to enter
14799 ;; accented letters.
14800 (keyboard-layout "latam"
14801 #:options '("ctrl:nocaps" "compose:menu"))
14802
14803 ;; The Russian layout for a ThinkPad keyboard.
14804 (keyboard-layout "ru" #:model "thinkpad")
14805
14806 ;; The "US international" layout, which is the US layout plus
14807 ;; dead keys to enter accented characters. This is for an
14808 ;; Apple MacBook keyboard.
14809 (keyboard-layout "us" "intl" #:model "macbook78")
14810 @end lisp
14811
14812 See the @file{share/X11/xkb} directory of the @code{xkeyboard-config} package
14813 for a complete list of supported layouts, variants, and models.
14814
14815 @cindex keyboard layout, configuration
14816 Let's say you want your system to use the Turkish keyboard layout throughout
14817 your system---bootloader, console, and Xorg. Here's what your system
14818 configuration would look like:
14819
14820 @findex set-xorg-configuration
14821 @lisp
14822 ;; Using the Turkish layout for the bootloader, the console,
14823 ;; and for Xorg.
14824
14825 (operating-system
14826 ;; ...
14827 (keyboard-layout (keyboard-layout "tr")) ;for the console
14828 (bootloader (bootloader-configuration
14829 (bootloader grub-efi-bootloader)
14830 (targets '("/boot/efi"))
14831 (keyboard-layout keyboard-layout))) ;for GRUB
14832 (services (cons (set-xorg-configuration
14833 (xorg-configuration ;for Xorg
14834 (keyboard-layout keyboard-layout)))
14835 %desktop-services)))
14836 @end lisp
14837
14838 In the example above, for GRUB and for Xorg, we just refer to the
14839 @code{keyboard-layout} field defined above, but we could just as well refer to
14840 a different layout. The @code{set-xorg-configuration} procedure communicates
14841 the desired Xorg configuration to the graphical log-in manager, by default
14842 GDM.
14843
14844 We've discussed how to specify the @emph{default} keyboard layout of your
14845 system when it starts, but you can also adjust it at run time:
14846
14847 @itemize
14848 @item
14849 If you're using GNOME, its settings panel has a ``Region & Language'' entry
14850 where you can select one or more keyboard layouts.
14851
14852 @item
14853 Under Xorg, the @command{setxkbmap} command (from the same-named package)
14854 allows you to change the current layout. For example, this is how you would
14855 change the layout to US Dvorak:
14856
14857 @example
14858 setxkbmap us dvorak
14859 @end example
14860
14861 @item
14862 The @code{loadkeys} command changes the keyboard layout in effect in the Linux
14863 console. However, note that @code{loadkeys} does @emph{not} use the XKB
14864 keyboard layout categorization described above. The command below loads the
14865 French bépo layout:
14866
14867 @example
14868 loadkeys fr-bepo
14869 @end example
14870 @end itemize
14871
14872 @node Locales
14873 @section Locales
14874
14875 @cindex locale
14876 A @dfn{locale} defines cultural conventions for a particular language
14877 and region of the world (@pxref{Locales,,, libc, The GNU C Library
14878 Reference Manual}). Each locale has a name that typically has the form
14879 @code{@var{language}_@var{territory}.@var{codeset}}---e.g.,
14880 @code{fr_LU.utf8} designates the locale for the French language, with
14881 cultural conventions from Luxembourg, and using the UTF-8 encoding.
14882
14883 @cindex locale definition
14884 Usually, you will want to specify the default locale for the machine
14885 using the @code{locale} field of the @code{operating-system} declaration
14886 (@pxref{operating-system Reference, @code{locale}}).
14887
14888 The selected locale is automatically added to the @dfn{locale
14889 definitions} known to the system if needed, with its codeset inferred
14890 from its name---e.g., @code{bo_CN.utf8} will be assumed to use the
14891 @code{UTF-8} codeset. Additional locale definitions can be specified in
14892 the @code{locale-definitions} slot of @code{operating-system}---this is
14893 useful, for instance, if the codeset could not be inferred from the
14894 locale name. The default set of locale definitions includes some widely
14895 used locales, but not all the available locales, in order to save space.
14896
14897 For instance, to add the North Frisian locale for Germany, the value of
14898 that field may be:
14899
14900 @lisp
14901 (cons (locale-definition
14902 (name "fy_DE.utf8") (source "fy_DE"))
14903 %default-locale-definitions)
14904 @end lisp
14905
14906 Likewise, to save space, one might want @code{locale-definitions} to
14907 list only the locales that are actually used, as in:
14908
14909 @lisp
14910 (list (locale-definition
14911 (name "ja_JP.eucjp") (source "ja_JP")
14912 (charset "EUC-JP")))
14913 @end lisp
14914
14915 @vindex LOCPATH
14916 The compiled locale definitions are available at
14917 @file{/run/current-system/locale/X.Y}, where @code{X.Y} is the libc
14918 version, which is the default location where the GNU@tie{}libc provided
14919 by Guix looks for locale data. This can be overridden using the
14920 @env{LOCPATH} environment variable (@pxref{locales-and-locpath,
14921 @env{LOCPATH} and locale packages}).
14922
14923 The @code{locale-definition} form is provided by the @code{(gnu system
14924 locale)} module. Details are given below.
14925
14926 @deftp {Data Type} locale-definition
14927 This is the data type of a locale definition.
14928
14929 @table @asis
14930
14931 @item @code{name}
14932 The name of the locale. @xref{Locale Names,,, libc, The GNU C Library
14933 Reference Manual}, for more information on locale names.
14934
14935 @item @code{source}
14936 The name of the source for that locale. This is typically the
14937 @code{@var{language}_@var{territory}} part of the locale name.
14938
14939 @item @code{charset} (default: @code{"UTF-8"})
14940 The ``character set'' or ``code set'' for that locale,
14941 @uref{https://www.iana.org/assignments/character-sets, as defined by
14942 IANA}.
14943
14944 @end table
14945 @end deftp
14946
14947 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %default-locale-definitions
14948 A list of commonly used UTF-8 locales, used as the default
14949 value of the @code{locale-definitions} field of @code{operating-system}
14950 declarations.
14951
14952 @cindex locale name
14953 @cindex normalized codeset in locale names
14954 These locale definitions use the @dfn{normalized codeset} for the part
14955 that follows the dot in the name (@pxref{Using gettextized software,
14956 normalized codeset,, libc, The GNU C Library Reference Manual}). So for
14957 instance it has @code{uk_UA.utf8} but @emph{not}, say,
14958 @code{uk_UA.UTF-8}.
14959 @end defvr
14960
14961 @subsection Locale Data Compatibility Considerations
14962
14963 @cindex incompatibility, of locale data
14964 @code{operating-system} declarations provide a @code{locale-libcs} field
14965 to specify the GNU@tie{}libc packages that are used to compile locale
14966 declarations (@pxref{operating-system Reference}). ``Why would I
14967 care?'', you may ask. Well, it turns out that the binary format of
14968 locale data is occasionally incompatible from one libc version to
14969 another.
14970
14971 @c See <https://sourceware.org/ml/libc-alpha/2015-09/msg00575.html>
14972 @c and <https://lists.gnu.org/archive/html/guix-devel/2015-08/msg00737.html>.
14973 For instance, a program linked against libc version 2.21 is unable to
14974 read locale data produced with libc 2.22; worse, that program
14975 @emph{aborts} instead of simply ignoring the incompatible locale
14976 data@footnote{Versions 2.23 and later of GNU@tie{}libc will simply skip
14977 the incompatible locale data, which is already an improvement.}.
14978 Similarly, a program linked against libc 2.22 can read most, but not
14979 all, of the locale data from libc 2.21 (specifically, @env{LC_COLLATE}
14980 data is incompatible); thus calls to @code{setlocale} may fail, but
14981 programs will not abort.
14982
14983 The ``problem'' with Guix is that users have a lot of freedom: They can
14984 choose whether and when to upgrade software in their profiles, and might
14985 be using a libc version different from the one the system administrator
14986 used to build the system-wide locale data.
14987
14988 Fortunately, unprivileged users can also install their own locale data
14989 and define @env{GUIX_LOCPATH} accordingly (@pxref{locales-and-locpath,
14990 @env{GUIX_LOCPATH} and locale packages}).
14991
14992 Still, it is best if the system-wide locale data at
14993 @file{/run/current-system/locale} is built for all the libc versions
14994 actually in use on the system, so that all the programs can access
14995 it---this is especially crucial on a multi-user system. To do that, the
14996 administrator can specify several libc packages in the
14997 @code{locale-libcs} field of @code{operating-system}:
14998
14999 @lisp
15000 (use-package-modules base)
15001
15002 (operating-system
15003 ;; @dots{}
15004 (locale-libcs (list glibc-2.21 (canonical-package glibc))))
15005 @end lisp
15006
15007 This example would lead to a system containing locale definitions for
15008 both libc 2.21 and the current version of libc in
15009 @file{/run/current-system/locale}.
15010
15011
15012 @node Services
15013 @section Services
15014
15015 @cindex system services
15016 An important part of preparing an @code{operating-system} declaration is
15017 listing @dfn{system services} and their configuration (@pxref{Using the
15018 Configuration System}). System services are typically daemons launched
15019 when the system boots, or other actions needed at that time---e.g.,
15020 configuring network access.
15021
15022 Guix has a broad definition of ``service'' (@pxref{Service
15023 Composition}), but many services are managed by the GNU@tie{}Shepherd
15024 (@pxref{Shepherd Services}). On a running system, the @command{herd}
15025 command allows you to list the available services, show their status,
15026 start and stop them, or do other specific operations (@pxref{Jump
15027 Start,,, shepherd, The GNU Shepherd Manual}). For example:
15028
15029 @example
15030 # herd status
15031 @end example
15032
15033 The above command, run as @code{root}, lists the currently defined
15034 services. The @command{herd doc} command shows a synopsis of the given
15035 service and its associated actions:
15036
15037 @example
15038 # herd doc nscd
15039 Run libc's name service cache daemon (nscd).
15040
15041 # herd doc nscd action invalidate
15042 invalidate: Invalidate the given cache--e.g., 'hosts' for host name lookups.
15043 @end example
15044
15045 The @command{start}, @command{stop}, and @command{restart} sub-commands
15046 have the effect you would expect. For instance, the commands below stop
15047 the nscd service and restart the Xorg display server:
15048
15049 @example
15050 # herd stop nscd
15051 Service nscd has been stopped.
15052 # herd restart xorg-server
15053 Service xorg-server has been stopped.
15054 Service xorg-server has been started.
15055 @end example
15056
15057 The following sections document the available services, starting with
15058 the core services, that may be used in an @code{operating-system}
15059 declaration.
15060
15061 @menu
15062 * Base Services:: Essential system services.
15063 * Scheduled Job Execution:: The mcron service.
15064 * Log Rotation:: The rottlog service.
15065 * Networking Services:: Network setup, SSH daemon, etc.
15066 * Unattended Upgrades:: Automated system upgrades.
15067 * X Window:: Graphical display.
15068 * Printing Services:: Local and remote printer support.
15069 * Desktop Services:: D-Bus and desktop services.
15070 * Sound Services:: ALSA and Pulseaudio services.
15071 * Database Services:: SQL databases, key-value stores, etc.
15072 * Mail Services:: IMAP, POP3, SMTP, and all that.
15073 * Messaging Services:: Messaging services.
15074 * Telephony Services:: Telephony services.
15075 * File-Sharing Services:: File-sharing services.
15076 * Monitoring Services:: Monitoring services.
15077 * Kerberos Services:: Kerberos services.
15078 * LDAP Services:: LDAP services.
15079 * Web Services:: Web servers.
15080 * Certificate Services:: TLS certificates via Let's Encrypt.
15081 * DNS Services:: DNS daemons.
15082 * VPN Services:: VPN daemons.
15083 * Network File System:: NFS related services.
15084 * Continuous Integration:: Cuirass and Laminar services.
15085 * Power Management Services:: Extending battery life.
15086 * Audio Services:: The MPD.
15087 * Virtualization Services:: Virtualization services.
15088 * Version Control Services:: Providing remote access to Git repositories.
15089 * Game Services:: Game servers.
15090 * PAM Mount Service:: Service to mount volumes when logging in.
15091 * Guix Services:: Services relating specifically to Guix.
15092 * Linux Services:: Services tied to the Linux kernel.
15093 * Hurd Services:: Services specific for a Hurd System.
15094 * Miscellaneous Services:: Other services.
15095 @end menu
15096
15097 @node Base Services
15098 @subsection Base Services
15099
15100 The @code{(gnu services base)} module provides definitions for the basic
15101 services that one expects from the system. The services exported by
15102 this module are listed below.
15103
15104 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %base-services
15105 This variable contains a list of basic services (@pxref{Service Types
15106 and Services}, for more information on service objects) one would
15107 expect from the system: a login service (mingetty) on each tty, syslogd,
15108 the libc name service cache daemon (nscd), the udev device manager, and
15109 more.
15110
15111 This is the default value of the @code{services} field of
15112 @code{operating-system} declarations. Usually, when customizing a
15113 system, you will want to append services to @code{%base-services}, like
15114 this:
15115
15116 @lisp
15117 (append (list (service avahi-service-type)
15118 (service openssh-service-type))
15119 %base-services)
15120 @end lisp
15121 @end defvr
15122
15123 @defvr {Scheme Variable} special-files-service-type
15124 This is the service that sets up ``special files'' such as
15125 @file{/bin/sh}; an instance of it is part of @code{%base-services}.
15126
15127 The value associated with @code{special-files-service-type} services
15128 must be a list of tuples where the first element is the ``special file''
15129 and the second element is its target. By default it is:
15130
15131 @cindex @file{/bin/sh}
15132 @cindex @file{sh}, in @file{/bin}
15133 @lisp
15134 `(("/bin/sh" ,(file-append bash "/bin/sh")))
15135 @end lisp
15136
15137 @cindex @file{/usr/bin/env}
15138 @cindex @file{env}, in @file{/usr/bin}
15139 If you want to add, say, @code{/usr/bin/env} to your system, you can
15140 change it to:
15141
15142 @lisp
15143 `(("/bin/sh" ,(file-append bash "/bin/sh"))
15144 ("/usr/bin/env" ,(file-append coreutils "/bin/env")))
15145 @end lisp
15146
15147 Since this is part of @code{%base-services}, you can use
15148 @code{modify-services} to customize the set of special files
15149 (@pxref{Service Reference, @code{modify-services}}). But the simple way
15150 to add a special file is @i{via} the @code{extra-special-file} procedure
15151 (see below).
15152 @end defvr
15153
15154 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} extra-special-file @var{file} @var{target}
15155 Use @var{target} as the ``special file'' @var{file}.
15156
15157 For example, adding the following lines to the @code{services} field of
15158 your operating system declaration leads to a @file{/usr/bin/env}
15159 symlink:
15160
15161 @lisp
15162 (extra-special-file "/usr/bin/env"
15163 (file-append coreutils "/bin/env"))
15164 @end lisp
15165 @end deffn
15166
15167 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} host-name-service @var{name}
15168 Return a service that sets the host name to @var{name}.
15169 @end deffn
15170
15171 @defvr {Scheme Variable} console-font-service-type
15172 Install the given fonts on the specified ttys (fonts are per
15173 virtual console on the kernel Linux). The value of this service is a list of
15174 tty/font pairs. The font can be the name of a font provided by the @code{kbd}
15175 package or any valid argument to @command{setfont}, as in this example:
15176
15177 @lisp
15178 `(("tty1" . "LatGrkCyr-8x16")
15179 ("tty2" . ,(file-append
15180 font-tamzen
15181 "/share/kbd/consolefonts/TamzenForPowerline10x20.psf"))
15182 ("tty3" . ,(file-append
15183 font-terminus
15184 "/share/consolefonts/ter-132n"))) ; for HDPI
15185 @end lisp
15186 @end defvr
15187
15188 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} login-service @var{config}
15189 Return a service to run login according to @var{config}, a
15190 @code{<login-configuration>} object, which specifies the message of the day,
15191 among other things.
15192 @end deffn
15193
15194 @deftp {Data Type} login-configuration
15195 This is the data type representing the configuration of login.
15196
15197 @table @asis
15198
15199 @item @code{motd}
15200 @cindex message of the day
15201 A file-like object containing the ``message of the day''.
15202
15203 @item @code{allow-empty-passwords?} (default: @code{#t})
15204 Allow empty passwords by default so that first-time users can log in when
15205 the 'root' account has just been created.
15206
15207 @end table
15208 @end deftp
15209
15210 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} mingetty-service @var{config}
15211 Return a service to run mingetty according to @var{config}, a
15212 @code{<mingetty-configuration>} object, which specifies the tty to run, among
15213 other things.
15214 @end deffn
15215
15216 @deftp {Data Type} mingetty-configuration
15217 This is the data type representing the configuration of Mingetty, which
15218 provides the default implementation of virtual console log-in.
15219
15220 @table @asis
15221
15222 @item @code{tty}
15223 The name of the console this Mingetty runs on---e.g., @code{"tty1"}.
15224
15225 @item @code{auto-login} (default: @code{#f})
15226 When true, this field must be a string denoting the user name under
15227 which the system automatically logs in. When it is @code{#f}, a
15228 user name and password must be entered to log in.
15229
15230 @item @code{login-program} (default: @code{#f})
15231 This must be either @code{#f}, in which case the default log-in program
15232 is used (@command{login} from the Shadow tool suite), or a gexp denoting
15233 the name of the log-in program.
15234
15235 @item @code{login-pause?} (default: @code{#f})
15236 When set to @code{#t} in conjunction with @var{auto-login}, the user
15237 will have to press a key before the log-in shell is launched.
15238
15239 @item @code{clear-on-logout?} (default: @code{#t})
15240 When set to @code{#t}, the screen will be cleared after logout.
15241
15242 @item @code{mingetty} (default: @var{mingetty})
15243 The Mingetty package to use.
15244
15245 @end table
15246 @end deftp
15247
15248 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} agetty-service @var{config}
15249 Return a service to run agetty according to @var{config}, an
15250 @code{<agetty-configuration>} object, which specifies the tty to run,
15251 among other things.
15252 @end deffn
15253
15254 @deftp {Data Type} agetty-configuration
15255 This is the data type representing the configuration of agetty, which
15256 implements virtual and serial console log-in. See the @code{agetty(8)}
15257 man page for more information.
15258
15259 @table @asis
15260
15261 @item @code{tty}
15262 The name of the console this agetty runs on, as a string---e.g.,
15263 @code{"ttyS0"}. This argument is optional, it will default to
15264 a reasonable default serial port used by the kernel Linux.
15265
15266 For this, if there is a value for an option @code{agetty.tty} in the kernel
15267 command line, agetty will extract the device name of the serial port
15268 from it and use that.
15269
15270 If not and if there is a value for an option @code{console} with a tty in
15271 the Linux command line, agetty will extract the device name of the
15272 serial port from it and use that.
15273
15274 In both cases, agetty will leave the other serial device settings
15275 (baud rate etc.)@: alone---in the hope that Linux pinned them to the
15276 correct values.
15277
15278 @item @code{baud-rate} (default: @code{#f})
15279 A string containing a comma-separated list of one or more baud rates, in
15280 descending order.
15281
15282 @item @code{term} (default: @code{#f})
15283 A string containing the value used for the @env{TERM} environment
15284 variable.
15285
15286 @item @code{eight-bits?} (default: @code{#f})
15287 When @code{#t}, the tty is assumed to be 8-bit clean, and parity detection is
15288 disabled.
15289
15290 @item @code{auto-login} (default: @code{#f})
15291 When passed a login name, as a string, the specified user will be logged
15292 in automatically without prompting for their login name or password.
15293
15294 @item @code{no-reset?} (default: @code{#f})
15295 When @code{#t}, don't reset terminal cflags (control modes).
15296
15297 @item @code{host} (default: @code{#f})
15298 This accepts a string containing the ``login_host'', which will be written
15299 into the @file{/var/run/utmpx} file.
15300
15301 @item @code{remote?} (default: @code{#f})
15302 When set to @code{#t} in conjunction with @var{host}, this will add an
15303 @code{-r} fakehost option to the command line of the login program
15304 specified in @var{login-program}.
15305
15306 @item @code{flow-control?} (default: @code{#f})
15307 When set to @code{#t}, enable hardware (RTS/CTS) flow control.
15308
15309 @item @code{no-issue?} (default: @code{#f})
15310 When set to @code{#t}, the contents of the @file{/etc/issue} file will
15311 not be displayed before presenting the login prompt.
15312
15313 @item @code{init-string} (default: @code{#f})
15314 This accepts a string that will be sent to the tty or modem before
15315 sending anything else. It can be used to initialize a modem.
15316
15317 @item @code{no-clear?} (default: @code{#f})
15318 When set to @code{#t}, agetty will not clear the screen before showing
15319 the login prompt.
15320
15321 @item @code{login-program} (default: (file-append shadow "/bin/login"))
15322 This must be either a gexp denoting the name of a log-in program, or
15323 unset, in which case the default value is the @command{login} from the
15324 Shadow tool suite.
15325
15326 @item @code{local-line} (default: @code{#f})
15327 Control the CLOCAL line flag. This accepts one of three symbols as
15328 arguments, @code{'auto}, @code{'always}, or @code{'never}. If @code{#f},
15329 the default value chosen by agetty is @code{'auto}.
15330
15331 @item @code{extract-baud?} (default: @code{#f})
15332 When set to @code{#t}, instruct agetty to try to extract the baud rate
15333 from the status messages produced by certain types of modems.
15334
15335 @item @code{skip-login?} (default: @code{#f})
15336 When set to @code{#t}, do not prompt the user for a login name. This
15337 can be used with @var{login-program} field to use non-standard login
15338 systems.
15339
15340 @item @code{no-newline?} (default: @code{#f})
15341 When set to @code{#t}, do not print a newline before printing the
15342 @file{/etc/issue} file.
15343
15344 @c Is this dangerous only when used with login-program, or always?
15345 @item @code{login-options} (default: @code{#f})
15346 This option accepts a string containing options that are passed to the
15347 login program. When used with the @var{login-program}, be aware that a
15348 malicious user could try to enter a login name containing embedded
15349 options that could be parsed by the login program.
15350
15351 @item @code{login-pause} (default: @code{#f})
15352 When set to @code{#t}, wait for any key before showing the login prompt.
15353 This can be used in conjunction with @var{auto-login} to save memory by
15354 lazily spawning shells.
15355
15356 @item @code{chroot} (default: @code{#f})
15357 Change root to the specified directory. This option accepts a directory
15358 path as a string.
15359
15360 @item @code{hangup?} (default: @code{#f})
15361 Use the Linux system call @code{vhangup} to do a virtual hangup of the
15362 specified terminal.
15363
15364 @item @code{keep-baud?} (default: @code{#f})
15365 When set to @code{#t}, try to keep the existing baud rate. The baud
15366 rates from @var{baud-rate} are used when agetty receives a @key{BREAK}
15367 character.
15368
15369 @item @code{timeout} (default: @code{#f})
15370 When set to an integer value, terminate if no user name could be read
15371 within @var{timeout} seconds.
15372
15373 @item @code{detect-case?} (default: @code{#f})
15374 When set to @code{#t}, turn on support for detecting an uppercase-only
15375 terminal. This setting will detect a login name containing only
15376 uppercase letters as indicating an uppercase-only terminal and turn on
15377 some upper-to-lower case conversions. Note that this will not support
15378 Unicode characters.
15379
15380 @item @code{wait-cr?} (default: @code{#f})
15381 When set to @code{#t}, wait for the user or modem to send a
15382 carriage-return or linefeed character before displaying
15383 @file{/etc/issue} or login prompt. This is typically used with the
15384 @var{init-string} option.
15385
15386 @item @code{no-hints?} (default: @code{#f})
15387 When set to @code{#t}, do not print hints about Num, Caps, and Scroll
15388 locks.
15389
15390 @item @code{no-hostname?} (default: @code{#f})
15391 By default, the hostname is printed. When this option is set to
15392 @code{#t}, no hostname will be shown at all.
15393
15394 @item @code{long-hostname?} (default: @code{#f})
15395 By default, the hostname is only printed until the first dot. When this
15396 option is set to @code{#t}, the fully qualified hostname by
15397 @code{gethostname} or @code{getaddrinfo} is shown.
15398
15399 @item @code{erase-characters} (default: @code{#f})
15400 This option accepts a string of additional characters that should be
15401 interpreted as backspace when the user types their login name.
15402
15403 @item @code{kill-characters} (default: @code{#f})
15404 This option accepts a string that should be interpreted to mean ``ignore
15405 all previous characters'' (also called a ``kill'' character) when the user
15406 types their login name.
15407
15408 @item @code{chdir} (default: @code{#f})
15409 This option accepts, as a string, a directory path that will be changed
15410 to before login.
15411
15412 @item @code{delay} (default: @code{#f})
15413 This options accepts, as an integer, the number of seconds to sleep
15414 before opening the tty and displaying the login prompt.
15415
15416 @item @code{nice} (default: @code{#f})
15417 This option accepts, as an integer, the nice value with which to run the
15418 @command{login} program.
15419
15420 @item @code{extra-options} (default: @code{'()})
15421 This option provides an ``escape hatch'' for the user to provide arbitrary
15422 command-line arguments to @command{agetty} as a list of strings.
15423
15424 @end table
15425 @end deftp
15426
15427 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} kmscon-service-type @var{config}
15428 Return a service to run @uref{https://www.freedesktop.org/wiki/Software/kmscon,kmscon}
15429 according to @var{config}, a @code{<kmscon-configuration>} object, which
15430 specifies the tty to run, among other things.
15431 @end deffn
15432
15433 @deftp {Data Type} kmscon-configuration
15434 This is the data type representing the configuration of Kmscon, which
15435 implements virtual console log-in.
15436
15437 @table @asis
15438
15439 @item @code{virtual-terminal}
15440 The name of the console this Kmscon runs on---e.g., @code{"tty1"}.
15441
15442 @item @code{login-program} (default: @code{#~(string-append #$shadow "/bin/login")})
15443 A gexp denoting the name of the log-in program. The default log-in program is
15444 @command{login} from the Shadow tool suite.
15445
15446 @item @code{login-arguments} (default: @code{'("-p")})
15447 A list of arguments to pass to @command{login}.
15448
15449 @item @code{auto-login} (default: @code{#f})
15450 When passed a login name, as a string, the specified user will be logged
15451 in automatically without prompting for their login name or password.
15452
15453 @item @code{hardware-acceleration?} (default: #f)
15454 Whether to use hardware acceleration.
15455
15456 @item @code{font-engine} (default: @code{"pango"})
15457 Font engine used in Kmscon.
15458
15459 @item @code{font-size} (default: @code{12})
15460 Font size used in Kmscon.
15461
15462 @item @code{keyboard-layout} (default: @code{#f})
15463 If this is @code{#f}, Kmscon uses the default keyboard layout---usually US
15464 English (``qwerty'') for a 105-key PC keyboard.
15465
15466 Otherwise this must be a @code{keyboard-layout} object specifying the
15467 keyboard layout. @xref{Keyboard Layout}, for more information on how to
15468 specify the keyboard layout.
15469
15470 @item @code{kmscon} (default: @var{kmscon})
15471 The Kmscon package to use.
15472
15473 @end table
15474 @end deftp
15475
15476 @cindex name service cache daemon
15477 @cindex nscd
15478 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} nscd-service [@var{config}] [#:glibc glibc] @
15479 [#:name-services '()]
15480 Return a service that runs the libc name service cache daemon (nscd) with the
15481 given @var{config}---an @code{<nscd-configuration>} object. @xref{Name
15482 Service Switch}, for an example.
15483
15484 For convenience, the Shepherd service for nscd provides the following actions:
15485
15486 @table @code
15487 @item invalidate
15488 @cindex cache invalidation, nscd
15489 @cindex nscd, cache invalidation
15490 This invalidate the given cache. For instance, running:
15491
15492 @example
15493 herd invalidate nscd hosts
15494 @end example
15495
15496 @noindent
15497 invalidates the host name lookup cache of nscd.
15498
15499 @item statistics
15500 Running @command{herd statistics nscd} displays information about nscd usage
15501 and caches.
15502 @end table
15503
15504 @end deffn
15505
15506 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %nscd-default-configuration
15507 This is the default @code{<nscd-configuration>} value (see below) used
15508 by @code{nscd-service}. It uses the caches defined by
15509 @code{%nscd-default-caches}; see below.
15510 @end defvr
15511
15512 @deftp {Data Type} nscd-configuration
15513 This is the data type representing the name service cache daemon (nscd)
15514 configuration.
15515
15516 @table @asis
15517
15518 @item @code{name-services} (default: @code{'()})
15519 List of packages denoting @dfn{name services} that must be visible to
15520 the nscd---e.g., @code{(list @var{nss-mdns})}.
15521
15522 @item @code{glibc} (default: @var{glibc})
15523 Package object denoting the GNU C Library providing the @command{nscd}
15524 command.
15525
15526 @item @code{log-file} (default: @code{"/var/log/nscd.log"})
15527 Name of the nscd log file. This is where debugging output goes when
15528 @code{debug-level} is strictly positive.
15529
15530 @item @code{debug-level} (default: @code{0})
15531 Integer denoting the debugging levels. Higher numbers mean that more
15532 debugging output is logged.
15533
15534 @item @code{caches} (default: @code{%nscd-default-caches})
15535 List of @code{<nscd-cache>} objects denoting things to be cached; see
15536 below.
15537
15538 @end table
15539 @end deftp
15540
15541 @deftp {Data Type} nscd-cache
15542 Data type representing a cache database of nscd and its parameters.
15543
15544 @table @asis
15545
15546 @item @code{database}
15547 This is a symbol representing the name of the database to be cached.
15548 Valid values are @code{passwd}, @code{group}, @code{hosts}, and
15549 @code{services}, which designate the corresponding NSS database
15550 (@pxref{NSS Basics,,, libc, The GNU C Library Reference Manual}).
15551
15552 @item @code{positive-time-to-live}
15553 @itemx @code{negative-time-to-live} (default: @code{20})
15554 A number representing the number of seconds during which a positive or
15555 negative lookup result remains in cache.
15556
15557 @item @code{check-files?} (default: @code{#t})
15558 Whether to check for updates of the files corresponding to
15559 @var{database}.
15560
15561 For instance, when @var{database} is @code{hosts}, setting this flag
15562 instructs nscd to check for updates in @file{/etc/hosts} and to take
15563 them into account.
15564
15565 @item @code{persistent?} (default: @code{#t})
15566 Whether the cache should be stored persistently on disk.
15567
15568 @item @code{shared?} (default: @code{#t})
15569 Whether the cache should be shared among users.
15570
15571 @item @code{max-database-size} (default: 32@tie{}MiB)
15572 Maximum size in bytes of the database cache.
15573
15574 @c XXX: 'suggested-size' and 'auto-propagate?' seem to be expert
15575 @c settings, so leave them out.
15576
15577 @end table
15578 @end deftp
15579
15580 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %nscd-default-caches
15581 List of @code{<nscd-cache>} objects used by default by
15582 @code{nscd-configuration} (see above).
15583
15584 It enables persistent and aggressive caching of service and host name
15585 lookups. The latter provides better host name lookup performance,
15586 resilience in the face of unreliable name servers, and also better
15587 privacy---often the result of host name lookups is in local cache, so
15588 external name servers do not even need to be queried.
15589 @end defvr
15590
15591 @anchor{syslog-configuration-type}
15592 @cindex syslog
15593 @cindex logging
15594 @deftp {Data Type} syslog-configuration
15595 This data type represents the configuration of the syslog daemon.
15596
15597 @table @asis
15598 @item @code{syslogd} (default: @code{#~(string-append #$inetutils "/libexec/syslogd")})
15599 The syslog daemon to use.
15600
15601 @item @code{config-file} (default: @code{%default-syslog.conf})
15602 The syslog configuration file to use.
15603
15604 @end table
15605 @end deftp
15606
15607 @anchor{syslog-service}
15608 @cindex syslog
15609 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} syslog-service @var{config}
15610 Return a service that runs a syslog daemon according to @var{config}.
15611
15612 @xref{syslogd invocation,,, inetutils, GNU Inetutils}, for more
15613 information on the configuration file syntax.
15614 @end deffn
15615
15616 @defvr {Scheme Variable} guix-service-type
15617 This is the type of the service that runs the build daemon,
15618 @command{guix-daemon} (@pxref{Invoking guix-daemon}). Its value must be a
15619 @code{guix-configuration} record as described below.
15620 @end defvr
15621
15622 @anchor{guix-configuration-type}
15623 @deftp {Data Type} guix-configuration
15624 This data type represents the configuration of the Guix build daemon.
15625 @xref{Invoking guix-daemon}, for more information.
15626
15627 @table @asis
15628 @item @code{guix} (default: @var{guix})
15629 The Guix package to use.
15630
15631 @item @code{build-group} (default: @code{"guixbuild"})
15632 Name of the group for build user accounts.
15633
15634 @item @code{build-accounts} (default: @code{10})
15635 Number of build user accounts to create.
15636
15637 @item @code{authorize-key?} (default: @code{#t})
15638 @cindex substitutes, authorization thereof
15639 Whether to authorize the substitute keys listed in
15640 @code{authorized-keys}---by default that of
15641 @code{@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER-1}} and
15642 @code{@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER-2}}
15643 (@pxref{Substitutes}).
15644
15645 When @code{authorize-key?} is true, @file{/etc/guix/acl} cannot be
15646 changed by invoking @command{guix archive --authorize}. You must
15647 instead adjust @code{guix-configuration} as you wish and reconfigure the
15648 system. This ensures that your operating system configuration file is
15649 self-contained.
15650
15651 @quotation Note
15652 When booting or reconfiguring to a system where @code{authorize-key?}
15653 is true, the existing @file{/etc/guix/acl} file is backed up as
15654 @file{/etc/guix/acl.bak} if it was determined to be a manually modified
15655 file. This is to facilitate migration from earlier versions, which
15656 allowed for in-place modifications to @file{/etc/guix/acl}.
15657 @end quotation
15658
15659 @vindex %default-authorized-guix-keys
15660 @item @code{authorized-keys} (default: @code{%default-authorized-guix-keys})
15661 The list of authorized key files for archive imports, as a list of
15662 string-valued gexps (@pxref{Invoking guix archive}). By default, it
15663 contains that of @code{@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER-1}} and
15664 @code{@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER-2}} (@pxref{Substitutes}). See
15665 @code{substitute-urls} below for an example on how to change it.
15666
15667 @item @code{use-substitutes?} (default: @code{#t})
15668 Whether to use substitutes.
15669
15670 @item @code{substitute-urls} (default: @code{%default-substitute-urls})
15671 The list of URLs where to look for substitutes by default.
15672
15673 Suppose you would like to fetch substitutes from @code{guix.example.org}
15674 in addition to @code{@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER-1}}. You will need to do
15675 two things: (1) add @code{guix.example.org} to @code{substitute-urls},
15676 and (2) authorize its signing key, having done appropriate checks
15677 (@pxref{Substitute Server Authorization}). The configuration below does
15678 exactly that:
15679
15680 @lisp
15681 (guix-configuration
15682 (substitute-urls
15683 (append (list "https://guix.example.org")
15684 %default-substitute-urls))
15685 (authorized-keys
15686 (append (list (local-file "./guix.example.org-key.pub"))
15687 %default-authorized-guix-keys)))
15688 @end lisp
15689
15690 This example assumes that the file @file{./guix.example.org-key.pub}
15691 contains the public key that @code{guix.example.org} uses to sign
15692 substitutes.
15693
15694 @item @code{max-silent-time} (default: @code{0})
15695 @itemx @code{timeout} (default: @code{0})
15696 The number of seconds of silence and the number of seconds of activity,
15697 respectively, after which a build process times out. A value of zero
15698 disables the timeout.
15699
15700 @item @code{log-compression} (default: @code{'bzip2})
15701 The type of compression used for build logs---one of @code{gzip},
15702 @code{bzip2}, or @code{none}.
15703
15704 @item @code{discover?} (default: @code{#f})
15705 Whether to discover substitute servers on the local network using mDNS
15706 and DNS-SD.
15707
15708 @item @code{extra-options} (default: @code{'()})
15709 List of extra command-line options for @command{guix-daemon}.
15710
15711 @item @code{log-file} (default: @code{"/var/log/guix-daemon.log"})
15712 File where @command{guix-daemon}'s standard output and standard error
15713 are written.
15714
15715 @cindex HTTP proxy, for @code{guix-daemon}
15716 @cindex proxy, for @code{guix-daemon} HTTP access
15717 @item @code{http-proxy} (default: @code{#f})
15718 The URL of the HTTP and HTTPS proxy used for downloading fixed-output
15719 derivations and substitutes.
15720
15721 It is also possible to change the daemon's proxy at run time through the
15722 @code{set-http-proxy} action, which restarts it:
15723
15724 @example
15725 herd set-http-proxy guix-daemon http://localhost:8118
15726 @end example
15727
15728 To clear the proxy settings, run:
15729
15730 @example
15731 herd set-http-proxy guix-daemon
15732 @end example
15733
15734 @item @code{tmpdir} (default: @code{#f})
15735 A directory path where the @command{guix-daemon} will perform builds.
15736
15737 @end table
15738 @end deftp
15739
15740 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} udev-service [#:udev @var{eudev} #:rules @code{'()}]
15741 Run @var{udev}, which populates the @file{/dev} directory dynamically.
15742 udev rules can be provided as a list of files through the @var{rules}
15743 variable. The procedures @code{udev-rule}, @code{udev-rules-service}
15744 and @code{file->udev-rule} from @code{(gnu services base)} simplify the
15745 creation of such rule files.
15746
15747 The @command{herd rules udev} command, as root, returns the name of the
15748 directory containing all the active udev rules.
15749 @end deffn
15750
15751 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} udev-rule [@var{file-name} @var{contents}]
15752 Return a udev-rule file named @var{file-name} containing the rules
15753 defined by the @var{contents} literal.
15754
15755 In the following example, a rule for a USB device is defined to be
15756 stored in the file @file{90-usb-thing.rules}. The rule runs a script
15757 upon detecting a USB device with a given product identifier.
15758
15759 @lisp
15760 (define %example-udev-rule
15761 (udev-rule
15762 "90-usb-thing.rules"
15763 (string-append "ACTION==\"add\", SUBSYSTEM==\"usb\", "
15764 "ATTR@{product@}==\"Example\", "
15765 "RUN+=\"/path/to/script\"")))
15766 @end lisp
15767 @end deffn
15768
15769 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} udev-rules-service [@var{name} @var{rules}] @
15770 [#:groups @var{groups}]
15771 Return a service that extends @code{udev-service-type } with @var{rules}
15772 and @code{account-service-type} with @var{groups} as system groups.
15773 This works by creating a singleton service type
15774 @code{@var{name}-udev-rules}, of which the returned service is an
15775 instance.
15776
15777 Here we show how it can be used to extend @code{udev-service-type} with the
15778 previously defined rule @code{%example-udev-rule}.
15779
15780 @lisp
15781 (operating-system
15782 ;; @dots{}
15783 (services
15784 (cons (udev-rules-service 'usb-thing %example-udev-rule)
15785 %desktop-services)))
15786 @end lisp
15787 @end deffn
15788
15789 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} file->udev-rule [@var{file-name} @var{file}]
15790 Return a udev file named @var{file-name} containing the rules defined
15791 within @var{file}, a file-like object.
15792
15793 The following example showcases how we can use an existing rule file.
15794
15795 @lisp
15796 (use-modules (guix download) ;for url-fetch
15797 (guix packages) ;for origin
15798 @dots{})
15799
15800 (define %android-udev-rules
15801 (file->udev-rule
15802 "51-android-udev.rules"
15803 (let ((version "20170910"))
15804 (origin
15805 (method url-fetch)
15806 (uri (string-append "https://raw.githubusercontent.com/M0Rf30/"
15807 "android-udev-rules/" version "/51-android.rules"))
15808 (sha256
15809 (base32 "0lmmagpyb6xsq6zcr2w1cyx9qmjqmajkvrdbhjx32gqf1d9is003"))))))
15810 @end lisp
15811 @end deffn
15812
15813 Additionally, Guix package definitions can be included in @var{rules} in
15814 order to extend the udev rules with the definitions found under their
15815 @file{lib/udev/rules.d} sub-directory. In lieu of the previous
15816 @var{file->udev-rule} example, we could have used the
15817 @var{android-udev-rules} package which exists in Guix in the @code{(gnu
15818 packages android)} module.
15819
15820 The following example shows how to use the @var{android-udev-rules}
15821 package so that the Android tool @command{adb} can detect devices
15822 without root privileges. It also details how to create the
15823 @code{adbusers} group, which is required for the proper functioning of
15824 the rules defined within the @code{android-udev-rules} package. To
15825 create such a group, we must define it both as part of the
15826 @code{supplementary-groups} of our @code{user-account} declaration, as
15827 well as in the @var{groups} of the @code{udev-rules-service} procedure.
15828
15829 @lisp
15830 (use-modules (gnu packages android) ;for android-udev-rules
15831 (gnu system shadow) ;for user-group
15832 @dots{})
15833
15834 (operating-system
15835 ;; @dots{}
15836 (users (cons (user-account
15837 ;; @dots{}
15838 (supplementary-groups
15839 '("adbusers" ;for adb
15840 "wheel" "netdev" "audio" "video")))))
15841 ;; @dots{}
15842 (services
15843 (cons (udev-rules-service 'android android-udev-rules
15844 #:groups '("adbusers"))
15845 %desktop-services)))
15846 @end lisp
15847
15848 @defvr {Scheme Variable} urandom-seed-service-type
15849 Save some entropy in @code{%random-seed-file} to seed @file{/dev/urandom}
15850 when rebooting. It also tries to seed @file{/dev/urandom} from
15851 @file{/dev/hwrng} while booting, if @file{/dev/hwrng} exists and is
15852 readable.
15853 @end defvr
15854
15855 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %random-seed-file
15856 This is the name of the file where some random bytes are saved by
15857 @var{urandom-seed-service} to seed @file{/dev/urandom} when rebooting.
15858 It defaults to @file{/var/lib/random-seed}.
15859 @end defvr
15860
15861 @cindex mouse
15862 @cindex gpm
15863 @defvr {Scheme Variable} gpm-service-type
15864 This is the type of the service that runs GPM, the @dfn{general-purpose
15865 mouse daemon}, which provides mouse support to the Linux console. GPM
15866 allows users to use the mouse in the console, notably to select, copy,
15867 and paste text.
15868
15869 The value for services of this type must be a @code{gpm-configuration}
15870 (see below). This service is not part of @code{%base-services}.
15871 @end defvr
15872
15873 @deftp {Data Type} gpm-configuration
15874 Data type representing the configuration of GPM.
15875
15876 @table @asis
15877 @item @code{options} (default: @code{%default-gpm-options})
15878 Command-line options passed to @command{gpm}. The default set of
15879 options instruct @command{gpm} to listen to mouse events on
15880 @file{/dev/input/mice}. @xref{Command Line,,, gpm, gpm manual}, for
15881 more information.
15882
15883 @item @code{gpm} (default: @code{gpm})
15884 The GPM package to use.
15885
15886 @end table
15887 @end deftp
15888
15889 @anchor{guix-publish-service-type}
15890 @deffn {Scheme Variable} guix-publish-service-type
15891 This is the service type for @command{guix publish} (@pxref{Invoking
15892 guix publish}). Its value must be a @code{guix-publish-configuration}
15893 object, as described below.
15894
15895 This assumes that @file{/etc/guix} already contains a signing key pair as
15896 created by @command{guix archive --generate-key} (@pxref{Invoking guix
15897 archive}). If that is not the case, the service will fail to start.
15898 @end deffn
15899
15900 @deftp {Data Type} guix-publish-configuration
15901 Data type representing the configuration of the @code{guix publish}
15902 service.
15903
15904 @table @asis
15905 @item @code{guix} (default: @code{guix})
15906 The Guix package to use.
15907
15908 @item @code{port} (default: @code{80})
15909 The TCP port to listen for connections.
15910
15911 @item @code{host} (default: @code{"localhost"})
15912 The host (and thus, network interface) to listen to. Use
15913 @code{"0.0.0.0"} to listen on all the network interfaces.
15914
15915 @item @code{advertise?} (default: @code{#f})
15916 When true, advertise the service on the local network @i{via} the DNS-SD
15917 protocol, using Avahi.
15918
15919 This allows neighboring Guix devices with discovery on (see
15920 @code{guix-configuration} above) to discover this @command{guix publish}
15921 instance and to automatically download substitutes from it.
15922
15923 @item @code{compression} (default: @code{'(("gzip" 3) ("zstd" 3))})
15924 This is a list of compression method/level tuple used when compressing
15925 substitutes. For example, to compress all substitutes with @emph{both} lzip
15926 at level 7 and gzip at level 9, write:
15927
15928 @lisp
15929 '(("lzip" 7) ("gzip" 9))
15930 @end lisp
15931
15932 Level 9 achieves the best compression ratio at the expense of increased CPU
15933 usage, whereas level 1 achieves fast compression. @xref{Invoking guix
15934 publish}, for more information on the available compression methods and
15935 the tradeoffs involved.
15936
15937 An empty list disables compression altogether.
15938
15939 @item @code{nar-path} (default: @code{"nar"})
15940 The URL path at which ``nars'' can be fetched. @xref{Invoking guix
15941 publish, @option{--nar-path}}, for details.
15942
15943 @item @code{cache} (default: @code{#f})
15944 When it is @code{#f}, disable caching and instead generate archives on
15945 demand. Otherwise, this should be the name of a directory---e.g.,
15946 @code{"/var/cache/guix/publish"}---where @command{guix publish} caches
15947 archives and meta-data ready to be sent. @xref{Invoking guix publish,
15948 @option{--cache}}, for more information on the tradeoffs involved.
15949
15950 @item @code{workers} (default: @code{#f})
15951 When it is an integer, this is the number of worker threads used for
15952 caching; when @code{#f}, the number of processors is used.
15953 @xref{Invoking guix publish, @option{--workers}}, for more information.
15954
15955 @item @code{cache-bypass-threshold} (default: 10 MiB)
15956 When @code{cache} is true, this is the maximum size in bytes of a store
15957 item for which @command{guix publish} may bypass its cache in case of a
15958 cache miss. @xref{Invoking guix publish,
15959 @option{--cache-bypass-threshold}}, for more information.
15960
15961 @item @code{ttl} (default: @code{#f})
15962 When it is an integer, this denotes the @dfn{time-to-live} in seconds
15963 of the published archives. @xref{Invoking guix publish, @option{--ttl}},
15964 for more information.
15965 @end table
15966 @end deftp
15967
15968 @anchor{rngd-service}
15969 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} rngd-service [#:rng-tools @var{rng-tools}] @
15970 [#:device "/dev/hwrng"]
15971 Return a service that runs the @command{rngd} program from @var{rng-tools}
15972 to add @var{device} to the kernel's entropy pool. The service will fail if
15973 @var{device} does not exist.
15974 @end deffn
15975
15976 @anchor{pam-limits-service}
15977 @cindex session limits
15978 @cindex ulimit
15979 @cindex priority
15980 @cindex realtime
15981 @cindex jackd
15982 @cindex nofile
15983 @cindex open file descriptors
15984 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} pam-limits-service [#:limits @code{'()}]
15985
15986 Return a service that installs a configuration file for the
15987 @uref{http://linux-pam.org/Linux-PAM-html/sag-pam_limits.html,
15988 @code{pam_limits} module}. The procedure optionally takes a list of
15989 @code{pam-limits-entry} values, which can be used to specify
15990 @code{ulimit} limits and @code{nice} priority limits to user sessions.
15991
15992 The following limits definition sets two hard and soft limits for all
15993 login sessions of users in the @code{realtime} group:
15994
15995 @lisp
15996 (pam-limits-service
15997 (list
15998 (pam-limits-entry "@@realtime" 'both 'rtprio 99)
15999 (pam-limits-entry "@@realtime" 'both 'memlock 'unlimited)))
16000 @end lisp
16001
16002 The first entry increases the maximum realtime priority for
16003 non-privileged processes; the second entry lifts any restriction of the
16004 maximum address space that can be locked in memory. These settings are
16005 commonly used for real-time audio systems.
16006
16007 Another useful example is raising the maximum number of open file
16008 descriptors that can be used:
16009
16010 @lisp
16011 (pam-limits-service
16012 (list
16013 (pam-limits-entry "*" 'both 'nofile 100000)))
16014 @end lisp
16015
16016 In the above example, the asterisk means the limit should apply to any
16017 user. It is important to ensure the chosen value doesn't exceed the
16018 maximum system value visible in the @file{/proc/sys/fs/file-max} file,
16019 else the users would be prevented from login in. For more information
16020 about the Pluggable Authentication Module (PAM) limits, refer to the
16021 @samp{pam_limits} man page from the @code{linux-pam} package.
16022 @end deffn
16023
16024 @node Scheduled Job Execution
16025 @subsection Scheduled Job Execution
16026
16027 @cindex cron
16028 @cindex mcron
16029 @cindex scheduling jobs
16030 The @code{(gnu services mcron)} module provides an interface to
16031 GNU@tie{}mcron, a daemon to run jobs at scheduled times (@pxref{Top,,,
16032 mcron, GNU@tie{}mcron}). GNU@tie{}mcron is similar to the traditional
16033 Unix @command{cron} daemon; the main difference is that it is
16034 implemented in Guile Scheme, which provides a lot of flexibility when
16035 specifying the scheduling of jobs and their actions.
16036
16037 The example below defines an operating system that runs the
16038 @command{updatedb} (@pxref{Invoking updatedb,,, find, Finding Files})
16039 and the @command{guix gc} commands (@pxref{Invoking guix gc}) daily, as
16040 well as the @command{mkid} command on behalf of an unprivileged user
16041 (@pxref{mkid invocation,,, idutils, ID Database Utilities}). It uses
16042 gexps to introduce job definitions that are passed to mcron
16043 (@pxref{G-Expressions}).
16044
16045 @lisp
16046 (use-modules (guix) (gnu) (gnu services mcron))
16047 (use-package-modules base idutils)
16048
16049 (define updatedb-job
16050 ;; Run 'updatedb' at 3AM every day. Here we write the
16051 ;; job's action as a Scheme procedure.
16052 #~(job '(next-hour '(3))
16053 (lambda ()
16054 (execl (string-append #$findutils "/bin/updatedb")
16055 "updatedb"
16056 "--prunepaths=/tmp /var/tmp /gnu/store"))
16057 "updatedb"))
16058
16059 (define garbage-collector-job
16060 ;; Collect garbage 5 minutes after midnight every day.
16061 ;; The job's action is a shell command.
16062 #~(job "5 0 * * *" ;Vixie cron syntax
16063 "guix gc -F 1G"))
16064
16065 (define idutils-job
16066 ;; Update the index database as user "charlie" at 12:15PM
16067 ;; and 19:15PM. This runs from the user's home directory.
16068 #~(job '(next-minute-from (next-hour '(12 19)) '(15))
16069 (string-append #$idutils "/bin/mkid src")
16070 #:user "charlie"))
16071
16072 (operating-system
16073 ;; @dots{}
16074
16075 ;; %BASE-SERVICES already includes an instance of
16076 ;; 'mcron-service-type', which we extend with additional
16077 ;; jobs using 'simple-service'.
16078 (services (cons (simple-service 'my-cron-jobs
16079 mcron-service-type
16080 (list garbage-collector-job
16081 updatedb-job
16082 idutils-job))
16083 %base-services)))
16084 @end lisp
16085
16086 @quotation Tip
16087 When providing the action of a job specification as a procedure, you
16088 should provide an explicit name for the job via the optional 3rd
16089 argument as done in the @code{updatedb-job} example above. Otherwise,
16090 the job would appear as ``Lambda function'' in the output of
16091 @command{herd schedule mcron}, which is not nearly descriptive enough!
16092 @end quotation
16093
16094 For more complex jobs defined in Scheme where you need control over the top
16095 level, for instance to introduce a @code{use-modules} form, you can move your
16096 code to a separate program using the @code{program-file} procedure of the
16097 @code{(guix gexp)} module (@pxref{G-Expressions}). The example below
16098 illustrates that.
16099
16100 @lisp
16101 (define %battery-alert-job
16102 ;; Beep when the battery percentage falls below %MIN-LEVEL.
16103 #~(job
16104 '(next-minute (range 0 60 1))
16105 #$(program-file
16106 "battery-alert.scm"
16107 (with-imported-modules (source-module-closure
16108 '((guix build utils)))
16109 #~(begin
16110 (use-modules (guix build utils)
16111 (ice-9 popen)
16112 (ice-9 regex)
16113 (ice-9 textual-ports)
16114 (srfi srfi-2))
16115
16116 (define %min-level 20)
16117
16118 (setenv "LC_ALL" "C") ;ensure English output
16119 (and-let* ((input-pipe (open-pipe*
16120 OPEN_READ
16121 #$(file-append acpi "/bin/acpi")))
16122 (output (get-string-all input-pipe))
16123 (m (string-match "Discharging, ([0-9]+)%" output))
16124 (level (string->number (match:substring m 1)))
16125 ((< level %min-level)))
16126 (format #t "warning: Battery level is low (~a%)~%" level)
16127 (invoke #$(file-append beep "/bin/beep") "-r5")))))))
16128 @end lisp
16129
16130 @xref{Guile Syntax, mcron job specifications,, mcron, GNU@tie{}mcron},
16131 for more information on mcron job specifications. Below is the
16132 reference of the mcron service.
16133
16134 On a running system, you can use the @code{schedule} action of the service to
16135 visualize the mcron jobs that will be executed next:
16136
16137 @example
16138 # herd schedule mcron
16139 @end example
16140
16141 @noindent
16142 The example above lists the next five tasks that will be executed, but you can
16143 also specify the number of tasks to display:
16144
16145 @example
16146 # herd schedule mcron 10
16147 @end example
16148
16149 @defvr {Scheme Variable} mcron-service-type
16150 This is the type of the @code{mcron} service, whose value is an
16151 @code{mcron-configuration} object.
16152
16153 This service type can be the target of a service extension that provides
16154 it additional job specifications (@pxref{Service Composition}). In
16155 other words, it is possible to define services that provide additional
16156 mcron jobs to run.
16157 @end defvr
16158
16159 @deftp {Data Type} mcron-configuration
16160 Data type representing the configuration of mcron.
16161
16162 @table @asis
16163 @item @code{mcron} (default: @var{mcron})
16164 The mcron package to use.
16165
16166 @item @code{jobs}
16167 This is a list of gexps (@pxref{G-Expressions}), where each gexp
16168 corresponds to an mcron job specification (@pxref{Syntax, mcron job
16169 specifications,, mcron, GNU@tie{}mcron}).
16170 @end table
16171 @end deftp
16172
16173
16174 @node Log Rotation
16175 @subsection Log Rotation
16176
16177 @cindex rottlog
16178 @cindex log rotation
16179 @cindex logging
16180 Log files such as those found in @file{/var/log} tend to grow endlessly,
16181 so it's a good idea to @dfn{rotate} them once in a while---i.e., archive
16182 their contents in separate files, possibly compressed. The @code{(gnu
16183 services admin)} module provides an interface to GNU@tie{}Rot[t]log, a
16184 log rotation tool (@pxref{Top,,, rottlog, GNU Rot[t]log Manual}).
16185
16186 This service is part of @code{%base-services}, and thus enabled by
16187 default, with the default settings, for commonly encountered log files.
16188 The example below shows how to extend it with an additional
16189 @dfn{rotation}, should you need to do that (usually, services that
16190 produce log files already take care of that):
16191
16192 @lisp
16193 (use-modules (guix) (gnu))
16194 (use-service-modules admin)
16195
16196 (define my-log-files
16197 ;; Log files that I want to rotate.
16198 '("/var/log/something.log" "/var/log/another.log"))
16199
16200 (operating-system
16201 ;; @dots{}
16202 (services (cons (simple-service 'rotate-my-stuff
16203 rottlog-service-type
16204 (list (log-rotation
16205 (frequency 'daily)
16206 (files my-log-files))))
16207 %base-services)))
16208 @end lisp
16209
16210 @defvr {Scheme Variable} rottlog-service-type
16211 This is the type of the Rottlog service, whose value is a
16212 @code{rottlog-configuration} object.
16213
16214 Other services can extend this one with new @code{log-rotation} objects
16215 (see below), thereby augmenting the set of files to be rotated.
16216
16217 This service type can define mcron jobs (@pxref{Scheduled Job
16218 Execution}) to run the rottlog service.
16219 @end defvr
16220
16221 @deftp {Data Type} rottlog-configuration
16222 Data type representing the configuration of rottlog.
16223
16224 @table @asis
16225 @item @code{rottlog} (default: @code{rottlog})
16226 The Rottlog package to use.
16227
16228 @item @code{rc-file} (default: @code{(file-append rottlog "/etc/rc")})
16229 The Rottlog configuration file to use (@pxref{Mandatory RC Variables,,,
16230 rottlog, GNU Rot[t]log Manual}).
16231
16232 @item @code{rotations} (default: @code{%default-rotations})
16233 A list of @code{log-rotation} objects as defined below.
16234
16235 @item @code{jobs}
16236 This is a list of gexps where each gexp corresponds to an mcron job
16237 specification (@pxref{Scheduled Job Execution}).
16238 @end table
16239 @end deftp
16240
16241 @deftp {Data Type} log-rotation
16242 Data type representing the rotation of a group of log files.
16243
16244 Taking an example from the Rottlog manual (@pxref{Period Related File
16245 Examples,,, rottlog, GNU Rot[t]log Manual}), a log rotation might be
16246 defined like this:
16247
16248 @lisp
16249 (log-rotation
16250 (frequency 'daily)
16251 (files '("/var/log/apache/*"))
16252 (options '("storedir apache-archives"
16253 "rotate 6"
16254 "notifempty"
16255 "nocompress")))
16256 @end lisp
16257
16258 The list of fields is as follows:
16259
16260 @table @asis
16261 @item @code{frequency} (default: @code{'weekly})
16262 The log rotation frequency, a symbol.
16263
16264 @item @code{files}
16265 The list of files or file glob patterns to rotate.
16266
16267 @item @code{options} (default: @code{'()})
16268 The list of rottlog options for this rotation (@pxref{Configuration
16269 parameters,,, rottlog, GNU Rot[t]lg Manual}).
16270
16271 @item @code{post-rotate} (default: @code{#f})
16272 Either @code{#f} or a gexp to execute once the rotation has completed.
16273 @end table
16274 @end deftp
16275
16276 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %default-rotations
16277 Specifies weekly rotation of @code{%rotated-files} and of
16278 @file{/var/log/guix-daemon.log}.
16279 @end defvr
16280
16281 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %rotated-files
16282 The list of syslog-controlled files to be rotated. By default it is:
16283 @code{'("/var/log/messages" "/var/log/secure" "/var/log/debug" \
16284 "/var/log/maillog")}.
16285 @end defvr
16286
16287 @node Networking Services
16288 @subsection Networking Services
16289
16290 The @code{(gnu services networking)} module provides services to configure
16291 the network interface.
16292
16293 @cindex DHCP, networking service
16294 @defvr {Scheme Variable} dhcp-client-service-type
16295 This is the type of services that run @var{dhcp}, a Dynamic Host Configuration
16296 Protocol (DHCP) client, on all the non-loopback network interfaces. Its value
16297 is the DHCP client package to use, @code{isc-dhcp} by default.
16298 @end defvr
16299
16300 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} dhcpd-service-type
16301 This type defines a service that runs a DHCP daemon. To create a
16302 service of this type, you must supply a @code{<dhcpd-configuration>}.
16303 For example:
16304
16305 @lisp
16306 (service dhcpd-service-type
16307 (dhcpd-configuration
16308 (config-file (local-file "my-dhcpd.conf"))
16309 (interfaces '("enp0s25"))))
16310 @end lisp
16311 @end deffn
16312
16313 @deftp {Data Type} dhcpd-configuration
16314 @table @asis
16315 @item @code{package} (default: @code{isc-dhcp})
16316 The package that provides the DHCP daemon. This package is expected to
16317 provide the daemon at @file{sbin/dhcpd} relative to its output
16318 directory. The default package is the
16319 @uref{https://www.isc.org/products/DHCP, ISC's DHCP server}.
16320 @item @code{config-file} (default: @code{#f})
16321 The configuration file to use. This is required. It will be passed to
16322 @code{dhcpd} via its @code{-cf} option. This may be any ``file-like''
16323 object (@pxref{G-Expressions, file-like objects}). See @code{man
16324 dhcpd.conf} for details on the configuration file syntax.
16325 @item @code{version} (default: @code{"4"})
16326 The DHCP version to use. The ISC DHCP server supports the values ``4'',
16327 ``6'', and ``4o6''. These correspond to the @code{dhcpd} program
16328 options @code{-4}, @code{-6}, and @code{-4o6}. See @code{man dhcpd} for
16329 details.
16330 @item @code{run-directory} (default: @code{"/run/dhcpd"})
16331 The run directory to use. At service activation time, this directory
16332 will be created if it does not exist.
16333 @item @code{pid-file} (default: @code{"/run/dhcpd/dhcpd.pid"})
16334 The PID file to use. This corresponds to the @code{-pf} option of
16335 @code{dhcpd}. See @code{man dhcpd} for details.
16336 @item @code{interfaces} (default: @code{'()})
16337 The names of the network interfaces on which dhcpd should listen for
16338 broadcasts. If this list is not empty, then its elements (which must be
16339 strings) will be appended to the @code{dhcpd} invocation when starting
16340 the daemon. It may not be necessary to explicitly specify any
16341 interfaces here; see @code{man dhcpd} for details.
16342 @end table
16343 @end deftp
16344
16345 @defvr {Scheme Variable} static-networking-service-type
16346 This is the type for statically-configured network interfaces.
16347 @c TODO Document <static-networking> data structures.
16348 @end defvr
16349
16350 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} static-networking-service @var{interface} @var{ip} @
16351 [#:netmask #f] [#:gateway #f] [#:name-servers @code{'()}] @
16352 [#:requirement @code{'(udev)}]
16353 Return a service that starts @var{interface} with address @var{ip}. If
16354 @var{netmask} is true, use it as the network mask. If @var{gateway} is true,
16355 it must be a string specifying the default network gateway. @var{requirement}
16356 can be used to declare a dependency on another service before configuring the
16357 interface.
16358
16359 This procedure can be called several times, one for each network
16360 interface of interest. Behind the scenes what it does is extend
16361 @code{static-networking-service-type} with additional network interfaces
16362 to handle.
16363
16364 For example:
16365
16366 @lisp
16367 (static-networking-service "eno1" "192.168.1.82"
16368 #:gateway "192.168.1.2"
16369 #:name-servers '("192.168.1.2"))
16370 @end lisp
16371 @end deffn
16372
16373 @cindex wicd
16374 @cindex wireless
16375 @cindex WiFi
16376 @cindex network management
16377 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} wicd-service [#:wicd @var{wicd}]
16378 Return a service that runs @url{https://launchpad.net/wicd,Wicd}, a network
16379 management daemon that aims to simplify wired and wireless networking.
16380
16381 This service adds the @var{wicd} package to the global profile, providing
16382 several commands to interact with the daemon and configure networking:
16383 @command{wicd-client}, a graphical user interface, and the @command{wicd-cli}
16384 and @command{wicd-curses} user interfaces.
16385 @end deffn
16386
16387 @cindex ModemManager
16388
16389 @defvr {Scheme Variable} modem-manager-service-type
16390 This is the service type for the
16391 @uref{https://wiki.gnome.org/Projects/ModemManager, ModemManager}
16392 service. The value for this service type is a
16393 @code{modem-manager-configuration} record.
16394
16395 This service is part of @code{%desktop-services} (@pxref{Desktop
16396 Services}).
16397 @end defvr
16398
16399 @deftp {Data Type} modem-manager-configuration
16400 Data type representing the configuration of ModemManager.
16401
16402 @table @asis
16403 @item @code{modem-manager} (default: @code{modem-manager})
16404 The ModemManager package to use.
16405
16406 @end table
16407 @end deftp
16408
16409 @cindex USB_ModeSwitch
16410 @cindex Modeswitching
16411
16412 @defvr {Scheme Variable} usb-modeswitch-service-type
16413 This is the service type for the
16414 @uref{https://www.draisberghof.de/usb_modeswitch/, USB_ModeSwitch}
16415 service. The value for this service type is
16416 a @code{usb-modeswitch-configuration} record.
16417
16418 When plugged in, some USB modems (and other USB devices) initially present
16419 themselves as a read-only storage medium and not as a modem. They need to be
16420 @dfn{modeswitched} before they are usable. The USB_ModeSwitch service type
16421 installs udev rules to automatically modeswitch these devices when they are
16422 plugged in.
16423
16424 This service is part of @code{%desktop-services} (@pxref{Desktop
16425 Services}).
16426 @end defvr
16427
16428 @deftp {Data Type} usb-modeswitch-configuration
16429 Data type representing the configuration of USB_ModeSwitch.
16430
16431 @table @asis
16432 @item @code{usb-modeswitch} (default: @code{usb-modeswitch})
16433 The USB_ModeSwitch package providing the binaries for modeswitching.
16434
16435 @item @code{usb-modeswitch-data} (default: @code{usb-modeswitch-data})
16436 The package providing the device data and udev rules file used by
16437 USB_ModeSwitch.
16438
16439 @item @code{config-file} (default: @code{#~(string-append #$usb-modeswitch:dispatcher "/etc/usb_modeswitch.conf")})
16440 Which config file to use for the USB_ModeSwitch dispatcher. By default the
16441 config file shipped with USB_ModeSwitch is used which disables logging to
16442 @file{/var/log} among other default settings. If set to @code{#f}, no config
16443 file is used.
16444
16445 @end table
16446 @end deftp
16447
16448 @cindex NetworkManager
16449
16450 @defvr {Scheme Variable} network-manager-service-type
16451 This is the service type for the
16452 @uref{https://wiki.gnome.org/Projects/NetworkManager, NetworkManager}
16453 service. The value for this service type is a
16454 @code{network-manager-configuration} record.
16455
16456 This service is part of @code{%desktop-services} (@pxref{Desktop
16457 Services}).
16458 @end defvr
16459
16460 @deftp {Data Type} network-manager-configuration
16461 Data type representing the configuration of NetworkManager.
16462
16463 @table @asis
16464 @item @code{network-manager} (default: @code{network-manager})
16465 The NetworkManager package to use.
16466
16467 @item @code{dns} (default: @code{"default"})
16468 Processing mode for DNS, which affects how NetworkManager uses the
16469 @code{resolv.conf} configuration file.
16470
16471 @table @samp
16472 @item default
16473 NetworkManager will update @code{resolv.conf} to reflect the nameservers
16474 provided by currently active connections.
16475
16476 @item dnsmasq
16477 NetworkManager will run @code{dnsmasq} as a local caching nameserver, using a
16478 @dfn{conditional forwarding} configuration if you are connected to a VPN, and
16479 then update @code{resolv.conf} to point to the local nameserver.
16480
16481 With this setting, you can share your network connection. For example when
16482 you want to share your network connection to another laptop @i{via} an
16483 Ethernet cable, you can open @command{nm-connection-editor} and configure the
16484 Wired connection's method for IPv4 and IPv6 to be ``Shared to other computers''
16485 and reestablish the connection (or reboot).
16486
16487 You can also set up a @dfn{host-to-guest connection} to QEMU VMs
16488 (@pxref{Installing Guix in a VM}). With a host-to-guest connection, you can
16489 e.g.@: access a Web server running on the VM (@pxref{Web Services}) from a Web
16490 browser on your host system, or connect to the VM @i{via} SSH
16491 (@pxref{Networking Services, @code{openssh-service-type}}). To set up a
16492 host-to-guest connection, run this command once:
16493
16494 @example
16495 nmcli connection add type tun \
16496 connection.interface-name tap0 \
16497 tun.mode tap tun.owner $(id -u) \
16498 ipv4.method shared \
16499 ipv4.addresses 172.28.112.1/24
16500 @end example
16501
16502 Then each time you launch your QEMU VM (@pxref{Running Guix in a VM}), pass
16503 @option{-nic tap,ifname=tap0,script=no,downscript=no} to
16504 @command{qemu-system-...}.
16505
16506 @item none
16507 NetworkManager will not modify @code{resolv.conf}.
16508 @end table
16509
16510 @item @code{vpn-plugins} (default: @code{'()})
16511 This is the list of available plugins for virtual private networks
16512 (VPNs). An example of this is the @code{network-manager-openvpn}
16513 package, which allows NetworkManager to manage VPNs @i{via} OpenVPN.
16514
16515 @end table
16516 @end deftp
16517
16518 @cindex Connman
16519 @deffn {Scheme Variable} connman-service-type
16520 This is the service type to run @url{https://01.org/connman,Connman},
16521 a network connection manager.
16522
16523 Its value must be an
16524 @code{connman-configuration} record as in this example:
16525
16526 @lisp
16527 (service connman-service-type
16528 (connman-configuration
16529 (disable-vpn? #t)))
16530 @end lisp
16531
16532 See below for details about @code{connman-configuration}.
16533 @end deffn
16534
16535 @deftp {Data Type} connman-configuration
16536 Data Type representing the configuration of connman.
16537
16538 @table @asis
16539 @item @code{connman} (default: @var{connman})
16540 The connman package to use.
16541
16542 @item @code{disable-vpn?} (default: @code{#f})
16543 When true, disable connman's vpn plugin.
16544 @end table
16545 @end deftp
16546
16547 @cindex WPA Supplicant
16548 @defvr {Scheme Variable} wpa-supplicant-service-type
16549 This is the service type to run @url{https://w1.fi/wpa_supplicant/,WPA
16550 supplicant}, an authentication daemon required to authenticate against
16551 encrypted WiFi or ethernet networks.
16552 @end defvr
16553
16554 @deftp {Data Type} wpa-supplicant-configuration
16555 Data type representing the configuration of WPA Supplicant.
16556
16557 It takes the following parameters:
16558
16559 @table @asis
16560 @item @code{wpa-supplicant} (default: @code{wpa-supplicant})
16561 The WPA Supplicant package to use.
16562
16563 @item @code{requirement} (default: @code{'(user-processes loopback syslogd)}
16564 List of services that should be started before WPA Supplicant starts.
16565
16566 @item @code{dbus?} (default: @code{#t})
16567 Whether to listen for requests on D-Bus.
16568
16569 @item @code{pid-file} (default: @code{"/var/run/wpa_supplicant.pid"})
16570 Where to store the PID file.
16571
16572 @item @code{interface} (default: @code{#f})
16573 If this is set, it must specify the name of a network interface that
16574 WPA supplicant will control.
16575
16576 @item @code{config-file} (default: @code{#f})
16577 Optional configuration file to use.
16578
16579 @item @code{extra-options} (default: @code{'()})
16580 List of additional command-line arguments to pass to the daemon.
16581 @end table
16582 @end deftp
16583
16584 @cindex hostapd service, for Wi-Fi access points
16585 @cindex Wi-Fi access points, hostapd service
16586 @defvr {Scheme Variable} hostapd-service-type
16587 This is the service type to run the @uref{https://w1.fi/hostapd/,
16588 hostapd} daemon to set up WiFi (IEEE 802.11) access points and
16589 authentication servers. Its associated value must be a
16590 @code{hostapd-configuration} as shown below:
16591
16592 @lisp
16593 ;; Use wlan1 to run the access point for "My Network".
16594 (service hostapd-service-type
16595 (hostapd-configuration
16596 (interface "wlan1")
16597 (ssid "My Network")
16598 (channel 12)))
16599 @end lisp
16600 @end defvr
16601
16602 @deftp {Data Type} hostapd-configuration
16603 This data type represents the configuration of the hostapd service, with
16604 the following fields:
16605
16606 @table @asis
16607 @item @code{package} (default: @code{hostapd})
16608 The hostapd package to use.
16609
16610 @item @code{interface} (default: @code{"wlan0"})
16611 The network interface to run the WiFi access point.
16612
16613 @item @code{ssid}
16614 The SSID (@dfn{service set identifier}), a string that identifies this
16615 network.
16616
16617 @item @code{broadcast-ssid?} (default: @code{#t})
16618 Whether to broadcast this SSID.
16619
16620 @item @code{channel} (default: @code{1})
16621 The WiFi channel to use.
16622
16623 @item @code{driver} (default: @code{"nl80211"})
16624 The driver interface type. @code{"nl80211"} is used with all Linux
16625 mac80211 drivers. Use @code{"none"} if building hostapd as a standalone
16626 RADIUS server that does # not control any wireless/wired driver.
16627
16628 @item @code{extra-settings} (default: @code{""})
16629 Extra settings to append as-is to the hostapd configuration file. See
16630 @uref{https://w1.fi/cgit/hostap/plain/hostapd/hostapd.conf} for the
16631 configuration file reference.
16632 @end table
16633 @end deftp
16634
16635 @defvr {Scheme Variable} simulated-wifi-service-type
16636 This is the type of a service to simulate WiFi networking, which can be
16637 useful in virtual machines for testing purposes. The service loads the
16638 Linux kernel
16639 @uref{https://www.kernel.org/doc/html/latest/networking/mac80211_hwsim/mac80211_hwsim.html,
16640 @code{mac80211_hwsim} module} and starts hostapd to create a pseudo WiFi
16641 network that can be seen on @code{wlan0}, by default.
16642
16643 The service's value is a @code{hostapd-configuration} record.
16644 @end defvr
16645
16646 @cindex iptables
16647 @defvr {Scheme Variable} iptables-service-type
16648 This is the service type to set up an iptables configuration. iptables is a
16649 packet filtering framework supported by the Linux kernel. This service
16650 supports configuring iptables for both IPv4 and IPv6. A simple example
16651 configuration rejecting all incoming connections except those to the ssh port
16652 22 is shown below.
16653
16654 @lisp
16655 (service iptables-service-type
16656 (iptables-configuration
16657 (ipv4-rules (plain-file "iptables.rules" "*filter
16658 :INPUT ACCEPT
16659 :FORWARD ACCEPT
16660 :OUTPUT ACCEPT
16661 -A INPUT -m conntrack --ctstate ESTABLISHED,RELATED -j ACCEPT
16662 -A INPUT -p tcp --dport 22 -j ACCEPT
16663 -A INPUT -j REJECT --reject-with icmp-port-unreachable
16664 COMMIT
16665 "))
16666 (ipv6-rules (plain-file "ip6tables.rules" "*filter
16667 :INPUT ACCEPT
16668 :FORWARD ACCEPT
16669 :OUTPUT ACCEPT
16670 -A INPUT -m conntrack --ctstate ESTABLISHED,RELATED -j ACCEPT
16671 -A INPUT -p tcp --dport 22 -j ACCEPT
16672 -A INPUT -j REJECT --reject-with icmp6-port-unreachable
16673 COMMIT
16674 "))))
16675 @end lisp
16676 @end defvr
16677
16678 @deftp {Data Type} iptables-configuration
16679 The data type representing the configuration of iptables.
16680
16681 @table @asis
16682 @item @code{iptables} (default: @code{iptables})
16683 The iptables package that provides @code{iptables-restore} and
16684 @code{ip6tables-restore}.
16685 @item @code{ipv4-rules} (default: @code{%iptables-accept-all-rules})
16686 The iptables rules to use. It will be passed to @code{iptables-restore}.
16687 This may be any ``file-like'' object (@pxref{G-Expressions, file-like
16688 objects}).
16689 @item @code{ipv6-rules} (default: @code{%iptables-accept-all-rules})
16690 The ip6tables rules to use. It will be passed to @code{ip6tables-restore}.
16691 This may be any ``file-like'' object (@pxref{G-Expressions, file-like
16692 objects}).
16693 @end table
16694 @end deftp
16695
16696 @cindex nftables
16697 @defvr {Scheme Variable} nftables-service-type
16698 This is the service type to set up a nftables configuration. nftables is a
16699 netfilter project that aims to replace the existing iptables, ip6tables,
16700 arptables and ebtables framework. It provides a new packet filtering
16701 framework, a new user-space utility @command{nft}, and a compatibility layer
16702 for iptables. This service comes with a default ruleset
16703 @code{%default-nftables-ruleset} that rejecting all incoming connections
16704 except those to the ssh port 22. To use it, simply write:
16705
16706 @lisp
16707 (service nftables-service-type)
16708 @end lisp
16709 @end defvr
16710
16711 @deftp {Data Type} nftables-configuration
16712 The data type representing the configuration of nftables.
16713
16714 @table @asis
16715 @item @code{package} (default: @code{nftables})
16716 The nftables package that provides @command{nft}.
16717 @item @code{ruleset} (default: @code{%default-nftables-ruleset})
16718 The nftables ruleset to use. This may be any ``file-like'' object
16719 (@pxref{G-Expressions, file-like objects}).
16720 @end table
16721 @end deftp
16722
16723 @cindex NTP (Network Time Protocol), service
16724 @cindex ntpd, service for the Network Time Protocol daemon
16725 @cindex real time clock
16726 @defvr {Scheme Variable} ntp-service-type
16727 This is the type of the service running the @uref{https://www.ntp.org,
16728 Network Time Protocol (NTP)} daemon, @command{ntpd}. The daemon will keep the
16729 system clock synchronized with that of the specified NTP servers.
16730
16731 The value of this service is an @code{ntpd-configuration} object, as described
16732 below.
16733 @end defvr
16734
16735 @deftp {Data Type} ntp-configuration
16736 This is the data type for the NTP service configuration.
16737
16738 @table @asis
16739 @item @code{servers} (default: @code{%ntp-servers})
16740 This is the list of servers (@code{<ntp-server>} records) with which
16741 @command{ntpd} will be synchronized. See the @code{ntp-server} data type
16742 definition below.
16743
16744 @item @code{allow-large-adjustment?} (default: @code{#t})
16745 This determines whether @command{ntpd} is allowed to make an initial
16746 adjustment of more than 1,000 seconds.
16747
16748 @item @code{ntp} (default: @code{ntp})
16749 The NTP package to use.
16750 @end table
16751 @end deftp
16752
16753 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %ntp-servers
16754 List of host names used as the default NTP servers. These are servers of the
16755 @uref{https://www.ntppool.org/en/, NTP Pool Project}.
16756 @end defvr
16757
16758 @deftp {Data Type} ntp-server
16759 The data type representing the configuration of a NTP server.
16760
16761 @table @asis
16762 @item @code{type} (default: @code{'server})
16763 The type of the NTP server, given as a symbol. One of @code{'pool},
16764 @code{'server}, @code{'peer}, @code{'broadcast} or @code{'manycastclient}.
16765
16766 @item @code{address}
16767 The address of the server, as a string.
16768
16769 @item @code{options}
16770 NTPD options to use with that specific server, given as a list of option names
16771 and/or of option names and values tuples. The following example define a server
16772 to use with the options @option{iburst} and @option{prefer}, as well as
16773 @option{version} 3 and a @option{maxpoll} time of 16 seconds.
16774
16775 @example
16776 (ntp-server
16777 (type 'server)
16778 (address "some.ntp.server.org")
16779 (options `(iburst (version 3) (maxpoll 16) prefer))))
16780 @end example
16781 @end table
16782 @end deftp
16783
16784 @cindex OpenNTPD
16785 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} openntpd-service-type
16786 Run the @command{ntpd}, the Network Time Protocol (NTP) daemon, as implemented
16787 by @uref{http://www.openntpd.org, OpenNTPD}. The daemon will keep the system
16788 clock synchronized with that of the given servers.
16789
16790 @lisp
16791 (service
16792 openntpd-service-type
16793 (openntpd-configuration
16794 (listen-on '("127.0.0.1" "::1"))
16795 (sensor '("udcf0 correction 70000"))
16796 (constraint-from '("www.gnu.org"))
16797 (constraints-from '("https://www.google.com/"))))
16798
16799 @end lisp
16800 @end deffn
16801
16802 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %openntpd-servers
16803 This variable is a list of the server addresses defined in
16804 @code{%ntp-servers}.
16805 @end defvr
16806
16807 @deftp {Data Type} openntpd-configuration
16808 @table @asis
16809 @item @code{openntpd} (default: @code{(file-append openntpd "/sbin/ntpd")})
16810 The openntpd executable to use.
16811 @item @code{listen-on} (default: @code{'("127.0.0.1" "::1")})
16812 A list of local IP addresses or hostnames the ntpd daemon should listen on.
16813 @item @code{query-from} (default: @code{'()})
16814 A list of local IP address the ntpd daemon should use for outgoing queries.
16815 @item @code{sensor} (default: @code{'()})
16816 Specify a list of timedelta sensor devices ntpd should use. @code{ntpd}
16817 will listen to each sensor that actually exists and ignore non-existent ones.
16818 See @uref{https://man.openbsd.org/ntpd.conf, upstream documentation} for more
16819 information.
16820 @item @code{server} (default: @code{'()})
16821 Specify a list of IP addresses or hostnames of NTP servers to synchronize to.
16822 @item @code{servers} (default: @code{%openntp-servers})
16823 Specify a list of IP addresses or hostnames of NTP pools to synchronize to.
16824 @item @code{constraint-from} (default: @code{'()})
16825 @code{ntpd} can be configured to query the ‘Date’ from trusted HTTPS servers via TLS.
16826 This time information is not used for precision but acts as an authenticated
16827 constraint, thereby reducing the impact of unauthenticated NTP
16828 man-in-the-middle attacks.
16829 Specify a list of URLs, IP addresses or hostnames of HTTPS servers to provide
16830 a constraint.
16831 @item @code{constraints-from} (default: @code{'()})
16832 As with constraint from, specify a list of URLs, IP addresses or hostnames of
16833 HTTPS servers to provide a constraint. Should the hostname resolve to multiple
16834 IP addresses, @code{ntpd} will calculate a median constraint from all of them.
16835 @end table
16836 @end deftp
16837
16838 @cindex inetd
16839 @deffn {Scheme variable} inetd-service-type
16840 This service runs the @command{inetd} (@pxref{inetd invocation,,,
16841 inetutils, GNU Inetutils}) daemon. @command{inetd} listens for
16842 connections on internet sockets, and lazily starts the specified server
16843 program when a connection is made on one of these sockets.
16844
16845 The value of this service is an @code{inetd-configuration} object. The
16846 following example configures the @command{inetd} daemon to provide the
16847 built-in @command{echo} service, as well as an smtp service which
16848 forwards smtp traffic over ssh to a server @code{smtp-server} behind a
16849 gateway @code{hostname}:
16850
16851 @lisp
16852 (service
16853 inetd-service-type
16854 (inetd-configuration
16855 (entries (list
16856 (inetd-entry
16857 (name "echo")
16858 (socket-type 'stream)
16859 (protocol "tcp")
16860 (wait? #f)
16861 (user "root"))
16862 (inetd-entry
16863 (node "127.0.0.1")
16864 (name "smtp")
16865 (socket-type 'stream)
16866 (protocol "tcp")
16867 (wait? #f)
16868 (user "root")
16869 (program (file-append openssh "/bin/ssh"))
16870 (arguments
16871 '("ssh" "-qT" "-i" "/path/to/ssh_key"
16872 "-W" "smtp-server:25" "user@@hostname")))))))
16873 @end lisp
16874
16875 See below for more details about @code{inetd-configuration}.
16876 @end deffn
16877
16878 @deftp {Data Type} inetd-configuration
16879 Data type representing the configuration of @command{inetd}.
16880
16881 @table @asis
16882 @item @code{program} (default: @code{(file-append inetutils "/libexec/inetd")})
16883 The @command{inetd} executable to use.
16884
16885 @item @code{entries} (default: @code{'()})
16886 A list of @command{inetd} service entries. Each entry should be created
16887 by the @code{inetd-entry} constructor.
16888 @end table
16889 @end deftp
16890
16891 @deftp {Data Type} inetd-entry
16892 Data type representing an entry in the @command{inetd} configuration.
16893 Each entry corresponds to a socket where @command{inetd} will listen for
16894 requests.
16895
16896 @table @asis
16897 @item @code{node} (default: @code{#f})
16898 Optional string, a comma-separated list of local addresses
16899 @command{inetd} should use when listening for this service.
16900 @xref{Configuration file,,, inetutils, GNU Inetutils} for a complete
16901 description of all options.
16902 @item @code{name}
16903 A string, the name must correspond to an entry in @code{/etc/services}.
16904 @item @code{socket-type}
16905 One of @code{'stream}, @code{'dgram}, @code{'raw}, @code{'rdm} or
16906 @code{'seqpacket}.
16907 @item @code{protocol}
16908 A string, must correspond to an entry in @code{/etc/protocols}.
16909 @item @code{wait?} (default: @code{#t})
16910 Whether @command{inetd} should wait for the server to exit before
16911 listening to new service requests.
16912 @item @code{user}
16913 A string containing the user (and, optionally, group) name of the user
16914 as whom the server should run. The group name can be specified in a
16915 suffix, separated by a colon or period, i.e.@: @code{"user"},
16916 @code{"user:group"} or @code{"user.group"}.
16917 @item @code{program} (default: @code{"internal"})
16918 The server program which will serve the requests, or @code{"internal"}
16919 if @command{inetd} should use a built-in service.
16920 @item @code{arguments} (default: @code{'()})
16921 A list strings or file-like objects, which are the server program's
16922 arguments, starting with the zeroth argument, i.e.@: the name of the
16923 program itself. For @command{inetd}'s internal services, this entry
16924 must be @code{'()} or @code{'("internal")}.
16925 @end table
16926
16927 @xref{Configuration file,,, inetutils, GNU Inetutils} for a more
16928 detailed discussion of each configuration field.
16929 @end deftp
16930
16931 @cindex opendht, distributed hash table network service
16932 @cindex dhtproxy, for use with jami
16933 @defvr {Scheme Variable} opendht-service-type
16934 This is the type of the service running a @uref{https://opendht.net,
16935 OpenDHT} node, @command{dhtnode}. The daemon can be used to host your
16936 own proxy service to the distributed hash table (DHT), for example to
16937 connect to with Jami, among other applications.
16938
16939 @quotation Important
16940 When using the OpenDHT proxy server, the IP addresses it ``sees'' from
16941 the clients should be addresses reachable from other peers. In practice
16942 this means that a publicly reachable address is best suited for a proxy
16943 server, outside of your private network. For example, hosting the proxy
16944 server on a IPv4 private local network and exposing it via port
16945 forwarding could work for external peers, but peers local to the proxy
16946 would have their private addresses shared with the external peers,
16947 leading to connectivity problems.
16948 @end quotation
16949
16950 The value of this service is a @code{opendht-configuration} object, as
16951 described below.
16952 @end defvr
16953
16954 @deftp {Data Type} opendht-configuration
16955 This is the data type for the OpenDHT service configuration.
16956
16957 @c The fields documentation has been auto-generated using the
16958 @c configuration->documentation procedure from
16959 @c (gnu services configuration).
16960 Available @code{opendht-configuration} fields are:
16961
16962 @deftypevr {@code{opendht-configuration} parameter} package opendht
16963 The @code{opendht} package to use.
16964
16965 @end deftypevr
16966
16967 @deftypevr {@code{opendht-configuration} parameter} boolean peer-discovery?
16968 Whether to enable the multicast local peer discovery mechanism.
16969
16970 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
16971
16972 @end deftypevr
16973
16974 @deftypevr {@code{opendht-configuration} parameter} boolean enable-logging?
16975 Whether to enable logging messages to syslog. It is disabled by default
16976 as it is rather verbose.
16977
16978 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
16979
16980 @end deftypevr
16981
16982 @deftypevr {@code{opendht-configuration} parameter} boolean debug?
16983 Whether to enable debug-level logging messages. This has no effect if
16984 logging is disabled.
16985
16986 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
16987
16988 @end deftypevr
16989
16990 @deftypevr {@code{opendht-configuration} parameter} maybe-string bootstrap-host
16991 The node host name that is used to make the first connection to the
16992 network. A specific port value can be provided by appending the
16993 @code{:PORT} suffix. By default, it uses the Jami bootstrap nodes, but
16994 any host can be specified here. It's also possible to disable
16995 bootsrapping by setting this to the @code{'disabled} symbol.
16996
16997 Defaults to @samp{"bootstrap.jami.net:4222"}.
16998
16999 @end deftypevr
17000
17001 @deftypevr {@code{opendht-configuration} parameter} maybe-number port
17002 The UDP port to bind to. When set to @code{'disabled}, an available
17003 port is automatically selected.
17004
17005 Defaults to @samp{4222}.
17006
17007 @end deftypevr
17008
17009 @deftypevr {@code{opendht-configuration} parameter} maybe-number proxy-server-port
17010 Spawn a proxy server listening on the specified port.
17011
17012 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
17013
17014 @end deftypevr
17015
17016 @deftypevr {@code{opendht-configuration} parameter} maybe-number proxy-server-port-tls
17017 Spawn a proxy server listening to TLS connections on the specified port.
17018
17019 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
17020
17021 @end deftypevr
17022 @end deftp
17023
17024 @cindex Tor
17025 @defvr {Scheme Variable} tor-service-type
17026 This is the type for a service that runs the @uref{https://torproject.org,
17027 Tor} anonymous networking daemon. The service is configured using a
17028 @code{<tor-configuration>} record. By default, the Tor daemon runs as the
17029 @code{tor} unprivileged user, which is a member of the @code{tor} group.
17030
17031 @end defvr
17032
17033 @deftp {Data Type} tor-configuration
17034 @table @asis
17035 @item @code{tor} (default: @code{tor})
17036 The package that provides the Tor daemon. This package is expected to provide
17037 the daemon at @file{bin/tor} relative to its output directory. The default
17038 package is the @uref{https://www.torproject.org, Tor Project's}
17039 implementation.
17040
17041 @item @code{config-file} (default: @code{(plain-file "empty" "")})
17042 The configuration file to use. It will be appended to a default configuration
17043 file, and the final configuration file will be passed to @code{tor} via its
17044 @code{-f} option. This may be any ``file-like'' object (@pxref{G-Expressions,
17045 file-like objects}). See @code{man tor} for details on the configuration file
17046 syntax.
17047
17048 @item @code{hidden-services} (default: @code{'()})
17049 The list of @code{<hidden-service>} records to use. For any hidden service
17050 you include in this list, appropriate configuration to enable the hidden
17051 service will be automatically added to the default configuration file. You
17052 may conveniently create @code{<hidden-service>} records using the
17053 @code{tor-hidden-service} procedure described below.
17054
17055 @item @code{socks-socket-type} (default: @code{'tcp})
17056 The default socket type that Tor should use for its SOCKS socket. This must
17057 be either @code{'tcp} or @code{'unix}. If it is @code{'tcp}, then by default
17058 Tor will listen on TCP port 9050 on the loopback interface (i.e., localhost).
17059 If it is @code{'unix}, then Tor will listen on the UNIX domain socket
17060 @file{/var/run/tor/socks-sock}, which will be made writable by members of the
17061 @code{tor} group.
17062
17063 If you want to customize the SOCKS socket in more detail, leave
17064 @code{socks-socket-type} at its default value of @code{'tcp} and use
17065 @code{config-file} to override the default by providing your own
17066 @code{SocksPort} option.
17067
17068 @item @code{control-socket?} (default: @code{#f})
17069 Whether or not to provide a ``control socket'' by which Tor can be
17070 controlled to, for instance, dynamically instantiate tor onion services.
17071 If @code{#t}, Tor will listen for control commands on the UNIX domain socket
17072 @file{/var/run/tor/control-sock}, which will be made writable by members of the
17073 @code{tor} group.
17074
17075 @end table
17076 @end deftp
17077
17078 @cindex hidden service
17079 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} tor-hidden-service @var{name} @var{mapping}
17080 Define a new Tor @dfn{hidden service} called @var{name} and implementing
17081 @var{mapping}. @var{mapping} is a list of port/host tuples, such as:
17082
17083 @example
17084 '((22 "127.0.0.1:22")
17085 (80 "127.0.0.1:8080"))
17086 @end example
17087
17088 In this example, port 22 of the hidden service is mapped to local port 22, and
17089 port 80 is mapped to local port 8080.
17090
17091 This creates a @file{/var/lib/tor/hidden-services/@var{name}} directory, where
17092 the @file{hostname} file contains the @code{.onion} host name for the hidden
17093 service.
17094
17095 See @uref{https://www.torproject.org/docs/tor-hidden-service.html.en, the Tor
17096 project's documentation} for more information.
17097 @end deffn
17098
17099 The @code{(gnu services rsync)} module provides the following services:
17100
17101 You might want an rsync daemon if you have files that you want available
17102 so anyone (or just yourself) can download existing files or upload new
17103 files.
17104
17105 @deffn {Scheme Variable} rsync-service-type
17106 This is the service type for the @uref{https://rsync.samba.org, rsync} daemon,
17107 The value for this service type is a
17108 @command{rsync-configuration} record as in this example:
17109
17110 @lisp
17111 (service rsync-service-type)
17112 @end lisp
17113
17114 See below for details about @code{rsync-configuration}.
17115 @end deffn
17116
17117 @deftp {Data Type} rsync-configuration
17118 Data type representing the configuration for @code{rsync-service}.
17119
17120 @table @asis
17121 @item @code{package} (default: @var{rsync})
17122 @code{rsync} package to use.
17123
17124 @item @code{port-number} (default: @code{873})
17125 TCP port on which @command{rsync} listens for incoming connections. If port
17126 is less than @code{1024} @command{rsync} needs to be started as the
17127 @code{root} user and group.
17128
17129 @item @code{pid-file} (default: @code{"/var/run/rsyncd/rsyncd.pid"})
17130 Name of the file where @command{rsync} writes its PID.
17131
17132 @item @code{lock-file} (default: @code{"/var/run/rsyncd/rsyncd.lock"})
17133 Name of the file where @command{rsync} writes its lock file.
17134
17135 @item @code{log-file} (default: @code{"/var/log/rsyncd.log"})
17136 Name of the file where @command{rsync} writes its log file.
17137
17138 @item @code{use-chroot?} (default: @var{#t})
17139 Whether to use chroot for @command{rsync} shared directory.
17140
17141 @item @code{share-path} (default: @file{/srv/rsync})
17142 Location of the @command{rsync} shared directory.
17143
17144 @item @code{share-comment} (default: @code{"Rsync share"})
17145 Comment of the @command{rsync} shared directory.
17146
17147 @item @code{read-only?} (default: @var{#f})
17148 Read-write permissions to shared directory.
17149
17150 @item @code{timeout} (default: @code{300})
17151 I/O timeout in seconds.
17152
17153 @item @code{user} (default: @var{"root"})
17154 Owner of the @code{rsync} process.
17155
17156 @item @code{group} (default: @var{"root"})
17157 Group of the @code{rsync} process.
17158
17159 @item @code{uid} (default: @var{"rsyncd"})
17160 User name or user ID that file transfers to and from that module should take
17161 place as when the daemon was run as @code{root}.
17162
17163 @item @code{gid} (default: @var{"rsyncd"})
17164 Group name or group ID that will be used when accessing the module.
17165
17166 @end table
17167 @end deftp
17168
17169 The @code{(gnu services syncthing)} module provides the following services:
17170 @cindex syncthing
17171
17172 You might want a syncthing daemon if you have files between two or more
17173 computers and want to sync them in real time, safely protected from
17174 prying eyes.
17175
17176 @deffn {Scheme Variable} syncthing-service-type
17177 This is the service type for the @uref{https://syncthing.net/,
17178 syncthing} daemon, The value for this service type is a
17179 @command{syncthing-configuration} record as in this example:
17180
17181 @lisp
17182 (service syncthing-service-type
17183 (syncthing-configuration (user "alice")))
17184 @end lisp
17185
17186 See below for details about @code{syncthing-configuration}.
17187
17188 @deftp {Data Type} syncthing-configuration
17189 Data type representing the configuration for @code{syncthing-service-type}.
17190
17191 @table @asis
17192 @item @code{syncthing} (default: @var{syncthing})
17193 @code{syncthing} package to use.
17194
17195 @item @code{arguments} (default: @var{'()})
17196 List of command-line arguments passing to @code{syncthing} binary.
17197
17198 @item @code{logflags} (default: @var{0})
17199 Sum of logging flags, see
17200 @uref{https://docs.syncthing.net/users/syncthing.html#cmdoption-logflags, Syncthing documentation logflags}.
17201
17202 @item @code{user} (default: @var{#f})
17203 The user as which the Syncthing service is to be run.
17204 This assumes that the specified user exists.
17205
17206 @item @code{group} (default: @var{"users"})
17207 The group as which the Syncthing service is to be run.
17208 This assumes that the specified group exists.
17209
17210 @item @code{home} (default: @var{#f})
17211 Common configuration and data directory. The default configuration
17212 directory is @file{$HOME} of the specified Syncthing @code{user}.
17213
17214 @end table
17215 @end deftp
17216 @end deffn
17217
17218 Furthermore, @code{(gnu services ssh)} provides the following services.
17219 @cindex SSH
17220 @cindex SSH server
17221
17222 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} lsh-service [#:host-key "/etc/lsh/host-key"] @
17223 [#:daemonic? #t] [#:interfaces '()] [#:port-number 22] @
17224 [#:allow-empty-passwords? #f] [#:root-login? #f] @
17225 [#:syslog-output? #t] [#:x11-forwarding? #t] @
17226 [#:tcp/ip-forwarding? #t] [#:password-authentication? #t] @
17227 [#:public-key-authentication? #t] [#:initialize? #t]
17228 Run the @command{lshd} program from @var{lsh} to listen on port @var{port-number}.
17229 @var{host-key} must designate a file containing the host key, and readable
17230 only by root.
17231
17232 When @var{daemonic?} is true, @command{lshd} will detach from the
17233 controlling terminal and log its output to syslogd, unless one sets
17234 @var{syslog-output?} to false. Obviously, it also makes lsh-service
17235 depend on existence of syslogd service. When @var{pid-file?} is true,
17236 @command{lshd} writes its PID to the file called @var{pid-file}.
17237
17238 When @var{initialize?} is true, automatically create the seed and host key
17239 upon service activation if they do not exist yet. This may take long and
17240 require interaction.
17241
17242 When @var{initialize?} is false, it is up to the user to initialize the
17243 randomness generator (@pxref{lsh-make-seed,,, lsh, LSH Manual}), and to create
17244 a key pair with the private key stored in file @var{host-key} (@pxref{lshd
17245 basics,,, lsh, LSH Manual}).
17246
17247 When @var{interfaces} is empty, lshd listens for connections on all the
17248 network interfaces; otherwise, @var{interfaces} must be a list of host names
17249 or addresses.
17250
17251 @var{allow-empty-passwords?} specifies whether to accept log-ins with empty
17252 passwords, and @var{root-login?} specifies whether to accept log-ins as
17253 root.
17254
17255 The other options should be self-descriptive.
17256 @end deffn
17257
17258 @cindex SSH
17259 @cindex SSH server
17260 @deffn {Scheme Variable} openssh-service-type
17261 This is the type for the @uref{http://www.openssh.org, OpenSSH} secure
17262 shell daemon, @command{sshd}. Its value must be an
17263 @code{openssh-configuration} record as in this example:
17264
17265 @lisp
17266 (service openssh-service-type
17267 (openssh-configuration
17268 (x11-forwarding? #t)
17269 (permit-root-login 'prohibit-password)
17270 (authorized-keys
17271 `(("alice" ,(local-file "alice.pub"))
17272 ("bob" ,(local-file "bob.pub"))))))
17273 @end lisp
17274
17275 See below for details about @code{openssh-configuration}.
17276
17277 This service can be extended with extra authorized keys, as in this
17278 example:
17279
17280 @lisp
17281 (service-extension openssh-service-type
17282 (const `(("charlie"
17283 ,(local-file "charlie.pub")))))
17284 @end lisp
17285 @end deffn
17286
17287 @deftp {Data Type} openssh-configuration
17288 This is the configuration record for OpenSSH's @command{sshd}.
17289
17290 @table @asis
17291 @item @code{openssh} (default @var{openssh})
17292 The Openssh package to use.
17293
17294 @item @code{pid-file} (default: @code{"/var/run/sshd.pid"})
17295 Name of the file where @command{sshd} writes its PID.
17296
17297 @item @code{port-number} (default: @code{22})
17298 TCP port on which @command{sshd} listens for incoming connections.
17299
17300 @item @code{permit-root-login} (default: @code{#f})
17301 This field determines whether and when to allow logins as root. If
17302 @code{#f}, root logins are disallowed; if @code{#t}, they are allowed.
17303 If it's the symbol @code{'prohibit-password}, then root logins are
17304 permitted but not with password-based authentication.
17305
17306 @item @code{allow-empty-passwords?} (default: @code{#f})
17307 When true, users with empty passwords may log in. When false, they may
17308 not.
17309
17310 @item @code{password-authentication?} (default: @code{#t})
17311 When true, users may log in with their password. When false, they have
17312 other authentication methods.
17313
17314 @item @code{public-key-authentication?} (default: @code{#t})
17315 When true, users may log in using public key authentication. When
17316 false, users have to use other authentication method.
17317
17318 Authorized public keys are stored in @file{~/.ssh/authorized_keys}.
17319 This is used only by protocol version 2.
17320
17321 @item @code{x11-forwarding?} (default: @code{#f})
17322 When true, forwarding of X11 graphical client connections is
17323 enabled---in other words, @command{ssh} options @option{-X} and
17324 @option{-Y} will work.
17325
17326 @item @code{allow-agent-forwarding?} (default: @code{#t})
17327 Whether to allow agent forwarding.
17328
17329 @item @code{allow-tcp-forwarding?} (default: @code{#t})
17330 Whether to allow TCP forwarding.
17331
17332 @item @code{gateway-ports?} (default: @code{#f})
17333 Whether to allow gateway ports.
17334
17335 @item @code{challenge-response-authentication?} (default: @code{#f})
17336 Specifies whether challenge response authentication is allowed (e.g.@: via
17337 PAM).
17338
17339 @item @code{use-pam?} (default: @code{#t})
17340 Enables the Pluggable Authentication Module interface. If set to
17341 @code{#t}, this will enable PAM authentication using
17342 @code{challenge-response-authentication?} and
17343 @code{password-authentication?}, in addition to PAM account and session
17344 module processing for all authentication types.
17345
17346 Because PAM challenge response authentication usually serves an
17347 equivalent role to password authentication, you should disable either
17348 @code{challenge-response-authentication?} or
17349 @code{password-authentication?}.
17350
17351 @item @code{print-last-log?} (default: @code{#t})
17352 Specifies whether @command{sshd} should print the date and time of the
17353 last user login when a user logs in interactively.
17354
17355 @item @code{subsystems} (default: @code{'(("sftp" "internal-sftp"))})
17356 Configures external subsystems (e.g.@: file transfer daemon).
17357
17358 This is a list of two-element lists, each of which containing the
17359 subsystem name and a command (with optional arguments) to execute upon
17360 subsystem request.
17361
17362 The command @command{internal-sftp} implements an in-process SFTP
17363 server. Alternatively, one can specify the @command{sftp-server} command:
17364 @lisp
17365 (service openssh-service-type
17366 (openssh-configuration
17367 (subsystems
17368 `(("sftp" ,(file-append openssh "/libexec/sftp-server"))))))
17369 @end lisp
17370
17371 @item @code{accepted-environment} (default: @code{'()})
17372 List of strings describing which environment variables may be exported.
17373
17374 Each string gets on its own line. See the @code{AcceptEnv} option in
17375 @code{man sshd_config}.
17376
17377 This example allows ssh-clients to export the @env{COLORTERM} variable.
17378 It is set by terminal emulators, which support colors. You can use it in
17379 your shell's resource file to enable colors for the prompt and commands
17380 if this variable is set.
17381
17382 @lisp
17383 (service openssh-service-type
17384 (openssh-configuration
17385 (accepted-environment '("COLORTERM"))))
17386 @end lisp
17387
17388 @item @code{authorized-keys} (default: @code{'()})
17389 @cindex authorized keys, SSH
17390 @cindex SSH authorized keys
17391 This is the list of authorized keys. Each element of the list is a user
17392 name followed by one or more file-like objects that represent SSH public
17393 keys. For example:
17394
17395 @lisp
17396 (openssh-configuration
17397 (authorized-keys
17398 `(("rekado" ,(local-file "rekado.pub"))
17399 ("chris" ,(local-file "chris.pub"))
17400 ("root" ,(local-file "rekado.pub") ,(local-file "chris.pub")))))
17401 @end lisp
17402
17403 @noindent
17404 registers the specified public keys for user accounts @code{rekado},
17405 @code{chris}, and @code{root}.
17406
17407 Additional authorized keys can be specified @i{via}
17408 @code{service-extension}.
17409
17410 Note that this does @emph{not} interfere with the use of
17411 @file{~/.ssh/authorized_keys}.
17412
17413 @item @code{log-level} (default: @code{'info})
17414 This is a symbol specifying the logging level: @code{quiet}, @code{fatal},
17415 @code{error}, @code{info}, @code{verbose}, @code{debug}, etc. See the man
17416 page for @file{sshd_config} for the full list of level names.
17417
17418 @item @code{extra-content} (default: @code{""})
17419 This field can be used to append arbitrary text to the configuration file. It
17420 is especially useful for elaborate configurations that cannot be expressed
17421 otherwise. This configuration, for example, would generally disable root
17422 logins, but permit them from one specific IP address:
17423
17424 @lisp
17425 (openssh-configuration
17426 (extra-content "\
17427 Match Address 192.168.0.1
17428 PermitRootLogin yes"))
17429 @end lisp
17430
17431 @end table
17432 @end deftp
17433
17434 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} dropbear-service [@var{config}]
17435 Run the @uref{https://matt.ucc.asn.au/dropbear/dropbear.html,Dropbear SSH
17436 daemon} with the given @var{config}, a @code{<dropbear-configuration>}
17437 object.
17438
17439 For example, to specify a Dropbear service listening on port 1234, add
17440 this call to the operating system's @code{services} field:
17441
17442 @lisp
17443 (dropbear-service (dropbear-configuration
17444 (port-number 1234)))
17445 @end lisp
17446 @end deffn
17447
17448 @deftp {Data Type} dropbear-configuration
17449 This data type represents the configuration of a Dropbear SSH daemon.
17450
17451 @table @asis
17452 @item @code{dropbear} (default: @var{dropbear})
17453 The Dropbear package to use.
17454
17455 @item @code{port-number} (default: 22)
17456 The TCP port where the daemon waits for incoming connections.
17457
17458 @item @code{syslog-output?} (default: @code{#t})
17459 Whether to enable syslog output.
17460
17461 @item @code{pid-file} (default: @code{"/var/run/dropbear.pid"})
17462 File name of the daemon's PID file.
17463
17464 @item @code{root-login?} (default: @code{#f})
17465 Whether to allow @code{root} logins.
17466
17467 @item @code{allow-empty-passwords?} (default: @code{#f})
17468 Whether to allow empty passwords.
17469
17470 @item @code{password-authentication?} (default: @code{#t})
17471 Whether to enable password-based authentication.
17472 @end table
17473 @end deftp
17474
17475 @cindex AutoSSH
17476 @deffn {Scheme Variable} autossh-service-type
17477 This is the type for the @uref{https://www.harding.motd.ca/autossh,
17478 AutoSSH} program that runs a copy of @command{ssh} and monitors it,
17479 restarting it as necessary should it die or stop passing traffic.
17480 AutoSSH can be run manually from the command-line by passing arguments
17481 to the binary @command{autossh} from the package @code{autossh}, but it
17482 can also be run as a Guix service. This latter use case is documented
17483 here.
17484
17485 AutoSSH can be used to forward local traffic to a remote machine using
17486 an SSH tunnel, and it respects the @file{~/.ssh/config} of the user it
17487 is run as.
17488
17489 For example, to specify a service running autossh as the user
17490 @code{pino} and forwarding all local connections to port @code{8081} to
17491 @code{remote:8081} using an SSH tunnel, add this call to the operating
17492 system's @code{services} field:
17493
17494 @lisp
17495 (service autossh-service-type
17496 (autossh-configuration
17497 (user "pino")
17498 (ssh-options (list "-T" "-N" "-L" "8081:localhost:8081" "remote.net"))))
17499 @end lisp
17500 @end deffn
17501
17502 @deftp {Data Type} autossh-configuration
17503 This data type represents the configuration of an AutoSSH service.
17504
17505 @table @asis
17506
17507 @item @code{user} (default @code{"autossh"})
17508 The user as which the AutoSSH service is to be run.
17509 This assumes that the specified user exists.
17510
17511 @item @code{poll} (default @code{600})
17512 Specifies the connection poll time in seconds.
17513
17514 @item @code{first-poll} (default @code{#f})
17515 Specifies how many seconds AutoSSH waits before the first connection
17516 test. After this first test, polling is resumed at the pace defined in
17517 @code{poll}. When set to @code{#f}, the first poll is not treated
17518 specially and will also use the connection poll specified in
17519 @code{poll}.
17520
17521 @item @code{gate-time} (default @code{30})
17522 Specifies how many seconds an SSH connection must be active before it is
17523 considered successful.
17524
17525 @item @code{log-level} (default @code{1})
17526 The log level, corresponding to the levels used by syslog---so @code{0}
17527 is the most silent while @code{7} is the chattiest.
17528
17529 @item @code{max-start} (default @code{#f})
17530 The maximum number of times SSH may be (re)started before AutoSSH exits.
17531 When set to @code{#f}, no maximum is configured and AutoSSH may restart indefinitely.
17532
17533 @item @code{message} (default @code{""})
17534 The message to append to the echo message sent when testing connections.
17535
17536 @item @code{port} (default @code{"0"})
17537 The ports used for monitoring the connection. When set to @code{"0"},
17538 monitoring is disabled. When set to @code{"@var{n}"} where @var{n} is
17539 a positive integer, ports @var{n} and @var{n}+1 are used for
17540 monitoring the connection, such that port @var{n} is the base
17541 monitoring port and @code{n+1} is the echo port. When set to
17542 @code{"@var{n}:@var{m}"} where @var{n} and @var{m} are positive
17543 integers, the ports @var{n} and @var{m} are used for monitoring the
17544 connection, such that port @var{n} is the base monitoring port and
17545 @var{m} is the echo port.
17546
17547 @item @code{ssh-options} (default @code{'()})
17548 The list of command-line arguments to pass to @command{ssh} when it is
17549 run. Options @option{-f} and @option{-M} are reserved for AutoSSH and
17550 may cause undefined behaviour.
17551
17552 @end table
17553 @end deftp
17554
17555 @cindex WebSSH
17556 @deffn {Scheme Variable} webssh-service-type
17557 This is the type for the @uref{https://webssh.huashengdun.org/, WebSSH}
17558 program that runs a web SSH client. WebSSH can be run manually from the
17559 command-line by passing arguments to the binary @command{wssh} from the
17560 package @code{webssh}, but it can also be run as a Guix service. This
17561 latter use case is documented here.
17562
17563 For example, to specify a service running WebSSH on loopback interface
17564 on port @code{8888} with reject policy with a list of allowed to
17565 connection hosts, and NGINX as a reverse-proxy to this service listening
17566 for HTTPS connection, add this call to the operating system's
17567 @code{services} field:
17568
17569 @lisp
17570 (service webssh-service-type
17571 (webssh-configuration (address "127.0.0.1")
17572 (port 8888)
17573 (policy 'reject)
17574 (known-hosts '("localhost ecdsa-sha2-nistp256 AAAA…"
17575 "127.0.0.1 ecdsa-sha2-nistp256 AAAA…"))))
17576
17577 (service nginx-service-type
17578 (nginx-configuration
17579 (server-blocks
17580 (list
17581 (nginx-server-configuration
17582 (inherit %webssh-configuration-nginx)
17583 (server-name '("webssh.example.com"))
17584 (listen '("443 ssl"))
17585 (ssl-certificate (letsencrypt-certificate "webssh.example.com"))
17586 (ssl-certificate-key (letsencrypt-key "webssh.example.com"))
17587 (locations
17588 (cons (nginx-location-configuration
17589 (uri "/.well-known")
17590 (body '("root /var/www;")))
17591 (nginx-server-configuration-locations %webssh-configuration-nginx))))))))
17592 @end lisp
17593 @end deffn
17594
17595 @deftp {Data Type} webssh-configuration
17596 Data type representing the configuration for @code{webssh-service}.
17597
17598 @table @asis
17599 @item @code{package} (default: @var{webssh})
17600 @code{webssh} package to use.
17601
17602 @item @code{user-name} (default: @var{"webssh"})
17603 User name or user ID that file transfers to and from that module should take
17604 place.
17605
17606 @item @code{group-name} (default: @var{"webssh"})
17607 Group name or group ID that will be used when accessing the module.
17608
17609 @item @code{address} (default: @var{#f})
17610 IP address on which @command{webssh} listens for incoming connections.
17611
17612 @item @code{port} (default: @var{8888})
17613 TCP port on which @command{webssh} listens for incoming connections.
17614
17615 @item @code{policy} (default: @var{#f})
17616 Connection policy. @var{reject} policy requires to specify @var{known-hosts}.
17617
17618 @item @code{known-hosts} (default: @var{'()})
17619 List of hosts which allowed for SSH connection from @command{webssh}.
17620
17621 @item @code{log-file} (default: @file{"/var/log/webssh.log"})
17622 Name of the file where @command{webssh} writes its log file.
17623
17624 @item @code{log-level} (default: @var{#f})
17625 Logging level.
17626
17627 @end table
17628 @end deftp
17629
17630 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %facebook-host-aliases
17631 This variable contains a string for use in @file{/etc/hosts}
17632 (@pxref{Host Names,,, libc, The GNU C Library Reference Manual}). Each
17633 line contains a entry that maps a known server name of the Facebook
17634 on-line service---e.g., @code{www.facebook.com}---to the local
17635 host---@code{127.0.0.1} or its IPv6 equivalent, @code{::1}.
17636
17637 This variable is typically used in the @code{hosts-file} field of an
17638 @code{operating-system} declaration (@pxref{operating-system Reference,
17639 @file{/etc/hosts}}):
17640
17641 @lisp
17642 (use-modules (gnu) (guix))
17643
17644 (operating-system
17645 (host-name "mymachine")
17646 ;; ...
17647 (hosts-file
17648 ;; Create a /etc/hosts file with aliases for "localhost"
17649 ;; and "mymachine", as well as for Facebook servers.
17650 (plain-file "hosts"
17651 (string-append (local-host-aliases host-name)
17652 %facebook-host-aliases))))
17653 @end lisp
17654
17655 This mechanism can prevent programs running locally, such as Web
17656 browsers, from accessing Facebook.
17657 @end defvr
17658
17659 The @code{(gnu services avahi)} provides the following definition.
17660
17661 @defvr {Scheme Variable} avahi-service-type
17662 This is the service that runs @command{avahi-daemon}, a system-wide
17663 mDNS/DNS-SD responder that allows for service discovery and
17664 ``zero-configuration'' host name lookups (see @uref{https://avahi.org/}).
17665 Its value must be an @code{avahi-configuration} record---see below.
17666
17667 This service extends the name service cache daemon (nscd) so that it can
17668 resolve @code{.local} host names using
17669 @uref{https://0pointer.de/lennart/projects/nss-mdns/, nss-mdns}. @xref{Name
17670 Service Switch}, for information on host name resolution.
17671
17672 Additionally, add the @var{avahi} package to the system profile so that
17673 commands such as @command{avahi-browse} are directly usable.
17674 @end defvr
17675
17676 @deftp {Data Type} avahi-configuration
17677 Data type representation the configuration for Avahi.
17678
17679 @table @asis
17680
17681 @item @code{host-name} (default: @code{#f})
17682 If different from @code{#f}, use that as the host name to
17683 publish for this machine; otherwise, use the machine's actual host name.
17684
17685 @item @code{publish?} (default: @code{#t})
17686 When true, allow host names and services to be published (broadcast) over the
17687 network.
17688
17689 @item @code{publish-workstation?} (default: @code{#t})
17690 When true, @command{avahi-daemon} publishes the machine's host name and IP
17691 address via mDNS on the local network. To view the host names published on
17692 your local network, you can run:
17693
17694 @example
17695 avahi-browse _workstation._tcp
17696 @end example
17697
17698 @item @code{wide-area?} (default: @code{#f})
17699 When true, DNS-SD over unicast DNS is enabled.
17700
17701 @item @code{ipv4?} (default: @code{#t})
17702 @itemx @code{ipv6?} (default: @code{#t})
17703 These fields determine whether to use IPv4/IPv6 sockets.
17704
17705 @item @code{domains-to-browse} (default: @code{'()})
17706 This is a list of domains to browse.
17707 @end table
17708 @end deftp
17709
17710 @deffn {Scheme Variable} openvswitch-service-type
17711 This is the type of the @uref{https://www.openvswitch.org, Open vSwitch}
17712 service, whose value should be an @code{openvswitch-configuration}
17713 object.
17714 @end deffn
17715
17716 @deftp {Data Type} openvswitch-configuration
17717 Data type representing the configuration of Open vSwitch, a multilayer
17718 virtual switch which is designed to enable massive network automation
17719 through programmatic extension.
17720
17721 @table @asis
17722 @item @code{package} (default: @var{openvswitch})
17723 Package object of the Open vSwitch.
17724
17725 @end table
17726 @end deftp
17727
17728 @defvr {Scheme Variable} pagekite-service-type
17729 This is the service type for the @uref{https://pagekite.net, PageKite} service,
17730 a tunneling solution for making localhost servers publicly visible, even from
17731 behind restrictive firewalls or NAT without forwarded ports. The value for
17732 this service type is a @code{pagekite-configuration} record.
17733
17734 Here's an example exposing the local HTTP and SSH daemons:
17735
17736 @lisp
17737 (service pagekite-service-type
17738 (pagekite-configuration
17739 (kites '("http:@@kitename:localhost:80:@@kitesecret"
17740 "raw/22:@@kitename:localhost:22:@@kitesecret"))
17741 (extra-file "/etc/pagekite.rc")))
17742 @end lisp
17743 @end defvr
17744
17745 @deftp {Data Type} pagekite-configuration
17746 Data type representing the configuration of PageKite.
17747
17748 @table @asis
17749 @item @code{package} (default: @var{pagekite})
17750 Package object of PageKite.
17751
17752 @item @code{kitename} (default: @code{#f})
17753 PageKite name for authenticating to the frontend server.
17754
17755 @item @code{kitesecret} (default: @code{#f})
17756 Shared secret for authenticating to the frontend server. You should probably
17757 put this inside @code{extra-file} instead.
17758
17759 @item @code{frontend} (default: @code{#f})
17760 Connect to the named PageKite frontend server instead of the
17761 @uref{https://pagekite.net,,pagekite.net} service.
17762
17763 @item @code{kites} (default: @code{'("http:@@kitename:localhost:80:@@kitesecret")})
17764 List of service kites to use. Exposes HTTP on port 80 by default. The format
17765 is @code{proto:kitename:host:port:secret}.
17766
17767 @item @code{extra-file} (default: @code{#f})
17768 Extra configuration file to read, which you are expected to create manually.
17769 Use this to add additional options and manage shared secrets out-of-band.
17770
17771 @end table
17772 @end deftp
17773
17774 @defvr {Scheme Variable} yggdrasil-service-type
17775 The service type for connecting to the @uref{https://yggdrasil-network.github.io/,
17776 Yggdrasil network}, an early-stage implementation of a fully end-to-end
17777 encrypted IPv6 network.
17778
17779 @quotation
17780 Yggdrasil provides name-independent routing with cryptographically generated
17781 addresses. Static addressing means you can keep the same address as long as
17782 you want, even if you move to a new location, or generate a new address (by
17783 generating new keys) whenever you want.
17784 @uref{https://yggdrasil-network.github.io/2018/07/28/addressing.html}
17785 @end quotation
17786
17787 Pass it a value of @code{yggdrasil-configuration} to connect it to public
17788 peers and/or local peers.
17789
17790 Here is an example using public peers and a static address. The static
17791 signing and encryption keys are defined in @file{/etc/yggdrasil-private.conf}
17792 (the default value for @code{config-file}).
17793
17794 @lisp
17795 ;; part of the operating-system declaration
17796 (service yggdrasil-service-type
17797 (yggdrasil-configuration
17798 (autoconf? #f) ;; use only the public peers
17799 (json-config
17800 ;; choose one from
17801 ;; https://github.com/yggdrasil-network/public-peers
17802 '((peers . #("tcp://1.2.3.4:1337"))))
17803 ;; /etc/yggdrasil-private.conf is the default value for config-file
17804 ))
17805 @end lisp
17806 @example
17807 # sample content for /etc/yggdrasil-private.conf
17808 @{
17809 # Your public encryption key. Your peers may ask you for this to put
17810 # into their AllowedEncryptionPublicKeys configuration.
17811 EncryptionPublicKey: 378dc5...
17812
17813 # Your private encryption key. DO NOT share this with anyone!
17814 EncryptionPrivateKey: 0777...
17815
17816 # Your public signing key. You should not ordinarily need to share
17817 # this with anyone.
17818 SigningPublicKey: e1664...
17819
17820 # Your private signing key. DO NOT share this with anyone!
17821 SigningPrivateKey: 0589d...
17822 @}
17823 @end example
17824 @end defvr
17825
17826 @deftp {Data Type} yggdrasil-configuration
17827 Data type representing the configuration of Yggdrasil.
17828
17829 @table @asis
17830 @item @code{package} (default: @code{yggdrasil})
17831 Package object of Yggdrasil.
17832
17833 @item @code{json-config} (default: @code{'()})
17834 Contents of @file{/etc/yggdrasil.conf}. Will be merged with
17835 @file{/etc/yggdrasil-private.conf}. Note that these settings are stored in
17836 the Guix store, which is readable to all users. @strong{Do not store your
17837 private keys in it}. See the output of @code{yggdrasil -genconf} for a
17838 quick overview of valid keys and their default values.
17839
17840 @item @code{autoconf?} (default: @code{#f})
17841 Whether to use automatic mode. Enabling it makes Yggdrasil use adynamic IP
17842 and peer with IPv6 neighbors.
17843
17844 @item @code{log-level} (default: @code{'info})
17845 How much detail to include in logs. Use @code{'debug} for more detail.
17846
17847 @item @code{log-to} (default: @code{'stdout})
17848 Where to send logs. By default, the service logs standard output to
17849 @file{/var/log/yggdrasil.log}. The alternative is @code{'syslog}, which
17850 sends output to the running syslog service.
17851
17852 @item @code{config-file} (default: @code{"/etc/yggdrasil-private.conf"})
17853 What HJSON file to load sensitive data from. This is where private keys
17854 should be stored, which are necessary to specify if you don't want a
17855 randomized address after each restart. Use @code{#f} to disable. Options
17856 defined in this file take precedence over @code{json-config}. Use the output
17857 of @code{yggdrasil -genconf} as a starting point. To configure a static
17858 address, delete everything except these options:
17859
17860 @itemize
17861 @item @code{EncryptionPublicKey}
17862 @item @code{EncryptionPrivateKey}
17863 @item @code{SigningPublicKey}
17864 @item @code{SigningPrivateKey}
17865 @end itemize
17866 @end table
17867 @end deftp
17868
17869 @cindex IPFS
17870 @defvr {Scheme Variable} ipfs-service-type
17871 The service type for connecting to the @uref{https://ipfs.io,IPFS network},
17872 a global, versioned, peer-to-peer file system. Pass it a
17873 @code{ipfs-configuration} to change the ports used for the gateway and API.
17874
17875 Here's an example configuration, using some non-standard ports:
17876
17877 @lisp
17878 (service ipfs-service-type
17879 (ipfs-configuration
17880 (gateway "/ip4/127.0.0.1/tcp/8880")
17881 (api "/ip4/127.0.0.1/tcp/8881")))
17882 @end lisp
17883 @end defvr
17884
17885 @deftp {Data Type} ipfs-configuration
17886 Data type representing the configuration of IPFS.
17887
17888 @table @asis
17889 @item @code{package} (default: @code{go-ipfs})
17890 Package object of IPFS.
17891
17892 @item @code{gateway} (default: @code{"/ip4/127.0.0.1/tcp/8082"})
17893 Address of the gateway, in ‘multiaddress’ format.
17894
17895 @item @code{api} (default: @code{"/ip4/127.0.0.1/tcp/5001"})
17896 Address of the API endpoint, in ‘multiaddress’ format.
17897 @end table
17898 @end deftp
17899
17900 @cindex keepalived
17901 @deffn {Scheme Variable} keepalived-service-type
17902 This is the type for the @uref{https://www.keepalived.org/, Keepalived}
17903 routing software, @command{keepalived}. Its value must be an
17904 @code{keepalived-configuration} record as in this example for master
17905 machine:
17906
17907 @lisp
17908 (service keepalived-service-type
17909 (keepalived-configuration
17910 (config-file (local-file "keepalived-master.conf"))))
17911 @end lisp
17912
17913 where @file{keepalived-master.conf}:
17914
17915 @example
17916 vrrp_instance my-group @{
17917 state MASTER
17918 interface enp9s0
17919 virtual_router_id 100
17920 priority 100
17921 unicast_peer @{ 10.0.0.2 @}
17922 virtual_ipaddress @{
17923 10.0.0.4/24
17924 @}
17925 @}
17926 @end example
17927
17928 and for backup machine:
17929
17930 @lisp
17931 (service keepalived-service-type
17932 (keepalived-configuration
17933 (config-file (local-file "keepalived-backup.conf"))))
17934 @end lisp
17935
17936 where @file{keepalived-backup.conf}:
17937
17938 @example
17939 vrrp_instance my-group @{
17940 state BACKUP
17941 interface enp9s0
17942 virtual_router_id 100
17943 priority 99
17944 unicast_peer @{ 10.0.0.3 @}
17945 virtual_ipaddress @{
17946 10.0.0.4/24
17947 @}
17948 @}
17949 @end example
17950 @end deffn
17951
17952 @node Unattended Upgrades
17953 @subsection Unattended Upgrades
17954
17955 @cindex unattended upgrades
17956 @cindex upgrades, unattended
17957 Guix provides a service to perform @emph{unattended upgrades}:
17958 periodically, the system automatically reconfigures itself from the
17959 latest Guix. Guix System has several properties that make unattended
17960 upgrades safe:
17961
17962 @itemize
17963 @item
17964 upgrades are transactional (either the upgrade succeeds or it fails, but
17965 you cannot end up with an ``in-between'' system state);
17966 @item
17967 the upgrade log is kept---you can view it with @command{guix system
17968 list-generations}---and you can roll back to any previous generation,
17969 should the upgraded system fail to behave as intended;
17970 @item
17971 channel code is authenticated so you know you can only run genuine code
17972 (@pxref{Channels});
17973 @item
17974 @command{guix system reconfigure} prevents downgrades, which makes it
17975 immune to @dfn{downgrade attacks}.
17976 @end itemize
17977
17978 To set up unattended upgrades, add an instance of
17979 @code{unattended-upgrade-service-type} like the one below to the list of
17980 your operating system services:
17981
17982 @lisp
17983 (service unattended-upgrade-service-type)
17984 @end lisp
17985
17986 The defaults above set up weekly upgrades: every Sunday at midnight.
17987 You do not need to provide the operating system configuration file: it
17988 uses @file{/run/current-system/configuration.scm}, which ensures it
17989 always uses your latest configuration---@pxref{provenance-service-type},
17990 for more information about this file.
17991
17992 There are several things that can be configured, in particular the
17993 periodicity and services (daemons) to be restarted upon completion.
17994 When the upgrade is successful, the service takes care of deleting
17995 system generations older that some threshold, as per @command{guix
17996 system delete-generations}. See the reference below for details.
17997
17998 To ensure that upgrades are actually happening, you can run
17999 @command{guix system describe}. To investigate upgrade failures, visit
18000 the unattended upgrade log file (see below).
18001
18002 @defvr {Scheme Variable} unattended-upgrade-service-type
18003 This is the service type for unattended upgrades. It sets up an mcron
18004 job (@pxref{Scheduled Job Execution}) that runs @command{guix system
18005 reconfigure} from the latest version of the specified channels.
18006
18007 Its value must be a @code{unattended-upgrade-configuration} record (see
18008 below).
18009 @end defvr
18010
18011 @deftp {Data Type} unattended-upgrade-configuration
18012 This data type represents the configuration of the unattended upgrade
18013 service. The following fields are available:
18014
18015 @table @asis
18016 @item @code{schedule} (default: @code{"30 01 * * 0"})
18017 This is the schedule of upgrades, expressed as a gexp containing an
18018 mcron job schedule (@pxref{Guile Syntax, mcron job specifications,,
18019 mcron, GNU@tie{}mcron}).
18020
18021 @item @code{channels} (default: @code{#~%default-channels})
18022 This gexp specifies the channels to use for the upgrade
18023 (@pxref{Channels}). By default, the tip of the official @code{guix}
18024 channel is used.
18025
18026 @item @code{operating-system-file} (default: @code{"/run/current-system/configuration.scm"})
18027 This field specifies the operating system configuration file to use.
18028 The default is to reuse the config file of the current configuration.
18029
18030 There are cases, though, where referring to
18031 @file{/run/current-system/configuration.scm} is not enough, for instance
18032 because that file refers to extra files (SSH public keys, extra
18033 configuration files, etc.) @i{via} @code{local-file} and similar
18034 constructs. For those cases, we recommend something along these lines:
18035
18036 @lisp
18037 (unattended-upgrade-configuration
18038 (operating-system-file
18039 (file-append (local-file "." "config-dir" #:recursive? #t)
18040 "/config.scm")))
18041 @end lisp
18042
18043 The effect here is to import all of the current directory into the
18044 store, and to refer to @file{config.scm} within that directory.
18045 Therefore, uses of @code{local-file} within @file{config.scm} will work
18046 as expected. @xref{G-Expressions}, for information about
18047 @code{local-file} and @code{file-append}.
18048
18049 @item @code{services-to-restart} (default: @code{'(mcron)})
18050 This field specifies the Shepherd services to restart when the upgrade
18051 completes.
18052
18053 Those services are restarted right away upon completion, as with
18054 @command{herd restart}, which ensures that the latest version is
18055 running---remember that by default @command{guix system reconfigure}
18056 only restarts services that are not currently running, which is
18057 conservative: it minimizes disruption but leaves outdated services
18058 running.
18059
18060 Use @command{herd status} to find out candidates for restarting.
18061 @xref{Services}, for general information about services. Common
18062 services to restart would include @code{ntpd} and @code{ssh-daemon}.
18063
18064 By default, the @code{mcron} service is restarted. This ensures that
18065 the latest version of the unattended upgrade job will be used next time.
18066
18067 @item @code{system-expiration} (default: @code{(* 3 30 24 3600)})
18068 This is the expiration time in seconds for system generations. System
18069 generations older that this amount of time are deleted with
18070 @command{guix system delete-generations} when an upgrade completes.
18071
18072 @quotation Note
18073 The unattended upgrade service does not run the garbage collector. You
18074 will probably want to set up your own mcron job to run @command{guix gc}
18075 periodically.
18076 @end quotation
18077
18078 @item @code{maximum-duration} (default: @code{3600})
18079 Maximum duration in seconds for the upgrade; past that time, the upgrade
18080 aborts.
18081
18082 This is primarily useful to ensure the upgrade does not end up
18083 rebuilding or re-downloading ``the world''.
18084
18085 @item @code{log-file} (default: @code{"/var/log/unattended-upgrade.log"})
18086 File where unattended upgrades are logged.
18087 @end table
18088 @end deftp
18089
18090 @node X Window
18091 @subsection X Window
18092
18093 @cindex X11
18094 @cindex X Window System
18095 @cindex login manager
18096 Support for the X Window graphical display system---specifically
18097 Xorg---is provided by the @code{(gnu services xorg)} module. Note that
18098 there is no @code{xorg-service} procedure. Instead, the X server is
18099 started by the @dfn{login manager}, by default the GNOME Display Manager (GDM).
18100
18101 @cindex GDM
18102 @cindex GNOME, login manager
18103 GDM of course allows users to log in into window managers and desktop
18104 environments other than GNOME; for those using GNOME, GDM is required for
18105 features such as automatic screen locking.
18106
18107 @cindex window manager
18108 To use X11, you must install at least one @dfn{window manager}---for
18109 example the @code{windowmaker} or @code{openbox} packages---preferably
18110 by adding it to the @code{packages} field of your operating system
18111 definition (@pxref{operating-system Reference, system-wide packages}).
18112
18113 @defvr {Scheme Variable} gdm-service-type
18114 This is the type for the @uref{https://wiki.gnome.org/Projects/GDM/, GNOME
18115 Desktop Manager} (GDM), a program that manages graphical display servers and
18116 handles graphical user logins. Its value must be a @code{gdm-configuration}
18117 (see below).
18118
18119 @cindex session types (X11)
18120 @cindex X11 session types
18121 GDM looks for @dfn{session types} described by the @file{.desktop} files in
18122 @file{/run/current-system/profile/share/xsessions} and allows users to choose
18123 a session from the log-in screen. Packages such as @code{gnome}, @code{xfce},
18124 and @code{i3} provide @file{.desktop} files; adding them to the system-wide
18125 set of packages automatically makes them available at the log-in screen.
18126
18127 In addition, @file{~/.xsession} files are honored. When available,
18128 @file{~/.xsession} must be an executable that starts a window manager
18129 and/or other X clients.
18130 @end defvr
18131
18132 @deftp {Data Type} gdm-configuration
18133 @table @asis
18134 @item @code{auto-login?} (default: @code{#f})
18135 @itemx @code{default-user} (default: @code{#f})
18136 When @code{auto-login?} is false, GDM presents a log-in screen.
18137
18138 When @code{auto-login?} is true, GDM logs in directly as
18139 @code{default-user}.
18140
18141 @item @code{debug?} (default: @code{#f})
18142 When true, GDM writes debug messages to its log.
18143
18144 @item @code{gnome-shell-assets} (default: ...)
18145 List of GNOME Shell assets needed by GDM: icon theme, fonts, etc.
18146
18147 @item @code{xorg-configuration} (default: @code{(xorg-configuration)})
18148 Configuration of the Xorg graphical server.
18149
18150 @item @code{xsession} (default: @code{(xinitrc)})
18151 Script to run before starting a X session.
18152
18153 @item @code{dbus-daemon} (default: @code{dbus-daemon-wrapper})
18154 File name of the @code{dbus-daemon} executable.
18155
18156 @item @code{gdm} (default: @code{gdm})
18157 The GDM package to use.
18158 @end table
18159 @end deftp
18160
18161 @defvr {Scheme Variable} slim-service-type
18162 This is the type for the SLiM graphical login manager for X11.
18163
18164 Like GDM, SLiM looks for session types described by @file{.desktop} files and
18165 allows users to choose a session from the log-in screen using @kbd{F1}. It
18166 also honors @file{~/.xsession} files.
18167
18168 Unlike GDM, SLiM does not spawn the user session on a different VT after
18169 logging in, which means that you can only start one graphical session. If you
18170 want to be able to run multiple graphical sessions at the same time you have
18171 to add multiple SLiM services to your system services. The following example
18172 shows how to replace the default GDM service with two SLiM services on tty7
18173 and tty8.
18174
18175 @lisp
18176 (use-modules (gnu services)
18177 (gnu services desktop)
18178 (gnu services xorg)
18179 (srfi srfi-1)) ;for 'remove'
18180
18181 (operating-system
18182 ;; ...
18183 (services (cons* (service slim-service-type (slim-configuration
18184 (display ":0")
18185 (vt "vt7")))
18186 (service slim-service-type (slim-configuration
18187 (display ":1")
18188 (vt "vt8")))
18189 (modify-services %desktop-services
18190 (delete gdm-service-type)))))
18191 @end lisp
18192
18193 @end defvr
18194
18195 @deftp {Data Type} slim-configuration
18196 Data type representing the configuration of @code{slim-service-type}.
18197
18198 @table @asis
18199 @item @code{allow-empty-passwords?} (default: @code{#t})
18200 Whether to allow logins with empty passwords.
18201
18202 @item @code{gnupg?} (default: @code{#f})
18203 If enabled, @code{pam-gnupg} will attempt to automatically unlock the
18204 user's GPG keys with the login password via @code{gpg-agent}. The
18205 keygrips of all keys to be unlocked should be written to
18206 @file{~/.pam-gnupg}, and can be queried with @code{gpg -K
18207 --with-keygrip}. Presetting passphrases must be enabled by adding
18208 @code{allow-preset-passphrase} in @file{~/.gnupg/gpg-agent.conf}.
18209
18210 @item @code{auto-login?} (default: @code{#f})
18211 @itemx @code{default-user} (default: @code{""})
18212 When @code{auto-login?} is false, SLiM presents a log-in screen.
18213
18214 When @code{auto-login?} is true, SLiM logs in directly as
18215 @code{default-user}.
18216
18217 @item @code{theme} (default: @code{%default-slim-theme})
18218 @itemx @code{theme-name} (default: @code{%default-slim-theme-name})
18219 The graphical theme to use and its name.
18220
18221 @item @code{auto-login-session} (default: @code{#f})
18222 If true, this must be the name of the executable to start as the default
18223 session---e.g., @code{(file-append windowmaker "/bin/windowmaker")}.
18224
18225 If false, a session described by one of the available @file{.desktop}
18226 files in @code{/run/current-system/profile} and @code{~/.guix-profile}
18227 will be used.
18228
18229 @quotation Note
18230 You must install at least one window manager in the system profile or in
18231 your user profile. Failing to do that, if @code{auto-login-session} is
18232 false, you will be unable to log in.
18233 @end quotation
18234
18235 @item @code{xorg-configuration} (default @code{(xorg-configuration)})
18236 Configuration of the Xorg graphical server.
18237
18238 @item @code{display} (default @code{":0"})
18239 The display on which to start the Xorg graphical server.
18240
18241 @item @code{vt} (default @code{"vt7"})
18242 The VT on which to start the Xorg graphical server.
18243
18244 @item @code{xauth} (default: @code{xauth})
18245 The XAuth package to use.
18246
18247 @item @code{shepherd} (default: @code{shepherd})
18248 The Shepherd package used when invoking @command{halt} and
18249 @command{reboot}.
18250
18251 @item @code{sessreg} (default: @code{sessreg})
18252 The sessreg package used in order to register the session.
18253
18254 @item @code{slim} (default: @code{slim})
18255 The SLiM package to use.
18256 @end table
18257 @end deftp
18258
18259 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %default-theme
18260 @defvrx {Scheme Variable} %default-theme-name
18261 The default SLiM theme and its name.
18262 @end defvr
18263
18264
18265 @deftp {Data Type} sddm-configuration
18266 This is the data type representing the SDDM service configuration.
18267
18268 @table @asis
18269 @item @code{display-server} (default: "x11")
18270 Select display server to use for the greeter. Valid values are
18271 @samp{"x11"} or @samp{"wayland"}.
18272
18273 @item @code{numlock} (default: "on")
18274 Valid values are @samp{"on"}, @samp{"off"} or @samp{"none"}.
18275
18276 @item @code{halt-command} (default @code{#~(string-apppend #$shepherd "/sbin/halt")})
18277 Command to run when halting.
18278
18279 @item @code{reboot-command} (default @code{#~(string-append #$shepherd "/sbin/reboot")})
18280 Command to run when rebooting.
18281
18282 @item @code{theme} (default "maldives")
18283 Theme to use. Default themes provided by SDDM are @samp{"elarun"},
18284 @samp{"maldives"} or @samp{"maya"}.
18285
18286 @item @code{themes-directory} (default "/run/current-system/profile/share/sddm/themes")
18287 Directory to look for themes.
18288
18289 @item @code{faces-directory} (default "/run/current-system/profile/share/sddm/faces")
18290 Directory to look for faces.
18291
18292 @item @code{default-path} (default "/run/current-system/profile/bin")
18293 Default PATH to use.
18294
18295 @item @code{minimum-uid} (default: 1000)
18296 Minimum UID displayed in SDDM and allowed for log-in.
18297
18298 @item @code{maximum-uid} (default: 2000)
18299 Maximum UID to display in SDDM.
18300
18301 @item @code{remember-last-user?} (default #t)
18302 Remember last user.
18303
18304 @item @code{remember-last-session?} (default #t)
18305 Remember last session.
18306
18307 @item @code{hide-users} (default "")
18308 Usernames to hide from SDDM greeter.
18309
18310 @item @code{hide-shells} (default @code{#~(string-append #$shadow "/sbin/nologin")})
18311 Users with shells listed will be hidden from the SDDM greeter.
18312
18313 @item @code{session-command} (default @code{#~(string-append #$sddm "/share/sddm/scripts/wayland-session")})
18314 Script to run before starting a wayland session.
18315
18316 @item @code{sessions-directory} (default "/run/current-system/profile/share/wayland-sessions")
18317 Directory to look for desktop files starting wayland sessions.
18318
18319 @item @code{xorg-configuration} (default @code{(xorg-configuration)})
18320 Configuration of the Xorg graphical server.
18321
18322 @item @code{xauth-path} (default @code{#~(string-append #$xauth "/bin/xauth")})
18323 Path to xauth.
18324
18325 @item @code{xephyr-path} (default @code{#~(string-append #$xorg-server "/bin/Xephyr")})
18326 Path to Xephyr.
18327
18328 @item @code{xdisplay-start} (default @code{#~(string-append #$sddm "/share/sddm/scripts/Xsetup")})
18329 Script to run after starting xorg-server.
18330
18331 @item @code{xdisplay-stop} (default @code{#~(string-append #$sddm "/share/sddm/scripts/Xstop")})
18332 Script to run before stopping xorg-server.
18333
18334 @item @code{xsession-command} (default: @code{xinitrc})
18335 Script to run before starting a X session.
18336
18337 @item @code{xsessions-directory} (default: "/run/current-system/profile/share/xsessions")
18338 Directory to look for desktop files starting X sessions.
18339
18340 @item @code{minimum-vt} (default: 7)
18341 Minimum VT to use.
18342
18343 @item @code{auto-login-user} (default "")
18344 User to use for auto-login.
18345
18346 @item @code{auto-login-session} (default "")
18347 Desktop file to use for auto-login.
18348
18349 @item @code{relogin?} (default #f)
18350 Relogin after logout.
18351
18352 @end table
18353 @end deftp
18354
18355 @cindex login manager
18356 @cindex X11 login
18357 @defvr {Scheme Variable} sddm-service-type
18358 This is the type of the service to run the
18359 @uref{https://github.com/sddm/sddm,SDDM display manager}. Its value
18360 must be a @code{sddm-configuration} record (see below).
18361
18362 Here's an example use:
18363
18364 @lisp
18365 (service sddm-service-type
18366 (sddm-configuration
18367 (auto-login-user "alice")
18368 (auto-login-session "xfce.desktop")))
18369 @end lisp
18370 @end defvr
18371
18372 @deftp {Data Type} sddm-configuration
18373 This data type represents the configuration of the SDDM login manager.
18374 The available fields are:
18375
18376 @table @asis
18377 @item @code{sddm} (default: @code{sddm})
18378 The SDDM package to use.
18379
18380 @item @code{display-server} (default: @code{"x11"})
18381 This must be either @code{"x11"} or @code{"wayland"}.
18382
18383 @c FIXME: Add more fields.
18384
18385 @item @code{auto-login-user} (default: @code{""})
18386 If non-empty, this is the user account under which to log in
18387 automatically.
18388
18389 @item @code{auto-login-session} (default: @code{""})
18390 If non-empty, this is the @file{.desktop} file name to use as the
18391 auto-login session.
18392 @end table
18393 @end deftp
18394
18395 @cindex Xorg, configuration
18396 @deftp {Data Type} xorg-configuration
18397 This data type represents the configuration of the Xorg graphical display
18398 server. Note that there is no Xorg service; instead, the X server is started
18399 by a ``display manager'' such as GDM, SDDM, and SLiM@. Thus, the configuration
18400 of these display managers aggregates an @code{xorg-configuration} record.
18401
18402 @table @asis
18403 @item @code{modules} (default: @code{%default-xorg-modules})
18404 This is a list of @dfn{module packages} loaded by the Xorg
18405 server---e.g., @code{xf86-video-vesa}, @code{xf86-input-keyboard}, and so on.
18406
18407 @item @code{fonts} (default: @code{%default-xorg-fonts})
18408 This is a list of font directories to add to the server's @dfn{font path}.
18409
18410 @item @code{drivers} (default: @code{'()})
18411 This must be either the empty list, in which case Xorg chooses a graphics
18412 driver automatically, or a list of driver names that will be tried in this
18413 order---e.g., @code{("modesetting" "vesa")}.
18414
18415 @item @code{resolutions} (default: @code{'()})
18416 When @code{resolutions} is the empty list, Xorg chooses an appropriate screen
18417 resolution. Otherwise, it must be a list of resolutions---e.g., @code{((1024
18418 768) (640 480))}.
18419
18420 @cindex keyboard layout, for Xorg
18421 @cindex keymap, for Xorg
18422 @item @code{keyboard-layout} (default: @code{#f})
18423 If this is @code{#f}, Xorg uses the default keyboard layout---usually US
18424 English (``qwerty'') for a 105-key PC keyboard.
18425
18426 Otherwise this must be a @code{keyboard-layout} object specifying the keyboard
18427 layout in use when Xorg is running. @xref{Keyboard Layout}, for more
18428 information on how to specify the keyboard layout.
18429
18430 @item @code{extra-config} (default: @code{'()})
18431 This is a list of strings or objects appended to the configuration file. It
18432 is used to pass extra text to be added verbatim to the configuration file.
18433
18434 @item @code{server} (default: @code{xorg-server})
18435 This is the package providing the Xorg server.
18436
18437 @item @code{server-arguments} (default: @code{%default-xorg-server-arguments})
18438 This is the list of command-line arguments to pass to the X server. The
18439 default is @code{-nolisten tcp}.
18440 @end table
18441 @end deftp
18442
18443 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} set-xorg-configuration @var{config} @
18444 [@var{login-manager-service-type}]
18445 Tell the log-in manager (of type @var{login-manager-service-type}) to use
18446 @var{config}, an @code{<xorg-configuration>} record.
18447
18448 Since the Xorg configuration is embedded in the log-in manager's
18449 configuration---e.g., @code{gdm-configuration}---this procedure provides a
18450 shorthand to set the Xorg configuration.
18451 @end deffn
18452
18453 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} xorg-start-command [@var{config}]
18454 Return a @code{startx} script in which the modules, fonts, etc. specified
18455 in @var{config}, are available. The result should be used in place of
18456 @code{startx}.
18457
18458 Usually the X server is started by a login manager.
18459 @end deffn
18460
18461
18462 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} screen-locker-service @var{package} [@var{program}]
18463 Add @var{package}, a package for a screen locker or screen saver whose
18464 command is @var{program}, to the set of setuid programs and add a PAM entry
18465 for it. For example:
18466
18467 @lisp
18468 (screen-locker-service xlockmore "xlock")
18469 @end lisp
18470
18471 makes the good ol' XlockMore usable.
18472 @end deffn
18473
18474
18475 @node Printing Services
18476 @subsection Printing Services
18477
18478 @cindex printer support with CUPS
18479 The @code{(gnu services cups)} module provides a Guix service definition
18480 for the CUPS printing service. To add printer support to a Guix
18481 system, add a @code{cups-service} to the operating system definition:
18482
18483 @deffn {Scheme Variable} cups-service-type
18484 The service type for the CUPS print server. Its value should be a valid
18485 CUPS configuration (see below). To use the default settings, simply
18486 write:
18487 @lisp
18488 (service cups-service-type)
18489 @end lisp
18490 @end deffn
18491
18492 The CUPS configuration controls the basic things about your CUPS
18493 installation: what interfaces it listens on, what to do if a print job
18494 fails, how much logging to do, and so on. To actually add a printer,
18495 you have to visit the @url{http://localhost:631} URL, or use a tool such
18496 as GNOME's printer configuration services. By default, configuring a
18497 CUPS service will generate a self-signed certificate if needed, for
18498 secure connections to the print server.
18499
18500 Suppose you want to enable the Web interface of CUPS and also add
18501 support for Epson printers @i{via} the @code{epson-inkjet-printer-escpr}
18502 package and for HP printers @i{via} the @code{hplip-minimal} package.
18503 You can do that directly, like this (you need to use the
18504 @code{(gnu packages cups)} module):
18505
18506 @lisp
18507 (service cups-service-type
18508 (cups-configuration
18509 (web-interface? #t)
18510 (extensions
18511 (list cups-filters epson-inkjet-printer-escpr hplip-minimal))))
18512 @end lisp
18513
18514 Note: If you wish to use the Qt5 based GUI which comes with the hplip
18515 package then it is suggested that you install the @code{hplip} package,
18516 either in your OS configuration file or as your user.
18517
18518 The available configuration parameters follow. Each parameter
18519 definition is preceded by its type; for example, @samp{string-list foo}
18520 indicates that the @code{foo} parameter should be specified as a list of
18521 strings. There is also a way to specify the configuration as a string,
18522 if you have an old @code{cupsd.conf} file that you want to port over
18523 from some other system; see the end for more details.
18524
18525 @c The following documentation was initially generated by
18526 @c (generate-documentation) in (gnu services cups). Manually maintained
18527 @c documentation is better, so we shouldn't hesitate to edit below as
18528 @c needed. However if the change you want to make to this documentation
18529 @c can be done in an automated way, it's probably easier to change
18530 @c (generate-documentation) than to make it below and have to deal with
18531 @c the churn as CUPS updates.
18532
18533
18534 Available @code{cups-configuration} fields are:
18535
18536 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} package cups
18537 The CUPS package.
18538 @end deftypevr
18539
18540 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} package-list extensions (default: @code{(list brlaser cups-filters epson-inkjet-printer-escpr foomatic-filters hplip-minimal splix)})
18541 Drivers and other extensions to the CUPS package.
18542 @end deftypevr
18543
18544 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} files-configuration files-configuration
18545 Configuration of where to write logs, what directories to use for print
18546 spools, and related privileged configuration parameters.
18547
18548 Available @code{files-configuration} fields are:
18549
18550 @deftypevr {@code{files-configuration} parameter} log-location access-log
18551 Defines the access log filename. Specifying a blank filename disables
18552 access log generation. The value @code{stderr} causes log entries to be
18553 sent to the standard error file when the scheduler is running in the
18554 foreground, or to the system log daemon when run in the background. The
18555 value @code{syslog} causes log entries to be sent to the system log
18556 daemon. The server name may be included in filenames using the string
18557 @code{%s}, as in @code{/var/log/cups/%s-access_log}.
18558
18559 Defaults to @samp{"/var/log/cups/access_log"}.
18560 @end deftypevr
18561
18562 @deftypevr {@code{files-configuration} parameter} file-name cache-dir
18563 Where CUPS should cache data.
18564
18565 Defaults to @samp{"/var/cache/cups"}.
18566 @end deftypevr
18567
18568 @deftypevr {@code{files-configuration} parameter} string config-file-perm
18569 Specifies the permissions for all configuration files that the scheduler
18570 writes.
18571
18572 Note that the permissions for the printers.conf file are currently
18573 masked to only allow access from the scheduler user (typically root).
18574 This is done because printer device URIs sometimes contain sensitive
18575 authentication information that should not be generally known on the
18576 system. There is no way to disable this security feature.
18577
18578 Defaults to @samp{"0640"}.
18579 @end deftypevr
18580
18581 @deftypevr {@code{files-configuration} parameter} log-location error-log
18582 Defines the error log filename. Specifying a blank filename disables
18583 error log generation. The value @code{stderr} causes log entries to be
18584 sent to the standard error file when the scheduler is running in the
18585 foreground, or to the system log daemon when run in the background. The
18586 value @code{syslog} causes log entries to be sent to the system log
18587 daemon. The server name may be included in filenames using the string
18588 @code{%s}, as in @code{/var/log/cups/%s-error_log}.
18589
18590 Defaults to @samp{"/var/log/cups/error_log"}.
18591 @end deftypevr
18592
18593 @deftypevr {@code{files-configuration} parameter} string fatal-errors
18594 Specifies which errors are fatal, causing the scheduler to exit. The
18595 kind strings are:
18596
18597 @table @code
18598 @item none
18599 No errors are fatal.
18600
18601 @item all
18602 All of the errors below are fatal.
18603
18604 @item browse
18605 Browsing initialization errors are fatal, for example failed connections
18606 to the DNS-SD daemon.
18607
18608 @item config
18609 Configuration file syntax errors are fatal.
18610
18611 @item listen
18612 Listen or Port errors are fatal, except for IPv6 failures on the
18613 loopback or @code{any} addresses.
18614
18615 @item log
18616 Log file creation or write errors are fatal.
18617
18618 @item permissions
18619 Bad startup file permissions are fatal, for example shared TLS
18620 certificate and key files with world-read permissions.
18621 @end table
18622
18623 Defaults to @samp{"all -browse"}.
18624 @end deftypevr
18625
18626 @deftypevr {@code{files-configuration} parameter} boolean file-device?
18627 Specifies whether the file pseudo-device can be used for new printer
18628 queues. The URI @uref{file:///dev/null} is always allowed.
18629
18630 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
18631 @end deftypevr
18632
18633 @deftypevr {@code{files-configuration} parameter} string group
18634 Specifies the group name or ID that will be used when executing external
18635 programs.
18636
18637 Defaults to @samp{"lp"}.
18638 @end deftypevr
18639
18640 @deftypevr {@code{files-configuration} parameter} string log-file-perm
18641 Specifies the permissions for all log files that the scheduler writes.
18642
18643 Defaults to @samp{"0644"}.
18644 @end deftypevr
18645
18646 @deftypevr {@code{files-configuration} parameter} log-location page-log
18647 Defines the page log filename. Specifying a blank filename disables
18648 page log generation. The value @code{stderr} causes log entries to be
18649 sent to the standard error file when the scheduler is running in the
18650 foreground, or to the system log daemon when run in the background. The
18651 value @code{syslog} causes log entries to be sent to the system log
18652 daemon. The server name may be included in filenames using the string
18653 @code{%s}, as in @code{/var/log/cups/%s-page_log}.
18654
18655 Defaults to @samp{"/var/log/cups/page_log"}.
18656 @end deftypevr
18657
18658 @deftypevr {@code{files-configuration} parameter} string remote-root
18659 Specifies the username that is associated with unauthenticated accesses
18660 by clients claiming to be the root user. The default is @code{remroot}.
18661
18662 Defaults to @samp{"remroot"}.
18663 @end deftypevr
18664
18665 @deftypevr {@code{files-configuration} parameter} file-name request-root
18666 Specifies the directory that contains print jobs and other HTTP request
18667 data.
18668
18669 Defaults to @samp{"/var/spool/cups"}.
18670 @end deftypevr
18671
18672 @deftypevr {@code{files-configuration} parameter} sandboxing sandboxing
18673 Specifies the level of security sandboxing that is applied to print
18674 filters, backends, and other child processes of the scheduler; either
18675 @code{relaxed} or @code{strict}. This directive is currently only
18676 used/supported on macOS.
18677
18678 Defaults to @samp{strict}.
18679 @end deftypevr
18680
18681 @deftypevr {@code{files-configuration} parameter} file-name server-keychain
18682 Specifies the location of TLS certificates and private keys. CUPS will
18683 look for public and private keys in this directory: @file{.crt} files
18684 for PEM-encoded certificates and corresponding @file{.key} files for
18685 PEM-encoded private keys.
18686
18687 Defaults to @samp{"/etc/cups/ssl"}.
18688 @end deftypevr
18689
18690 @deftypevr {@code{files-configuration} parameter} file-name server-root
18691 Specifies the directory containing the server configuration files.
18692
18693 Defaults to @samp{"/etc/cups"}.
18694 @end deftypevr
18695
18696 @deftypevr {@code{files-configuration} parameter} boolean sync-on-close?
18697 Specifies whether the scheduler calls fsync(2) after writing
18698 configuration or state files.
18699
18700 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
18701 @end deftypevr
18702
18703 @deftypevr {@code{files-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list system-group
18704 Specifies the group(s) to use for @code{@@SYSTEM} group authentication.
18705 @end deftypevr
18706
18707 @deftypevr {@code{files-configuration} parameter} file-name temp-dir
18708 Specifies the directory where temporary files are stored.
18709
18710 Defaults to @samp{"/var/spool/cups/tmp"}.
18711 @end deftypevr
18712
18713 @deftypevr {@code{files-configuration} parameter} string user
18714 Specifies the user name or ID that is used when running external
18715 programs.
18716
18717 Defaults to @samp{"lp"}.
18718 @end deftypevr
18719
18720 @deftypevr {@code{files-configuration} parameter} string set-env
18721 Set the specified environment variable to be passed to child processes.
18722
18723 Defaults to @samp{"variable value"}.
18724 @end deftypevr
18725 @end deftypevr
18726
18727 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} access-log-level access-log-level
18728 Specifies the logging level for the AccessLog file. The @code{config}
18729 level logs when printers and classes are added, deleted, or modified and
18730 when configuration files are accessed or updated. The @code{actions}
18731 level logs when print jobs are submitted, held, released, modified, or
18732 canceled, and any of the conditions for @code{config}. The @code{all}
18733 level logs all requests.
18734
18735 Defaults to @samp{actions}.
18736 @end deftypevr
18737
18738 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} boolean auto-purge-jobs?
18739 Specifies whether to purge job history data automatically when it is no
18740 longer required for quotas.
18741
18742 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
18743 @end deftypevr
18744
18745 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} comma-separated-string-list browse-dns-sd-sub-types
18746 Specifies a list of DNS-SD sub-types to advertise for each shared printer.
18747 For example, @samp{"_cups" "_print"} will tell network clients that both
18748 CUPS sharing and IPP Everywhere are supported.
18749
18750 Defaults to @samp{"_cups"}.
18751 @end deftypevr
18752
18753 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} browse-local-protocols browse-local-protocols
18754 Specifies which protocols to use for local printer sharing.
18755
18756 Defaults to @samp{dnssd}.
18757 @end deftypevr
18758
18759 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} boolean browse-web-if?
18760 Specifies whether the CUPS web interface is advertised.
18761
18762 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
18763 @end deftypevr
18764
18765 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} boolean browsing?
18766 Specifies whether shared printers are advertised.
18767
18768 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
18769 @end deftypevr
18770
18771 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} string classification
18772 Specifies the security classification of the server. Any valid banner
18773 name can be used, including @samp{"classified"}, @samp{"confidential"},
18774 @samp{"secret"}, @samp{"topsecret"}, and @samp{"unclassified"}, or the
18775 banner can be omitted to disable secure printing functions.
18776
18777 Defaults to @samp{""}.
18778 @end deftypevr
18779
18780 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} boolean classify-override?
18781 Specifies whether users may override the classification (cover page) of
18782 individual print jobs using the @code{job-sheets} option.
18783
18784 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
18785 @end deftypevr
18786
18787 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} default-auth-type default-auth-type
18788 Specifies the default type of authentication to use.
18789
18790 Defaults to @samp{Basic}.
18791 @end deftypevr
18792
18793 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} default-encryption default-encryption
18794 Specifies whether encryption will be used for authenticated requests.
18795
18796 Defaults to @samp{Required}.
18797 @end deftypevr
18798
18799 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} string default-language
18800 Specifies the default language to use for text and web content.
18801
18802 Defaults to @samp{"en"}.
18803 @end deftypevr
18804
18805 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} string default-paper-size
18806 Specifies the default paper size for new print queues. @samp{"Auto"}
18807 uses a locale-specific default, while @samp{"None"} specifies there is
18808 no default paper size. Specific size names are typically
18809 @samp{"Letter"} or @samp{"A4"}.
18810
18811 Defaults to @samp{"Auto"}.
18812 @end deftypevr
18813
18814 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} string default-policy
18815 Specifies the default access policy to use.
18816
18817 Defaults to @samp{"default"}.
18818 @end deftypevr
18819
18820 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} boolean default-shared?
18821 Specifies whether local printers are shared by default.
18822
18823 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
18824 @end deftypevr
18825
18826 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer dirty-clean-interval
18827 Specifies the delay for updating of configuration and state files, in
18828 seconds. A value of 0 causes the update to happen as soon as possible,
18829 typically within a few milliseconds.
18830
18831 Defaults to @samp{30}.
18832 @end deftypevr
18833
18834 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} error-policy error-policy
18835 Specifies what to do when an error occurs. Possible values are
18836 @code{abort-job}, which will discard the failed print job;
18837 @code{retry-job}, which will retry the job at a later time;
18838 @code{retry-current-job}, which retries the failed job immediately; and
18839 @code{stop-printer}, which stops the printer.
18840
18841 Defaults to @samp{stop-printer}.
18842 @end deftypevr
18843
18844 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer filter-limit
18845 Specifies the maximum cost of filters that are run concurrently, which
18846 can be used to minimize disk, memory, and CPU resource problems. A
18847 limit of 0 disables filter limiting. An average print to a
18848 non-PostScript printer needs a filter limit of about 200. A PostScript
18849 printer needs about half that (100). Setting the limit below these
18850 thresholds will effectively limit the scheduler to printing a single job
18851 at any time.
18852
18853 Defaults to @samp{0}.
18854 @end deftypevr
18855
18856 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer filter-nice
18857 Specifies the scheduling priority of filters that are run to print a
18858 job. The nice value ranges from 0, the highest priority, to 19, the
18859 lowest priority.
18860
18861 Defaults to @samp{0}.
18862 @end deftypevr
18863
18864 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} host-name-lookups host-name-lookups
18865 Specifies whether to do reverse lookups on connecting clients. The
18866 @code{double} setting causes @code{cupsd} to verify that the hostname
18867 resolved from the address matches one of the addresses returned for that
18868 hostname. Double lookups also prevent clients with unregistered
18869 addresses from connecting to your server. Only set this option to
18870 @code{#t} or @code{double} if absolutely required.
18871
18872 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
18873 @end deftypevr
18874
18875 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer job-kill-delay
18876 Specifies the number of seconds to wait before killing the filters and
18877 backend associated with a canceled or held job.
18878
18879 Defaults to @samp{30}.
18880 @end deftypevr
18881
18882 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer job-retry-interval
18883 Specifies the interval between retries of jobs in seconds. This is
18884 typically used for fax queues but can also be used with normal print
18885 queues whose error policy is @code{retry-job} or
18886 @code{retry-current-job}.
18887
18888 Defaults to @samp{30}.
18889 @end deftypevr
18890
18891 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer job-retry-limit
18892 Specifies the number of retries that are done for jobs. This is
18893 typically used for fax queues but can also be used with normal print
18894 queues whose error policy is @code{retry-job} or
18895 @code{retry-current-job}.
18896
18897 Defaults to @samp{5}.
18898 @end deftypevr
18899
18900 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} boolean keep-alive?
18901 Specifies whether to support HTTP keep-alive connections.
18902
18903 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
18904 @end deftypevr
18905
18906 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer limit-request-body
18907 Specifies the maximum size of print files, IPP requests, and HTML form
18908 data. A limit of 0 disables the limit check.
18909
18910 Defaults to @samp{0}.
18911 @end deftypevr
18912
18913 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} multiline-string-list listen
18914 Listens on the specified interfaces for connections. Valid values are
18915 of the form @var{address}:@var{port}, where @var{address} is either an
18916 IPv6 address enclosed in brackets, an IPv4 address, or @code{*} to
18917 indicate all addresses. Values can also be file names of local UNIX
18918 domain sockets. The Listen directive is similar to the Port directive
18919 but allows you to restrict access to specific interfaces or networks.
18920 @end deftypevr
18921
18922 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer listen-back-log
18923 Specifies the number of pending connections that will be allowed. This
18924 normally only affects very busy servers that have reached the MaxClients
18925 limit, but can also be triggered by large numbers of simultaneous
18926 connections. When the limit is reached, the operating system will
18927 refuse additional connections until the scheduler can accept the pending
18928 ones.
18929
18930 Defaults to @samp{128}.
18931 @end deftypevr
18932
18933 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} location-access-control-list location-access-controls
18934 Specifies a set of additional access controls.
18935
18936 Available @code{location-access-controls} fields are:
18937
18938 @deftypevr {@code{location-access-controls} parameter} file-name path
18939 Specifies the URI path to which the access control applies.
18940 @end deftypevr
18941
18942 @deftypevr {@code{location-access-controls} parameter} access-control-list access-controls
18943 Access controls for all access to this path, in the same format as the
18944 @code{access-controls} of @code{operation-access-control}.
18945
18946 Defaults to @samp{()}.
18947 @end deftypevr
18948
18949 @deftypevr {@code{location-access-controls} parameter} method-access-control-list method-access-controls
18950 Access controls for method-specific access to this path.
18951
18952 Defaults to @samp{()}.
18953
18954 Available @code{method-access-controls} fields are:
18955
18956 @deftypevr {@code{method-access-controls} parameter} boolean reverse?
18957 If @code{#t}, apply access controls to all methods except the listed
18958 methods. Otherwise apply to only the listed methods.
18959
18960 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
18961 @end deftypevr
18962
18963 @deftypevr {@code{method-access-controls} parameter} method-list methods
18964 Methods to which this access control applies.
18965
18966 Defaults to @samp{()}.
18967 @end deftypevr
18968
18969 @deftypevr {@code{method-access-controls} parameter} access-control-list access-controls
18970 Access control directives, as a list of strings. Each string should be
18971 one directive, such as @samp{"Order allow,deny"}.
18972
18973 Defaults to @samp{()}.
18974 @end deftypevr
18975 @end deftypevr
18976 @end deftypevr
18977
18978 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer log-debug-history
18979 Specifies the number of debugging messages that are retained for logging
18980 if an error occurs in a print job. Debug messages are logged regardless
18981 of the LogLevel setting.
18982
18983 Defaults to @samp{100}.
18984 @end deftypevr
18985
18986 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} log-level log-level
18987 Specifies the level of logging for the ErrorLog file. The value
18988 @code{none} stops all logging while @code{debug2} logs everything.
18989
18990 Defaults to @samp{info}.
18991 @end deftypevr
18992
18993 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} log-time-format log-time-format
18994 Specifies the format of the date and time in the log files. The value
18995 @code{standard} logs whole seconds while @code{usecs} logs microseconds.
18996
18997 Defaults to @samp{standard}.
18998 @end deftypevr
18999
19000 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer max-clients
19001 Specifies the maximum number of simultaneous clients that are allowed by
19002 the scheduler.
19003
19004 Defaults to @samp{100}.
19005 @end deftypevr
19006
19007 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer max-clients-per-host
19008 Specifies the maximum number of simultaneous clients that are allowed
19009 from a single address.
19010
19011 Defaults to @samp{100}.
19012 @end deftypevr
19013
19014 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer max-copies
19015 Specifies the maximum number of copies that a user can print of each
19016 job.
19017
19018 Defaults to @samp{9999}.
19019 @end deftypevr
19020
19021 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer max-hold-time
19022 Specifies the maximum time a job may remain in the @code{indefinite}
19023 hold state before it is canceled. A value of 0 disables cancellation of
19024 held jobs.
19025
19026 Defaults to @samp{0}.
19027 @end deftypevr
19028
19029 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer max-jobs
19030 Specifies the maximum number of simultaneous jobs that are allowed. Set
19031 to 0 to allow an unlimited number of jobs.
19032
19033 Defaults to @samp{500}.
19034 @end deftypevr
19035
19036 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer max-jobs-per-printer
19037 Specifies the maximum number of simultaneous jobs that are allowed per
19038 printer. A value of 0 allows up to MaxJobs jobs per printer.
19039
19040 Defaults to @samp{0}.
19041 @end deftypevr
19042
19043 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer max-jobs-per-user
19044 Specifies the maximum number of simultaneous jobs that are allowed per
19045 user. A value of 0 allows up to MaxJobs jobs per user.
19046
19047 Defaults to @samp{0}.
19048 @end deftypevr
19049
19050 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer max-job-time
19051 Specifies the maximum time a job may take to print before it is
19052 canceled, in seconds. Set to 0 to disable cancellation of ``stuck'' jobs.
19053
19054 Defaults to @samp{10800}.
19055 @end deftypevr
19056
19057 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer max-log-size
19058 Specifies the maximum size of the log files before they are rotated, in
19059 bytes. The value 0 disables log rotation.
19060
19061 Defaults to @samp{1048576}.
19062 @end deftypevr
19063
19064 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer multiple-operation-timeout
19065 Specifies the maximum amount of time to allow between files in a
19066 multiple file print job, in seconds.
19067
19068 Defaults to @samp{300}.
19069 @end deftypevr
19070
19071 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} string page-log-format
19072 Specifies the format of PageLog lines. Sequences beginning with percent
19073 (@samp{%}) characters are replaced with the corresponding information,
19074 while all other characters are copied literally. The following percent
19075 sequences are recognized:
19076
19077 @table @samp
19078 @item %%
19079 insert a single percent character
19080
19081 @item %@{name@}
19082 insert the value of the specified IPP attribute
19083
19084 @item %C
19085 insert the number of copies for the current page
19086
19087 @item %P
19088 insert the current page number
19089
19090 @item %T
19091 insert the current date and time in common log format
19092
19093 @item %j
19094 insert the job ID
19095
19096 @item %p
19097 insert the printer name
19098
19099 @item %u
19100 insert the username
19101 @end table
19102
19103 A value of the empty string disables page logging. The string @code{%p
19104 %u %j %T %P %C %@{job-billing@} %@{job-originating-host-name@}
19105 %@{job-name@} %@{media@} %@{sides@}} creates a page log with the
19106 standard items.
19107
19108 Defaults to @samp{""}.
19109 @end deftypevr
19110
19111 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} environment-variables environment-variables
19112 Passes the specified environment variable(s) to child processes; a list
19113 of strings.
19114
19115 Defaults to @samp{()}.
19116 @end deftypevr
19117
19118 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} policy-configuration-list policies
19119 Specifies named access control policies.
19120
19121 Available @code{policy-configuration} fields are:
19122
19123 @deftypevr {@code{policy-configuration} parameter} string name
19124 Name of the policy.
19125 @end deftypevr
19126
19127 @deftypevr {@code{policy-configuration} parameter} string job-private-access
19128 Specifies an access list for a job's private values. @code{@@ACL} maps
19129 to the printer's requesting-user-name-allowed or
19130 requesting-user-name-denied values. @code{@@OWNER} maps to the job's
19131 owner. @code{@@SYSTEM} maps to the groups listed for the
19132 @code{system-group} field of the @code{files-configuration},
19133 which is reified into the @code{cups-files.conf(5)} file. Other
19134 possible elements of the access list include specific user names, and
19135 @code{@@@var{group}} to indicate members of a specific group. The
19136 access list may also be simply @code{all} or @code{default}.
19137
19138 Defaults to @samp{"@@OWNER @@SYSTEM"}.
19139 @end deftypevr
19140
19141 @deftypevr {@code{policy-configuration} parameter} string job-private-values
19142 Specifies the list of job values to make private, or @code{all},
19143 @code{default}, or @code{none}.
19144
19145 Defaults to @samp{"job-name job-originating-host-name
19146 job-originating-user-name phone"}.
19147 @end deftypevr
19148
19149 @deftypevr {@code{policy-configuration} parameter} string subscription-private-access
19150 Specifies an access list for a subscription's private values.
19151 @code{@@ACL} maps to the printer's requesting-user-name-allowed or
19152 requesting-user-name-denied values. @code{@@OWNER} maps to the job's
19153 owner. @code{@@SYSTEM} maps to the groups listed for the
19154 @code{system-group} field of the @code{files-configuration},
19155 which is reified into the @code{cups-files.conf(5)} file. Other
19156 possible elements of the access list include specific user names, and
19157 @code{@@@var{group}} to indicate members of a specific group. The
19158 access list may also be simply @code{all} or @code{default}.
19159
19160 Defaults to @samp{"@@OWNER @@SYSTEM"}.
19161 @end deftypevr
19162
19163 @deftypevr {@code{policy-configuration} parameter} string subscription-private-values
19164 Specifies the list of job values to make private, or @code{all},
19165 @code{default}, or @code{none}.
19166
19167 Defaults to @samp{"notify-events notify-pull-method notify-recipient-uri
19168 notify-subscriber-user-name notify-user-data"}.
19169 @end deftypevr
19170
19171 @deftypevr {@code{policy-configuration} parameter} operation-access-control-list access-controls
19172 Access control by IPP operation.
19173
19174 Defaults to @samp{()}.
19175 @end deftypevr
19176 @end deftypevr
19177
19178 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} boolean-or-non-negative-integer preserve-job-files
19179 Specifies whether job files (documents) are preserved after a job is
19180 printed. If a numeric value is specified, job files are preserved for
19181 the indicated number of seconds after printing. Otherwise a boolean
19182 value applies indefinitely.
19183
19184 Defaults to @samp{86400}.
19185 @end deftypevr
19186
19187 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} boolean-or-non-negative-integer preserve-job-history
19188 Specifies whether the job history is preserved after a job is printed.
19189 If a numeric value is specified, the job history is preserved for the
19190 indicated number of seconds after printing. If @code{#t}, the job
19191 history is preserved until the MaxJobs limit is reached.
19192
19193 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
19194 @end deftypevr
19195
19196 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer reload-timeout
19197 Specifies the amount of time to wait for job completion before
19198 restarting the scheduler.
19199
19200 Defaults to @samp{30}.
19201 @end deftypevr
19202
19203 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} string rip-cache
19204 Specifies the maximum amount of memory to use when converting documents
19205 into bitmaps for a printer.
19206
19207 Defaults to @samp{"128m"}.
19208 @end deftypevr
19209
19210 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} string server-admin
19211 Specifies the email address of the server administrator.
19212
19213 Defaults to @samp{"root@@localhost.localdomain"}.
19214 @end deftypevr
19215
19216 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} host-name-list-or-* server-alias
19217 The ServerAlias directive is used for HTTP Host header validation when
19218 clients connect to the scheduler from external interfaces. Using the
19219 special name @code{*} can expose your system to known browser-based DNS
19220 rebinding attacks, even when accessing sites through a firewall. If the
19221 auto-discovery of alternate names does not work, we recommend listing
19222 each alternate name with a ServerAlias directive instead of using
19223 @code{*}.
19224
19225 Defaults to @samp{*}.
19226 @end deftypevr
19227
19228 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} string server-name
19229 Specifies the fully-qualified host name of the server.
19230
19231 Defaults to @samp{"localhost"}.
19232 @end deftypevr
19233
19234 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} server-tokens server-tokens
19235 Specifies what information is included in the Server header of HTTP
19236 responses. @code{None} disables the Server header. @code{ProductOnly}
19237 reports @code{CUPS}. @code{Major} reports @code{CUPS 2}. @code{Minor}
19238 reports @code{CUPS 2.0}. @code{Minimal} reports @code{CUPS 2.0.0}.
19239 @code{OS} reports @code{CUPS 2.0.0 (@var{uname})} where @var{uname} is
19240 the output of the @code{uname} command. @code{Full} reports @code{CUPS
19241 2.0.0 (@var{uname}) IPP/2.0}.
19242
19243 Defaults to @samp{Minimal}.
19244 @end deftypevr
19245
19246 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} multiline-string-list ssl-listen
19247 Listens on the specified interfaces for encrypted connections. Valid
19248 values are of the form @var{address}:@var{port}, where @var{address} is
19249 either an IPv6 address enclosed in brackets, an IPv4 address, or
19250 @code{*} to indicate all addresses.
19251
19252 Defaults to @samp{()}.
19253 @end deftypevr
19254
19255 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} ssl-options ssl-options
19256 Sets encryption options. By default, CUPS only supports encryption
19257 using TLS v1.0 or higher using known secure cipher suites. Security is
19258 reduced when @code{Allow} options are used, and enhanced when @code{Deny}
19259 options are used. The @code{AllowRC4} option enables the 128-bit RC4 cipher
19260 suites, which are required for some older clients. The @code{AllowSSL3} option
19261 enables SSL v3.0, which is required for some older clients that do not support
19262 TLS v1.0. The @code{DenyCBC} option disables all CBC cipher suites. The
19263 @code{DenyTLS1.0} option disables TLS v1.0 support - this sets the minimum
19264 protocol version to TLS v1.1.
19265
19266 Defaults to @samp{()}.
19267 @end deftypevr
19268
19269 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} boolean strict-conformance?
19270 Specifies whether the scheduler requires clients to strictly adhere to
19271 the IPP specifications.
19272
19273 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
19274 @end deftypevr
19275
19276 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer timeout
19277 Specifies the HTTP request timeout, in seconds.
19278
19279 Defaults to @samp{300}.
19280
19281 @end deftypevr
19282
19283 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} boolean web-interface?
19284 Specifies whether the web interface is enabled.
19285
19286 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
19287 @end deftypevr
19288
19289 At this point you're probably thinking ``oh dear, Guix manual, I like
19290 you but you can stop already with the configuration options''. Indeed.
19291 However, one more point: it could be that you have an existing
19292 @code{cupsd.conf} that you want to use. In that case, you can pass an
19293 @code{opaque-cups-configuration} as the configuration of a
19294 @code{cups-service-type}.
19295
19296 Available @code{opaque-cups-configuration} fields are:
19297
19298 @deftypevr {@code{opaque-cups-configuration} parameter} package cups
19299 The CUPS package.
19300 @end deftypevr
19301
19302 @deftypevr {@code{opaque-cups-configuration} parameter} string cupsd.conf
19303 The contents of the @code{cupsd.conf}, as a string.
19304 @end deftypevr
19305
19306 @deftypevr {@code{opaque-cups-configuration} parameter} string cups-files.conf
19307 The contents of the @code{cups-files.conf} file, as a string.
19308 @end deftypevr
19309
19310 For example, if your @code{cupsd.conf} and @code{cups-files.conf} are in
19311 strings of the same name, you could instantiate a CUPS service like
19312 this:
19313
19314 @lisp
19315 (service cups-service-type
19316 (opaque-cups-configuration
19317 (cupsd.conf cupsd.conf)
19318 (cups-files.conf cups-files.conf)))
19319 @end lisp
19320
19321
19322 @node Desktop Services
19323 @subsection Desktop Services
19324
19325 The @code{(gnu services desktop)} module provides services that are
19326 usually useful in the context of a ``desktop'' setup---that is, on a
19327 machine running a graphical display server, possibly with graphical user
19328 interfaces, etc. It also defines services that provide specific desktop
19329 environments like GNOME, Xfce or MATE.
19330
19331 To simplify things, the module defines a variable containing the set of
19332 services that users typically expect on a machine with a graphical
19333 environment and networking:
19334
19335 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %desktop-services
19336 This is a list of services that builds upon @code{%base-services} and
19337 adds or adjusts services for a typical ``desktop'' setup.
19338
19339 In particular, it adds a graphical login manager (@pxref{X Window,
19340 @code{gdm-service-type}}), screen lockers, a network management tool
19341 (@pxref{Networking Services, @code{network-manager-service-type}}) with modem
19342 support (@pxref{Networking Services, @code{modem-manager-service-type}}),
19343 energy and color management services, the @code{elogind} login and seat
19344 manager, the Polkit privilege service, the GeoClue location service, the
19345 AccountsService daemon that allows authorized users change system passwords,
19346 an NTP client (@pxref{Networking Services}), the Avahi daemon, and has the
19347 name service switch service configured to be able to use @code{nss-mdns}
19348 (@pxref{Name Service Switch, mDNS}).
19349 @end defvr
19350
19351 The @code{%desktop-services} variable can be used as the @code{services}
19352 field of an @code{operating-system} declaration (@pxref{operating-system
19353 Reference, @code{services}}).
19354
19355 Additionally, the @code{gnome-desktop-service-type},
19356 @code{xfce-desktop-service}, @code{mate-desktop-service-type},
19357 @code{lxqt-desktop-service-type} and @code{enlightenment-desktop-service-type}
19358 procedures can add GNOME, Xfce, MATE and/or Enlightenment to a system. To
19359 ``add GNOME'' means that system-level services like the backlight adjustment
19360 helpers and the power management utilities are added to the system, extending
19361 @code{polkit} and @code{dbus} appropriately, allowing GNOME to operate with
19362 elevated privileges on a limited number of special-purpose system interfaces.
19363 Additionally, adding a service made by @code{gnome-desktop-service-type} adds
19364 the GNOME metapackage to the system profile. Likewise, adding the Xfce
19365 service not only adds the @code{xfce} metapackage to the system profile, but
19366 it also gives the Thunar file manager the ability to open a ``root-mode'' file
19367 management window, if the user authenticates using the administrator's
19368 password via the standard polkit graphical interface. To ``add MATE'' means
19369 that @code{polkit} and @code{dbus} are extended appropriately, allowing MATE
19370 to operate with elevated privileges on a limited number of special-purpose
19371 system interfaces. Additionally, adding a service of type
19372 @code{mate-desktop-service-type} adds the MATE metapackage to the system
19373 profile. ``Adding Enlightenment'' means that @code{dbus} is extended
19374 appropriately, and several of Enlightenment's binaries are set as setuid,
19375 allowing Enlightenment's screen locker and other functionality to work as
19376 expected.
19377
19378 The desktop environments in Guix use the Xorg display server by
19379 default. If you'd like to use the newer display server protocol
19380 called Wayland, you need to use the @code{sddm-service} instead of
19381 GDM as the graphical login manager. You should then
19382 select the ``GNOME (Wayland)'' session in SDDM@. Alternatively you can
19383 also try starting GNOME on Wayland manually from a TTY with the
19384 command ``XDG_SESSION_TYPE=wayland exec dbus-run-session
19385 gnome-session``. Currently only GNOME has support for Wayland.
19386
19387 @defvr {Scheme Variable} gnome-desktop-service-type
19388 This is the type of the service that adds the @uref{https://www.gnome.org,
19389 GNOME} desktop environment. Its value is a @code{gnome-desktop-configuration}
19390 object (see below).
19391
19392 This service adds the @code{gnome} package to the system profile, and extends
19393 polkit with the actions from @code{gnome-settings-daemon}.
19394 @end defvr
19395
19396 @deftp {Data Type} gnome-desktop-configuration
19397 Configuration record for the GNOME desktop environment.
19398
19399 @table @asis
19400 @item @code{gnome} (default: @code{gnome})
19401 The GNOME package to use.
19402 @end table
19403 @end deftp
19404
19405 @defvr {Scheme Variable} xfce-desktop-service-type
19406 This is the type of a service to run the @uref{Xfce, https://xfce.org/}
19407 desktop environment. Its value is an @code{xfce-desktop-configuration} object
19408 (see below).
19409
19410 This service adds the @code{xfce} package to the system profile, and
19411 extends polkit with the ability for @code{thunar} to manipulate the file
19412 system as root from within a user session, after the user has authenticated
19413 with the administrator's password.
19414
19415 Note that @code{xfce4-panel} and its plugin packages should be installed in
19416 the same profile to ensure compatibility. When using this service, you should
19417 add extra plugins (@code{xfce4-whiskermenu-plugin},
19418 @code{xfce4-weather-plugin}, etc.) to the @code{packages} field of your
19419 @code{operating-system}.
19420 @end defvr
19421
19422 @deftp {Data Type} xfce-desktop-configuration
19423 Configuration record for the Xfce desktop environment.
19424
19425 @table @asis
19426 @item @code{xfce} (default: @code{xfce})
19427 The Xfce package to use.
19428 @end table
19429 @end deftp
19430
19431 @deffn {Scheme Variable} mate-desktop-service-type
19432 This is the type of the service that runs the @uref{https://mate-desktop.org/,
19433 MATE desktop environment}. Its value is a @code{mate-desktop-configuration}
19434 object (see below).
19435
19436 This service adds the @code{mate} package to the system
19437 profile, and extends polkit with the actions from
19438 @code{mate-settings-daemon}.
19439 @end deffn
19440
19441 @deftp {Data Type} mate-desktop-configuration
19442 Configuration record for the MATE desktop environment.
19443
19444 @table @asis
19445 @item @code{mate} (default: @code{mate})
19446 The MATE package to use.
19447 @end table
19448 @end deftp
19449
19450 @deffn {Scheme Variable} lxqt-desktop-service-type
19451 This is the type of the service that runs the @uref{https://lxqt-project.org,
19452 LXQt desktop environment}. Its value is a @code{lxqt-desktop-configuration}
19453 object (see below).
19454
19455 This service adds the @code{lxqt} package to the system
19456 profile.
19457 @end deffn
19458
19459 @deftp {Data Type} lxqt-desktop-configuration
19460 Configuration record for the LXQt desktop environment.
19461
19462 @table @asis
19463 @item @code{lxqt} (default: @code{lxqt})
19464 The LXQT package to use.
19465 @end table
19466 @end deftp
19467
19468 @deffn {Scheme Variable} enlightenment-desktop-service-type
19469 Return a service that adds the @code{enlightenment} package to the system
19470 profile, and extends dbus with actions from @code{efl}.
19471 @end deffn
19472
19473 @deftp {Data Type} enlightenment-desktop-service-configuration
19474 @table @asis
19475 @item @code{enlightenment} (default: @code{enlightenment})
19476 The enlightenment package to use.
19477 @end table
19478 @end deftp
19479
19480 Because the GNOME, Xfce and MATE desktop services pull in so many packages,
19481 the default @code{%desktop-services} variable doesn't include any of
19482 them by default. To add GNOME, Xfce or MATE, just @code{cons} them onto
19483 @code{%desktop-services} in the @code{services} field of your
19484 @code{operating-system}:
19485
19486 @lisp
19487 (use-modules (gnu))
19488 (use-service-modules desktop)
19489 (operating-system
19490 ...
19491 ;; cons* adds items to the list given as its last argument.
19492 (services (cons* (service gnome-desktop-service-type)
19493 (service xfce-desktop-service)
19494 %desktop-services))
19495 ...)
19496 @end lisp
19497
19498 These desktop environments will then be available as options in the
19499 graphical login window.
19500
19501 The actual service definitions included in @code{%desktop-services} and
19502 provided by @code{(gnu services dbus)} and @code{(gnu services desktop)}
19503 are described below.
19504
19505 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} dbus-service [#:dbus @var{dbus}] [#:services '()]
19506 Return a service that runs the ``system bus'', using @var{dbus}, with
19507 support for @var{services}.
19508
19509 @uref{https://dbus.freedesktop.org/, D-Bus} is an inter-process communication
19510 facility. Its system bus is used to allow system services to communicate
19511 and to be notified of system-wide events.
19512
19513 @var{services} must be a list of packages that provide an
19514 @file{etc/dbus-1/system.d} directory containing additional D-Bus configuration
19515 and policy files. For example, to allow avahi-daemon to use the system bus,
19516 @var{services} must be equal to @code{(list avahi)}.
19517 @end deffn
19518
19519 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} elogind-service [#:config @var{config}]
19520 Return a service that runs the @code{elogind} login and
19521 seat management daemon. @uref{https://github.com/elogind/elogind,
19522 Elogind} exposes a D-Bus interface that can be used to know which users
19523 are logged in, know what kind of sessions they have open, suspend the
19524 system, inhibit system suspend, reboot the system, and other tasks.
19525
19526 Elogind handles most system-level power events for a computer, for
19527 example suspending the system when a lid is closed, or shutting it down
19528 when the power button is pressed.
19529
19530 The @var{config} keyword argument specifies the configuration for
19531 elogind, and should be the result of an @code{(elogind-configuration
19532 (@var{parameter} @var{value})...)} invocation. Available parameters and
19533 their default values are:
19534
19535 @table @code
19536 @item kill-user-processes?
19537 @code{#f}
19538 @item kill-only-users
19539 @code{()}
19540 @item kill-exclude-users
19541 @code{("root")}
19542 @item inhibit-delay-max-seconds
19543 @code{5}
19544 @item handle-power-key
19545 @code{poweroff}
19546 @item handle-suspend-key
19547 @code{suspend}
19548 @item handle-hibernate-key
19549 @code{hibernate}
19550 @item handle-lid-switch
19551 @code{suspend}
19552 @item handle-lid-switch-docked
19553 @code{ignore}
19554 @item handle-lid-switch-external-power
19555 @code{ignore}
19556 @item power-key-ignore-inhibited?
19557 @code{#f}
19558 @item suspend-key-ignore-inhibited?
19559 @code{#f}
19560 @item hibernate-key-ignore-inhibited?
19561 @code{#f}
19562 @item lid-switch-ignore-inhibited?
19563 @code{#t}
19564 @item holdoff-timeout-seconds
19565 @code{30}
19566 @item idle-action
19567 @code{ignore}
19568 @item idle-action-seconds
19569 @code{(* 30 60)}
19570 @item runtime-directory-size-percent
19571 @code{10}
19572 @item runtime-directory-size
19573 @code{#f}
19574 @item remove-ipc?
19575 @code{#t}
19576 @item suspend-state
19577 @code{("mem" "standby" "freeze")}
19578 @item suspend-mode
19579 @code{()}
19580 @item hibernate-state
19581 @code{("disk")}
19582 @item hibernate-mode
19583 @code{("platform" "shutdown")}
19584 @item hybrid-sleep-state
19585 @code{("disk")}
19586 @item hybrid-sleep-mode
19587 @code{("suspend" "platform" "shutdown")}
19588 @end table
19589 @end deffn
19590
19591 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} accountsservice-service @
19592 [#:accountsservice @var{accountsservice}]
19593 Return a service that runs AccountsService, a system service that can
19594 list available accounts, change their passwords, and so on.
19595 AccountsService integrates with PolicyKit to enable unprivileged users
19596 to acquire the capability to modify their system configuration.
19597 @uref{https://www.freedesktop.org/wiki/Software/AccountsService/, the
19598 accountsservice web site} for more information.
19599
19600 The @var{accountsservice} keyword argument is the @code{accountsservice}
19601 package to expose as a service.
19602 @end deffn
19603
19604 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} polkit-service @
19605 [#:polkit @var{polkit}]
19606 Return a service that runs the
19607 @uref{https://www.freedesktop.org/wiki/Software/polkit/, Polkit privilege
19608 management service}, which allows system administrators to grant access to
19609 privileged operations in a structured way. By querying the Polkit service, a
19610 privileged system component can know when it should grant additional
19611 capabilities to ordinary users. For example, an ordinary user can be granted
19612 the capability to suspend the system if the user is logged in locally.
19613 @end deffn
19614
19615 @defvr {Scheme Variable} polkit-wheel-service
19616 Service that adds the @code{wheel} group as admins to the Polkit
19617 service. This makes it so that users in the @code{wheel} group are queried
19618 for their own passwords when performing administrative actions instead of
19619 @code{root}'s, similar to the behaviour used by @code{sudo}.
19620 @end defvr
19621
19622 @defvr {Scheme Variable} upower-service-type
19623 Service that runs @uref{https://upower.freedesktop.org/, @command{upowerd}}, a
19624 system-wide monitor for power consumption and battery levels, with the given
19625 configuration settings.
19626
19627 It implements the @code{org.freedesktop.UPower} D-Bus interface, and is
19628 notably used by GNOME.
19629 @end defvr
19630
19631 @deftp {Data Type} upower-configuration
19632 Data type representation the configuration for UPower.
19633
19634 @table @asis
19635
19636 @item @code{upower} (default: @var{upower})
19637 Package to use for @code{upower}.
19638
19639 @item @code{watts-up-pro?} (default: @code{#f})
19640 Enable the Watts Up Pro device.
19641
19642 @item @code{poll-batteries?} (default: @code{#t})
19643 Enable polling the kernel for battery level changes.
19644
19645 @item @code{ignore-lid?} (default: @code{#f})
19646 Ignore the lid state, this can be useful if it's incorrect on a device.
19647
19648 @item @code{use-percentage-for-policy?} (default: @code{#f})
19649 Whether battery percentage based policy should be used. The default is to use
19650 the time left, change to @code{#t} to use the percentage.
19651
19652 @item @code{percentage-low} (default: @code{10})
19653 When @code{use-percentage-for-policy?} is @code{#t}, this sets the percentage
19654 at which the battery is considered low.
19655
19656 @item @code{percentage-critical} (default: @code{3})
19657 When @code{use-percentage-for-policy?} is @code{#t}, this sets the percentage
19658 at which the battery is considered critical.
19659
19660 @item @code{percentage-action} (default: @code{2})
19661 When @code{use-percentage-for-policy?} is @code{#t}, this sets the percentage
19662 at which action will be taken.
19663
19664 @item @code{time-low} (default: @code{1200})
19665 When @code{use-time-for-policy?} is @code{#f}, this sets the time remaining in
19666 seconds at which the battery is considered low.
19667
19668 @item @code{time-critical} (default: @code{300})
19669 When @code{use-time-for-policy?} is @code{#f}, this sets the time remaining in
19670 seconds at which the battery is considered critical.
19671
19672 @item @code{time-action} (default: @code{120})
19673 When @code{use-time-for-policy?} is @code{#f}, this sets the time remaining in
19674 seconds at which action will be taken.
19675
19676 @item @code{critical-power-action} (default: @code{'hybrid-sleep})
19677 The action taken when @code{percentage-action} or @code{time-action} is
19678 reached (depending on the configuration of @code{use-percentage-for-policy?}).
19679
19680 Possible values are:
19681
19682 @itemize @bullet
19683 @item
19684 @code{'power-off}
19685
19686 @item
19687 @code{'hibernate}
19688
19689 @item
19690 @code{'hybrid-sleep}.
19691 @end itemize
19692
19693 @end table
19694 @end deftp
19695
19696 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} udisks-service [#:udisks @var{udisks}]
19697 Return a service for @uref{https://udisks.freedesktop.org/docs/latest/,
19698 UDisks}, a @dfn{disk management} daemon that provides user interfaces
19699 with notifications and ways to mount/unmount disks. Programs that talk
19700 to UDisks include the @command{udisksctl} command, part of UDisks, and
19701 GNOME Disks. Note that Udisks relies on the @command{mount} command, so
19702 it will only be able to use the file-system utilities installed in the
19703 system profile. For example if you want to be able to mount NTFS
19704 file-systems in read and write fashion, you'll need to have
19705 @code{ntfs-3g} installed system-wide.
19706 @end deffn
19707
19708 @deffn {Scheme Variable} colord-service-type
19709 This is the type of the service that runs @command{colord}, a system
19710 service with a D-Bus
19711 interface to manage the color profiles of input and output devices such as
19712 screens and scanners. It is notably used by the GNOME Color Manager graphical
19713 tool. See @uref{https://www.freedesktop.org/software/colord/, the colord web
19714 site} for more information.
19715 @end deffn
19716
19717 @cindex scanner access
19718 @defvr {Scheme Variable} sane-service-type
19719 This service provides access to scanners @i{via}
19720 @uref{http://www.sane-project.org, SANE} by installing the necessary
19721 udev rules. It is included in @code{%desktop-services} (@pxref{Desktop
19722 Services}) and relies by default on @code{sane-backends-minimal} package
19723 (see below) for hardware support.
19724 @end defvr
19725
19726 @defvr {Scheme Variable} sane-backends-minimal
19727 The default package which the @code{sane-service-type} installs. It
19728 supports many recent scanners.
19729 @end defvr
19730
19731 @defvr {Scheme Variable} sane-backends
19732 This package includes support for all scanners that
19733 @code{sane-backends-minimal} supports, plus older Hewlett-Packard
19734 scanners supported by @code{hplip} package. In order to use this on
19735 a system which relies on @code{%desktop-services}, you may use
19736 @code{modify-services} (@pxref{Service Reference,
19737 @code{modify-services}}) as illustrated below:
19738
19739 @lisp
19740 (use-modules (gnu))
19741 (use-service-modules
19742 @dots{}
19743 desktop)
19744 (use-package-modules
19745 @dots{}
19746 scanner)
19747
19748 (define %my-desktop-services
19749 ;; List of desktop services that supports a broader range of scanners.
19750 (modify-services %desktop-services
19751 (sane-service-type _ => sane-backends)))
19752
19753 (operating-system
19754 @dots{}
19755 (services %my-desktop-services)
19756 @end lisp
19757 @end defvr
19758
19759 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} geoclue-application name [#:allowed? #t] [#:system? #f] [#:users '()]
19760 Return a configuration allowing an application to access GeoClue
19761 location data. @var{name} is the Desktop ID of the application, without
19762 the @code{.desktop} part. If @var{allowed?} is true, the application
19763 will have access to location information by default. The boolean
19764 @var{system?} value indicates whether an application is a system component
19765 or not. Finally @var{users} is a list of UIDs of all users for which
19766 this application is allowed location info access. An empty users list
19767 means that all users are allowed.
19768 @end deffn
19769
19770 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %standard-geoclue-applications
19771 The standard list of well-known GeoClue application configurations,
19772 granting authority to the GNOME date-and-time utility to ask for the
19773 current location in order to set the time zone, and allowing the
19774 IceCat and Epiphany web browsers to request location information.
19775 IceCat and Epiphany both query the user before allowing a web page to
19776 know the user's location.
19777 @end defvr
19778
19779 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} geoclue-service [#:colord @var{colord}] @
19780 [#:whitelist '()] @
19781 [#:wifi-geolocation-url "https://location.services.mozilla.com/v1/geolocate?key=geoclue"] @
19782 [#:submit-data? #f]
19783 [#:wifi-submission-url "https://location.services.mozilla.com/v1/submit?key=geoclue"] @
19784 [#:submission-nick "geoclue"] @
19785 [#:applications %standard-geoclue-applications]
19786 Return a service that runs the GeoClue location service. This service
19787 provides a D-Bus interface to allow applications to request access to a
19788 user's physical location, and optionally to add information to online
19789 location databases. See
19790 @uref{https://wiki.freedesktop.org/www/Software/GeoClue/, the GeoClue
19791 web site} for more information.
19792 @end deffn
19793
19794 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} bluetooth-service [#:bluez @var{bluez}] @
19795 [@w{#:auto-enable? #f}]
19796 Return a service that runs the @command{bluetoothd} daemon, which
19797 manages all the Bluetooth devices and provides a number of D-Bus
19798 interfaces. When AUTO-ENABLE? is true, the bluetooth controller is
19799 powered automatically at boot, which can be useful when using a
19800 bluetooth keyboard or mouse.
19801
19802 Users need to be in the @code{lp} group to access the D-Bus service.
19803 @end deffn
19804
19805 @defvr {Scheme Variable} gnome-keyring-service-type
19806 This is the type of the service that adds the
19807 @uref{https://wiki.gnome.org/Projects/GnomeKeyring, GNOME Keyring}. Its
19808 value is a @code{gnome-keyring-configuration} object (see below).
19809
19810 This service adds the @code{gnome-keyring} package to the system profile
19811 and extends PAM with entries using @code{pam_gnome_keyring.so}, unlocking
19812 a user's login keyring when they log in or setting its password with passwd.
19813 @end defvr
19814
19815 @deftp {Data Type} gnome-keyring-configuration
19816 Configuration record for the GNOME Keyring service.
19817
19818 @table @asis
19819 @item @code{keyring} (default: @code{gnome-keyring})
19820 The GNOME keyring package to use.
19821
19822 @item @code{pam-services}
19823 A list of @code{(@var{service} . @var{kind})} pairs denoting PAM
19824 services to extend, where @var{service} is the name of an existing
19825 service to extend and @var{kind} is one of @code{login} or
19826 @code{passwd}.
19827
19828 If @code{login} is given, it adds an optional
19829 @code{pam_gnome_keyring.so} to the auth block without arguments and to
19830 the session block with @code{auto_start}. If @code{passwd} is given, it
19831 adds an optional @code{pam_gnome_keyring.so} to the password block
19832 without arguments.
19833
19834 By default, this field contains ``gdm-password'' with the value @code{login}
19835 and ``passwd'' is with the value @code{passwd}.
19836 @end table
19837 @end deftp
19838
19839
19840 @node Sound Services
19841 @subsection Sound Services
19842
19843 @cindex sound support
19844 @cindex ALSA
19845 @cindex PulseAudio, sound support
19846
19847 The @code{(gnu services sound)} module provides a service to configure the
19848 Advanced Linux Sound Architecture (ALSA) system, which makes PulseAudio the
19849 preferred ALSA output driver.
19850
19851 @deffn {Scheme Variable} alsa-service-type
19852 This is the type for the @uref{https://alsa-project.org/, Advanced Linux Sound
19853 Architecture} (ALSA) system, which generates the @file{/etc/asound.conf}
19854 configuration file. The value for this type is a @command{alsa-configuration}
19855 record as in this example:
19856
19857 @lisp
19858 (service alsa-service-type)
19859 @end lisp
19860
19861 See below for details about @code{alsa-configuration}.
19862 @end deffn
19863
19864 @deftp {Data Type} alsa-configuration
19865 Data type representing the configuration for @code{alsa-service}.
19866
19867 @table @asis
19868 @item @code{alsa-plugins} (default: @var{alsa-plugins})
19869 @code{alsa-plugins} package to use.
19870
19871 @item @code{pulseaudio?} (default: @var{#t})
19872 Whether ALSA applications should transparently be made to use the
19873 @uref{https://www.pulseaudio.org/, PulseAudio} sound server.
19874
19875 Using PulseAudio allows you to run several sound-producing applications
19876 at the same time and to individual control them @i{via}
19877 @command{pavucontrol}, among other things.
19878
19879 @item @code{extra-options} (default: @var{""})
19880 String to append to the @file{/etc/asound.conf} file.
19881
19882 @end table
19883 @end deftp
19884
19885 Individual users who want to override the system configuration of ALSA can do
19886 it with the @file{~/.asoundrc} file:
19887
19888 @example
19889 # In guix, we have to specify the absolute path for plugins.
19890 pcm_type.jack @{
19891 lib "/home/alice/.guix-profile/lib/alsa-lib/libasound_module_pcm_jack.so"
19892 @}
19893
19894 # Routing ALSA to jack:
19895 # <http://jackaudio.org/faq/routing_alsa.html>.
19896 pcm.rawjack @{
19897 type jack
19898 playback_ports @{
19899 0 system:playback_1
19900 1 system:playback_2
19901 @}
19902
19903 capture_ports @{
19904 0 system:capture_1
19905 1 system:capture_2
19906 @}
19907 @}
19908
19909 pcm.!default @{
19910 type plug
19911 slave @{
19912 pcm "rawjack"
19913 @}
19914 @}
19915 @end example
19916
19917 See @uref{https://www.alsa-project.org/main/index.php/Asoundrc} for the
19918 details.
19919
19920 @deffn {Scheme Variable} pulseaudio-service-type
19921 This is the type for the @uref{https://www.pulseaudio.org/, PulseAudio}
19922 sound server. It exists to allow system overrides of the default settings
19923 via @code{pulseaudio-configuration}, see below.
19924
19925 @quotation Warning
19926 This service overrides per-user configuration files. If you want
19927 PulseAudio to honor configuration files in @file{~/.config/pulse} you
19928 have to unset the environment variables @env{PULSE_CONFIG} and
19929 @env{PULSE_CLIENTCONFIG} in your @file{~/.bash_profile}.
19930 @end quotation
19931
19932 @quotation Warning
19933 This service on its own does not ensure, that the @code{pulseaudio} package
19934 exists on your machine. It merely adds configuration files for it, as
19935 detailed below. In the (admittedly unlikely) case, that you find yourself
19936 without a @code{pulseaudio} package, consider enabling it through the
19937 @code{alsa-service-type} above.
19938 @end quotation
19939 @end deffn
19940
19941 @deftp {Data Type} pulseaudio-configuration
19942 Data type representing the configuration for @code{pulseaudio-service}.
19943
19944 @table @asis
19945 @item @code{client-conf} (default: @code{'()})
19946 List of settings to set in @file{client.conf}.
19947 Accepts a list of strings or a symbol-value pairs. A string will be
19948 inserted as-is with a newline added. A pair will be formatted as
19949 ``key = value'', again with a newline added.
19950
19951 @item @code{daemon-conf} (default: @code{'((flat-volumes . no))})
19952 List of settings to set in @file{daemon.conf}, formatted just like
19953 @var{client-conf}.
19954
19955 @item @code{script-file} (default: @code{(file-append pulseaudio "/etc/pulse/default.pa")})
19956 Script file to use as @file{default.pa}.
19957
19958 @item @code{system-script-file} (default: @code{(file-append pulseaudio "/etc/pulse/system.pa")})
19959 Script file to use as @file{system.pa}.
19960 @end table
19961 @end deftp
19962
19963 @deffn {Scheme Variable} ladspa-service-type
19964 This service sets the @var{LADSPA_PATH} variable, so that programs, which
19965 respect it, e.g. PulseAudio, can load LADSPA plugins.
19966
19967 The following example will setup the service to enable modules from the
19968 @code{swh-plugins} package:
19969
19970 @lisp
19971 (service ladspa-service-type
19972 (ladspa-configuration (plugins (list swh-plugins))))
19973 @end lisp
19974
19975 See @uref{http://plugin.org.uk/ladspa-swh/docs/ladspa-swh.html} for the
19976 details.
19977
19978 @end deffn
19979
19980 @node Database Services
19981 @subsection Database Services
19982
19983 @cindex database
19984 @cindex SQL
19985 The @code{(gnu services databases)} module provides the following services.
19986
19987 @subsubheading PostgreSQL
19988
19989 The following example describes a PostgreSQL service with the default
19990 configuration.
19991
19992 @lisp
19993 (service postgresql-service-type
19994 (postgresql-configuration
19995 (postgresql postgresql-10)))
19996 @end lisp
19997
19998 If the services fails to start, it may be due to an incompatible
19999 cluster already present in @var{data-directory}. Adjust it (or, if you
20000 don't need the cluster anymore, delete @var{data-directory}), then
20001 restart the service.
20002
20003 Peer authentication is used by default and the @code{postgres} user
20004 account has no shell, which prevents the direct execution of @code{psql}
20005 commands as this user. To use @code{psql}, you can temporarily log in
20006 as @code{postgres} using a shell, create a PostgreSQL superuser with the
20007 same name as one of the system users and then create the associated
20008 database.
20009
20010 @example
20011 sudo -u postgres -s /bin/sh
20012 createuser --interactive
20013 createdb $MY_USER_LOGIN # Replace appropriately.
20014 @end example
20015
20016 @deftp {Data Type} postgresql-configuration
20017 Data type representing the configuration for the
20018 @code{postgresql-service-type}.
20019
20020 @table @asis
20021 @item @code{postgresql}
20022 PostgreSQL package to use for the service.
20023
20024 @item @code{port} (default: @code{5432})
20025 Port on which PostgreSQL should listen.
20026
20027 @item @code{locale} (default: @code{"en_US.utf8"})
20028 Locale to use as the default when creating the database cluster.
20029
20030 @item @code{config-file} (default: @code{(postgresql-config-file)})
20031 The configuration file to use when running PostgreSQL@. The default
20032 behaviour uses the postgresql-config-file record with the default values
20033 for the fields.
20034
20035 @item @code{log-directory} (default: @code{"/var/log/postgresql"})
20036 The directory where @command{pg_ctl} output will be written in a file
20037 named @code{"pg_ctl.log"}. This file can be useful to debug PostgreSQL
20038 configuration errors for instance.
20039
20040 @item @code{data-directory} (default: @code{"/var/lib/postgresql/data"})
20041 Directory in which to store the data.
20042
20043 @item @code{extension-packages} (default: @code{'()})
20044 @cindex postgresql extension-packages
20045 Additional extensions are loaded from packages listed in
20046 @var{extension-packages}. Extensions are available at runtime. For instance,
20047 to create a geographic database using the @code{postgis} extension, a user can
20048 configure the postgresql-service as in this example:
20049
20050 @cindex postgis
20051 @lisp
20052 (use-package-modules databases geo)
20053
20054 (operating-system
20055 ...
20056 ;; postgresql is required to run `psql' but postgis is not required for
20057 ;; proper operation.
20058 (packages (cons* postgresql %base-packages))
20059 (services
20060 (cons*
20061 (service postgresql-service-type
20062 (postgresql-configuration
20063 (postgresql postgresql-10)
20064 (extension-packages (list postgis))))
20065 %base-services)))
20066 @end lisp
20067
20068 Then the extension becomes visible and you can initialise an empty geographic
20069 database in this way:
20070
20071 @example
20072 psql -U postgres
20073 > create database postgistest;
20074 > \connect postgistest;
20075 > create extension postgis;
20076 > create extension postgis_topology;
20077 @end example
20078
20079 There is no need to add this field for contrib extensions such as hstore or
20080 dblink as they are already loadable by postgresql. This field is only
20081 required to add extensions provided by other packages.
20082
20083 @end table
20084 @end deftp
20085
20086 @deftp {Data Type} postgresql-config-file
20087 Data type representing the PostgreSQL configuration file. As shown in
20088 the following example, this can be used to customize the configuration
20089 of PostgreSQL@. Note that you can use any G-expression or filename in
20090 place of this record, if you already have a configuration file you'd
20091 like to use for example.
20092
20093 @lisp
20094 (service postgresql-service-type
20095 (postgresql-configuration
20096 (config-file
20097 (postgresql-config-file
20098 (log-destination "stderr")
20099 (hba-file
20100 (plain-file "pg_hba.conf"
20101 "
20102 local all all trust
20103 host all all 127.0.0.1/32 md5
20104 host all all ::1/128 md5"))
20105 (extra-config
20106 '(("session_preload_libraries" "auto_explain")
20107 ("random_page_cost" 2)
20108 ("auto_explain.log_min_duration" "100 ms")
20109 ("work_mem" "500 MB")
20110 ("logging_collector" #t)
20111 ("log_directory" "/var/log/postgresql")))))))
20112 @end lisp
20113
20114 @table @asis
20115 @item @code{log-destination} (default: @code{"syslog"})
20116 The logging method to use for PostgreSQL@. Multiple values are accepted,
20117 separated by commas.
20118
20119 @item @code{hba-file} (default: @code{%default-postgres-hba})
20120 Filename or G-expression for the host-based authentication
20121 configuration.
20122
20123 @item @code{ident-file} (default: @code{%default-postgres-ident})
20124 Filename or G-expression for the user name mapping configuration.
20125
20126 @item @code{socket-directory} (default: @code{#false})
20127 Specifies the directory of the Unix-domain socket(s) on which PostgreSQL
20128 is to listen for connections from client applications. If set to
20129 @code{""} PostgreSQL does not listen on any Unix-domain sockets, in
20130 which case only TCP/IP sockets can be used to connect to the server.
20131
20132 By default, the @code{#false} value means the PostgreSQL default value
20133 will be used, which is currently @samp{/tmp}.
20134
20135 @item @code{extra-config} (default: @code{'()})
20136 List of additional keys and values to include in the PostgreSQL config
20137 file. Each entry in the list should be a list where the first element
20138 is the key, and the remaining elements are the values.
20139
20140 The values can be numbers, booleans or strings and will be mapped to
20141 PostgreSQL parameters types @code{Boolean}, @code{String},
20142 @code{Numeric}, @code{Numeric with Unit} and @code{Enumerated} described
20143 @uref{https://www.postgresql.org/docs/current/config-setting.html,
20144 here}.
20145
20146 @end table
20147 @end deftp
20148
20149 @deffn {Scheme Variable} postgresql-role-service-type
20150 This service allows to create PostgreSQL roles and databases after
20151 PostgreSQL service start. Here is an example of its use.
20152
20153 @lisp
20154 (service postgresql-role-service-type
20155 (postgresql-role-configuration
20156 (roles
20157 (list (postgresql-role
20158 (name "test")
20159 (create-database? #t))))))
20160 @end lisp
20161
20162 This service can be extended with extra roles, as in this
20163 example:
20164
20165 @lisp
20166 (service-extension postgresql-role-service-type
20167 (const (postgresql-role
20168 (name "alice")
20169 (create-database? #t))))
20170 @end lisp
20171 @end deffn
20172
20173 @deftp {Data Type} postgresql-role
20174 PostgreSQL manages database access permissions using the concept of
20175 roles. A role can be thought of as either a database user, or a group
20176 of database users, depending on how the role is set up. Roles can own
20177 database objects (for example, tables) and can assign privileges on
20178 those objects to other roles to control who has access to which objects.
20179
20180 @table @asis
20181 @item @code{name}
20182 The role name.
20183
20184 @item @code{permissions} (default: @code{'(createdb login)})
20185 The role permissions list. Supported permissions are @code{bypassrls},
20186 @code{createdb}, @code{createrole}, @code{login}, @code{replication} and
20187 @code{superuser}.
20188
20189 @item @code{create-database?} (default: @code{#f})
20190 Whether to create a database with the same name as the role.
20191
20192 @end table
20193 @end deftp
20194
20195 @deftp {Data Type} postgresql-role-configuration
20196 Data type representing the configuration of
20197 @var{postgresql-role-service-type}.
20198
20199 @table @asis
20200 @item @code{host} (default: @code{"/var/run/postgresql"})
20201 The PostgreSQL host to connect to.
20202
20203 @item @code{log} (default: @code{"/var/log/postgresql_roles.log"})
20204 File name of the log file.
20205
20206 @item @code{roles} (default: @code{'()})
20207 The initial PostgreSQL roles to create.
20208 @end table
20209 @end deftp
20210
20211 @subsubheading MariaDB/MySQL
20212
20213 @defvr {Scheme Variable} mysql-service-type
20214 This is the service type for a MySQL or MariaDB database server. Its value
20215 is a @code{mysql-configuration} object that specifies which package to use,
20216 as well as various settings for the @command{mysqld} daemon.
20217 @end defvr
20218
20219 @deftp {Data Type} mysql-configuration
20220 Data type representing the configuration of @var{mysql-service-type}.
20221
20222 @table @asis
20223 @item @code{mysql} (default: @var{mariadb})
20224 Package object of the MySQL database server, can be either @var{mariadb}
20225 or @var{mysql}.
20226
20227 For MySQL, a temporary root password will be displayed at activation time.
20228 For MariaDB, the root password is empty.
20229
20230 @item @code{bind-address} (default: @code{"127.0.0.1"})
20231 The IP on which to listen for network connections. Use @code{"0.0.0.0"}
20232 to bind to all available network interfaces.
20233
20234 @item @code{port} (default: @code{3306})
20235 TCP port on which the database server listens for incoming connections.
20236
20237 @item @code{socket} (default: @code{"/run/mysqld/mysqld.sock"})
20238 Socket file to use for local (non-network) connections.
20239
20240 @item @code{extra-content} (default: @code{""})
20241 Additional settings for the @file{my.cnf} configuration file.
20242
20243 @item @code{extra-environment} (default: @code{#~'()})
20244 List of environment variables passed to the @command{mysqld} process.
20245
20246 @item @code{auto-upgrade?} (default: @code{#t})
20247 Whether to automatically run @command{mysql_upgrade} after starting the
20248 service. This is necessary to upgrade the @dfn{system schema} after
20249 ``major'' updates (such as switching from MariaDB 10.4 to 10.5), but can
20250 be disabled if you would rather do that manually.
20251
20252 @end table
20253 @end deftp
20254
20255 @subsubheading Memcached
20256
20257 @defvr {Scheme Variable} memcached-service-type
20258 This is the service type for the @uref{https://memcached.org/,
20259 Memcached} service, which provides a distributed in memory cache. The
20260 value for the service type is a @code{memcached-configuration} object.
20261 @end defvr
20262
20263 @lisp
20264 (service memcached-service-type)
20265 @end lisp
20266
20267 @deftp {Data Type} memcached-configuration
20268 Data type representing the configuration of memcached.
20269
20270 @table @asis
20271 @item @code{memcached} (default: @code{memcached})
20272 The Memcached package to use.
20273
20274 @item @code{interfaces} (default: @code{'("0.0.0.0")})
20275 Network interfaces on which to listen.
20276
20277 @item @code{tcp-port} (default: @code{11211})
20278 Port on which to accept connections.
20279
20280 @item @code{udp-port} (default: @code{11211})
20281 Port on which to accept UDP connections on, a value of 0 will disable
20282 listening on a UDP socket.
20283
20284 @item @code{additional-options} (default: @code{'()})
20285 Additional command line options to pass to @code{memcached}.
20286 @end table
20287 @end deftp
20288
20289 @subsubheading Redis
20290
20291 @defvr {Scheme Variable} redis-service-type
20292 This is the service type for the @uref{https://redis.io/, Redis}
20293 key/value store, whose value is a @code{redis-configuration} object.
20294 @end defvr
20295
20296 @deftp {Data Type} redis-configuration
20297 Data type representing the configuration of redis.
20298
20299 @table @asis
20300 @item @code{redis} (default: @code{redis})
20301 The Redis package to use.
20302
20303 @item @code{bind} (default: @code{"127.0.0.1"})
20304 Network interface on which to listen.
20305
20306 @item @code{port} (default: @code{6379})
20307 Port on which to accept connections on, a value of 0 will disable
20308 listening on a TCP socket.
20309
20310 @item @code{working-directory} (default: @code{"/var/lib/redis"})
20311 Directory in which to store the database and related files.
20312 @end table
20313 @end deftp
20314
20315 @node Mail Services
20316 @subsection Mail Services
20317
20318 @cindex mail
20319 @cindex email
20320 The @code{(gnu services mail)} module provides Guix service definitions
20321 for email services: IMAP, POP3, and LMTP servers, as well as mail
20322 transport agents (MTAs). Lots of acronyms! These services are detailed
20323 in the subsections below.
20324
20325 @subsubheading Dovecot Service
20326
20327 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} dovecot-service [#:config (dovecot-configuration)]
20328 Return a service that runs the Dovecot IMAP/POP3/LMTP mail server.
20329 @end deffn
20330
20331 By default, Dovecot does not need much configuration; the default
20332 configuration object created by @code{(dovecot-configuration)} will
20333 suffice if your mail is delivered to @code{~/Maildir}. A self-signed
20334 certificate will be generated for TLS-protected connections, though
20335 Dovecot will also listen on cleartext ports by default. There are a
20336 number of options, though, which mail administrators might need to change,
20337 and as is the case with other services, Guix allows the system
20338 administrator to specify these parameters via a uniform Scheme interface.
20339
20340 For example, to specify that mail is located at @code{maildir~/.mail},
20341 one would instantiate the Dovecot service like this:
20342
20343 @lisp
20344 (dovecot-service #:config
20345 (dovecot-configuration
20346 (mail-location "maildir:~/.mail")))
20347 @end lisp
20348
20349 The available configuration parameters follow. Each parameter
20350 definition is preceded by its type; for example, @samp{string-list foo}
20351 indicates that the @code{foo} parameter should be specified as a list of
20352 strings. There is also a way to specify the configuration as a string,
20353 if you have an old @code{dovecot.conf} file that you want to port over
20354 from some other system; see the end for more details.
20355
20356 @c The following documentation was initially generated by
20357 @c (generate-documentation) in (gnu services mail). Manually maintained
20358 @c documentation is better, so we shouldn't hesitate to edit below as
20359 @c needed. However if the change you want to make to this documentation
20360 @c can be done in an automated way, it's probably easier to change
20361 @c (generate-documentation) than to make it below and have to deal with
20362 @c the churn as dovecot updates.
20363
20364 Available @code{dovecot-configuration} fields are:
20365
20366 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} package dovecot
20367 The dovecot package.
20368 @end deftypevr
20369
20370 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} comma-separated-string-list listen
20371 A list of IPs or hosts where to listen for connections. @samp{*}
20372 listens on all IPv4 interfaces, @samp{::} listens on all IPv6
20373 interfaces. If you want to specify non-default ports or anything more
20374 complex, customize the address and port fields of the
20375 @samp{inet-listener} of the specific services you are interested in.
20376 @end deftypevr
20377
20378 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} protocol-configuration-list protocols
20379 List of protocols we want to serve. Available protocols include
20380 @samp{imap}, @samp{pop3}, and @samp{lmtp}.
20381
20382 Available @code{protocol-configuration} fields are:
20383
20384 @deftypevr {@code{protocol-configuration} parameter} string name
20385 The name of the protocol.
20386 @end deftypevr
20387
20388 @deftypevr {@code{protocol-configuration} parameter} string auth-socket-path
20389 UNIX socket path to the master authentication server to find users.
20390 This is used by imap (for shared users) and lda.
20391 It defaults to @samp{"/var/run/dovecot/auth-userdb"}.
20392 @end deftypevr
20393
20394 @deftypevr {@code{protocol-configuration} parameter} boolean imap-metadata?
20395 Whether to enable the @code{IMAP METADATA} extension as defined in
20396 @uref{https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5464,RFC@tie{}5464}, which provides
20397 a means for clients to set and retrieve per-mailbox, per-user metadata
20398 and annotations over IMAP.
20399
20400 If this is @samp{#t}, you must also specify a dictionary @i{via} the
20401 @code{mail-attribute-dict} setting.
20402
20403 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
20404
20405 @end deftypevr
20406
20407 @deftypevr {@code{protocol-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list managesieve-notify-capabilities
20408 Which NOTIFY capabilities to report to clients that first connect to
20409 the ManageSieve service, before authentication. These may differ from the
20410 capabilities offered to authenticated users. If this field is left empty,
20411 report what the Sieve interpreter supports by default.
20412
20413 Defaults to @samp{()}.
20414 @end deftypevr
20415
20416 @deftypevr {@code{protocol-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list managesieve-sieve-capability
20417 Which SIEVE capabilities to report to clients that first connect to
20418 the ManageSieve service, before authentication. These may differ from the
20419 capabilities offered to authenticated users. If this field is left empty,
20420 report what the Sieve interpreter supports by default.
20421
20422 Defaults to @samp{()}.
20423
20424 @end deftypevr
20425
20426 @deftypevr {@code{protocol-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list mail-plugins
20427 Space separated list of plugins to load.
20428 @end deftypevr
20429
20430 @deftypevr {@code{protocol-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer mail-max-userip-connections
20431 Maximum number of IMAP connections allowed for a user from each IP
20432 address. NOTE: The username is compared case-sensitively.
20433 Defaults to @samp{10}.
20434 @end deftypevr
20435
20436 @end deftypevr
20437
20438 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} service-configuration-list services
20439 List of services to enable. Available services include @samp{imap},
20440 @samp{imap-login}, @samp{pop3}, @samp{pop3-login}, @samp{auth}, and
20441 @samp{lmtp}.
20442
20443 Available @code{service-configuration} fields are:
20444
20445 @deftypevr {@code{service-configuration} parameter} string kind
20446 The service kind. Valid values include @code{director},
20447 @code{imap-login}, @code{pop3-login}, @code{lmtp}, @code{imap},
20448 @code{pop3}, @code{auth}, @code{auth-worker}, @code{dict},
20449 @code{tcpwrap}, @code{quota-warning}, or anything else.
20450 @end deftypevr
20451
20452 @deftypevr {@code{service-configuration} parameter} listener-configuration-list listeners
20453 Listeners for the service. A listener is either a
20454 @code{unix-listener-configuration}, a @code{fifo-listener-configuration}, or
20455 an @code{inet-listener-configuration}.
20456 Defaults to @samp{()}.
20457
20458 Available @code{unix-listener-configuration} fields are:
20459
20460 @deftypevr {@code{unix-listener-configuration} parameter} string path
20461 Path to the file, relative to @code{base-dir} field. This is also used as
20462 the section name.
20463 @end deftypevr
20464
20465 @deftypevr {@code{unix-listener-configuration} parameter} string mode
20466 The access mode for the socket.
20467 Defaults to @samp{"0600"}.
20468 @end deftypevr
20469
20470 @deftypevr {@code{unix-listener-configuration} parameter} string user
20471 The user to own the socket.
20472 Defaults to @samp{""}.
20473 @end deftypevr
20474
20475 @deftypevr {@code{unix-listener-configuration} parameter} string group
20476 The group to own the socket.
20477 Defaults to @samp{""}.
20478 @end deftypevr
20479
20480
20481 Available @code{fifo-listener-configuration} fields are:
20482
20483 @deftypevr {@code{fifo-listener-configuration} parameter} string path
20484 Path to the file, relative to @code{base-dir} field. This is also used as
20485 the section name.
20486 @end deftypevr
20487
20488 @deftypevr {@code{fifo-listener-configuration} parameter} string mode
20489 The access mode for the socket.
20490 Defaults to @samp{"0600"}.
20491 @end deftypevr
20492
20493 @deftypevr {@code{fifo-listener-configuration} parameter} string user
20494 The user to own the socket.
20495 Defaults to @samp{""}.
20496 @end deftypevr
20497
20498 @deftypevr {@code{fifo-listener-configuration} parameter} string group
20499 The group to own the socket.
20500 Defaults to @samp{""}.
20501 @end deftypevr
20502
20503
20504 Available @code{inet-listener-configuration} fields are:
20505
20506 @deftypevr {@code{inet-listener-configuration} parameter} string protocol
20507 The protocol to listen for.
20508 @end deftypevr
20509
20510 @deftypevr {@code{inet-listener-configuration} parameter} string address
20511 The address on which to listen, or empty for all addresses.
20512 Defaults to @samp{""}.
20513 @end deftypevr
20514
20515 @deftypevr {@code{inet-listener-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer port
20516 The port on which to listen.
20517 @end deftypevr
20518
20519 @deftypevr {@code{inet-listener-configuration} parameter} boolean ssl?
20520 Whether to use SSL for this service; @samp{yes}, @samp{no}, or
20521 @samp{required}.
20522 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
20523 @end deftypevr
20524
20525 @end deftypevr
20526
20527 @deftypevr {@code{service-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer client-limit
20528 Maximum number of simultaneous client connections per process. Once
20529 this number of connections is received, the next incoming connection
20530 will prompt Dovecot to spawn another process. If set to 0,
20531 @code{default-client-limit} is used instead.
20532
20533 Defaults to @samp{0}.
20534
20535 @end deftypevr
20536
20537 @deftypevr {@code{service-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer service-count
20538 Number of connections to handle before starting a new process.
20539 Typically the only useful values are 0 (unlimited) or 1. 1 is more
20540 secure, but 0 is faster. <doc/wiki/LoginProcess.txt>.
20541 Defaults to @samp{1}.
20542
20543 @end deftypevr
20544
20545 @deftypevr {@code{service-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer process-limit
20546 Maximum number of processes that can exist for this service. If set to
20547 0, @code{default-process-limit} is used instead.
20548
20549 Defaults to @samp{0}.
20550
20551 @end deftypevr
20552
20553 @deftypevr {@code{service-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer process-min-avail
20554 Number of processes to always keep waiting for more connections.
20555 Defaults to @samp{0}.
20556 @end deftypevr
20557
20558 @deftypevr {@code{service-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer vsz-limit
20559 If you set @samp{service-count 0}, you probably need to grow
20560 this.
20561 Defaults to @samp{256000000}.
20562 @end deftypevr
20563
20564 @end deftypevr
20565
20566 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} dict-configuration dict
20567 Dict configuration, as created by the @code{dict-configuration}
20568 constructor.
20569
20570 Available @code{dict-configuration} fields are:
20571
20572 @deftypevr {@code{dict-configuration} parameter} free-form-fields entries
20573 A list of key-value pairs that this dict should hold.
20574 Defaults to @samp{()}.
20575 @end deftypevr
20576
20577 @end deftypevr
20578
20579 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} passdb-configuration-list passdbs
20580 A list of passdb configurations, each one created by the
20581 @code{passdb-configuration} constructor.
20582
20583 Available @code{passdb-configuration} fields are:
20584
20585 @deftypevr {@code{passdb-configuration} parameter} string driver
20586 The driver that the passdb should use. Valid values include
20587 @samp{pam}, @samp{passwd}, @samp{shadow}, @samp{bsdauth}, and
20588 @samp{static}.
20589 Defaults to @samp{"pam"}.
20590 @end deftypevr
20591
20592 @deftypevr {@code{passdb-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list args
20593 Space separated list of arguments to the passdb driver.
20594 Defaults to @samp{""}.
20595 @end deftypevr
20596
20597 @end deftypevr
20598
20599 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} userdb-configuration-list userdbs
20600 List of userdb configurations, each one created by the
20601 @code{userdb-configuration} constructor.
20602
20603 Available @code{userdb-configuration} fields are:
20604
20605 @deftypevr {@code{userdb-configuration} parameter} string driver
20606 The driver that the userdb should use. Valid values include
20607 @samp{passwd} and @samp{static}.
20608 Defaults to @samp{"passwd"}.
20609 @end deftypevr
20610
20611 @deftypevr {@code{userdb-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list args
20612 Space separated list of arguments to the userdb driver.
20613 Defaults to @samp{""}.
20614 @end deftypevr
20615
20616 @deftypevr {@code{userdb-configuration} parameter} free-form-args override-fields
20617 Override fields from passwd.
20618 Defaults to @samp{()}.
20619 @end deftypevr
20620
20621 @end deftypevr
20622
20623 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} plugin-configuration plugin-configuration
20624 Plug-in configuration, created by the @code{plugin-configuration}
20625 constructor.
20626 @end deftypevr
20627
20628 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} list-of-namespace-configuration namespaces
20629 List of namespaces. Each item in the list is created by the
20630 @code{namespace-configuration} constructor.
20631
20632 Available @code{namespace-configuration} fields are:
20633
20634 @deftypevr {@code{namespace-configuration} parameter} string name
20635 Name for this namespace.
20636 @end deftypevr
20637
20638 @deftypevr {@code{namespace-configuration} parameter} string type
20639 Namespace type: @samp{private}, @samp{shared} or @samp{public}.
20640 Defaults to @samp{"private"}.
20641 @end deftypevr
20642
20643 @deftypevr {@code{namespace-configuration} parameter} string separator
20644 Hierarchy separator to use. You should use the same separator for
20645 all namespaces or some clients get confused. @samp{/} is usually a good
20646 one. The default however depends on the underlying mail storage
20647 format.
20648 Defaults to @samp{""}.
20649 @end deftypevr
20650
20651 @deftypevr {@code{namespace-configuration} parameter} string prefix
20652 Prefix required to access this namespace. This needs to be
20653 different for all namespaces. For example @samp{Public/}.
20654 Defaults to @samp{""}.
20655 @end deftypevr
20656
20657 @deftypevr {@code{namespace-configuration} parameter} string location
20658 Physical location of the mailbox. This is in the same format as
20659 mail_location, which is also the default for it.
20660 Defaults to @samp{""}.
20661 @end deftypevr
20662
20663 @deftypevr {@code{namespace-configuration} parameter} boolean inbox?
20664 There can be only one INBOX, and this setting defines which
20665 namespace has it.
20666 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
20667 @end deftypevr
20668
20669 @deftypevr {@code{namespace-configuration} parameter} boolean hidden?
20670 If namespace is hidden, it's not advertised to clients via NAMESPACE
20671 extension. You'll most likely also want to set @samp{list? #f}. This is mostly
20672 useful when converting from another server with different namespaces
20673 which you want to deprecate but still keep working. For example you can
20674 create hidden namespaces with prefixes @samp{~/mail/}, @samp{~%u/mail/}
20675 and @samp{mail/}.
20676 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
20677 @end deftypevr
20678
20679 @deftypevr {@code{namespace-configuration} parameter} boolean list?
20680 Show the mailboxes under this namespace with the LIST command. This
20681 makes the namespace visible for clients that do not support the NAMESPACE
20682 extension. The special @code{children} value lists child mailboxes, but
20683 hides the namespace prefix.
20684 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
20685 @end deftypevr
20686
20687 @deftypevr {@code{namespace-configuration} parameter} boolean subscriptions?
20688 Namespace handles its own subscriptions. If set to @code{#f}, the
20689 parent namespace handles them. The empty prefix should always have this
20690 as @code{#t}).
20691 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
20692 @end deftypevr
20693
20694 @deftypevr {@code{namespace-configuration} parameter} mailbox-configuration-list mailboxes
20695 List of predefined mailboxes in this namespace.
20696 Defaults to @samp{()}.
20697
20698 Available @code{mailbox-configuration} fields are:
20699
20700 @deftypevr {@code{mailbox-configuration} parameter} string name
20701 Name for this mailbox.
20702 @end deftypevr
20703
20704 @deftypevr {@code{mailbox-configuration} parameter} string auto
20705 @samp{create} will automatically create this mailbox.
20706 @samp{subscribe} will both create and subscribe to the mailbox.
20707 Defaults to @samp{"no"}.
20708 @end deftypevr
20709
20710 @deftypevr {@code{mailbox-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list special-use
20711 List of IMAP @code{SPECIAL-USE} attributes as specified by RFC 6154.
20712 Valid values are @code{\All}, @code{\Archive}, @code{\Drafts},
20713 @code{\Flagged}, @code{\Junk}, @code{\Sent}, and @code{\Trash}.
20714 Defaults to @samp{()}.
20715 @end deftypevr
20716
20717 @end deftypevr
20718
20719 @end deftypevr
20720
20721 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} file-name base-dir
20722 Base directory where to store runtime data.
20723 Defaults to @samp{"/var/run/dovecot/"}.
20724 @end deftypevr
20725
20726 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string login-greeting
20727 Greeting message for clients.
20728 Defaults to @samp{"Dovecot ready."}.
20729 @end deftypevr
20730
20731 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list login-trusted-networks
20732 List of trusted network ranges. Connections from these IPs are
20733 allowed to override their IP addresses and ports (for logging and for
20734 authentication checks). @samp{disable-plaintext-auth} is also ignored
20735 for these networks. Typically you would specify your IMAP proxy servers
20736 here.
20737 Defaults to @samp{()}.
20738 @end deftypevr
20739
20740 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list login-access-sockets
20741 List of login access check sockets (e.g.@: tcpwrap).
20742 Defaults to @samp{()}.
20743 @end deftypevr
20744
20745 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean verbose-proctitle?
20746 Show more verbose process titles (in ps). Currently shows user name
20747 and IP address. Useful for seeing who is actually using the IMAP
20748 processes (e.g.@: shared mailboxes or if the same uid is used for multiple
20749 accounts).
20750 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
20751 @end deftypevr
20752
20753 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean shutdown-clients?
20754 Should all processes be killed when Dovecot master process shuts down.
20755 Setting this to @code{#f} means that Dovecot can be upgraded without
20756 forcing existing client connections to close (although that could also
20757 be a problem if the upgrade is e.g.@: due to a security fix).
20758 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
20759 @end deftypevr
20760
20761 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer doveadm-worker-count
20762 If non-zero, run mail commands via this many connections to doveadm
20763 server, instead of running them directly in the same process.
20764 Defaults to @samp{0}.
20765 @end deftypevr
20766
20767 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string doveadm-socket-path
20768 UNIX socket or host:port used for connecting to doveadm server.
20769 Defaults to @samp{"doveadm-server"}.
20770 @end deftypevr
20771
20772 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list import-environment
20773 List of environment variables that are preserved on Dovecot startup
20774 and passed down to all of its child processes. You can also give
20775 key=value pairs to always set specific settings.
20776 @end deftypevr
20777
20778 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean disable-plaintext-auth?
20779 Disable LOGIN command and all other plaintext authentications unless
20780 SSL/TLS is used (LOGINDISABLED capability). Note that if the remote IP
20781 matches the local IP (i.e.@: you're connecting from the same computer),
20782 the connection is considered secure and plaintext authentication is
20783 allowed. See also ssl=required setting.
20784 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
20785 @end deftypevr
20786
20787 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer auth-cache-size
20788 Authentication cache size (e.g.@: @samp{#e10e6}). 0 means it's disabled.
20789 Note that bsdauth, PAM and vpopmail require @samp{cache-key} to be set
20790 for caching to be used.
20791 Defaults to @samp{0}.
20792 @end deftypevr
20793
20794 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string auth-cache-ttl
20795 Time to live for cached data. After TTL expires the cached record
20796 is no longer used, *except* if the main database lookup returns internal
20797 failure. We also try to handle password changes automatically: If
20798 user's previous authentication was successful, but this one wasn't, the
20799 cache isn't used. For now this works only with plaintext
20800 authentication.
20801 Defaults to @samp{"1 hour"}.
20802 @end deftypevr
20803
20804 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string auth-cache-negative-ttl
20805 TTL for negative hits (user not found, password mismatch).
20806 0 disables caching them completely.
20807 Defaults to @samp{"1 hour"}.
20808 @end deftypevr
20809
20810 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list auth-realms
20811 List of realms for SASL authentication mechanisms that need them.
20812 You can leave it empty if you don't want to support multiple realms.
20813 Many clients simply use the first one listed here, so keep the default
20814 realm first.
20815 Defaults to @samp{()}.
20816 @end deftypevr
20817
20818 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string auth-default-realm
20819 Default realm/domain to use if none was specified. This is used for
20820 both SASL realms and appending @@domain to username in plaintext
20821 logins.
20822 Defaults to @samp{""}.
20823 @end deftypevr
20824
20825 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string auth-username-chars
20826 List of allowed characters in username. If the user-given username
20827 contains a character not listed in here, the login automatically fails.
20828 This is just an extra check to make sure user can't exploit any
20829 potential quote escaping vulnerabilities with SQL/LDAP databases. If
20830 you want to allow all characters, set this value to empty.
20831 Defaults to @samp{"abcdefghijklmnopqrstuvwxyzABCDEFGHIJKLMNOPQRSTUVWXYZ01234567890.-_@@"}.
20832 @end deftypevr
20833
20834 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string auth-username-translation
20835 Username character translations before it's looked up from
20836 databases. The value contains series of from -> to characters. For
20837 example @samp{#@@/@@} means that @samp{#} and @samp{/} characters are
20838 translated to @samp{@@}.
20839 Defaults to @samp{""}.
20840 @end deftypevr
20841
20842 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string auth-username-format
20843 Username formatting before it's looked up from databases. You can
20844 use the standard variables here, e.g.@: %Lu would lowercase the username,
20845 %n would drop away the domain if it was given, or @samp{%n-AT-%d} would
20846 change the @samp{@@} into @samp{-AT-}. This translation is done after
20847 @samp{auth-username-translation} changes.
20848 Defaults to @samp{"%Lu"}.
20849 @end deftypevr
20850
20851 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string auth-master-user-separator
20852 If you want to allow master users to log in by specifying the master
20853 username within the normal username string (i.e.@: not using SASL
20854 mechanism's support for it), you can specify the separator character
20855 here. The format is then <username><separator><master username>.
20856 UW-IMAP uses @samp{*} as the separator, so that could be a good
20857 choice.
20858 Defaults to @samp{""}.
20859 @end deftypevr
20860
20861 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string auth-anonymous-username
20862 Username to use for users logging in with ANONYMOUS SASL
20863 mechanism.
20864 Defaults to @samp{"anonymous"}.
20865 @end deftypevr
20866
20867 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer auth-worker-max-count
20868 Maximum number of dovecot-auth worker processes. They're used to
20869 execute blocking passdb and userdb queries (e.g.@: MySQL and PAM).
20870 They're automatically created and destroyed as needed.
20871 Defaults to @samp{30}.
20872 @end deftypevr
20873
20874 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string auth-gssapi-hostname
20875 Host name to use in GSSAPI principal names. The default is to use
20876 the name returned by gethostname(). Use @samp{$ALL} (with quotes) to
20877 allow all keytab entries.
20878 Defaults to @samp{""}.
20879 @end deftypevr
20880
20881 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string auth-krb5-keytab
20882 Kerberos keytab to use for the GSSAPI mechanism. Will use the
20883 system default (usually @file{/etc/krb5.keytab}) if not specified. You may
20884 need to change the auth service to run as root to be able to read this
20885 file.
20886 Defaults to @samp{""}.
20887 @end deftypevr
20888
20889 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean auth-use-winbind?
20890 Do NTLM and GSS-SPNEGO authentication using Samba's winbind daemon
20891 and @samp{ntlm-auth} helper.
20892 <doc/wiki/Authentication/Mechanisms/Winbind.txt>.
20893 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
20894 @end deftypevr
20895
20896 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} file-name auth-winbind-helper-path
20897 Path for Samba's @samp{ntlm-auth} helper binary.
20898 Defaults to @samp{"/usr/bin/ntlm_auth"}.
20899 @end deftypevr
20900
20901 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string auth-failure-delay
20902 Time to delay before replying to failed authentications.
20903 Defaults to @samp{"2 secs"}.
20904 @end deftypevr
20905
20906 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean auth-ssl-require-client-cert?
20907 Require a valid SSL client certificate or the authentication
20908 fails.
20909 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
20910 @end deftypevr
20911
20912 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean auth-ssl-username-from-cert?
20913 Take the username from client's SSL certificate, using
20914 @code{X509_NAME_get_text_by_NID()} which returns the subject's DN's
20915 CommonName.
20916 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
20917 @end deftypevr
20918
20919 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list auth-mechanisms
20920 List of wanted authentication mechanisms. Supported mechanisms are:
20921 @samp{plain}, @samp{login}, @samp{digest-md5}, @samp{cram-md5},
20922 @samp{ntlm}, @samp{rpa}, @samp{apop}, @samp{anonymous}, @samp{gssapi},
20923 @samp{otp}, @samp{skey}, and @samp{gss-spnego}. NOTE: See also
20924 @samp{disable-plaintext-auth} setting.
20925 @end deftypevr
20926
20927 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list director-servers
20928 List of IPs or hostnames to all director servers, including ourself.
20929 Ports can be specified as ip:port. The default port is the same as what
20930 director service's @samp{inet-listener} is using.
20931 Defaults to @samp{()}.
20932 @end deftypevr
20933
20934 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list director-mail-servers
20935 List of IPs or hostnames to all backend mail servers. Ranges are
20936 allowed too, like 10.0.0.10-10.0.0.30.
20937 Defaults to @samp{()}.
20938 @end deftypevr
20939
20940 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string director-user-expire
20941 How long to redirect users to a specific server after it no longer
20942 has any connections.
20943 Defaults to @samp{"15 min"}.
20944 @end deftypevr
20945
20946 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string director-username-hash
20947 How the username is translated before being hashed. Useful values
20948 include %Ln if user can log in with or without @@domain, %Ld if mailboxes
20949 are shared within domain.
20950 Defaults to @samp{"%Lu"}.
20951 @end deftypevr
20952
20953 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string log-path
20954 Log file to use for error messages. @samp{syslog} logs to syslog,
20955 @samp{/dev/stderr} logs to stderr.
20956 Defaults to @samp{"syslog"}.
20957 @end deftypevr
20958
20959 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string info-log-path
20960 Log file to use for informational messages. Defaults to
20961 @samp{log-path}.
20962 Defaults to @samp{""}.
20963 @end deftypevr
20964
20965 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string debug-log-path
20966 Log file to use for debug messages. Defaults to
20967 @samp{info-log-path}.
20968 Defaults to @samp{""}.
20969 @end deftypevr
20970
20971 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string syslog-facility
20972 Syslog facility to use if you're logging to syslog. Usually if you
20973 don't want to use @samp{mail}, you'll use local0..local7. Also other
20974 standard facilities are supported.
20975 Defaults to @samp{"mail"}.
20976 @end deftypevr
20977
20978 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean auth-verbose?
20979 Log unsuccessful authentication attempts and the reasons why they
20980 failed.
20981 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
20982 @end deftypevr
20983
20984 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string auth-verbose-passwords
20985 In case of password mismatches, log the attempted password. Valid
20986 values are no, plain and sha1. sha1 can be useful for detecting brute
20987 force password attempts vs. user simply trying the same password over
20988 and over again. You can also truncate the value to n chars by appending
20989 ":n" (e.g.@: sha1:6).
20990 Defaults to @samp{"no"}.
20991 @end deftypevr
20992
20993 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean auth-debug?
20994 Even more verbose logging for debugging purposes. Shows for example
20995 SQL queries.
20996 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
20997 @end deftypevr
20998
20999 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean auth-debug-passwords?
21000 In case of password mismatches, log the passwords and used scheme so
21001 the problem can be debugged. Enabling this also enables
21002 @samp{auth-debug}.
21003 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
21004 @end deftypevr
21005
21006 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean mail-debug?
21007 Enable mail process debugging. This can help you figure out why
21008 Dovecot isn't finding your mails.
21009 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
21010 @end deftypevr
21011
21012 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean verbose-ssl?
21013 Show protocol level SSL errors.
21014 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
21015 @end deftypevr
21016
21017 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string log-timestamp
21018 Prefix for each line written to log file. % codes are in
21019 strftime(3) format.
21020 Defaults to @samp{"\"%b %d %H:%M:%S \""}.
21021 @end deftypevr
21022
21023 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list login-log-format-elements
21024 List of elements we want to log. The elements which have a
21025 non-empty variable value are joined together to form a comma-separated
21026 string.
21027 @end deftypevr
21028
21029 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string login-log-format
21030 Login log format. %s contains @samp{login-log-format-elements}
21031 string, %$ contains the data we want to log.
21032 Defaults to @samp{"%$: %s"}.
21033 @end deftypevr
21034
21035 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mail-log-prefix
21036 Log prefix for mail processes. See doc/wiki/Variables.txt for list
21037 of possible variables you can use.
21038 Defaults to @samp{"\"%s(%u)<%@{pid@}><%@{session@}>: \""}.
21039 @end deftypevr
21040
21041 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string deliver-log-format
21042 Format to use for logging mail deliveries. You can use variables:
21043 @table @code
21044 @item %$
21045 Delivery status message (e.g.@: @samp{saved to INBOX})
21046 @item %m
21047 Message-ID
21048 @item %s
21049 Subject
21050 @item %f
21051 From address
21052 @item %p
21053 Physical size
21054 @item %w
21055 Virtual size.
21056 @end table
21057 Defaults to @samp{"msgid=%m: %$"}.
21058 @end deftypevr
21059
21060 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mail-location
21061 Location for users' mailboxes. The default is empty, which means
21062 that Dovecot tries to find the mailboxes automatically. This won't work
21063 if the user doesn't yet have any mail, so you should explicitly tell
21064 Dovecot the full location.
21065
21066 If you're using mbox, giving a path to the INBOX
21067 file (e.g.@: @file{/var/mail/%u}) isn't enough. You'll also need to tell Dovecot
21068 where the other mailboxes are kept. This is called the @emph{root mail
21069 directory}, and it must be the first path given in the
21070 @samp{mail-location} setting.
21071
21072 There are a few special variables you can use, e.g.:
21073
21074 @table @samp
21075 @item %u
21076 username
21077 @item %n
21078 user part in user@@domain, same as %u if there's no domain
21079 @item %d
21080 domain part in user@@domain, empty if there's no domain
21081 @item %h
21082 home director
21083 @end table
21084
21085 See doc/wiki/Variables.txt for full list. Some examples:
21086 @table @samp
21087 @item maildir:~/Maildir
21088 @item mbox:~/mail:INBOX=/var/mail/%u
21089 @item mbox:/var/mail/%d/%1n/%n:INDEX=/var/indexes/%d/%1n/%
21090 @end table
21091 Defaults to @samp{""}.
21092 @end deftypevr
21093
21094 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mail-uid
21095 System user and group used to access mails. If you use multiple,
21096 userdb can override these by returning uid or gid fields. You can use
21097 either numbers or names. <doc/wiki/UserIds.txt>.
21098 Defaults to @samp{""}.
21099 @end deftypevr
21100
21101 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mail-gid
21102
21103 Defaults to @samp{""}.
21104 @end deftypevr
21105
21106 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mail-privileged-group
21107 Group to enable temporarily for privileged operations. Currently
21108 this is used only with INBOX when either its initial creation or
21109 dotlocking fails. Typically this is set to @samp{"mail"} to give access to
21110 @file{/var/mail}.
21111 Defaults to @samp{""}.
21112 @end deftypevr
21113
21114 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mail-access-groups
21115 Grant access to these supplementary groups for mail processes.
21116 Typically these are used to set up access to shared mailboxes. Note
21117 that it may be dangerous to set these if users can create symlinks
21118 (e.g.@: if @samp{mail} group is set here, @code{ln -s /var/mail ~/mail/var}
21119 could allow a user to delete others' mailboxes, or @code{ln -s
21120 /secret/shared/box ~/mail/mybox} would allow reading it). Defaults to
21121 @samp{""}.
21122 @end deftypevr
21123
21124 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mail-attribute-dict
21125 The location of a dictionary used to store @code{IMAP METADATA}
21126 as defined by @uref{https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5464, RFC@tie{}5464}.
21127
21128 The IMAP METADATA commands are available only if the ``imap''
21129 protocol configuration's @code{imap-metadata?} field is @samp{#t}.
21130
21131 Defaults to @samp{""}.
21132
21133 @end deftypevr
21134
21135 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean mail-full-filesystem-access?
21136 Allow full file system access to clients. There's no access checks
21137 other than what the operating system does for the active UID/GID@. It
21138 works with both maildir and mboxes, allowing you to prefix mailboxes
21139 names with e.g.@: @file{/path/} or @file{~user/}.
21140 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
21141 @end deftypevr
21142
21143 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean mmap-disable?
21144 Don't use @code{mmap()} at all. This is required if you store indexes to
21145 shared file systems (NFS or clustered file system).
21146 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
21147 @end deftypevr
21148
21149 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean dotlock-use-excl?
21150 Rely on @samp{O_EXCL} to work when creating dotlock files. NFS
21151 supports @samp{O_EXCL} since version 3, so this should be safe to use
21152 nowadays by default.
21153 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
21154 @end deftypevr
21155
21156 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mail-fsync
21157 When to use fsync() or fdatasync() calls:
21158 @table @code
21159 @item optimized
21160 Whenever necessary to avoid losing important data
21161 @item always
21162 Useful with e.g.@: NFS when @code{write()}s are delayed
21163 @item never
21164 Never use it (best performance, but crashes can lose data).
21165 @end table
21166 Defaults to @samp{"optimized"}.
21167 @end deftypevr
21168
21169 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean mail-nfs-storage?
21170 Mail storage exists in NFS@. Set this to yes to make Dovecot flush
21171 NFS caches whenever needed. If you're using only a single mail server
21172 this isn't needed.
21173 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
21174 @end deftypevr
21175
21176 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean mail-nfs-index?
21177 Mail index files also exist in NFS@. Setting this to yes requires
21178 @samp{mmap-disable? #t} and @samp{fsync-disable? #f}.
21179 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
21180 @end deftypevr
21181
21182 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string lock-method
21183 Locking method for index files. Alternatives are fcntl, flock and
21184 dotlock. Dotlocking uses some tricks which may create more disk I/O
21185 than other locking methods. NFS users: flock doesn't work, remember to
21186 change @samp{mmap-disable}.
21187 Defaults to @samp{"fcntl"}.
21188 @end deftypevr
21189
21190 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} file-name mail-temp-dir
21191 Directory in which LDA/LMTP temporarily stores incoming mails >128
21192 kB.
21193 Defaults to @samp{"/tmp"}.
21194 @end deftypevr
21195
21196 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer first-valid-uid
21197 Valid UID range for users. This is mostly to make sure that users can't
21198 log in as daemons or other system users. Note that denying root logins is
21199 hardcoded to dovecot binary and can't be done even if @samp{first-valid-uid}
21200 is set to 0.
21201 Defaults to @samp{500}.
21202 @end deftypevr
21203
21204 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer last-valid-uid
21205
21206 Defaults to @samp{0}.
21207 @end deftypevr
21208
21209 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer first-valid-gid
21210 Valid GID range for users. Users having non-valid GID as primary group ID
21211 aren't allowed to log in. If user belongs to supplementary groups with
21212 non-valid GIDs, those groups are not set.
21213 Defaults to @samp{1}.
21214 @end deftypevr
21215
21216 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer last-valid-gid
21217
21218 Defaults to @samp{0}.
21219 @end deftypevr
21220
21221 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer mail-max-keyword-length
21222 Maximum allowed length for mail keyword name. It's only forced when
21223 trying to create new keywords.
21224 Defaults to @samp{50}.
21225 @end deftypevr
21226
21227 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} colon-separated-file-name-list valid-chroot-dirs
21228 List of directories under which chrooting is allowed for mail
21229 processes (i.e.@: @file{/var/mail} will allow chrooting to @file{/var/mail/foo/bar}
21230 too). This setting doesn't affect @samp{login-chroot}
21231 @samp{mail-chroot} or auth chroot settings. If this setting is empty,
21232 @samp{/./} in home dirs are ignored. WARNING: Never add directories here
21233 which local users can modify, that may lead to root exploit. Usually
21234 this should be done only if you don't allow shell access for users.
21235 <doc/wiki/Chrooting.txt>.
21236 Defaults to @samp{()}.
21237 @end deftypevr
21238
21239 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mail-chroot
21240 Default chroot directory for mail processes. This can be overridden
21241 for specific users in user database by giving @samp{/./} in user's home
21242 directory (e.g.@: @samp{/home/./user} chroots into @file{/home}). Note that usually
21243 there is no real need to do chrooting, Dovecot doesn't allow users to
21244 access files outside their mail directory anyway. If your home
21245 directories are prefixed with the chroot directory, append @samp{/.} to
21246 @samp{mail-chroot}. <doc/wiki/Chrooting.txt>.
21247 Defaults to @samp{""}.
21248 @end deftypevr
21249
21250 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} file-name auth-socket-path
21251 UNIX socket path to master authentication server to find users.
21252 This is used by imap (for shared users) and lda.
21253 Defaults to @samp{"/var/run/dovecot/auth-userdb"}.
21254 @end deftypevr
21255
21256 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} file-name mail-plugin-dir
21257 Directory where to look up mail plugins.
21258 Defaults to @samp{"/usr/lib/dovecot"}.
21259 @end deftypevr
21260
21261 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list mail-plugins
21262 List of plugins to load for all services. Plugins specific to IMAP,
21263 LDA, etc.@: are added to this list in their own .conf files.
21264 Defaults to @samp{()}.
21265 @end deftypevr
21266
21267 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer mail-cache-min-mail-count
21268 The minimum number of mails in a mailbox before updates are done to
21269 cache file. This allows optimizing Dovecot's behavior to do less disk
21270 writes at the cost of more disk reads.
21271 Defaults to @samp{0}.
21272 @end deftypevr
21273
21274 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mailbox-idle-check-interval
21275 When IDLE command is running, mailbox is checked once in a while to
21276 see if there are any new mails or other changes. This setting defines
21277 the minimum time to wait between those checks. Dovecot can also use
21278 dnotify, inotify and kqueue to find out immediately when changes
21279 occur.
21280 Defaults to @samp{"30 secs"}.
21281 @end deftypevr
21282
21283 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean mail-save-crlf?
21284 Save mails with CR+LF instead of plain LF@. This makes sending those
21285 mails take less CPU, especially with sendfile() syscall with Linux and
21286 FreeBSD@. But it also creates a bit more disk I/O which may just make it
21287 slower. Also note that if other software reads the mboxes/maildirs,
21288 they may handle the extra CRs wrong and cause problems.
21289 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
21290 @end deftypevr
21291
21292 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean maildir-stat-dirs?
21293 By default LIST command returns all entries in maildir beginning
21294 with a dot. Enabling this option makes Dovecot return only entries
21295 which are directories. This is done by stat()ing each entry, so it
21296 causes more disk I/O.
21297 (For systems setting struct @samp{dirent->d_type} this check is free
21298 and it's done always regardless of this setting).
21299 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
21300 @end deftypevr
21301
21302 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean maildir-copy-with-hardlinks?
21303 When copying a message, do it with hard links whenever possible.
21304 This makes the performance much better, and it's unlikely to have any
21305 side effects.
21306 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
21307 @end deftypevr
21308
21309 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean maildir-very-dirty-syncs?
21310 Assume Dovecot is the only MUA accessing Maildir: Scan cur/
21311 directory only when its mtime changes unexpectedly or when we can't find
21312 the mail otherwise.
21313 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
21314 @end deftypevr
21315
21316 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list mbox-read-locks
21317 Which locking methods to use for locking mbox. There are four
21318 available:
21319
21320 @table @code
21321 @item dotlock
21322 Create <mailbox>.lock file. This is the oldest and most NFS-safe
21323 solution. If you want to use /var/mail/ like directory, the users will
21324 need write access to that directory.
21325 @item dotlock-try
21326 Same as dotlock, but if it fails because of permissions or because there
21327 isn't enough disk space, just skip it.
21328 @item fcntl
21329 Use this if possible. Works with NFS too if lockd is used.
21330 @item flock
21331 May not exist in all systems. Doesn't work with NFS.
21332 @item lockf
21333 May not exist in all systems. Doesn't work with NFS.
21334 @end table
21335
21336 You can use multiple locking methods; if you do the order they're declared
21337 in is important to avoid deadlocks if other MTAs/MUAs are using multiple
21338 locking methods as well. Some operating systems don't allow using some of
21339 them simultaneously.
21340 @end deftypevr
21341
21342 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list mbox-write-locks
21343
21344 @end deftypevr
21345
21346 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mbox-lock-timeout
21347 Maximum time to wait for lock (all of them) before aborting.
21348 Defaults to @samp{"5 mins"}.
21349 @end deftypevr
21350
21351 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mbox-dotlock-change-timeout
21352 If dotlock exists but the mailbox isn't modified in any way,
21353 override the lock file after this much time.
21354 Defaults to @samp{"2 mins"}.
21355 @end deftypevr
21356
21357 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean mbox-dirty-syncs?
21358 When mbox changes unexpectedly we have to fully read it to find out
21359 what changed. If the mbox is large this can take a long time. Since
21360 the change is usually just a newly appended mail, it'd be faster to
21361 simply read the new mails. If this setting is enabled, Dovecot does
21362 this but still safely fallbacks to re-reading the whole mbox file
21363 whenever something in mbox isn't how it's expected to be. The only real
21364 downside to this setting is that if some other MUA changes message
21365 flags, Dovecot doesn't notice it immediately. Note that a full sync is
21366 done with SELECT, EXAMINE, EXPUNGE and CHECK commands.
21367 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
21368 @end deftypevr
21369
21370 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean mbox-very-dirty-syncs?
21371 Like @samp{mbox-dirty-syncs}, but don't do full syncs even with SELECT,
21372 EXAMINE, EXPUNGE or CHECK commands. If this is set,
21373 @samp{mbox-dirty-syncs} is ignored.
21374 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
21375 @end deftypevr
21376
21377 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean mbox-lazy-writes?
21378 Delay writing mbox headers until doing a full write sync (EXPUNGE
21379 and CHECK commands and when closing the mailbox). This is especially
21380 useful for POP3 where clients often delete all mails. The downside is
21381 that our changes aren't immediately visible to other MUAs.
21382 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
21383 @end deftypevr
21384
21385 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer mbox-min-index-size
21386 If mbox size is smaller than this (e.g.@: 100k), don't write index
21387 files. If an index file already exists it's still read, just not
21388 updated.
21389 Defaults to @samp{0}.
21390 @end deftypevr
21391
21392 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer mdbox-rotate-size
21393 Maximum dbox file size until it's rotated.
21394 Defaults to @samp{10000000}.
21395 @end deftypevr
21396
21397 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mdbox-rotate-interval
21398 Maximum dbox file age until it's rotated. Typically in days. Day
21399 begins from midnight, so 1d = today, 2d = yesterday, etc. 0 = check
21400 disabled.
21401 Defaults to @samp{"1d"}.
21402 @end deftypevr
21403
21404 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean mdbox-preallocate-space?
21405 When creating new mdbox files, immediately preallocate their size to
21406 @samp{mdbox-rotate-size}. This setting currently works only in Linux
21407 with some file systems (ext4, xfs).
21408 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
21409 @end deftypevr
21410
21411 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mail-attachment-dir
21412 sdbox and mdbox support saving mail attachments to external files,
21413 which also allows single instance storage for them. Other backends
21414 don't support this for now.
21415
21416 WARNING: This feature hasn't been tested much yet. Use at your own risk.
21417
21418 Directory root where to store mail attachments. Disabled, if empty.
21419 Defaults to @samp{""}.
21420 @end deftypevr
21421
21422 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer mail-attachment-min-size
21423 Attachments smaller than this aren't saved externally. It's also
21424 possible to write a plugin to disable saving specific attachments
21425 externally.
21426 Defaults to @samp{128000}.
21427 @end deftypevr
21428
21429 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mail-attachment-fs
21430 File system backend to use for saving attachments:
21431 @table @code
21432 @item posix
21433 No SiS done by Dovecot (but this might help FS's own deduplication)
21434 @item sis posix
21435 SiS with immediate byte-by-byte comparison during saving
21436 @item sis-queue posix
21437 SiS with delayed comparison and deduplication.
21438 @end table
21439 Defaults to @samp{"sis posix"}.
21440 @end deftypevr
21441
21442 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mail-attachment-hash
21443 Hash format to use in attachment filenames. You can add any text and
21444 variables: @code{%@{md4@}}, @code{%@{md5@}}, @code{%@{sha1@}},
21445 @code{%@{sha256@}}, @code{%@{sha512@}}, @code{%@{size@}}. Variables can be
21446 truncated, e.g.@: @code{%@{sha256:80@}} returns only first 80 bits.
21447 Defaults to @samp{"%@{sha1@}"}.
21448 @end deftypevr
21449
21450 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer default-process-limit
21451
21452 Defaults to @samp{100}.
21453 @end deftypevr
21454
21455 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer default-client-limit
21456
21457 Defaults to @samp{1000}.
21458 @end deftypevr
21459
21460 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer default-vsz-limit
21461 Default VSZ (virtual memory size) limit for service processes.
21462 This is mainly intended to catch and kill processes that leak memory
21463 before they eat up everything.
21464 Defaults to @samp{256000000}.
21465 @end deftypevr
21466
21467 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string default-login-user
21468 Login user is internally used by login processes. This is the most
21469 untrusted user in Dovecot system. It shouldn't have access to anything
21470 at all.
21471 Defaults to @samp{"dovenull"}.
21472 @end deftypevr
21473
21474 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string default-internal-user
21475 Internal user is used by unprivileged processes. It should be
21476 separate from login user, so that login processes can't disturb other
21477 processes.
21478 Defaults to @samp{"dovecot"}.
21479 @end deftypevr
21480
21481 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string ssl?
21482 SSL/TLS support: yes, no, required. <doc/wiki/SSL.txt>.
21483 Defaults to @samp{"required"}.
21484 @end deftypevr
21485
21486 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string ssl-cert
21487 PEM encoded X.509 SSL/TLS certificate (public key).
21488 Defaults to @samp{"</etc/dovecot/default.pem"}.
21489 @end deftypevr
21490
21491 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string ssl-key
21492 PEM encoded SSL/TLS private key. The key is opened before
21493 dropping root privileges, so keep the key file unreadable by anyone but
21494 root.
21495 Defaults to @samp{"</etc/dovecot/private/default.pem"}.
21496 @end deftypevr
21497
21498 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string ssl-key-password
21499 If key file is password protected, give the password here.
21500 Alternatively give it when starting dovecot with -p parameter. Since
21501 this file is often world-readable, you may want to place this setting
21502 instead to a different.
21503 Defaults to @samp{""}.
21504 @end deftypevr
21505
21506 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string ssl-ca
21507 PEM encoded trusted certificate authority. Set this only if you
21508 intend to use @samp{ssl-verify-client-cert? #t}. The file should
21509 contain the CA certificate(s) followed by the matching
21510 CRL(s). (e.g.@: @samp{ssl-ca </etc/ssl/certs/ca.pem}).
21511 Defaults to @samp{""}.
21512 @end deftypevr
21513
21514 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean ssl-require-crl?
21515 Require that CRL check succeeds for client certificates.
21516 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
21517 @end deftypevr
21518
21519 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean ssl-verify-client-cert?
21520 Request client to send a certificate. If you also want to require
21521 it, set @samp{auth-ssl-require-client-cert? #t} in auth section.
21522 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
21523 @end deftypevr
21524
21525 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string ssl-cert-username-field
21526 Which field from certificate to use for username. commonName and
21527 x500UniqueIdentifier are the usual choices. You'll also need to set
21528 @samp{auth-ssl-username-from-cert? #t}.
21529 Defaults to @samp{"commonName"}.
21530 @end deftypevr
21531
21532 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string ssl-min-protocol
21533 Minimum SSL protocol version to accept.
21534 Defaults to @samp{"TLSv1"}.
21535 @end deftypevr
21536
21537 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string ssl-cipher-list
21538 SSL ciphers to use.
21539 Defaults to @samp{"ALL:!kRSA:!SRP:!kDHd:!DSS:!aNULL:!eNULL:!EXPORT:!DES:!3DES:!MD5:!PSK:!RC4:!ADH:!LOW@@STRENGTH"}.
21540 @end deftypevr
21541
21542 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string ssl-crypto-device
21543 SSL crypto device to use, for valid values run "openssl engine".
21544 Defaults to @samp{""}.
21545 @end deftypevr
21546
21547 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string postmaster-address
21548 Address to use when sending rejection mails.
21549 %d expands to recipient domain.
21550 Defaults to @samp{"postmaster@@%d"}.
21551 @end deftypevr
21552
21553 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string hostname
21554 Hostname to use in various parts of sent mails (e.g.@: in Message-Id)
21555 and in LMTP replies. Default is the system's real hostname@@domain.
21556 Defaults to @samp{""}.
21557 @end deftypevr
21558
21559 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean quota-full-tempfail?
21560 If user is over quota, return with temporary failure instead of
21561 bouncing the mail.
21562 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
21563 @end deftypevr
21564
21565 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} file-name sendmail-path
21566 Binary to use for sending mails.
21567 Defaults to @samp{"/usr/sbin/sendmail"}.
21568 @end deftypevr
21569
21570 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string submission-host
21571 If non-empty, send mails via this SMTP host[:port] instead of
21572 sendmail.
21573 Defaults to @samp{""}.
21574 @end deftypevr
21575
21576 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string rejection-subject
21577 Subject: header to use for rejection mails. You can use the same
21578 variables as for @samp{rejection-reason} below.
21579 Defaults to @samp{"Rejected: %s"}.
21580 @end deftypevr
21581
21582 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string rejection-reason
21583 Human readable error message for rejection mails. You can use
21584 variables:
21585
21586 @table @code
21587 @item %n
21588 CRLF
21589 @item %r
21590 reason
21591 @item %s
21592 original subject
21593 @item %t
21594 recipient
21595 @end table
21596 Defaults to @samp{"Your message to <%t> was automatically rejected:%n%r"}.
21597 @end deftypevr
21598
21599 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string recipient-delimiter
21600 Delimiter character between local-part and detail in email
21601 address.
21602 Defaults to @samp{"+"}.
21603 @end deftypevr
21604
21605 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string lda-original-recipient-header
21606 Header where the original recipient address (SMTP's RCPT TO:
21607 address) is taken from if not available elsewhere. With dovecot-lda -a
21608 parameter overrides this. A commonly used header for this is
21609 X-Original-To.
21610 Defaults to @samp{""}.
21611 @end deftypevr
21612
21613 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean lda-mailbox-autocreate?
21614 Should saving a mail to a nonexistent mailbox automatically create
21615 it?.
21616 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
21617 @end deftypevr
21618
21619 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean lda-mailbox-autosubscribe?
21620 Should automatically created mailboxes be also automatically
21621 subscribed?.
21622 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
21623 @end deftypevr
21624
21625 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer imap-max-line-length
21626 Maximum IMAP command line length. Some clients generate very long
21627 command lines with huge mailboxes, so you may need to raise this if you
21628 get "Too long argument" or "IMAP command line too large" errors
21629 often.
21630 Defaults to @samp{64000}.
21631 @end deftypevr
21632
21633 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string imap-logout-format
21634 IMAP logout format string:
21635 @table @code
21636 @item %i
21637 total number of bytes read from client
21638 @item %o
21639 total number of bytes sent to client.
21640 @end table
21641 See @file{doc/wiki/Variables.txt} for a list of all the variables you can use.
21642 Defaults to @samp{"in=%i out=%o deleted=%@{deleted@} expunged=%@{expunged@} trashed=%@{trashed@} hdr_count=%@{fetch_hdr_count@} hdr_bytes=%@{fetch_hdr_bytes@} body_count=%@{fetch_body_count@} body_bytes=%@{fetch_body_bytes@}"}.
21643 @end deftypevr
21644
21645 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string imap-capability
21646 Override the IMAP CAPABILITY response. If the value begins with '+',
21647 add the given capabilities on top of the defaults (e.g.@: +XFOO XBAR).
21648 Defaults to @samp{""}.
21649 @end deftypevr
21650
21651 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string imap-idle-notify-interval
21652 How long to wait between "OK Still here" notifications when client
21653 is IDLEing.
21654 Defaults to @samp{"2 mins"}.
21655 @end deftypevr
21656
21657 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string imap-id-send
21658 ID field names and values to send to clients. Using * as the value
21659 makes Dovecot use the default value. The following fields have default
21660 values currently: name, version, os, os-version, support-url,
21661 support-email.
21662 Defaults to @samp{""}.
21663 @end deftypevr
21664
21665 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string imap-id-log
21666 ID fields sent by client to log. * means everything.
21667 Defaults to @samp{""}.
21668 @end deftypevr
21669
21670 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list imap-client-workarounds
21671 Workarounds for various client bugs:
21672
21673 @table @code
21674 @item delay-newmail
21675 Send EXISTS/RECENT new mail notifications only when replying to NOOP and
21676 CHECK commands. Some clients ignore them otherwise, for example OSX
21677 Mail (<v2.1). Outlook Express breaks more badly though, without this it
21678 may show user "Message no longer in server" errors. Note that OE6
21679 still breaks even with this workaround if synchronization is set to
21680 "Headers Only".
21681
21682 @item tb-extra-mailbox-sep
21683 Thunderbird gets somehow confused with LAYOUT=fs (mbox and dbox) and
21684 adds extra @samp{/} suffixes to mailbox names. This option causes Dovecot to
21685 ignore the extra @samp{/} instead of treating it as invalid mailbox name.
21686
21687 @item tb-lsub-flags
21688 Show \Noselect flags for LSUB replies with LAYOUT=fs (e.g.@: mbox).
21689 This makes Thunderbird realize they aren't selectable and show them
21690 greyed out, instead of only later giving "not selectable" popup error.
21691 @end table
21692 Defaults to @samp{()}.
21693 @end deftypevr
21694
21695 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string imap-urlauth-host
21696 Host allowed in URLAUTH URLs sent by client. "*" allows all.
21697 Defaults to @samp{""}.
21698 @end deftypevr
21699
21700
21701 Whew! Lots of configuration options. The nice thing about it though is
21702 that Guix has a complete interface to Dovecot's configuration
21703 language. This allows not only a nice way to declare configurations,
21704 but also offers reflective capabilities as well: users can write code to
21705 inspect and transform configurations from within Scheme.
21706
21707 However, it could be that you just want to get a @code{dovecot.conf} up
21708 and running. In that case, you can pass an
21709 @code{opaque-dovecot-configuration} as the @code{#:config} parameter to
21710 @code{dovecot-service}. As its name indicates, an opaque configuration
21711 does not have easy reflective capabilities.
21712
21713 Available @code{opaque-dovecot-configuration} fields are:
21714
21715 @deftypevr {@code{opaque-dovecot-configuration} parameter} package dovecot
21716 The dovecot package.
21717 @end deftypevr
21718
21719 @deftypevr {@code{opaque-dovecot-configuration} parameter} string string
21720 The contents of the @code{dovecot.conf}, as a string.
21721 @end deftypevr
21722
21723 For example, if your @code{dovecot.conf} is just the empty string, you
21724 could instantiate a dovecot service like this:
21725
21726 @lisp
21727 (dovecot-service #:config
21728 (opaque-dovecot-configuration
21729 (string "")))
21730 @end lisp
21731
21732 @subsubheading OpenSMTPD Service
21733
21734 @deffn {Scheme Variable} opensmtpd-service-type
21735 This is the type of the @uref{https://www.opensmtpd.org, OpenSMTPD}
21736 service, whose value should be an @code{opensmtpd-configuration} object
21737 as in this example:
21738
21739 @lisp
21740 (service opensmtpd-service-type
21741 (opensmtpd-configuration
21742 (config-file (local-file "./my-smtpd.conf"))))
21743 @end lisp
21744 @end deffn
21745
21746 @deftp {Data Type} opensmtpd-configuration
21747 Data type representing the configuration of opensmtpd.
21748
21749 @table @asis
21750 @item @code{package} (default: @var{opensmtpd})
21751 Package object of the OpenSMTPD SMTP server.
21752
21753 @item @code{config-file} (default: @code{%default-opensmtpd-file})
21754 File-like object of the OpenSMTPD configuration file to use. By default
21755 it listens on the loopback network interface, and allows for mail from
21756 users and daemons on the local machine, as well as permitting email to
21757 remote servers. Run @command{man smtpd.conf} for more information.
21758
21759 @end table
21760 @end deftp
21761
21762 @subsubheading Exim Service
21763
21764 @cindex mail transfer agent (MTA)
21765 @cindex MTA (mail transfer agent)
21766 @cindex SMTP
21767
21768 @deffn {Scheme Variable} exim-service-type
21769 This is the type of the @uref{https://exim.org, Exim} mail transfer
21770 agent (MTA), whose value should be an @code{exim-configuration} object
21771 as in this example:
21772
21773 @lisp
21774 (service exim-service-type
21775 (exim-configuration
21776 (config-file (local-file "./my-exim.conf"))))
21777 @end lisp
21778 @end deffn
21779
21780 In order to use an @code{exim-service-type} service you must also have a
21781 @code{mail-aliases-service-type} service present in your
21782 @code{operating-system} (even if it has no aliases).
21783
21784 @deftp {Data Type} exim-configuration
21785 Data type representing the configuration of exim.
21786
21787 @table @asis
21788 @item @code{package} (default: @var{exim})
21789 Package object of the Exim server.
21790
21791 @item @code{config-file} (default: @code{#f})
21792 File-like object of the Exim configuration file to use. If its value is
21793 @code{#f} then use the default configuration file from the package
21794 provided in @code{package}. The resulting configuration file is loaded
21795 after setting the @code{exim_user} and @code{exim_group} configuration
21796 variables.
21797
21798 @end table
21799 @end deftp
21800
21801 @subsubheading Getmail service
21802
21803 @cindex IMAP
21804 @cindex POP
21805
21806 @deffn {Scheme Variable} getmail-service-type
21807 This is the type of the @uref{http://pyropus.ca/software/getmail/, Getmail}
21808 mail retriever, whose value should be an @code{getmail-configuration}.
21809 @end deffn
21810
21811 Available @code{getmail-configuration} fields are:
21812
21813 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-configuration} parameter} symbol name
21814 A symbol to identify the getmail service.
21815
21816 Defaults to @samp{"unset"}.
21817
21818 @end deftypevr
21819
21820 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-configuration} parameter} package package
21821 The getmail package to use.
21822
21823 @end deftypevr
21824
21825 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-configuration} parameter} string user
21826 The user to run getmail as.
21827
21828 Defaults to @samp{"getmail"}.
21829
21830 @end deftypevr
21831
21832 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-configuration} parameter} string group
21833 The group to run getmail as.
21834
21835 Defaults to @samp{"getmail"}.
21836
21837 @end deftypevr
21838
21839 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-configuration} parameter} string directory
21840 The getmail directory to use.
21841
21842 Defaults to @samp{"/var/lib/getmail/default"}.
21843
21844 @end deftypevr
21845
21846 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-configuration} parameter} getmail-configuration-file rcfile
21847 The getmail configuration file to use.
21848
21849 Available @code{getmail-configuration-file} fields are:
21850
21851 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-configuration-file} parameter} getmail-retriever-configuration retriever
21852 What mail account to retrieve mail from, and how to access that account.
21853
21854 Available @code{getmail-retriever-configuration} fields are:
21855
21856 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-retriever-configuration} parameter} string type
21857 The type of mail retriever to use. Valid values include @samp{passwd}
21858 and @samp{static}.
21859
21860 Defaults to @samp{"SimpleIMAPSSLRetriever"}.
21861
21862 @end deftypevr
21863
21864 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-retriever-configuration} parameter} string server
21865 Username to login to the mail server with.
21866
21867 Defaults to @samp{unset}.
21868
21869 @end deftypevr
21870
21871 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-retriever-configuration} parameter} string username
21872 Username to login to the mail server with.
21873
21874 Defaults to @samp{unset}.
21875
21876 @end deftypevr
21877
21878 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-retriever-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer port
21879 Port number to connect to.
21880
21881 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
21882
21883 @end deftypevr
21884
21885 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-retriever-configuration} parameter} string password
21886 Override fields from passwd.
21887
21888 Defaults to @samp{""}.
21889
21890 @end deftypevr
21891
21892 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-retriever-configuration} parameter} list password-command
21893 Override fields from passwd.
21894
21895 Defaults to @samp{()}.
21896
21897 @end deftypevr
21898
21899 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-retriever-configuration} parameter} string keyfile
21900 PEM-formatted key file to use for the TLS negotiation.
21901
21902 Defaults to @samp{""}.
21903
21904 @end deftypevr
21905
21906 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-retriever-configuration} parameter} string certfile
21907 PEM-formatted certificate file to use for the TLS negotiation.
21908
21909 Defaults to @samp{""}.
21910
21911 @end deftypevr
21912
21913 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-retriever-configuration} parameter} string ca-certs
21914 CA certificates to use.
21915
21916 Defaults to @samp{""}.
21917
21918 @end deftypevr
21919
21920 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-retriever-configuration} parameter} parameter-alist extra-parameters
21921 Extra retriever parameters.
21922
21923 Defaults to @samp{()}.
21924
21925 @end deftypevr
21926
21927 @end deftypevr
21928
21929 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-configuration-file} parameter} getmail-destination-configuration destination
21930 What to do with retrieved messages.
21931
21932 Available @code{getmail-destination-configuration} fields are:
21933
21934 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-destination-configuration} parameter} string type
21935 The type of mail destination. Valid values include @samp{Maildir},
21936 @samp{Mboxrd} and @samp{MDA_external}.
21937
21938 Defaults to @samp{unset}.
21939
21940 @end deftypevr
21941
21942 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-destination-configuration} parameter} string-or-filelike path
21943 The path option for the mail destination. The behaviour depends on the
21944 chosen type.
21945
21946 Defaults to @samp{""}.
21947
21948 @end deftypevr
21949
21950 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-destination-configuration} parameter} parameter-alist extra-parameters
21951 Extra destination parameters
21952
21953 Defaults to @samp{()}.
21954
21955 @end deftypevr
21956
21957 @end deftypevr
21958
21959 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-configuration-file} parameter} getmail-options-configuration options
21960 Configure getmail.
21961
21962 Available @code{getmail-options-configuration} fields are:
21963
21964 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-options-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer verbose
21965 If set to @samp{0}, getmail will only print warnings and errors. A
21966 value of @samp{1} means that messages will be printed about retrieving
21967 and deleting messages. If set to @samp{2}, getmail will print messages
21968 about each of its actions.
21969
21970 Defaults to @samp{1}.
21971
21972 @end deftypevr
21973
21974 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-options-configuration} parameter} boolean read-all
21975 If true, getmail will retrieve all available messages. Otherwise it
21976 will only retrieve messages it hasn't seen previously.
21977
21978 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
21979
21980 @end deftypevr
21981
21982 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-options-configuration} parameter} boolean delete
21983 If set to true, messages will be deleted from the server after
21984 retrieving and successfully delivering them. Otherwise, messages will
21985 be left on the server.
21986
21987 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
21988
21989 @end deftypevr
21990
21991 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-options-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer delete-after
21992 Getmail will delete messages this number of days after seeing them, if
21993 they have been delivered. This means messages will be left on the
21994 server this number of days after delivering them. A value of @samp{0}
21995 disabled this feature.
21996
21997 Defaults to @samp{0}.
21998
21999 @end deftypevr
22000
22001 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-options-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer delete-bigger-than
22002 Delete messages larger than this of bytes after retrieving them, even if
22003 the delete and delete-after options are disabled. A value of @samp{0}
22004 disables this feature.
22005
22006 Defaults to @samp{0}.
22007
22008 @end deftypevr
22009
22010 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-options-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer max-bytes-per-session
22011 Retrieve messages totalling up to this number of bytes before closing
22012 the session with the server. A value of @samp{0} disables this feature.
22013
22014 Defaults to @samp{0}.
22015
22016 @end deftypevr
22017
22018 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-options-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer max-message-size
22019 Don't retrieve messages larger than this number of bytes. A value of
22020 @samp{0} disables this feature.
22021
22022 Defaults to @samp{0}.
22023
22024 @end deftypevr
22025
22026 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-options-configuration} parameter} boolean delivered-to
22027 If true, getmail will add a Delivered-To header to messages.
22028
22029 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
22030
22031 @end deftypevr
22032
22033 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-options-configuration} parameter} boolean received
22034 If set, getmail adds a Received header to the messages.
22035
22036 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
22037
22038 @end deftypevr
22039
22040 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-options-configuration} parameter} string message-log
22041 Getmail will record a log of its actions to the named file. A value of
22042 @samp{""} disables this feature.
22043
22044 Defaults to @samp{""}.
22045
22046 @end deftypevr
22047
22048 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-options-configuration} parameter} boolean message-log-syslog
22049 If true, getmail will record a log of its actions using the system
22050 logger.
22051
22052 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
22053
22054 @end deftypevr
22055
22056 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-options-configuration} parameter} boolean message-log-verbose
22057 If true, getmail will log information about messages not retrieved and
22058 the reason for not retrieving them, as well as starting and ending
22059 information lines.
22060
22061 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
22062
22063 @end deftypevr
22064
22065 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-options-configuration} parameter} parameter-alist extra-parameters
22066 Extra options to include.
22067
22068 Defaults to @samp{()}.
22069
22070 @end deftypevr
22071
22072 @end deftypevr
22073
22074 @end deftypevr
22075
22076 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-configuration} parameter} list idle
22077 A list of mailboxes that getmail should wait on the server for new mail
22078 notifications. This depends on the server supporting the IDLE
22079 extension.
22080
22081 Defaults to @samp{()}.
22082
22083 @end deftypevr
22084
22085 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-configuration} parameter} list environment-variables
22086 Environment variables to set for getmail.
22087
22088 Defaults to @samp{()}.
22089
22090 @end deftypevr
22091
22092 @subsubheading Mail Aliases Service
22093
22094 @cindex email aliases
22095 @cindex aliases, for email addresses
22096
22097 @deffn {Scheme Variable} mail-aliases-service-type
22098 This is the type of the service which provides @code{/etc/aliases},
22099 specifying how to deliver mail to users on this system.
22100
22101 @lisp
22102 (service mail-aliases-service-type
22103 '(("postmaster" "bob")
22104 ("bob" "bob@@example.com" "bob@@example2.com")))
22105 @end lisp
22106 @end deffn
22107
22108 The configuration for a @code{mail-aliases-service-type} service is an
22109 association list denoting how to deliver mail that comes to this
22110 system. Each entry is of the form @code{(alias addresses ...)}, with
22111 @code{alias} specifying the local alias and @code{addresses} specifying
22112 where to deliver this user's mail.
22113
22114 The aliases aren't required to exist as users on the local system. In
22115 the above example, there doesn't need to be a @code{postmaster} entry in
22116 the @code{operating-system}'s @code{user-accounts} in order to deliver
22117 the @code{postmaster} mail to @code{bob} (which subsequently would
22118 deliver mail to @code{bob@@example.com} and @code{bob@@example2.com}).
22119
22120 @subsubheading GNU Mailutils IMAP4 Daemon
22121 @cindex GNU Mailutils IMAP4 Daemon
22122
22123 @deffn {Scheme Variable} imap4d-service-type
22124 This is the type of the GNU Mailutils IMAP4 Daemon (@pxref{imap4d,,,
22125 mailutils, GNU Mailutils Manual}), whose value should be an
22126 @code{imap4d-configuration} object as in this example:
22127
22128 @lisp
22129 (service imap4d-service-type
22130 (imap4d-configuration
22131 (config-file (local-file "imap4d.conf"))))
22132 @end lisp
22133 @end deffn
22134
22135 @deftp {Data Type} imap4d-configuration
22136 Data type representing the configuration of @command{imap4d}.
22137
22138 @table @asis
22139 @item @code{package} (default: @code{mailutils})
22140 The package that provides @command{imap4d}.
22141
22142 @item @code{config-file} (default: @code{%default-imap4d-config-file})
22143 File-like object of the configuration file to use, by default it will listen
22144 on TCP port 143 of @code{localhost}. @xref{Conf-imap4d,,, mailutils, GNU
22145 Mailutils Manual}, for details.
22146
22147 @end table
22148 @end deftp
22149
22150 @subsubheading Radicale Service
22151 @cindex CalDAV
22152 @cindex CardDAV
22153
22154 @deffn {Scheme Variable} radicale-service-type
22155 This is the type of the @uref{https://radicale.org, Radicale} CalDAV/CardDAV
22156 server whose value should be a @code{radicale-configuration}.
22157 @end deffn
22158
22159 @deftp {Data Type} radicale-configuration
22160 Data type representing the configuration of @command{radicale}.
22161
22162 @table @asis
22163 @item @code{package} (default: @code{radicale})
22164 The package that provides @command{radicale}.
22165
22166 @item @code{config-file} (default: @code{%default-radicale-config-file})
22167 File-like object of the configuration file to use, by default it will listen
22168 on TCP port 5232 of @code{localhost} and use the @code{htpasswd} file at
22169 @file{/var/lib/radicale/users} with no (@code{plain}) encryption.
22170
22171 @end table
22172 @end deftp
22173
22174 @node Messaging Services
22175 @subsection Messaging Services
22176
22177 @cindex messaging
22178 @cindex jabber
22179 @cindex XMPP
22180 The @code{(gnu services messaging)} module provides Guix service
22181 definitions for messaging services. Currently it provides the following
22182 services:
22183
22184 @subsubheading Prosody Service
22185
22186 @deffn {Scheme Variable} prosody-service-type
22187 This is the type for the @uref{https://prosody.im, Prosody XMPP
22188 communication server}. Its value must be a @code{prosody-configuration}
22189 record as in this example:
22190
22191 @lisp
22192 (service prosody-service-type
22193 (prosody-configuration
22194 (modules-enabled (cons* "groups" "mam" %default-modules-enabled))
22195 (int-components
22196 (list
22197 (int-component-configuration
22198 (hostname "conference.example.net")
22199 (plugin "muc")
22200 (mod-muc (mod-muc-configuration)))))
22201 (virtualhosts
22202 (list
22203 (virtualhost-configuration
22204 (domain "example.net"))))))
22205 @end lisp
22206
22207 See below for details about @code{prosody-configuration}.
22208
22209 @end deffn
22210
22211 By default, Prosody does not need much configuration. Only one
22212 @code{virtualhosts} field is needed: it specifies the domain you wish
22213 Prosody to serve.
22214
22215 You can perform various sanity checks on the generated configuration
22216 with the @code{prosodyctl check} command.
22217
22218 Prosodyctl will also help you to import certificates from the
22219 @code{letsencrypt} directory so that the @code{prosody} user can access
22220 them. See @url{https://prosody.im/doc/letsencrypt}.
22221
22222 @example
22223 prosodyctl --root cert import /etc/letsencrypt/live
22224 @end example
22225
22226 The available configuration parameters follow. Each parameter
22227 definition is preceded by its type; for example, @samp{string-list foo}
22228 indicates that the @code{foo} parameter should be specified as a list of
22229 strings. Types starting with @code{maybe-} denote parameters that won't
22230 show up in @code{prosody.cfg.lua} when their value is @code{'disabled}.
22231
22232 There is also a way to specify the configuration as a string, if you
22233 have an old @code{prosody.cfg.lua} file that you want to port over from
22234 some other system; see the end for more details.
22235
22236 The @code{file-object} type designates either a file-like object
22237 (@pxref{G-Expressions, file-like objects}) or a file name.
22238
22239 @c The following documentation was initially generated by
22240 @c (generate-documentation) in (gnu services messaging). Manually maintained
22241 @c documentation is better, so we shouldn't hesitate to edit below as
22242 @c needed. However if the change you want to make to this documentation
22243 @c can be done in an automated way, it's probably easier to change
22244 @c (generate-documentation) than to make it below and have to deal with
22245 @c the churn as Prosody updates.
22246
22247 Available @code{prosody-configuration} fields are:
22248
22249 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} package prosody
22250 The Prosody package.
22251 @end deftypevr
22252
22253 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} file-name data-path
22254 Location of the Prosody data storage directory. See
22255 @url{https://prosody.im/doc/configure}.
22256 Defaults to @samp{"/var/lib/prosody"}.
22257 @end deftypevr
22258
22259 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} file-object-list plugin-paths
22260 Additional plugin directories. They are searched in all the specified
22261 paths in order. See @url{https://prosody.im/doc/plugins_directory}.
22262 Defaults to @samp{()}.
22263 @end deftypevr
22264
22265 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} file-name certificates
22266 Every virtual host and component needs a certificate so that clients and
22267 servers can securely verify its identity. Prosody will automatically load
22268 certificates/keys from the directory specified here.
22269 Defaults to @samp{"/etc/prosody/certs"}.
22270 @end deftypevr
22271
22272 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} string-list admins
22273 This is a list of accounts that are admins for the server. Note that you
22274 must create the accounts separately. See @url{https://prosody.im/doc/admins} and
22275 @url{https://prosody.im/doc/creating_accounts}.
22276 Example: @code{(admins '("user1@@example.com" "user2@@example.net"))}
22277 Defaults to @samp{()}.
22278 @end deftypevr
22279
22280 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} boolean use-libevent?
22281 Enable use of libevent for better performance under high load. See
22282 @url{https://prosody.im/doc/libevent}.
22283 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
22284 @end deftypevr
22285
22286 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} module-list modules-enabled
22287 This is the list of modules Prosody will load on startup. It looks for
22288 @code{mod_modulename.lua} in the plugins folder, so make sure that exists too.
22289 Documentation on modules can be found at:
22290 @url{https://prosody.im/doc/modules}.
22291 Defaults to @samp{("roster" "saslauth" "tls" "dialback" "disco" "carbons" "private" "blocklist" "vcard" "version" "uptime" "time" "ping" "pep" "register" "admin_adhoc")}.
22292 @end deftypevr
22293
22294 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} string-list modules-disabled
22295 @samp{"offline"}, @samp{"c2s"} and @samp{"s2s"} are auto-loaded, but
22296 should you want to disable them then add them to this list.
22297 Defaults to @samp{()}.
22298 @end deftypevr
22299
22300 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} file-object groups-file
22301 Path to a text file where the shared groups are defined. If this path is
22302 empty then @samp{mod_groups} does nothing. See
22303 @url{https://prosody.im/doc/modules/mod_groups}.
22304 Defaults to @samp{"/var/lib/prosody/sharedgroups.txt"}.
22305 @end deftypevr
22306
22307 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} boolean allow-registration?
22308 Disable account creation by default, for security. See
22309 @url{https://prosody.im/doc/creating_accounts}.
22310 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
22311 @end deftypevr
22312
22313 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} maybe-ssl-configuration ssl
22314 These are the SSL/TLS-related settings. Most of them are disabled so to
22315 use Prosody's defaults. If you do not completely understand these options, do
22316 not add them to your config, it is easy to lower the security of your server
22317 using them. See @url{https://prosody.im/doc/advanced_ssl_config}.
22318
22319 Available @code{ssl-configuration} fields are:
22320
22321 @deftypevr {@code{ssl-configuration} parameter} maybe-string protocol
22322 This determines what handshake to use.
22323 @end deftypevr
22324
22325 @deftypevr {@code{ssl-configuration} parameter} maybe-file-name key
22326 Path to your private key file.
22327 @end deftypevr
22328
22329 @deftypevr {@code{ssl-configuration} parameter} maybe-file-name certificate
22330 Path to your certificate file.
22331 @end deftypevr
22332
22333 @deftypevr {@code{ssl-configuration} parameter} file-object capath
22334 Path to directory containing root certificates that you wish Prosody to
22335 trust when verifying the certificates of remote servers.
22336 Defaults to @samp{"/etc/ssl/certs"}.
22337 @end deftypevr
22338
22339 @deftypevr {@code{ssl-configuration} parameter} maybe-file-object cafile
22340 Path to a file containing root certificates that you wish Prosody to trust.
22341 Similar to @code{capath} but with all certificates concatenated together.
22342 @end deftypevr
22343
22344 @deftypevr {@code{ssl-configuration} parameter} maybe-string-list verify
22345 A list of verification options (these mostly map to OpenSSL's
22346 @code{set_verify()} flags).
22347 @end deftypevr
22348
22349 @deftypevr {@code{ssl-configuration} parameter} maybe-string-list options
22350 A list of general options relating to SSL/TLS@. These map to OpenSSL's
22351 @code{set_options()}. For a full list of options available in LuaSec, see the
22352 LuaSec source.
22353 @end deftypevr
22354
22355 @deftypevr {@code{ssl-configuration} parameter} maybe-non-negative-integer depth
22356 How long a chain of certificate authorities to check when looking for a
22357 trusted root certificate.
22358 @end deftypevr
22359
22360 @deftypevr {@code{ssl-configuration} parameter} maybe-string ciphers
22361 An OpenSSL cipher string. This selects what ciphers Prosody will offer to
22362 clients, and in what order.
22363 @end deftypevr
22364
22365 @deftypevr {@code{ssl-configuration} parameter} maybe-file-name dhparam
22366 A path to a file containing parameters for Diffie-Hellman key exchange. You
22367 can create such a file with:
22368 @code{openssl dhparam -out /etc/prosody/certs/dh-2048.pem 2048}
22369 @end deftypevr
22370
22371 @deftypevr {@code{ssl-configuration} parameter} maybe-string curve
22372 Curve for Elliptic curve Diffie-Hellman. Prosody's default is
22373 @samp{"secp384r1"}.
22374 @end deftypevr
22375
22376 @deftypevr {@code{ssl-configuration} parameter} maybe-string-list verifyext
22377 A list of ``extra'' verification options.
22378 @end deftypevr
22379
22380 @deftypevr {@code{ssl-configuration} parameter} maybe-string password
22381 Password for encrypted private keys.
22382 @end deftypevr
22383
22384 @end deftypevr
22385
22386 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} boolean c2s-require-encryption?
22387 Whether to force all client-to-server connections to be encrypted or not.
22388 See @url{https://prosody.im/doc/modules/mod_tls}.
22389 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
22390 @end deftypevr
22391
22392 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} string-list disable-sasl-mechanisms
22393 Set of mechanisms that will never be offered. See
22394 @url{https://prosody.im/doc/modules/mod_saslauth}.
22395 Defaults to @samp{("DIGEST-MD5")}.
22396 @end deftypevr
22397
22398 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} boolean s2s-require-encryption?
22399 Whether to force all server-to-server connections to be encrypted or not.
22400 See @url{https://prosody.im/doc/modules/mod_tls}.
22401 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
22402 @end deftypevr
22403
22404 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} boolean s2s-secure-auth?
22405 Whether to require encryption and certificate authentication. This
22406 provides ideal security, but requires servers you communicate with to support
22407 encryption AND present valid, trusted certificates. See
22408 @url{https://prosody.im/doc/s2s#security}.
22409 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
22410 @end deftypevr
22411
22412 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} string-list s2s-insecure-domains
22413 Many servers don't support encryption or have invalid or self-signed
22414 certificates. You can list domains here that will not be required to
22415 authenticate using certificates. They will be authenticated using DNS@. See
22416 @url{https://prosody.im/doc/s2s#security}.
22417 Defaults to @samp{()}.
22418 @end deftypevr
22419
22420 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} string-list s2s-secure-domains
22421 Even if you leave @code{s2s-secure-auth?} disabled, you can still require
22422 valid certificates for some domains by specifying a list here. See
22423 @url{https://prosody.im/doc/s2s#security}.
22424 Defaults to @samp{()}.
22425 @end deftypevr
22426
22427 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} string authentication
22428 Select the authentication backend to use. The default provider stores
22429 passwords in plaintext and uses Prosody's configured data storage to store the
22430 authentication data. If you do not trust your server please see
22431 @url{https://prosody.im/doc/modules/mod_auth_internal_hashed} for information
22432 about using the hashed backend. See also
22433 @url{https://prosody.im/doc/authentication}
22434 Defaults to @samp{"internal_plain"}.
22435 @end deftypevr
22436
22437 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} maybe-string log
22438 Set logging options. Advanced logging configuration is not yet supported
22439 by the Prosody service. See @url{https://prosody.im/doc/logging}.
22440 Defaults to @samp{"*syslog"}.
22441 @end deftypevr
22442
22443 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} file-name pidfile
22444 File to write pid in. See @url{https://prosody.im/doc/modules/mod_posix}.
22445 Defaults to @samp{"/var/run/prosody/prosody.pid"}.
22446 @end deftypevr
22447
22448 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} maybe-non-negative-integer http-max-content-size
22449 Maximum allowed size of the HTTP body (in bytes).
22450 @end deftypevr
22451
22452 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} maybe-string http-external-url
22453 Some modules expose their own URL in various ways. This URL is built
22454 from the protocol, host and port used. If Prosody sits behind a proxy, the
22455 public URL will be @code{http-external-url} instead. See
22456 @url{https://prosody.im/doc/http#external_url}.
22457 @end deftypevr
22458
22459 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} virtualhost-configuration-list virtualhosts
22460 A host in Prosody is a domain on which user accounts can be created. For
22461 example if you want your users to have addresses like
22462 @samp{"john.smith@@example.com"} then you need to add a host
22463 @samp{"example.com"}. All options in this list will apply only to this host.
22464
22465 Note: the name @emph{virtual} host is used in configuration to avoid confusion with
22466 the actual physical host that Prosody is installed on. A single Prosody
22467 instance can serve many domains, each one defined as a VirtualHost entry in
22468 Prosody's configuration. Conversely a server that hosts a single domain would
22469 have just one VirtualHost entry.
22470
22471 See @url{https://prosody.im/doc/configure#virtual_host_settings}.
22472
22473 Available @code{virtualhost-configuration} fields are:
22474
22475 all these @code{prosody-configuration} fields: @code{admins}, @code{use-libevent?}, @code{modules-enabled}, @code{modules-disabled}, @code{groups-file}, @code{allow-registration?}, @code{ssl}, @code{c2s-require-encryption?}, @code{disable-sasl-mechanisms}, @code{s2s-require-encryption?}, @code{s2s-secure-auth?}, @code{s2s-insecure-domains}, @code{s2s-secure-domains}, @code{authentication}, @code{log}, @code{http-max-content-size}, @code{http-external-url}, @code{raw-content}, plus:
22476 @deftypevr {@code{virtualhost-configuration} parameter} string domain
22477 Domain you wish Prosody to serve.
22478 @end deftypevr
22479
22480 @end deftypevr
22481
22482 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} int-component-configuration-list int-components
22483 Components are extra services on a server which are available to clients,
22484 usually on a subdomain of the main server (such as
22485 @samp{"mycomponent.example.com"}). Example components might be chatroom
22486 servers, user directories, or gateways to other protocols.
22487
22488 Internal components are implemented with Prosody-specific plugins. To add an
22489 internal component, you simply fill the hostname field, and the plugin you wish
22490 to use for the component.
22491
22492 See @url{https://prosody.im/doc/components}.
22493 Defaults to @samp{()}.
22494
22495 Available @code{int-component-configuration} fields are:
22496
22497 all these @code{prosody-configuration} fields: @code{admins}, @code{use-libevent?}, @code{modules-enabled}, @code{modules-disabled}, @code{groups-file}, @code{allow-registration?}, @code{ssl}, @code{c2s-require-encryption?}, @code{disable-sasl-mechanisms}, @code{s2s-require-encryption?}, @code{s2s-secure-auth?}, @code{s2s-insecure-domains}, @code{s2s-secure-domains}, @code{authentication}, @code{log}, @code{http-max-content-size}, @code{http-external-url}, @code{raw-content}, plus:
22498 @deftypevr {@code{int-component-configuration} parameter} string hostname
22499 Hostname of the component.
22500 @end deftypevr
22501
22502 @deftypevr {@code{int-component-configuration} parameter} string plugin
22503 Plugin you wish to use for the component.
22504 @end deftypevr
22505
22506 @deftypevr {@code{int-component-configuration} parameter} maybe-mod-muc-configuration mod-muc
22507 Multi-user chat (MUC) is Prosody's module for allowing you to create
22508 hosted chatrooms/conferences for XMPP users.
22509
22510 General information on setting up and using multi-user chatrooms can be found
22511 in the ``Chatrooms'' documentation (@url{https://prosody.im/doc/chatrooms}),
22512 which you should read if you are new to XMPP chatrooms.
22513
22514 See also @url{https://prosody.im/doc/modules/mod_muc}.
22515
22516 Available @code{mod-muc-configuration} fields are:
22517
22518 @deftypevr {@code{mod-muc-configuration} parameter} string name
22519 The name to return in service discovery responses.
22520 Defaults to @samp{"Prosody Chatrooms"}.
22521 @end deftypevr
22522
22523 @deftypevr {@code{mod-muc-configuration} parameter} string-or-boolean restrict-room-creation
22524 If @samp{#t}, this will only allow admins to create new chatrooms.
22525 Otherwise anyone can create a room. The value @samp{"local"} restricts room
22526 creation to users on the service's parent domain. E.g.@: @samp{user@@example.com}
22527 can create rooms on @samp{rooms.example.com}. The value @samp{"admin"}
22528 restricts to service administrators only.
22529 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
22530 @end deftypevr
22531
22532 @deftypevr {@code{mod-muc-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer max-history-messages
22533 Maximum number of history messages that will be sent to the member that has
22534 just joined the room.
22535 Defaults to @samp{20}.
22536 @end deftypevr
22537
22538 @end deftypevr
22539
22540 @end deftypevr
22541
22542 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} ext-component-configuration-list ext-components
22543 External components use XEP-0114, which most standalone components
22544 support. To add an external component, you simply fill the hostname field. See
22545 @url{https://prosody.im/doc/components}.
22546 Defaults to @samp{()}.
22547
22548 Available @code{ext-component-configuration} fields are:
22549
22550 all these @code{prosody-configuration} fields: @code{admins}, @code{use-libevent?}, @code{modules-enabled}, @code{modules-disabled}, @code{groups-file}, @code{allow-registration?}, @code{ssl}, @code{c2s-require-encryption?}, @code{disable-sasl-mechanisms}, @code{s2s-require-encryption?}, @code{s2s-secure-auth?}, @code{s2s-insecure-domains}, @code{s2s-secure-domains}, @code{authentication}, @code{log}, @code{http-max-content-size}, @code{http-external-url}, @code{raw-content}, plus:
22551 @deftypevr {@code{ext-component-configuration} parameter} string component-secret
22552 Password which the component will use to log in.
22553 @end deftypevr
22554
22555 @deftypevr {@code{ext-component-configuration} parameter} string hostname
22556 Hostname of the component.
22557 @end deftypevr
22558
22559 @end deftypevr
22560
22561 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer-list component-ports
22562 Port(s) Prosody listens on for component connections.
22563 Defaults to @samp{(5347)}.
22564 @end deftypevr
22565
22566 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} string component-interface
22567 Interface Prosody listens on for component connections.
22568 Defaults to @samp{"127.0.0.1"}.
22569 @end deftypevr
22570
22571 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} maybe-raw-content raw-content
22572 Raw content that will be added to the configuration file.
22573 @end deftypevr
22574
22575 It could be that you just want to get a @code{prosody.cfg.lua}
22576 up and running. In that case, you can pass an
22577 @code{opaque-prosody-configuration} record as the value of
22578 @code{prosody-service-type}. As its name indicates, an opaque configuration
22579 does not have easy reflective capabilities.
22580 Available @code{opaque-prosody-configuration} fields are:
22581
22582 @deftypevr {@code{opaque-prosody-configuration} parameter} package prosody
22583 The prosody package.
22584 @end deftypevr
22585
22586 @deftypevr {@code{opaque-prosody-configuration} parameter} string prosody.cfg.lua
22587 The contents of the @code{prosody.cfg.lua} to use.
22588 @end deftypevr
22589
22590 For example, if your @code{prosody.cfg.lua} is just the empty
22591 string, you could instantiate a prosody service like this:
22592
22593 @lisp
22594 (service prosody-service-type
22595 (opaque-prosody-configuration
22596 (prosody.cfg.lua "")))
22597 @end lisp
22598
22599 @c end of Prosody auto-generated documentation
22600
22601 @subsubheading BitlBee Service
22602
22603 @cindex IRC (Internet Relay Chat)
22604 @cindex IRC gateway
22605 @url{https://bitlbee.org,BitlBee} is a gateway that provides an IRC
22606 interface to a variety of messaging protocols such as XMPP.
22607
22608 @defvr {Scheme Variable} bitlbee-service-type
22609 This is the service type for the @url{https://bitlbee.org,BitlBee} IRC
22610 gateway daemon. Its value is a @code{bitlbee-configuration} (see
22611 below).
22612
22613 To have BitlBee listen on port 6667 on localhost, add this line to your
22614 services:
22615
22616 @lisp
22617 (service bitlbee-service-type)
22618 @end lisp
22619 @end defvr
22620
22621 @deftp {Data Type} bitlbee-configuration
22622 This is the configuration for BitlBee, with the following fields:
22623
22624 @table @asis
22625 @item @code{interface} (default: @code{"127.0.0.1"})
22626 @itemx @code{port} (default: @code{6667})
22627 Listen on the network interface corresponding to the IP address
22628 specified in @var{interface}, on @var{port}.
22629
22630 When @var{interface} is @code{127.0.0.1}, only local clients can
22631 connect; when it is @code{0.0.0.0}, connections can come from any
22632 networking interface.
22633
22634 @item @code{bitlbee} (default: @code{bitlbee})
22635 The BitlBee package to use.
22636
22637 @item @code{plugins} (default: @code{'()})
22638 List of plugin packages to use---e.g., @code{bitlbee-discord}.
22639
22640 @item @code{extra-settings} (default: @code{""})
22641 Configuration snippet added as-is to the BitlBee configuration file.
22642 @end table
22643 @end deftp
22644
22645 @subsubheading Quassel Service
22646
22647 @cindex IRC (Internet Relay Chat)
22648 @url{https://quassel-irc.org/,Quassel} is a distributed IRC client,
22649 meaning that one or more clients can attach to and detach from the
22650 central core.
22651
22652 @defvr {Scheme Variable} quassel-service-type
22653 This is the service type for the @url{https://quassel-irc.org/,Quassel}
22654 IRC backend daemon. Its value is a @code{quassel-configuration}
22655 (see below).
22656 @end defvr
22657
22658 @deftp {Data Type} quassel-configuration
22659 This is the configuration for Quassel, with the following fields:
22660
22661 @table @asis
22662 @item @code{quassel} (default: @code{quassel})
22663 The Quassel package to use.
22664
22665 @item @code{interface} (default: @code{"::,0.0.0.0"})
22666 @item @code{port} (default: @code{4242})
22667 Listen on the network interface(s) corresponding to the IPv4 or IPv6
22668 interfaces specified in the comma delimited @var{interface}, on
22669 @var{port}.
22670
22671 @item @code{loglevel} (default: @code{"Info"})
22672 The level of logging desired. Accepted values are Debug, Info, Warning
22673 and Error.
22674 @end table
22675 @end deftp
22676
22677 @node Telephony Services
22678 @subsection Telephony Services
22679
22680 @cindex telephony, services
22681 The @code{(gnu services telephony)} module contains Guix service
22682 definitions for telephony services. Currently it provides the following
22683 services:
22684
22685 @subsubheading Jami
22686
22687 @cindex jami, service
22688
22689 This section describes how to configure a Jami server that can be used
22690 to host video (or audio) conferences, among other uses. The following
22691 example demonstrates how to specify Jami account archives (backups) to
22692 be provisioned automatically:
22693
22694 @lisp
22695 (service jami-service-type
22696 (jami-configuration
22697 (accounts
22698 (list (jami-account
22699 (archive "/etc/jami/unencrypted-account-1.gz"))
22700 (jami-account
22701 (archive "/etc/jami/unencrypted-account-2.gz"))))))
22702 @end lisp
22703
22704 When the accounts field is specified, the Jami account files of the
22705 service found under @file{/var/lib/jami} are recreated every time the
22706 service starts.
22707
22708 Jami accounts and their corresponding backup archives can be generated
22709 using either the @code{jami-qt} or @code{jami-gnome} Jami clients. The
22710 accounts should not be password-protected, but it is wise to ensure
22711 their files are only readable by @samp{root}.
22712
22713 The next example shows how to declare that only some contacts should be
22714 allowed to communicate with a given account:
22715
22716 @lisp
22717 (service jami-service-type
22718 (jami-configuration
22719 (accounts
22720 (list (jami-account
22721 (archive "/etc/jami/unencrypted-account-1.gz")
22722 (peer-discovery? #t)
22723 (rendezvous-point? #t)
22724 (allowed-contacts
22725 '("1dbcb0f5f37324228235564b79f2b9737e9a008f"
22726 "2dbcb0f5f37324228235564b79f2b9737e9a008f")))))))
22727 @end lisp
22728
22729 In this mode, only the declared @code{allowed-contacts} can initiate
22730 communication with the Jami account. This can be used, for example,
22731 with rendezvous point accounts to create a private video conferencing
22732 space.
22733
22734 To put the system administrator in full control of the conferences
22735 hosted on their system, the Jami service supports the following actions:
22736
22737 @example sh
22738 # herd doc jami list-actions
22739 (list-accounts
22740 list-account-details
22741 list-banned-contacts
22742 list-contacts
22743 list-moderators
22744 add-moderator
22745 ban-contact
22746 enable-account
22747 disable-account)
22748 @end example
22749
22750 The above actions aim to provide the most valuable actions for
22751 moderation purposes, not to cover the whole Jami API. Users wanting to
22752 interact with the Jami daemon from Guile may be interested in
22753 experimenting with the @code{(gnu build jami-service)} module, which
22754 powers the above Shepherd actions.
22755
22756 @c TODO: This should be auto-generated from the doc already defined on
22757 @c the shepherd-actions themselves in (gnu services telephony).
22758 The @code{add-moderator} and @code{ban-contact} actions accept a contact
22759 @emph{fingerprint} (40 characters long hash) as first argument and an
22760 account fingerprint or username as second argument:
22761
22762 @example sh
22763 # herd add-moderator jami 1dbcb0f5f37324228235564b79f2b9737e9a008f \
22764 f3345f2775ddfe07a4b0d95daea111d15fbc1199
22765
22766 # herd list-moderators jami
22767 Moderators for account f3345f2775ddfe07a4b0d95daea111d15fbc1199:
22768 - 1dbcb0f5f37324228235564b79f2b9737e9a008f
22769
22770 @end example
22771
22772 In the case of @code{ban-contact}, the second username argument is
22773 optional; when omitted, the account is banned from all Jami accounts:
22774
22775 @example sh
22776 # herd ban-contact jami 1dbcb0f5f37324228235564b79f2b9737e9a008f
22777
22778 # herd list-banned-contacts jami
22779 Banned contacts for account f3345f2775ddfe07a4b0d95daea111d15fbc1199:
22780 - 1dbcb0f5f37324228235564b79f2b9737e9a008f
22781
22782 @end example
22783
22784 Banned contacts are also stripped from their moderation privileges.
22785
22786 The @code{disable-account} action allows to completely disconnect an
22787 account from the network, making it unreachable, while
22788 @code{enable-account} does the inverse. They accept a single account
22789 username or fingerprint as first argument:
22790
22791 @example sh
22792 # herd disable-account jami f3345f2775ddfe07a4b0d95daea111d15fbc1199
22793
22794 # herd list-accounts jami
22795 The following Jami accounts are available:
22796 - f3345f2775ddfe07a4b0d95daea111d15fbc1199 (dummy) [disabled]
22797
22798 @end example
22799
22800 The @code{list-account-details} action prints the detailed parameters of
22801 each accounts in the Recutils format, which means the @command{recsel}
22802 command can be used to select accounts of interest (@pxref{Selection
22803 Expressions,,,recutils, GNU recutils manual}). Note that period
22804 characters (@samp{.}) found in the account parameter keys are mapped to
22805 underscores (@samp{_}) in the output, to meet the requirements of the
22806 Recutils format. The following example shows how to print the account
22807 fingerprints for all accounts operating in the rendezvous point mode:
22808
22809 @example sh
22810 # herd list-account-details jami | \
22811 recsel -p Account.username -e 'Account.rendezVous ~ "true"'
22812 Account_username: f3345f2775ddfe07a4b0d95daea111d15fbc1199
22813 @end example
22814
22815 The remaining actions should be self-explanatory.
22816
22817 The complete set of available configuration options is detailed below.
22818
22819 @c TODO: Ideally, the following fragments would be auto-generated at
22820 @c build time, so that they needn't be manually duplicated.
22821 @c Auto-generated via (configuration->documentation 'jami-configuration)
22822 @deftp {Data Type} jami-configuration
22823 Available @code{jami-configuration} fields are:
22824
22825 @table @asis
22826 @item @code{jamid} (default: @code{libring}) (type: package)
22827 The Jami daemon package to use.
22828
22829 @item @code{dbus} (default: @code{dbus}) (type: package)
22830 The D-Bus package to use to start the required D-Bus session.
22831
22832 @item @code{nss-certs} (default: @code{nss-certs}) (type: package)
22833 The nss-certs package to use to provide TLS certificates.
22834
22835 @item @code{enable-logging?} (default: @code{#t}) (type: boolean)
22836 Whether to enable logging to syslog.
22837
22838 @item @code{debug?} (default: @code{#f}) (type: boolean)
22839 Whether to enable debug level messages.
22840
22841 @item @code{auto-answer?} (default: @code{#f}) (type: boolean)
22842 Whether to force automatic answer to incoming calls.
22843
22844 @item @code{accounts} (default: @code{disabled}) (type: maybe-jami-account-list)
22845 A list of Jami accounts to be (re-)provisioned every time the Jami
22846 daemon service starts. When providing this field, the account
22847 directories under @file{/var/lib/jami/} are recreated every time the
22848 service starts, ensuring a consistent state.
22849
22850 @end table
22851
22852 @end deftp
22853
22854 @c Auto-generated via (configuration->documentation 'jami-account)
22855 @deftp {Data Type} jami-account
22856 Available @code{jami-account} fields are:
22857
22858 @table @asis
22859 @item @code{archive} (type: string-or-computed-file)
22860 The account archive (backup) file name of the account. This is used to
22861 provision the account when the service starts. The account archive
22862 should @emph{not} be encrypted. It is highly recommended to make it
22863 readable only to the @samp{root} user (i.e., not in the store), to guard
22864 against leaking the secret key material of the Jami account it contains.
22865
22866 @item @code{allowed-contacts} (default: @code{disabled}) (type: maybe-account-fingerprint-list)
22867 The list of allowed contacts for the account, entered as their 40
22868 characters long fingerprint. Messages or calls from accounts not in
22869 that list will be rejected. When unspecified, the configuration of the
22870 account archive is used as-is with respect to contacts and public
22871 inbound calls/messaging allowance, which typically defaults to allow any
22872 contact to communicate with the account.
22873
22874 @item @code{moderators} (default: @code{disabled}) (type: maybe-account-fingerprint-list)
22875 The list of contacts that should have moderation privileges (to ban,
22876 mute, etc. other users) in rendezvous conferences, entered as their 40
22877 characters long fingerprint. When unspecified, the configuration of the
22878 account archive is used as-is with respect to moderation, which
22879 typically defaults to allow anyone to moderate.
22880
22881 @item @code{rendezvous-point?} (default: @code{disabled}) (type: maybe-boolean)
22882 Whether the account should operate in the rendezvous mode. In this
22883 mode, all the incoming audio/video calls are mixed into a conference.
22884 When left unspecified, the value from the account archive prevails.
22885
22886 @item @code{peer-discovery?} (default: @code{disabled}) (type: maybe-boolean)
22887 Whether peer discovery should be enabled. Peer discovery is used to
22888 discover other OpenDHT nodes on the local network, which can be useful
22889 to maintain communication between devices on such network even when the
22890 connection to the the Internet has been lost. When left unspecified,
22891 the value from the account archive prevails.
22892
22893 @item @code{bootstrap-hostnames} (default: @code{disabled}) (type: maybe-string-list)
22894 A list of hostnames or IPs pointing to OpenDHT nodes, that should be
22895 used to initially join the OpenDHT network. When left unspecified, the
22896 value from the account archive prevails.
22897
22898 @item @code{name-server-uri} (default: @code{disabled}) (type: maybe-string)
22899 The URI of the name server to use, that can be used to retrieve the
22900 account fingerprint for a registered username.
22901
22902 @end table
22903
22904 @end deftp
22905
22906 @subsubheading Murmur (VoIP server)
22907
22908 @cindex Murmur (VoIP server)
22909 @cindex VoIP server
22910 This section describes how to set up and run a Murmur server. Murmur is
22911 the server of the @uref{https://mumble.info, Mumble} voice-over-IP
22912 (VoIP) suite.
22913
22914 @deftp {Data Type} murmur-configuration
22915 The service type for the Murmur server. An example configuration can
22916 look like this:
22917
22918 @lisp
22919 (service murmur-service-type
22920 (murmur-configuration
22921 (welcome-text
22922 "Welcome to this Mumble server running on Guix!")
22923 (cert-required? #t) ;disallow text password logins
22924 (ssl-cert "/etc/letsencrypt/live/mumble.example.com/fullchain.pem")
22925 (ssl-key "/etc/letsencrypt/live/mumble.example.com/privkey.pem")))
22926 @end lisp
22927
22928 After reconfiguring your system, you can manually set the murmur @code{SuperUser}
22929 password with the command that is printed during the activation phase.
22930
22931 It is recommended to register a normal Mumble user account
22932 and grant it admin or moderator rights.
22933 You can use the @code{mumble} client to
22934 login as new normal user, register yourself, and log out.
22935 For the next step login with the name @code{SuperUser} use
22936 the @code{SuperUser} password that you set previously,
22937 and grant your newly registered mumble user administrator or moderator
22938 rights and create some channels.
22939
22940 Available @code{murmur-configuration} fields are:
22941
22942 @table @asis
22943 @item @code{package} (default: @code{mumble})
22944 Package that contains @code{bin/murmurd}.
22945
22946 @item @code{user} (default: @code{"murmur"})
22947 User who will run the Murmur server.
22948
22949 @item @code{group} (default: @code{"murmur"})
22950 Group of the user who will run the murmur server.
22951
22952 @item @code{port} (default: @code{64738})
22953 Port on which the server will listen.
22954
22955 @item @code{welcome-text} (default: @code{""})
22956 Welcome text sent to clients when they connect.
22957
22958 @item @code{server-password} (default: @code{""})
22959 Password the clients have to enter in order to connect.
22960
22961 @item @code{max-users} (default: @code{100})
22962 Maximum of users that can be connected to the server at once.
22963
22964 @item @code{max-user-bandwidth} (default: @code{#f})
22965 Maximum voice traffic a user can send per second.
22966
22967 @item @code{database-file} (default: @code{"/var/lib/murmur/db.sqlite"})
22968 File name of the sqlite database.
22969 The service's user will become the owner of the directory.
22970
22971 @item @code{log-file} (default: @code{"/var/log/murmur/murmur.log"})
22972 File name of the log file.
22973 The service's user will become the owner of the directory.
22974
22975 @item @code{autoban-attempts} (default: @code{10})
22976 Maximum number of logins a user can make in @code{autoban-timeframe}
22977 without getting auto banned for @code{autoban-time}.
22978
22979 @item @code{autoban-timeframe} (default: @code{120})
22980 Timeframe for autoban in seconds.
22981
22982 @item @code{autoban-time} (default: @code{300})
22983 Amount of time in seconds for which a client gets banned
22984 when violating the autoban limits.
22985
22986 @item @code{opus-threshold} (default: @code{100})
22987 Percentage of clients that need to support opus
22988 before switching over to opus audio codec.
22989
22990 @item @code{channel-nesting-limit} (default: @code{10})
22991 How deep channels can be nested at maximum.
22992
22993 @item @code{channelname-regex} (default: @code{#f})
22994 A string in form of a Qt regular expression that channel names must conform to.
22995
22996 @item @code{username-regex} (default: @code{#f})
22997 A string in form of a Qt regular expression that user names must conform to.
22998
22999 @item @code{text-message-length} (default: @code{5000})
23000 Maximum size in bytes that a user can send in one text chat message.
23001
23002 @item @code{image-message-length} (default: @code{(* 128 1024)})
23003 Maximum size in bytes that a user can send in one image message.
23004
23005 @item @code{cert-required?} (default: @code{#f})
23006 If it is set to @code{#t} clients that use weak password authentication
23007 will not be accepted. Users must have completed the certificate wizard to join.
23008
23009 @item @code{remember-channel?} (default: @code{#f})
23010 Should murmur remember the last channel each user was in when they disconnected
23011 and put them into the remembered channel when they rejoin.
23012
23013 @item @code{allow-html?} (default: @code{#f})
23014 Should html be allowed in text messages, user comments, and channel descriptions.
23015
23016 @item @code{allow-ping?} (default: @code{#f})
23017 Setting to true exposes the current user count, the maximum user count, and
23018 the server's maximum bandwidth per client to unauthenticated users. In the
23019 Mumble client, this information is shown in the Connect dialog.
23020
23021 Disabling this setting will prevent public listing of the server.
23022
23023 @item @code{bonjour?} (default: @code{#f})
23024 Should the server advertise itself in the local network through the bonjour protocol.
23025
23026 @item @code{send-version?} (default: @code{#f})
23027 Should the murmur server version be exposed in ping requests.
23028
23029 @item @code{log-days} (default: @code{31})
23030 Murmur also stores logs in the database, which are accessible via RPC.
23031 The default is 31 days of months, but you can set this setting to 0 to keep logs forever,
23032 or -1 to disable logging to the database.
23033
23034 @item @code{obfuscate-ips?} (default: @code{#t})
23035 Should logged ips be obfuscated to protect the privacy of users.
23036
23037 @item @code{ssl-cert} (default: @code{#f})
23038 File name of the SSL/TLS certificate used for encrypted connections.
23039
23040 @lisp
23041 (ssl-cert "/etc/letsencrypt/live/example.com/fullchain.pem")
23042 @end lisp
23043 @item @code{ssl-key} (default: @code{#f})
23044 Filepath to the ssl private key used for encrypted connections.
23045 @lisp
23046 (ssl-key "/etc/letsencrypt/live/example.com/privkey.pem")
23047 @end lisp
23048
23049 @item @code{ssl-dh-params} (default: @code{#f})
23050 File name of a PEM-encoded file with Diffie-Hellman parameters
23051 for the SSL/TLS encryption. Alternatively you set it to
23052 @code{"@@ffdhe2048"}, @code{"@@ffdhe3072"}, @code{"@@ffdhe4096"}, @code{"@@ffdhe6144"}
23053 or @code{"@@ffdhe8192"} to use bundled parameters from RFC 7919.
23054
23055 @item @code{ssl-ciphers} (default: @code{#f})
23056 The @code{ssl-ciphers} option chooses the cipher suites to make available for use
23057 in SSL/TLS.
23058
23059 This option is specified using
23060 @uref{https://www.openssl.org/docs/apps/ciphers.html#CIPHER-LIST-FORMAT,
23061 OpenSSL cipher list notation}.
23062
23063 It is recommended that you try your cipher string using 'openssl ciphers <string>'
23064 before setting it here, to get a feel for which cipher suites you will get.
23065 After setting this option, it is recommend that you inspect your Murmur log
23066 to ensure that Murmur is using the cipher suites that you expected it to.
23067
23068 Note: Changing this option may impact the backwards compatibility of your
23069 Murmur server, and can remove the ability for older Mumble clients to be able
23070 to connect to it.
23071
23072 @item @code{public-registration} (default: @code{#f})
23073 Must be a @code{<murmur-public-registration-configuration>} record or @code{#f}.
23074
23075 You can optionally register your server in the public server list that the
23076 @code{mumble} client shows on startup.
23077 You cannot register your server if you have set a @code{server-password},
23078 or set @code{allow-ping} to @code{#f}.
23079
23080 It might take a few hours until it shows up in the public list.
23081
23082 @item @code{file} (default: @code{#f})
23083 Optional alternative override for this configuration.
23084 @end table
23085 @end deftp
23086
23087 @deftp {Data Type} murmur-public-registration-configuration
23088 Configuration for public registration of a murmur service.
23089
23090 @table @asis
23091 @item @code{name}
23092 This is a display name for your server. Not to be confused with the hostname.
23093
23094 @item @code{password}
23095 A password to identify your registration.
23096 Subsequent updates will need the same password. Don't lose your password.
23097
23098 @item @code{url}
23099 This should be a @code{http://} or @code{https://} link to your web
23100 site.
23101
23102 @item @code{hostname} (default: @code{#f})
23103 By default your server will be listed by its IP address.
23104 If it is set your server will be linked by this host name instead.
23105 @end table
23106 @end deftp
23107
23108
23109
23110 @node File-Sharing Services
23111 @subsection File-Sharing Services
23112
23113 The @code{(gnu services file-sharing)} module provides services that
23114 assist with transferring files over peer-to-peer file-sharing networks.
23115
23116 @subsubheading Transmission Daemon Service
23117
23118 @uref{https://transmissionbt.com/, Transmission} is a flexible
23119 BitTorrent client that offers a variety of graphical and command-line
23120 interfaces. A @code{transmission-daemon-service-type} service provides
23121 Transmission's headless variant, @command{transmission-daemon}, as a
23122 system service, allowing users to share files via BitTorrent even when
23123 they are not logged in.
23124
23125 @deffn {Scheme Variable} transmission-daemon-service-type
23126 The service type for the Transmission Daemon BitTorrent client. Its
23127 value must be a @code{transmission-daemon-configuration} object as in
23128 this example:
23129
23130 @lisp
23131 (service transmission-daemon-service-type
23132 (transmission-daemon-configuration
23133 ;; Restrict access to the RPC ("control") interface
23134 (rpc-authentication-required? #t)
23135 (rpc-username "transmission")
23136 (rpc-password
23137 (transmission-password-hash
23138 "transmission" ; desired password
23139 "uKd1uMs9")) ; arbitrary salt value
23140
23141 ;; Accept requests from this and other hosts on the
23142 ;; local network
23143 (rpc-whitelist-enabled? #t)
23144 (rpc-whitelist '("::1" "127.0.0.1" "192.168.0.*"))
23145
23146 ;; Limit bandwidth use during work hours
23147 (alt-speed-down (* 1024 2)) ; 2 MB/s
23148 (alt-speed-up 512) ; 512 kB/s
23149
23150 (alt-speed-time-enabled? #t)
23151 (alt-speed-time-day 'weekdays)
23152 (alt-speed-time-begin
23153 (+ (* 60 8) 30)) ; 8:30 am
23154 (alt-speed-time-end
23155 (+ (* 60 (+ 12 5)) 30)))) ; 5:30 pm
23156 @end lisp
23157 @end deffn
23158
23159 Once the service is started, users can interact with the daemon through
23160 its Web interface (at @code{http://localhost:9091/}) or by using the
23161 @command{transmission-remote} command-line tool, available in the
23162 @code{transmission} package. (Emacs users may want to also consider the
23163 @code{emacs-transmission} package.) Both communicate with the daemon
23164 through its remote procedure call (RPC) interface, which by default is
23165 available to all users on the system; you may wish to change this by
23166 assigning values to the @code{rpc-authentication-required?},
23167 @code{rpc-username} and @code{rpc-password} settings, as shown in the
23168 example above and documented further below.
23169
23170 The value for @code{rpc-password} must be a password hash of the type
23171 generated and used by Transmission clients. This can be copied verbatim
23172 from an existing @file{settings.json} file, if another Transmission
23173 client is already being used. Otherwise, the
23174 @code{transmission-password-hash} and @code{transmission-random-salt}
23175 procedures provided by this module can be used to obtain a suitable hash
23176 value.
23177
23178 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} transmission-password-hash @var{password} @var{salt}
23179 Returns a string containing the result of hashing @var{password}
23180 together with @var{salt}, in the format recognized by Transmission
23181 clients for their @code{rpc-password} configuration setting.
23182
23183 @var{salt} must be an eight-character string. The
23184 @code{transmission-random-salt} procedure can be used to generate a
23185 suitable salt value at random.
23186 @end deffn
23187
23188 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} transmission-random-salt
23189 Returns a string containing a random, eight-character salt value of the
23190 type generated and used by Transmission clients, suitable for passing to
23191 the @code{transmission-password-hash} procedure.
23192 @end deffn
23193
23194 These procedures are accessible from within a Guile REPL started with
23195 the @command{guix repl} command (@pxref{Invoking guix repl}). This is
23196 useful for obtaining a random salt value to provide as the second
23197 parameter to `transmission-password-hash`, as in this example session:
23198
23199 @example
23200 $ guix repl
23201 scheme@@(guix-user)> ,use (gnu services file-sharing)
23202 scheme@@(guix-user)> (transmission-random-salt)
23203 $1 = "uKd1uMs9"
23204 @end example
23205
23206 Alternatively, a complete password hash can generated in a single step:
23207
23208 @example
23209 scheme@@(guix-user)> (transmission-password-hash "transmission"
23210 (transmission-random-salt))
23211 $2 = "@{c8bbc6d1740cd8dc819a6e25563b67812c1c19c9VtFPfdsX"
23212 @end example
23213
23214 The resulting string can be used as-is for the value of
23215 @code{rpc-password}, allowing the password to be kept hidden even in the
23216 operating-system configuration.
23217
23218 Torrent files downloaded by the daemon are directly accessible only to
23219 users in the ``transmission'' user group, who receive read-only access
23220 to the directory specified by the @code{download-dir} configuration
23221 setting (and also the directory specified by @code{incomplete-dir}, if
23222 @code{incomplete-dir-enabled?} is @code{#t}). Downloaded files can be
23223 moved to another directory or deleted altogether using
23224 @command{transmission-remote} with its @code{--move} and
23225 @code{--remove-and-delete} options.
23226
23227 If the @code{watch-dir-enabled?} setting is set to @code{#t}, users in
23228 the ``transmission'' group are able also to place @file{.torrent} files
23229 in the directory specified by @code{watch-dir} to have the corresponding
23230 torrents added by the daemon. (The @code{trash-original-torrent-files?}
23231 setting controls whether the daemon deletes these files after processing
23232 them.)
23233
23234 Some of the daemon's configuration settings can be changed temporarily
23235 by @command{transmission-remote} and similar tools. To undo these
23236 changes, use the service's @code{reload} action to have the daemon
23237 reload its settings from disk:
23238
23239 @example
23240 # herd reload transmission-daemon
23241 @end example
23242
23243 The full set of available configuration settings is defined by the
23244 @code{transmission-daemon-configuration} data type.
23245
23246 @deftp {Data Type} transmission-daemon-configuration
23247 The data type representing configuration settings for Transmission
23248 Daemon. These correspond directly to the settings recognized by
23249 Transmission clients in their @file{settings.json} file.
23250 @end deftp
23251
23252 @c The following documentation was initially generated by
23253 @c (generate-transmission-daemon-documentation) in (gnu services
23254 @c file-sharing). Manually maintained documentation is better, so we
23255 @c shouldn't hesitate to edit below as needed. However if the change
23256 @c you want to make to this documentation can be done in an automated
23257 @c way, it's probably easier to change (generate-documentation) than to
23258 @c make it below and have to deal with the churn as Transmission Daemon
23259 @c updates.
23260
23261 @c %start of fragment
23262
23263 Available @code{transmission-daemon-configuration} fields are:
23264
23265 @deftypevr {@code{transmission-daemon-configuration} parameter} package transmission
23266 The Transmission package to use.
23267
23268 @end deftypevr
23269
23270 @deftypevr {@code{transmission-daemon-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer stop-wait-period
23271 The period, in seconds, to wait when stopping the service for
23272 @command{transmission-daemon} to exit before killing its process. This
23273 allows the daemon time to complete its housekeeping and send a final
23274 update to trackers as it shuts down. On slow hosts, or hosts with a
23275 slow network connection, this value may need to be increased.
23276
23277 Defaults to @samp{10}.
23278
23279 @end deftypevr
23280
23281 @deftypevr {@code{transmission-daemon-configuration} parameter} string download-dir
23282 The directory to which torrent files are downloaded.
23283
23284 Defaults to @samp{"/var/lib/transmission-daemon/downloads"}.
23285
23286 @end deftypevr
23287
23288 @deftypevr {@code{transmission-daemon-configuration} parameter} boolean incomplete-dir-enabled?
23289 If @code{#t}, files will be held in @code{incomplete-dir} while their
23290 torrent is being downloaded, then moved to @code{download-dir} once the
23291 torrent is complete. Otherwise, files for all torrents (including those
23292 still being downloaded) will be placed in @code{download-dir}.
23293
23294 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
23295
23296 @end deftypevr
23297
23298 @deftypevr {@code{transmission-daemon-configuration} parameter} maybe-string incomplete-dir
23299 The directory in which files from incompletely downloaded torrents will
23300 be held when @code{incomplete-dir-enabled?} is @code{#t}.
23301
23302 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
23303
23304 @end deftypevr
23305
23306 @deftypevr {@code{transmission-daemon-configuration} parameter} umask umask
23307 The file mode creation mask used for downloaded files. (See the
23308 @command{umask} man page for more information.)
23309
23310 Defaults to @samp{18}.
23311
23312 @end deftypevr
23313
23314 @deftypevr {@code{transmission-daemon-configuration} parameter} boolean rename-partial-files?
23315 When @code{#t}, ``.part'' is appended to the name of partially
23316 downloaded files.
23317
23318 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
23319
23320 @end deftypevr
23321
23322 @deftypevr {@code{transmission-daemon-configuration} parameter} preallocation-mode preallocation
23323 The mode by which space should be preallocated for downloaded files, one
23324 of @code{none}, @code{fast} (or @code{sparse}) and @code{full}.
23325 Specifying @code{full} will minimize disk fragmentation at a cost to
23326 file-creation speed.
23327
23328 Defaults to @samp{fast}.
23329
23330 @end deftypevr
23331
23332 @deftypevr {@code{transmission-daemon-configuration} parameter} boolean watch-dir-enabled?
23333 If @code{#t}, the directory specified by @code{watch-dir} will be
23334 watched for new @file{.torrent} files and the torrents they describe
23335 added automatically (and the original files removed, if
23336 @code{trash-original-torrent-files?} is @code{#t}).
23337
23338 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
23339
23340 @end deftypevr
23341
23342 @deftypevr {@code{transmission-daemon-configuration} parameter} maybe-string watch-dir
23343 The directory to be watched for @file{.torrent} files indicating new
23344 torrents to be added, when @code{watch-dir-enabled} is @code{#t}.
23345
23346 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
23347
23348 @end deftypevr
23349
23350 @deftypevr {@code{transmission-daemon-configuration} parameter} boolean trash-original-torrent-files?
23351 When @code{#t}, @file{.torrent} files will be deleted from the watch
23352 directory once their torrent has been added (see
23353 @code{watch-directory-enabled?}).
23354
23355 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
23356
23357 @end deftypevr
23358
23359 @deftypevr {@code{transmission-daemon-configuration} parameter} boolean speed-limit-down-enabled?
23360 When @code{#t}, the daemon's download speed will be limited to the rate
23361 specified by @code{speed-limit-down}.
23362
23363 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
23364
23365 @end deftypevr
23366
23367 @deftypevr {@code{transmission-daemon-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer speed-limit-down
23368 The default global-maximum download speed, in kilobytes per second.
23369
23370 Defaults to @samp{100}.
23371
23372 @end deftypevr
23373
23374 @deftypevr {@code{transmission-daemon-configuration} parameter} boolean speed-limit-up-enabled?
23375 When @code{#t}, the daemon's upload speed will be limited to the rate
23376 specified by @code{speed-limit-up}.
23377
23378 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
23379
23380 @end deftypevr
23381
23382 @deftypevr {@code{transmission-daemon-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer speed-limit-up
23383 The default global-maximum upload speed, in kilobytes per second.
23384
23385 Defaults to @samp{100}.
23386
23387 @end deftypevr
23388
23389 @deftypevr {@code{transmission-daemon-configuration} parameter} boolean alt-speed-enabled?
23390 When @code{#t}, the alternate speed limits @code{alt-speed-down} and
23391 @code{alt-speed-up} are used (in place of @code{speed-limit-down} and
23392 @code{speed-limit-up}, if they are enabled) to constrain the daemon's
23393 bandwidth usage. This can be scheduled to occur automatically at
23394 certain times during the week; see @code{alt-speed-time-enabled?}.
23395
23396 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
23397
23398 @end deftypevr
23399
23400 @deftypevr {@code{transmission-daemon-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer alt-speed-down
23401 The alternate global-maximum download speed, in kilobytes per second.
23402
23403 Defaults to @samp{50}.
23404
23405 @end deftypevr
23406
23407 @deftypevr {@code{transmission-daemon-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer alt-speed-up
23408 The alternate global-maximum upload speed, in kilobytes per second.
23409
23410 Defaults to @samp{50}.
23411
23412 @end deftypevr
23413
23414 @deftypevr {@code{transmission-daemon-configuration} parameter} boolean alt-speed-time-enabled?
23415 When @code{#t}, the alternate speed limits @code{alt-speed-down} and
23416 @code{alt-speed-up} will be enabled automatically during the periods
23417 specified by @code{alt-speed-time-day}, @code{alt-speed-time-begin} and
23418 @code{alt-time-speed-end}.
23419
23420 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
23421
23422 @end deftypevr
23423
23424 @deftypevr {@code{transmission-daemon-configuration} parameter} day-list alt-speed-time-day
23425 The days of the week on which the alternate-speed schedule should be
23426 used, specified either as a list of days (@code{sunday}, @code{monday},
23427 and so on) or using one of the symbols @code{weekdays}, @code{weekends}
23428 or @code{all}.
23429
23430 Defaults to @samp{all}.
23431
23432 @end deftypevr
23433
23434 @deftypevr {@code{transmission-daemon-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer alt-speed-time-begin
23435 The time of day at which to enable the alternate speed limits, expressed
23436 as a number of minutes since midnight.
23437
23438 Defaults to @samp{540}.
23439
23440 @end deftypevr
23441
23442 @deftypevr {@code{transmission-daemon-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer alt-speed-time-end
23443 The time of day at which to disable the alternate speed limits,
23444 expressed as a number of minutes since midnight.
23445
23446 Defaults to @samp{1020}.
23447
23448 @end deftypevr
23449
23450 @deftypevr {@code{transmission-daemon-configuration} parameter} string bind-address-ipv4
23451 The IP address at which to listen for peer connections, or ``0.0.0.0''
23452 to listen at all available IP addresses.
23453
23454 Defaults to @samp{"0.0.0.0"}.
23455
23456 @end deftypevr
23457
23458 @deftypevr {@code{transmission-daemon-configuration} parameter} string bind-address-ipv6
23459 The IPv6 address at which to listen for peer connections, or ``::'' to
23460 listen at all available IPv6 addresses.
23461
23462 Defaults to @samp{"::"}.
23463
23464 @end deftypevr
23465
23466 @deftypevr {@code{transmission-daemon-configuration} parameter} boolean peer-port-random-on-start?
23467 If @code{#t}, when the daemon starts it will select a port at random on
23468 which to listen for peer connections, from the range specified
23469 (inclusively) by @code{peer-port-random-low} and
23470 @code{peer-port-random-high}. Otherwise, it listens on the port
23471 specified by @code{peer-port}.
23472
23473 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
23474
23475 @end deftypevr
23476
23477 @deftypevr {@code{transmission-daemon-configuration} parameter} port-number peer-port-random-low
23478 The lowest selectable port number when @code{peer-port-random-on-start?}
23479 is @code{#t}.
23480
23481 Defaults to @samp{49152}.
23482
23483 @end deftypevr
23484
23485 @deftypevr {@code{transmission-daemon-configuration} parameter} port-number peer-port-random-high
23486 The highest selectable port number when @code{peer-port-random-on-start}
23487 is @code{#t}.
23488
23489 Defaults to @samp{65535}.
23490
23491 @end deftypevr
23492
23493 @deftypevr {@code{transmission-daemon-configuration} parameter} port-number peer-port
23494 The port on which to listen for peer connections when
23495 @code{peer-port-random-on-start?} is @code{#f}.
23496
23497 Defaults to @samp{51413}.
23498
23499 @end deftypevr
23500
23501 @deftypevr {@code{transmission-daemon-configuration} parameter} boolean port-forwarding-enabled?
23502 If @code{#t}, the daemon will attempt to configure port-forwarding on an
23503 upstream gateway automatically using @acronym{UPnP} and
23504 @acronym{NAT-PMP}.
23505
23506 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
23507
23508 @end deftypevr
23509
23510 @deftypevr {@code{transmission-daemon-configuration} parameter} encryption-mode encryption
23511 The encryption preference for peer connections, one of
23512 @code{prefer-unencrypted-connections},
23513 @code{prefer-encrypted-connections} or
23514 @code{require-encrypted-connections}.
23515
23516 Defaults to @samp{prefer-encrypted-connections}.
23517
23518 @end deftypevr
23519
23520 @deftypevr {@code{transmission-daemon-configuration} parameter} maybe-string peer-congestion-algorithm
23521 The TCP congestion-control algorithm to use for peer connections,
23522 specified using a string recognized by the operating system in calls to
23523 @code{setsockopt} (or set to @code{disabled}, in which case the
23524 operating-system default is used).
23525
23526 Note that on GNU/Linux systems, the kernel must be configured to allow
23527 processes to use a congestion-control algorithm not in the default set;
23528 otherwise, it will deny these requests with ``Operation not permitted''.
23529 To see which algorithms are available on your system and which are
23530 currently permitted for use, look at the contents of the files
23531 @file{tcp_available_congestion_control} and
23532 @file{tcp_allowed_congestion_control} in the @file{/proc/sys/net/ipv4}
23533 directory.
23534
23535 As an example, to have Transmission Daemon use
23536 @uref{http://www-ece.rice.edu/networks/TCP-LP/,the TCP Low Priority
23537 congestion-control algorithm}, you'll need to modify your kernel
23538 configuration to build in support for the algorithm, then update your
23539 operating-system configuration to allow its use by adding a
23540 @code{sysctl-service-type} service (or updating the existing one's
23541 configuration) with lines like the following:
23542
23543 @lisp
23544 (service sysctl-service-type
23545 (sysctl-configuration
23546 (settings
23547 ("net.ipv4.tcp_allowed_congestion_control" .
23548 "reno cubic lp"))))
23549 @end lisp
23550
23551 The Transmission Daemon configuration can then be updated with
23552
23553 @lisp
23554 (peer-congestion-algorithm "lp")
23555 @end lisp
23556
23557 and the system reconfigured to have the changes take effect.
23558
23559 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
23560
23561 @end deftypevr
23562
23563 @deftypevr {@code{transmission-daemon-configuration} parameter} tcp-type-of-service peer-socket-tos
23564 The type of service to request in outgoing @acronym{TCP} packets, one of
23565 @code{default}, @code{low-cost}, @code{throughput}, @code{low-delay} and
23566 @code{reliability}.
23567
23568 Defaults to @samp{default}.
23569
23570 @end deftypevr
23571
23572 @deftypevr {@code{transmission-daemon-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer peer-limit-global
23573 The global limit on the number of connected peers.
23574
23575 Defaults to @samp{200}.
23576
23577 @end deftypevr
23578
23579 @deftypevr {@code{transmission-daemon-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer peer-limit-per-torrent
23580 The per-torrent limit on the number of connected peers.
23581
23582 Defaults to @samp{50}.
23583
23584 @end deftypevr
23585
23586 @deftypevr {@code{transmission-daemon-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer upload-slots-per-torrent
23587 The maximum number of peers to which the daemon will upload data
23588 simultaneously for each torrent.
23589
23590 Defaults to @samp{14}.
23591
23592 @end deftypevr
23593
23594 @deftypevr {@code{transmission-daemon-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer peer-id-ttl-hours
23595 The maximum lifespan, in hours, of the peer ID associated with each
23596 public torrent before it is regenerated.
23597
23598 Defaults to @samp{6}.
23599
23600 @end deftypevr
23601
23602 @deftypevr {@code{transmission-daemon-configuration} parameter} boolean blocklist-enabled?
23603 When @code{#t}, the daemon will ignore peers mentioned in the blocklist
23604 it has most recently downloaded from @code{blocklist-url}.
23605
23606 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
23607
23608 @end deftypevr
23609
23610 @deftypevr {@code{transmission-daemon-configuration} parameter} maybe-string blocklist-url
23611 The URL of a peer blocklist (in @acronym{P2P}-plaintext or eMule
23612 @file{.dat} format) to be periodically downloaded and applied when
23613 @code{blocklist-enabled?} is @code{#t}.
23614
23615 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
23616
23617 @end deftypevr
23618
23619 @deftypevr {@code{transmission-daemon-configuration} parameter} boolean download-queue-enabled?
23620 If @code{#t}, the daemon will be limited to downloading at most
23621 @code{download-queue-size} non-stalled torrents simultaneously.
23622
23623 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
23624
23625 @end deftypevr
23626
23627 @deftypevr {@code{transmission-daemon-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer download-queue-size
23628 The size of the daemon's download queue, which limits the number of
23629 non-stalled torrents it will download at any one time when
23630 @code{download-queue-enabled?} is @code{#t}.
23631
23632 Defaults to @samp{5}.
23633
23634 @end deftypevr
23635
23636 @deftypevr {@code{transmission-daemon-configuration} parameter} boolean seed-queue-enabled?
23637 If @code{#t}, the daemon will be limited to seeding at most
23638 @code{seed-queue-size} non-stalled torrents simultaneously.
23639
23640 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
23641
23642 @end deftypevr
23643
23644 @deftypevr {@code{transmission-daemon-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer seed-queue-size
23645 The size of the daemon's seed queue, which limits the number of
23646 non-stalled torrents it will seed at any one time when
23647 @code{seed-queue-enabled?} is @code{#t}.
23648
23649 Defaults to @samp{10}.
23650
23651 @end deftypevr
23652
23653 @deftypevr {@code{transmission-daemon-configuration} parameter} boolean queue-stalled-enabled?
23654 When @code{#t}, the daemon will consider torrents for which it has not
23655 shared data in the past @code{queue-stalled-minutes} minutes to be
23656 stalled and not count them against its @code{download-queue-size} and
23657 @code{seed-queue-size} limits.
23658
23659 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
23660
23661 @end deftypevr
23662
23663 @deftypevr {@code{transmission-daemon-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer queue-stalled-minutes
23664 The maximum period, in minutes, a torrent may be idle before it is
23665 considered to be stalled, when @code{queue-stalled-enabled?} is
23666 @code{#t}.
23667
23668 Defaults to @samp{30}.
23669
23670 @end deftypevr
23671
23672 @deftypevr {@code{transmission-daemon-configuration} parameter} boolean ratio-limit-enabled?
23673 When @code{#t}, a torrent being seeded will automatically be paused once
23674 it reaches the ratio specified by @code{ratio-limit}.
23675
23676 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
23677
23678 @end deftypevr
23679
23680 @deftypevr {@code{transmission-daemon-configuration} parameter} non-negative-rational ratio-limit
23681 The ratio at which a torrent being seeded will be paused, when
23682 @code{ratio-limit-enabled?} is @code{#t}.
23683
23684 Defaults to @samp{2.0}.
23685
23686 @end deftypevr
23687
23688 @deftypevr {@code{transmission-daemon-configuration} parameter} boolean idle-seeding-limit-enabled?
23689 When @code{#t}, a torrent being seeded will automatically be paused once
23690 it has been idle for @code{idle-seeding-limit} minutes.
23691
23692 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
23693
23694 @end deftypevr
23695
23696 @deftypevr {@code{transmission-daemon-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer idle-seeding-limit
23697 The maximum period, in minutes, a torrent being seeded may be idle
23698 before it is paused, when @code{idle-seeding-limit-enabled?} is
23699 @code{#t}.
23700
23701 Defaults to @samp{30}.
23702
23703 @end deftypevr
23704
23705 @deftypevr {@code{transmission-daemon-configuration} parameter} boolean dht-enabled?
23706 Enable @uref{http://bittorrent.org/beps/bep_0005.html,the distributed
23707 hash table (@acronym{DHT}) protocol}, which supports the use of
23708 trackerless torrents.
23709
23710 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
23711
23712 @end deftypevr
23713
23714 @deftypevr {@code{transmission-daemon-configuration} parameter} boolean lpd-enabled?
23715 Enable @uref{https://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Local_Peer_Discovery,local
23716 peer discovery} (@acronym{LPD}), which allows the discovery of peers on
23717 the local network and may reduce the amount of data sent over the public
23718 Internet.
23719
23720 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
23721
23722 @end deftypevr
23723
23724 @deftypevr {@code{transmission-daemon-configuration} parameter} boolean pex-enabled?
23725 Enable @uref{https://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Peer_exchange,peer exchange}
23726 (@acronym{PEX}), which reduces the daemon's reliance on external
23727 trackers and may improve its performance.
23728
23729 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
23730
23731 @end deftypevr
23732
23733 @deftypevr {@code{transmission-daemon-configuration} parameter} boolean utp-enabled?
23734 Enable @uref{http://bittorrent.org/beps/bep_0029.html,the micro
23735 transport protocol} (@acronym{uTP}), which aims to reduce the impact of
23736 BitTorrent traffic on other users of the local network while maintaining
23737 full utilization of the available bandwidth.
23738
23739 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
23740
23741 @end deftypevr
23742
23743 @deftypevr {@code{transmission-daemon-configuration} parameter} boolean rpc-enabled?
23744 If @code{#t}, enable the remote procedure call (@acronym{RPC})
23745 interface, which allows remote control of the daemon via its Web
23746 interface, the @command{transmission-remote} command-line client, and
23747 similar tools.
23748
23749 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
23750
23751 @end deftypevr
23752
23753 @deftypevr {@code{transmission-daemon-configuration} parameter} string rpc-bind-address
23754 The IP address at which to listen for @acronym{RPC} connections, or
23755 ``0.0.0.0'' to listen at all available IP addresses.
23756
23757 Defaults to @samp{"0.0.0.0"}.
23758
23759 @end deftypevr
23760
23761 @deftypevr {@code{transmission-daemon-configuration} parameter} port-number rpc-port
23762 The port on which to listen for @acronym{RPC} connections.
23763
23764 Defaults to @samp{9091}.
23765
23766 @end deftypevr
23767
23768 @deftypevr {@code{transmission-daemon-configuration} parameter} string rpc-url
23769 The path prefix to use in the @acronym{RPC}-endpoint @acronym{URL}.
23770
23771 Defaults to @samp{"/transmission/"}.
23772
23773 @end deftypevr
23774
23775 @deftypevr {@code{transmission-daemon-configuration} parameter} boolean rpc-authentication-required?
23776 When @code{#t}, clients must authenticate (see @code{rpc-username} and
23777 @code{rpc-password}) when using the @acronym{RPC} interface. Note this
23778 has the side effect of disabling host-name whitelisting (see
23779 @code{rpc-host-whitelist-enabled?}.
23780
23781 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
23782
23783 @end deftypevr
23784
23785 @deftypevr {@code{transmission-daemon-configuration} parameter} maybe-string rpc-username
23786 The username required by clients to access the @acronym{RPC} interface
23787 when @code{rpc-authentication-required?} is @code{#t}.
23788
23789 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
23790
23791 @end deftypevr
23792
23793 @deftypevr {@code{transmission-daemon-configuration} parameter} maybe-transmission-password-hash rpc-password
23794 The password required by clients to access the @acronym{RPC} interface
23795 when @code{rpc-authentication-required?} is @code{#t}. This must be
23796 specified using a password hash in the format recognized by Transmission
23797 clients, either copied from an existing @file{settings.json} file or
23798 generated using the @code{transmission-password-hash} procedure.
23799
23800 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
23801
23802 @end deftypevr
23803
23804 @deftypevr {@code{transmission-daemon-configuration} parameter} boolean rpc-whitelist-enabled?
23805 When @code{#t}, @acronym{RPC} requests will be accepted only when they
23806 originate from an address specified in @code{rpc-whitelist}.
23807
23808 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
23809
23810 @end deftypevr
23811
23812 @deftypevr {@code{transmission-daemon-configuration} parameter} string-list rpc-whitelist
23813 The list of IP and IPv6 addresses from which @acronym{RPC} requests will
23814 be accepted when @code{rpc-whitelist-enabled?} is @code{#t}. Wildcards
23815 may be specified using @samp{*}.
23816
23817 Defaults to @samp{("127.0.0.1" "::1")}.
23818
23819 @end deftypevr
23820
23821 @deftypevr {@code{transmission-daemon-configuration} parameter} boolean rpc-host-whitelist-enabled?
23822 When @code{#t}, @acronym{RPC} requests will be accepted only when they
23823 are addressed to a host named in @code{rpc-host-whitelist}. Note that
23824 requests to ``localhost'' or ``localhost.'', or to a numeric address,
23825 are always accepted regardless of these settings.
23826
23827 Note also this functionality is disabled when
23828 @code{rpc-authentication-required?} is @code{#t}.
23829
23830 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
23831
23832 @end deftypevr
23833
23834 @deftypevr {@code{transmission-daemon-configuration} parameter} string-list rpc-host-whitelist
23835 The list of host names recognized by the @acronym{RPC} server when
23836 @code{rpc-host-whitelist-enabled?} is @code{#t}.
23837
23838 Defaults to @samp{()}.
23839
23840 @end deftypevr
23841
23842 @deftypevr {@code{transmission-daemon-configuration} parameter} message-level message-level
23843 The minimum severity level of messages to be logged (to
23844 @file{/var/log/transmission.log}) by the daemon, one of @code{none} (no
23845 logging), @code{error}, @code{info} and @code{debug}.
23846
23847 Defaults to @samp{info}.
23848
23849 @end deftypevr
23850
23851 @deftypevr {@code{transmission-daemon-configuration} parameter} boolean start-added-torrents?
23852 When @code{#t}, torrents are started as soon as they are added;
23853 otherwise, they are added in ``paused'' state.
23854
23855 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
23856
23857 @end deftypevr
23858
23859 @deftypevr {@code{transmission-daemon-configuration} parameter} boolean script-torrent-done-enabled?
23860 When @code{#t}, the script specified by
23861 @code{script-torrent-done-filename} will be invoked each time a torrent
23862 completes.
23863
23864 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
23865
23866 @end deftypevr
23867
23868 @deftypevr {@code{transmission-daemon-configuration} parameter} maybe-file-object script-torrent-done-filename
23869 A file name or file-like object specifying a script to run each time a
23870 torrent completes, when @code{script-torrent-done-enabled?} is
23871 @code{#t}.
23872
23873 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
23874
23875 @end deftypevr
23876
23877 @deftypevr {@code{transmission-daemon-configuration} parameter} boolean scrape-paused-torrents-enabled?
23878 When @code{#t}, the daemon will scrape trackers for a torrent even when
23879 the torrent is paused.
23880
23881 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
23882
23883 @end deftypevr
23884
23885 @deftypevr {@code{transmission-daemon-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer cache-size-mb
23886 The amount of memory, in megabytes, to allocate for the daemon's
23887 in-memory cache. A larger value may increase performance by reducing
23888 the frequency of disk I/O.
23889
23890 Defaults to @samp{4}.
23891
23892 @end deftypevr
23893
23894 @deftypevr {@code{transmission-daemon-configuration} parameter} boolean prefetch-enabled?
23895 When @code{#t}, the daemon will try to improve I/O performance by
23896 hinting to the operating system which data is likely to be read next
23897 from disk to satisfy requests from peers.
23898
23899 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
23900
23901 @end deftypevr
23902
23903
23904 @c %end of fragment
23905
23906
23907
23908 @node Monitoring Services
23909 @subsection Monitoring Services
23910
23911 @subsubheading Tailon Service
23912
23913 @uref{https://tailon.readthedocs.io/, Tailon} is a web application for
23914 viewing and searching log files.
23915
23916 The following example will configure the service with default values.
23917 By default, Tailon can be accessed on port 8080 (@code{http://localhost:8080}).
23918
23919 @lisp
23920 (service tailon-service-type)
23921 @end lisp
23922
23923 The following example customises more of the Tailon configuration,
23924 adding @command{sed} to the list of allowed commands.
23925
23926 @lisp
23927 (service tailon-service-type
23928 (tailon-configuration
23929 (config-file
23930 (tailon-configuration-file
23931 (allowed-commands '("tail" "grep" "awk" "sed"))))))
23932 @end lisp
23933
23934
23935 @deftp {Data Type} tailon-configuration
23936 Data type representing the configuration of Tailon.
23937 This type has the following parameters:
23938
23939 @table @asis
23940 @item @code{config-file} (default: @code{(tailon-configuration-file)})
23941 The configuration file to use for Tailon. This can be set to a
23942 @dfn{tailon-configuration-file} record value, or any gexp
23943 (@pxref{G-Expressions}).
23944
23945 For example, to instead use a local file, the @code{local-file} function
23946 can be used:
23947
23948 @lisp
23949 (service tailon-service-type
23950 (tailon-configuration
23951 (config-file (local-file "./my-tailon.conf"))))
23952 @end lisp
23953
23954 @item @code{package} (default: @code{tailon})
23955 The tailon package to use.
23956
23957 @end table
23958 @end deftp
23959
23960 @deftp {Data Type} tailon-configuration-file
23961 Data type representing the configuration options for Tailon.
23962 This type has the following parameters:
23963
23964 @table @asis
23965 @item @code{files} (default: @code{(list "/var/log")})
23966 List of files to display. The list can include strings for a single file
23967 or directory, or a list, where the first item is the name of a
23968 subsection, and the remaining items are the files or directories in that
23969 subsection.
23970
23971 @item @code{bind} (default: @code{"localhost:8080"})
23972 Address and port to which Tailon should bind on.
23973
23974 @item @code{relative-root} (default: @code{#f})
23975 URL path to use for Tailon, set to @code{#f} to not use a path.
23976
23977 @item @code{allow-transfers?} (default: @code{#t})
23978 Allow downloading the log files in the web interface.
23979
23980 @item @code{follow-names?} (default: @code{#t})
23981 Allow tailing of not-yet existent files.
23982
23983 @item @code{tail-lines} (default: @code{200})
23984 Number of lines to read initially from each file.
23985
23986 @item @code{allowed-commands} (default: @code{(list "tail" "grep" "awk")})
23987 Commands to allow running. By default, @code{sed} is disabled.
23988
23989 @item @code{debug?} (default: @code{#f})
23990 Set @code{debug?} to @code{#t} to show debug messages.
23991
23992 @item @code{wrap-lines} (default: @code{#t})
23993 Initial line wrapping state in the web interface. Set to @code{#t} to
23994 initially wrap lines (the default), or to @code{#f} to initially not
23995 wrap lines.
23996
23997 @item @code{http-auth} (default: @code{#f})
23998 HTTP authentication type to use. Set to @code{#f} to disable
23999 authentication (the default). Supported values are @code{"digest"} or
24000 @code{"basic"}.
24001
24002 @item @code{users} (default: @code{#f})
24003 If HTTP authentication is enabled (see @code{http-auth}), access will be
24004 restricted to the credentials provided here. To configure users, use a
24005 list of pairs, where the first element of the pair is the username, and
24006 the 2nd element of the pair is the password.
24007
24008 @lisp
24009 (tailon-configuration-file
24010 (http-auth "basic")
24011 (users '(("user1" . "password1")
24012 ("user2" . "password2"))))
24013 @end lisp
24014
24015 @end table
24016 @end deftp
24017
24018
24019 @subsubheading Darkstat Service
24020 @cindex darkstat
24021 Darkstat is a packet sniffer that captures network traffic, calculates
24022 statistics about usage, and serves reports over HTTP.
24023
24024 @defvar {Scheme Variable} darkstat-service-type
24025 This is the service type for the
24026 @uref{https://unix4lyfe.org/darkstat/, darkstat}
24027 service, its value must be a @code{darkstat-configuration} record as in
24028 this example:
24029
24030 @lisp
24031 (service darkstat-service-type
24032 (darkstat-configuration
24033 (interface "eno1")))
24034 @end lisp
24035 @end defvar
24036
24037 @deftp {Data Type} darkstat-configuration
24038 Data type representing the configuration of @command{darkstat}.
24039
24040 @table @asis
24041 @item @code{package} (default: @code{darkstat})
24042 The darkstat package to use.
24043
24044 @item @code{interface}
24045 Capture traffic on the specified network interface.
24046
24047 @item @code{port} (default: @code{"667"})
24048 Bind the web interface to the specified port.
24049
24050 @item @code{bind-address} (default: @code{"127.0.0.1"})
24051 Bind the web interface to the specified address.
24052
24053 @item @code{base} (default: @code{"/"})
24054 Specify the path of the base URL@. This can be useful if
24055 @command{darkstat} is accessed via a reverse proxy.
24056
24057 @end table
24058 @end deftp
24059
24060 @subsubheading Prometheus Node Exporter Service
24061
24062 @cindex prometheus-node-exporter
24063 The Prometheus ``node exporter'' makes hardware and operating system statistics
24064 provided by the Linux kernel available for the Prometheus monitoring system.
24065 This service should be deployed on all physical nodes and virtual machines,
24066 where monitoring these statistics is desirable.
24067
24068 @defvar {Scheme variable} prometheus-node-exporter-service-type
24069 This is the service type for the
24070 @uref{https://github.com/prometheus/node_exporter/, prometheus-node-exporter}
24071 service, its value must be a @code{prometheus-node-exporter-configuration}.
24072
24073 @lisp
24074 (service prometheus-node-exporter-service-type)
24075 @end lisp
24076 @end defvar
24077
24078 @deftp {Data Type} prometheus-node-exporter-configuration
24079 Data type representing the configuration of @command{node_exporter}.
24080
24081 @table @asis
24082 @item @code{package} (default: @code{go-github-com-prometheus-node-exporter})
24083 The prometheus-node-exporter package to use.
24084
24085 @item @code{web-listen-address} (default: @code{":9100"})
24086 Bind the web interface to the specified address.
24087
24088 @item @code{textfile-directory} (default: @code{"/var/lib/prometheus/node-exporter"})
24089 This directory can be used to export metrics specific to this machine.
24090 Files containing metrics in the text format, with the filename ending in
24091 @code{.prom} should be placed in this directory.
24092
24093 @item @code{extra-options} (default: @code{'()})
24094 Extra options to pass to the Prometheus node exporter.
24095
24096 @end table
24097 @end deftp
24098
24099 @subsubheading Zabbix server
24100 @cindex zabbix zabbix-server
24101 Zabbix provides monitoring metrics, among others network utilization, CPU load
24102 and disk space consumption:
24103
24104 @itemize
24105 @item High performance, high capacity (able to monitor hundreds of thousands of devices).
24106 @item Auto-discovery of servers and network devices and interfaces.
24107 @item Low-level discovery, allows to automatically start monitoring new items, file systems or network interfaces among others.
24108 @item Distributed monitoring with centralized web administration.
24109 @item Native high performance agents.
24110 @item SLA, and ITIL KPI metrics on reporting.
24111 @item High-level (business) view of monitored resources through user-defined visual console screens and dashboards.
24112 @item Remote command execution through Zabbix proxies.
24113 @end itemize
24114
24115 @c %start of fragment
24116
24117 Available @code{zabbix-server-configuration} fields are:
24118
24119 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-server-configuration} parameter} package zabbix-server
24120 The zabbix-server package.
24121
24122 @end deftypevr
24123
24124 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-server-configuration} parameter} string user
24125 User who will run the Zabbix server.
24126
24127 Defaults to @samp{"zabbix"}.
24128
24129 @end deftypevr
24130
24131 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-server-configuration} parameter} group group
24132 Group who will run the Zabbix server.
24133
24134 Defaults to @samp{"zabbix"}.
24135
24136 @end deftypevr
24137
24138 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-server-configuration} parameter} string db-host
24139 Database host name.
24140
24141 Defaults to @samp{"127.0.0.1"}.
24142
24143 @end deftypevr
24144
24145 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-server-configuration} parameter} string db-name
24146 Database name.
24147
24148 Defaults to @samp{"zabbix"}.
24149
24150 @end deftypevr
24151
24152 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-server-configuration} parameter} string db-user
24153 Database user.
24154
24155 Defaults to @samp{"zabbix"}.
24156
24157 @end deftypevr
24158
24159 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-server-configuration} parameter} string db-password
24160 Database password. Please, use @code{include-files} with
24161 @code{DBPassword=SECRET} inside a specified file instead.
24162
24163 Defaults to @samp{""}.
24164
24165 @end deftypevr
24166
24167 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-server-configuration} parameter} number db-port
24168 Database port.
24169
24170 Defaults to @samp{5432}.
24171
24172 @end deftypevr
24173
24174 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-server-configuration} parameter} string log-type
24175 Specifies where log messages are written to:
24176
24177 @itemize @bullet
24178 @item
24179 @code{system} - syslog.
24180
24181 @item
24182 @code{file} - file specified with @code{log-file} parameter.
24183
24184 @item
24185 @code{console} - standard output.
24186
24187 @end itemize
24188
24189 Defaults to @samp{""}.
24190
24191 @end deftypevr
24192
24193 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-server-configuration} parameter} string log-file
24194 Log file name for @code{log-type} @code{file} parameter.
24195
24196 Defaults to @samp{"/var/log/zabbix/server.log"}.
24197
24198 @end deftypevr
24199
24200 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-server-configuration} parameter} string pid-file
24201 Name of PID file.
24202
24203 Defaults to @samp{"/var/run/zabbix/zabbix_server.pid"}.
24204
24205 @end deftypevr
24206
24207 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-server-configuration} parameter} string ssl-ca-location
24208 The location of certificate authority (CA) files for SSL server
24209 certificate verification.
24210
24211 Defaults to @samp{"/etc/ssl/certs/ca-certificates.crt"}.
24212
24213 @end deftypevr
24214
24215 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-server-configuration} parameter} string ssl-cert-location
24216 Location of SSL client certificates.
24217
24218 Defaults to @samp{"/etc/ssl/certs"}.
24219
24220 @end deftypevr
24221
24222 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-server-configuration} parameter} string extra-options
24223 Extra options will be appended to Zabbix server configuration file.
24224
24225 Defaults to @samp{""}.
24226
24227 @end deftypevr
24228
24229 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-server-configuration} parameter} include-files include-files
24230 You may include individual files or all files in a directory in the
24231 configuration file.
24232
24233 Defaults to @samp{()}.
24234
24235 @end deftypevr
24236
24237 @c %end of fragment
24238
24239 @subsubheading Zabbix agent
24240 @cindex zabbix zabbix-agent
24241
24242 Zabbix agent gathers information for Zabbix server.
24243
24244 @c %start of fragment
24245
24246 Available @code{zabbix-agent-configuration} fields are:
24247
24248 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-agent-configuration} parameter} package zabbix-agent
24249 The zabbix-agent package.
24250
24251 @end deftypevr
24252
24253 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-agent-configuration} parameter} string user
24254 User who will run the Zabbix agent.
24255
24256 Defaults to @samp{"zabbix"}.
24257
24258 @end deftypevr
24259
24260 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-agent-configuration} parameter} group group
24261 Group who will run the Zabbix agent.
24262
24263 Defaults to @samp{"zabbix"}.
24264
24265 @end deftypevr
24266
24267 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-agent-configuration} parameter} string hostname
24268 Unique, case sensitive hostname which is required for active checks and
24269 must match hostname as configured on the server.
24270
24271 Defaults to @samp{""}.
24272
24273 @end deftypevr
24274
24275 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-agent-configuration} parameter} string log-type
24276 Specifies where log messages are written to:
24277
24278 @itemize @bullet
24279 @item
24280 @code{system} - syslog.
24281
24282 @item
24283 @code{file} - file specified with @code{log-file} parameter.
24284
24285 @item
24286 @code{console} - standard output.
24287
24288 @end itemize
24289
24290 Defaults to @samp{""}.
24291
24292 @end deftypevr
24293
24294 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-agent-configuration} parameter} string log-file
24295 Log file name for @code{log-type} @code{file} parameter.
24296
24297 Defaults to @samp{"/var/log/zabbix/agent.log"}.
24298
24299 @end deftypevr
24300
24301 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-agent-configuration} parameter} string pid-file
24302 Name of PID file.
24303
24304 Defaults to @samp{"/var/run/zabbix/zabbix_agent.pid"}.
24305
24306 @end deftypevr
24307
24308 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-agent-configuration} parameter} list server
24309 List of IP addresses, optionally in CIDR notation, or hostnames of
24310 Zabbix servers and Zabbix proxies. Incoming connections will be
24311 accepted only from the hosts listed here.
24312
24313 Defaults to @samp{("127.0.0.1")}.
24314
24315 @end deftypevr
24316
24317 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-agent-configuration} parameter} list server-active
24318 List of IP:port (or hostname:port) pairs of Zabbix servers and Zabbix
24319 proxies for active checks. If port is not specified, default port is
24320 used. If this parameter is not specified, active checks are disabled.
24321
24322 Defaults to @samp{("127.0.0.1")}.
24323
24324 @end deftypevr
24325
24326 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-agent-configuration} parameter} string extra-options
24327 Extra options will be appended to Zabbix server configuration file.
24328
24329 Defaults to @samp{""}.
24330
24331 @end deftypevr
24332
24333 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-agent-configuration} parameter} include-files include-files
24334 You may include individual files or all files in a directory in the
24335 configuration file.
24336
24337 Defaults to @samp{()}.
24338
24339 @end deftypevr
24340
24341 @c %end of fragment
24342
24343 @subsubheading Zabbix front-end
24344 @cindex zabbix zabbix-front-end
24345
24346 This service provides a WEB interface to Zabbix server.
24347
24348 @c %start of fragment
24349
24350 Available @code{zabbix-front-end-configuration} fields are:
24351
24352 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-front-end-configuration} parameter} nginx-server-configuration-list nginx
24353 NGINX configuration.
24354
24355 @end deftypevr
24356
24357 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-front-end-configuration} parameter} string db-host
24358 Database host name.
24359
24360 Defaults to @samp{"localhost"}.
24361
24362 @end deftypevr
24363
24364 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-front-end-configuration} parameter} number db-port
24365 Database port.
24366
24367 Defaults to @samp{5432}.
24368
24369 @end deftypevr
24370
24371 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-front-end-configuration} parameter} string db-name
24372 Database name.
24373
24374 Defaults to @samp{"zabbix"}.
24375
24376 @end deftypevr
24377
24378 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-front-end-configuration} parameter} string db-user
24379 Database user.
24380
24381 Defaults to @samp{"zabbix"}.
24382
24383 @end deftypevr
24384
24385 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-front-end-configuration} parameter} string db-password
24386 Database password. Please, use @code{db-secret-file} instead.
24387
24388 Defaults to @samp{""}.
24389
24390 @end deftypevr
24391
24392 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-front-end-configuration} parameter} string db-secret-file
24393 Secret file containing the credentials for the Zabbix front-end. The value
24394 must be a local file name, not a G-expression. You are expected to create
24395 this file manually. Its contents will be copied into @file{zabbix.conf.php}
24396 as the value of @code{$DB['PASSWORD']}.
24397
24398 Defaults to @samp{""}.
24399
24400 @end deftypevr
24401
24402 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-front-end-configuration} parameter} string zabbix-host
24403 Zabbix server hostname.
24404
24405 Defaults to @samp{"localhost"}.
24406
24407 @end deftypevr
24408
24409 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-front-end-configuration} parameter} number zabbix-port
24410 Zabbix server port.
24411
24412 Defaults to @samp{10051}.
24413
24414 @end deftypevr
24415
24416
24417 @c %end of fragment
24418
24419 @node Kerberos Services
24420 @subsection Kerberos Services
24421 @cindex Kerberos
24422
24423 The @code{(gnu services kerberos)} module provides services relating to
24424 the authentication protocol @dfn{Kerberos}.
24425
24426 @subsubheading Krb5 Service
24427
24428 Programs using a Kerberos client library normally
24429 expect a configuration file in @file{/etc/krb5.conf}.
24430 This service generates such a file from a definition provided in the
24431 operating system declaration.
24432 It does not cause any daemon to be started.
24433
24434 No ``keytab'' files are provided by this service---you must explicitly create them.
24435 This service is known to work with the MIT client library, @code{mit-krb5}.
24436 Other implementations have not been tested.
24437
24438 @defvr {Scheme Variable} krb5-service-type
24439 A service type for Kerberos 5 clients.
24440 @end defvr
24441
24442 @noindent
24443 Here is an example of its use:
24444 @lisp
24445 (service krb5-service-type
24446 (krb5-configuration
24447 (default-realm "EXAMPLE.COM")
24448 (allow-weak-crypto? #t)
24449 (realms (list
24450 (krb5-realm
24451 (name "EXAMPLE.COM")
24452 (admin-server "groucho.example.com")
24453 (kdc "karl.example.com"))
24454 (krb5-realm
24455 (name "ARGRX.EDU")
24456 (admin-server "kerb-admin.argrx.edu")
24457 (kdc "keys.argrx.edu"))))))
24458 @end lisp
24459
24460 @noindent
24461 This example provides a Kerberos@tie{}5 client configuration which:
24462 @itemize
24463 @item Recognizes two realms, @i{viz:} ``EXAMPLE.COM'' and ``ARGRX.EDU'', both
24464 of which have distinct administration servers and key distribution centers;
24465 @item Will default to the realm ``EXAMPLE.COM'' if the realm is not explicitly
24466 specified by clients;
24467 @item Accepts services which only support encryption types known to be weak.
24468 @end itemize
24469
24470 The @code{krb5-realm} and @code{krb5-configuration} types have many fields.
24471 Only the most commonly used ones are described here.
24472 For a full list, and more detailed explanation of each, see the MIT
24473 @uref{https://web.mit.edu/kerberos/krb5-devel/doc/admin/conf_files/krb5_conf.html,,krb5.conf}
24474 documentation.
24475
24476
24477 @deftp {Data Type} krb5-realm
24478 @cindex realm, kerberos
24479 @table @asis
24480 @item @code{name}
24481 This field is a string identifying the name of the realm.
24482 A common convention is to use the fully qualified DNS name of your organization,
24483 converted to upper case.
24484
24485 @item @code{admin-server}
24486 This field is a string identifying the host where the administration server is
24487 running.
24488
24489 @item @code{kdc}
24490 This field is a string identifying the key distribution center
24491 for the realm.
24492 @end table
24493 @end deftp
24494
24495 @deftp {Data Type} krb5-configuration
24496
24497 @table @asis
24498 @item @code{allow-weak-crypto?} (default: @code{#f})
24499 If this flag is @code{#t} then services which only offer encryption algorithms
24500 known to be weak will be accepted.
24501
24502 @item @code{default-realm} (default: @code{#f})
24503 This field should be a string identifying the default Kerberos
24504 realm for the client.
24505 You should set this field to the name of your Kerberos realm.
24506 If this value is @code{#f}
24507 then a realm must be specified with every Kerberos principal when invoking programs
24508 such as @command{kinit}.
24509
24510 @item @code{realms}
24511 This should be a non-empty list of @code{krb5-realm} objects, which clients may
24512 access.
24513 Normally, one of them will have a @code{name} field matching the @code{default-realm}
24514 field.
24515 @end table
24516 @end deftp
24517
24518
24519 @subsubheading PAM krb5 Service
24520 @cindex pam-krb5
24521
24522 The @code{pam-krb5} service allows for login authentication and password
24523 management via Kerberos.
24524 You will need this service if you want PAM enabled applications to authenticate
24525 users using Kerberos.
24526
24527 @defvr {Scheme Variable} pam-krb5-service-type
24528 A service type for the Kerberos 5 PAM module.
24529 @end defvr
24530
24531 @deftp {Data Type} pam-krb5-configuration
24532 Data type representing the configuration of the Kerberos 5 PAM module.
24533 This type has the following parameters:
24534 @table @asis
24535 @item @code{pam-krb5} (default: @code{pam-krb5})
24536 The pam-krb5 package to use.
24537
24538 @item @code{minimum-uid} (default: @code{1000})
24539 The smallest user ID for which Kerberos authentications should be attempted.
24540 Local accounts with lower values will silently fail to authenticate.
24541 @end table
24542 @end deftp
24543
24544
24545 @node LDAP Services
24546 @subsection LDAP Services
24547 @cindex LDAP
24548 @cindex nslcd, LDAP service
24549
24550 The @code{(gnu services authentication)} module provides the
24551 @code{nslcd-service-type}, which can be used to authenticate against an LDAP
24552 server. In addition to configuring the service itself, you may want to add
24553 @code{ldap} as a name service to the Name Service Switch. @xref{Name Service
24554 Switch} for detailed information.
24555
24556 Here is a simple operating system declaration with a default configuration of
24557 the @code{nslcd-service-type} and a Name Service Switch configuration that
24558 consults the @code{ldap} name service last:
24559
24560 @lisp
24561 (use-service-modules authentication)
24562 (use-modules (gnu system nss))
24563 ...
24564 (operating-system
24565 ...
24566 (services
24567 (cons*
24568 (service nslcd-service-type)
24569 (service dhcp-client-service-type)
24570 %base-services))
24571 (name-service-switch
24572 (let ((services (list (name-service (name "db"))
24573 (name-service (name "files"))
24574 (name-service (name "ldap")))))
24575 (name-service-switch
24576 (inherit %mdns-host-lookup-nss)
24577 (password services)
24578 (shadow services)
24579 (group services)
24580 (netgroup services)
24581 (gshadow services)))))
24582 @end lisp
24583
24584 @c %start of generated documentation for nslcd-configuration
24585
24586 Available @code{nslcd-configuration} fields are:
24587
24588 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} package nss-pam-ldapd
24589 The @code{nss-pam-ldapd} package to use.
24590
24591 @end deftypevr
24592
24593 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-number threads
24594 The number of threads to start that can handle requests and perform LDAP
24595 queries. Each thread opens a separate connection to the LDAP server.
24596 The default is to start 5 threads.
24597
24598 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
24599
24600 @end deftypevr
24601
24602 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} string uid
24603 This specifies the user id with which the daemon should be run.
24604
24605 Defaults to @samp{"nslcd"}.
24606
24607 @end deftypevr
24608
24609 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} string gid
24610 This specifies the group id with which the daemon should be run.
24611
24612 Defaults to @samp{"nslcd"}.
24613
24614 @end deftypevr
24615
24616 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} log-option log
24617 This option controls the way logging is done via a list containing
24618 SCHEME and LEVEL@. The SCHEME argument may either be the symbols
24619 @samp{none} or @samp{syslog}, or an absolute file name. The LEVEL
24620 argument is optional and specifies the log level. The log level may be
24621 one of the following symbols: @samp{crit}, @samp{error}, @samp{warning},
24622 @samp{notice}, @samp{info} or @samp{debug}. All messages with the
24623 specified log level or higher are logged.
24624
24625 Defaults to @samp{("/var/log/nslcd" info)}.
24626
24627 @end deftypevr
24628
24629 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} list uri
24630 The list of LDAP server URIs. Normally, only the first server will be
24631 used with the following servers as fall-back.
24632
24633 Defaults to @samp{("ldap://localhost:389/")}.
24634
24635 @end deftypevr
24636
24637 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-string ldap-version
24638 The version of the LDAP protocol to use. The default is to use the
24639 maximum version supported by the LDAP library.
24640
24641 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
24642
24643 @end deftypevr
24644
24645 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-string binddn
24646 Specifies the distinguished name with which to bind to the directory
24647 server for lookups. The default is to bind anonymously.
24648
24649 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
24650
24651 @end deftypevr
24652
24653 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-string bindpw
24654 Specifies the credentials with which to bind. This option is only
24655 applicable when used with binddn.
24656
24657 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
24658
24659 @end deftypevr
24660
24661 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-string rootpwmoddn
24662 Specifies the distinguished name to use when the root user tries to
24663 modify a user's password using the PAM module.
24664
24665 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
24666
24667 @end deftypevr
24668
24669 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-string rootpwmodpw
24670 Specifies the credentials with which to bind if the root user tries to
24671 change a user's password. This option is only applicable when used with
24672 rootpwmoddn
24673
24674 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
24675
24676 @end deftypevr
24677
24678 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-string sasl-mech
24679 Specifies the SASL mechanism to be used when performing SASL
24680 authentication.
24681
24682 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
24683
24684 @end deftypevr
24685
24686 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-string sasl-realm
24687 Specifies the SASL realm to be used when performing SASL authentication.
24688
24689 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
24690
24691 @end deftypevr
24692
24693 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-string sasl-authcid
24694 Specifies the authentication identity to be used when performing SASL
24695 authentication.
24696
24697 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
24698
24699 @end deftypevr
24700
24701 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-string sasl-authzid
24702 Specifies the authorization identity to be used when performing SASL
24703 authentication.
24704
24705 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
24706
24707 @end deftypevr
24708
24709 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-boolean sasl-canonicalize?
24710 Determines whether the LDAP server host name should be canonicalised. If
24711 this is enabled the LDAP library will do a reverse host name lookup. By
24712 default, it is left up to the LDAP library whether this check is
24713 performed or not.
24714
24715 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
24716
24717 @end deftypevr
24718
24719 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-string krb5-ccname
24720 Set the name for the GSS-API Kerberos credentials cache.
24721
24722 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
24723
24724 @end deftypevr
24725
24726 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} string base
24727 The directory search base.
24728
24729 Defaults to @samp{"dc=example,dc=com"}.
24730
24731 @end deftypevr
24732
24733 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} scope-option scope
24734 Specifies the search scope (subtree, onelevel, base or children). The
24735 default scope is subtree; base scope is almost never useful for name
24736 service lookups; children scope is not supported on all servers.
24737
24738 Defaults to @samp{(subtree)}.
24739
24740 @end deftypevr
24741
24742 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-deref-option deref
24743 Specifies the policy for dereferencing aliases. The default policy is
24744 to never dereference aliases.
24745
24746 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
24747
24748 @end deftypevr
24749
24750 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-boolean referrals
24751 Specifies whether automatic referral chasing should be enabled. The
24752 default behaviour is to chase referrals.
24753
24754 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
24755
24756 @end deftypevr
24757
24758 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} list-of-map-entries maps
24759 This option allows for custom attributes to be looked up instead of the
24760 default RFC 2307 attributes. It is a list of maps, each consisting of
24761 the name of a map, the RFC 2307 attribute to match and the query
24762 expression for the attribute as it is available in the directory.
24763
24764 Defaults to @samp{()}.
24765
24766 @end deftypevr
24767
24768 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} list-of-filter-entries filters
24769 A list of filters consisting of the name of a map to which the filter
24770 applies and an LDAP search filter expression.
24771
24772 Defaults to @samp{()}.
24773
24774 @end deftypevr
24775
24776 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-number bind-timelimit
24777 Specifies the time limit in seconds to use when connecting to the
24778 directory server. The default value is 10 seconds.
24779
24780 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
24781
24782 @end deftypevr
24783
24784 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-number timelimit
24785 Specifies the time limit (in seconds) to wait for a response from the
24786 LDAP server. A value of zero, which is the default, is to wait
24787 indefinitely for searches to be completed.
24788
24789 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
24790
24791 @end deftypevr
24792
24793 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-number idle-timelimit
24794 Specifies the period if inactivity (in seconds) after which the con‐
24795 nection to the LDAP server will be closed. The default is not to time
24796 out connections.
24797
24798 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
24799
24800 @end deftypevr
24801
24802 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-number reconnect-sleeptime
24803 Specifies the number of seconds to sleep when connecting to all LDAP
24804 servers fails. By default one second is waited between the first
24805 failure and the first retry.
24806
24807 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
24808
24809 @end deftypevr
24810
24811 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-number reconnect-retrytime
24812 Specifies the time after which the LDAP server is considered to be
24813 permanently unavailable. Once this time is reached retries will be done
24814 only once per this time period. The default value is 10 seconds.
24815
24816 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
24817
24818 @end deftypevr
24819
24820 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-ssl-option ssl
24821 Specifies whether to use SSL/TLS or not (the default is not to). If
24822 'start-tls is specified then StartTLS is used rather than raw LDAP over
24823 SSL.
24824
24825 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
24826
24827 @end deftypevr
24828
24829 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-tls-reqcert-option tls-reqcert
24830 Specifies what checks to perform on a server-supplied certificate. The
24831 meaning of the values is described in the ldap.conf(5) manual page.
24832
24833 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
24834
24835 @end deftypevr
24836
24837 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-string tls-cacertdir
24838 Specifies the directory containing X.509 certificates for peer authen‐
24839 tication. This parameter is ignored when using GnuTLS.
24840
24841 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
24842
24843 @end deftypevr
24844
24845 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-string tls-cacertfile
24846 Specifies the path to the X.509 certificate for peer authentication.
24847
24848 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
24849
24850 @end deftypevr
24851
24852 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-string tls-randfile
24853 Specifies the path to an entropy source. This parameter is ignored when
24854 using GnuTLS.
24855
24856 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
24857
24858 @end deftypevr
24859
24860 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-string tls-ciphers
24861 Specifies the ciphers to use for TLS as a string.
24862
24863 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
24864
24865 @end deftypevr
24866
24867 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-string tls-cert
24868 Specifies the path to the file containing the local certificate for
24869 client TLS authentication.
24870
24871 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
24872
24873 @end deftypevr
24874
24875 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-string tls-key
24876 Specifies the path to the file containing the private key for client TLS
24877 authentication.
24878
24879 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
24880
24881 @end deftypevr
24882
24883 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-number pagesize
24884 Set this to a number greater than 0 to request paged results from the
24885 LDAP server in accordance with RFC2696. The default (0) is to not
24886 request paged results.
24887
24888 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
24889
24890 @end deftypevr
24891
24892 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-ignore-users-option nss-initgroups-ignoreusers
24893 This option prevents group membership lookups through LDAP for the
24894 specified users. Alternatively, the value 'all-local may be used. With
24895 that value nslcd builds a full list of non-LDAP users on startup.
24896
24897 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
24898
24899 @end deftypevr
24900
24901 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-number nss-min-uid
24902 This option ensures that LDAP users with a numeric user id lower than
24903 the specified value are ignored.
24904
24905 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
24906
24907 @end deftypevr
24908
24909 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-number nss-uid-offset
24910 This option specifies an offset that is added to all LDAP numeric user
24911 ids. This can be used to avoid user id collisions with local users.
24912
24913 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
24914
24915 @end deftypevr
24916
24917 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-number nss-gid-offset
24918 This option specifies an offset that is added to all LDAP numeric group
24919 ids. This can be used to avoid user id collisions with local groups.
24920
24921 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
24922
24923 @end deftypevr
24924
24925 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-boolean nss-nested-groups
24926 If this option is set, the member attribute of a group may point to
24927 another group. Members of nested groups are also returned in the higher
24928 level group and parent groups are returned when finding groups for a
24929 specific user. The default is not to perform extra searches for nested
24930 groups.
24931
24932 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
24933
24934 @end deftypevr
24935
24936 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-boolean nss-getgrent-skipmembers
24937 If this option is set, the group member list is not retrieved when
24938 looking up groups. Lookups for finding which groups a user belongs to
24939 will remain functional so the user will likely still get the correct
24940 groups assigned on login.
24941
24942 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
24943
24944 @end deftypevr
24945
24946 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-boolean nss-disable-enumeration
24947 If this option is set, functions which cause all user/group entries to
24948 be loaded from the directory will not succeed in doing so. This can
24949 dramatically reduce LDAP server load in situations where there are a
24950 great number of users and/or groups. This option is not recommended for
24951 most configurations.
24952
24953 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
24954
24955 @end deftypevr
24956
24957 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-string validnames
24958 This option can be used to specify how user and group names are verified
24959 within the system. This pattern is used to check all user and group
24960 names that are requested and returned from LDAP.
24961
24962 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
24963
24964 @end deftypevr
24965
24966 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-boolean ignorecase
24967 This specifies whether or not to perform searches using case-insensitive
24968 matching. Enabling this could open up the system to authorization
24969 bypass vulnerabilities and introduce nscd cache poisoning
24970 vulnerabilities which allow denial of service.
24971
24972 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
24973
24974 @end deftypevr
24975
24976 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-boolean pam-authc-ppolicy
24977 This option specifies whether password policy controls are requested and
24978 handled from the LDAP server when performing user authentication.
24979
24980 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
24981
24982 @end deftypevr
24983
24984 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-string pam-authc-search
24985 By default nslcd performs an LDAP search with the user's credentials
24986 after BIND (authentication) to ensure that the BIND operation was
24987 successful. The default search is a simple check to see if the user's
24988 DN exists. A search filter can be specified that will be used instead.
24989 It should return at least one entry.
24990
24991 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
24992
24993 @end deftypevr
24994
24995 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-string pam-authz-search
24996 This option allows flexible fine tuning of the authorisation check that
24997 should be performed. The search filter specified is executed and if any
24998 entries match, access is granted, otherwise access is denied.
24999
25000 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
25001
25002 @end deftypevr
25003
25004 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-string pam-password-prohibit-message
25005 If this option is set password modification using pam_ldap will be
25006 denied and the specified message will be presented to the user instead.
25007 The message can be used to direct the user to an alternative means of
25008 changing their password.
25009
25010 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
25011
25012 @end deftypevr
25013
25014 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} list pam-services
25015 List of pam service names for which LDAP authentication should suffice.
25016
25017 Defaults to @samp{()}.
25018
25019 @end deftypevr
25020
25021 @c %end of generated documentation for nslcd-configuration
25022
25023
25024 @node Web Services
25025 @subsection Web Services
25026
25027 @cindex web
25028 @cindex www
25029 @cindex HTTP
25030 The @code{(gnu services web)} module provides the Apache HTTP Server,
25031 the nginx web server, and also a fastcgi wrapper daemon.
25032
25033 @subsubheading Apache HTTP Server
25034
25035 @deffn {Scheme Variable} httpd-service-type
25036 Service type for the @uref{https://httpd.apache.org/,Apache HTTP} server
25037 (@dfn{httpd}). The value for this service type is a
25038 @code{httpd-configuration} record.
25039
25040 A simple example configuration is given below.
25041
25042 @lisp
25043 (service httpd-service-type
25044 (httpd-configuration
25045 (config
25046 (httpd-config-file
25047 (server-name "www.example.com")
25048 (document-root "/srv/http/www.example.com")))))
25049 @end lisp
25050
25051 Other services can also extend the @code{httpd-service-type} to add to
25052 the configuration.
25053
25054 @lisp
25055 (simple-service 'www.example.com-server httpd-service-type
25056 (list
25057 (httpd-virtualhost
25058 "*:80"
25059 (list (string-join '("ServerName www.example.com"
25060 "DocumentRoot /srv/http/www.example.com")
25061 "\n")))))
25062 @end lisp
25063 @end deffn
25064
25065 The details for the @code{httpd-configuration}, @code{httpd-module},
25066 @code{httpd-config-file} and @code{httpd-virtualhost} record types are
25067 given below.
25068
25069 @deffn {Data Type} httpd-configuration
25070 This data type represents the configuration for the httpd service.
25071
25072 @table @asis
25073 @item @code{package} (default: @code{httpd})
25074 The httpd package to use.
25075
25076 @item @code{pid-file} (default: @code{"/var/run/httpd"})
25077 The pid file used by the shepherd-service.
25078
25079 @item @code{config} (default: @code{(httpd-config-file)})
25080 The configuration file to use with the httpd service. The default value
25081 is a @code{httpd-config-file} record, but this can also be a different
25082 G-expression that generates a file, for example a @code{plain-file}. A
25083 file outside of the store can also be specified through a string.
25084
25085 @end table
25086 @end deffn
25087
25088 @deffn {Data Type} httpd-module
25089 This data type represents a module for the httpd service.
25090
25091 @table @asis
25092 @item @code{name}
25093 The name of the module.
25094
25095 @item @code{file}
25096 The file for the module. This can be relative to the httpd package being
25097 used, the absolute location of a file, or a G-expression for a file
25098 within the store, for example @code{(file-append mod-wsgi
25099 "/modules/mod_wsgi.so")}.
25100
25101 @end table
25102 @end deffn
25103
25104 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %default-httpd-modules
25105 A default list of @code{httpd-module} objects.
25106 @end defvr
25107
25108 @deffn {Data Type} httpd-config-file
25109 This data type represents a configuration file for the httpd service.
25110
25111 @table @asis
25112 @item @code{modules} (default: @code{%default-httpd-modules})
25113 The modules to load. Additional modules can be added here, or loaded by
25114 additional configuration.
25115
25116 For example, in order to handle requests for PHP files, you can use Apache’s
25117 @code{mod_proxy_fcgi} module along with @code{php-fpm-service-type}:
25118
25119 @lisp
25120 (service httpd-service-type
25121 (httpd-configuration
25122 (config
25123 (httpd-config-file
25124 (modules (cons*
25125 (httpd-module
25126 (name "proxy_module")
25127 (file "modules/mod_proxy.so"))
25128 (httpd-module
25129 (name "proxy_fcgi_module")
25130 (file "modules/mod_proxy_fcgi.so"))
25131 %default-httpd-modules))
25132 (extra-config (list "\
25133 <FilesMatch \\.php$>
25134 SetHandler \"proxy:unix:/var/run/php-fpm.sock|fcgi://localhost/\"
25135 </FilesMatch>"))))))
25136 (service php-fpm-service-type
25137 (php-fpm-configuration
25138 (socket "/var/run/php-fpm.sock")
25139 (socket-group "httpd")))
25140 @end lisp
25141
25142 @item @code{server-root} (default: @code{httpd})
25143 The @code{ServerRoot} in the configuration file, defaults to the httpd
25144 package. Directives including @code{Include} and @code{LoadModule} are
25145 taken as relative to the server root.
25146
25147 @item @code{server-name} (default: @code{#f})
25148 The @code{ServerName} in the configuration file, used to specify the
25149 request scheme, hostname and port that the server uses to identify
25150 itself.
25151
25152 This doesn't need to be set in the server config, and can be specified
25153 in virtual hosts. The default is @code{#f} to not specify a
25154 @code{ServerName}.
25155
25156 @item @code{document-root} (default: @code{"/srv/http"})
25157 The @code{DocumentRoot} from which files will be served.
25158
25159 @item @code{listen} (default: @code{'("80")})
25160 The list of values for the @code{Listen} directives in the config
25161 file. The value should be a list of strings, when each string can
25162 specify the port number to listen on, and optionally the IP address and
25163 protocol to use.
25164
25165 @item @code{pid-file} (default: @code{"/var/run/httpd"})
25166 The @code{PidFile} to use. This should match the @code{pid-file} set in
25167 the @code{httpd-configuration} so that the Shepherd service is
25168 configured correctly.
25169
25170 @item @code{error-log} (default: @code{"/var/log/httpd/error_log"})
25171 The @code{ErrorLog} to which the server will log errors.
25172
25173 @item @code{user} (default: @code{"httpd"})
25174 The @code{User} which the server will answer requests as.
25175
25176 @item @code{group} (default: @code{"httpd"})
25177 The @code{Group} which the server will answer requests as.
25178
25179 @item @code{extra-config} (default: @code{(list "TypesConfig etc/httpd/mime.types")})
25180 A flat list of strings and G-expressions which will be added to the end
25181 of the configuration file.
25182
25183 Any values which the service is extended with will be appended to this
25184 list.
25185
25186 @end table
25187 @end deffn
25188
25189 @deffn {Data Type} httpd-virtualhost
25190 This data type represents a virtualhost configuration block for the httpd service.
25191
25192 These should be added to the extra-config for the httpd-service.
25193
25194 @lisp
25195 (simple-service 'www.example.com-server httpd-service-type
25196 (list
25197 (httpd-virtualhost
25198 "*:80"
25199 (list (string-join '("ServerName www.example.com"
25200 "DocumentRoot /srv/http/www.example.com")
25201 "\n")))))
25202 @end lisp
25203
25204 @table @asis
25205 @item @code{addresses-and-ports}
25206 The addresses and ports for the @code{VirtualHost} directive.
25207
25208 @item @code{contents}
25209 The contents of the @code{VirtualHost} directive, this should be a list
25210 of strings and G-expressions.
25211
25212 @end table
25213 @end deffn
25214
25215 @anchor{NGINX}
25216 @subsubheading NGINX
25217
25218 @deffn {Scheme Variable} nginx-service-type
25219 Service type for the @uref{https://nginx.org/,NGinx} web server. The
25220 value for this service type is a @code{<nginx-configuration>} record.
25221
25222 A simple example configuration is given below.
25223
25224 @lisp
25225 (service nginx-service-type
25226 (nginx-configuration
25227 (server-blocks
25228 (list (nginx-server-configuration
25229 (server-name '("www.example.com"))
25230 (root "/srv/http/www.example.com"))))))
25231 @end lisp
25232
25233 In addition to adding server blocks to the service configuration
25234 directly, this service can be extended by other services to add server
25235 blocks, as in this example:
25236
25237 @lisp
25238 (simple-service 'my-extra-server nginx-service-type
25239 (list (nginx-server-configuration
25240 (root "/srv/http/extra-website")
25241 (try-files (list "$uri" "$uri/index.html")))))
25242 @end lisp
25243 @end deffn
25244
25245 At startup, @command{nginx} has not yet read its configuration file, so
25246 it uses a default file to log error messages. If it fails to load its
25247 configuration file, that is where error messages are logged. After the
25248 configuration file is loaded, the default error log file changes as per
25249 configuration. In our case, startup error messages can be found in
25250 @file{/var/run/nginx/logs/error.log}, and after configuration in
25251 @file{/var/log/nginx/error.log}. The second location can be changed
25252 with the @var{log-directory} configuration option.
25253
25254 @deffn {Data Type} nginx-configuration
25255 This data type represents the configuration for NGinx. Some
25256 configuration can be done through this and the other provided record
25257 types, or alternatively, a config file can be provided.
25258
25259 @table @asis
25260 @item @code{nginx} (default: @code{nginx})
25261 The nginx package to use.
25262
25263 @item @code{log-directory} (default: @code{"/var/log/nginx"})
25264 The directory to which NGinx will write log files.
25265
25266 @item @code{run-directory} (default: @code{"/var/run/nginx"})
25267 The directory in which NGinx will create a pid file, and write temporary
25268 files.
25269
25270 @item @code{server-blocks} (default: @code{'()})
25271 A list of @dfn{server blocks} to create in the generated configuration
25272 file, the elements should be of type
25273 @code{<nginx-server-configuration>}.
25274
25275 The following example would setup NGinx to serve @code{www.example.com}
25276 from the @code{/srv/http/www.example.com} directory, without using
25277 HTTPS.
25278 @lisp
25279 (service nginx-service-type
25280 (nginx-configuration
25281 (server-blocks
25282 (list (nginx-server-configuration
25283 (server-name '("www.example.com"))
25284 (root "/srv/http/www.example.com"))))))
25285 @end lisp
25286
25287 @item @code{upstream-blocks} (default: @code{'()})
25288 A list of @dfn{upstream blocks} to create in the generated configuration
25289 file, the elements should be of type
25290 @code{<nginx-upstream-configuration>}.
25291
25292 Configuring upstreams through the @code{upstream-blocks} can be useful
25293 when combined with @code{locations} in the
25294 @code{<nginx-server-configuration>} records. The following example
25295 creates a server configuration with one location configuration, that
25296 will proxy requests to a upstream configuration, which will handle
25297 requests with two servers.
25298
25299 @lisp
25300 (service
25301 nginx-service-type
25302 (nginx-configuration
25303 (server-blocks
25304 (list (nginx-server-configuration
25305 (server-name '("www.example.com"))
25306 (root "/srv/http/www.example.com")
25307 (locations
25308 (list
25309 (nginx-location-configuration
25310 (uri "/path1")
25311 (body '("proxy_pass http://server-proxy;"))))))))
25312 (upstream-blocks
25313 (list (nginx-upstream-configuration
25314 (name "server-proxy")
25315 (servers (list "server1.example.com"
25316 "server2.example.com")))))))
25317 @end lisp
25318
25319 @item @code{file} (default: @code{#f})
25320 If a configuration @var{file} is provided, this will be used, rather than
25321 generating a configuration file from the provided @code{log-directory},
25322 @code{run-directory}, @code{server-blocks} and @code{upstream-blocks}. For
25323 proper operation, these arguments should match what is in @var{file} to ensure
25324 that the directories are created when the service is activated.
25325
25326 This can be useful if you have an existing configuration file, or it's
25327 not possible to do what is required through the other parts of the
25328 nginx-configuration record.
25329
25330 @item @code{server-names-hash-bucket-size} (default: @code{#f})
25331 Bucket size for the server names hash tables, defaults to @code{#f} to
25332 use the size of the processors cache line.
25333
25334 @item @code{server-names-hash-bucket-max-size} (default: @code{#f})
25335 Maximum bucket size for the server names hash tables.
25336
25337 @item @code{modules} (default: @code{'()})
25338 List of nginx dynamic modules to load. This should be a list of file
25339 names of loadable modules, as in this example:
25340
25341 @lisp
25342 (modules
25343 (list
25344 (file-append nginx-accept-language-module "\
25345 /etc/nginx/modules/ngx_http_accept_language_module.so")
25346 (file-append nginx-lua-module "\
25347 /etc/nginx/modules/ngx_http_lua_module.so")))
25348 @end lisp
25349
25350 @item @code{lua-package-path} (default: @code{'()})
25351 List of nginx lua packages to load. This should be a list of package
25352 names of loadable lua modules, as in this example:
25353
25354 @lisp
25355 (lua-package-path (list lua-resty-core
25356 lua-resty-lrucache
25357 lua-resty-signal
25358 lua-tablepool
25359 lua-resty-shell))
25360 @end lisp
25361
25362 @item @code{lua-package-cpath} (default: @code{'()})
25363 List of nginx lua C packages to load. This should be a list of package
25364 names of loadable lua C modules, as in this example:
25365
25366 @lisp
25367 (lua-package-cpath (list lua-resty-signal))
25368 @end lisp
25369
25370 @item @code{global-directives} (default: @code{'((events . ()))})
25371 Association list of global directives for the top level of the nginx
25372 configuration. Values may themselves be association lists.
25373
25374 @lisp
25375 (global-directives
25376 `((worker_processes . 16)
25377 (pcre_jit . on)
25378 (events . ((worker_connections . 1024)))))
25379 @end lisp
25380
25381 @item @code{extra-content} (default: @code{""})
25382 Extra content for the @code{http} block. Should be string or a string
25383 valued G-expression.
25384
25385 @end table
25386 @end deffn
25387
25388 @deftp {Data Type} nginx-server-configuration
25389 Data type representing the configuration of an nginx server block.
25390 This type has the following parameters:
25391
25392 @table @asis
25393 @item @code{listen} (default: @code{'("80" "443 ssl")})
25394 Each @code{listen} directive sets the address and port for IP, or the
25395 path for a UNIX-domain socket on which the server will accept requests.
25396 Both address and port, or only address or only port can be specified.
25397 An address may also be a hostname, for example:
25398
25399 @lisp
25400 '("127.0.0.1:8000" "127.0.0.1" "8000" "*:8000" "localhost:8000")
25401 @end lisp
25402
25403 @item @code{server-name} (default: @code{(list 'default)})
25404 A list of server names this server represents. @code{'default} represents the
25405 default server for connections matching no other server.
25406
25407 @item @code{root} (default: @code{"/srv/http"})
25408 Root of the website nginx will serve.
25409
25410 @item @code{locations} (default: @code{'()})
25411 A list of @dfn{nginx-location-configuration} or
25412 @dfn{nginx-named-location-configuration} records to use within this
25413 server block.
25414
25415 @item @code{index} (default: @code{(list "index.html")})
25416 Index files to look for when clients ask for a directory. If it cannot be found,
25417 Nginx will send the list of files in the directory.
25418
25419 @item @code{try-files} (default: @code{'()})
25420 A list of files whose existence is checked in the specified order.
25421 @code{nginx} will use the first file it finds to process the request.
25422
25423 @item @code{ssl-certificate} (default: @code{#f})
25424 Where to find the certificate for secure connections. Set it to @code{#f} if
25425 you don't have a certificate or you don't want to use HTTPS.
25426
25427 @item @code{ssl-certificate-key} (default: @code{#f})
25428 Where to find the private key for secure connections. Set it to @code{#f} if
25429 you don't have a key or you don't want to use HTTPS.
25430
25431 @item @code{server-tokens?} (default: @code{#f})
25432 Whether the server should add its configuration to response.
25433
25434 @item @code{raw-content} (default: @code{'()})
25435 A list of raw lines added to the server block.
25436
25437 @end table
25438 @end deftp
25439
25440 @deftp {Data Type} nginx-upstream-configuration
25441 Data type representing the configuration of an nginx @code{upstream}
25442 block. This type has the following parameters:
25443
25444 @table @asis
25445 @item @code{name}
25446 Name for this group of servers.
25447
25448 @item @code{servers}
25449 Specify the addresses of the servers in the group. The address can be
25450 specified as a IP address (e.g.@: @samp{127.0.0.1}), domain name
25451 (e.g.@: @samp{backend1.example.com}) or a path to a UNIX socket using the
25452 prefix @samp{unix:}. For addresses using an IP address or domain name,
25453 the default port is 80, and a different port can be specified
25454 explicitly.
25455
25456 @end table
25457 @end deftp
25458
25459 @deftp {Data Type} nginx-location-configuration
25460 Data type representing the configuration of an nginx @code{location}
25461 block. This type has the following parameters:
25462
25463 @table @asis
25464 @item @code{uri}
25465 URI which this location block matches.
25466
25467 @anchor{nginx-location-configuration body}
25468 @item @code{body}
25469 Body of the location block, specified as a list of strings. This can contain
25470 many
25471 configuration directives. For example, to pass requests to a upstream
25472 server group defined using an @code{nginx-upstream-configuration} block,
25473 the following directive would be specified in the body @samp{(list "proxy_pass
25474 http://upstream-name;")}.
25475
25476 @end table
25477 @end deftp
25478
25479 @deftp {Data Type} nginx-named-location-configuration
25480 Data type representing the configuration of an nginx named location
25481 block. Named location blocks are used for request redirection, and not
25482 used for regular request processing. This type has the following
25483 parameters:
25484
25485 @table @asis
25486 @item @code{name}
25487 Name to identify this location block.
25488
25489 @item @code{body}
25490 @xref{nginx-location-configuration body}, as the body for named location
25491 blocks can be used in a similar way to the
25492 @code{nginx-location-configuration body}. One restriction is that the
25493 body of a named location block cannot contain location blocks.
25494
25495 @end table
25496 @end deftp
25497
25498 @subsubheading Varnish Cache
25499 @cindex Varnish
25500 Varnish is a fast cache server that sits in between web applications
25501 and end users. It proxies requests from clients and caches the
25502 accessed URLs such that multiple requests for the same resource only
25503 creates one request to the back-end.
25504
25505 @defvr {Scheme Variable} varnish-service-type
25506 Service type for the Varnish daemon.
25507 @end defvr
25508
25509 @deftp {Data Type} varnish-configuration
25510 Data type representing the @code{varnish} service configuration.
25511 This type has the following parameters:
25512
25513 @table @asis
25514 @item @code{package} (default: @code{varnish})
25515 The Varnish package to use.
25516
25517 @item @code{name} (default: @code{"default"})
25518 A name for this Varnish instance. Varnish will create a directory in
25519 @file{/var/varnish/} with this name and keep temporary files there. If
25520 the name starts with a forward slash, it is interpreted as an absolute
25521 directory name.
25522
25523 Pass the @code{-n} argument to other Varnish programs to connect to the
25524 named instance, e.g.@: @command{varnishncsa -n default}.
25525
25526 @item @code{backend} (default: @code{"localhost:8080"})
25527 The backend to use. This option has no effect if @code{vcl} is set.
25528
25529 @item @code{vcl} (default: #f)
25530 The @dfn{VCL} (Varnish Configuration Language) program to run. If this
25531 is @code{#f}, Varnish will proxy @code{backend} using the default
25532 configuration. Otherwise this must be a file-like object with valid
25533 VCL syntax.
25534
25535 @c Varnish does not support HTTPS, so keep this URL to avoid confusion.
25536 For example, to mirror @url{https://www.gnu.org,www.gnu.org} with VCL you
25537 can do something along these lines:
25538
25539 @lisp
25540 (define %gnu-mirror
25541 (plain-file "gnu.vcl"
25542 "vcl 4.1;
25543 backend gnu @{ .host = \"www.gnu.org\"; @}"))
25544
25545 (operating-system
25546 ;; @dots{}
25547 (services (cons (service varnish-service-type
25548 (varnish-configuration
25549 (listen '(":80"))
25550 (vcl %gnu-mirror)))
25551 %base-services)))
25552 @end lisp
25553
25554 The configuration of an already running Varnish instance can be inspected
25555 and changed using the @command{varnishadm} program.
25556
25557 Consult the @url{https://varnish-cache.org/docs/,Varnish User Guide} and
25558 @url{https://book.varnish-software.com/4.0/,Varnish Book} for
25559 comprehensive documentation on Varnish and its configuration language.
25560
25561 @item @code{listen} (default: @code{'("localhost:80")})
25562 List of addresses Varnish will listen on.
25563
25564 @item @code{storage} (default: @code{'("malloc,128m")})
25565 List of storage backends that will be available in VCL.
25566
25567 @item @code{parameters} (default: @code{'()})
25568 List of run-time parameters in the form @code{'(("parameter" . "value"))}.
25569
25570 @item @code{extra-options} (default: @code{'()})
25571 Additional arguments to pass to the @command{varnishd} process.
25572
25573 @end table
25574 @end deftp
25575
25576 @subsubheading Patchwork
25577 @cindex Patchwork
25578 Patchwork is a patch tracking system. It can collect patches sent to a
25579 mailing list, and display them in a web interface.
25580
25581 @defvr {Scheme Variable} patchwork-service-type
25582 Service type for Patchwork.
25583 @end defvr
25584
25585 The following example is an example of a minimal service for Patchwork, for
25586 the @code{patchwork.example.com} domain.
25587
25588 @lisp
25589 (service patchwork-service-type
25590 (patchwork-configuration
25591 (domain "patchwork.example.com")
25592 (settings-module
25593 (patchwork-settings-module
25594 (allowed-hosts (list domain))
25595 (default-from-email "patchwork@@patchwork.example.com")))
25596 (getmail-retriever-config
25597 (getmail-retriever-configuration
25598 (type "SimpleIMAPSSLRetriever")
25599 (server "imap.example.com")
25600 (port 993)
25601 (username "patchwork")
25602 (password-command
25603 (list (file-append coreutils "/bin/cat")
25604 "/etc/getmail-patchwork-imap-password"))
25605 (extra-parameters
25606 '((mailboxes . ("Patches"))))))))
25607
25608 @end lisp
25609
25610 There are three records for configuring the Patchwork service. The
25611 @code{<patchwork-configuration>} relates to the configuration for Patchwork
25612 within the HTTPD service.
25613
25614 The @code{settings-module} field within the @code{<patchwork-configuration>}
25615 record can be populated with the @code{<patchwork-settings-module>} record,
25616 which describes a settings module that is generated within the Guix store.
25617
25618 For the @code{database-configuration} field within the
25619 @code{<patchwork-settings-module>}, the
25620 @code{<patchwork-database-configuration>} must be used.
25621
25622 @deftp {Data Type} patchwork-configuration
25623 Data type representing the Patchwork service configuration. This type has the
25624 following parameters:
25625
25626 @table @asis
25627 @item @code{patchwork} (default: @code{patchwork})
25628 The Patchwork package to use.
25629
25630 @item @code{domain}
25631 The domain to use for Patchwork, this is used in the HTTPD service virtual
25632 host.
25633
25634 @item @code{settings-module}
25635 The settings module to use for Patchwork. As a Django application, Patchwork
25636 is configured with a Python module containing the settings. This can either be
25637 an instance of the @code{<patchwork-settings-module>} record, any other record
25638 that represents the settings in the store, or a directory outside of the
25639 store.
25640
25641 @item @code{static-path} (default: @code{"/static/"})
25642 The path under which the HTTPD service should serve the static files.
25643
25644 @item @code{getmail-retriever-config}
25645 The getmail-retriever-configuration record value to use with
25646 Patchwork. Getmail will be configured with this value, the messages will be
25647 delivered to Patchwork.
25648
25649 @end table
25650 @end deftp
25651
25652 @deftp {Data Type} patchwork-settings-module
25653 Data type representing a settings module for Patchwork. Some of these
25654 settings relate directly to Patchwork, but others relate to Django, the web
25655 framework used by Patchwork, or the Django Rest Framework library. This type
25656 has the following parameters:
25657
25658 @table @asis
25659 @item @code{database-configuration} (default: @code{(patchwork-database-configuration)})
25660 The database connection settings used for Patchwork. See the
25661 @code{<patchwork-database-configuration>} record type for more information.
25662
25663 @item @code{secret-key-file} (default: @code{"/etc/patchwork/django-secret-key"})
25664 Patchwork, as a Django web application uses a secret key for cryptographically
25665 signing values. This file should contain a unique unpredictable value.
25666
25667 If this file does not exist, it will be created and populated with a random
25668 value by the patchwork-setup shepherd service.
25669
25670 This setting relates to Django.
25671
25672 @item @code{allowed-hosts}
25673 A list of valid hosts for this Patchwork service. This should at least include
25674 the domain specified in the @code{<patchwork-configuration>} record.
25675
25676 This is a Django setting.
25677
25678 @item @code{default-from-email}
25679 The email address from which Patchwork should send email by default.
25680
25681 This is a Patchwork setting.
25682
25683 @item @code{static-url} (default: @code{#f})
25684 The URL to use when serving static assets. It can be part of a URL, or a full
25685 URL, but must end in a @code{/}.
25686
25687 If the default value is used, the @code{static-path} value from the
25688 @code{<patchwork-configuration>} record will be used.
25689
25690 This is a Django setting.
25691
25692 @item @code{admins} (default: @code{'()})
25693 Email addresses to send the details of errors that occur. Each value should
25694 be a list containing two elements, the name and then the email address.
25695
25696 This is a Django setting.
25697
25698 @item @code{debug?} (default: @code{#f})
25699 Whether to run Patchwork in debug mode. If set to @code{#t}, detailed error
25700 messages will be shown.
25701
25702 This is a Django setting.
25703
25704 @item @code{enable-rest-api?} (default: @code{#t})
25705 Whether to enable the Patchwork REST API.
25706
25707 This is a Patchwork setting.
25708
25709 @item @code{enable-xmlrpc?} (default: @code{#t})
25710 Whether to enable the XML RPC API.
25711
25712 This is a Patchwork setting.
25713
25714 @item @code{force-https-links?} (default: @code{#t})
25715 Whether to use HTTPS links on Patchwork pages.
25716
25717 This is a Patchwork setting.
25718
25719 @item @code{extra-settings} (default: @code{""})
25720 Extra code to place at the end of the Patchwork settings module.
25721
25722 @end table
25723 @end deftp
25724
25725 @deftp {Data Type} patchwork-database-configuration
25726 Data type representing the database configuration for Patchwork.
25727
25728 @table @asis
25729 @item @code{engine} (default: @code{"django.db.backends.postgresql_psycopg2"})
25730 The database engine to use.
25731
25732 @item @code{name} (default: @code{"patchwork"})
25733 The name of the database to use.
25734
25735 @item @code{user} (default: @code{"httpd"})
25736 The user to connect to the database as.
25737
25738 @item @code{password} (default: @code{""})
25739 The password to use when connecting to the database.
25740
25741 @item @code{host} (default: @code{""})
25742 The host to make the database connection to.
25743
25744 @item @code{port} (default: @code{""})
25745 The port on which to connect to the database.
25746
25747 @end table
25748 @end deftp
25749
25750 @subsubheading Mumi
25751
25752 @cindex Mumi, Debbugs Web interface
25753 @cindex Debbugs, Mumi Web interface
25754 @uref{https://git.elephly.net/gitweb.cgi?p=software/mumi.git, Mumi} is a
25755 Web interface to the Debbugs bug tracker, by default for
25756 @uref{https://bugs.gnu.org, the GNU instance}. Mumi is a Web server,
25757 but it also fetches and indexes mail retrieved from Debbugs.
25758
25759 @defvr {Scheme Variable} mumi-service-type
25760 This is the service type for Mumi.
25761 @end defvr
25762
25763 @deftp {Data Type} mumi-configuration
25764 Data type representing the Mumi service configuration. This type has the
25765 following fields:
25766
25767 @table @asis
25768 @item @code{mumi} (default: @code{mumi})
25769 The Mumi package to use.
25770
25771 @item @code{mailer?} (default: @code{#true})
25772 Whether to enable or disable the mailer component.
25773
25774 @item @code{mumi-configuration-sender}
25775 The email address used as the sender for comments.
25776
25777 @item @code{mumi-configuration-smtp}
25778 A URI to configure the SMTP settings for Mailutils. This could be
25779 something like @code{sendmail:///path/to/bin/msmtp} or any other URI
25780 supported by Mailutils. @xref{SMTP Mailboxes, SMTP Mailboxes,,
25781 mailutils, GNU@tie{}Mailutils}.
25782
25783 @end table
25784 @end deftp
25785
25786
25787 @subsubheading FastCGI
25788 @cindex fastcgi
25789 @cindex fcgiwrap
25790 FastCGI is an interface between the front-end and the back-end of a web
25791 service. It is a somewhat legacy facility; new web services should
25792 generally just talk HTTP between the front-end and the back-end.
25793 However there are a number of back-end services such as PHP or the
25794 optimized HTTP Git repository access that use FastCGI, so we have
25795 support for it in Guix.
25796
25797 To use FastCGI, you configure the front-end web server (e.g., nginx) to
25798 dispatch some subset of its requests to the fastcgi backend, which
25799 listens on a local TCP or UNIX socket. There is an intermediary
25800 @code{fcgiwrap} program that sits between the actual backend process and
25801 the web server. The front-end indicates which backend program to run,
25802 passing that information to the @code{fcgiwrap} process.
25803
25804 @defvr {Scheme Variable} fcgiwrap-service-type
25805 A service type for the @code{fcgiwrap} FastCGI proxy.
25806 @end defvr
25807
25808 @deftp {Data Type} fcgiwrap-configuration
25809 Data type representing the configuration of the @code{fcgiwrap} service.
25810 This type has the following parameters:
25811 @table @asis
25812 @item @code{package} (default: @code{fcgiwrap})
25813 The fcgiwrap package to use.
25814
25815 @item @code{socket} (default: @code{tcp:127.0.0.1:9000})
25816 The socket on which the @code{fcgiwrap} process should listen, as a
25817 string. Valid @var{socket} values include
25818 @code{unix:@var{/path/to/unix/socket}},
25819 @code{tcp:@var{dot.ted.qu.ad}:@var{port}} and
25820 @code{tcp6:[@var{ipv6_addr}]:port}.
25821
25822 @item @code{user} (default: @code{fcgiwrap})
25823 @itemx @code{group} (default: @code{fcgiwrap})
25824 The user and group names, as strings, under which to run the
25825 @code{fcgiwrap} process. The @code{fastcgi} service will ensure that if
25826 the user asks for the specific user or group names @code{fcgiwrap} that
25827 the corresponding user and/or group is present on the system.
25828
25829 It is possible to configure a FastCGI-backed web service to pass HTTP
25830 authentication information from the front-end to the back-end, and to
25831 allow @code{fcgiwrap} to run the back-end process as a corresponding
25832 local user. To enable this capability on the back-end, run
25833 @code{fcgiwrap} as the @code{root} user and group. Note that this
25834 capability also has to be configured on the front-end as well.
25835 @end table
25836 @end deftp
25837
25838 @cindex php-fpm
25839 PHP-FPM (FastCGI Process Manager) is an alternative PHP FastCGI implementation
25840 with some additional features useful for sites of any size.
25841
25842 These features include:
25843 @itemize @bullet
25844 @item Adaptive process spawning
25845 @item Basic statistics (similar to Apache's mod_status)
25846 @item Advanced process management with graceful stop/start
25847 @item Ability to start workers with different uid/gid/chroot/environment
25848 and different php.ini (replaces safe_mode)
25849 @item Stdout & stderr logging
25850 @item Emergency restart in case of accidental opcode cache destruction
25851 @item Accelerated upload support
25852 @item Support for a "slowlog"
25853 @item Enhancements to FastCGI, such as fastcgi_finish_request() -
25854 a special function to finish request & flush all data while continuing to do
25855 something time-consuming (video converting, stats processing, etc.)
25856 @end itemize
25857 ...@: and much more.
25858
25859 @defvr {Scheme Variable} php-fpm-service-type
25860 A Service type for @code{php-fpm}.
25861 @end defvr
25862
25863 @deftp {Data Type} php-fpm-configuration
25864 Data Type for php-fpm service configuration.
25865 @table @asis
25866 @item @code{php} (default: @code{php})
25867 The php package to use.
25868 @item @code{socket} (default: @code{(string-append "/var/run/php" (version-major (package-version php)) "-fpm.sock")})
25869 The address on which to accept FastCGI requests. Valid syntaxes are:
25870 @table @asis
25871 @item @code{"ip.add.re.ss:port"}
25872 Listen on a TCP socket to a specific address on a specific port.
25873 @item @code{"port"}
25874 Listen on a TCP socket to all addresses on a specific port.
25875 @item @code{"/path/to/unix/socket"}
25876 Listen on a unix socket.
25877 @end table
25878
25879 @item @code{user} (default: @code{php-fpm})
25880 User who will own the php worker processes.
25881 @item @code{group} (default: @code{php-fpm})
25882 Group of the worker processes.
25883 @item @code{socket-user} (default: @code{php-fpm})
25884 User who can speak to the php-fpm socket.
25885 @item @code{socket-group} (default: @code{nginx})
25886 Group that can speak to the php-fpm socket.
25887 @item @code{pid-file} (default: @code{(string-append "/var/run/php" (version-major (package-version php)) "-fpm.pid")})
25888 The process id of the php-fpm process is written to this file
25889 once the service has started.
25890 @item @code{log-file} (default: @code{(string-append "/var/log/php" (version-major (package-version php)) "-fpm.log")})
25891 Log for the php-fpm master process.
25892 @item @code{process-manager} (default: @code{(php-fpm-dynamic-process-manager-configuration)})
25893 Detailed settings for the php-fpm process manager.
25894 Must be one of:
25895 @table @asis
25896 @item @code{<php-fpm-dynamic-process-manager-configuration>}
25897 @item @code{<php-fpm-static-process-manager-configuration>}
25898 @item @code{<php-fpm-on-demand-process-manager-configuration>}
25899 @end table
25900 @item @code{display-errors} (default @code{#f})
25901 Determines whether php errors and warning should be sent to clients
25902 and displayed in their browsers.
25903 This is useful for local php development, but a security risk for public sites,
25904 as error messages can reveal passwords and personal data.
25905 @item @code{timezone} (default @code{#f})
25906 Specifies @code{php_admin_value[date.timezone]} parameter.
25907 @item @code{workers-logfile} (default @code{(string-append "/var/log/php" (version-major (package-version php)) "-fpm.www.log")})
25908 This file will log the @code{stderr} outputs of php worker processes.
25909 Can be set to @code{#f} to disable logging.
25910 @item @code{file} (default @code{#f})
25911 An optional override of the whole configuration.
25912 You can use the @code{mixed-text-file} function or an absolute filepath for it.
25913 @item @code{php-ini-file} (default @code{#f})
25914 An optional override of the default php settings.
25915 It may be any ``file-like'' object (@pxref{G-Expressions, file-like objects}).
25916 You can use the @code{mixed-text-file} function or an absolute filepath for it.
25917
25918 For local development it is useful to set a higher timeout and memory
25919 limit for spawned php processes. This be accomplished with the
25920 following operating system configuration snippet:
25921 @lisp
25922 (define %local-php-ini
25923 (plain-file "php.ini"
25924 "memory_limit = 2G
25925 max_execution_time = 1800"))
25926
25927 (operating-system
25928 ;; @dots{}
25929 (services (cons (service php-fpm-service-type
25930 (php-fpm-configuration
25931 (php-ini-file %local-php-ini)))
25932 %base-services)))
25933 @end lisp
25934
25935 Consult the @url{https://www.php.net/manual/en/ini.core.php,core php.ini
25936 directives} for comprehensive documentation on the acceptable
25937 @file{php.ini} directives.
25938 @end table
25939 @end deftp
25940
25941 @deftp {Data type} php-fpm-dynamic-process-manager-configuration
25942 Data Type for the @code{dynamic} php-fpm process manager. With the
25943 @code{dynamic} process manager, spare worker processes are kept around
25944 based on its configured limits.
25945 @table @asis
25946 @item @code{max-children} (default: @code{5})
25947 Maximum of worker processes.
25948 @item @code{start-servers} (default: @code{2})
25949 How many worker processes should be started on start-up.
25950 @item @code{min-spare-servers} (default: @code{1})
25951 How many spare worker processes should be kept around at minimum.
25952 @item @code{max-spare-servers} (default: @code{3})
25953 How many spare worker processes should be kept around at maximum.
25954 @end table
25955 @end deftp
25956
25957 @deftp {Data type} php-fpm-static-process-manager-configuration
25958 Data Type for the @code{static} php-fpm process manager. With the
25959 @code{static} process manager, an unchanging number of worker processes
25960 are created.
25961 @table @asis
25962 @item @code{max-children} (default: @code{5})
25963 Maximum of worker processes.
25964 @end table
25965 @end deftp
25966
25967 @deftp {Data type} php-fpm-on-demand-process-manager-configuration
25968 Data Type for the @code{on-demand} php-fpm process manager. With the
25969 @code{on-demand} process manager, worker processes are only created as
25970 requests arrive.
25971 @table @asis
25972 @item @code{max-children} (default: @code{5})
25973 Maximum of worker processes.
25974 @item @code{process-idle-timeout} (default: @code{10})
25975 The time in seconds after which a process with no requests is killed.
25976 @end table
25977 @end deftp
25978
25979
25980 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} nginx-php-location @
25981 [#:nginx-package nginx] @
25982 [socket (string-append "/var/run/php" @
25983 (version-major (package-version php)) @
25984 "-fpm.sock")]
25985 A helper function to quickly add php to an @code{nginx-server-configuration}.
25986 @end deffn
25987
25988 A simple services setup for nginx with php can look like this:
25989 @lisp
25990 (services (cons* (service dhcp-client-service-type)
25991 (service php-fpm-service-type)
25992 (service nginx-service-type
25993 (nginx-server-configuration
25994 (server-name '("example.com"))
25995 (root "/srv/http/")
25996 (locations
25997 (list (nginx-php-location)))
25998 (listen '("80"))
25999 (ssl-certificate #f)
26000 (ssl-certificate-key #f)))
26001 %base-services))
26002 @end lisp
26003
26004 @cindex cat-avatar-generator
26005 The cat avatar generator is a simple service to demonstrate the use of php-fpm
26006 in @code{Nginx}. It is used to generate cat avatar from a seed, for instance
26007 the hash of a user's email address.
26008
26009 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} cat-avatar-generator-service @
26010 [#:cache-dir "/var/cache/cat-avatar-generator"] @
26011 [#:package cat-avatar-generator] @
26012 [#:configuration (nginx-server-configuration)]
26013 Returns an nginx-server-configuration that inherits @code{configuration}. It
26014 extends the nginx configuration to add a server block that serves @code{package},
26015 a version of cat-avatar-generator. During execution, cat-avatar-generator will
26016 be able to use @code{cache-dir} as its cache directory.
26017 @end deffn
26018
26019 A simple setup for cat-avatar-generator can look like this:
26020 @lisp
26021 (services (cons* (cat-avatar-generator-service
26022 #:configuration
26023 (nginx-server-configuration
26024 (server-name '("example.com"))))
26025 ...
26026 %base-services))
26027 @end lisp
26028
26029 @subsubheading Hpcguix-web
26030
26031 @cindex hpcguix-web
26032 The @uref{https://github.com/UMCUGenetics/hpcguix-web/, hpcguix-web}
26033 program is a customizable web interface to browse Guix packages,
26034 initially designed for users of high-performance computing (HPC)
26035 clusters.
26036
26037 @defvr {Scheme Variable} hpcguix-web-service-type
26038 The service type for @code{hpcguix-web}.
26039 @end defvr
26040
26041 @deftp {Data Type} hpcguix-web-configuration
26042 Data type for the hpcguix-web service configuration.
26043
26044 @table @asis
26045 @item @code{specs}
26046 A gexp (@pxref{G-Expressions}) specifying the hpcguix-web service
26047 configuration. The main items available in this spec are:
26048
26049 @table @asis
26050 @item @code{title-prefix} (default: @code{"hpcguix | "})
26051 The page title prefix.
26052
26053 @item @code{guix-command} (default: @code{"guix"})
26054 The @command{guix} command.
26055
26056 @item @code{package-filter-proc} (default: @code{(const #t)})
26057 A procedure specifying how to filter packages that are displayed.
26058
26059 @item @code{package-page-extension-proc} (default: @code{(const '())})
26060 Extension package for @code{hpcguix-web}.
26061
26062 @item @code{menu} (default: @code{'()})
26063 Additional entry in page @code{menu}.
26064
26065 @item @code{channels} (default: @code{%default-channels})
26066 List of channels from which the package list is built (@pxref{Channels}).
26067
26068 @item @code{package-list-expiration} (default: @code{(* 12 3600)})
26069 The expiration time, in seconds, after which the package list is rebuilt from
26070 the latest instances of the given channels.
26071 @end table
26072
26073 See the hpcguix-web repository for a
26074 @uref{https://github.com/UMCUGenetics/hpcguix-web/blob/master/hpcweb-configuration.scm,
26075 complete example}.
26076
26077 @item @code{package} (default: @code{hpcguix-web})
26078 The hpcguix-web package to use.
26079 @end table
26080 @end deftp
26081
26082 A typical hpcguix-web service declaration looks like this:
26083
26084 @lisp
26085 (service hpcguix-web-service-type
26086 (hpcguix-web-configuration
26087 (specs
26088 #~(define site-config
26089 (hpcweb-configuration
26090 (title-prefix "Guix-HPC - ")
26091 (menu '(("/about" "ABOUT"))))))))
26092 @end lisp
26093
26094 @quotation Note
26095 The hpcguix-web service periodically updates the package list it publishes by
26096 pulling channels from Git. To that end, it needs to access X.509 certificates
26097 so that it can authenticate Git servers when communicating over HTTPS, and it
26098 assumes that @file{/etc/ssl/certs} contains those certificates.
26099
26100 Thus, make sure to add @code{nss-certs} or another certificate package to the
26101 @code{packages} field of your configuration. @ref{X.509 Certificates}, for
26102 more information on X.509 certificates.
26103 @end quotation
26104
26105 @subsubheading gmnisrv
26106
26107 @cindex gmnisrv
26108 The @uref{https://git.sr.ht/~sircmpwn/gmnisrv, gmnisrv} program is a
26109 simple @uref{https://gemini.circumlunar.space/, Gemini} protocol server.
26110
26111 @deffn {Scheme Variable} gmnisrv-service-type
26112 This is the type of the gmnisrv service, whose value should be a
26113 @code{gmnisrv-configuration} object, as in this example:
26114
26115 @lisp
26116 (service gmnisrv-service-type
26117 (gmnisrv-configuration
26118 (config-file (local-file "./my-gmnisrv.ini"))))
26119 @end lisp
26120 @end deffn
26121
26122 @deftp {Data Type} gmnisrv-configuration
26123 Data type representing the configuration of gmnisrv.
26124
26125 @table @asis
26126 @item @code{package} (default: @var{gmnisrv})
26127 Package object of the gmnisrv server.
26128
26129 @item @code{config-file} (default: @code{%default-gmnisrv-config-file})
26130 File-like object of the gmnisrv configuration file to use. The default
26131 configuration listens on port 1965 and serves files from
26132 @file{/srv/gemini}. Certificates are stored in
26133 @file{/var/lib/gemini/certs}. For more information, run @command{man
26134 gmnisrv} and @command{man gmnisrv.ini}.
26135
26136 @end table
26137 @end deftp
26138
26139 @subsubheading Agate
26140
26141 @cindex agate
26142 The @uref{gemini://qwertqwefsday.eu/agate.gmi, Agate}
26143 (@uref{https://github.com/mbrubeck/agate, GitHub page over HTTPS})
26144 program is a simple @uref{https://gemini.circumlunar.space/, Gemini}
26145 protocol server written in Rust.
26146
26147 @deffn {Scheme Variable} agate-service-type
26148 This is the type of the agate service, whose value should be an
26149 @code{agate-service-type} object, as in this example:
26150
26151 @lisp
26152 (service agate-service-type
26153 (agate-configuration
26154 (content "/srv/gemini")
26155 (cert "/srv/cert.pem")
26156 (key "/srv/key.rsa")))
26157 @end lisp
26158
26159 The example above represents the minimal tweaking necessary to get Agate
26160 up and running. Specifying the path to the certificate and key is
26161 always necessary, as the Gemini protocol requires TLS by default.
26162
26163 To obtain a certificate and a key, you could, for example, use OpenSSL,
26164 running a command similar to the following example:
26165
26166 @example
26167 openssl req -x509 -newkey rsa:4096 -keyout key.rsa -out cert.pem \
26168 -days 3650 -nodes -subj "/CN=example.com"
26169 @end example
26170
26171 Of course, you'll have to replace @i{example.com} with your own domain
26172 name, and then point the Agate configuration towards the path of the
26173 generated key and certificate.
26174
26175 @end deffn
26176
26177 @deftp {Data Type} agate-configuration
26178 Data type representing the configuration of Agate.
26179
26180 @table @asis
26181 @item @code{package} (default: @code{agate})
26182 The package object of the Agate server.
26183
26184 @item @code{content} (default: @file{"/srv/gemini"})
26185 The directory from which Agate will serve files.
26186
26187 @item @code{cert} (default: @code{#f})
26188 The path to the TLS certificate PEM file to be used for encrypted
26189 connections. Must be filled in with a value from the user.
26190
26191 @item @code{key} (default: @code{#f})
26192 The path to the PKCS8 private key file to be used for encrypted
26193 connections. Must be filled in with a value from the user.
26194
26195 @item @code{addr} (default: @code{'("0.0.0.0:1965" "[::]:1965")})
26196 A list of the addresses to listen on.
26197
26198 @item @code{hostname} (default: @code{#f})
26199 The domain name of this Gemini server. Optional.
26200
26201 @item @code{lang} (default: @code{#f})
26202 RFC 4646 language code(s) for text/gemini documents. Optional.
26203
26204 @item @code{silent?} (default: @code{#f})
26205 Set to @code{#t} to disable logging output.
26206
26207 @item @code{serve-secret?} (default: @code{#f})
26208 Set to @code{#t} to serve secret files (files/directories starting with
26209 a dot).
26210
26211 @item @code{log-ip?} (default: @code{#t})
26212 Whether or not to output IP addresses when logging.
26213
26214 @item @code{user} (default: @code{"agate"})
26215 Owner of the @code{agate} process.
26216
26217 @item @code{group} (default: @code{"agate"})
26218 Owner's group of the @code{agate} process.
26219
26220 @item @code{log-file} (default: @file{"/var/log/agate.log"})
26221 The file which should store the logging output of Agate.
26222
26223 @end table
26224 @end deftp
26225
26226 @node Certificate Services
26227 @subsection Certificate Services
26228
26229 @cindex Web
26230 @cindex HTTP, HTTPS
26231 @cindex Let's Encrypt
26232 @cindex TLS certificates
26233 The @code{(gnu services certbot)} module provides a service to
26234 automatically obtain a valid TLS certificate from the Let's Encrypt
26235 certificate authority. These certificates can then be used to serve
26236 content securely over HTTPS or other TLS-based protocols, with the
26237 knowledge that the client will be able to verify the server's
26238 authenticity.
26239
26240 @url{https://letsencrypt.org/, Let's Encrypt} provides the
26241 @code{certbot} tool to automate the certification process. This tool
26242 first securely generates a key on the server. It then makes a request
26243 to the Let's Encrypt certificate authority (CA) to sign the key. The CA
26244 checks that the request originates from the host in question by using a
26245 challenge-response protocol, requiring the server to provide its
26246 response over HTTP@. If that protocol completes successfully, the CA
26247 signs the key, resulting in a certificate. That certificate is valid
26248 for a limited period of time, and therefore to continue to provide TLS
26249 services, the server needs to periodically ask the CA to renew its
26250 signature.
26251
26252 The certbot service automates this process: the initial key
26253 generation, the initial certification request to the Let's Encrypt
26254 service, the web server challenge/response integration, writing the
26255 certificate to disk, the automated periodic renewals, and the deployment
26256 tasks associated with the renewal (e.g.@: reloading services, copying keys
26257 with different permissions).
26258
26259 Certbot is run twice a day, at a random minute within the hour. It
26260 won't do anything until your certificates are due for renewal or
26261 revoked, but running it regularly would give your service a chance of
26262 staying online in case a Let's Encrypt-initiated revocation happened for
26263 some reason.
26264
26265 By using this service, you agree to the ACME Subscriber Agreement, which
26266 can be found there:
26267 @url{https://acme-v01.api.letsencrypt.org/directory}.
26268
26269 @defvr {Scheme Variable} certbot-service-type
26270 A service type for the @code{certbot} Let's Encrypt client. Its value
26271 must be a @code{certbot-configuration} record as in this example:
26272
26273 @lisp
26274 (define %nginx-deploy-hook
26275 (program-file
26276 "nginx-deploy-hook"
26277 #~(let ((pid (call-with-input-file "/var/run/nginx/pid" read)))
26278 (kill pid SIGHUP))))
26279
26280 (service certbot-service-type
26281 (certbot-configuration
26282 (email "foo@@example.net")
26283 (certificates
26284 (list
26285 (certificate-configuration
26286 (domains '("example.net" "www.example.net"))
26287 (deploy-hook %nginx-deploy-hook))
26288 (certificate-configuration
26289 (domains '("bar.example.net")))))))
26290 @end lisp
26291
26292 See below for details about @code{certbot-configuration}.
26293 @end defvr
26294
26295 @deftp {Data Type} certbot-configuration
26296 Data type representing the configuration of the @code{certbot} service.
26297 This type has the following parameters:
26298
26299 @table @asis
26300 @item @code{package} (default: @code{certbot})
26301 The certbot package to use.
26302
26303 @item @code{webroot} (default: @code{/var/www})
26304 The directory from which to serve the Let's Encrypt challenge/response
26305 files.
26306
26307 @item @code{certificates} (default: @code{()})
26308 A list of @code{certificates-configuration}s for which to generate
26309 certificates and request signatures. Each certificate has a @code{name}
26310 and several @code{domains}.
26311
26312 @item @code{email} (default: @code{#f})
26313 Optional email address used for registration and recovery contact.
26314 Setting this is encouraged as it allows you to receive important
26315 notifications about the account and issued certificates.
26316
26317 @item @code{server} (default: @code{#f})
26318 Optional URL of ACME server. Setting this overrides certbot's default,
26319 which is the Let's Encrypt server.
26320
26321 @item @code{rsa-key-size} (default: @code{2048})
26322 Size of the RSA key.
26323
26324 @item @code{default-location} (default: @i{see below})
26325 The default @code{nginx-location-configuration}. Because @code{certbot}
26326 needs to be able to serve challenges and responses, it needs to be able
26327 to run a web server. It does so by extending the @code{nginx} web
26328 service with an @code{nginx-server-configuration} listening on the
26329 @var{domains} on port 80, and which has a
26330 @code{nginx-location-configuration} for the @code{/.well-known/} URI
26331 path subspace used by Let's Encrypt. @xref{Web Services}, for more on
26332 these nginx configuration data types.
26333
26334 Requests to other URL paths will be matched by the
26335 @code{default-location}, which if present is added to all
26336 @code{nginx-server-configuration}s.
26337
26338 By default, the @code{default-location} will issue a redirect from
26339 @code{http://@var{domain}/...} to @code{https://@var{domain}/...}, leaving
26340 you to define what to serve on your site via @code{https}.
26341
26342 Pass @code{#f} to not issue a default location.
26343 @end table
26344 @end deftp
26345
26346 @deftp {Data Type} certificate-configuration
26347 Data type representing the configuration of a certificate.
26348 This type has the following parameters:
26349
26350 @table @asis
26351 @item @code{name} (default: @i{see below})
26352 This name is used by Certbot for housekeeping and in file paths; it
26353 doesn't affect the content of the certificate itself. To see
26354 certificate names, run @code{certbot certificates}.
26355
26356 Its default is the first provided domain.
26357
26358 @item @code{domains} (default: @code{()})
26359 The first domain provided will be the subject CN of the certificate, and
26360 all domains will be Subject Alternative Names on the certificate.
26361
26362 @item @code{challenge} (default: @code{#f})
26363 The challenge type that has to be run by certbot. If @code{#f} is specified,
26364 default to the HTTP challenge. If a value is specified, defaults to the
26365 manual plugin (see @code{authentication-hook}, @code{cleanup-hook} and
26366 the documentation at @url{https://certbot.eff.org/docs/using.html#hooks}),
26367 and gives Let's Encrypt permission to log the public IP address of the
26368 requesting machine.
26369
26370 @item @code{csr} (default: @code{#f})
26371 File name of Certificate Signing Request (CSR) in DER or PEM format.
26372 If @code{#f} is specified, this argument will not be passed to certbot.
26373 If a value is specified, certbot will use it to obtain a certificate, instead of
26374 using a self-generated CSR.
26375 The domain-name(s) mentioned in @code{domains}, must be consistent with the
26376 domain-name(s) mentioned in CSR file.
26377
26378 @item @code{authentication-hook} (default: @code{#f})
26379 Command to be run in a shell once for each certificate challenge to be
26380 answered. For this command, the shell variable @code{$CERTBOT_DOMAIN}
26381 will contain the domain being authenticated, @code{$CERTBOT_VALIDATION}
26382 contains the validation string and @code{$CERTBOT_TOKEN} contains the
26383 file name of the resource requested when performing an HTTP-01 challenge.
26384
26385 @item @code{cleanup-hook} (default: @code{#f})
26386 Command to be run in a shell once for each certificate challenge that
26387 have been answered by the @code{auth-hook}. For this command, the shell
26388 variables available in the @code{auth-hook} script are still available, and
26389 additionally @code{$CERTBOT_AUTH_OUTPUT} will contain the standard output
26390 of the @code{auth-hook} script.
26391
26392 @item @code{deploy-hook} (default: @code{#f})
26393 Command to be run in a shell once for each successfully issued
26394 certificate. For this command, the shell variable
26395 @code{$RENEWED_LINEAGE} will point to the config live subdirectory (for
26396 example, @samp{"/etc/letsencrypt/live/example.com"}) containing the new
26397 certificates and keys; the shell variable @code{$RENEWED_DOMAINS} will
26398 contain a space-delimited list of renewed certificate domains (for
26399 example, @samp{"example.com www.example.com"}.
26400
26401 @end table
26402 @end deftp
26403
26404 For each @code{certificate-configuration}, the certificate is saved to
26405 @code{/etc/letsencrypt/live/@var{name}/fullchain.pem} and the key is
26406 saved to @code{/etc/letsencrypt/live/@var{name}/privkey.pem}.
26407 @node DNS Services
26408 @subsection DNS Services
26409 @cindex DNS (domain name system)
26410 @cindex domain name system (DNS)
26411
26412 The @code{(gnu services dns)} module provides services related to the
26413 @dfn{domain name system} (DNS). It provides a server service for hosting
26414 an @emph{authoritative} DNS server for multiple zones, slave or master.
26415 This service uses @uref{https://www.knot-dns.cz/, Knot DNS}. And also a
26416 caching and forwarding DNS server for the LAN, which uses
26417 @uref{http://www.thekelleys.org.uk/dnsmasq/doc.html, dnsmasq}.
26418
26419 @subsubheading Knot Service
26420
26421 An example configuration of an authoritative server for two zones, one master
26422 and one slave, is:
26423
26424 @lisp
26425 (define-zone-entries example.org.zone
26426 ;; Name TTL Class Type Data
26427 ("@@" "" "IN" "A" "127.0.0.1")
26428 ("@@" "" "IN" "NS" "ns")
26429 ("ns" "" "IN" "A" "127.0.0.1"))
26430
26431 (define master-zone
26432 (knot-zone-configuration
26433 (domain "example.org")
26434 (zone (zone-file
26435 (origin "example.org")
26436 (entries example.org.zone)))))
26437
26438 (define slave-zone
26439 (knot-zone-configuration
26440 (domain "plop.org")
26441 (dnssec-policy "default")
26442 (master (list "plop-master"))))
26443
26444 (define plop-master
26445 (knot-remote-configuration
26446 (id "plop-master")
26447 (address (list "208.76.58.171"))))
26448
26449 (operating-system
26450 ;; ...
26451 (services (cons* (service knot-service-type
26452 (knot-configuration
26453 (remotes (list plop-master))
26454 (zones (list master-zone slave-zone))))
26455 ;; ...
26456 %base-services)))
26457 @end lisp
26458
26459 @deffn {Scheme Variable} knot-service-type
26460 This is the type for the Knot DNS server.
26461
26462 Knot DNS is an authoritative DNS server, meaning that it can serve multiple
26463 zones, that is to say domain names you would buy from a registrar. This server
26464 is not a resolver, meaning that it can only resolve names for which it is
26465 authoritative. This server can be configured to serve zones as a master server
26466 or a slave server as a per-zone basis. Slave zones will get their data from
26467 masters, and will serve it as an authoritative server. From the point of view
26468 of a resolver, there is no difference between master and slave.
26469
26470 The following data types are used to configure the Knot DNS server:
26471 @end deffn
26472
26473 @deftp {Data Type} knot-key-configuration
26474 Data type representing a key.
26475 This type has the following parameters:
26476
26477 @table @asis
26478 @item @code{id} (default: @code{""})
26479 An identifier for other configuration fields to refer to this key. IDs must
26480 be unique and must not be empty.
26481
26482 @item @code{algorithm} (default: @code{#f})
26483 The algorithm to use. Choose between @code{#f}, @code{'hmac-md5},
26484 @code{'hmac-sha1}, @code{'hmac-sha224}, @code{'hmac-sha256}, @code{'hmac-sha384}
26485 and @code{'hmac-sha512}.
26486
26487 @item @code{secret} (default: @code{""})
26488 The secret key itself.
26489
26490 @end table
26491 @end deftp
26492
26493 @deftp {Data Type} knot-acl-configuration
26494 Data type representing an Access Control List (ACL) configuration.
26495 This type has the following parameters:
26496
26497 @table @asis
26498 @item @code{id} (default: @code{""})
26499 An identifier for other configuration fields to refer to this key. IDs must be
26500 unique and must not be empty.
26501
26502 @item @code{address} (default: @code{'()})
26503 An ordered list of IP addresses, network subnets, or network ranges represented
26504 with strings. The query must match one of them. Empty value means that
26505 address match is not required.
26506
26507 @item @code{key} (default: @code{'()})
26508 An ordered list of references to keys represented with strings. The string
26509 must match a key ID defined in a @code{knot-key-configuration}. No key means
26510 that a key is not require to match that ACL.
26511
26512 @item @code{action} (default: @code{'()})
26513 An ordered list of actions that are permitted or forbidden by this ACL@. Possible
26514 values are lists of zero or more elements from @code{'transfer}, @code{'notify}
26515 and @code{'update}.
26516
26517 @item @code{deny?} (default: @code{#f})
26518 When true, the ACL defines restrictions. Listed actions are forbidden. When
26519 false, listed actions are allowed.
26520
26521 @end table
26522 @end deftp
26523
26524 @deftp {Data Type} zone-entry
26525 Data type representing a record entry in a zone file.
26526 This type has the following parameters:
26527
26528 @table @asis
26529 @item @code{name} (default: @code{"@@"})
26530 The name of the record. @code{"@@"} refers to the origin of the zone. Names
26531 are relative to the origin of the zone. For example, in the @code{example.org}
26532 zone, @code{"ns.example.org"} actually refers to @code{ns.example.org.example.org}.
26533 Names ending with a dot are absolute, which means that @code{"ns.example.org."}
26534 refers to @code{ns.example.org}.
26535
26536 @item @code{ttl} (default: @code{""})
26537 The Time-To-Live (TTL) of this record. If not set, the default TTL is used.
26538
26539 @item @code{class} (default: @code{"IN"})
26540 The class of the record. Knot currently supports only @code{"IN"} and
26541 partially @code{"CH"}.
26542
26543 @item @code{type} (default: @code{"A"})
26544 The type of the record. Common types include A (IPv4 address), AAAA (IPv6
26545 address), NS (Name Server) and MX (Mail eXchange). Many other types are
26546 defined.
26547
26548 @item @code{data} (default: @code{""})
26549 The data contained in the record. For instance an IP address associated with
26550 an A record, or a domain name associated with an NS record. Remember that
26551 domain names are relative to the origin unless they end with a dot.
26552
26553 @end table
26554 @end deftp
26555
26556 @deftp {Data Type} zone-file
26557 Data type representing the content of a zone file.
26558 This type has the following parameters:
26559
26560 @table @asis
26561 @item @code{entries} (default: @code{'()})
26562 The list of entries. The SOA record is taken care of, so you don't need to
26563 put it in the list of entries. This list should probably contain an entry
26564 for your primary authoritative DNS server. Other than using a list of entries
26565 directly, you can use @code{define-zone-entries} to define a object containing
26566 the list of entries more easily, that you can later pass to the @code{entries}
26567 field of the @code{zone-file}.
26568
26569 @item @code{origin} (default: @code{""})
26570 The name of your zone. This parameter cannot be empty.
26571
26572 @item @code{ns} (default: @code{"ns"})
26573 The domain of your primary authoritative DNS server. The name is relative to
26574 the origin, unless it ends with a dot. It is mandatory that this primary
26575 DNS server corresponds to an NS record in the zone and that it is associated
26576 to an IP address in the list of entries.
26577
26578 @item @code{mail} (default: @code{"hostmaster"})
26579 An email address people can contact you at, as the owner of the zone. This
26580 is translated as @code{<mail>@@<origin>}.
26581
26582 @item @code{serial} (default: @code{1})
26583 The serial number of the zone. As this is used to keep track of changes by
26584 both slaves and resolvers, it is mandatory that it @emph{never} decreases.
26585 Always increment it when you make a change in your zone.
26586
26587 @item @code{refresh} (default: @code{(* 2 24 3600)})
26588 The frequency at which slaves will do a zone transfer. This value is a number
26589 of seconds. It can be computed by multiplications or with
26590 @code{(string->duration)}.
26591
26592 @item @code{retry} (default: @code{(* 15 60)})
26593 The period after which a slave will retry to contact its master when it fails
26594 to do so a first time.
26595
26596 @item @code{expiry} (default: @code{(* 14 24 3600)})
26597 Default TTL of records. Existing records are considered correct for at most
26598 this amount of time. After this period, resolvers will invalidate their cache
26599 and check again that it still exists.
26600
26601 @item @code{nx} (default: @code{3600})
26602 Default TTL of inexistent records. This delay is usually short because you want
26603 your new domains to reach everyone quickly.
26604
26605 @end table
26606 @end deftp
26607
26608 @deftp {Data Type} knot-remote-configuration
26609 Data type representing a remote configuration.
26610 This type has the following parameters:
26611
26612 @table @asis
26613 @item @code{id} (default: @code{""})
26614 An identifier for other configuration fields to refer to this remote. IDs must
26615 be unique and must not be empty.
26616
26617 @item @code{address} (default: @code{'()})
26618 An ordered list of destination IP addresses. Addresses are tried in sequence.
26619 An optional port can be given with the @@ separator. For instance:
26620 @code{(list "1.2.3.4" "2.3.4.5@@53")}. Default port is 53.
26621
26622 @item @code{via} (default: @code{'()})
26623 An ordered list of source IP addresses. An empty list will have Knot choose
26624 an appropriate source IP@. An optional port can be given with the @@ separator.
26625 The default is to choose at random.
26626
26627 @item @code{key} (default: @code{#f})
26628 A reference to a key, that is a string containing the identifier of a key
26629 defined in a @code{knot-key-configuration} field.
26630
26631 @end table
26632 @end deftp
26633
26634 @deftp {Data Type} knot-keystore-configuration
26635 Data type representing a keystore to hold dnssec keys.
26636 This type has the following parameters:
26637
26638 @table @asis
26639 @item @code{id} (default: @code{""})
26640 The id of the keystore. It must not be empty.
26641
26642 @item @code{backend} (default: @code{'pem})
26643 The backend to store the keys in. Can be @code{'pem} or @code{'pkcs11}.
26644
26645 @item @code{config} (default: @code{"/var/lib/knot/keys/keys"})
26646 The configuration string of the backend. An example for the PKCS#11 is:
26647 @code{"pkcs11:token=knot;pin-value=1234 /gnu/store/.../lib/pkcs11/libsofthsm2.so"}.
26648 For the pem backend, the string represents a path in the file system.
26649
26650 @end table
26651 @end deftp
26652
26653 @deftp {Data Type} knot-policy-configuration
26654 Data type representing a dnssec policy. Knot DNS is able to automatically
26655 sign your zones. It can either generate and manage your keys automatically or
26656 use keys that you generate.
26657
26658 Dnssec is usually implemented using two keys: a Key Signing Key (KSK) that is
26659 used to sign the second, and a Zone Signing Key (ZSK) that is used to sign the
26660 zone. In order to be trusted, the KSK needs to be present in the parent zone
26661 (usually a top-level domain). If your registrar supports dnssec, you will
26662 have to send them your KSK's hash so they can add a DS record in their zone.
26663 This is not automated and need to be done each time you change your KSK.
26664
26665 The policy also defines the lifetime of keys. Usually, ZSK can be changed
26666 easily and use weaker cryptographic functions (they use lower parameters) in
26667 order to sign records quickly, so they are changed often. The KSK however
26668 requires manual interaction with the registrar, so they are changed less often
26669 and use stronger parameters because they sign only one record.
26670
26671 This type has the following parameters:
26672
26673 @table @asis
26674 @item @code{id} (default: @code{""})
26675 The id of the policy. It must not be empty.
26676
26677 @item @code{keystore} (default: @code{"default"})
26678 A reference to a keystore, that is a string containing the identifier of a
26679 keystore defined in a @code{knot-keystore-configuration} field. The
26680 @code{"default"} identifier means the default keystore (a kasp database that
26681 was setup by this service).
26682
26683 @item @code{manual?} (default: @code{#f})
26684 Whether the key management is manual or automatic.
26685
26686 @item @code{single-type-signing?} (default: @code{#f})
26687 When @code{#t}, use the Single-Type Signing Scheme.
26688
26689 @item @code{algorithm} (default: @code{"ecdsap256sha256"})
26690 An algorithm of signing keys and issued signatures.
26691
26692 @item @code{ksk-size} (default: @code{256})
26693 The length of the KSK@. Note that this value is correct for the default
26694 algorithm, but would be unsecure for other algorithms.
26695
26696 @item @code{zsk-size} (default: @code{256})
26697 The length of the ZSK@. Note that this value is correct for the default
26698 algorithm, but would be unsecure for other algorithms.
26699
26700 @item @code{dnskey-ttl} (default: @code{'default})
26701 The TTL value for DNSKEY records added into zone apex. The special
26702 @code{'default} value means same as the zone SOA TTL.
26703
26704 @item @code{zsk-lifetime} (default: @code{(* 30 24 3600)})
26705 The period between ZSK publication and the next rollover initiation.
26706
26707 @item @code{propagation-delay} (default: @code{(* 24 3600)})
26708 An extra delay added for each key rollover step. This value should be high
26709 enough to cover propagation of data from the master server to all slaves.
26710
26711 @item @code{rrsig-lifetime} (default: @code{(* 14 24 3600)})
26712 A validity period of newly issued signatures.
26713
26714 @item @code{rrsig-refresh} (default: @code{(* 7 24 3600)})
26715 A period how long before a signature expiration the signature will be refreshed.
26716
26717 @item @code{nsec3?} (default: @code{#f})
26718 When @code{#t}, NSEC3 will be used instead of NSEC.
26719
26720 @item @code{nsec3-iterations} (default: @code{5})
26721 The number of additional times the hashing is performed.
26722
26723 @item @code{nsec3-salt-length} (default: @code{8})
26724 The length of a salt field in octets, which is appended to the original owner
26725 name before hashing.
26726
26727 @item @code{nsec3-salt-lifetime} (default: @code{(* 30 24 3600)})
26728 The validity period of newly issued salt field.
26729
26730 @end table
26731 @end deftp
26732
26733 @deftp {Data Type} knot-zone-configuration
26734 Data type representing a zone served by Knot.
26735 This type has the following parameters:
26736
26737 @table @asis
26738 @item @code{domain} (default: @code{""})
26739 The domain served by this configuration. It must not be empty.
26740
26741 @item @code{file} (default: @code{""})
26742 The file where this zone is saved. This parameter is ignored by master zones.
26743 Empty means default location that depends on the domain name.
26744
26745 @item @code{zone} (default: @code{(zone-file)})
26746 The content of the zone file. This parameter is ignored by slave zones. It
26747 must contain a zone-file record.
26748
26749 @item @code{master} (default: @code{'()})
26750 A list of master remotes. When empty, this zone is a master. When set, this
26751 zone is a slave. This is a list of remotes identifiers.
26752
26753 @item @code{ddns-master} (default: @code{#f})
26754 The main master. When empty, it defaults to the first master in the list of
26755 masters.
26756
26757 @item @code{notify} (default: @code{'()})
26758 A list of slave remote identifiers.
26759
26760 @item @code{acl} (default: @code{'()})
26761 A list of acl identifiers.
26762
26763 @item @code{semantic-checks?} (default: @code{#f})
26764 When set, this adds more semantic checks to the zone.
26765
26766 @item @code{disable-any?} (default: @code{#f})
26767 When set, this forbids queries of the ANY type.
26768
26769 @item @code{zonefile-sync} (default: @code{0})
26770 The delay between a modification in memory and on disk. 0 means immediate
26771 synchronization.
26772
26773 @item @code{zonefile-load} (default: @code{#f})
26774 The way the zone file contents are applied during zone load. Possible values
26775 are:
26776
26777 @itemize
26778 @item @code{#f} for using the default value from Knot,
26779 @item @code{'none} for not using the zone file at all,
26780 @item @code{'difference} for computing the difference between already available
26781 contents and zone contents and applying it to the current zone contents,
26782 @item @code{'difference-no-serial} for the same as @code{'difference}, but
26783 ignoring the SOA serial in the zone file, while the server takes care of it
26784 automatically.
26785 @item @code{'whole} for loading zone contents from the zone file.
26786 @end itemize
26787
26788 @item @code{journal-content} (default: @code{#f})
26789 The way the journal is used to store zone and its changes. Possible values
26790 are @code{'none} to not use it at all, @code{'changes} to store changes and
26791 @code{'all} to store contents. @code{#f} does not set this option, so the
26792 default value from Knot is used.
26793
26794 @item @code{max-journal-usage} (default: @code{#f})
26795 The maximum size for the journal on disk. @code{#f} does not set this option,
26796 so the default value from Knot is used.
26797
26798 @item @code{max-journal-depth} (default: @code{#f})
26799 The maximum size of the history. @code{#f} does not set this option, so the
26800 default value from Knot is used.
26801
26802 @item @code{max-zone-size} (default: @code{#f})
26803 The maximum size of the zone file. This limit is enforced for incoming
26804 transfer and updates. @code{#f} does not set this option, so the default
26805 value from Knot is used.
26806
26807 @item @code{dnssec-policy} (default: @code{#f})
26808 A reference to a @code{knot-policy-configuration} record, or the special
26809 name @code{"default"}. If the value is @code{#f}, there is no dnssec signing
26810 on this zone.
26811
26812 @item @code{serial-policy} (default: @code{'increment})
26813 A policy between @code{'increment} and @code{'unixtime}.
26814
26815 @end table
26816 @end deftp
26817
26818 @deftp {Data Type} knot-configuration
26819 Data type representing the Knot configuration.
26820 This type has the following parameters:
26821
26822 @table @asis
26823 @item @code{knot} (default: @code{knot})
26824 The Knot package.
26825
26826 @item @code{run-directory} (default: @code{"/var/run/knot"})
26827 The run directory. This directory will be used for pid file and sockets.
26828
26829 @item @code{includes} (default: @code{'()})
26830 A list of strings or file-like objects denoting other files that must be
26831 included at the top of the configuration file.
26832
26833 @cindex secrets, Knot service
26834 This can be used to manage secrets out-of-band. For example, secret
26835 keys may be stored in an out-of-band file not managed by Guix, and
26836 thus not visible in @file{/gnu/store}---e.g., you could store secret
26837 key configuration in @file{/etc/knot/secrets.conf} and add this file
26838 to the @code{includes} list.
26839
26840 One can generate a secret tsig key (for nsupdate and zone transfers with the
26841 keymgr command from the knot package. Note that the package is not automatically
26842 installed by the service. The following example shows how to generate a new
26843 tsig key:
26844
26845 @example
26846 keymgr -t mysecret > /etc/knot/secrets.conf
26847 chmod 600 /etc/knot/secrets.conf
26848 @end example
26849
26850 Also note that the generated key will be named @var{mysecret}, so it is the
26851 name that needs to be used in the @var{key} field of the
26852 @code{knot-acl-configuration} record and in other places that need to refer
26853 to that key.
26854
26855 It can also be used to add configuration not supported by this interface.
26856
26857 @item @code{listen-v4} (default: @code{"0.0.0.0"})
26858 An ip address on which to listen.
26859
26860 @item @code{listen-v6} (default: @code{"::"})
26861 An ip address on which to listen.
26862
26863 @item @code{listen-port} (default: @code{53})
26864 A port on which to listen.
26865
26866 @item @code{keys} (default: @code{'()})
26867 The list of knot-key-configuration used by this configuration.
26868
26869 @item @code{acls} (default: @code{'()})
26870 The list of knot-acl-configuration used by this configuration.
26871
26872 @item @code{remotes} (default: @code{'()})
26873 The list of knot-remote-configuration used by this configuration.
26874
26875 @item @code{zones} (default: @code{'()})
26876 The list of knot-zone-configuration used by this configuration.
26877
26878 @end table
26879 @end deftp
26880
26881 @subsubheading Knot Resolver Service
26882
26883 @deffn {Scheme Variable} knot-resolver-service-type
26884 This is the type of the knot resolver service, whose value should be
26885 an @code{knot-resolver-configuration} object as in this example:
26886
26887 @lisp
26888 (service knot-resolver-service-type
26889 (knot-resolver-configuration
26890 (kresd-config-file (plain-file "kresd.conf" "
26891 net.listen('192.168.0.1', 5353)
26892 user('knot-resolver', 'knot-resolver')
26893 modules = @{ 'hints > iterate', 'stats', 'predict' @}
26894 cache.size = 100 * MB
26895 "))))
26896 @end lisp
26897
26898 For more information, refer its @url{https://knot-resolver.readthedocs.org/en/stable/daemon.html#configuration, manual}.
26899 @end deffn
26900
26901 @deftp {Data Type} knot-resolver-configuration
26902 Data type representing the configuration of knot-resolver.
26903
26904 @table @asis
26905 @item @code{package} (default: @var{knot-resolver})
26906 Package object of the knot DNS resolver.
26907
26908 @item @code{kresd-config-file} (default: %kresd.conf)
26909 File-like object of the kresd configuration file to use, by default it
26910 will listen on @code{127.0.0.1} and @code{::1}.
26911
26912 @item @code{garbage-collection-interval} (default: 1000)
26913 Number of milliseconds for @code{kres-cache-gc} to periodically trim the cache.
26914
26915 @end table
26916 @end deftp
26917
26918
26919 @subsubheading Dnsmasq Service
26920
26921 @deffn {Scheme Variable} dnsmasq-service-type
26922 This is the type of the dnsmasq service, whose value should be an
26923 @code{dnsmasq-configuration} object as in this example:
26924
26925 @lisp
26926 (service dnsmasq-service-type
26927 (dnsmasq-configuration
26928 (no-resolv? #t)
26929 (servers '("192.168.1.1"))))
26930 @end lisp
26931 @end deffn
26932
26933 @deftp {Data Type} dnsmasq-configuration
26934 Data type representing the configuration of dnsmasq.
26935
26936 @table @asis
26937 @item @code{package} (default: @var{dnsmasq})
26938 Package object of the dnsmasq server.
26939
26940 @item @code{no-hosts?} (default: @code{#f})
26941 When true, don't read the hostnames in /etc/hosts.
26942
26943 @item @code{port} (default: @code{53})
26944 The port to listen on. Setting this to zero completely disables DNS
26945 responses, leaving only DHCP and/or TFTP functions.
26946
26947 @item @code{local-service?} (default: @code{#t})
26948 Accept DNS queries only from hosts whose address is on a local subnet,
26949 ie a subnet for which an interface exists on the server.
26950
26951 @item @code{listen-addresses} (default: @code{'()})
26952 Listen on the given IP addresses.
26953
26954 @item @code{resolv-file} (default: @code{"/etc/resolv.conf"})
26955 The file to read the IP address of the upstream nameservers from.
26956
26957 @item @code{no-resolv?} (default: @code{#f})
26958 When true, don't read @var{resolv-file}.
26959
26960 @item @code{servers} (default: @code{'()})
26961 Specify IP address of upstream servers directly.
26962
26963 @item @code{addresses} (default: @code{'()})
26964 For each entry, specify an IP address to return for any host in the
26965 given domains. Queries in the domains are never forwarded and always
26966 replied to with the specified IP address.
26967
26968 This is useful for redirecting hosts locally, for example:
26969
26970 @lisp
26971 (service dnsmasq-service-type
26972 (dnsmasq-configuration
26973 (addresses
26974 '(; Redirect to a local web-server.
26975 "/example.org/127.0.0.1"
26976 ; Redirect subdomain to a specific IP.
26977 "/subdomain.example.org/192.168.1.42"))))
26978 @end lisp
26979
26980 Note that rules in @file{/etc/hosts} take precedence over this.
26981
26982 @item @code{cache-size} (default: @code{150})
26983 Set the size of dnsmasq's cache. Setting the cache size to zero
26984 disables caching.
26985
26986 @item @code{negative-cache?} (default: @code{#t})
26987 When false, disable negative caching.
26988
26989 @item @code{tftp-enable?} (default: @code{#f})
26990 Whether to enable the built-in TFTP server.
26991
26992 @item @code{tftp-no-fail?} (default: @code{#f})
26993 If true, does not fail dnsmasq if the TFTP server could not start up.
26994
26995 @item @code{tftp-single-port?} (default: @code{#f})
26996 Whether to use only one single port for TFTP.
26997
26998 @item @code{tftp-secure?} (default: @code{#f})
26999 If true, only files owned by the user running the dnsmasq process are accessible.
27000
27001 If dnsmasq is being run as root, different rules apply:
27002 @code{tftp-secure?} has no effect, but only files which have the
27003 world-readable bit set are accessible.
27004
27005 @item @code{tftp-max} (default: @code{#f})
27006 If set, sets the maximal number of concurrent connections allowed.
27007
27008 @item @code{tftp-mtu} (default: @code{#f})
27009 If set, sets the MTU for TFTP packets to that value.
27010
27011 @item @code{tftp-no-blocksize?} (default: @code{#f})
27012 If true, stops the TFTP server from negotiating the blocksize with a client.
27013
27014 @item @code{tftp-lowercase?} (default: @code{#f})
27015 Whether to convert all filenames in TFTP requests to lowercase.
27016
27017 @item @code{tftp-port-range} (default: @code{#f})
27018 If set, fixes the dynamical ports (one per client) to the given range
27019 (@code{"<start>,<end>"}).
27020
27021 @item @code{tftp-root} (default: @code{/var/empty,lo})
27022 Look for files to transfer using TFTP relative to the given directory.
27023 When this is set, TFTP paths which include @samp{..} are rejected, to stop clients
27024 getting outside the specified root. Absolute paths (starting with @samp{/}) are
27025 allowed, but they must be within the TFTP-root. If the optional interface
27026 argument is given, the directory is only used for TFTP requests via that
27027 interface.
27028
27029 @item @code{tftp-unique-root} (default: @code{#f})
27030 If set, add the IP or hardware address of the TFTP client as a path component
27031 on the end of the TFTP-root. Only valid if a TFTP root is set and the
27032 directory exists. Defaults to adding IP address (in standard dotted-quad
27033 format).
27034
27035 For instance, if @option{--tftp-root} is @samp{/tftp} and client
27036 @samp{1.2.3.4} requests file @file{myfile} then the effective path will
27037 be @file{/tftp/1.2.3.4/myfile} if @file{/tftp/1.2.3.4} exists or
27038 @file{/tftp/myfile} otherwise. When @samp{=mac} is specified it will
27039 append the MAC address instead, using lowercase zero padded digits
27040 separated by dashes, e.g.: @samp{01-02-03-04-aa-bb}. Note that
27041 resolving MAC addresses is only possible if the client is in the local
27042 network or obtained a DHCP lease from dnsmasq.
27043
27044 @end table
27045 @end deftp
27046
27047 @subsubheading ddclient Service
27048
27049 @cindex ddclient
27050 The ddclient service described below runs the ddclient daemon, which takes
27051 care of automatically updating DNS entries for service providers such as
27052 @uref{https://dyn.com/dns/, Dyn}.
27053
27054 The following example show instantiates the service with its default
27055 configuration:
27056
27057 @lisp
27058 (service ddclient-service-type)
27059 @end lisp
27060
27061 Note that ddclient needs to access credentials that are stored in a
27062 @dfn{secret file}, by default @file{/etc/ddclient/secrets} (see
27063 @code{secret-file} below). You are expected to create this file manually, in
27064 an ``out-of-band'' fashion (you @emph{could} make this file part of the
27065 service configuration, for instance by using @code{plain-file}, but it will be
27066 world-readable @i{via} @file{/gnu/store}). See the examples in the
27067 @file{share/ddclient} directory of the @code{ddclient} package.
27068
27069 @c %start of fragment
27070
27071 Available @code{ddclient-configuration} fields are:
27072
27073 @deftypevr {@code{ddclient-configuration} parameter} package ddclient
27074 The ddclient package.
27075
27076 @end deftypevr
27077
27078 @deftypevr {@code{ddclient-configuration} parameter} integer daemon
27079 The period after which ddclient will retry to check IP and domain name.
27080
27081 Defaults to @samp{300}.
27082
27083 @end deftypevr
27084
27085 @deftypevr {@code{ddclient-configuration} parameter} boolean syslog
27086 Use syslog for the output.
27087
27088 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
27089
27090 @end deftypevr
27091
27092 @deftypevr {@code{ddclient-configuration} parameter} string mail
27093 Mail to user.
27094
27095 Defaults to @samp{"root"}.
27096
27097 @end deftypevr
27098
27099 @deftypevr {@code{ddclient-configuration} parameter} string mail-failure
27100 Mail failed update to user.
27101
27102 Defaults to @samp{"root"}.
27103
27104 @end deftypevr
27105
27106 @deftypevr {@code{ddclient-configuration} parameter} string pid
27107 The ddclient PID file.
27108
27109 Defaults to @samp{"/var/run/ddclient/ddclient.pid"}.
27110
27111 @end deftypevr
27112
27113 @deftypevr {@code{ddclient-configuration} parameter} boolean ssl
27114 Enable SSL support.
27115
27116 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
27117
27118 @end deftypevr
27119
27120 @deftypevr {@code{ddclient-configuration} parameter} string user
27121 Specifies the user name or ID that is used when running ddclient
27122 program.
27123
27124 Defaults to @samp{"ddclient"}.
27125
27126 @end deftypevr
27127
27128 @deftypevr {@code{ddclient-configuration} parameter} string group
27129 Group of the user who will run the ddclient program.
27130
27131 Defaults to @samp{"ddclient"}.
27132
27133 @end deftypevr
27134
27135 @deftypevr {@code{ddclient-configuration} parameter} string secret-file
27136 Secret file which will be appended to @file{ddclient.conf} file. This
27137 file contains credentials for use by ddclient. You are expected to
27138 create it manually.
27139
27140 Defaults to @samp{"/etc/ddclient/secrets.conf"}.
27141
27142 @end deftypevr
27143
27144 @deftypevr {@code{ddclient-configuration} parameter} list extra-options
27145 Extra options will be appended to @file{ddclient.conf} file.
27146
27147 Defaults to @samp{()}.
27148
27149 @end deftypevr
27150
27151
27152 @c %end of fragment
27153
27154
27155 @node VPN Services
27156 @subsection VPN Services
27157 @cindex VPN (virtual private network)
27158 @cindex virtual private network (VPN)
27159
27160 The @code{(gnu services vpn)} module provides services related to
27161 @dfn{virtual private networks} (VPNs).
27162
27163 @subsubheading Bitmask
27164
27165 @defvr {Scheme Variable} bitmask-service-type
27166 A service type for the @uref{https://bitmask.net, Bitmask} VPN client. It makes
27167 the client available in the system and loads its polkit policy. Please note that
27168 the client expects an active polkit-agent, which is either run by your
27169 desktop-environment or should be run manually.
27170 @end defvr
27171
27172 @subsubheading OpenVPN
27173
27174 It provides a @emph{client} service for your machine to connect to a
27175 VPN, and a @emph{server} service for your machine to host a VPN@.
27176
27177 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} openvpn-client-service @
27178 [#:config (openvpn-client-configuration)]
27179
27180 Return a service that runs @command{openvpn}, a VPN daemon, as a client.
27181 @end deffn
27182
27183 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} openvpn-server-service @
27184 [#:config (openvpn-server-configuration)]
27185
27186 Return a service that runs @command{openvpn}, a VPN daemon, as a server.
27187
27188 Both can be run simultaneously.
27189 @end deffn
27190
27191 @c %automatically generated documentation
27192
27193 Available @code{openvpn-client-configuration} fields are:
27194
27195 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-client-configuration} parameter} package openvpn
27196 The OpenVPN package.
27197
27198 @end deftypevr
27199
27200 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-client-configuration} parameter} string pid-file
27201 The OpenVPN pid file.
27202
27203 Defaults to @samp{"/var/run/openvpn/openvpn.pid"}.
27204
27205 @end deftypevr
27206
27207 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-client-configuration} parameter} proto proto
27208 The protocol (UDP or TCP) used to open a channel between clients and
27209 servers.
27210
27211 Defaults to @samp{udp}.
27212
27213 @end deftypevr
27214
27215 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-client-configuration} parameter} dev dev
27216 The device type used to represent the VPN connection.
27217
27218 Defaults to @samp{tun}.
27219
27220 @end deftypevr
27221
27222 If you do not have some of these files (eg.@: you use a username and
27223 password), you can disable any of the following three fields by setting
27224 it to @code{'disabled}.
27225
27226 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-client-configuration} parameter} maybe-string ca
27227 The certificate authority to check connections against.
27228
27229 Defaults to @samp{"/etc/openvpn/ca.crt"}.
27230
27231 @end deftypevr
27232
27233 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-client-configuration} parameter} maybe-string cert
27234 The certificate of the machine the daemon is running on. It should be
27235 signed by the authority given in @code{ca}.
27236
27237 Defaults to @samp{"/etc/openvpn/client.crt"}.
27238
27239 @end deftypevr
27240
27241 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-client-configuration} parameter} maybe-string key
27242 The key of the machine the daemon is running on. It must be the key whose
27243 certificate is @code{cert}.
27244
27245 Defaults to @samp{"/etc/openvpn/client.key"}.
27246
27247 @end deftypevr
27248
27249 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-client-configuration} parameter} boolean comp-lzo?
27250 Whether to use the lzo compression algorithm.
27251
27252 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
27253
27254 @end deftypevr
27255
27256 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-client-configuration} parameter} boolean persist-key?
27257 Don't re-read key files across SIGUSR1 or --ping-restart.
27258
27259 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
27260
27261 @end deftypevr
27262
27263 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-client-configuration} parameter} boolean persist-tun?
27264 Don't close and reopen TUN/TAP device or run up/down scripts across
27265 SIGUSR1 or --ping-restart restarts.
27266
27267 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
27268
27269 @end deftypevr
27270
27271 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-client-configuration} parameter} boolean fast-io?
27272 (Experimental) Optimize TUN/TAP/UDP I/O writes by avoiding a call to
27273 poll/epoll/select prior to the write operation.
27274
27275 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
27276 @end deftypevr
27277
27278 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-client-configuration} parameter} number verbosity
27279 Verbosity level.
27280
27281 Defaults to @samp{3}.
27282
27283 @end deftypevr
27284
27285 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-client-configuration} parameter} tls-auth-client tls-auth
27286 Add an additional layer of HMAC authentication on top of the TLS control
27287 channel to protect against DoS attacks.
27288
27289 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
27290
27291 @end deftypevr
27292
27293 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-client-configuration} parameter} maybe-string auth-user-pass
27294 Authenticate with server using username/password. The option is a file
27295 containing username/password on 2 lines. Do not use a file-like object as it
27296 would be added to the store and readable by any user.
27297
27298 Defaults to @samp{'disabled}.
27299 @end deftypevr
27300
27301 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-client-configuration} parameter} key-usage verify-key-usage?
27302 Whether to check the server certificate has server usage extension.
27303
27304 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
27305
27306 @end deftypevr
27307
27308 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-client-configuration} parameter} bind bind?
27309 Bind to a specific local port number.
27310
27311 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
27312
27313 @end deftypevr
27314
27315 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-client-configuration} parameter} resolv-retry resolv-retry?
27316 Retry resolving server address.
27317
27318 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
27319
27320 @end deftypevr
27321
27322 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-client-configuration} parameter} openvpn-remote-list remote
27323 A list of remote servers to connect to.
27324
27325 Defaults to @samp{()}.
27326
27327 Available @code{openvpn-remote-configuration} fields are:
27328
27329 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-remote-configuration} parameter} string name
27330 Server name.
27331
27332 Defaults to @samp{"my-server"}.
27333
27334 @end deftypevr
27335
27336 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-remote-configuration} parameter} number port
27337 Port number the server listens to.
27338
27339 Defaults to @samp{1194}.
27340
27341 @end deftypevr
27342
27343 @end deftypevr
27344 @c %end of automatic openvpn-client documentation
27345
27346 @c %automatically generated documentation
27347
27348 Available @code{openvpn-server-configuration} fields are:
27349
27350 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} package openvpn
27351 The OpenVPN package.
27352
27353 @end deftypevr
27354
27355 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} string pid-file
27356 The OpenVPN pid file.
27357
27358 Defaults to @samp{"/var/run/openvpn/openvpn.pid"}.
27359
27360 @end deftypevr
27361
27362 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} proto proto
27363 The protocol (UDP or TCP) used to open a channel between clients and
27364 servers.
27365
27366 Defaults to @samp{udp}.
27367
27368 @end deftypevr
27369
27370 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} dev dev
27371 The device type used to represent the VPN connection.
27372
27373 Defaults to @samp{tun}.
27374
27375 @end deftypevr
27376
27377 If you do not have some of these files (eg.@: you use a username and
27378 password), you can disable any of the following three fields by setting
27379 it to @code{'disabled}.
27380
27381 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} maybe-string ca
27382 The certificate authority to check connections against.
27383
27384 Defaults to @samp{"/etc/openvpn/ca.crt"}.
27385
27386 @end deftypevr
27387
27388 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} maybe-string cert
27389 The certificate of the machine the daemon is running on. It should be
27390 signed by the authority given in @code{ca}.
27391
27392 Defaults to @samp{"/etc/openvpn/client.crt"}.
27393
27394 @end deftypevr
27395
27396 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} maybe-string key
27397 The key of the machine the daemon is running on. It must be the key whose
27398 certificate is @code{cert}.
27399
27400 Defaults to @samp{"/etc/openvpn/client.key"}.
27401
27402 @end deftypevr
27403
27404 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} boolean comp-lzo?
27405 Whether to use the lzo compression algorithm.
27406
27407 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
27408
27409 @end deftypevr
27410
27411 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} boolean persist-key?
27412 Don't re-read key files across SIGUSR1 or --ping-restart.
27413
27414 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
27415
27416 @end deftypevr
27417
27418 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} boolean persist-tun?
27419 Don't close and reopen TUN/TAP device or run up/down scripts across
27420 SIGUSR1 or --ping-restart restarts.
27421
27422 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
27423
27424 @end deftypevr
27425
27426 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} boolean fast-io?
27427 (Experimental) Optimize TUN/TAP/UDP I/O writes by avoiding a call to
27428 poll/epoll/select prior to the write operation.
27429
27430 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
27431 @end deftypevr
27432
27433 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} number verbosity
27434 Verbosity level.
27435
27436 Defaults to @samp{3}.
27437
27438 @end deftypevr
27439
27440 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} tls-auth-server tls-auth
27441 Add an additional layer of HMAC authentication on top of the TLS control
27442 channel to protect against DoS attacks.
27443
27444 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
27445
27446 @end deftypevr
27447
27448 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} number port
27449 Specifies the port number on which the server listens.
27450
27451 Defaults to @samp{1194}.
27452
27453 @end deftypevr
27454
27455 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} ip-mask server
27456 An ip and mask specifying the subnet inside the virtual network.
27457
27458 Defaults to @samp{"10.8.0.0 255.255.255.0"}.
27459
27460 @end deftypevr
27461
27462 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} cidr6 server-ipv6
27463 A CIDR notation specifying the IPv6 subnet inside the virtual network.
27464
27465 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
27466
27467 @end deftypevr
27468
27469 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} string dh
27470 The Diffie-Hellman parameters file.
27471
27472 Defaults to @samp{"/etc/openvpn/dh2048.pem"}.
27473
27474 @end deftypevr
27475
27476 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} string ifconfig-pool-persist
27477 The file that records client IPs.
27478
27479 Defaults to @samp{"/etc/openvpn/ipp.txt"}.
27480
27481 @end deftypevr
27482
27483 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} gateway redirect-gateway?
27484 When true, the server will act as a gateway for its clients.
27485
27486 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
27487
27488 @end deftypevr
27489
27490 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} boolean client-to-client?
27491 When true, clients are allowed to talk to each other inside the VPN.
27492
27493 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
27494
27495 @end deftypevr
27496
27497 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} keepalive keepalive
27498 Causes ping-like messages to be sent back and forth over the link so
27499 that each side knows when the other side has gone down. @code{keepalive}
27500 requires a pair. The first element is the period of the ping sending,
27501 and the second element is the timeout before considering the other side
27502 down.
27503
27504 @end deftypevr
27505
27506 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} number max-clients
27507 The maximum number of clients.
27508
27509 Defaults to @samp{100}.
27510
27511 @end deftypevr
27512
27513 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} string status
27514 The status file. This file shows a small report on current connection.
27515 It is truncated and rewritten every minute.
27516
27517 Defaults to @samp{"/var/run/openvpn/status"}.
27518
27519 @end deftypevr
27520
27521 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} openvpn-ccd-list client-config-dir
27522 The list of configuration for some clients.
27523
27524 Defaults to @samp{()}.
27525
27526 Available @code{openvpn-ccd-configuration} fields are:
27527
27528 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-ccd-configuration} parameter} string name
27529 Client name.
27530
27531 Defaults to @samp{"client"}.
27532
27533 @end deftypevr
27534
27535 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-ccd-configuration} parameter} ip-mask iroute
27536 Client own network
27537
27538 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
27539
27540 @end deftypevr
27541
27542 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-ccd-configuration} parameter} ip-mask ifconfig-push
27543 Client VPN IP.
27544
27545 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
27546
27547 @end deftypevr
27548
27549 @end deftypevr
27550
27551 @c %end of automatic openvpn-server documentation
27552
27553 @subheading strongSwan
27554
27555 Currently, the strongSwan service only provides legacy-style configuration with
27556 @file{ipsec.conf} and @file{ipsec.secrets} files.
27557
27558 @defvr {Scheme Variable} strongswan-service-type
27559 A service type for configuring strongSwan for IPsec @acronym{VPN,
27560 Virtual Private Networking}. Its value must be a
27561 @code{strongswan-configuration} record as in this example:
27562
27563 @lisp
27564 (service strongswan-service-type
27565 (strongswan-configuration
27566 (ipsec-conf "/etc/ipsec.conf")
27567 (ipsec-secrets "/etc/ipsec.secrets")))
27568 @end lisp
27569
27570 @end defvr
27571
27572 @deftp {Data Type} strongswan-configuration
27573 Data type representing the configuration of the StrongSwan service.
27574
27575 @table @asis
27576 @item @code{strongswan}
27577 The strongSwan package to use for this service.
27578
27579 @item @code{ipsec-conf} (default: @code{#f})
27580 The file name of your @file{ipsec.conf}. If not @code{#f}, then this and
27581 @code{ipsec-secrets} must both be strings.
27582
27583 @item @code{ipsec-secrets} (default @code{#f})
27584 The file name of your @file{ipsec.secrets}. If not @code{#f}, then this and
27585 @code{ipsec-conf} must both be strings.
27586
27587 @end table
27588 @end deftp
27589
27590 @subsubheading Wireguard
27591
27592 @defvr {Scheme Variable} wireguard-service-type
27593 A service type for a Wireguard tunnel interface. Its value must be a
27594 @code{wireguard-configuration} record as in this example:
27595
27596 @lisp
27597 (service wireguard-service-type
27598 (wireguard-configuration
27599 (peers
27600 (list
27601 (wireguard-peer
27602 (name "my-peer")
27603 (endpoint "my.wireguard.com:51820")
27604 (public-key "hzpKg9X1yqu1axN6iJp0mWf6BZGo8m1wteKwtTmDGF4=")
27605 (allowed-ips '("10.0.0.2/32")))))))
27606 @end lisp
27607
27608 @end defvr
27609
27610 @deftp {Data Type} wireguard-configuration
27611 Data type representing the configuration of the Wireguard service.
27612
27613 @table @asis
27614 @item @code{wireguard}
27615 The wireguard package to use for this service.
27616
27617 @item @code{interface} (default: @code{"wg0"})
27618 The interface name for the VPN.
27619
27620 @item @code{addresses} (default: @code{'("10.0.0.1/32")})
27621 The IP addresses to be assigned to the above interface.
27622
27623 @item @code{private-key} (default: @code{"/etc/wireguard/private.key"})
27624 The private key file for the interface. It is automatically generated if
27625 the file does not exist.
27626
27627 @item @code{peers} (default: @code{'()})
27628 The authorized peers on this interface. This is a list of
27629 @var{wireguard-peer} records.
27630
27631 @end table
27632 @end deftp
27633
27634 @deftp {Data Type} wireguard-peer
27635 Data type representing a Wireguard peer attached to a given interface.
27636
27637 @table @asis
27638 @item @code{name}
27639 The peer name.
27640
27641 @item @code{endpoint} (default: @code{#f})
27642 The optional endpoint for the peer, such as
27643 @code{"demo.wireguard.com:51820"}.
27644
27645 @item @code{public-key}
27646 The peer public-key represented as a base64 string.
27647
27648 @item @code{allowed-ips}
27649 A list of IP addresses from which incoming traffic for this peer is
27650 allowed and to which incoming traffic for this peer is directed.
27651
27652 @item @code{keep-alive} (default: @code{#f})
27653 An optional time interval in seconds. A packet will be sent to the
27654 server endpoint once per time interval. This helps receiving
27655 incoming connections from this peer when you are behind a NAT or
27656 a firewall.
27657
27658 @end table
27659 @end deftp
27660
27661 @node Network File System
27662 @subsection Network File System
27663 @cindex NFS
27664
27665 The @code{(gnu services nfs)} module provides the following services,
27666 which are most commonly used in relation to mounting or exporting
27667 directory trees as @dfn{network file systems} (NFS).
27668
27669 While it is possible to use the individual components that together make
27670 up a Network File System service, we recommended to configure an NFS
27671 server with the @code{nfs-service-type}.
27672
27673 @subsubheading NFS Service
27674 @cindex NFS, server
27675
27676 The NFS service takes care of setting up all NFS component services,
27677 kernel configuration file systems, and installs configuration files in
27678 the locations that NFS expects.
27679
27680 @defvr {Scheme Variable} nfs-service-type
27681 A service type for a complete NFS server.
27682 @end defvr
27683
27684 @deftp {Data Type} nfs-configuration
27685 This data type represents the configuration of the NFS service and all
27686 of its subsystems.
27687
27688 It has the following parameters:
27689 @table @asis
27690 @item @code{nfs-utils} (default: @code{nfs-utils})
27691 The nfs-utils package to use.
27692
27693 @item @code{nfs-versions} (default: @code{'("4.2" "4.1" "4.0")})
27694 If a list of string values is provided, the @command{rpc.nfsd} daemon
27695 will be limited to supporting the given versions of the NFS protocol.
27696
27697 @item @code{exports} (default: @code{'()})
27698 This is a list of directories the NFS server should export. Each entry
27699 is a list consisting of two elements: a directory name and a string
27700 containing all options. This is an example in which the directory
27701 @file{/export} is served to all NFS clients as a read-only share:
27702
27703 @lisp
27704 (nfs-configuration
27705 (exports
27706 '(("/export"
27707 "*(ro,insecure,no_subtree_check,crossmnt,fsid=0)"))))
27708 @end lisp
27709
27710 @item @code{rpcmountd-port} (default: @code{#f})
27711 The network port that the @command{rpc.mountd} daemon should use.
27712
27713 @item @code{rpcstatd-port} (default: @code{#f})
27714 The network port that the @command{rpc.statd} daemon should use.
27715
27716 @item @code{rpcbind} (default: @code{rpcbind})
27717 The rpcbind package to use.
27718
27719 @item @code{idmap-domain} (default: @code{"localdomain"})
27720 The local NFSv4 domain name.
27721
27722 @item @code{nfsd-port} (default: @code{2049})
27723 The network port that the @command{nfsd} daemon should use.
27724
27725 @item @code{nfsd-threads} (default: @code{8})
27726 The number of threads used by the @command{nfsd} daemon.
27727
27728 @item @code{nfsd-tcp?} (default: @code{#t})
27729 Whether the @command{nfsd} daemon should listen on a TCP socket.
27730
27731 @item @code{nfsd-udp?} (default: @code{#f})
27732 Whether the @command{nfsd} daemon should listen on a UDP socket.
27733
27734 @item @code{pipefs-directory} (default: @code{"/var/lib/nfs/rpc_pipefs"})
27735 The directory where the pipefs file system is mounted.
27736
27737 @item @code{debug} (default: @code{'()"})
27738 A list of subsystems for which debugging output should be enabled. This
27739 is a list of symbols. Any of these symbols are valid: @code{nfsd},
27740 @code{nfs}, @code{rpc}, @code{idmap}, @code{statd}, or @code{mountd}.
27741 @end table
27742 @end deftp
27743
27744 If you don't need a complete NFS service or prefer to build it yourself
27745 you can use the individual component services that are documented below.
27746
27747 @subsubheading RPC Bind Service
27748 @cindex rpcbind
27749
27750 The RPC Bind service provides a facility to map program numbers into
27751 universal addresses.
27752 Many NFS related services use this facility. Hence it is automatically
27753 started when a dependent service starts.
27754
27755 @defvr {Scheme Variable} rpcbind-service-type
27756 A service type for the RPC portmapper daemon.
27757 @end defvr
27758
27759
27760 @deftp {Data Type} rpcbind-configuration
27761 Data type representing the configuration of the RPC Bind Service.
27762 This type has the following parameters:
27763 @table @asis
27764 @item @code{rpcbind} (default: @code{rpcbind})
27765 The rpcbind package to use.
27766
27767 @item @code{warm-start?} (default: @code{#t})
27768 If this parameter is @code{#t}, then the daemon will read a
27769 state file on startup thus reloading state information saved by a previous
27770 instance.
27771 @end table
27772 @end deftp
27773
27774
27775 @subsubheading Pipefs Pseudo File System
27776 @cindex pipefs
27777 @cindex rpc_pipefs
27778
27779 The pipefs file system is used to transfer NFS related data
27780 between the kernel and user space programs.
27781
27782 @defvr {Scheme Variable} pipefs-service-type
27783 A service type for the pipefs pseudo file system.
27784 @end defvr
27785
27786 @deftp {Data Type} pipefs-configuration
27787 Data type representing the configuration of the pipefs pseudo file system service.
27788 This type has the following parameters:
27789 @table @asis
27790 @item @code{mount-point} (default: @code{"/var/lib/nfs/rpc_pipefs"})
27791 The directory to which the file system is to be attached.
27792 @end table
27793 @end deftp
27794
27795
27796 @subsubheading GSS Daemon Service
27797 @cindex GSSD
27798 @cindex GSS
27799 @cindex global security system
27800
27801 The @dfn{global security system} (GSS) daemon provides strong security for RPC
27802 based protocols.
27803 Before exchanging RPC requests an RPC client must establish a security
27804 context. Typically this is done using the Kerberos command @command{kinit}
27805 or automatically at login time using PAM services (@pxref{Kerberos Services}).
27806
27807 @defvr {Scheme Variable} gss-service-type
27808 A service type for the Global Security System (GSS) daemon.
27809 @end defvr
27810
27811 @deftp {Data Type} gss-configuration
27812 Data type representing the configuration of the GSS daemon service.
27813 This type has the following parameters:
27814 @table @asis
27815 @item @code{nfs-utils} (default: @code{nfs-utils})
27816 The package in which the @command{rpc.gssd} command is to be found.
27817
27818 @item @code{pipefs-directory} (default: @code{"/var/lib/nfs/rpc_pipefs"})
27819 The directory where the pipefs file system is mounted.
27820
27821 @end table
27822 @end deftp
27823
27824
27825 @subsubheading IDMAP Daemon Service
27826 @cindex idmapd
27827 @cindex name mapper
27828
27829 The idmap daemon service provides mapping between user IDs and user names.
27830 Typically it is required in order to access file systems mounted via NFSv4.
27831
27832 @defvr {Scheme Variable} idmap-service-type
27833 A service type for the Identity Mapper (IDMAP) daemon.
27834 @end defvr
27835
27836 @deftp {Data Type} idmap-configuration
27837 Data type representing the configuration of the IDMAP daemon service.
27838 This type has the following parameters:
27839 @table @asis
27840 @item @code{nfs-utils} (default: @code{nfs-utils})
27841 The package in which the @command{rpc.idmapd} command is to be found.
27842
27843 @item @code{pipefs-directory} (default: @code{"/var/lib/nfs/rpc_pipefs"})
27844 The directory where the pipefs file system is mounted.
27845
27846 @item @code{domain} (default: @code{#f})
27847 The local NFSv4 domain name.
27848 This must be a string or @code{#f}.
27849 If it is @code{#f} then the daemon will use the host's fully qualified domain name.
27850
27851 @item @code{verbosity} (default: @code{0})
27852 The verbosity level of the daemon.
27853
27854 @end table
27855 @end deftp
27856
27857 @node Continuous Integration
27858 @subsection Continuous Integration
27859
27860 @cindex continuous integration
27861 @uref{https://guix.gnu.org/cuirass/, Cuirass} is a continuous
27862 integration tool for Guix. It can be used both for development and for
27863 providing substitutes to others (@pxref{Substitutes}).
27864
27865 The @code{(gnu services cuirass)} module provides the following service.
27866
27867 @defvr {Scheme Procedure} cuirass-service-type
27868 The type of the Cuirass service. Its value must be a
27869 @code{cuirass-configuration} object, as described below.
27870 @end defvr
27871
27872 To add build jobs, you have to set the @code{specifications} field of
27873 the configuration. For instance, the following example will build all
27874 the packages provided by the @code{my-channel} channel.
27875
27876 @lisp
27877 (define %cuirass-specs
27878 #~(list (specification
27879 (name "my-channel")
27880 (build '(channels my-channel))
27881 (channels
27882 (cons (channel
27883 (name 'my-channel)
27884 (url "https://my-channel.git"))
27885 %default-channels)))))
27886
27887 (service cuirass-service-type
27888 (cuirass-configuration
27889 (specifications %cuirass-specs)))
27890 @end lisp
27891
27892 To build the @code{linux-libre} package defined by the default Guix
27893 channel, one can use the following configuration.
27894
27895 @lisp
27896 (define %cuirass-specs
27897 #~(list (specification
27898 (name "my-linux")
27899 (build '(packages "linux-libre")))))
27900
27901 (service cuirass-service-type
27902 (cuirass-configuration
27903 (specifications %cuirass-specs)))
27904 @end lisp
27905
27906 The other configuration possibilities, as well as the specification
27907 record itself are described in the Cuirass manual
27908 (@pxref{Specifications,,, cuirass, Cuirass}).
27909
27910 While information related to build jobs is located directly in the
27911 specifications, global settings for the @command{cuirass} process are
27912 accessible in other @code{cuirass-configuration} fields.
27913
27914 @deftp {Data Type} cuirass-configuration
27915 Data type representing the configuration of Cuirass.
27916
27917 @table @asis
27918 @item @code{cuirass} (default: @code{cuirass})
27919 The Cuirass package to use.
27920
27921 @item @code{log-file} (default: @code{"/var/log/cuirass.log"})
27922 Location of the log file.
27923
27924 @item @code{web-log-file} (default: @code{"/var/log/cuirass-web.log"})
27925 Location of the log file used by the web interface.
27926
27927 @item @code{cache-directory} (default: @code{"/var/cache/cuirass"})
27928 Location of the repository cache.
27929
27930 @item @code{user} (default: @code{"cuirass"})
27931 Owner of the @code{cuirass} process.
27932
27933 @item @code{group} (default: @code{"cuirass"})
27934 Owner's group of the @code{cuirass} process.
27935
27936 @item @code{interval} (default: @code{60})
27937 Number of seconds between the poll of the repositories followed by the
27938 Cuirass jobs.
27939
27940 @item @code{parameters} (default: @code{#f})
27941 Read parameters from the given @var{parameters} file. The supported
27942 parameters are described here (@pxref{Parameters,,, cuirass, Cuirass}).
27943
27944 @item @code{remote-server} (default: @code{#f})
27945 A @code{cuirass-remote-server-configuration} record to use the build
27946 remote mechanism or @code{#f} to use the default build mechanism.
27947
27948 @item @code{database} (default: @code{"dbname=cuirass host=/var/run/postgresql"})
27949 Use @var{database} as the database containing the jobs and the past
27950 build results. Since Cuirass uses PostgreSQL as a database engine,
27951 @var{database} must be a string such as @code{"dbname=cuirass
27952 host=localhost"}.
27953
27954 @item @code{port} (default: @code{8081})
27955 Port number used by the HTTP server.
27956
27957 @item @code{host} (default: @code{"localhost"})
27958 Listen on the network interface for @var{host}. The default is to
27959 accept connections from localhost.
27960
27961 @item @code{specifications} (default: @code{#~'()})
27962 A gexp (@pxref{G-Expressions}) that evaluates to a list of
27963 specifications records. The specification record is described in the
27964 Cuirass manual (@pxref{Specifications,,, cuirass, Cuirass}).
27965
27966 @item @code{use-substitutes?} (default: @code{#f})
27967 This allows using substitutes to avoid building every dependencies of a job
27968 from source.
27969
27970 @item @code{one-shot?} (default: @code{#f})
27971 Only evaluate specifications and build derivations once.
27972
27973 @item @code{fallback?} (default: @code{#f})
27974 When substituting a pre-built binary fails, fall back to building
27975 packages locally.
27976
27977 @item @code{extra-options} (default: @code{'()})
27978 Extra options to pass when running the Cuirass processes.
27979
27980 @end table
27981 @end deftp
27982
27983 @cindex remote build
27984 @subsubheading Cuirass remote building
27985
27986 Cuirass supports two mechanisms to build derivations.
27987
27988 @itemize
27989 @item Using the local Guix daemon.
27990 This is the default build mechanism. Once the build jobs are
27991 evaluated, they are sent to the local Guix daemon. Cuirass then
27992 listens to the Guix daemon output to detect the various build events.
27993
27994 @item Using the remote build mechanism.
27995 The build jobs are not submitted to the local Guix daemon. Instead, a
27996 remote server dispatches build requests to the connect remote workers,
27997 according to the build priorities.
27998
27999 @end itemize
28000
28001 To enable this build mode a @code{cuirass-remote-server-configuration}
28002 record must be passed as @code{remote-server} argument of the
28003 @code{cuirass-configuration} record. The
28004 @code{cuirass-remote-server-configuration} record is described below.
28005
28006 This build mode scales way better than the default build mode. This is
28007 the build mode that is used on the GNU Guix build farm at
28008 @url{https://ci.guix.gnu.org}. It should be preferred when using
28009 Cuirass to build large amount of packages.
28010
28011 @deftp {Data Type} cuirass-remote-server-configuration
28012 Data type representing the configuration of the Cuirass remote-server.
28013
28014 @table @asis
28015 @item @code{backend-port} (default: @code{5555})
28016 The TCP port for communicating with @code{remote-worker} processes
28017 using ZMQ. It defaults to @code{5555}.
28018
28019 @item @code{log-port} (default: @code{5556})
28020 The TCP port of the log server. It defaults to @code{5556}.
28021
28022 @item @code{publish-port} (default: @code{5557})
28023 The TCP port of the publish server. It defaults to @code{5557}.
28024
28025 @item @code{log-file} (default: @code{"/var/log/cuirass-remote-server.log"})
28026 Location of the log file.
28027
28028 @item @code{cache} (default: @code{"/var/cache/cuirass/remote"})
28029 Use @var{cache} directory to cache build log files.
28030
28031 @item @code{trigger-url} (default: @code{#f})
28032 Once a substitute is successfully fetched, trigger substitute baking at
28033 @var{trigger-url}.
28034
28035 @item @code{publish?} (default: @code{#t})
28036 If set to false, do not start a publish server and ignore the
28037 @code{publish-port} argument. This can be useful if there is already a
28038 standalone publish server standing next to the remote server.
28039
28040 @item @code{public-key}
28041 @item @code{private-key}
28042 Use the specific @var{file}s as the public/private key pair used to sign
28043 the store items being published.
28044
28045 @end table
28046 @end deftp
28047
28048 At least one remote worker must also be started on any machine of the
28049 local network to actually perform the builds and report their status.
28050
28051 @deftp {Data Type} cuirass-remote-worker-configuration
28052 Data type representing the configuration of the Cuirass remote-worker.
28053
28054 @table @asis
28055 @item @code{cuirass} (default: @code{cuirass})
28056 The Cuirass package to use.
28057
28058 @item @code{workers} (default: @code{1})
28059 Start @var{workers} parallel workers.
28060
28061 @item @code{server} (default: @code{#f})
28062 Do not use Avahi discovery and connect to the given @code{server} IP
28063 address instead.
28064
28065 @item @code{systems} (default: @code{(list (%current-system))})
28066 Only request builds for the given @var{systems}.
28067
28068 @item @code{log-file} (default: @code{"/var/log/cuirass-remote-worker.log"})
28069 Location of the log file.
28070
28071 @item @code{publish-port} (default: @code{5558})
28072 The TCP port of the publish server. It defaults to @code{5558}.
28073
28074 @item @code{substitute-urls} (default: @code{%default-substitute-urls})
28075 The list of URLs where to look for substitutes by default.
28076
28077 @item @code{public-key}
28078 @item @code{private-key}
28079 Use the specific @var{file}s as the public/private key pair used to sign
28080 the store items being published.
28081
28082 @end table
28083 @end deftp
28084
28085 @subsubheading Laminar
28086
28087 @uref{https://laminar.ohwg.net/, Laminar} is a lightweight and modular
28088 Continuous Integration service. It doesn't have a configuration web UI
28089 instead uses version-controllable configuration files and scripts.
28090
28091 Laminar encourages the use of existing tools such as bash and cron
28092 instead of reinventing them.
28093
28094 @defvr {Scheme Procedure} laminar-service-type
28095 The type of the Laminar service. Its value must be a
28096 @code{laminar-configuration} object, as described below.
28097
28098 All configuration values have defaults, a minimal configuration to get
28099 Laminar running is shown below. By default, the web interface is
28100 available on port 8080.
28101
28102 @lisp
28103 (service laminar-service-type)
28104 @end lisp
28105 @end defvr
28106
28107 @deftp {Data Type} laminar-configuration
28108 Data type representing the configuration of Laminar.
28109
28110 @table @asis
28111 @item @code{laminar} (default: @code{laminar})
28112 The Laminar package to use.
28113
28114 @item @code{home-directory} (default: @code{"/var/lib/laminar"})
28115 The directory for job configurations and run directories.
28116
28117 @item @code{bind-http} (default: @code{"*:8080"})
28118 The interface/port or unix socket on which laminard should listen for
28119 incoming connections to the web frontend.
28120
28121 @item @code{bind-rpc} (default: @code{"unix-abstract:laminar"})
28122 The interface/port or unix socket on which laminard should listen for
28123 incoming commands such as build triggers.
28124
28125 @item @code{title} (default: @code{"Laminar"})
28126 The page title to show in the web frontend.
28127
28128 @item @code{keep-rundirs} (default: @code{0})
28129 Set to an integer defining how many rundirs to keep per job. The
28130 lowest-numbered ones will be deleted. The default is 0, meaning all run
28131 dirs will be immediately deleted.
28132
28133 @item @code{archive-url} (default: @code{#f})
28134 The web frontend served by laminard will use this URL to form links to
28135 artefacts archived jobs.
28136
28137 @item @code{base-url} (default: @code{#f})
28138 Base URL to use for links to laminar itself.
28139
28140 @end table
28141 @end deftp
28142
28143 @node Power Management Services
28144 @subsection Power Management Services
28145
28146 @cindex tlp
28147 @cindex power management with TLP
28148 @subsubheading TLP daemon
28149
28150 The @code{(gnu services pm)} module provides a Guix service definition
28151 for the Linux power management tool TLP.
28152
28153 TLP enables various powersaving modes in userspace and kernel.
28154 Contrary to @code{upower-service}, it is not a passive,
28155 monitoring tool, as it will apply custom settings each time a new power
28156 source is detected. More information can be found at
28157 @uref{https://linrunner.de/en/tlp/tlp.html, TLP home page}.
28158
28159 @deffn {Scheme Variable} tlp-service-type
28160 The service type for the TLP tool. The default settings are optimised
28161 for battery life on most systems, but you can tweak them to your heart's
28162 content by adding a valid @code{tlp-configuration}:
28163 @lisp
28164 (service tlp-service-type
28165 (tlp-configuration
28166 (cpu-scaling-governor-on-ac (list "performance"))
28167 (sched-powersave-on-bat? #t)))
28168 @end lisp
28169 @end deffn
28170
28171 Each parameter definition is preceded by its type; for example,
28172 @samp{boolean foo} indicates that the @code{foo} parameter
28173 should be specified as a boolean. Types starting with
28174 @code{maybe-} denote parameters that won't show up in TLP config file
28175 when their value is @code{'disabled}.
28176
28177 @c The following documentation was initially generated by
28178 @c (generate-tlp-documentation) in (gnu services pm). Manually maintained
28179 @c documentation is better, so we shouldn't hesitate to edit below as
28180 @c needed. However if the change you want to make to this documentation
28181 @c can be done in an automated way, it's probably easier to change
28182 @c (generate-documentation) than to make it below and have to deal with
28183 @c the churn as TLP updates.
28184
28185 Available @code{tlp-configuration} fields are:
28186
28187 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} package tlp
28188 The TLP package.
28189
28190 @end deftypevr
28191
28192 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} boolean tlp-enable?
28193 Set to true if you wish to enable TLP.
28194
28195 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
28196
28197 @end deftypevr
28198
28199 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} string tlp-default-mode
28200 Default mode when no power supply can be detected. Alternatives are AC
28201 and BAT.
28202
28203 Defaults to @samp{"AC"}.
28204
28205 @end deftypevr
28206
28207 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer disk-idle-secs-on-ac
28208 Number of seconds Linux kernel has to wait after the disk goes idle,
28209 before syncing on AC.
28210
28211 Defaults to @samp{0}.
28212
28213 @end deftypevr
28214
28215 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer disk-idle-secs-on-bat
28216 Same as @code{disk-idle-ac} but on BAT mode.
28217
28218 Defaults to @samp{2}.
28219
28220 @end deftypevr
28221
28222 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer max-lost-work-secs-on-ac
28223 Dirty pages flushing periodicity, expressed in seconds.
28224
28225 Defaults to @samp{15}.
28226
28227 @end deftypevr
28228
28229 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer max-lost-work-secs-on-bat
28230 Same as @code{max-lost-work-secs-on-ac} but on BAT mode.
28231
28232 Defaults to @samp{60}.
28233
28234 @end deftypevr
28235
28236 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-space-separated-string-list cpu-scaling-governor-on-ac
28237 CPU frequency scaling governor on AC mode. With intel_pstate driver,
28238 alternatives are powersave and performance. With acpi-cpufreq driver,
28239 alternatives are ondemand, powersave, performance and conservative.
28240
28241 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
28242
28243 @end deftypevr
28244
28245 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-space-separated-string-list cpu-scaling-governor-on-bat
28246 Same as @code{cpu-scaling-governor-on-ac} but on BAT mode.
28247
28248 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
28249
28250 @end deftypevr
28251
28252 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-non-negative-integer cpu-scaling-min-freq-on-ac
28253 Set the min available frequency for the scaling governor on AC.
28254
28255 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
28256
28257 @end deftypevr
28258
28259 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-non-negative-integer cpu-scaling-max-freq-on-ac
28260 Set the max available frequency for the scaling governor on AC.
28261
28262 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
28263
28264 @end deftypevr
28265
28266 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-non-negative-integer cpu-scaling-min-freq-on-bat
28267 Set the min available frequency for the scaling governor on BAT.
28268
28269 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
28270
28271 @end deftypevr
28272
28273 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-non-negative-integer cpu-scaling-max-freq-on-bat
28274 Set the max available frequency for the scaling governor on BAT.
28275
28276 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
28277
28278 @end deftypevr
28279
28280 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-non-negative-integer cpu-min-perf-on-ac
28281 Limit the min P-state to control the power dissipation of the CPU, in AC
28282 mode. Values are stated as a percentage of the available performance.
28283
28284 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
28285
28286 @end deftypevr
28287
28288 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-non-negative-integer cpu-max-perf-on-ac
28289 Limit the max P-state to control the power dissipation of the CPU, in AC
28290 mode. Values are stated as a percentage of the available performance.
28291
28292 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
28293
28294 @end deftypevr
28295
28296 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-non-negative-integer cpu-min-perf-on-bat
28297 Same as @code{cpu-min-perf-on-ac} on BAT mode.
28298
28299 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
28300
28301 @end deftypevr
28302
28303 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-non-negative-integer cpu-max-perf-on-bat
28304 Same as @code{cpu-max-perf-on-ac} on BAT mode.
28305
28306 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
28307
28308 @end deftypevr
28309
28310 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-boolean cpu-boost-on-ac?
28311 Enable CPU turbo boost feature on AC mode.
28312
28313 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
28314
28315 @end deftypevr
28316
28317 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-boolean cpu-boost-on-bat?
28318 Same as @code{cpu-boost-on-ac?} on BAT mode.
28319
28320 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
28321
28322 @end deftypevr
28323
28324 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} boolean sched-powersave-on-ac?
28325 Allow Linux kernel to minimize the number of CPU cores/hyper-threads
28326 used under light load conditions.
28327
28328 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
28329
28330 @end deftypevr
28331
28332 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} boolean sched-powersave-on-bat?
28333 Same as @code{sched-powersave-on-ac?} but on BAT mode.
28334
28335 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
28336
28337 @end deftypevr
28338
28339 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} boolean nmi-watchdog?
28340 Enable Linux kernel NMI watchdog.
28341
28342 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
28343
28344 @end deftypevr
28345
28346 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-string phc-controls
28347 For Linux kernels with PHC patch applied, change CPU voltages. An
28348 example value would be @samp{"F:V F:V F:V F:V"}.
28349
28350 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
28351
28352 @end deftypevr
28353
28354 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} string energy-perf-policy-on-ac
28355 Set CPU performance versus energy saving policy on AC@. Alternatives are
28356 performance, normal, powersave.
28357
28358 Defaults to @samp{"performance"}.
28359
28360 @end deftypevr
28361
28362 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} string energy-perf-policy-on-bat
28363 Same as @code{energy-perf-policy-ac} but on BAT mode.
28364
28365 Defaults to @samp{"powersave"}.
28366
28367 @end deftypevr
28368
28369 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list disks-devices
28370 Hard disk devices.
28371
28372 @end deftypevr
28373
28374 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list disk-apm-level-on-ac
28375 Hard disk advanced power management level.
28376
28377 @end deftypevr
28378
28379 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list disk-apm-level-on-bat
28380 Same as @code{disk-apm-bat} but on BAT mode.
28381
28382 @end deftypevr
28383
28384 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-space-separated-string-list disk-spindown-timeout-on-ac
28385 Hard disk spin down timeout. One value has to be specified for each
28386 declared hard disk.
28387
28388 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
28389
28390 @end deftypevr
28391
28392 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-space-separated-string-list disk-spindown-timeout-on-bat
28393 Same as @code{disk-spindown-timeout-on-ac} but on BAT mode.
28394
28395 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
28396
28397 @end deftypevr
28398
28399 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-space-separated-string-list disk-iosched
28400 Select IO scheduler for disk devices. One value has to be specified for
28401 each declared hard disk. Example alternatives are cfq, deadline and
28402 noop.
28403
28404 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
28405
28406 @end deftypevr
28407
28408 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} string sata-linkpwr-on-ac
28409 SATA aggressive link power management (ALPM) level. Alternatives are
28410 min_power, medium_power, max_performance.
28411
28412 Defaults to @samp{"max_performance"}.
28413
28414 @end deftypevr
28415
28416 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} string sata-linkpwr-on-bat
28417 Same as @code{sata-linkpwr-ac} but on BAT mode.
28418
28419 Defaults to @samp{"min_power"}.
28420
28421 @end deftypevr
28422
28423 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-string sata-linkpwr-blacklist
28424 Exclude specified SATA host devices for link power management.
28425
28426 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
28427
28428 @end deftypevr
28429
28430 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-on-off-boolean ahci-runtime-pm-on-ac?
28431 Enable Runtime Power Management for AHCI controller and disks on AC
28432 mode.
28433
28434 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
28435
28436 @end deftypevr
28437
28438 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-on-off-boolean ahci-runtime-pm-on-bat?
28439 Same as @code{ahci-runtime-pm-on-ac} on BAT mode.
28440
28441 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
28442
28443 @end deftypevr
28444
28445 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer ahci-runtime-pm-timeout
28446 Seconds of inactivity before disk is suspended.
28447
28448 Defaults to @samp{15}.
28449
28450 @end deftypevr
28451
28452 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} string pcie-aspm-on-ac
28453 PCI Express Active State Power Management level. Alternatives are
28454 default, performance, powersave.
28455
28456 Defaults to @samp{"performance"}.
28457
28458 @end deftypevr
28459
28460 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} string pcie-aspm-on-bat
28461 Same as @code{pcie-aspm-ac} but on BAT mode.
28462
28463 Defaults to @samp{"powersave"}.
28464
28465 @end deftypevr
28466
28467 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} string radeon-power-profile-on-ac
28468 Radeon graphics clock speed level. Alternatives are low, mid, high,
28469 auto, default.
28470
28471 Defaults to @samp{"high"}.
28472
28473 @end deftypevr
28474
28475 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} string radeon-power-profile-on-bat
28476 Same as @code{radeon-power-ac} but on BAT mode.
28477
28478 Defaults to @samp{"low"}.
28479
28480 @end deftypevr
28481
28482 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} string radeon-dpm-state-on-ac
28483 Radeon dynamic power management method (DPM). Alternatives are battery,
28484 performance.
28485
28486 Defaults to @samp{"performance"}.
28487
28488 @end deftypevr
28489
28490 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} string radeon-dpm-state-on-bat
28491 Same as @code{radeon-dpm-state-ac} but on BAT mode.
28492
28493 Defaults to @samp{"battery"}.
28494
28495 @end deftypevr
28496
28497 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} string radeon-dpm-perf-level-on-ac
28498 Radeon DPM performance level. Alternatives are auto, low, high.
28499
28500 Defaults to @samp{"auto"}.
28501
28502 @end deftypevr
28503
28504 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} string radeon-dpm-perf-level-on-bat
28505 Same as @code{radeon-dpm-perf-ac} but on BAT mode.
28506
28507 Defaults to @samp{"auto"}.
28508
28509 @end deftypevr
28510
28511 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} on-off-boolean wifi-pwr-on-ac?
28512 Wifi power saving mode.
28513
28514 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
28515
28516 @end deftypevr
28517
28518 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} on-off-boolean wifi-pwr-on-bat?
28519 Same as @code{wifi-power-ac?} but on BAT mode.
28520
28521 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
28522
28523 @end deftypevr
28524
28525 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} y-n-boolean wol-disable?
28526 Disable wake on LAN.
28527
28528 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
28529
28530 @end deftypevr
28531
28532 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer sound-power-save-on-ac
28533 Timeout duration in seconds before activating audio power saving on
28534 Intel HDA and AC97 devices. A value of 0 disables power saving.
28535
28536 Defaults to @samp{0}.
28537
28538 @end deftypevr
28539
28540 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer sound-power-save-on-bat
28541 Same as @code{sound-powersave-ac} but on BAT mode.
28542
28543 Defaults to @samp{1}.
28544
28545 @end deftypevr
28546
28547 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} y-n-boolean sound-power-save-controller?
28548 Disable controller in powersaving mode on Intel HDA devices.
28549
28550 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
28551
28552 @end deftypevr
28553
28554 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} boolean bay-poweroff-on-bat?
28555 Enable optical drive in UltraBay/MediaBay on BAT mode. Drive can be
28556 powered on again by releasing (and reinserting) the eject lever or by
28557 pressing the disc eject button on newer models.
28558
28559 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
28560
28561 @end deftypevr
28562
28563 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} string bay-device
28564 Name of the optical drive device to power off.
28565
28566 Defaults to @samp{"sr0"}.
28567
28568 @end deftypevr
28569
28570 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} string runtime-pm-on-ac
28571 Runtime Power Management for PCI(e) bus devices. Alternatives are on
28572 and auto.
28573
28574 Defaults to @samp{"on"}.
28575
28576 @end deftypevr
28577
28578 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} string runtime-pm-on-bat
28579 Same as @code{runtime-pm-ac} but on BAT mode.
28580
28581 Defaults to @samp{"auto"}.
28582
28583 @end deftypevr
28584
28585 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} boolean runtime-pm-all?
28586 Runtime Power Management for all PCI(e) bus devices, except blacklisted
28587 ones.
28588
28589 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
28590
28591 @end deftypevr
28592
28593 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-space-separated-string-list runtime-pm-blacklist
28594 Exclude specified PCI(e) device addresses from Runtime Power Management.
28595
28596 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
28597
28598 @end deftypevr
28599
28600 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list runtime-pm-driver-blacklist
28601 Exclude PCI(e) devices assigned to the specified drivers from Runtime
28602 Power Management.
28603
28604 @end deftypevr
28605
28606 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} boolean usb-autosuspend?
28607 Enable USB autosuspend feature.
28608
28609 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
28610
28611 @end deftypevr
28612
28613 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-string usb-blacklist
28614 Exclude specified devices from USB autosuspend.
28615
28616 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
28617
28618 @end deftypevr
28619
28620 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} boolean usb-blacklist-wwan?
28621 Exclude WWAN devices from USB autosuspend.
28622
28623 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
28624
28625 @end deftypevr
28626
28627 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-string usb-whitelist
28628 Include specified devices into USB autosuspend, even if they are already
28629 excluded by the driver or via @code{usb-blacklist-wwan?}.
28630
28631 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
28632
28633 @end deftypevr
28634
28635 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-boolean usb-autosuspend-disable-on-shutdown?
28636 Enable USB autosuspend before shutdown.
28637
28638 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
28639
28640 @end deftypevr
28641
28642 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} boolean restore-device-state-on-startup?
28643 Restore radio device state (bluetooth, wifi, wwan) from previous
28644 shutdown on system startup.
28645
28646 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
28647
28648 @end deftypevr
28649
28650 @cindex thermald
28651 @cindex CPU frequency scaling with thermald
28652 @subsubheading Thermald daemon
28653
28654 The @code{(gnu services pm)} module provides an interface to
28655 thermald, a CPU frequency scaling service which helps prevent overheating.
28656
28657 @defvr {Scheme Variable} thermald-service-type
28658 This is the service type for
28659 @uref{https://01.org/linux-thermal-daemon/, thermald}, the Linux
28660 Thermal Daemon, which is responsible for controlling the thermal state
28661 of processors and preventing overheating.
28662 @end defvr
28663
28664 @deftp {Data Type} thermald-configuration
28665 Data type representing the configuration of @code{thermald-service-type}.
28666
28667 @table @asis
28668 @item @code{ignore-cpuid-check?} (default: @code{#f})
28669 Ignore cpuid check for supported CPU models.
28670
28671 @item @code{thermald} (default: @var{thermald})
28672 Package object of thermald.
28673
28674 @end table
28675 @end deftp
28676
28677 @node Audio Services
28678 @subsection Audio Services
28679
28680 The @code{(gnu services audio)} module provides a service to start MPD
28681 (the Music Player Daemon).
28682
28683 @cindex mpd
28684 @subsubheading Music Player Daemon
28685
28686 The Music Player Daemon (MPD) is a service that can play music while
28687 being controlled from the local machine or over the network by a variety
28688 of clients.
28689
28690 The following example shows how one might run @code{mpd} as user
28691 @code{"bob"} on port @code{6666}. It uses pulseaudio for output.
28692
28693 @lisp
28694 (service mpd-service-type
28695 (mpd-configuration
28696 (user "bob")
28697 (port "6666")))
28698 @end lisp
28699
28700 @defvr {Scheme Variable} mpd-service-type
28701 The service type for @command{mpd}
28702 @end defvr
28703
28704 @deftp {Data Type} mpd-configuration
28705 Data type representing the configuration of @command{mpd}.
28706
28707 @table @asis
28708 @item @code{user} (default: @code{"mpd"})
28709 The user to run mpd as.
28710
28711 @item @code{music-dir} (default: @code{"~/Music"})
28712 The directory to scan for music files.
28713
28714 @item @code{playlist-dir} (default: @code{"~/.mpd/playlists"})
28715 The directory to store playlists.
28716
28717 @item @code{db-file} (default: @code{"~/.mpd/tag_cache"})
28718 The location of the music database.
28719
28720 @item @code{state-file} (default: @code{"~/.mpd/state"})
28721 The location of the file that stores current MPD's state.
28722
28723 @item @code{sticker-file} (default: @code{"~/.mpd/sticker.sql"})
28724 The location of the sticker database.
28725
28726 @item @code{port} (default: @code{"6600"})
28727 The port to run mpd on.
28728
28729 @item @code{address} (default: @code{"any"})
28730 The address that mpd will bind to. To use a Unix domain socket,
28731 an absolute path can be specified here.
28732
28733 @item @code{outputs} (default: @code{"(list (mpd-output))"})
28734 The audio outputs that MPD can use. By default this is a single output using pulseaudio.
28735
28736 @end table
28737 @end deftp
28738
28739 @deftp {Data Type} mpd-output
28740 Data type representing an @command{mpd} audio output.
28741
28742 @table @asis
28743 @item @code{name} (default: @code{"MPD"})
28744 The name of the audio output.
28745
28746 @item @code{type} (default: @code{"pulse"})
28747 The type of audio output.
28748
28749 @item @code{enabled?} (default: @code{#t})
28750 Specifies whether this audio output is enabled when MPD is started. By
28751 default, all audio outputs are enabled. This is just the default
28752 setting when there is no state file; with a state file, the previous
28753 state is restored.
28754
28755 @item @code{tags?} (default: @code{#t})
28756 If set to @code{#f}, then MPD will not send tags to this output. This
28757 is only useful for output plugins that can receive tags, for example the
28758 @code{httpd} output plugin.
28759
28760 @item @code{always-on?} (default: @code{#f})
28761 If set to @code{#t}, then MPD attempts to keep this audio output always
28762 open. This may be useful for streaming servers, when you don’t want to
28763 disconnect all listeners even when playback is accidentally stopped.
28764
28765 @item @code{mixer-type}
28766 This field accepts a symbol that specifies which mixer should be used
28767 for this audio output: the @code{hardware} mixer, the @code{software}
28768 mixer, the @code{null} mixer (allows setting the volume, but with no
28769 effect; this can be used as a trick to implement an external mixer
28770 External Mixer) or no mixer (@code{none}).
28771
28772 @item @code{extra-options} (default: @code{'()})
28773 An association list of option symbols to string values to be appended to
28774 the audio output configuration.
28775
28776 @end table
28777 @end deftp
28778
28779 The following example shows a configuration of @code{mpd} that provides
28780 an HTTP audio streaming output.
28781
28782 @lisp
28783 (service mpd-service-type
28784 (mpd-configuration
28785 (outputs
28786 (list (mpd-output
28787 (name "streaming")
28788 (type "httpd")
28789 (mixer-type 'null)
28790 (extra-options
28791 `((encoder . "vorbis")
28792 (port . "8080"))))))))
28793 @end lisp
28794
28795
28796 @node Virtualization Services
28797 @subsection Virtualization Services
28798
28799 The @code{(gnu services virtualization)} module provides services for
28800 the libvirt and virtlog daemons, as well as other virtualization-related
28801 services.
28802
28803 @subsubheading Libvirt daemon
28804
28805 @code{libvirtd} is the server side daemon component of the libvirt
28806 virtualization management system. This daemon runs on host servers
28807 and performs required management tasks for virtualized guests.
28808
28809 @deffn {Scheme Variable} libvirt-service-type
28810 This is the type of the @uref{https://libvirt.org, libvirt daemon}.
28811 Its value must be a @code{libvirt-configuration}.
28812
28813 @lisp
28814 (service libvirt-service-type
28815 (libvirt-configuration
28816 (unix-sock-group "libvirt")
28817 (tls-port "16555")))
28818 @end lisp
28819 @end deffn
28820
28821 @c Auto-generated with (generate-libvirt-documentation)
28822 Available @code{libvirt-configuration} fields are:
28823
28824 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} package libvirt
28825 Libvirt package.
28826
28827 @end deftypevr
28828
28829 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} boolean listen-tls?
28830 Flag listening for secure TLS connections on the public TCP/IP port.
28831 You must set @code{listen} for this to have any effect.
28832
28833 It is necessary to setup a CA and issue server certificates before using
28834 this capability.
28835
28836 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
28837
28838 @end deftypevr
28839
28840 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} boolean listen-tcp?
28841 Listen for unencrypted TCP connections on the public TCP/IP port. You must
28842 set @code{listen} for this to have any effect.
28843
28844 Using the TCP socket requires SASL authentication by default. Only SASL
28845 mechanisms which support data encryption are allowed. This is
28846 DIGEST_MD5 and GSSAPI (Kerberos5).
28847
28848 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
28849
28850 @end deftypevr
28851
28852 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} string tls-port
28853 Port for accepting secure TLS connections. This can be a port number,
28854 or service name.
28855
28856 Defaults to @samp{"16514"}.
28857
28858 @end deftypevr
28859
28860 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} string tcp-port
28861 Port for accepting insecure TCP connections. This can be a port number,
28862 or service name.
28863
28864 Defaults to @samp{"16509"}.
28865
28866 @end deftypevr
28867
28868 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} string listen-addr
28869 IP address or hostname used for client connections.
28870
28871 Defaults to @samp{"0.0.0.0"}.
28872
28873 @end deftypevr
28874
28875 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} boolean mdns-adv?
28876 Flag toggling mDNS advertisement of the libvirt service.
28877
28878 Alternatively can disable for all services on a host by stopping the
28879 Avahi daemon.
28880
28881 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
28882
28883 @end deftypevr
28884
28885 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} string mdns-name
28886 Default mDNS advertisement name. This must be unique on the immediate
28887 broadcast network.
28888
28889 Defaults to @samp{"Virtualization Host <hostname>"}.
28890
28891 @end deftypevr
28892
28893 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} string unix-sock-group
28894 UNIX domain socket group ownership. This can be used to allow a
28895 'trusted' set of users access to management capabilities without
28896 becoming root.
28897
28898 Defaults to @samp{"root"}.
28899
28900 @end deftypevr
28901
28902 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} string unix-sock-ro-perms
28903 UNIX socket permissions for the R/O socket. This is used for monitoring
28904 VM status only.
28905
28906 Defaults to @samp{"0777"}.
28907
28908 @end deftypevr
28909
28910 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} string unix-sock-rw-perms
28911 UNIX socket permissions for the R/W socket. Default allows only root.
28912 If PolicyKit is enabled on the socket, the default will change to allow
28913 everyone (eg, 0777)
28914
28915 Defaults to @samp{"0770"}.
28916
28917 @end deftypevr
28918
28919 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} string unix-sock-admin-perms
28920 UNIX socket permissions for the admin socket. Default allows only owner
28921 (root), do not change it unless you are sure to whom you are exposing
28922 the access to.
28923
28924 Defaults to @samp{"0777"}.
28925
28926 @end deftypevr
28927
28928 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} string unix-sock-dir
28929 The directory in which sockets will be found/created.
28930
28931 Defaults to @samp{"/var/run/libvirt"}.
28932
28933 @end deftypevr
28934
28935 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} string auth-unix-ro
28936 Authentication scheme for UNIX read-only sockets. By default socket
28937 permissions allow anyone to connect
28938
28939 Defaults to @samp{"polkit"}.
28940
28941 @end deftypevr
28942
28943 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} string auth-unix-rw
28944 Authentication scheme for UNIX read-write sockets. By default socket
28945 permissions only allow root. If PolicyKit support was compiled into
28946 libvirt, the default will be to use 'polkit' auth.
28947
28948 Defaults to @samp{"polkit"}.
28949
28950 @end deftypevr
28951
28952 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} string auth-tcp
28953 Authentication scheme for TCP sockets. If you don't enable SASL, then
28954 all TCP traffic is cleartext. Don't do this outside of a dev/test
28955 scenario.
28956
28957 Defaults to @samp{"sasl"}.
28958
28959 @end deftypevr
28960
28961 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} string auth-tls
28962 Authentication scheme for TLS sockets. TLS sockets already have
28963 encryption provided by the TLS layer, and limited authentication is done
28964 by certificates.
28965
28966 It is possible to make use of any SASL authentication mechanism as well,
28967 by using 'sasl' for this option
28968
28969 Defaults to @samp{"none"}.
28970
28971 @end deftypevr
28972
28973 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} optional-list access-drivers
28974 API access control scheme.
28975
28976 By default an authenticated user is allowed access to all APIs. Access
28977 drivers can place restrictions on this.
28978
28979 Defaults to @samp{()}.
28980
28981 @end deftypevr
28982
28983 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} string key-file
28984 Server key file path. If set to an empty string, then no private key is
28985 loaded.
28986
28987 Defaults to @samp{""}.
28988
28989 @end deftypevr
28990
28991 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} string cert-file
28992 Server key file path. If set to an empty string, then no certificate is
28993 loaded.
28994
28995 Defaults to @samp{""}.
28996
28997 @end deftypevr
28998
28999 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} string ca-file
29000 Server key file path. If set to an empty string, then no CA certificate
29001 is loaded.
29002
29003 Defaults to @samp{""}.
29004
29005 @end deftypevr
29006
29007 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} string crl-file
29008 Certificate revocation list path. If set to an empty string, then no
29009 CRL is loaded.
29010
29011 Defaults to @samp{""}.
29012
29013 @end deftypevr
29014
29015 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} boolean tls-no-sanity-cert
29016 Disable verification of our own server certificates.
29017
29018 When libvirtd starts it performs some sanity checks against its own
29019 certificates.
29020
29021 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
29022
29023 @end deftypevr
29024
29025 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} boolean tls-no-verify-cert
29026 Disable verification of client certificates.
29027
29028 Client certificate verification is the primary authentication mechanism.
29029 Any client which does not present a certificate signed by the CA will be
29030 rejected.
29031
29032 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
29033
29034 @end deftypevr
29035
29036 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} optional-list tls-allowed-dn-list
29037 Whitelist of allowed x509 Distinguished Name.
29038
29039 Defaults to @samp{()}.
29040
29041 @end deftypevr
29042
29043 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} optional-list sasl-allowed-usernames
29044 Whitelist of allowed SASL usernames. The format for username depends on
29045 the SASL authentication mechanism.
29046
29047 Defaults to @samp{()}.
29048
29049 @end deftypevr
29050
29051 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} string tls-priority
29052 Override the compile time default TLS priority string. The default is
29053 usually @samp{"NORMAL"} unless overridden at build time. Only set this is it
29054 is desired for libvirt to deviate from the global default settings.
29055
29056 Defaults to @samp{"NORMAL"}.
29057
29058 @end deftypevr
29059
29060 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} integer max-clients
29061 Maximum number of concurrent client connections to allow over all
29062 sockets combined.
29063
29064 Defaults to @samp{5000}.
29065
29066 @end deftypevr
29067
29068 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} integer max-queued-clients
29069 Maximum length of queue of connections waiting to be accepted by the
29070 daemon. Note, that some protocols supporting retransmission may obey
29071 this so that a later reattempt at connection succeeds.
29072
29073 Defaults to @samp{1000}.
29074
29075 @end deftypevr
29076
29077 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} integer max-anonymous-clients
29078 Maximum length of queue of accepted but not yet authenticated clients.
29079 Set this to zero to turn this feature off
29080
29081 Defaults to @samp{20}.
29082
29083 @end deftypevr
29084
29085 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} integer min-workers
29086 Number of workers to start up initially.
29087
29088 Defaults to @samp{5}.
29089
29090 @end deftypevr
29091
29092 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} integer max-workers
29093 Maximum number of worker threads.
29094
29095 If the number of active clients exceeds @code{min-workers}, then more
29096 threads are spawned, up to max_workers limit. Typically you'd want
29097 max_workers to equal maximum number of clients allowed.
29098
29099 Defaults to @samp{20}.
29100
29101 @end deftypevr
29102
29103 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} integer prio-workers
29104 Number of priority workers. If all workers from above pool are stuck,
29105 some calls marked as high priority (notably domainDestroy) can be
29106 executed in this pool.
29107
29108 Defaults to @samp{5}.
29109
29110 @end deftypevr
29111
29112 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} integer max-requests
29113 Total global limit on concurrent RPC calls.
29114
29115 Defaults to @samp{20}.
29116
29117 @end deftypevr
29118
29119 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} integer max-client-requests
29120 Limit on concurrent requests from a single client connection. To avoid
29121 one client monopolizing the server this should be a small fraction of
29122 the global max_requests and max_workers parameter.
29123
29124 Defaults to @samp{5}.
29125
29126 @end deftypevr
29127
29128 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} integer admin-min-workers
29129 Same as @code{min-workers} but for the admin interface.
29130
29131 Defaults to @samp{1}.
29132
29133 @end deftypevr
29134
29135 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} integer admin-max-workers
29136 Same as @code{max-workers} but for the admin interface.
29137
29138 Defaults to @samp{5}.
29139
29140 @end deftypevr
29141
29142 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} integer admin-max-clients
29143 Same as @code{max-clients} but for the admin interface.
29144
29145 Defaults to @samp{5}.
29146
29147 @end deftypevr
29148
29149 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} integer admin-max-queued-clients
29150 Same as @code{max-queued-clients} but for the admin interface.
29151
29152 Defaults to @samp{5}.
29153
29154 @end deftypevr
29155
29156 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} integer admin-max-client-requests
29157 Same as @code{max-client-requests} but for the admin interface.
29158
29159 Defaults to @samp{5}.
29160
29161 @end deftypevr
29162
29163 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} integer log-level
29164 Logging level. 4 errors, 3 warnings, 2 information, 1 debug.
29165
29166 Defaults to @samp{3}.
29167
29168 @end deftypevr
29169
29170 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} string log-filters
29171 Logging filters.
29172
29173 A filter allows to select a different logging level for a given category
29174 of logs. The format for a filter is one of:
29175
29176 @itemize @bullet
29177 @item
29178 x:name
29179
29180 @item
29181 x:+name
29182
29183 @end itemize
29184
29185 where @code{name} is a string which is matched against the category
29186 given in the @code{VIR_LOG_INIT()} at the top of each libvirt source
29187 file, e.g., @samp{"remote"}, @samp{"qemu"}, or @samp{"util.json"} (the
29188 name in the filter can be a substring of the full category name, in
29189 order to match multiple similar categories), the optional @samp{"+"}
29190 prefix tells libvirt to log stack trace for each message matching name,
29191 and @code{x} is the minimal level where matching messages should be
29192 logged:
29193
29194 @itemize @bullet
29195 @item
29196 1: DEBUG
29197
29198 @item
29199 2: INFO
29200
29201 @item
29202 3: WARNING
29203
29204 @item
29205 4: ERROR
29206
29207 @end itemize
29208
29209 Multiple filters can be defined in a single filters statement, they just
29210 need to be separated by spaces.
29211
29212 Defaults to @samp{"3:remote 4:event"}.
29213
29214 @end deftypevr
29215
29216 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} string log-outputs
29217 Logging outputs.
29218
29219 An output is one of the places to save logging information. The format
29220 for an output can be:
29221
29222 @table @code
29223 @item x:stderr
29224 output goes to stderr
29225
29226 @item x:syslog:name
29227 use syslog for the output and use the given name as the ident
29228
29229 @item x:file:file_path
29230 output to a file, with the given filepath
29231
29232 @item x:journald
29233 output to journald logging system
29234
29235 @end table
29236
29237 In all case the x prefix is the minimal level, acting as a filter
29238
29239 @itemize @bullet
29240 @item
29241 1: DEBUG
29242
29243 @item
29244 2: INFO
29245
29246 @item
29247 3: WARNING
29248
29249 @item
29250 4: ERROR
29251
29252 @end itemize
29253
29254 Multiple outputs can be defined, they just need to be separated by
29255 spaces.
29256
29257 Defaults to @samp{"3:stderr"}.
29258
29259 @end deftypevr
29260
29261 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} integer audit-level
29262 Allows usage of the auditing subsystem to be altered
29263
29264 @itemize @bullet
29265 @item
29266 0: disable all auditing
29267
29268 @item
29269 1: enable auditing, only if enabled on host
29270
29271 @item
29272 2: enable auditing, and exit if disabled on host.
29273
29274 @end itemize
29275
29276 Defaults to @samp{1}.
29277
29278 @end deftypevr
29279
29280 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} boolean audit-logging
29281 Send audit messages via libvirt logging infrastructure.
29282
29283 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
29284
29285 @end deftypevr
29286
29287 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} optional-string host-uuid
29288 Host UUID@. UUID must not have all digits be the same.
29289
29290 Defaults to @samp{""}.
29291
29292 @end deftypevr
29293
29294 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} string host-uuid-source
29295 Source to read host UUID.
29296
29297 @itemize @bullet
29298 @item
29299 @code{smbios}: fetch the UUID from @code{dmidecode -s system-uuid}
29300
29301 @item
29302 @code{machine-id}: fetch the UUID from @code{/etc/machine-id}
29303
29304 @end itemize
29305
29306 If @code{dmidecode} does not provide a valid UUID a temporary UUID will
29307 be generated.
29308
29309 Defaults to @samp{"smbios"}.
29310
29311 @end deftypevr
29312
29313 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} integer keepalive-interval
29314 A keepalive message is sent to a client after @code{keepalive_interval}
29315 seconds of inactivity to check if the client is still responding. If
29316 set to -1, libvirtd will never send keepalive requests; however clients
29317 can still send them and the daemon will send responses.
29318
29319 Defaults to @samp{5}.
29320
29321 @end deftypevr
29322
29323 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} integer keepalive-count
29324 Maximum number of keepalive messages that are allowed to be sent to the
29325 client without getting any response before the connection is considered
29326 broken.
29327
29328 In other words, the connection is automatically closed approximately
29329 after @code{keepalive_interval * (keepalive_count + 1)} seconds since
29330 the last message received from the client. When @code{keepalive-count}
29331 is set to 0, connections will be automatically closed after
29332 @code{keepalive-interval} seconds of inactivity without sending any
29333 keepalive messages.
29334
29335 Defaults to @samp{5}.
29336
29337 @end deftypevr
29338
29339 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} integer admin-keepalive-interval
29340 Same as above but for admin interface.
29341
29342 Defaults to @samp{5}.
29343
29344 @end deftypevr
29345
29346 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} integer admin-keepalive-count
29347 Same as above but for admin interface.
29348
29349 Defaults to @samp{5}.
29350
29351 @end deftypevr
29352
29353 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} integer ovs-timeout
29354 Timeout for Open vSwitch calls.
29355
29356 The @code{ovs-vsctl} utility is used for the configuration and its
29357 timeout option is set by default to 5 seconds to avoid potential
29358 infinite waits blocking libvirt.
29359
29360 Defaults to @samp{5}.
29361
29362 @end deftypevr
29363
29364 @c %end of autogenerated docs
29365
29366 @subsubheading Virtlog daemon
29367 The virtlogd service is a server side daemon component of libvirt that is
29368 used to manage logs from virtual machine consoles.
29369
29370 This daemon is not used directly by libvirt client applications, rather it
29371 is called on their behalf by @code{libvirtd}. By maintaining the logs in a
29372 standalone daemon, the main @code{libvirtd} daemon can be restarted without
29373 risk of losing logs. The @code{virtlogd} daemon has the ability to re-exec()
29374 itself upon receiving @code{SIGUSR1}, to allow live upgrades without downtime.
29375
29376 @deffn {Scheme Variable} virtlog-service-type
29377 This is the type of the virtlog daemon.
29378 Its value must be a @code{virtlog-configuration}.
29379
29380 @lisp
29381 (service virtlog-service-type
29382 (virtlog-configuration
29383 (max-clients 1000)))
29384 @end lisp
29385 @end deffn
29386
29387 @deftypevr {@code{virtlog-configuration} parameter} integer log-level
29388 Logging level. 4 errors, 3 warnings, 2 information, 1 debug.
29389
29390 Defaults to @samp{3}.
29391
29392 @end deftypevr
29393
29394 @deftypevr {@code{virtlog-configuration} parameter} string log-filters
29395 Logging filters.
29396
29397 A filter allows to select a different logging level for a given category
29398 of logs The format for a filter is one of:
29399
29400 @itemize @bullet
29401 @item
29402 x:name
29403
29404 @item
29405 x:+name
29406
29407 @end itemize
29408
29409 where @code{name} is a string which is matched against the category
29410 given in the @code{VIR_LOG_INIT()} at the top of each libvirt source
29411 file, e.g., "remote", "qemu", or "util.json" (the name in the filter can
29412 be a substring of the full category name, in order to match multiple
29413 similar categories), the optional "+" prefix tells libvirt to log stack
29414 trace for each message matching name, and @code{x} is the minimal level
29415 where matching messages should be logged:
29416
29417 @itemize @bullet
29418 @item
29419 1: DEBUG
29420
29421 @item
29422 2: INFO
29423
29424 @item
29425 3: WARNING
29426
29427 @item
29428 4: ERROR
29429
29430 @end itemize
29431
29432 Multiple filters can be defined in a single filters statement, they just
29433 need to be separated by spaces.
29434
29435 Defaults to @samp{"3:remote 4:event"}.
29436
29437 @end deftypevr
29438
29439 @deftypevr {@code{virtlog-configuration} parameter} string log-outputs
29440 Logging outputs.
29441
29442 An output is one of the places to save logging information The format
29443 for an output can be:
29444
29445 @table @code
29446 @item x:stderr
29447 output goes to stderr
29448
29449 @item x:syslog:name
29450 use syslog for the output and use the given name as the ident
29451
29452 @item x:file:file_path
29453 output to a file, with the given filepath
29454
29455 @item x:journald
29456 output to journald logging system
29457
29458 @end table
29459
29460 In all case the x prefix is the minimal level, acting as a filter
29461
29462 @itemize @bullet
29463 @item
29464 1: DEBUG
29465
29466 @item
29467 2: INFO
29468
29469 @item
29470 3: WARNING
29471
29472 @item
29473 4: ERROR
29474
29475 @end itemize
29476
29477 Multiple outputs can be defined, they just need to be separated by
29478 spaces.
29479
29480 Defaults to @samp{"3:stderr"}.
29481
29482 @end deftypevr
29483
29484 @deftypevr {@code{virtlog-configuration} parameter} integer max-clients
29485 Maximum number of concurrent client connections to allow over all
29486 sockets combined.
29487
29488 Defaults to @samp{1024}.
29489
29490 @end deftypevr
29491
29492 @deftypevr {@code{virtlog-configuration} parameter} integer max-size
29493 Maximum file size before rolling over.
29494
29495 Defaults to @samp{2MB}
29496
29497 @end deftypevr
29498
29499 @deftypevr {@code{virtlog-configuration} parameter} integer max-backups
29500 Maximum number of backup files to keep.
29501
29502 Defaults to @samp{3}
29503
29504 @end deftypevr
29505
29506 @anchor{transparent-emulation-qemu}
29507 @subsubheading Transparent Emulation with QEMU
29508
29509 @cindex emulation
29510 @cindex @code{binfmt_misc}
29511 @code{qemu-binfmt-service-type} provides support for transparent
29512 emulation of program binaries built for different architectures---e.g.,
29513 it allows you to transparently execute an ARMv7 program on an x86_64
29514 machine. It achieves this by combining the @uref{https://www.qemu.org,
29515 QEMU} emulator and the @code{binfmt_misc} feature of the kernel Linux.
29516 This feature only allows you to emulate GNU/Linux on a different
29517 architecture, but see below for GNU/Hurd support.
29518
29519 @defvr {Scheme Variable} qemu-binfmt-service-type
29520 This is the type of the QEMU/binfmt service for transparent emulation.
29521 Its value must be a @code{qemu-binfmt-configuration} object, which
29522 specifies the QEMU package to use as well as the architecture we want to
29523 emulated:
29524
29525 @lisp
29526 (service qemu-binfmt-service-type
29527 (qemu-binfmt-configuration
29528 (platforms (lookup-qemu-platforms "arm" "aarch64"))))
29529 @end lisp
29530
29531 In this example, we enable transparent emulation for the ARM and aarch64
29532 platforms. Running @code{herd stop qemu-binfmt} turns it off, and
29533 running @code{herd start qemu-binfmt} turns it back on (@pxref{Invoking
29534 herd, the @command{herd} command,, shepherd, The GNU Shepherd Manual}).
29535 @end defvr
29536
29537 @deftp {Data Type} qemu-binfmt-configuration
29538 This is the configuration for the @code{qemu-binfmt} service.
29539
29540 @table @asis
29541 @item @code{platforms} (default: @code{'()})
29542 The list of emulated QEMU platforms. Each item must be a @dfn{platform
29543 object} as returned by @code{lookup-qemu-platforms} (see below).
29544
29545 For example, let's suppose you're on an x86_64 machine and you have this
29546 service:
29547
29548 @lisp
29549 (service qemu-binfmt-service-type
29550 (qemu-binfmt-configuration
29551 (platforms (lookup-qemu-platforms "arm"))))
29552 @end lisp
29553
29554 You can run:
29555
29556 @example
29557 guix build -s armhf-linux inkscape
29558 @end example
29559
29560 @noindent
29561 and it will build Inkscape for ARMv7 @emph{as if it were a native
29562 build}, transparently using QEMU to emulate the ARMv7 CPU@. Pretty handy
29563 if you'd like to test a package build for an architecture you don't have
29564 access to!
29565
29566 @item @code{qemu} (default: @code{qemu})
29567 The QEMU package to use.
29568 @end table
29569 @end deftp
29570
29571 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} lookup-qemu-platforms @var{platforms}@dots{}
29572 Return the list of QEMU platform objects corresponding to
29573 @var{platforms}@dots{}. @var{platforms} must be a list of strings
29574 corresponding to platform names, such as @code{"arm"}, @code{"sparc"},
29575 @code{"mips64el"}, and so on.
29576 @end deffn
29577
29578 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} qemu-platform? @var{obj}
29579 Return true if @var{obj} is a platform object.
29580 @end deffn
29581
29582 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} qemu-platform-name @var{platform}
29583 Return the name of @var{platform}---a string such as @code{"arm"}.
29584 @end deffn
29585
29586
29587 @subsubheading The Hurd in a Virtual Machine
29588
29589 @cindex @code{hurd}
29590 @cindex the Hurd
29591 @cindex childhurd
29592
29593 Service @code{hurd-vm} provides support for running GNU/Hurd in a
29594 virtual machine (VM), a so-called @dfn{childhurd}. This service is meant
29595 to be used on GNU/Linux and the given GNU/Hurd operating system
29596 configuration is cross-compiled. The virtual machine is a Shepherd
29597 service that can be referred to by the names @code{hurd-vm} and
29598 @code{childhurd} and be controlled with commands such as:
29599
29600 @example
29601 herd start hurd-vm
29602 herd stop childhurd
29603 @end example
29604
29605 When the service is running, you can view its console by connecting to
29606 it with a VNC client, for example with:
29607
29608 @example
29609 guix environment --ad-hoc tigervnc-client -- \
29610 vncviewer localhost:5900
29611 @end example
29612
29613 The default configuration (see @code{hurd-vm-configuration} below)
29614 spawns a secure shell (SSH) server in your GNU/Hurd system, which QEMU
29615 (the virtual machine emulator) redirects to port 10222 on the host.
29616 Thus, you can connect over SSH to the childhurd with:
29617
29618 @example
29619 ssh root@@localhost -p 10022
29620 @end example
29621
29622 The childhurd is volatile and stateless: it starts with a fresh root
29623 file system every time you restart it. By default though, all the files
29624 under @file{/etc/childhurd} on the host are copied as is to the root
29625 file system of the childhurd when it boots. This allows you to
29626 initialize ``secrets'' inside the VM: SSH host keys, authorized
29627 substitute keys, and so on---see the explanation of @code{secret-root}
29628 below.
29629
29630 @defvr {Scheme Variable} hurd-vm-service-type
29631 This is the type of the Hurd in a Virtual Machine service. Its value
29632 must be a @code{hurd-vm-configuration} object, which specifies the
29633 operating system (@pxref{operating-system Reference}) and the disk size
29634 for the Hurd Virtual Machine, the QEMU package to use as well as the
29635 options for running it.
29636
29637 For example:
29638
29639 @lisp
29640 (service hurd-vm-service-type
29641 (hurd-vm-configuration
29642 (disk-size (* 5000 (expt 2 20))) ;5G
29643 (memory-size 1024))) ;1024MiB
29644 @end lisp
29645
29646 would create a disk image big enough to build GNU@tie{}Hello, with some
29647 extra memory.
29648 @end defvr
29649
29650 @deftp {Data Type} hurd-vm-configuration
29651 The data type representing the configuration for
29652 @code{hurd-vm-service-type}.
29653
29654 @table @asis
29655 @item @code{os} (default: @var{%hurd-vm-operating-system})
29656 The operating system to instantiate. This default is bare-bones with a
29657 permissive OpenSSH secure shell daemon listening on port 2222
29658 (@pxref{Networking Services, @code{openssh-service-type}}).
29659
29660 @item @code{qemu} (default: @code{qemu-minimal})
29661 The QEMU package to use.
29662
29663 @item @code{image} (default: @var{hurd-vm-disk-image})
29664 The procedure used to build the disk-image built from this
29665 configuration.
29666
29667 @item @code{disk-size} (default: @code{'guess})
29668 The size of the disk image.
29669
29670 @item @code{memory-size} (default: @code{512})
29671 The memory size of the Virtual Machine in mebibytes.
29672
29673 @item @code{options} (default: @code{'("--snapshot")})
29674 The extra options for running QEMU.
29675
29676 @item @code{id} (default: @code{#f})
29677 If set, a non-zero positive integer used to parameterize Childhurd
29678 instances. It is appended to the service's name,
29679 e.g. @code{childhurd1}.
29680
29681 @item @code{net-options} (default: @var{hurd-vm-net-options})
29682 The procedure used to produce the list of QEMU networking options.
29683
29684 By default, it produces
29685
29686 @lisp
29687 '("--device" "rtl8139,netdev=net0"
29688 "--netdev" (string-append
29689 "user,id=net0,"
29690 "hostfwd=tcp:127.0.0.1:@var{secrets-port}-:1004,"
29691 "hostfwd=tcp:127.0.0.1:@var{ssh-port}-:2222,"
29692 "hostfwd=tcp:127.0.0.1:@var{vnc-port}-:5900"))
29693 @end lisp
29694
29695 with forwarded ports:
29696
29697 @example
29698 @var{secrets-port}: @code{(+ 11004 (* 1000 @var{ID}))}
29699 @var{ssh-port}: @code{(+ 10022 (* 1000 @var{ID}))}
29700 @var{vnc-port}: @code{(+ 15900 (* 1000 @var{ID}))}
29701 @end example
29702
29703 @item @code{secret-root} (default: @file{/etc/childhurd})
29704 The root directory with out-of-band secrets to be installed into the
29705 childhurd once it runs. Childhurds are volatile which means that on
29706 every startup, secrets such as the SSH host keys and Guix signing key
29707 are recreated.
29708
29709 If the @file{/etc/childhurd} directory does not exist, the
29710 @code{secret-service} running in the Childhurd will be sent an empty
29711 list of secrets.
29712
29713 By default, the service automatically populates @file{/etc/childhurd}
29714 with the following non-volatile secrets, unless they already exist:
29715
29716 @example
29717 /etc/childhurd/etc/guix/acl
29718 /etc/childhurd/etc/guix/signing-key.pub
29719 /etc/childhurd/etc/guix/signing-key.sec
29720 /etc/childhurd/etc/ssh/ssh_host_ed25519_key
29721 /etc/childhurd/etc/ssh/ssh_host_ecdsa_key
29722 /etc/childhurd/etc/ssh/ssh_host_ed25519_key.pub
29723 /etc/childhurd/etc/ssh/ssh_host_ecdsa_key.pub
29724 @end example
29725
29726 These files are automatically sent to the guest Hurd VM when it boots,
29727 including permissions.
29728
29729 @cindex childhurd, offloading
29730 @cindex Hurd, offloading
29731 Having these files in place means that only a couple of things are
29732 missing to allow the host to offload @code{i586-gnu} builds to the
29733 childhurd:
29734
29735 @enumerate
29736 @item
29737 Authorizing the childhurd's key on the host so that the host accepts
29738 build results coming from the childhurd, which can be done like so:
29739
29740 @example
29741 guix archive --authorize < \
29742 /etc/childhurd/etc/guix/signing-key.pub
29743 @end example
29744
29745 @item
29746 Adding the childhurd to @file{/etc/guix/machines.scm} (@pxref{Daemon
29747 Offload Setup}).
29748 @end enumerate
29749
29750 We're working towards making that happen automatically---get in touch
29751 with us at @email{guix-devel@@gnu.org} to discuss it!
29752 @end table
29753 @end deftp
29754
29755 Note that by default the VM image is volatile, i.e., once stopped the
29756 contents are lost. If you want a stateful image instead, override the
29757 configuration's @code{image} and @code{options} without
29758 the @code{--snapshot} flag using something along these lines:
29759
29760 @lisp
29761 (service hurd-vm-service-type
29762 (hurd-vm-configuration
29763 (image (const "/out/of/store/writable/hurd.img"))
29764 (options '())))
29765 @end lisp
29766
29767 @subsubheading Ganeti
29768
29769 @cindex ganeti
29770
29771 @quotation Note
29772 This service is considered experimental. Configuration options may be changed
29773 in a backwards-incompatible manner, and not all features have been thorougly
29774 tested. Users of this service are encouraged to share their experience at
29775 @email{guix-devel@@gnu.org}.
29776 @end quotation
29777
29778 Ganeti is a virtual machine management system. It is designed to keep virtual
29779 machines running on a cluster of servers even in the event of hardware failures,
29780 and to make maintenance and recovery tasks easy. It consists of multiple
29781 services which are described later in this section. In addition to the Ganeti
29782 service, you will need the OpenSSH service (@pxref{Networking Services,
29783 @code{openssh-service-type}}), and update the @file{/etc/hosts} file
29784 (@pxref{operating-system Reference, @code{hosts-file}}) with the cluster name
29785 and address (or use a DNS server).
29786
29787 All nodes participating in a Ganeti cluster should have the same Ganeti and
29788 @file{/etc/hosts} configuration. Here is an example configuration for a Ganeti
29789 cluster node that supports multiple storage backends, and installs the
29790 @code{debootstrap} and @code{guix} @dfn{OS providers}:
29791
29792 @lisp
29793 (use-package-modules virtualization)
29794 (use-service-modules base ganeti networking ssh)
29795 (operating-system
29796 ;; @dots{}
29797 (host-name "node1")
29798 (hosts-file (plain-file "hosts" (format #f "
29799 127.0.0.1 localhost
29800 ::1 localhost
29801
29802 192.168.1.200 ganeti.example.com
29803 192.168.1.201 node1.example.com node1
29804 192.168.1.202 node2.example.com node2
29805 ")))
29806
29807 ;; Install QEMU so we can use KVM-based instances, and LVM, DRBD and Ceph
29808 ;; in order to use the "plain", "drbd" and "rbd" storage backends.
29809 (packages (append (map specification->package
29810 '("qemu" "lvm2" "drbd-utils" "ceph"
29811 ;; Add the debootstrap and guix OS providers.
29812 "ganeti-instance-guix" "ganeti-instance-debootstrap"))
29813 %base-packages))
29814 (services
29815 (append (list (static-networking-service "eth0" "192.168.1.201"
29816 #:netmask "255.255.255.0"
29817 #:gateway "192.168.1.254"
29818 #:name-servers '("192.168.1.252"
29819 "192.168.1.253"))
29820
29821 ;; Ganeti uses SSH to communicate between nodes.
29822 (service openssh-service-type
29823 (openssh-configuration
29824 (permit-root-login 'prohibit-password)))
29825
29826 (service ganeti-service-type
29827 (ganeti-configuration
29828 ;; This list specifies allowed file system paths
29829 ;; for storing virtual machine images.
29830 (file-storage-paths '("/srv/ganeti/file-storage"))
29831 ;; This variable configures a single "variant" for
29832 ;; both Debootstrap and Guix that works with KVM.
29833 (os %default-ganeti-os))))
29834 %base-services)))
29835 @end lisp
29836
29837 Users are advised to read the
29838 @url{http://docs.ganeti.org/ganeti/master/html/admin.html,Ganeti
29839 administrators guide} to learn about the various cluster options and
29840 day-to-day operations. There is also a
29841 @url{https://guix.gnu.org/blog/2020/running-a-ganeti-cluster-on-guix/,blog post}
29842 describing how to configure and initialize a small cluster.
29843
29844 @defvr {Scheme Variable} ganeti-service-type
29845 This is a service type that includes all the various services that Ganeti
29846 nodes should run.
29847
29848 Its value is a @code{ganeti-configuration} object that defines the package
29849 to use for CLI operations, as well as configuration for the various daemons.
29850 Allowed file storage paths and available guest operating systems are also
29851 configured through this data type.
29852 @end defvr
29853
29854 @deftp {Data Type} ganeti-configuration
29855 The @code{ganeti} service takes the following configuration options:
29856
29857 @table @asis
29858 @item @code{ganeti} (default: @code{ganeti})
29859 The @code{ganeti} package to use. It will be installed to the system profile
29860 and make @command{gnt-cluster}, @command{gnt-instance}, etc available. Note
29861 that the value specified here does not affect the other services as each refer
29862 to a specific @code{ganeti} package (see below).
29863
29864 @item @code{noded-configuration} (default: @code{(ganeti-noded-configuration)})
29865 @itemx @code{confd-configuration} (default: @code{(ganeti-confd-configuration)})
29866 @itemx @code{wconfd-configuration} (default: @code{(ganeti-wconfd-configuration)})
29867 @itemx @code{luxid-configuration} (default: @code{(ganeti-luxid-configuration)})
29868 @itemx @code{rapi-configuration} (default: @code{(ganeti-rapi-configuration)})
29869 @itemx @code{kvmd-configuration} (default: @code{(ganeti-kvmd-configuration)})
29870 @itemx @code{mond-configuration} (default: @code{(ganeti-mond-configuration)})
29871 @itemx @code{metad-configuration} (default: @code{(ganeti-metad-configuration)})
29872 @itemx @code{watcher-configuration} (default: @code{(ganeti-watcher-configuration)})
29873 @itemx @code{cleaner-configuration} (default: @code{(ganeti-cleaner-configuration)})
29874
29875 These options control the various daemons and cron jobs that are distributed
29876 with Ganeti. The possible values for these are described in detail below.
29877 To override a setting, you must use the configuration type for that service:
29878
29879 @lisp
29880 (service ganeti-service-type
29881 (ganeti-configuration
29882 (rapi-configuration
29883 (ganeti-rapi-configuration
29884 (interface "eth1"))))
29885 (watcher-configuration
29886 (ganeti-watcher-configuration
29887 (rapi-ip "10.0.0.1"))))
29888 @end lisp
29889
29890 @item @code{file-storage-paths} (default: @code{'()})
29891 List of allowed directories for file storage backend.
29892
29893 @item @code{os} (default: @code{%default-ganeti-os})
29894 List of @code{<ganeti-os>} records.
29895 @end table
29896
29897 In essence @code{ganeti-service-type} is shorthand for declaring each service
29898 individually:
29899
29900 @lisp
29901 (service ganeti-noded-service-type)
29902 (service ganeti-confd-service-type)
29903 (service ganeti-wconfd-service-type)
29904 (service ganeti-luxid-service-type)
29905 (service ganeti-kvmd-service-type)
29906 (service ganeti-mond-service-type)
29907 (service ganeti-metad-service-type)
29908 (service ganeti-watcher-service-type)
29909 (service ganeti-cleaner-service-type)
29910 @end lisp
29911
29912 Plus a service extension for @code{etc-service-type} that configures the file
29913 storage backend and OS variants.
29914
29915 @end deftp
29916
29917 @deftp {Data Type} ganeti-os
29918 This data type is suitable for passing to the @code{os} parameter of
29919 @code{ganeti-configuration}. It takes the following parameters:
29920
29921 @table @asis
29922 @item @code{name}
29923 The name for this OS provider. It is only used to specify where the
29924 configuration ends up. Setting it to ``debootstrap'' will create
29925 @file{/etc/ganeti/instance-debootstrap}.
29926
29927 @item @code{extension}
29928 The file extension for variants of this OS type. For example
29929 @file{.conf} or @file{.scm}.
29930
29931 @item @code{variants} (default: @code{'()})
29932 List of @code{ganeti-os-variant} objects for this OS.
29933
29934 @end table
29935 @end deftp
29936
29937 @deftp {Data Type} ganeti-os-variant
29938 This is the data type for a Ganeti OS variant. It takes the following
29939 parameters:
29940
29941 @table @asis
29942 @item @code{name}
29943 The name of this variant.
29944
29945 @item @code{configuration}
29946 A configuration file for this variant.
29947 @end table
29948 @end deftp
29949
29950 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %default-debootstrap-hooks
29951 This variable contains hooks to configure networking and the GRUB bootloader.
29952 @end defvr
29953
29954 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %default-debootstrap-extra-pkgs
29955 This variable contains a list of packages suitable for a fully-virtualized guest.
29956 @end defvr
29957
29958 @deftp {Data Type} debootstrap-configuration
29959
29960 This data type creates configuration files suitable for the debootstrap OS provider.
29961
29962 @table @asis
29963 @item @code{hooks} (default: @code{%default-debootstrap-hooks})
29964 When not @code{#f}, this must be a G-expression that specifies a directory with
29965 scripts that will run when the OS is installed. It can also be a list of
29966 @code{(name . file-like)} pairs. For example:
29967
29968 @lisp
29969 `((99-hello-world . ,(plain-file "#!/bin/sh\necho Hello, World")))
29970 @end lisp
29971
29972 That will create a directory with one executable named @code{99-hello-world}
29973 and run it every time this variant is installed. If set to @code{#f}, hooks
29974 in @file{/etc/ganeti/instance-debootstrap/hooks} will be used, if any.
29975 @item @code{proxy} (default: @code{#f})
29976 Optional HTTP proxy to use.
29977 @item @code{mirror} (default: @code{#f})
29978 The Debian mirror. Typically something like @code{http://ftp.no.debian.org/debian}.
29979 The default varies depending on the distribution.
29980 @item @code{arch} (default: @code{#f})
29981 The dpkg architecture. Set to @code{armhf} to debootstrap an ARMv7 instance
29982 on an AArch64 host. Default is to use the current system architecture.
29983 @item @code{suite} (default: @code{"stable"})
29984 When set, this must be a Debian distribution ``suite'' such as @code{buster}
29985 or @code{focal}. If set to @code{#f}, the default for the OS provider is used.
29986 @item @code{extra-pkgs} (default: @code{%default-debootstrap-extra-pkgs})
29987 List of extra packages that will get installed by dpkg in addition
29988 to the minimal system.
29989 @item @code{components} (default: @code{#f})
29990 When set, must be a list of Debian repository ``components''. For example
29991 @code{'("main" "contrib")}.
29992 @item @code{generate-cache?} (default: @code{#t})
29993 Whether to automatically cache the generated debootstrap archive.
29994 @item @code{clean-cache} (default: @code{14})
29995 Discard the cache after this amount of days. Use @code{#f} to never
29996 clear the cache.
29997 @item @code{partition-style} (default: @code{'msdos})
29998 The type of partition to create. When set, it must be one of
29999 @code{'msdos}, @code{'none} or a string.
30000 @item @code{partition-alignment} (default: @code{2048})
30001 Alignment of the partition in sectors.
30002 @end table
30003 @end deftp
30004
30005 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} debootstrap-variant @var{name} @var{configuration}
30006 This is a helper procedure that creates a @code{ganeti-os-variant} record. It
30007 takes two parameters: a name and a @code{debootstrap-configuration} object.
30008 @end deffn
30009
30010 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} debootstrap-os @var{variants}@dots{}
30011 This is a helper procedure that creates a @code{ganeti-os} record. It takes
30012 a list of variants created with @code{debootstrap-variant}.
30013 @end deffn
30014
30015 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} guix-variant @var{name} @var{configuration}
30016 This is a helper procedure that creates a @code{ganeti-os-variant} record for
30017 use with the Guix OS provider. It takes a name and a G-expression that returns
30018 a ``file-like'' (@pxref{G-Expressions, file-like objects}) object containing a
30019 Guix System configuration.
30020 @end deffn
30021
30022 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} guix-os @var{variants}@dots{}
30023 This is a helper procedure that creates a @code{ganeti-os} record. It
30024 takes a list of variants produced by @code{guix-variant}.
30025 @end deffn
30026
30027 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %default-debootstrap-variants
30028 This is a convenience variable to make the debootstrap provider work
30029 ``out of the box'' without users having to declare variants manually. It
30030 contains a single debootstrap variant with the default configuration:
30031
30032 @lisp
30033 (list (debootstrap-variant
30034 "default"
30035 (debootstrap-configuration)))
30036 @end lisp
30037 @end defvr
30038
30039 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %default-guix-variants
30040 This is a convenience variable to make the Guix OS provider work without
30041 additional configuration. It creates a virtual machine that has an SSH
30042 server, a serial console, and authorizes the Ganeti hosts SSH keys.
30043
30044 @lisp
30045 (list (guix-variant
30046 "default"
30047 (file-append ganeti-instance-guix
30048 "/share/doc/ganeti-instance-guix/examples/dynamic.scm")))
30049 @end lisp
30050 @end defvr
30051
30052 Users can implement support for OS providers unbeknownst to Guix by extending
30053 the @code{ganeti-os} and @code{ganeti-os-variant} records appropriately.
30054 For example:
30055
30056 @lisp
30057 (ganeti-os
30058 (name "custom")
30059 (extension ".conf")
30060 (variants
30061 (list (ganeti-os-variant
30062 (name "foo")
30063 (configuration (plain-file "bar" "this is fine"))))))
30064 @end lisp
30065
30066 That creates @file{/etc/ganeti/instance-custom/variants/foo.conf} which points
30067 to a file in the store with contents @code{this is fine}. It also creates
30068 @file{/etc/ganeti/instance-custom/variants/variants.list} with contents @code{foo}.
30069
30070 Obviously this may not work for all OS providers out there. If you find the
30071 interface limiting, please reach out to @email{guix-devel@@gnu.org}.
30072
30073 The rest of this section documents the various services that are included by
30074 @code{ganeti-service-type}.
30075
30076 @defvr {Scheme Variable} ganeti-noded-service-type
30077 @command{ganeti-noded} is the daemon responsible for node-specific functions
30078 within the Ganeti system. The value of this service must be a
30079 @code{ganeti-noded-configuration} object.
30080 @end defvr
30081
30082 @deftp {Data Type} ganeti-noded-configuration
30083 This is the configuration for the @code{ganeti-noded} service.
30084
30085 @table @asis
30086 @item @code{ganeti} (default: @code{ganeti})
30087 The @code{ganeti} package to use for this service.
30088
30089 @item @code{port} (default: @code{1811})
30090 The TCP port on which the node daemon listens for network requests.
30091
30092 @item @code{address} (default: @code{"0.0.0.0"})
30093 The network address that the daemon will bind to. The default address means
30094 bind to all available addresses.
30095
30096 @item @code{interface} (default: @code{#f})
30097 When this is set, it must be a specific network interface (e.g.@: @code{eth0})
30098 that the daemon will bind to.
30099
30100 @item @code{max-clients} (default: @code{20})
30101 This sets a limit on the maximum number of simultaneous client connections
30102 that the daemon will handle. Connections above this count are accepted, but
30103 no responses will be sent until enough connections have closed.
30104
30105 @item @code{ssl?} (default: @code{#t})
30106 Whether to use SSL/TLS to encrypt network communications. The certificate
30107 is automatically provisioned by the cluster and can be rotated with
30108 @command{gnt-cluster renew-crypto}.
30109
30110 @item @code{ssl-key} (default: @file{"/var/lib/ganeti/server.pem"})
30111 This can be used to provide a specific encryption key for TLS communications.
30112
30113 @item @code{ssl-cert} (default: @file{"/var/lib/ganeti/server.pem"})
30114 This can be used to provide a specific certificate for TLS communications.
30115
30116 @item @code{debug?} (default: @code{#f})
30117 When true, the daemon performs additional logging for debugging purposes.
30118 Note that this will leak encryption details to the log files, use with caution.
30119
30120 @end table
30121 @end deftp
30122
30123 @defvr {Scheme Variable} ganeti-confd-service-type
30124 @command{ganeti-confd} answers queries related to the configuration of a
30125 Ganeti cluster. The purpose of this daemon is to have a highly available
30126 and fast way to query cluster configuration values. It is automatically
30127 active on all @dfn{master candidates}. The value of this service must be a
30128 @code{ganeti-confd-configuration} object.
30129
30130 @end defvr
30131
30132 @deftp {Data Type} ganeti-confd-configuration
30133 This is the configuration for the @code{ganeti-confd} service.
30134
30135 @table @asis
30136 @item @code{ganeti} (default: @code{ganeti})
30137 The @code{ganeti} package to use for this service.
30138
30139 @item @code{port} (default: @code{1814})
30140 The UDP port on which to listen for network requests.
30141
30142 @item @code{address} (default: @code{"0.0.0.0"})
30143 Network address that the daemon will bind to.
30144
30145 @item @code{debug?} (default: @code{#f})
30146 When true, the daemon performs additional logging for debugging purposes.
30147
30148 @end table
30149 @end deftp
30150
30151 @defvr {Scheme Variable} ganeti-wconfd-service-type
30152 @command{ganeti-wconfd} is the daemon that has authoritative knowledge
30153 about the cluster configuration and is the only entity that can accept
30154 changes to it. All jobs that need to modify the configuration will do so
30155 by sending appropriate requests to this daemon. It only runs on the
30156 @dfn{master node} and will automatically disable itself on other nodes.
30157
30158 The value of this service must be a
30159 @code{ganeti-wconfd-configuration} object.
30160 @end defvr
30161
30162 @deftp {Data Type} ganeti-wconfd-configuration
30163 This is the configuration for the @code{ganeti-wconfd} service.
30164
30165 @table @asis
30166 @item @code{ganeti} (default: @code{ganeti})
30167 The @code{ganeti} package to use for this service.
30168
30169 @item @code{no-voting?} (default: @code{#f})
30170 The daemon will refuse to start if the majority of cluster nodes does not
30171 agree that it is running on the master node. Set to @code{#t} to start
30172 even if a quorum can not be reached (dangerous, use with caution).
30173
30174 @item @code{debug?} (default: @code{#f})
30175 When true, the daemon performs additional logging for debugging purposes.
30176
30177 @end table
30178 @end deftp
30179
30180 @defvr {Scheme Variable} ganeti-luxid-service-type
30181 @command{ganeti-luxid} is a daemon used to answer queries related to the
30182 configuration and the current live state of a Ganeti cluster. Additionally,
30183 it is the authoritative daemon for the Ganeti job queue. Jobs can be
30184 submitted via this daemon and it schedules and starts them.
30185
30186 It takes a @code{ganeti-luxid-configuration} object.
30187 @end defvr
30188
30189 @deftp {Data Type} ganeti-luxid-configuration
30190 This is the configuration for the @code{ganeti-wconfd} service.
30191
30192 @table @asis
30193 @item @code{ganeti} (default: @code{ganeti})
30194 The @code{ganeti} package to use for this service.
30195
30196 @item @code{no-voting?} (default: @code{#f})
30197 The daemon will refuse to start if it cannot verify that the majority of
30198 cluster nodes believes that it is running on the master node. Set to
30199 @code{#t} to ignore such checks and start anyway (this can be dangerous).
30200
30201 @item @code{debug?} (default: @code{#f})
30202 When true, the daemon performs additional logging for debugging purposes.
30203
30204 @end table
30205 @end deftp
30206
30207 @defvr {Scheme Variable} ganeti-rapi-service-type
30208 @command{ganeti-rapi} provides a remote API for Ganeti clusters. It runs on
30209 the master node and can be used to perform cluster actions programmatically
30210 via a JSON-based RPC protocol.
30211
30212 Most query operations are allowed without authentication (unless
30213 @var{require-authentication?} is set), whereas write operations require
30214 explicit authorization via the @file{/var/lib/ganeti/rapi/users} file. See
30215 the @url{http://docs.ganeti.org/ganeti/master/html/rapi.html, Ganeti Remote
30216 API documentation} for more information.
30217
30218 The value of this service must be a @code{ganeti-rapi-configuration} object.
30219 @end defvr
30220
30221 @deftp {Data Type} ganeti-rapi-configuration
30222 This is the configuration for the @code{ganeti-rapi} service.
30223
30224 @table @asis
30225 @item @code{ganeti} (default: @code{ganeti})
30226 The @code{ganeti} package to use for this service.
30227
30228 @item @code{require-authentication?} (default: @code{#f})
30229 Whether to require authentication even for read-only operations.
30230
30231 @item @code{port} (default: @code{5080})
30232 The TCP port on which to listen to API requests.
30233
30234 @item @code{address} (default: @code{"0.0.0.0"})
30235 The network address that the service will bind to. By default it listens
30236 on all configured addresses.
30237
30238 @item @code{interface} (default: @code{#f})
30239 When set, it must specify a specific network interface such as @code{eth0}
30240 that the daemon will bind to.
30241
30242 @item @code{max-clients} (default: @code{20})
30243 The maximum number of simultaneous client requests to handle. Further
30244 connections are allowed, but no responses are sent until enough connections
30245 have closed.
30246
30247 @item @code{ssl?} (default: @code{#t})
30248 Whether to use SSL/TLS encryption on the RAPI port.
30249
30250 @item @code{ssl-key} (default: @file{"/var/lib/ganeti/server.pem"})
30251 This can be used to provide a specific encryption key for TLS communications.
30252
30253 @item @code{ssl-cert} (default: @file{"/var/lib/ganeti/server.pem"})
30254 This can be used to provide a specific certificate for TLS communications.
30255
30256 @item @code{debug?} (default: @code{#f})
30257 When true, the daemon performs additional logging for debugging purposes.
30258 Note that this will leak encryption details to the log files, use with caution.
30259
30260 @end table
30261 @end deftp
30262
30263 @defvr {Scheme Variable} ganeti-kvmd-service-type
30264 @command{ganeti-kvmd} is responsible for determining whether a given KVM
30265 instance was shut down by an administrator or a user. Normally Ganeti will
30266 restart an instance that was not stopped through Ganeti itself. If the
30267 cluster option @code{user_shutdown} is true, this daemon monitors the
30268 @code{QMP} socket provided by QEMU and listens for shutdown events, and
30269 marks the instance as @dfn{USER_down} instead of @dfn{ERROR_down} when
30270 it shuts down gracefully by itself.
30271
30272 It takes a @code{ganeti-kvmd-configuration} object.
30273 @end defvr
30274
30275 @deftp {Data Type} ganeti-kvmd-configuration
30276
30277 @table @asis
30278 @item @code{ganeti} (default: @code{ganeti})
30279 The @code{ganeti} package to use for this service.
30280
30281 @item @code{debug?} (default: @code{#f})
30282 When true, the daemon performs additional logging for debugging purposes.
30283
30284 @end table
30285 @end deftp
30286
30287 @defvr {Scheme Variable} ganeti-mond-service-type
30288 @command{ganeti-mond} is an optional daemon that provides Ganeti monitoring
30289 functionality. It is responsible for running data collectors and publish the
30290 collected information through a HTTP interface.
30291
30292 It takes a @code{ganeti-mond-configuration} object.
30293 @end defvr
30294
30295 @deftp {Data Type} ganeti-mond-configuration
30296
30297 @table @asis
30298 @item @code{ganeti} (default: @code{ganeti})
30299 The @code{ganeti} package to use for this service.
30300
30301 @item @code{port} (default: @code{1815})
30302 The port on which the daemon will listen.
30303
30304 @item @code{address} (default: @code{"0.0.0.0"})
30305 The network address that the daemon will bind to. By default it binds to all
30306 available interfaces.
30307
30308 @item @code{debug?} (default: @code{#f})
30309 When true, the daemon performs additional logging for debugging purposes.
30310
30311 @end table
30312 @end deftp
30313
30314 @defvr {Scheme Variable} ganeti-metad-service-type
30315 @command{ganeti-metad} is an optional daemon that can be used to provide
30316 information about the cluster to instances or OS install scripts.
30317
30318 It takes a @code{ganeti-metad-configuration} object.
30319 @end defvr
30320
30321 @deftp {Data Type} ganeti-metad-configuration
30322
30323 @table @asis
30324 @item @code{ganeti} (default: @code{ganeti})
30325 The @code{ganeti} package to use for this service.
30326
30327 @item @code{port} (default: @code{80})
30328 The port on which the daemon will listen.
30329
30330 @item @code{address} (default: @code{#f})
30331 If set, the daemon will bind to this address only. If left unset, the behavior
30332 depends on the cluster configuration.
30333
30334 @item @code{debug?} (default: @code{#f})
30335 When true, the daemon performs additional logging for debugging purposes.
30336
30337 @end table
30338 @end deftp
30339
30340 @defvr {Scheme Variable} ganeti-watcher-service-type
30341 @command{ganeti-watcher} is a script designed to run periodically and ensure
30342 the health of a cluster. It will automatically restart instances that have
30343 stopped without Ganeti's consent, and repairs DRBD links in case a node has
30344 rebooted. It also archives old cluster jobs and restarts Ganeti daemons
30345 that are not running. If the cluster parameter @code{ensure_node_health}
30346 is set, the watcher will also shutdown instances and DRBD devices if the
30347 node it is running on is declared offline by known master candidates.
30348
30349 It can be paused on all nodes with @command{gnt-cluster watcher pause}.
30350
30351 The service takes a @code{ganeti-watcher-configuration} object.
30352 @end defvr
30353
30354 @deftp {Data Type} ganeti-watcher-configuration
30355
30356 @table @asis
30357 @item @code{ganeti} (default: @code{ganeti})
30358 The @code{ganeti} package to use for this service.
30359
30360 @item @code{schedule} (default: @code{'(next-second-from (next-minute (range 0 60 5)))})
30361 How often to run the script. The default is every five minutes.
30362
30363 @item @code{rapi-ip} (default: @code{#f})
30364 This option needs to be specified only if the RAPI daemon is configured to use
30365 a particular interface or address. By default the cluster address is used.
30366
30367 @item @code{job-age} (default: @code{(* 6 3600)})
30368 Archive cluster jobs older than this age, specified in seconds. The default
30369 is 6 hours. This keeps @command{gnt-job list} manageable.
30370
30371 @item @code{verify-disks?} (default: @code{#t})
30372 If this is @code{#f}, the watcher will not try to repair broken DRBD links
30373 automatically. Administrators will need to use @command{gnt-cluster verify-disks}
30374 manually instead.
30375
30376 @item @code{debug?} (default: @code{#f})
30377 When @code{#t}, the script performs additional logging for debugging purposes.
30378
30379 @end table
30380 @end deftp
30381
30382 @defvr {Scheme Variable} ganeti-cleaner-service-type
30383 @command{ganeti-cleaner} is a script designed to run periodically and remove
30384 old files from the cluster. This service type controls two @dfn{cron jobs}:
30385 one intended for the master node that permanently purges old cluster jobs,
30386 and one intended for every node that removes expired X509 certificates, keys,
30387 and outdated @command{ganeti-watcher} information. Like all Ganeti services,
30388 it is safe to include even on non-master nodes as it will disable itself as
30389 necessary.
30390
30391 It takes a @code{ganeti-cleaner-configuration} object.
30392 @end defvr
30393
30394 @deftp {Data Type} ganeti-cleaner-configuration
30395
30396 @table @asis
30397 @item @code{ganeti} (default: @code{ganeti})
30398 The @code{ganeti} package to use for the @command{gnt-cleaner} command.
30399
30400 @item @code{master-schedule} (default: @code{"45 1 * * *"})
30401 How often to run the master cleaning job. The default is once per day, at
30402 01:45:00.
30403
30404 @item @code{node-schedule} (default: @code{"45 2 * * *"})
30405 How often to run the node cleaning job. The default is once per day, at
30406 02:45:00.
30407
30408 @end table
30409 @end deftp
30410
30411 @node Version Control Services
30412 @subsection Version Control Services
30413
30414 The @code{(gnu services version-control)} module provides a service to
30415 allow remote access to local Git repositories. There are three options:
30416 the @code{git-daemon-service}, which provides access to repositories via
30417 the @code{git://} unsecured TCP-based protocol, extending the
30418 @code{nginx} web server to proxy some requests to
30419 @code{git-http-backend}, or providing a web interface with
30420 @code{cgit-service-type}.
30421
30422 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} git-daemon-service [#:config (git-daemon-configuration)]
30423
30424 Return a service that runs @command{git daemon}, a simple TCP server to
30425 expose repositories over the Git protocol for anonymous access.
30426
30427 The optional @var{config} argument should be a
30428 @code{<git-daemon-configuration>} object, by default it allows read-only
30429 access to exported@footnote{By creating the magic file
30430 @file{git-daemon-export-ok} in the repository directory.} repositories under
30431 @file{/srv/git}.
30432
30433 @end deffn
30434
30435 @deftp {Data Type} git-daemon-configuration
30436 Data type representing the configuration for @code{git-daemon-service}.
30437
30438 @table @asis
30439 @item @code{package} (default: @code{git})
30440 Package object of the Git distributed version control system.
30441
30442 @item @code{export-all?} (default: @code{#f})
30443 Whether to allow access for all Git repositories, even if they do not
30444 have the @file{git-daemon-export-ok} file.
30445
30446 @item @code{base-path} (default: @file{/srv/git})
30447 Whether to remap all the path requests as relative to the given path.
30448 If you run @command{git daemon} with @code{(base-path "/srv/git")} on
30449 @samp{example.com}, then if you later try to pull
30450 @indicateurl{git://example.com/hello.git}, git daemon will interpret the
30451 path as @file{/srv/git/hello.git}.
30452
30453 @item @code{user-path} (default: @code{#f})
30454 Whether to allow @code{~user} notation to be used in requests. When
30455 specified with empty string, requests to
30456 @indicateurl{git://host/~alice/foo} is taken as a request to access
30457 @code{foo} repository in the home directory of user @code{alice}. If
30458 @code{(user-path "@var{path}")} is specified, the same request is taken
30459 as a request to access @file{@var{path}/foo} repository in the home
30460 directory of user @code{alice}.
30461
30462 @item @code{listen} (default: @code{'()})
30463 Whether to listen on specific IP addresses or hostnames, defaults to
30464 all.
30465
30466 @item @code{port} (default: @code{#f})
30467 Whether to listen on an alternative port, which defaults to 9418.
30468
30469 @item @code{whitelist} (default: @code{'()})
30470 If not empty, only allow access to this list of directories.
30471
30472 @item @code{extra-options} (default: @code{'()})
30473 Extra options will be passed to @command{git daemon}, please run
30474 @command{man git-daemon} for more information.
30475
30476 @end table
30477 @end deftp
30478
30479 The @code{git://} protocol lacks authentication. When you pull from a
30480 repository fetched via @code{git://}, you don't know whether the data you
30481 receive was modified or is even coming from the specified host, and your
30482 connection is subject to eavesdropping. It's better to use an authenticated
30483 and encrypted transport, such as @code{https}. Although Git allows you
30484 to serve repositories using unsophisticated file-based web servers,
30485 there is a faster protocol implemented by the @code{git-http-backend}
30486 program. This program is the back-end of a proper Git web service. It
30487 is designed to sit behind a FastCGI proxy. @xref{Web Services}, for more
30488 on running the necessary @code{fcgiwrap} daemon.
30489
30490 Guix has a separate configuration data type for serving Git repositories
30491 over HTTP.
30492
30493 @deftp {Data Type} git-http-configuration
30494 Data type representing the configuration for a future
30495 @code{git-http-service-type}; can currently be used to configure Nginx
30496 through @code{git-http-nginx-location-configuration}.
30497
30498 @table @asis
30499 @item @code{package} (default: @var{git})
30500 Package object of the Git distributed version control system.
30501
30502 @item @code{git-root} (default: @file{/srv/git})
30503 Directory containing the Git repositories to expose to the world.
30504
30505 @item @code{export-all?} (default: @code{#f})
30506 Whether to expose access for all Git repositories in @var{git-root},
30507 even if they do not have the @file{git-daemon-export-ok} file.
30508
30509 @item @code{uri-path} (default: @samp{/git/})
30510 Path prefix for Git access. With the default @samp{/git/} prefix, this
30511 will map @indicateurl{http://@var{server}/git/@var{repo}.git} to
30512 @file{/srv/git/@var{repo}.git}. Requests whose URI paths do not begin
30513 with this prefix are not passed on to this Git instance.
30514
30515 @item @code{fcgiwrap-socket} (default: @code{127.0.0.1:9000})
30516 The socket on which the @code{fcgiwrap} daemon is listening. @xref{Web
30517 Services}.
30518 @end table
30519 @end deftp
30520
30521 There is no @code{git-http-service-type}, currently; instead you can
30522 create an @code{nginx-location-configuration} from a
30523 @code{git-http-configuration} and then add that location to a web
30524 server.
30525
30526 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} git-http-nginx-location-configuration @
30527 [config=(git-http-configuration)]
30528 Compute an @code{nginx-location-configuration} that corresponds to the
30529 given Git http configuration. An example nginx service definition to
30530 serve the default @file{/srv/git} over HTTPS might be:
30531
30532 @lisp
30533 (service nginx-service-type
30534 (nginx-configuration
30535 (server-blocks
30536 (list
30537 (nginx-server-configuration
30538 (listen '("443 ssl"))
30539 (server-name "git.my-host.org")
30540 (ssl-certificate
30541 "/etc/letsencrypt/live/git.my-host.org/fullchain.pem")
30542 (ssl-certificate-key
30543 "/etc/letsencrypt/live/git.my-host.org/privkey.pem")
30544 (locations
30545 (list
30546 (git-http-nginx-location-configuration
30547 (git-http-configuration (uri-path "/"))))))))))
30548 @end lisp
30549
30550 This example assumes that you are using Let's Encrypt to get your TLS
30551 certificate. @xref{Certificate Services}. The default @code{certbot}
30552 service will redirect all HTTP traffic on @code{git.my-host.org} to
30553 HTTPS@. You will also need to add an @code{fcgiwrap} proxy to your
30554 system services. @xref{Web Services}.
30555 @end deffn
30556
30557 @subsubheading Cgit Service
30558
30559 @cindex Cgit service
30560 @cindex Git, web interface
30561 @uref{https://git.zx2c4.com/cgit/, Cgit} is a web frontend for Git
30562 repositories written in C.
30563
30564 The following example will configure the service with default values.
30565 By default, Cgit can be accessed on port 80 (@code{http://localhost:80}).
30566
30567 @lisp
30568 (service cgit-service-type)
30569 @end lisp
30570
30571 The @code{file-object} type designates either a file-like object
30572 (@pxref{G-Expressions, file-like objects}) or a string.
30573
30574 @c %start of fragment
30575
30576 Available @code{cgit-configuration} fields are:
30577
30578 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} package package
30579 The CGIT package.
30580
30581 @end deftypevr
30582
30583 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} nginx-server-configuration-list nginx
30584 NGINX configuration.
30585
30586 @end deftypevr
30587
30588 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} file-object about-filter
30589 Specifies a command which will be invoked to format the content of about
30590 pages (both top-level and for each repository).
30591
30592 Defaults to @samp{""}.
30593
30594 @end deftypevr
30595
30596 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} string agefile
30597 Specifies a path, relative to each repository path, which can be used to
30598 specify the date and time of the youngest commit in the repository.
30599
30600 Defaults to @samp{""}.
30601
30602 @end deftypevr
30603
30604 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} file-object auth-filter
30605 Specifies a command that will be invoked for authenticating repository
30606 access.
30607
30608 Defaults to @samp{""}.
30609
30610 @end deftypevr
30611
30612 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} string branch-sort
30613 Flag which, when set to @samp{age}, enables date ordering in the branch
30614 ref list, and when set @samp{name} enables ordering by branch name.
30615
30616 Defaults to @samp{"name"}.
30617
30618 @end deftypevr
30619
30620 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} string cache-root
30621 Path used to store the cgit cache entries.
30622
30623 Defaults to @samp{"/var/cache/cgit"}.
30624
30625 @end deftypevr
30626
30627 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} integer cache-static-ttl
30628 Number which specifies the time-to-live, in minutes, for the cached
30629 version of repository pages accessed with a fixed SHA1.
30630
30631 Defaults to @samp{-1}.
30632
30633 @end deftypevr
30634
30635 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} integer cache-dynamic-ttl
30636 Number which specifies the time-to-live, in minutes, for the cached
30637 version of repository pages accessed without a fixed SHA1.
30638
30639 Defaults to @samp{5}.
30640
30641 @end deftypevr
30642
30643 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} integer cache-repo-ttl
30644 Number which specifies the time-to-live, in minutes, for the cached
30645 version of the repository summary page.
30646
30647 Defaults to @samp{5}.
30648
30649 @end deftypevr
30650
30651 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} integer cache-root-ttl
30652 Number which specifies the time-to-live, in minutes, for the cached
30653 version of the repository index page.
30654
30655 Defaults to @samp{5}.
30656
30657 @end deftypevr
30658
30659 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} integer cache-scanrc-ttl
30660 Number which specifies the time-to-live, in minutes, for the result of
30661 scanning a path for Git repositories.
30662
30663 Defaults to @samp{15}.
30664
30665 @end deftypevr
30666
30667 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} integer cache-about-ttl
30668 Number which specifies the time-to-live, in minutes, for the cached
30669 version of the repository about page.
30670
30671 Defaults to @samp{15}.
30672
30673 @end deftypevr
30674
30675 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} integer cache-snapshot-ttl
30676 Number which specifies the time-to-live, in minutes, for the cached
30677 version of snapshots.
30678
30679 Defaults to @samp{5}.
30680
30681 @end deftypevr
30682
30683 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} integer cache-size
30684 The maximum number of entries in the cgit cache. When set to @samp{0},
30685 caching is disabled.
30686
30687 Defaults to @samp{0}.
30688
30689 @end deftypevr
30690
30691 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean case-sensitive-sort?
30692 Sort items in the repo list case sensitively.
30693
30694 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
30695
30696 @end deftypevr
30697
30698 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} list clone-prefix
30699 List of common prefixes which, when combined with a repository URL,
30700 generates valid clone URLs for the repository.
30701
30702 Defaults to @samp{()}.
30703
30704 @end deftypevr
30705
30706 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} list clone-url
30707 List of @code{clone-url} templates.
30708
30709 Defaults to @samp{()}.
30710
30711 @end deftypevr
30712
30713 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} file-object commit-filter
30714 Command which will be invoked to format commit messages.
30715
30716 Defaults to @samp{""}.
30717
30718 @end deftypevr
30719
30720 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} string commit-sort
30721 Flag which, when set to @samp{date}, enables strict date ordering in the
30722 commit log, and when set to @samp{topo} enables strict topological
30723 ordering.
30724
30725 Defaults to @samp{"git log"}.
30726
30727 @end deftypevr
30728
30729 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} file-object css
30730 URL which specifies the css document to include in all cgit pages.
30731
30732 Defaults to @samp{"/share/cgit/cgit.css"}.
30733
30734 @end deftypevr
30735
30736 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} file-object email-filter
30737 Specifies a command which will be invoked to format names and email
30738 address of committers, authors, and taggers, as represented in various
30739 places throughout the cgit interface.
30740
30741 Defaults to @samp{""}.
30742
30743 @end deftypevr
30744
30745 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean embedded?
30746 Flag which, when set to @samp{#t}, will make cgit generate a HTML
30747 fragment suitable for embedding in other HTML pages.
30748
30749 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
30750
30751 @end deftypevr
30752
30753 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean enable-commit-graph?
30754 Flag which, when set to @samp{#t}, will make cgit print an ASCII-art
30755 commit history graph to the left of the commit messages in the
30756 repository log page.
30757
30758 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
30759
30760 @end deftypevr
30761
30762 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean enable-filter-overrides?
30763 Flag which, when set to @samp{#t}, allows all filter settings to be
30764 overridden in repository-specific cgitrc files.
30765
30766 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
30767
30768 @end deftypevr
30769
30770 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean enable-follow-links?
30771 Flag which, when set to @samp{#t}, allows users to follow a file in the
30772 log view.
30773
30774 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
30775
30776 @end deftypevr
30777
30778 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean enable-http-clone?
30779 If set to @samp{#t}, cgit will act as an dumb HTTP endpoint for Git
30780 clones.
30781
30782 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
30783
30784 @end deftypevr
30785
30786 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean enable-index-links?
30787 Flag which, when set to @samp{#t}, will make cgit generate extra links
30788 "summary", "commit", "tree" for each repo in the repository index.
30789
30790 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
30791
30792 @end deftypevr
30793
30794 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean enable-index-owner?
30795 Flag which, when set to @samp{#t}, will make cgit display the owner of
30796 each repo in the repository index.
30797
30798 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
30799
30800 @end deftypevr
30801
30802 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean enable-log-filecount?
30803 Flag which, when set to @samp{#t}, will make cgit print the number of
30804 modified files for each commit on the repository log page.
30805
30806 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
30807
30808 @end deftypevr
30809
30810 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean enable-log-linecount?
30811 Flag which, when set to @samp{#t}, will make cgit print the number of
30812 added and removed lines for each commit on the repository log page.
30813
30814 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
30815
30816 @end deftypevr
30817
30818 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean enable-remote-branches?
30819 Flag which, when set to @code{#t}, will make cgit display remote
30820 branches in the summary and refs views.
30821
30822 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
30823
30824 @end deftypevr
30825
30826 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean enable-subject-links?
30827 Flag which, when set to @code{1}, will make cgit use the subject of the
30828 parent commit as link text when generating links to parent commits in
30829 commit view.
30830
30831 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
30832
30833 @end deftypevr
30834
30835 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean enable-html-serving?
30836 Flag which, when set to @samp{#t}, will make cgit use the subject of the
30837 parent commit as link text when generating links to parent commits in
30838 commit view.
30839
30840 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
30841
30842 @end deftypevr
30843
30844 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean enable-tree-linenumbers?
30845 Flag which, when set to @samp{#t}, will make cgit generate linenumber
30846 links for plaintext blobs printed in the tree view.
30847
30848 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
30849
30850 @end deftypevr
30851
30852 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean enable-git-config?
30853 Flag which, when set to @samp{#f}, will allow cgit to use Git config to
30854 set any repo specific settings.
30855
30856 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
30857
30858 @end deftypevr
30859
30860 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} file-object favicon
30861 URL used as link to a shortcut icon for cgit.
30862
30863 Defaults to @samp{"/favicon.ico"}.
30864
30865 @end deftypevr
30866
30867 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} string footer
30868 The content of the file specified with this option will be included
30869 verbatim at the bottom of all pages (i.e.@: it replaces the standard
30870 "generated by..."@: message).
30871
30872 Defaults to @samp{""}.
30873
30874 @end deftypevr
30875
30876 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} string head-include
30877 The content of the file specified with this option will be included
30878 verbatim in the HTML HEAD section on all pages.
30879
30880 Defaults to @samp{""}.
30881
30882 @end deftypevr
30883
30884 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} string header
30885 The content of the file specified with this option will be included
30886 verbatim at the top of all pages.
30887
30888 Defaults to @samp{""}.
30889
30890 @end deftypevr
30891
30892 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} file-object include
30893 Name of a configfile to include before the rest of the current config-
30894 file is parsed.
30895
30896 Defaults to @samp{""}.
30897
30898 @end deftypevr
30899
30900 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} string index-header
30901 The content of the file specified with this option will be included
30902 verbatim above the repository index.
30903
30904 Defaults to @samp{""}.
30905
30906 @end deftypevr
30907
30908 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} string index-info
30909 The content of the file specified with this option will be included
30910 verbatim below the heading on the repository index page.
30911
30912 Defaults to @samp{""}.
30913
30914 @end deftypevr
30915
30916 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean local-time?
30917 Flag which, if set to @samp{#t}, makes cgit print commit and tag times
30918 in the servers timezone.
30919
30920 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
30921
30922 @end deftypevr
30923
30924 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} file-object logo
30925 URL which specifies the source of an image which will be used as a logo
30926 on all cgit pages.
30927
30928 Defaults to @samp{"/share/cgit/cgit.png"}.
30929
30930 @end deftypevr
30931
30932 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} string logo-link
30933 URL loaded when clicking on the cgit logo image.
30934
30935 Defaults to @samp{""}.
30936
30937 @end deftypevr
30938
30939 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} file-object owner-filter
30940 Command which will be invoked to format the Owner column of the main
30941 page.
30942
30943 Defaults to @samp{""}.
30944
30945 @end deftypevr
30946
30947 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} integer max-atom-items
30948 Number of items to display in atom feeds view.
30949
30950 Defaults to @samp{10}.
30951
30952 @end deftypevr
30953
30954 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} integer max-commit-count
30955 Number of entries to list per page in "log" view.
30956
30957 Defaults to @samp{50}.
30958
30959 @end deftypevr
30960
30961 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} integer max-message-length
30962 Number of commit message characters to display in "log" view.
30963
30964 Defaults to @samp{80}.
30965
30966 @end deftypevr
30967
30968 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} integer max-repo-count
30969 Specifies the number of entries to list per page on the repository index
30970 page.
30971
30972 Defaults to @samp{50}.
30973
30974 @end deftypevr
30975
30976 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} integer max-repodesc-length
30977 Specifies the maximum number of repo description characters to display
30978 on the repository index page.
30979
30980 Defaults to @samp{80}.
30981
30982 @end deftypevr
30983
30984 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} integer max-blob-size
30985 Specifies the maximum size of a blob to display HTML for in KBytes.
30986
30987 Defaults to @samp{0}.
30988
30989 @end deftypevr
30990
30991 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} string max-stats
30992 Maximum statistics period. Valid values are @samp{week},@samp{month},
30993 @samp{quarter} and @samp{year}.
30994
30995 Defaults to @samp{""}.
30996
30997 @end deftypevr
30998
30999 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} mimetype-alist mimetype
31000 Mimetype for the specified filename extension.
31001
31002 Defaults to @samp{((gif "image/gif") (html "text/html") (jpg
31003 "image/jpeg") (jpeg "image/jpeg") (pdf "application/pdf") (png
31004 "image/png") (svg "image/svg+xml"))}.
31005
31006 @end deftypevr
31007
31008 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} file-object mimetype-file
31009 Specifies the file to use for automatic mimetype lookup.
31010
31011 Defaults to @samp{""}.
31012
31013 @end deftypevr
31014
31015 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} string module-link
31016 Text which will be used as the formatstring for a hyperlink when a
31017 submodule is printed in a directory listing.
31018
31019 Defaults to @samp{""}.
31020
31021 @end deftypevr
31022
31023 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean nocache?
31024 If set to the value @samp{#t} caching will be disabled.
31025
31026 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
31027
31028 @end deftypevr
31029
31030 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean noplainemail?
31031 If set to @samp{#t} showing full author email addresses will be
31032 disabled.
31033
31034 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
31035
31036 @end deftypevr
31037
31038 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean noheader?
31039 Flag which, when set to @samp{#t}, will make cgit omit the standard
31040 header on all pages.
31041
31042 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
31043
31044 @end deftypevr
31045
31046 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} project-list project-list
31047 A list of subdirectories inside of @code{repository-directory}, relative
31048 to it, that should loaded as Git repositories. An empty list means that
31049 all subdirectories will be loaded.
31050
31051 Defaults to @samp{()}.
31052
31053 @end deftypevr
31054
31055 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} file-object readme
31056 Text which will be used as default value for @code{cgit-repo-readme}.
31057
31058 Defaults to @samp{""}.
31059
31060 @end deftypevr
31061
31062 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean remove-suffix?
31063 If set to @code{#t} and @code{repository-directory} is enabled, if any
31064 repositories are found with a suffix of @code{.git}, this suffix will be
31065 removed for the URL and name.
31066
31067 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
31068
31069 @end deftypevr
31070
31071 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} integer renamelimit
31072 Maximum number of files to consider when detecting renames.
31073
31074 Defaults to @samp{-1}.
31075
31076 @end deftypevr
31077
31078 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} string repository-sort
31079 The way in which repositories in each section are sorted.
31080
31081 Defaults to @samp{""}.
31082
31083 @end deftypevr
31084
31085 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} robots-list robots
31086 Text used as content for the @code{robots} meta-tag.
31087
31088 Defaults to @samp{("noindex" "nofollow")}.
31089
31090 @end deftypevr
31091
31092 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} string root-desc
31093 Text printed below the heading on the repository index page.
31094
31095 Defaults to @samp{"a fast webinterface for the git dscm"}.
31096
31097 @end deftypevr
31098
31099 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} string root-readme
31100 The content of the file specified with this option will be included
31101 verbatim below the ``about'' link on the repository index page.
31102
31103 Defaults to @samp{""}.
31104
31105 @end deftypevr
31106
31107 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} string root-title
31108 Text printed as heading on the repository index page.
31109
31110 Defaults to @samp{""}.
31111
31112 @end deftypevr
31113
31114 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean scan-hidden-path
31115 If set to @samp{#t} and repository-directory is enabled,
31116 repository-directory will recurse into directories whose name starts
31117 with a period. Otherwise, repository-directory will stay away from such
31118 directories, considered as ``hidden''. Note that this does not apply to
31119 the @file{.git} directory in non-bare repos.
31120
31121 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
31122
31123 @end deftypevr
31124
31125 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} list snapshots
31126 Text which specifies the default set of snapshot formats that cgit
31127 generates links for.
31128
31129 Defaults to @samp{()}.
31130
31131 @end deftypevr
31132
31133 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} repository-directory repository-directory
31134 Name of the directory to scan for repositories (represents
31135 @code{scan-path}).
31136
31137 Defaults to @samp{"/srv/git"}.
31138
31139 @end deftypevr
31140
31141 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} string section
31142 The name of the current repository section - all repositories defined
31143 after this option will inherit the current section name.
31144
31145 Defaults to @samp{""}.
31146
31147 @end deftypevr
31148
31149 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} string section-sort
31150 Flag which, when set to @samp{1}, will sort the sections on the
31151 repository listing by name.
31152
31153 Defaults to @samp{""}.
31154
31155 @end deftypevr
31156
31157 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} integer section-from-path
31158 A number which, if defined prior to repository-directory, specifies how
31159 many path elements from each repo path to use as a default section name.
31160
31161 Defaults to @samp{0}.
31162
31163 @end deftypevr
31164
31165 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean side-by-side-diffs?
31166 If set to @samp{#t} shows side-by-side diffs instead of unidiffs per
31167 default.
31168
31169 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
31170
31171 @end deftypevr
31172
31173 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} file-object source-filter
31174 Specifies a command which will be invoked to format plaintext blobs in
31175 the tree view.
31176
31177 Defaults to @samp{""}.
31178
31179 @end deftypevr
31180
31181 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} integer summary-branches
31182 Specifies the number of branches to display in the repository ``summary''
31183 view.
31184
31185 Defaults to @samp{10}.
31186
31187 @end deftypevr
31188
31189 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} integer summary-log
31190 Specifies the number of log entries to display in the repository
31191 ``summary'' view.
31192
31193 Defaults to @samp{10}.
31194
31195 @end deftypevr
31196
31197 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} integer summary-tags
31198 Specifies the number of tags to display in the repository ``summary''
31199 view.
31200
31201 Defaults to @samp{10}.
31202
31203 @end deftypevr
31204
31205 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} string strict-export
31206 Filename which, if specified, needs to be present within the repository
31207 for cgit to allow access to that repository.
31208
31209 Defaults to @samp{""}.
31210
31211 @end deftypevr
31212
31213 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} string virtual-root
31214 URL which, if specified, will be used as root for all cgit links.
31215
31216 Defaults to @samp{"/"}.
31217
31218 @end deftypevr
31219
31220 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} repository-cgit-configuration-list repositories
31221 A list of @dfn{cgit-repo} records to use with config.
31222
31223 Defaults to @samp{()}.
31224
31225 Available @code{repository-cgit-configuration} fields are:
31226
31227 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-list snapshots
31228 A mask of snapshot formats for this repo that cgit generates links for,
31229 restricted by the global @code{snapshots} setting.
31230
31231 Defaults to @samp{()}.
31232
31233 @end deftypevr
31234
31235 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-file-object source-filter
31236 Override the default @code{source-filter}.
31237
31238 Defaults to @samp{""}.
31239
31240 @end deftypevr
31241
31242 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-string url
31243 The relative URL used to access the repository.
31244
31245 Defaults to @samp{""}.
31246
31247 @end deftypevr
31248
31249 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-file-object about-filter
31250 Override the default @code{about-filter}.
31251
31252 Defaults to @samp{""}.
31253
31254 @end deftypevr
31255
31256 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-string branch-sort
31257 Flag which, when set to @samp{age}, enables date ordering in the branch
31258 ref list, and when set to @samp{name} enables ordering by branch name.
31259
31260 Defaults to @samp{""}.
31261
31262 @end deftypevr
31263
31264 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-list clone-url
31265 A list of URLs which can be used to clone repo.
31266
31267 Defaults to @samp{()}.
31268
31269 @end deftypevr
31270
31271 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-file-object commit-filter
31272 Override the default @code{commit-filter}.
31273
31274 Defaults to @samp{""}.
31275
31276 @end deftypevr
31277
31278 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-string commit-sort
31279 Flag which, when set to @samp{date}, enables strict date ordering in the
31280 commit log, and when set to @samp{topo} enables strict topological
31281 ordering.
31282
31283 Defaults to @samp{""}.
31284
31285 @end deftypevr
31286
31287 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-string defbranch
31288 The name of the default branch for this repository. If no such branch
31289 exists in the repository, the first branch name (when sorted) is used as
31290 default instead. By default branch pointed to by HEAD, or ``master'' if
31291 there is no suitable HEAD.
31292
31293 Defaults to @samp{""}.
31294
31295 @end deftypevr
31296
31297 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-string desc
31298 The value to show as repository description.
31299
31300 Defaults to @samp{""}.
31301
31302 @end deftypevr
31303
31304 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-string homepage
31305 The value to show as repository homepage.
31306
31307 Defaults to @samp{""}.
31308
31309 @end deftypevr
31310
31311 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-file-object email-filter
31312 Override the default @code{email-filter}.
31313
31314 Defaults to @samp{""}.
31315
31316 @end deftypevr
31317
31318 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} maybe-repo-boolean enable-commit-graph?
31319 A flag which can be used to disable the global setting
31320 @code{enable-commit-graph?}.
31321
31322 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
31323
31324 @end deftypevr
31325
31326 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} maybe-repo-boolean enable-log-filecount?
31327 A flag which can be used to disable the global setting
31328 @code{enable-log-filecount?}.
31329
31330 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
31331
31332 @end deftypevr
31333
31334 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} maybe-repo-boolean enable-log-linecount?
31335 A flag which can be used to disable the global setting
31336 @code{enable-log-linecount?}.
31337
31338 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
31339
31340 @end deftypevr
31341
31342 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} maybe-repo-boolean enable-remote-branches?
31343 Flag which, when set to @code{#t}, will make cgit display remote
31344 branches in the summary and refs views.
31345
31346 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
31347
31348 @end deftypevr
31349
31350 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} maybe-repo-boolean enable-subject-links?
31351 A flag which can be used to override the global setting
31352 @code{enable-subject-links?}.
31353
31354 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
31355
31356 @end deftypevr
31357
31358 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} maybe-repo-boolean enable-html-serving?
31359 A flag which can be used to override the global setting
31360 @code{enable-html-serving?}.
31361
31362 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
31363
31364 @end deftypevr
31365
31366 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-boolean hide?
31367 Flag which, when set to @code{#t}, hides the repository from the
31368 repository index.
31369
31370 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
31371
31372 @end deftypevr
31373
31374 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-boolean ignore?
31375 Flag which, when set to @samp{#t}, ignores the repository.
31376
31377 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
31378
31379 @end deftypevr
31380
31381 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-file-object logo
31382 URL which specifies the source of an image which will be used as a logo
31383 on this repo’s pages.
31384
31385 Defaults to @samp{""}.
31386
31387 @end deftypevr
31388
31389 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-string logo-link
31390 URL loaded when clicking on the cgit logo image.
31391
31392 Defaults to @samp{""}.
31393
31394 @end deftypevr
31395
31396 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-file-object owner-filter
31397 Override the default @code{owner-filter}.
31398
31399 Defaults to @samp{""}.
31400
31401 @end deftypevr
31402
31403 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-string module-link
31404 Text which will be used as the formatstring for a hyperlink when a
31405 submodule is printed in a directory listing. The arguments for the
31406 formatstring are the path and SHA1 of the submodule commit.
31407
31408 Defaults to @samp{""}.
31409
31410 @end deftypevr
31411
31412 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} module-link-path module-link-path
31413 Text which will be used as the formatstring for a hyperlink when a
31414 submodule with the specified subdirectory path is printed in a directory
31415 listing.
31416
31417 Defaults to @samp{()}.
31418
31419 @end deftypevr
31420
31421 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-string max-stats
31422 Override the default maximum statistics period.
31423
31424 Defaults to @samp{""}.
31425
31426 @end deftypevr
31427
31428 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-string name
31429 The value to show as repository name.
31430
31431 Defaults to @samp{""}.
31432
31433 @end deftypevr
31434
31435 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-string owner
31436 A value used to identify the owner of the repository.
31437
31438 Defaults to @samp{""}.
31439
31440 @end deftypevr
31441
31442 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-string path
31443 An absolute path to the repository directory.
31444
31445 Defaults to @samp{""}.
31446
31447 @end deftypevr
31448
31449 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-string readme
31450 A path (relative to repo) which specifies a file to include verbatim as
31451 the ``About'' page for this repo.
31452
31453 Defaults to @samp{""}.
31454
31455 @end deftypevr
31456
31457 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-string section
31458 The name of the current repository section - all repositories defined
31459 after this option will inherit the current section name.
31460
31461 Defaults to @samp{""}.
31462
31463 @end deftypevr
31464
31465 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-list extra-options
31466 Extra options will be appended to cgitrc file.
31467
31468 Defaults to @samp{()}.
31469
31470 @end deftypevr
31471
31472 @end deftypevr
31473
31474 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} list extra-options
31475 Extra options will be appended to cgitrc file.
31476
31477 Defaults to @samp{()}.
31478
31479 @end deftypevr
31480
31481
31482 @c %end of fragment
31483
31484 However, it could be that you just want to get a @code{cgitrc} up and
31485 running. In that case, you can pass an @code{opaque-cgit-configuration}
31486 as a record to @code{cgit-service-type}. As its name indicates, an
31487 opaque configuration does not have easy reflective capabilities.
31488
31489 Available @code{opaque-cgit-configuration} fields are:
31490
31491 @deftypevr {@code{opaque-cgit-configuration} parameter} package cgit
31492 The cgit package.
31493 @end deftypevr
31494
31495 @deftypevr {@code{opaque-cgit-configuration} parameter} string string
31496 The contents of the @code{cgitrc}, as a string.
31497 @end deftypevr
31498
31499 For example, if your @code{cgitrc} is just the empty string, you
31500 could instantiate a cgit service like this:
31501
31502 @lisp
31503 (service cgit-service-type
31504 (opaque-cgit-configuration
31505 (cgitrc "")))
31506 @end lisp
31507
31508 @subsubheading Gitolite Service
31509
31510 @cindex Gitolite service
31511 @cindex Git, hosting
31512 @uref{https://gitolite.com/gitolite/, Gitolite} is a tool for hosting Git
31513 repositories on a central server.
31514
31515 Gitolite can handle multiple repositories and users, and supports flexible
31516 configuration of the permissions for the users on the repositories.
31517
31518 The following example will configure Gitolite using the default @code{git}
31519 user, and the provided SSH public key.
31520
31521 @lisp
31522 (service gitolite-service-type
31523 (gitolite-configuration
31524 (admin-pubkey (plain-file
31525 "yourname.pub"
31526 "ssh-rsa AAAA... guix@@example.com"))))
31527 @end lisp
31528
31529 Gitolite is configured through a special admin repository which you can clone,
31530 for example, if you setup Gitolite on @code{example.com}, you would run the
31531 following command to clone the admin repository.
31532
31533 @example
31534 git clone git@@example.com:gitolite-admin
31535 @end example
31536
31537 When the Gitolite service is activated, the provided @code{admin-pubkey} will
31538 be inserted in to the @file{keydir} directory in the gitolite-admin
31539 repository. If this results in a change in the repository, it will be
31540 committed using the message ``gitolite setup by GNU Guix''.
31541
31542 @deftp {Data Type} gitolite-configuration
31543 Data type representing the configuration for @code{gitolite-service-type}.
31544
31545 @table @asis
31546 @item @code{package} (default: @var{gitolite})
31547 Gitolite package to use.
31548
31549 @item @code{user} (default: @var{git})
31550 User to use for Gitolite. This will be user that you use when accessing
31551 Gitolite over SSH.
31552
31553 @item @code{group} (default: @var{git})
31554 Group to use for Gitolite.
31555
31556 @item @code{home-directory} (default: @var{"/var/lib/gitolite"})
31557 Directory in which to store the Gitolite configuration and repositories.
31558
31559 @item @code{rc-file} (default: @var{(gitolite-rc-file)})
31560 A ``file-like'' object (@pxref{G-Expressions, file-like objects}),
31561 representing the configuration for Gitolite.
31562
31563 @item @code{admin-pubkey} (default: @var{#f})
31564 A ``file-like'' object (@pxref{G-Expressions, file-like objects}) used to
31565 setup Gitolite. This will be inserted in to the @file{keydir} directory
31566 within the gitolite-admin repository.
31567
31568 To specify the SSH key as a string, use the @code{plain-file} function.
31569
31570 @lisp
31571 (plain-file "yourname.pub" "ssh-rsa AAAA... guix@@example.com")
31572 @end lisp
31573
31574 @end table
31575 @end deftp
31576
31577 @deftp {Data Type} gitolite-rc-file
31578 Data type representing the Gitolite RC file.
31579
31580 @table @asis
31581 @item @code{umask} (default: @code{#o0077})
31582 This controls the permissions Gitolite sets on the repositories and their
31583 contents.
31584
31585 A value like @code{#o0027} will give read access to the group used by Gitolite
31586 (by default: @code{git}). This is necessary when using Gitolite with software
31587 like cgit or gitweb.
31588
31589 @item @code{unsafe-pattern} (default: @code{#f})
31590 An optional Perl regular expression for catching unsafe configurations in
31591 the configuration file. See
31592 @uref{https://gitolite.com/gitolite/git-config.html#compensating-for-unsafe_patt,
31593 Gitolite's documentation} for more information.
31594
31595 When the value is not @code{#f}, it should be a string containing a Perl
31596 regular expression, such as @samp{"[`~#\$\&()|;<>]"}, which is the default
31597 value used by gitolite. It rejects any special character in configuration
31598 that might be interpreted by a shell, which is useful when sharing the
31599 administration burden with other people that do not otherwise have shell
31600 access on the server.
31601
31602 @item @code{git-config-keys} (default: @code{""})
31603 Gitolite allows you to set git config values using the @samp{config}
31604 keyword. This setting allows control over the config keys to accept.
31605
31606 @item @code{roles} (default: @code{'(("READERS" . 1) ("WRITERS" . ))})
31607 Set the role names allowed to be used by users running the perms command.
31608
31609 @item @code{enable} (default: @code{'("help" "desc" "info" "perms" "writable" "ssh-authkeys" "git-config" "daemon" "gitweb")})
31610 This setting controls the commands and features to enable within Gitolite.
31611
31612 @end table
31613 @end deftp
31614
31615
31616 @subsubheading Gitile Service
31617
31618 @cindex Gitile service
31619 @cindex Git, forge
31620 @uref{https://git.lepiller.eu/gitile, Gitile} is a Git forge for viewing
31621 public git repository contents from a web browser.
31622
31623 Gitile works best in collaboration with Gitolite, and will serve the public
31624 repositories from Gitolite by default. The service should listen only on
31625 a local port, and a webserver should be configured to serve static resources.
31626 The gitile service provides an easy way to extend the Nginx service for
31627 that purpose (@pxref{NGINX}).
31628
31629 The following example will configure Gitile to serve repositories from a
31630 custom location, with some default messages for the home page and the
31631 footers.
31632
31633 @lisp
31634 (service gitile-service-type
31635 (gitile-configuration
31636 (repositories "/srv/git")
31637 (base-git-url "https://myweb.site/git")
31638 (index-title "My git repositories")
31639 (intro '((p "This is all my public work!")))
31640 (footer '((p "This is the end")))
31641 (nginx-server-block
31642 (nginx-server-configuration
31643 (ssl-certificate
31644 "/etc/letsencrypt/live/myweb.site/fullchain.pem")
31645 (ssl-certificate-key
31646 "/etc/letsencrypt/live/myweb.site/privkey.pem")
31647 (listen '("443 ssl http2" "[::]:443 ssl http2"))
31648 (locations
31649 (list
31650 ;; Allow for https anonymous fetch on /git/ urls.
31651 (git-http-nginx-location-configuration
31652 (git-http-configuration
31653 (uri-path "/git/")
31654 (git-root "/var/lib/gitolite/repositories")))))))))
31655 @end lisp
31656
31657 In addition to the configuration record, you should configure your git
31658 repositories to contain some optional information. First, your public
31659 repositories need to contain the @file{git-daemon-export-ok} magic file
31660 that allows Git to export the repository. Gitile uses the presence of this
31661 file to detect public repositories it should make accessible. To do so with
31662 Gitolite for instance, modify your @file{conf/gitolite.conf} to include
31663 this in the repositories you want to make public:
31664
31665 @example
31666 repo foo
31667 R = daemon
31668 @end example
31669
31670 In addition, Gitile can read the repository configuration to display more
31671 infomation on the repository. Gitile uses the gitweb namespace for its
31672 configuration. As an example, you can use the following in your
31673 @file{conf/gitolite.conf}:
31674
31675 @example
31676 repo foo
31677 R = daemon
31678 desc = A long description, optionally with <i>HTML</i>, shown on the index page
31679 config gitweb.name = The Foo Project
31680 config gitweb.synopsis = A short description, shown on the main page of the project
31681 @end example
31682
31683 Do not forget to commit and push these changes once you are satisfied. You
31684 may need to change your gitolite configuration to allow the previous
31685 configuration options to be set. One way to do that is to add the
31686 following service definition:
31687
31688 @lisp
31689 (service gitolite-service-type
31690 (gitolite-configuration
31691 (admin-pubkey (local-file "key.pub"))
31692 (rc-file
31693 (gitolite-rc-file
31694 (umask #o0027)
31695 ;; Allow to set any configuration key
31696 (git-config-keys ".*")
31697 ;; Allow any text as a valid configuration value
31698 (unsafe-patt "^$")))))
31699 @end lisp
31700
31701 @deftp {Data Type} gitile-configuration
31702 Data type representing the configuration for @code{gitile-service-type}.
31703
31704 @table @asis
31705 @item @code{package} (default: @var{gitile})
31706 Gitile package to use.
31707
31708 @item @code{host} (default: @code{"localhost"})
31709 The host on which gitile is listening.
31710
31711 @item @code{port} (default: @code{8080})
31712 The port on which gitile is listening.
31713
31714 @item @code{database} (default: @code{"/var/lib/gitile/gitile-db.sql"})
31715 The location of the database.
31716
31717 @item @code{repositories} (default: @code{"/var/lib/gitolite/repositories"})
31718 The location of the repositories. Note that only public repositories will
31719 be shown by Gitile. To make a repository public, add an empty
31720 @file{git-daemon-export-ok} file at the root of that repository.
31721
31722 @item @code{base-git-url}
31723 The base git url that will be used to show clone commands.
31724
31725 @item @code{index-title} (default: @code{"Index"})
31726 The page title for the index page that lists all the available repositories.
31727
31728 @item @code{intro} (default: @code{'()})
31729 The intro content, as a list of sxml expressions. This is shown above the list
31730 of repositories, on the index page.
31731
31732 @item @code{footer} (default: @code{'()})
31733 The footer content, as a list of sxml expressions. This is shown on every
31734 page served by Gitile.
31735
31736 @item @code{nginx-server-block}
31737 An nginx server block that will be extended and used as a reverse proxy by
31738 Gitile to serve its pages, and as a normal web server to serve its assets.
31739
31740 You can use this block to add more custom URLs to your domain, such as a
31741 @code{/git/} URL for anonymous clones, or serving any other files you would
31742 like to serve.
31743 @end table
31744 @end deftp
31745
31746
31747 @node Game Services
31748 @subsection Game Services
31749
31750 @subsubheading The Battle for Wesnoth Service
31751 @cindex wesnothd
31752 @uref{https://wesnoth.org, The Battle for Wesnoth} is a fantasy, turn
31753 based tactical strategy game, with several single player campaigns, and
31754 multiplayer games (both networked and local).
31755
31756 @defvar {Scheme Variable} wesnothd-service-type
31757 Service type for the wesnothd service. Its value must be a
31758 @code{wesnothd-configuration} object. To run wesnothd in the default
31759 configuration, instantiate it as:
31760
31761 @lisp
31762 (service wesnothd-service-type)
31763 @end lisp
31764 @end defvar
31765
31766 @deftp {Data Type} wesnothd-configuration
31767 Data type representing the configuration of @command{wesnothd}.
31768
31769 @table @asis
31770 @item @code{package} (default: @code{wesnoth-server})
31771 The wesnoth server package to use.
31772
31773 @item @code{port} (default: @code{15000})
31774 The port to bind the server to.
31775 @end table
31776 @end deftp
31777
31778
31779 @node PAM Mount Service
31780 @subsection PAM Mount Service
31781 @cindex pam-mount
31782
31783 The @code{(gnu services pam-mount)} module provides a service allowing
31784 users to mount volumes when they log in. It should be able to mount any
31785 volume format supported by the system.
31786
31787 @defvar {Scheme Variable} pam-mount-service-type
31788 Service type for PAM Mount support.
31789 @end defvar
31790
31791 @deftp {Data Type} pam-mount-configuration
31792 Data type representing the configuration of PAM Mount.
31793
31794 It takes the following parameters:
31795
31796 @table @asis
31797 @item @code{rules}
31798 The configuration rules that will be used to generate
31799 @file{/etc/security/pam_mount.conf.xml}.
31800
31801 The configuration rules are SXML elements (@pxref{SXML,,, guile, GNU
31802 Guile Reference Manual}), and the default ones don't mount anything for
31803 anyone at login:
31804
31805 @lisp
31806 `((debug (@@ (enable "0")))
31807 (mntoptions (@@ (allow ,(string-join
31808 '("nosuid" "nodev" "loop"
31809 "encryption" "fsck" "nonempty"
31810 "allow_root" "allow_other")
31811 ","))))
31812 (mntoptions (@@ (require "nosuid,nodev")))
31813 (logout (@@ (wait "0")
31814 (hup "0")
31815 (term "no")
31816 (kill "no")))
31817 (mkmountpoint (@@ (enable "1")
31818 (remove "true"))))
31819 @end lisp
31820
31821 Some @code{volume} elements must be added to automatically mount volumes
31822 at login. Here's an example allowing the user @code{alice} to mount her
31823 encrypted @env{HOME} directory and allowing the user @code{bob} to mount
31824 the partition where he stores his data:
31825
31826 @lisp
31827 (define pam-mount-rules
31828 `((debug (@@ (enable "0")))
31829 (volume (@@ (user "alice")
31830 (fstype "crypt")
31831 (path "/dev/sda2")
31832 (mountpoint "/home/alice")))
31833 (volume (@@ (user "bob")
31834 (fstype "auto")
31835 (path "/dev/sdb3")
31836 (mountpoint "/home/bob/data")
31837 (options "defaults,autodefrag,compress")))
31838 (mntoptions (@@ (allow ,(string-join
31839 '("nosuid" "nodev" "loop"
31840 "encryption" "fsck" "nonempty"
31841 "allow_root" "allow_other")
31842 ","))))
31843 (mntoptions (@@ (require "nosuid,nodev")))
31844 (logout (@@ (wait "0")
31845 (hup "0")
31846 (term "no")
31847 (kill "no")))
31848 (mkmountpoint (@@ (enable "1")
31849 (remove "true")))))
31850
31851 (service pam-mount-service-type
31852 (pam-mount-configuration
31853 (rules pam-mount-rules)))
31854 @end lisp
31855
31856 The complete list of possible options can be found in the man page for
31857 @uref{http://pam-mount.sourceforge.net/pam_mount.conf.5.html, pam_mount.conf}.
31858 @end table
31859 @end deftp
31860
31861
31862 @node Guix Services
31863 @subsection Guix Services
31864
31865 @subsubheading Guix Build Coordinator
31866 The @uref{https://git.cbaines.net/guix/build-coordinator/,Guix Build
31867 Coordinator} aids in distributing derivation builds among machines
31868 running an @dfn{agent}. The build daemon is still used to build the
31869 derivations, but the Guix Build Coordinator manages allocating builds
31870 and working with the results.
31871
31872 @quotation Note
31873 This service is considered experimental. Configuration options may be
31874 changed in a backwards-incompatible manner, and not all features have
31875 been thorougly tested.
31876 @end quotation
31877
31878 The Guix Build Coordinator consists of one @dfn{coordinator}, and one or
31879 more connected @dfn{agent} processes. The coordinator process handles
31880 clients submitting builds, and allocating builds to agents. The agent
31881 processes talk to a build daemon to actually perform the builds, then
31882 send the results back to the coordinator.
31883
31884 There is a script to run the coordinator component of the Guix Build
31885 Coordinator, but the Guix service uses a custom Guile script instead, to
31886 provide better integration with G-expressions used in the configuration.
31887
31888 @defvar {Scheme Variable} guix-build-coordinator-service-type
31889 Service type for the Guix Build Coordinator. Its value must be a
31890 @code{guix-build-coordinator-configuration} object.
31891 @end defvar
31892
31893 @deftp {Data Type} guix-build-coordinator-configuration
31894 Data type representing the configuration of the Guix Build Coordinator.
31895
31896 @table @asis
31897 @item @code{package} (default: @code{guix-build-coordinator})
31898 The Guix Build Coordinator package to use.
31899
31900 @item @code{user} (default: @code{"guix-build-coordinator"})
31901 The system user to run the service as.
31902
31903 @item @code{group} (default: @code{"guix-build-coordinator"})
31904 The system group to run the service as.
31905
31906 @item @code{database-uri-string} (default: @code{"sqlite:///var/lib/guix-build-coordinator/guix_build_coordinator.db"})
31907 The URI to use for the database.
31908
31909 @item @code{agent-communication-uri} (default: @code{"http://0.0.0.0:8745"})
31910 The URI describing how to listen to requests from agent processes.
31911
31912 @item @code{client-communication-uri} (default: @code{"http://127.0.0.1:8746"})
31913 The URI describing how to listen to requests from clients. The client
31914 API allows submitting builds and currently isn't authenticated, so take
31915 care when configuring this value.
31916
31917 @item @code{allocation-strategy} (default: @code{#~basic-build-allocation-strategy})
31918 A G-expression for the allocation strategy to be used. This is a
31919 procedure that takes the datastore as an argument and populates the
31920 allocation plan in the database.
31921
31922 @item @code{hooks} (default: @var{'()})
31923 An association list of hooks. These provide a way to execute arbitrary
31924 code upon certain events, like a build result being processed.
31925
31926 @item @code{guile} (default: @code{guile-3.0-latest})
31927 The Guile package with which to run the Guix Build Coordinator.
31928
31929 @end table
31930 @end deftp
31931
31932 @defvar {Scheme Variable} guix-build-coordinator-agent-service-type
31933 Service type for a Guix Build Coordinator agent. Its value must be a
31934 @code{guix-build-coordinator-agent-configuration} object.
31935 @end defvar
31936
31937 @deftp {Data Type} guix-build-coordinator-agent-configuration
31938 Data type representing the configuration a Guix Build Coordinator agent.
31939
31940 @table @asis
31941 @item @code{package} (default: @code{guix-build-coordinator})
31942 The Guix Build Coordinator package to use.
31943
31944 @item @code{user} (default: @code{"guix-build-coordinator-agent"})
31945 The system user to run the service as.
31946
31947 @item @code{coordinator} (default: @code{"http://localhost:8745"})
31948 The URI to use when connecting to the coordinator.
31949
31950 @item @code{authentication}
31951 Record describing how this agent should authenticate with the
31952 coordinator. Possible record types are described below.
31953
31954 @item @code{systems} (default: @code{#f})
31955 The systems for which this agent should fetch builds. The agent process
31956 will use the current system it's running on as the default.
31957
31958 @item @code{max-parallel-builds} (default: @code{1})
31959 The number of builds to perform in parallel.
31960
31961 @item @code{max-1min-load-average} (default: @code{#f})
31962 Load average value to look at when considering starting new builds, if
31963 the 1 minute load average exceeds this value, the agent will wait before
31964 starting new builds.
31965
31966 This will be unspecified if the value is @code{#f}, and the agent will
31967 use the number of cores reported by the system as the max 1 minute load
31968 average.
31969
31970 @item @code{derivation-substitute-urls} (default: @code{#f})
31971 URLs from which to attempt to fetch substitutes for derivations, if the
31972 derivations aren't already available.
31973
31974 @item @code{non-derivation-substitute-urls} (default: @code{#f})
31975 URLs from which to attempt to fetch substitutes for build inputs, if the
31976 input store items aren't already available.
31977
31978 @end table
31979 @end deftp
31980
31981 @deftp {Data Type} guix-build-coordinator-agent-password-auth
31982 Data type representing an agent authenticating with a coordinator via a
31983 UUID and password.
31984
31985 @table @asis
31986 @item @code{uuid}
31987 The UUID of the agent. This should be generated by the coordinator
31988 process, stored in the coordinator database, and used by the intended
31989 agent.
31990
31991 @item @code{password}
31992 The password to use when connecting to the coordinator.
31993
31994 @end table
31995 @end deftp
31996
31997 @deftp {Data Type} guix-build-coordinator-agent-password-file-auth
31998 Data type representing an agent authenticating with a coordinator via a
31999 UUID and password read from a file.
32000
32001 @table @asis
32002 @item @code{uuid}
32003 The UUID of the agent. This should be generated by the coordinator
32004 process, stored in the coordinator database, and used by the intended
32005 agent.
32006
32007 @item @code{password-file}
32008 A file containing the password to use when connecting to the
32009 coordinator.
32010
32011 @end table
32012 @end deftp
32013
32014 @deftp {Data Type} guix-build-coordinator-agent-dynamic-auth
32015 Data type representing an agent authenticating with a coordinator via a
32016 dynamic auth token and agent name.
32017
32018 @table @asis
32019 @item @code{agent-name}
32020 Name of an agent, this is used to match up to an existing entry in the
32021 database if there is one. When no existing entry is found, a new entry
32022 is automatically added.
32023
32024 @item @code{token}
32025 Dynamic auth token, this is created and stored in the coordinator
32026 database, and is used by the agent to authenticate.
32027
32028 @end table
32029 @end deftp
32030
32031 @deftp {Data Type} guix-build-coordinator-agent-dynamic-auth-with-file
32032 Data type representing an agent authenticating with a coordinator via a
32033 dynamic auth token read from a file and agent name.
32034
32035 @table @asis
32036 @item @code{agent-name}
32037 Name of an agent, this is used to match up to an existing entry in the
32038 database if there is one. When no existing entry is found, a new entry
32039 is automatically added.
32040
32041 @item @code{token-file}
32042 File containing the dynamic auth token, this is created and stored in
32043 the coordinator database, and is used by the agent to authenticate.
32044
32045 @end table
32046 @end deftp
32047
32048 The Guix Build Coordinator package contains a script to query an
32049 instance of the Guix Data Service for derivations to build, and then
32050 submit builds for those derivations to the coordinator. The service
32051 type below assists in running this script. This is an additional tool
32052 that may be useful when building derivations contained within an
32053 instance of the Guix Data Service.
32054
32055 @defvar {Scheme Variable} guix-build-coordinator-queue-builds-service-type
32056 Service type for the
32057 guix-build-coordinator-queue-builds-from-guix-data-service script. Its
32058 value must be a @code{guix-build-coordinator-queue-builds-configuration}
32059 object.
32060 @end defvar
32061
32062 @deftp {Data Type} guix-build-coordinator-queue-builds-configuration
32063 Data type representing the options to the queue builds from guix data
32064 service script.
32065
32066 @table @asis
32067 @item @code{package} (default: @code{guix-build-coordinator})
32068 The Guix Build Coordinator package to use.
32069
32070 @item @code{user} (default: @code{"guix-build-coordinator-queue-builds"})
32071 The system user to run the service as.
32072
32073 @item @code{coordinator} (default: @code{"http://localhost:8746"})
32074 The URI to use when connecting to the coordinator.
32075
32076 @item @code{systems} (default: @code{#f})
32077 The systems for which to fetch derivations to build.
32078
32079 @item @code{systems-and-targets} (default: @code{#f})
32080 An association list of system and target pairs for which to fetch
32081 derivations to build.
32082
32083 @item @code{guix-data-service} (default: @code{"https://data.guix.gnu.org"})
32084 The Guix Data Service instance from which to query to find out about
32085 derivations to build.
32086
32087 @item @code{processed-commits-file} (default: @code{"/var/cache/guix-build-coordinator-queue-builds/processed-commits"})
32088 A file to record which commits have been processed, to avoid needlessly
32089 processing them again if the service is restarted.
32090
32091 @end table
32092 @end deftp
32093
32094 @subsubheading Guix Data Service
32095 The @uref{http://data.guix.gnu.org,Guix Data Service} processes, stores
32096 and provides data about GNU Guix. This includes information about
32097 packages, derivations and lint warnings.
32098
32099 The data is stored in a PostgreSQL database, and available through a web
32100 interface.
32101
32102 @defvar {Scheme Variable} guix-data-service-type
32103 Service type for the Guix Data Service. Its value must be a
32104 @code{guix-data-service-configuration} object. The service optionally
32105 extends the getmail service, as the guix-commits mailing list is used to
32106 find out about changes in the Guix git repository.
32107 @end defvar
32108
32109 @deftp {Data Type} guix-data-service-configuration
32110 Data type representing the configuration of the Guix Data Service.
32111
32112 @table @asis
32113 @item @code{package} (default: @code{guix-data-service})
32114 The Guix Data Service package to use.
32115
32116 @item @code{user} (default: @code{"guix-data-service"})
32117 The system user to run the service as.
32118
32119 @item @code{group} (default: @code{"guix-data-service"})
32120 The system group to run the service as.
32121
32122 @item @code{port} (default: @code{8765})
32123 The port to bind the web service to.
32124
32125 @item @code{host} (default: @code{"127.0.0.1"})
32126 The host to bind the web service to.
32127
32128 @item @code{getmail-idle-mailboxes} (default: @code{#f})
32129 If set, this is the list of mailboxes that the getmail service will be
32130 configured to listen to.
32131
32132 @item @code{commits-getmail-retriever-configuration} (default: @code{#f})
32133 If set, this is the @code{getmail-retriever-configuration} object with
32134 which to configure getmail to fetch mail from the guix-commits mailing
32135 list.
32136
32137 @item @code{extra-options} (default: @var{'()})
32138 Extra command line options for @code{guix-data-service}.
32139
32140 @item @code{extra-process-jobs-options} (default: @var{'()})
32141 Extra command line options for @code{guix-data-service-process-jobs}.
32142
32143 @end table
32144 @end deftp
32145
32146 @node Linux Services
32147 @subsection Linux Services
32148
32149 @cindex oom
32150 @cindex out of memory killer
32151 @cindex earlyoom
32152 @cindex early out of memory daemon
32153 @subsubheading Early OOM Service
32154
32155 @uref{https://github.com/rfjakob/earlyoom,Early OOM}, also known as
32156 Earlyoom, is a minimalist out of memory (OOM) daemon that runs in user
32157 space and provides a more responsive and configurable alternative to the
32158 in-kernel OOM killer. It is useful to prevent the system from becoming
32159 unresponsive when it runs out of memory.
32160
32161 @deffn {Scheme Variable} earlyoom-service-type
32162 The service type for running @command{earlyoom}, the Early OOM daemon.
32163 Its value must be a @code{earlyoom-configuration} object, described
32164 below. The service can be instantiated in its default configuration
32165 with:
32166
32167 @lisp
32168 (service earlyoom-service-type)
32169 @end lisp
32170 @end deffn
32171
32172 @deftp {Data Type} earlyoom-configuration
32173 This is the configuration record for the @code{earlyoom-service-type}.
32174
32175 @table @asis
32176 @item @code{earlyoom} (default: @var{earlyoom})
32177 The Earlyoom package to use.
32178
32179 @item @code{minimum-available-memory} (default: @code{10})
32180 The threshold for the minimum @emph{available} memory, in percentages.
32181
32182 @item @code{minimum-free-swap} (default: @code{10})
32183 The threshold for the minimum free swap memory, in percentages.
32184
32185 @item @code{prefer-regexp} (default: @code{#f})
32186 A regular expression (as a string) to match the names of the processes
32187 that should be preferably killed.
32188
32189 @item @code{avoid-regexp} (default: @code{#f})
32190 A regular expression (as a string) to match the names of the processes
32191 that should @emph{not} be killed.
32192
32193 @item @code{memory-report-interval} (default: @code{0})
32194 The interval in seconds at which a memory report is printed. It is
32195 disabled by default.
32196
32197 @item @code{ignore-positive-oom-score-adj?} (default: @code{#f})
32198 A boolean indicating whether the positive adjustments set in
32199 @file{/proc/*/oom_score_adj} should be ignored.
32200
32201 @item @code{show-debug-messages?} (default: @code{#f})
32202 A boolean indicating whether debug messages should be printed. The logs
32203 are saved at @file{/var/log/earlyoom.log}.
32204
32205 @item @code{send-notification-command} (default: @code{#f})
32206 This can be used to provide a custom command used for sending
32207 notifications.
32208 @end table
32209 @end deftp
32210
32211 @cindex modprobe
32212 @cindex kernel module loader
32213 @subsubheading Kernel Module Loader Service
32214
32215 The kernel module loader service allows one to load loadable kernel
32216 modules at boot. This is especially useful for modules that don't
32217 autoload and need to be manually loaded, as is the case with
32218 @code{ddcci}.
32219
32220 @deffn {Scheme Variable} kernel-module-loader-service-type
32221 The service type for loading loadable kernel modules at boot with
32222 @command{modprobe}. Its value must be a list of strings representing
32223 module names. For example loading the drivers provided by
32224 @code{ddcci-driver-linux}, in debugging mode by passing some module
32225 parameters, can be done as follow:
32226
32227 @lisp
32228 (use-modules (gnu) (gnu services))
32229 (use-package-modules linux)
32230 (use-service-modules linux)
32231
32232 (define ddcci-config
32233 (plain-file "ddcci.conf"
32234 "options ddcci dyndbg delay=120"))
32235
32236 (operating-system
32237 ...
32238 (services (cons* (service kernel-module-loader-service-type
32239 '("ddcci" "ddcci_backlight"))
32240 (simple-service 'ddcci-config etc-service-type
32241 (list `("modprobe.d/ddcci.conf"
32242 ,ddcci-config)))
32243 %base-services))
32244 (kernel-loadable-modules (list ddcci-driver-linux)))
32245 @end lisp
32246 @end deffn
32247
32248 @cindex rasdaemon
32249 @cindex Platform Reliability, Availability and Serviceability daemon
32250 @subsubheading Rasdaemon Service
32251
32252 The Rasdaemon service provides a daemon which monitors platform
32253 @acronym{RAS, Reliability@comma{} Availability@comma{} and Serviceability} reports from
32254 Linux kernel trace events, logging them to syslogd.
32255
32256 Reliability, Availability and Serviceability is a concept used on servers meant
32257 to measure their robustness.
32258
32259 @strong{Relability} is the probability that a system will produce correct
32260 outputs:
32261
32262 @itemize @bullet
32263 @item Generally measured as Mean Time Between Failures (MTBF), and
32264 @item Enhanced by features that help to avoid, detect and repair hardware
32265 faults
32266 @end itemize
32267
32268 @strong{Availability} is the probability that a system is operational at a
32269 given time:
32270
32271 @itemize @bullet
32272 @item Generally measured as a percentage of downtime per a period of time, and
32273 @item Often uses mechanisms to detect and correct hardware faults in runtime.
32274 @end itemize
32275
32276 @strong{Serviceability} is the simplicity and speed with which a system can be
32277 repaired or maintained:
32278
32279 @itemize @bullet
32280 @item Generally measured on Mean Time Between Repair (MTBR).
32281 @end itemize
32282
32283
32284 Among the monitoring measures, the most usual ones include:
32285
32286 @itemize @bullet
32287 @item CPU – detect errors at instruction execution and at L1/L2/L3 caches;
32288 @item Memory – add error correction logic (ECC) to detect and correct errors;
32289 @item I/O – add CRC checksums for transferred data;
32290 @item Storage – RAID, journal file systems, checksums, Self-Monitoring,
32291 Analysis and Reporting Technology (SMART).
32292 @end itemize
32293
32294 By monitoring the number of occurrences of error detections, it is possible to
32295 identify if the probability of hardware errors is increasing, and, on such
32296 case, do a preventive maintenance to replace a degraded component while those
32297 errors are correctable.
32298
32299 For detailed information about the types of error events gathered and how to
32300 make sense of them, see the kernel administrator's guide at
32301 @url{https://www.kernel.org/doc/html/latest/admin-guide/ras.html}.
32302
32303 @defvr {Scheme Variable} rasdaemon-service-type
32304 Service type for the @command{rasdaemon} service. It accepts a
32305 @code{rasdaemon-configuration} object. Instantiating like
32306
32307 @lisp
32308 (service rasdaemon-service-type)
32309 @end lisp
32310
32311 will load with a default configuration, which monitors all events and logs to
32312 syslogd.
32313 @end defvr
32314
32315 @deftp {Data Type} rasdaemon-configuration
32316 The data type representing the configuration of @command{rasdaemon}.
32317
32318 @table @asis
32319 @item @code{record?} (default: @code{#f})
32320
32321 A boolean indicating whether to record the events in an SQLite database. This
32322 provides a more structured access to the information contained in the log file.
32323 The database location is hard-coded to @file{/var/lib/rasdaemon/ras-mc_event.db}.
32324
32325 @end table
32326 @end deftp
32327
32328 @cindex zram
32329 @cindex compressed swap
32330 @cindex Compressed RAM-based block devices
32331 @subsubheading Zram Device Service
32332
32333 The Zram device service provides a compressed swap device in system
32334 memory. The Linux Kernel documentation has more information about
32335 @uref{https://www.kernel.org/doc/html/latest/admin-guide/blockdev/zram.html,zram}
32336 devices.
32337
32338 @deffn {Scheme Variable} zram-device-service-type
32339 This service creates the zram block device, formats it as swap and
32340 enables it as a swap device. The service's value is a
32341 @code{zram-device-configuration} record.
32342
32343 @deftp {Data Type} zram-device-configuration
32344 This is the data type representing the configuration for the zram-device
32345 service.
32346
32347 @table @asis
32348 @item @code{size} (default @code{"1G"})
32349 This is the amount of space you wish to provide for the zram device. It
32350 accepts a string and can be a number of bytes or use a suffix, eg.:
32351 @code{"512M"} or @code{1024000}.
32352 @item @code{compression-algorithm} (default @code{'lzo})
32353 This is the compression algorithm you wish to use. It is difficult to
32354 list all the possible compression options, but common ones supported by
32355 Guix's Linux Libre Kernel include @code{'lzo}, @code{'lz4} and @code{'zstd}.
32356 @item @code{memory-limit} (default @code{0})
32357 This is the maximum amount of memory which the zram device can use.
32358 Setting it to '0' disables the limit. While it is generally expected
32359 that compression will be 2:1, it is possible that uncompressable data
32360 can be written to swap and this is a method to limit how much memory can
32361 be used. It accepts a string and can be a number of bytes or use a
32362 suffix, eg.: @code{"2G"}.
32363 @item @code{priority} (default @code{-1})
32364 This is the priority of the swap device created from the zram device.
32365 @code{swapon} accepts values between -1 and 32767, with higher values
32366 indicating higher priority. Higher priority swap will generally be used
32367 first.
32368 @end table
32369
32370 @end deftp
32371 @end deffn
32372
32373 @node Hurd Services
32374 @subsection Hurd Services
32375
32376 @defvr {Scheme Variable} hurd-console-service-type
32377 This service starts the fancy @code{VGA} console client on the Hurd.
32378
32379 The service's value is a @code{hurd-console-configuration} record.
32380 @end defvr
32381
32382 @deftp {Data Type} hurd-console-configuration
32383 This is the data type representing the configuration for the
32384 hurd-console-service.
32385
32386 @table @asis
32387 @item @code{hurd} (default: @var{hurd})
32388 The Hurd package to use.
32389 @end table
32390 @end deftp
32391
32392 @defvr {Scheme Variable} hurd-getty-service-type
32393 This service starts a tty using the Hurd @code{getty} program.
32394
32395 The service's value is a @code{hurd-getty-configuration} record.
32396 @end defvr
32397
32398 @deftp {Data Type} hurd-getty-configuration
32399 This is the data type representing the configuration for the
32400 hurd-getty-service.
32401
32402 @table @asis
32403 @item @code{hurd} (default: @var{hurd})
32404 The Hurd package to use.
32405
32406 @item @code{tty}
32407 The name of the console this Getty runs on---e.g., @code{"tty1"}.
32408
32409 @item @code{baud-rate} (default: @code{38400})
32410 An integer specifying the baud rate of the tty.
32411
32412 @end table
32413 @end deftp
32414
32415 @node Miscellaneous Services
32416 @subsection Miscellaneous Services
32417
32418 @cindex fingerprint
32419 @subsubheading Fingerprint Service
32420
32421 The @code{(gnu services authentication)} module provides a DBus service to
32422 read and identify fingerprints via a fingerprint sensor.
32423
32424 @defvr {Scheme Variable} fprintd-service-type
32425 The service type for @command{fprintd}, which provides the fingerprint
32426 reading capability.
32427
32428 @lisp
32429 (service fprintd-service-type)
32430 @end lisp
32431 @end defvr
32432
32433 @cindex sysctl
32434 @subsubheading System Control Service
32435
32436 The @code{(gnu services sysctl)} provides a service to configure kernel
32437 parameters at boot.
32438
32439 @defvr {Scheme Variable} sysctl-service-type
32440 The service type for @command{sysctl}, which modifies kernel parameters
32441 under @file{/proc/sys/}. To enable IPv4 forwarding, it can be
32442 instantiated as:
32443
32444 @lisp
32445 (service sysctl-service-type
32446 (sysctl-configuration
32447 (settings '(("net.ipv4.ip_forward" . "1")))))
32448 @end lisp
32449
32450 Since @code{sysctl-service-type} is used in the default lists of
32451 services, @code{%base-services} and @code{%desktop-services}, you can
32452 use @code{modify-services} to change its configuration and add the
32453 kernel parameters that you want (@pxref{Service Reference,
32454 @code{modify-services}}).
32455
32456 @lisp
32457 (modify-services %base-services
32458 (sysctl-service-type config =>
32459 (sysctl-configuration
32460 (settings (append '(("net.ipv4.ip_forward" . "1"))
32461 %default-sysctl-settings)))))
32462 @end lisp
32463
32464 @end defvr
32465
32466 @deftp {Data Type} sysctl-configuration
32467 The data type representing the configuration of @command{sysctl}.
32468
32469 @table @asis
32470 @item @code{sysctl} (default: @code{(file-append procps "/sbin/sysctl"})
32471 The @command{sysctl} executable to use.
32472
32473 @item @code{settings} (default: @code{%default-sysctl-settings})
32474 An association list specifies kernel parameters and their values.
32475 @end table
32476 @end deftp
32477
32478 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %default-sysctl-settings
32479 An association list specifying the default @command{sysctl} parameters
32480 on Guix System.
32481 @end defvr
32482
32483 @cindex pcscd
32484 @subsubheading PC/SC Smart Card Daemon Service
32485
32486 The @code{(gnu services security-token)} module provides the following service
32487 to run @command{pcscd}, the PC/SC Smart Card Daemon. @command{pcscd} is the
32488 daemon program for pcsc-lite and the MuscleCard framework. It is a resource
32489 manager that coordinates communications with smart card readers, smart cards
32490 and cryptographic tokens that are connected to the system.
32491
32492 @defvr {Scheme Variable} pcscd-service-type
32493 Service type for the @command{pcscd} service. Its value must be a
32494 @code{pcscd-configuration} object. To run pcscd in the default
32495 configuration, instantiate it as:
32496
32497 @lisp
32498 (service pcscd-service-type)
32499 @end lisp
32500 @end defvr
32501
32502 @deftp {Data Type} pcscd-configuration
32503 The data type representing the configuration of @command{pcscd}.
32504
32505 @table @asis
32506 @item @code{pcsc-lite} (default: @code{pcsc-lite})
32507 The pcsc-lite package that provides pcscd.
32508 @item @code{usb-drivers} (default: @code{(list ccid)})
32509 List of packages that provide USB drivers to pcscd. Drivers are expected to be
32510 under @file{pcsc/drivers} in the store directory of the package.
32511 @end table
32512 @end deftp
32513
32514 @cindex lirc
32515 @subsubheading Lirc Service
32516
32517 The @code{(gnu services lirc)} module provides the following service.
32518
32519 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} lirc-service [#:lirc lirc] @
32520 [#:device #f] [#:driver #f] [#:config-file #f] @
32521 [#:extra-options '()]
32522 Return a service that runs @url{http://www.lirc.org,LIRC}, a daemon that
32523 decodes infrared signals from remote controls.
32524
32525 Optionally, @var{device}, @var{driver} and @var{config-file}
32526 (configuration file name) may be specified. See @command{lircd} manual
32527 for details.
32528
32529 Finally, @var{extra-options} is a list of additional command-line options
32530 passed to @command{lircd}.
32531 @end deffn
32532
32533 @cindex spice
32534 @subsubheading Spice Service
32535
32536 The @code{(gnu services spice)} module provides the following service.
32537
32538 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} spice-vdagent-service [#:spice-vdagent]
32539 Returns a service that runs @url{https://www.spice-space.org,VDAGENT}, a daemon
32540 that enables sharing the clipboard with a vm and setting the guest display
32541 resolution when the graphical console window resizes.
32542 @end deffn
32543
32544 @cindex inputattach
32545 @subsubheading inputattach Service
32546
32547 @cindex tablet input, for Xorg
32548 @cindex touchscreen input, for Xorg
32549 The @uref{https://linuxwacom.github.io/, inputattach} service allows you to
32550 use input devices such as Wacom tablets, touchscreens, or joysticks with the
32551 Xorg display server.
32552
32553 @deffn {Scheme Variable} inputattach-service-type
32554 Type of a service that runs @command{inputattach} on a device and
32555 dispatches events from it.
32556 @end deffn
32557
32558 @deftp {Data Type} inputattach-configuration
32559 @table @asis
32560 @item @code{device-type} (default: @code{"wacom"})
32561 The type of device to connect to. Run @command{inputattach --help}, from the
32562 @code{inputattach} package, to see the list of supported device types.
32563
32564 @item @code{device} (default: @code{"/dev/ttyS0"})
32565 The device file to connect to the device.
32566
32567 @item @code{baud-rate} (default: @code{#f})
32568 Baud rate to use for the serial connection.
32569 Should be a number or @code{#f}.
32570
32571 @item @code{log-file} (default: @code{#f})
32572 If true, this must be the name of a file to log messages to.
32573 @end table
32574 @end deftp
32575
32576 @subsubheading Dictionary Service
32577 @cindex dictionary
32578 The @code{(gnu services dict)} module provides the following service:
32579
32580 @defvr {Scheme Variable} dicod-service-type
32581 This is the type of the service that runs the @command{dicod} daemon, an
32582 implementation of DICT server (@pxref{Dicod,,, dico, GNU Dico Manual}).
32583 @end defvr
32584
32585 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} dicod-service [#:config (dicod-configuration)]
32586 Return a service that runs the @command{dicod} daemon, an implementation
32587 of DICT server (@pxref{Dicod,,, dico, GNU Dico Manual}).
32588
32589 The optional @var{config} argument specifies the configuration for
32590 @command{dicod}, which should be a @code{<dicod-configuration>} object, by
32591 default it serves the GNU Collaborative International Dictionary of English.
32592
32593 You can add @command{open localhost} to your @file{~/.dico} file to make
32594 @code{localhost} the default server for @command{dico} client
32595 (@pxref{Initialization File,,, dico, GNU Dico Manual}).
32596 @end deffn
32597
32598 @deftp {Data Type} dicod-configuration
32599 Data type representing the configuration of dicod.
32600
32601 @table @asis
32602 @item @code{dico} (default: @var{dico})
32603 Package object of the GNU Dico dictionary server.
32604
32605 @item @code{interfaces} (default: @var{'("localhost")})
32606 This is the list of IP addresses and ports and possibly socket file
32607 names to listen to (@pxref{Server Settings, @code{listen} directive,,
32608 dico, GNU Dico Manual}).
32609
32610 @item @code{handlers} (default: @var{'()})
32611 List of @code{<dicod-handler>} objects denoting handlers (module instances).
32612
32613 @item @code{databases} (default: @var{(list %dicod-database:gcide)})
32614 List of @code{<dicod-database>} objects denoting dictionaries to be served.
32615 @end table
32616 @end deftp
32617
32618 @deftp {Data Type} dicod-handler
32619 Data type representing a dictionary handler (module instance).
32620
32621 @table @asis
32622 @item @code{name}
32623 Name of the handler (module instance).
32624
32625 @item @code{module} (default: @var{#f})
32626 Name of the dicod module of the handler (instance). If it is @code{#f},
32627 the module has the same name as the handler.
32628 (@pxref{Modules,,, dico, GNU Dico Manual}).
32629
32630 @item @code{options}
32631 List of strings or gexps representing the arguments for the module handler
32632 @end table
32633 @end deftp
32634
32635 @deftp {Data Type} dicod-database
32636 Data type representing a dictionary database.
32637
32638 @table @asis
32639 @item @code{name}
32640 Name of the database, will be used in DICT commands.
32641
32642 @item @code{handler}
32643 Name of the dicod handler (module instance) used by this database
32644 (@pxref{Handlers,,, dico, GNU Dico Manual}).
32645
32646 @item @code{complex?} (default: @var{#f})
32647 Whether the database configuration complex. The complex configuration
32648 will need a corresponding @code{<dicod-handler>} object, otherwise not.
32649
32650 @item @code{options}
32651 List of strings or gexps representing the arguments for the database
32652 (@pxref{Databases,,, dico, GNU Dico Manual}).
32653 @end table
32654 @end deftp
32655
32656 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %dicod-database:gcide
32657 A @code{<dicod-database>} object serving the GNU Collaborative International
32658 Dictionary of English using the @code{gcide} package.
32659 @end defvr
32660
32661 The following is an example @code{dicod-service} configuration.
32662
32663 @lisp
32664 (dicod-service #:config
32665 (dicod-configuration
32666 (handlers (list (dicod-handler
32667 (name "wordnet")
32668 (module "dictorg")
32669 (options
32670 (list #~(string-append "dbdir=" #$wordnet))))))
32671 (databases (list (dicod-database
32672 (name "wordnet")
32673 (complex? #t)
32674 (handler "wordnet")
32675 (options '("database=wn")))
32676 %dicod-database:gcide))))
32677 @end lisp
32678
32679 @cindex Docker
32680 @subsubheading Docker Service
32681
32682 The @code{(gnu services docker)} module provides the following services.
32683
32684 @defvr {Scheme Variable} docker-service-type
32685
32686 This is the type of the service that runs @url{https://www.docker.com,Docker},
32687 a daemon that can execute application bundles (sometimes referred to as
32688 ``containers'') in isolated environments.
32689
32690 @end defvr
32691
32692 @deftp {Data Type} docker-configuration
32693 This is the data type representing the configuration of Docker and Containerd.
32694
32695 @table @asis
32696
32697 @item @code{docker} (default: @code{docker})
32698 The Docker daemon package to use.
32699
32700 @item @code{docker-cli} (default: @code{docker-cli})
32701 The Docker client package to use.
32702
32703 @item @code{containerd} (default: @var{containerd})
32704 The Containerd package to use.
32705
32706 @item @code{proxy} (default @var{docker-libnetwork-cmd-proxy})
32707 The Docker user-land networking proxy package to use.
32708
32709 @item @code{enable-proxy?} (default @code{#t})
32710 Enable or disable the use of the Docker user-land networking proxy.
32711
32712 @item @code{debug?} (default @code{#f})
32713 Enable or disable debug output.
32714
32715 @item @code{enable-iptables?} (default @code{#t})
32716 Enable or disable the addition of iptables rules.
32717
32718 @end table
32719 @end deftp
32720
32721 @cindex Singularity, container service
32722 @defvr {Scheme Variable} singularity-service-type
32723 This is the type of the service that allows you to run
32724 @url{https://www.sylabs.io/singularity/, Singularity}, a Docker-style tool to
32725 create and run application bundles (aka. ``containers''). The value for this
32726 service is the Singularity package to use.
32727
32728 The service does not install a daemon; instead, it installs helper programs as
32729 setuid-root (@pxref{Setuid Programs}) such that unprivileged users can invoke
32730 @command{singularity run} and similar commands.
32731 @end defvr
32732
32733 @cindex Audit
32734 @subsubheading Auditd Service
32735
32736 The @code{(gnu services auditd)} module provides the following service.
32737
32738 @defvr {Scheme Variable} auditd-service-type
32739
32740 This is the type of the service that runs
32741 @url{https://people.redhat.com/sgrubb/audit/,auditd},
32742 a daemon that tracks security-relevant information on your system.
32743
32744 Examples of things that can be tracked:
32745
32746 @enumerate
32747 @item
32748 File accesses
32749 @item
32750 System calls
32751 @item
32752 Invoked commands
32753 @item
32754 Failed login attempts
32755 @item
32756 Firewall filtering
32757 @item
32758 Network access
32759 @end enumerate
32760
32761 @command{auditctl} from the @code{audit} package can be used in order
32762 to add or remove events to be tracked (until the next reboot).
32763 In order to permanently track events, put the command line arguments
32764 of auditctl into a file called @code{audit.rules} in the configuration
32765 directory (see below).
32766 @command{aureport} from the @code{audit} package can be used in order
32767 to view a report of all recorded events.
32768 The audit daemon by default logs into the file
32769 @file{/var/log/audit.log}.
32770
32771 @end defvr
32772
32773 @deftp {Data Type} auditd-configuration
32774 This is the data type representing the configuration of auditd.
32775
32776 @table @asis
32777
32778 @item @code{audit} (default: @code{audit})
32779 The audit package to use.
32780
32781 @item @code{configuration-directory} (default: @code{%default-auditd-configuration-directory})
32782 The directory containing the configuration file for the audit package, which
32783 must be named @code{auditd.conf}, and optionally some audit rules to
32784 instantiate on startup.
32785
32786 @end table
32787 @end deftp
32788
32789 @cindex rshiny
32790 @subsubheading R-Shiny service
32791
32792 The @code{(gnu services science)} module provides the following service.
32793
32794 @defvr {Scheme Variable} rshiny-service-type
32795
32796 This is a type of service which is used to run a webapp created with
32797 @code{r-shiny}. This service sets the @env{R_LIBS_USER} environment
32798 variable and runs the provided script to call @code{runApp}.
32799
32800 @deftp {Data Type} rshiny-configuration
32801 This is the data type representing the configuration of rshiny.
32802
32803 @table @asis
32804
32805 @item @code{package} (default: @code{r-shiny})
32806 The package to use.
32807
32808 @item @code{binary} (defaunlt @code{"rshiny"})
32809 The name of the binary or shell script located at @code{package/bin/} to
32810 run when the service is run.
32811
32812 The common way to create this file is as follows:
32813
32814 @lisp
32815 @dots{}
32816 (let* ((out (assoc-ref %outputs "out"))
32817 (targetdir (string-append out "/share/" ,name))
32818 (app (string-append out "/bin/" ,name))
32819 (Rbin (string-append (assoc-ref %build-inputs "r-min")
32820 "/bin/Rscript")))
32821 ;; @dots{}
32822 (mkdir-p (string-append out "/bin"))
32823 (call-with-output-file app
32824 (lambda (port)
32825 (format port
32826 "#!~a
32827 library(shiny)
32828 setwd(\"~a\")
32829 runApp(launch.browser=0, port=4202)~%\n"
32830 Rbin targetdir))))
32831 @end lisp
32832
32833 @end table
32834 @end deftp
32835 @end defvr
32836
32837 @cindex Nix
32838 @subsubheading Nix service
32839
32840 The @code{(gnu services nix)} module provides the following service.
32841
32842 @defvr {Scheme Variable} nix-service-type
32843
32844 This is the type of the service that runs build daemon of the
32845 @url{https://nixos.org/nix/, Nix} package manager. Here is an example showing
32846 how to use it:
32847
32848 @lisp
32849 (use-modules (gnu))
32850 (use-service-modules nix)
32851 (use-package-modules package-management)
32852
32853 (operating-system
32854 ;; @dots{}
32855 (packages (append (list nix)
32856 %base-packages))
32857
32858 (services (append (list (service nix-service-type))
32859 %base-services)))
32860 @end lisp
32861
32862 After @command{guix system reconfigure} configure Nix for your user:
32863
32864 @itemize
32865 @item Add a Nix channel and update it. See
32866 @url{https://nixos.org/nix/manual/, Nix Package Manager Guide}.
32867
32868 @item Create a symlink to your profile and activate Nix profile:
32869 @end itemize
32870
32871 @example
32872 $ ln -s "/nix/var/nix/profiles/per-user/$USER/profile" ~/.nix-profile
32873 $ source /run/current-system/profile/etc/profile.d/nix.sh
32874 @end example
32875
32876 @end defvr
32877
32878 @deftp {Data Type} nix-configuration
32879 This data type represents the configuration of the Nix daemon.
32880
32881 @table @asis
32882 @item @code{nix} (default: @code{nix})
32883 The Nix package to use.
32884
32885 @item @code{sandbox} (default: @code{#t})
32886 Specifies whether builds are sandboxed by default.
32887
32888 @item @code{build-sandbox-items} (default: @code{'()})
32889 This is a list of strings or objects appended to the
32890 @code{build-sandbox-items} field of the configuration file.
32891
32892 @item @code{extra-config} (default: @code{'()})
32893 This is a list of strings or objects appended to the configuration file.
32894 It is used to pass extra text to be added verbatim to the configuration
32895 file.
32896
32897 @item @code{extra-options} (default: @code{'()})
32898 Extra command line options for @code{nix-service-type}.
32899 @end table
32900 @end deftp
32901
32902 @node Setuid Programs
32903 @section Setuid Programs
32904
32905 @cindex setuid programs
32906 Some programs need to run with ``root'' privileges, even when they are
32907 launched by unprivileged users. A notorious example is the
32908 @command{passwd} program, which users can run to change their
32909 password, and which needs to access the @file{/etc/passwd} and
32910 @file{/etc/shadow} files---something normally restricted to root, for
32911 obvious security reasons. To address that, these executables are
32912 @dfn{setuid-root}, meaning that they always run with root privileges
32913 (@pxref{How Change Persona,,, libc, The GNU C Library Reference Manual},
32914 for more info about the setuid mechanism).
32915
32916 The store itself @emph{cannot} contain setuid programs: that would be a
32917 security issue since any user on the system can write derivations that
32918 populate the store (@pxref{The Store}). Thus, a different mechanism is
32919 used: instead of changing the setuid bit directly on files that are in
32920 the store, we let the system administrator @emph{declare} which programs
32921 should be setuid root.
32922
32923 The @code{setuid-programs} field of an @code{operating-system}
32924 declaration contains a list of @code{<setuid-program>} denoting the
32925 names of programs to have a setuid or setgid bit set (@pxref{Using the
32926 Configuration System}). For instance, the @command{passwd} program,
32927 which is part of the Shadow package, with a setuid root can be
32928 designated like this:
32929
32930 @example
32931 (setuid-program
32932 (program (file-append #$shadow "/bin/passwd")))
32933 @end example
32934
32935 @deftp {Data Type} setuid-program
32936 This data type represents a program with a setuid or setgid bit set.
32937
32938 @table @asis
32939 @item @code{program}
32940 A file-like object having its setuid and/or setgid bit set.
32941
32942 @item @code{setuid?} (default: @code{#t})
32943 Whether to set user setuid bit.
32944
32945 @item @code{setgid?} (default: @code{#f})
32946 Whether to set group setgid bit.
32947
32948 @item @code{user} (default: @code{0})
32949 UID (integer) or user name (string) for the user owner of the program,
32950 defaults to root.
32951
32952 @item @code{group} (default: @code{0})
32953 GID (integer) goup name (string) for the group owner of the program,
32954 defaults to root.
32955
32956 @end table
32957 @end deftp
32958
32959 A default set of setuid programs is defined by the
32960 @code{%setuid-programs} variable of the @code{(gnu system)} module.
32961
32962 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %setuid-programs
32963 A list of @code{<setuid-program>} denoting common programs that are
32964 setuid-root.
32965
32966 The list includes commands such as @command{passwd}, @command{ping},
32967 @command{su}, and @command{sudo}.
32968 @end defvr
32969
32970 Under the hood, the actual setuid programs are created in the
32971 @file{/run/setuid-programs} directory at system activation time. The
32972 files in this directory refer to the ``real'' binaries, which are in the
32973 store.
32974
32975 @node X.509 Certificates
32976 @section X.509 Certificates
32977
32978 @cindex HTTPS, certificates
32979 @cindex X.509 certificates
32980 @cindex TLS
32981 Web servers available over HTTPS (that is, HTTP over the transport-layer
32982 security mechanism, TLS) send client programs an @dfn{X.509 certificate}
32983 that the client can then use to @emph{authenticate} the server. To do
32984 that, clients verify that the server's certificate is signed by a
32985 so-called @dfn{certificate authority} (CA). But to verify the CA's
32986 signature, clients must have first acquired the CA's certificate.
32987
32988 Web browsers such as GNU@tie{}IceCat include their own set of CA
32989 certificates, such that they are able to verify CA signatures
32990 out-of-the-box.
32991
32992 However, most other programs that can talk HTTPS---@command{wget},
32993 @command{git}, @command{w3m}, etc.---need to be told where CA
32994 certificates can be found.
32995
32996 @cindex @code{nss-certs}
32997 In Guix, this is done by adding a package that provides certificates
32998 to the @code{packages} field of the @code{operating-system} declaration
32999 (@pxref{operating-system Reference}). Guix includes one such package,
33000 @code{nss-certs}, which is a set of CA certificates provided as part of
33001 Mozilla's Network Security Services.
33002
33003 Note that it is @emph{not} part of @code{%base-packages}, so you need to
33004 explicitly add it. The @file{/etc/ssl/certs} directory, which is where
33005 most applications and libraries look for certificates by default, points
33006 to the certificates installed globally.
33007
33008 Unprivileged users, including users of Guix on a foreign distro,
33009 can also install their own certificate package in
33010 their profile. A number of environment variables need to be defined so
33011 that applications and libraries know where to find them. Namely, the
33012 OpenSSL library honors the @env{SSL_CERT_DIR} and @env{SSL_CERT_FILE}
33013 variables. Some applications add their own environment variables; for
33014 instance, the Git version control system honors the certificate bundle
33015 pointed to by the @env{GIT_SSL_CAINFO} environment variable. Thus, you
33016 would typically run something like:
33017
33018 @example
33019 guix install nss-certs
33020 export SSL_CERT_DIR="$HOME/.guix-profile/etc/ssl/certs"
33021 export SSL_CERT_FILE="$HOME/.guix-profile/etc/ssl/certs/ca-certificates.crt"
33022 export GIT_SSL_CAINFO="$SSL_CERT_FILE"
33023 @end example
33024
33025 As another example, R requires the @env{CURL_CA_BUNDLE} environment
33026 variable to point to a certificate bundle, so you would have to run
33027 something like this:
33028
33029 @example
33030 guix install nss-certs
33031 export CURL_CA_BUNDLE="$HOME/.guix-profile/etc/ssl/certs/ca-certificates.crt"
33032 @end example
33033
33034 For other applications you may want to look up the required environment
33035 variable in the relevant documentation.
33036
33037
33038 @node Name Service Switch
33039 @section Name Service Switch
33040
33041 @cindex name service switch
33042 @cindex NSS
33043 The @code{(gnu system nss)} module provides bindings to the
33044 configuration file of the libc @dfn{name service switch} or @dfn{NSS}
33045 (@pxref{NSS Configuration File,,, libc, The GNU C Library Reference
33046 Manual}). In a nutshell, the NSS is a mechanism that allows libc to be
33047 extended with new ``name'' lookup methods for system databases, which
33048 includes host names, service names, user accounts, and more (@pxref{Name
33049 Service Switch, System Databases and Name Service Switch,, libc, The GNU
33050 C Library Reference Manual}).
33051
33052 The NSS configuration specifies, for each system database, which lookup
33053 method is to be used, and how the various methods are chained
33054 together---for instance, under which circumstances NSS should try the
33055 next method in the list. The NSS configuration is given in the
33056 @code{name-service-switch} field of @code{operating-system} declarations
33057 (@pxref{operating-system Reference, @code{name-service-switch}}).
33058
33059 @cindex nss-mdns
33060 @cindex .local, host name lookup
33061 As an example, the declaration below configures the NSS to use the
33062 @uref{https://0pointer.de/lennart/projects/nss-mdns/, @code{nss-mdns}
33063 back-end}, which supports host name lookups over multicast DNS (mDNS)
33064 for host names ending in @code{.local}:
33065
33066 @lisp
33067 (name-service-switch
33068 (hosts (list %files ;first, check /etc/hosts
33069
33070 ;; If the above did not succeed, try
33071 ;; with 'mdns_minimal'.
33072 (name-service
33073 (name "mdns_minimal")
33074
33075 ;; 'mdns_minimal' is authoritative for
33076 ;; '.local'. When it returns "not found",
33077 ;; no need to try the next methods.
33078 (reaction (lookup-specification
33079 (not-found => return))))
33080
33081 ;; Then fall back to DNS.
33082 (name-service
33083 (name "dns"))
33084
33085 ;; Finally, try with the "full" 'mdns'.
33086 (name-service
33087 (name "mdns")))))
33088 @end lisp
33089
33090 Do not worry: the @code{%mdns-host-lookup-nss} variable (see below)
33091 contains this configuration, so you will not have to type it if all you
33092 want is to have @code{.local} host lookup working.
33093
33094 Note that, in this case, in addition to setting the
33095 @code{name-service-switch} of the @code{operating-system} declaration,
33096 you also need to use @code{avahi-service-type} (@pxref{Networking Services,
33097 @code{avahi-service-type}}), or @code{%desktop-services}, which includes it
33098 (@pxref{Desktop Services}). Doing this makes @code{nss-mdns} accessible
33099 to the name service cache daemon (@pxref{Base Services,
33100 @code{nscd-service}}).
33101
33102 For convenience, the following variables provide typical NSS
33103 configurations.
33104
33105 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %default-nss
33106 This is the default name service switch configuration, a
33107 @code{name-service-switch} object.
33108 @end defvr
33109
33110 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %mdns-host-lookup-nss
33111 This is the name service switch configuration with support for host name
33112 lookup over multicast DNS (mDNS) for host names ending in @code{.local}.
33113 @end defvr
33114
33115 The reference for name service switch configuration is given below. It
33116 is a direct mapping of the configuration file format of the C library , so
33117 please refer to the C library manual for more information (@pxref{NSS
33118 Configuration File,,, libc, The GNU C Library Reference Manual}).
33119 Compared to the configuration file format of libc NSS, it has the advantage
33120 not only of adding this warm parenthetic feel that we like, but also
33121 static checks: you will know about syntax errors and typos as soon as you
33122 run @command{guix system}.
33123
33124 @deftp {Data Type} name-service-switch
33125
33126 This is the data type representation the configuration of libc's name
33127 service switch (NSS). Each field below represents one of the supported
33128 system databases.
33129
33130 @table @code
33131 @item aliases
33132 @itemx ethers
33133 @itemx group
33134 @itemx gshadow
33135 @itemx hosts
33136 @itemx initgroups
33137 @itemx netgroup
33138 @itemx networks
33139 @itemx password
33140 @itemx public-key
33141 @itemx rpc
33142 @itemx services
33143 @itemx shadow
33144 The system databases handled by the NSS@. Each of these fields must be a
33145 list of @code{<name-service>} objects (see below).
33146 @end table
33147 @end deftp
33148
33149 @deftp {Data Type} name-service
33150
33151 This is the data type representing an actual name service and the
33152 associated lookup action.
33153
33154 @table @code
33155 @item name
33156 A string denoting the name service (@pxref{Services in the NSS
33157 configuration,,, libc, The GNU C Library Reference Manual}).
33158
33159 Note that name services listed here must be visible to nscd. This is
33160 achieved by passing the @code{#:name-services} argument to
33161 @code{nscd-service} the list of packages providing the needed name
33162 services (@pxref{Base Services, @code{nscd-service}}).
33163
33164 @item reaction
33165 An action specified using the @code{lookup-specification} macro
33166 (@pxref{Actions in the NSS configuration,,, libc, The GNU C Library
33167 Reference Manual}). For example:
33168
33169 @lisp
33170 (lookup-specification (unavailable => continue)
33171 (success => return))
33172 @end lisp
33173 @end table
33174 @end deftp
33175
33176 @node Initial RAM Disk
33177 @section Initial RAM Disk
33178
33179 @cindex initrd
33180 @cindex initial RAM disk
33181 For bootstrapping purposes, the Linux-Libre kernel is passed an
33182 @dfn{initial RAM disk}, or @dfn{initrd}. An initrd contains a temporary
33183 root file system as well as an initialization script. The latter is
33184 responsible for mounting the real root file system, and for loading any
33185 kernel modules that may be needed to achieve that.
33186
33187 The @code{initrd-modules} field of an @code{operating-system}
33188 declaration allows you to specify Linux-libre kernel modules that must
33189 be available in the initrd. In particular, this is where you would list
33190 modules needed to actually drive the hard disk where your root partition
33191 is---although the default value of @code{initrd-modules} should cover
33192 most use cases. For example, assuming you need the @code{megaraid_sas}
33193 module in addition to the default modules to be able to access your root
33194 file system, you would write:
33195
33196 @lisp
33197 (operating-system
33198 ;; @dots{}
33199 (initrd-modules (cons "megaraid_sas" %base-initrd-modules)))
33200 @end lisp
33201
33202 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %base-initrd-modules
33203 This is the list of kernel modules included in the initrd by default.
33204 @end defvr
33205
33206 Furthermore, if you need lower-level customization, the @code{initrd}
33207 field of an @code{operating-system} declaration allows
33208 you to specify which initrd you would like to use. The @code{(gnu
33209 system linux-initrd)} module provides three ways to build an initrd: the
33210 high-level @code{base-initrd} procedure and the low-level
33211 @code{raw-initrd} and @code{expression->initrd} procedures.
33212
33213 The @code{base-initrd} procedure is intended to cover most common uses.
33214 For example, if you want to add a bunch of kernel modules to be loaded
33215 at boot time, you can define the @code{initrd} field of the operating
33216 system declaration like this:
33217
33218 @lisp
33219 (initrd (lambda (file-systems . rest)
33220 ;; Create a standard initrd but set up networking
33221 ;; with the parameters QEMU expects by default.
33222 (apply base-initrd file-systems
33223 #:qemu-networking? #t
33224 rest)))
33225 @end lisp
33226
33227 The @code{base-initrd} procedure also handles common use cases that
33228 involves using the system as a QEMU guest, or as a ``live'' system with
33229 volatile root file system.
33230
33231 The @code{base-initrd} procedure is built from @code{raw-initrd} procedure.
33232 Unlike @code{base-initrd}, @code{raw-initrd} doesn't do anything high-level,
33233 such as trying to guess which kernel modules and packages should be included
33234 to the initrd. An example use of @code{raw-initrd} is when a user has
33235 a custom Linux kernel configuration and default kernel modules included by
33236 @code{base-initrd} are not available.
33237
33238 The initial RAM disk produced by @code{base-initrd} or @code{raw-initrd}
33239 honors several options passed on the Linux kernel command line
33240 (that is, arguments passed @i{via} the @code{linux} command of GRUB, or the
33241 @code{-append} option of QEMU), notably:
33242
33243 @table @code
33244 @item --load=@var{boot}
33245 Tell the initial RAM disk to load @var{boot}, a file containing a Scheme
33246 program, once it has mounted the root file system.
33247
33248 Guix uses this option to yield control to a boot program that runs the
33249 service activation programs and then spawns the GNU@tie{}Shepherd, the
33250 initialization system.
33251
33252 @item --root=@var{root}
33253 Mount @var{root} as the root file system. @var{root} can be a device
33254 name like @code{/dev/sda1}, a file system label, or a file system UUID.
33255 When unspecified, the device name from the root file system of the
33256 operating system declaration is used.
33257
33258 @item --system=@var{system}
33259 Have @file{/run/booted-system} and @file{/run/current-system} point to
33260 @var{system}.
33261
33262 @item modprobe.blacklist=@var{modules}@dots{}
33263 @cindex module, black-listing
33264 @cindex black list, of kernel modules
33265 Instruct the initial RAM disk as well as the @command{modprobe} command
33266 (from the kmod package) to refuse to load @var{modules}. @var{modules}
33267 must be a comma-separated list of module names---e.g.,
33268 @code{usbkbd,9pnet}.
33269
33270 @item --repl
33271 Start a read-eval-print loop (REPL) from the initial RAM disk before it
33272 tries to load kernel modules and to mount the root file system. Our
33273 marketing team calls it @dfn{boot-to-Guile}. The Schemer in you will
33274 love it. @xref{Using Guile Interactively,,, guile, GNU Guile Reference
33275 Manual}, for more information on Guile's REPL.
33276
33277 @end table
33278
33279 Now that you know all the features that initial RAM disks produced by
33280 @code{base-initrd} and @code{raw-initrd} provide,
33281 here is how to use it and customize it further.
33282
33283 @cindex initrd
33284 @cindex initial RAM disk
33285 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} raw-initrd @var{file-systems} @
33286 [#:linux-modules '()] [#:mapped-devices '()] @
33287 [#:keyboard-layout #f] @
33288 [#:helper-packages '()] [#:qemu-networking? #f] [#:volatile-root? #f]
33289 Return a derivation that builds a raw initrd. @var{file-systems} is
33290 a list of file systems to be mounted by the initrd, possibly in addition to
33291 the root file system specified on the kernel command line via @option{--root}.
33292 @var{linux-modules} is a list of kernel modules to be loaded at boot time.
33293 @var{mapped-devices} is a list of device mappings to realize before
33294 @var{file-systems} are mounted (@pxref{Mapped Devices}).
33295 @var{helper-packages} is a list of packages to be copied in the initrd.
33296 It may
33297 include @code{e2fsck/static} or other packages needed by the initrd to check
33298 the root file system.
33299
33300 When true, @var{keyboard-layout} is a @code{<keyboard-layout>} record denoting
33301 the desired console keyboard layout. This is done before @var{mapped-devices}
33302 are set up and before @var{file-systems} are mounted such that, should the
33303 user need to enter a passphrase or use the REPL, this happens using the
33304 intended keyboard layout.
33305
33306 When @var{qemu-networking?} is true, set up networking with the standard QEMU
33307 parameters. When @var{virtio?} is true, load additional modules so that the
33308 initrd can be used as a QEMU guest with para-virtualized I/O drivers.
33309
33310 When @var{volatile-root?} is true, the root file system is writable but any changes
33311 to it are lost.
33312 @end deffn
33313
33314 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} base-initrd @var{file-systems} @
33315 [#:mapped-devices '()] [#:keyboard-layout #f] @
33316 [#:qemu-networking? #f] [#:volatile-root? #f] @
33317 [#:linux-modules '()]
33318 Return as a file-like object a generic initrd, with kernel
33319 modules taken from @var{linux}. @var{file-systems} is a list of file-systems to be
33320 mounted by the initrd, possibly in addition to the root file system specified
33321 on the kernel command line via @option{--root}. @var{mapped-devices} is a list of device
33322 mappings to realize before @var{file-systems} are mounted.
33323
33324 When true, @var{keyboard-layout} is a @code{<keyboard-layout>} record denoting
33325 the desired console keyboard layout. This is done before @var{mapped-devices}
33326 are set up and before @var{file-systems} are mounted such that, should the
33327 user need to enter a passphrase or use the REPL, this happens using the
33328 intended keyboard layout.
33329
33330 @var{qemu-networking?} and @var{volatile-root?} behaves as in @code{raw-initrd}.
33331
33332 The initrd is automatically populated with all the kernel modules necessary
33333 for @var{file-systems} and for the given options. Additional kernel
33334 modules can be listed in @var{linux-modules}. They will be added to the initrd, and
33335 loaded at boot time in the order in which they appear.
33336 @end deffn
33337
33338 Needless to say, the initrds we produce and use embed a
33339 statically-linked Guile, and the initialization program is a Guile
33340 program. That gives a lot of flexibility. The
33341 @code{expression->initrd} procedure builds such an initrd, given the
33342 program to run in that initrd.
33343
33344 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} expression->initrd @var{exp} @
33345 [#:guile %guile-static-stripped] [#:name "guile-initrd"]
33346 Return as a file-like object a Linux initrd (a gzipped cpio archive)
33347 containing @var{guile} and that evaluates @var{exp}, a G-expression,
33348 upon booting. All the derivations referenced by @var{exp} are
33349 automatically copied to the initrd.
33350 @end deffn
33351
33352 @node Bootloader Configuration
33353 @section Bootloader Configuration
33354
33355 @cindex bootloader
33356 @cindex boot loader
33357
33358 The operating system supports multiple bootloaders. The bootloader is
33359 configured using @code{bootloader-configuration} declaration. All the
33360 fields of this structure are bootloader agnostic except for one field,
33361 @code{bootloader} that indicates the bootloader to be configured and
33362 installed.
33363
33364 Some of the bootloaders do not honor every field of
33365 @code{bootloader-configuration}. For instance, the extlinux
33366 bootloader does not support themes and thus ignores the @code{theme}
33367 field.
33368
33369 @deftp {Data Type} bootloader-configuration
33370 The type of a bootloader configuration declaration.
33371
33372 @table @asis
33373
33374 @item @code{bootloader}
33375 @cindex EFI, bootloader
33376 @cindex UEFI, bootloader
33377 @cindex BIOS, bootloader
33378 The bootloader to use, as a @code{bootloader} object. For now
33379 @code{grub-bootloader}, @code{grub-efi-bootloader},
33380 @code{grub-efi-netboot-bootloader}, @code{extlinux-bootloader} and
33381 @code{u-boot-bootloader} are supported.
33382
33383 @cindex ARM, bootloaders
33384 @cindex AArch64, bootloaders
33385 Available bootloaders are described in @code{(gnu bootloader @dots{})}
33386 modules. In particular, @code{(gnu bootloader u-boot)} contains definitions
33387 of bootloaders for a wide range of ARM and AArch64 systems, using the
33388 @uref{https://www.denx.de/wiki/U-Boot/, U-Boot bootloader}.
33389
33390 @vindex grub-efi-bootloader
33391 @code{grub-efi-bootloader} allows to boot on modern systems using the
33392 @dfn{Unified Extensible Firmware Interface} (UEFI). This is what you should
33393 use if the installation image contains a @file{/sys/firmware/efi} directory
33394 when you boot it on your system.
33395
33396 @vindex grub-bootloader
33397 @code{grub-bootloader} allows you to boot in particular Intel-based machines
33398 in ``legacy'' BIOS mode.
33399
33400 @vindex grub-efi-netboot-bootloader
33401 @code{grub-efi-netboot-bootloader} allows you to boot your system over network
33402 through TFTP@. In combination with an NFS root file system this allows you to
33403 build a diskless Guix system.
33404
33405 The installation of the @code{grub-efi-netboot-bootloader} generates the
33406 content of the TFTP root directory at @code{targets} (@pxref{Bootloader
33407 Configuration, @code{targets}}), to be served by a TFTP server. You may
33408 want to mount your TFTP server directories onto the @code{targets} to
33409 move the required files to the TFTP server automatically.
33410
33411 If you plan to use an NFS root file system as well (actually if you mount the
33412 store from an NFS share), then the TFTP server needs to serve the file
33413 @file{/boot/grub/grub.cfg} and other files from the store (like GRUBs background
33414 image, the kernel (@pxref{operating-system Reference, @code{kernel}}) and the
33415 initrd (@pxref{operating-system Reference, @code{initrd}})), too. All these
33416 files from the store will be accessed by GRUB through TFTP with their normal
33417 store path, for example as
33418 @file{tftp://tftp-server/gnu/store/…-initrd/initrd.cpio.gz}.
33419
33420 Two symlinks are created to make this possible. For each target in the
33421 @code{targets} field, the first symlink is
33422 @samp{target}@file{/efi/Guix/boot/grub/grub.cfg} pointing to
33423 @file{../../../boot/grub/grub.cfg}, where @samp{target} may be
33424 @file{/boot}. In this case the link is not leaving the served TFTP root
33425 directory, but otherwise it does. The second link is
33426 @samp{target}@file{/gnu/store} and points to @file{../gnu/store}. This
33427 link is leaving the served TFTP root directory.
33428
33429 The assumption behind all this is that you have an NFS server exporting
33430 the root file system for your Guix system, and additionally a TFTP
33431 server exporting your @code{targets} directories—usually a single
33432 @file{/boot}—from that same root file system for your Guix system. In
33433 this constellation the symlinks will work.
33434
33435 For other constellations you will have to program your own bootloader
33436 installer, which then takes care to make necessary files from the store
33437 accessible through TFTP, for example by copying them into the TFTP root
33438 directory to your @code{targets}.
33439
33440 It is important to note that symlinks pointing outside the TFTP root directory
33441 may need to be allowed in the configuration of your TFTP server. Further the
33442 store link exposes the whole store through TFTP@. Both points need to be
33443 considered carefully for security aspects.
33444
33445 Beside the @code{grub-efi-netboot-bootloader}, the already mentioned TFTP and
33446 NFS servers, you also need a properly configured DHCP server to make the booting
33447 over netboot possible. For all this we can currently only recommend you to look
33448 for instructions about @acronym{PXE, Preboot eXecution Environment}.
33449
33450 @item @code{targets}
33451 This is a list of strings denoting the targets onto which to install the
33452 bootloader.
33453
33454 The interpretation of targets depends on the bootloader in question.
33455 For @code{grub-bootloader}, for example, they should be device names
33456 understood by the bootloader @command{installer} command, such as
33457 @code{/dev/sda} or @code{(hd0)} (@pxref{Invoking grub-install,,, grub,
33458 GNU GRUB Manual}). For @code{grub-efi-bootloader}, they should be mount
33459 points of the EFI file system, usually @file{/boot/efi}. For
33460 @code{grub-efi-netboot-bootloader}, @code{targets} should be the mount
33461 points corresponding to TFTP root directories served by your TFTP
33462 server.
33463
33464 @item @code{menu-entries} (default: @code{()})
33465 A possibly empty list of @code{menu-entry} objects (see below), denoting
33466 entries to appear in the bootloader menu, in addition to the current
33467 system entry and the entry pointing to previous system generations.
33468
33469 @item @code{default-entry} (default: @code{0})
33470 The index of the default boot menu entry. Index 0 is for the entry of the
33471 current system.
33472
33473 @item @code{timeout} (default: @code{5})
33474 The number of seconds to wait for keyboard input before booting. Set to
33475 0 to boot immediately, and to -1 to wait indefinitely.
33476
33477 @cindex keyboard layout, for the bootloader
33478 @item @code{keyboard-layout} (default: @code{#f})
33479 If this is @code{#f}, the bootloader's menu (if any) uses the default keyboard
33480 layout, usually US@tie{}English (``qwerty'').
33481
33482 Otherwise, this must be a @code{keyboard-layout} object (@pxref{Keyboard
33483 Layout}).
33484
33485 @quotation Note
33486 This option is currently ignored by bootloaders other than @code{grub} and
33487 @code{grub-efi}.
33488 @end quotation
33489
33490 @item @code{theme} (default: @var{#f})
33491 The bootloader theme object describing the theme to use. If no theme
33492 is provided, some bootloaders might use a default theme, that's true
33493 for GRUB.
33494
33495 @item @code{terminal-outputs} (default: @code{'(gfxterm)})
33496 The output terminals used for the bootloader boot menu, as a list of
33497 symbols. GRUB accepts the values: @code{console}, @code{serial},
33498 @code{serial_@{0-3@}}, @code{gfxterm}, @code{vga_text},
33499 @code{mda_text}, @code{morse}, and @code{pkmodem}. This field
33500 corresponds to the GRUB variable @code{GRUB_TERMINAL_OUTPUT} (@pxref{Simple
33501 configuration,,, grub,GNU GRUB manual}).
33502
33503 @item @code{terminal-inputs} (default: @code{'()})
33504 The input terminals used for the bootloader boot menu, as a list of
33505 symbols. For GRUB, the default is the native platform terminal as
33506 determined at run-time. GRUB accepts the values: @code{console},
33507 @code{serial}, @code{serial_@{0-3@}}, @code{at_keyboard}, and
33508 @code{usb_keyboard}. This field corresponds to the GRUB variable
33509 @code{GRUB_TERMINAL_INPUT} (@pxref{Simple configuration,,, grub,GNU GRUB
33510 manual}).
33511
33512 @item @code{serial-unit} (default: @code{#f})
33513 The serial unit used by the bootloader, as an integer from 0 to 3.
33514 For GRUB, it is chosen at run-time; currently GRUB chooses 0, which
33515 corresponds to COM1 (@pxref{Serial terminal,,, grub,GNU GRUB manual}).
33516
33517 @item @code{serial-speed} (default: @code{#f})
33518 The speed of the serial interface, as an integer. For GRUB, the
33519 default value is chosen at run-time; currently GRUB chooses
33520 9600@tie{}bps (@pxref{Serial terminal,,, grub,GNU GRUB manual}).
33521 @end table
33522
33523 @end deftp
33524
33525 @cindex dual boot
33526 @cindex boot menu
33527 Should you want to list additional boot menu entries @i{via} the
33528 @code{menu-entries} field above, you will need to create them with the
33529 @code{menu-entry} form. For example, imagine you want to be able to
33530 boot another distro (hard to imagine!), you can define a menu entry
33531 along these lines:
33532
33533 @lisp
33534 (menu-entry
33535 (label "The Other Distro")
33536 (linux "/boot/old/vmlinux-2.6.32")
33537 (linux-arguments '("root=/dev/sda2"))
33538 (initrd "/boot/old/initrd"))
33539 @end lisp
33540
33541 Details below.
33542
33543 @deftp {Data Type} menu-entry
33544 The type of an entry in the bootloader menu.
33545
33546 @table @asis
33547
33548 @item @code{label}
33549 The label to show in the menu---e.g., @code{"GNU"}.
33550
33551 @item @code{linux} (default: @code{#f})
33552 The Linux kernel image to boot, for example:
33553
33554 @lisp
33555 (file-append linux-libre "/bzImage")
33556 @end lisp
33557
33558 For GRUB, it is also possible to specify a device explicitly in the
33559 file path using GRUB's device naming convention (@pxref{Naming
33560 convention,,, grub, GNU GRUB manual}), for example:
33561
33562 @example
33563 "(hd0,msdos1)/boot/vmlinuz"
33564 @end example
33565
33566 If the device is specified explicitly as above, then the @code{device}
33567 field is ignored entirely.
33568
33569 @item @code{linux-arguments} (default: @code{()})
33570 The list of extra Linux kernel command-line arguments---e.g.,
33571 @code{("console=ttyS0")}.
33572
33573 @item @code{initrd} (default: @code{#f})
33574 A G-Expression or string denoting the file name of the initial RAM disk
33575 to use (@pxref{G-Expressions}).
33576
33577 @item @code{device} (default: @code{#f})
33578 The device where the kernel and initrd are to be found---i.e., for GRUB,
33579 @dfn{root} for this menu entry (@pxref{root,,, grub, GNU GRUB manual}).
33580
33581 This may be a file system label (a string), a file system UUID (a
33582 bytevector, @pxref{File Systems}), or @code{#f}, in which case
33583 the bootloader will search the device containing the file specified by
33584 the @code{linux} field (@pxref{search,,, grub, GNU GRUB manual}). It
33585 must @emph{not} be an OS device name such as @file{/dev/sda1}.
33586
33587 @item @code{multiboot-kernel} (default: @code{#f})
33588 The kernel to boot in Multiboot-mode (@pxref{multiboot,,, grub, GNU GRUB
33589 manual}). When this field is set, a Multiboot menu-entry is generated.
33590 For example:
33591
33592 @lisp
33593 (file-append mach "/boot/gnumach")
33594 @end lisp
33595
33596 @item @code{multiboot-arguments} (default: @code{()})
33597 The list of extra command-line arguments for the multiboot-kernel.
33598
33599 @item @code{multiboot-modules} (default: @code{()})
33600 The list of commands for loading Multiboot modules. For example:
33601
33602 @lisp
33603 (list (list (file-append hurd "/hurd/ext2fs.static") "ext2fs"
33604 @dots{})
33605 (list (file-append libc "/lib/ld.so.1") "exec"
33606 @dots{}))
33607 @end lisp
33608
33609 @end table
33610 @end deftp
33611
33612 @cindex HDPI
33613 @cindex HiDPI
33614 @cindex resolution
33615 @c FIXME: Write documentation once it's stable.
33616 For now only GRUB has theme support. GRUB themes are created using
33617 the @code{grub-theme} form, which is not fully documented yet.
33618
33619 @deftp {Data Type} grub-theme
33620 Data type representing the configuration of the GRUB theme.
33621
33622 @table @asis
33623 @item @code{gfxmode} (default: @code{'("auto")})
33624 The GRUB @code{gfxmode} to set (a list of screen resolution strings,
33625 @pxref{gfxmode,,, grub, GNU GRUB manual}).
33626 @end table
33627 @end deftp
33628
33629 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} grub-theme
33630 Return the default GRUB theme used by the operating system if no
33631 @code{theme} field is specified in @code{bootloader-configuration}
33632 record.
33633
33634 It comes with a fancy background image displaying the GNU and Guix
33635 logos.
33636 @end deffn
33637
33638 For example, to override the default resolution, you may use something
33639 like
33640
33641 @lisp
33642 (bootloader
33643 (bootloader-configuration
33644 ;; @dots{}
33645 (theme (grub-theme
33646 (inherit (grub-theme))
33647 (gfxmode '("1024x786x32" "auto"))))))
33648 @end lisp
33649
33650 @node Invoking guix system
33651 @section Invoking @code{guix system}
33652
33653 Once you have written an operating system declaration as seen in the
33654 previous section, it can be @dfn{instantiated} using the @command{guix
33655 system} command. The synopsis is:
33656
33657 @example
33658 guix system @var{options}@dots{} @var{action} @var{file}
33659 @end example
33660
33661 @var{file} must be the name of a file containing an
33662 @code{operating-system} declaration. @var{action} specifies how the
33663 operating system is instantiated. Currently the following values are
33664 supported:
33665
33666 @table @code
33667 @item search
33668 Display available service type definitions that match the given regular
33669 expressions, sorted by relevance:
33670
33671 @cindex HDPI
33672 @cindex HiDPI
33673 @cindex resolution
33674 @example
33675 $ guix system search console
33676 name: console-fonts
33677 location: gnu/services/base.scm:806:2
33678 extends: shepherd-root
33679 description: Install the given fonts on the specified ttys (fonts are per
33680 + virtual console on GNU/Linux). The value of this service is a list of
33681 + tty/font pairs. The font can be the name of a font provided by the `kbd'
33682 + package or any valid argument to `setfont', as in this example:
33683 +
33684 + '(("tty1" . "LatGrkCyr-8x16")
33685 + ("tty2" . (file-append
33686 + font-tamzen
33687 + "/share/kbd/consolefonts/TamzenForPowerline10x20.psf"))
33688 + ("tty3" . (file-append
33689 + font-terminus
33690 + "/share/consolefonts/ter-132n"))) ; for HDPI
33691 relevance: 9
33692
33693 name: mingetty
33694 location: gnu/services/base.scm:1190:2
33695 extends: shepherd-root
33696 description: Provide console login using the `mingetty' program.
33697 relevance: 2
33698
33699 name: login
33700 location: gnu/services/base.scm:860:2
33701 extends: pam
33702 description: Provide a console log-in service as specified by its
33703 + configuration value, a `login-configuration' object.
33704 relevance: 2
33705
33706 @dots{}
33707 @end example
33708
33709 As for @command{guix package --search}, the result is written in
33710 @code{recutils} format, which makes it easy to filter the output
33711 (@pxref{Top, GNU recutils databases,, recutils, GNU recutils manual}).
33712
33713 @item reconfigure
33714 Build the operating system described in @var{file}, activate it, and
33715 switch to it@footnote{This action (and the related actions
33716 @code{switch-generation} and @code{roll-back}) are usable only on
33717 systems already running Guix System.}.
33718
33719 @quotation Note
33720 @c The paragraph below refers to the problem discussed at
33721 @c <https://lists.gnu.org/archive/html/guix-devel/2014-08/msg00057.html>.
33722 It is highly recommended to run @command{guix pull} once before you run
33723 @command{guix system reconfigure} for the first time (@pxref{Invoking
33724 guix pull}). Failing to do that you would see an older version of Guix
33725 once @command{reconfigure} has completed.
33726 @end quotation
33727
33728 This effects all the configuration specified in @var{file}: user
33729 accounts, system services, global package list, setuid programs, etc.
33730 The command starts system services specified in @var{file} that are not
33731 currently running; if a service is currently running this command will
33732 arrange for it to be upgraded the next time it is stopped (e.g.@: by
33733 @code{herd stop X} or @code{herd restart X}).
33734
33735 This command creates a new generation whose number is one greater than
33736 the current generation (as reported by @command{guix system
33737 list-generations}). If that generation already exists, it will be
33738 overwritten. This behavior mirrors that of @command{guix package}
33739 (@pxref{Invoking guix package}).
33740
33741 It also adds a bootloader menu entry for the new OS configuration,
33742 ---unless @option{--no-bootloader} is passed. For GRUB, it moves
33743 entries for older configurations to a submenu, allowing you to choose
33744 an older system generation at boot time should you need it.
33745
33746 @cindex provenance tracking, of the operating system
33747 Upon completion, the new system is deployed under
33748 @file{/run/current-system}. This directory contains @dfn{provenance
33749 meta-data}: the list of channels in use (@pxref{Channels}) and
33750 @var{file} itself, when available. You can view it by running:
33751
33752 @example
33753 guix system describe
33754 @end example
33755
33756 This information is useful should you later want to inspect how this
33757 particular generation was built. In fact, assuming @var{file} is
33758 self-contained, you can later rebuild generation @var{n} of your
33759 operating system with:
33760
33761 @example
33762 guix time-machine \
33763 -C /var/guix/profiles/system-@var{n}-link/channels.scm -- \
33764 system reconfigure \
33765 /var/guix/profiles/system-@var{n}-link/configuration.scm
33766 @end example
33767
33768 You can think of it as some sort of built-in version control! Your
33769 system is not just a binary artifact: @emph{it carries its own source}.
33770 @xref{Service Reference, @code{provenance-service-type}}, for more
33771 information on provenance tracking.
33772
33773 By default, @command{reconfigure} @emph{prevents you from downgrading
33774 your system}, which could (re)introduce security vulnerabilities and
33775 also cause problems with ``stateful'' services such as database
33776 management systems. You can override that behavior by passing
33777 @option{--allow-downgrades}.
33778
33779 @item switch-generation
33780 @cindex generations
33781 Switch to an existing system generation. This action atomically
33782 switches the system profile to the specified system generation. It
33783 also rearranges the system's existing bootloader menu entries. It
33784 makes the menu entry for the specified system generation the default,
33785 and it moves the entries for the other generations to a submenu, if
33786 supported by the bootloader being used. The next time the system
33787 boots, it will use the specified system generation.
33788
33789 The bootloader itself is not being reinstalled when using this
33790 command. Thus, the installed bootloader is used with an updated
33791 configuration file.
33792
33793 The target generation can be specified explicitly by its generation
33794 number. For example, the following invocation would switch to system
33795 generation 7:
33796
33797 @example
33798 guix system switch-generation 7
33799 @end example
33800
33801 The target generation can also be specified relative to the current
33802 generation with the form @code{+N} or @code{-N}, where @code{+3} means
33803 ``3 generations ahead of the current generation,'' and @code{-1} means
33804 ``1 generation prior to the current generation.'' When specifying a
33805 negative value such as @code{-1}, you must precede it with @code{--} to
33806 prevent it from being parsed as an option. For example:
33807
33808 @example
33809 guix system switch-generation -- -1
33810 @end example
33811
33812 Currently, the effect of invoking this action is @emph{only} to switch
33813 the system profile to an existing generation and rearrange the
33814 bootloader menu entries. To actually start using the target system
33815 generation, you must reboot after running this action. In the future,
33816 it will be updated to do the same things as @command{reconfigure},
33817 like activating and deactivating services.
33818
33819 This action will fail if the specified generation does not exist.
33820
33821 @item roll-back
33822 @cindex rolling back
33823 Switch to the preceding system generation. The next time the system
33824 boots, it will use the preceding system generation. This is the inverse
33825 of @command{reconfigure}, and it is exactly the same as invoking
33826 @command{switch-generation} with an argument of @code{-1}.
33827
33828 Currently, as with @command{switch-generation}, you must reboot after
33829 running this action to actually start using the preceding system
33830 generation.
33831
33832 @item delete-generations
33833 @cindex deleting system generations
33834 @cindex saving space
33835 Delete system generations, making them candidates for garbage collection
33836 (@pxref{Invoking guix gc}, for information on how to run the ``garbage
33837 collector'').
33838
33839 This works in the same way as @samp{guix package --delete-generations}
33840 (@pxref{Invoking guix package, @option{--delete-generations}}). With no
33841 arguments, all system generations but the current one are deleted:
33842
33843 @example
33844 guix system delete-generations
33845 @end example
33846
33847 You can also select the generations you want to delete. The example below
33848 deletes all the system generations that are more than two month old:
33849
33850 @example
33851 guix system delete-generations 2m
33852 @end example
33853
33854 Running this command automatically reinstalls the bootloader with an updated
33855 list of menu entries---e.g., the ``old generations'' sub-menu in GRUB no
33856 longer lists the generations that have been deleted.
33857
33858 @item build
33859 Build the derivation of the operating system, which includes all the
33860 configuration files and programs needed to boot and run the system.
33861 This action does not actually install anything.
33862
33863 @item init
33864 Populate the given directory with all the files necessary to run the
33865 operating system specified in @var{file}. This is useful for first-time
33866 installations of Guix System. For instance:
33867
33868 @example
33869 guix system init my-os-config.scm /mnt
33870 @end example
33871
33872 copies to @file{/mnt} all the store items required by the configuration
33873 specified in @file{my-os-config.scm}. This includes configuration
33874 files, packages, and so on. It also creates other essential files
33875 needed for the system to operate correctly---e.g., the @file{/etc},
33876 @file{/var}, and @file{/run} directories, and the @file{/bin/sh} file.
33877
33878 This command also installs bootloader on the targets specified in
33879 @file{my-os-config}, unless the @option{--no-bootloader} option was
33880 passed.
33881
33882 @item vm
33883 @cindex virtual machine
33884 @cindex VM
33885 @anchor{guix system vm}
33886 Build a virtual machine that contains the operating system declared in
33887 @var{file}, and return a script to run that virtual machine (VM).
33888
33889 @quotation Note
33890 The @code{vm} action and others below
33891 can use KVM support in the Linux-libre kernel. Specifically, if the
33892 machine has hardware virtualization support, the corresponding
33893 KVM kernel module should be loaded, and the @file{/dev/kvm} device node
33894 must exist and be readable and writable by the user and by the
33895 build users of the daemon (@pxref{Build Environment Setup}).
33896 @end quotation
33897
33898 Arguments given to the script are passed to QEMU as in the example
33899 below, which enables networking and requests 1@tie{}GiB of RAM for the
33900 emulated machine:
33901
33902 @example
33903 $ /gnu/store/@dots{}-run-vm.sh -m 1024 -smp 2 -nic user,model=virtio-net-pci
33904 @end example
33905
33906 The VM shares its store with the host system.
33907
33908 Additional file systems can be shared between the host and the VM using
33909 the @option{--share} and @option{--expose} command-line options: the former
33910 specifies a directory to be shared with write access, while the latter
33911 provides read-only access to the shared directory.
33912
33913 The example below creates a VM in which the user's home directory is
33914 accessible read-only, and where the @file{/exchange} directory is a
33915 read-write mapping of @file{$HOME/tmp} on the host:
33916
33917 @example
33918 guix system vm my-config.scm \
33919 --expose=$HOME --share=$HOME/tmp=/exchange
33920 @end example
33921
33922 On GNU/Linux, the default is to boot directly to the kernel; this has
33923 the advantage of requiring only a very tiny root disk image since the
33924 store of the host can then be mounted.
33925
33926 The @option{--full-boot} option forces a complete boot sequence, starting
33927 with the bootloader. This requires more disk space since a root image
33928 containing at least the kernel, initrd, and bootloader data files must
33929 be created. The @option{--image-size} option can be used to specify the
33930 size of the image.
33931
33932 @cindex System images, creation in various formats
33933 @cindex Creating system images in various formats
33934 @item image
33935 @itemx docker-image
33936 Return a virtual machine, disk image, or Docker image of the operating
33937 system declared in @var{file} that stands alone. By default,
33938 @command{guix system} estimates the size of the image needed to store
33939 the system, but you can use the @option{--image-size} option to specify
33940 a value. Docker images are built to contain exactly what they need, so
33941 the @option{--image-size} option is ignored in the case of
33942 @code{docker-image}.
33943
33944 @cindex image, creating disk images
33945 The @code{image} command can produce various image types. The
33946 image type can be selected using the @option{--image-type} option. It
33947 defaults to @code{efi-raw}. When its value is @code{iso9660}, the
33948 @option{--label} option can be used to specify a volume ID with
33949 @code{image}. By default, the root file system of a disk image is
33950 mounted non-volatile; the @option{--volatile} option can be provided to
33951 make it volatile instead. When using @code{image}, the bootloader
33952 installed on the generated image is taken from the provided
33953 @code{operating-system} definition. The following example demonstrates
33954 how to generate an image that uses the @code{grub-efi-bootloader}
33955 bootloader and boot it with QEMU:
33956
33957 @example
33958 image=$(guix system image --image-type=qcow2 \
33959 gnu/system/examples/lightweight-desktop.tmpl)
33960 cp $image /tmp/my-image.qcow2
33961 chmod +w /tmp/my-image.qcow2
33962 qemu-system-x86_64 -enable-kvm -hda /tmp/my-image.qcow2 -m 1000 \
33963 -bios $(guix build ovmf)/share/firmware/ovmf_x64.bin
33964 @end example
33965
33966 When using the @code{efi-raw} image type, a raw disk image is produced;
33967 it can be copied as is to a USB stick, for instance. Assuming
33968 @code{/dev/sdc} is the device corresponding to a USB stick, one can copy
33969 the image to it using the following command:
33970
33971 @example
33972 # dd if=$(guix system image my-os.scm) of=/dev/sdc status=progress
33973 @end example
33974
33975 The @code{--list-image-types} command lists all the available image
33976 types.
33977
33978 @cindex creating virtual machine images
33979 When using the @code{qcow2} image type, the returned image is in qcow2
33980 format, which the QEMU emulator can efficiently use. @xref{Running Guix
33981 in a VM}, for more information on how to run the image in a virtual
33982 machine. The @code{grub-bootloader} bootloader is always used
33983 independently of what is declared in the @code{operating-system} file
33984 passed as argument. This is to make it easier to work with QEMU, which
33985 uses the SeaBIOS BIOS by default, expecting a bootloader to be installed
33986 in the Master Boot Record (MBR).
33987
33988 @cindex docker-image, creating docker images
33989 When using @code{docker-image}, a Docker image is produced. Guix builds
33990 the image from scratch, not from a pre-existing Docker base image. As a
33991 result, it contains @emph{exactly} what you define in the operating
33992 system configuration file. You can then load the image and launch a
33993 Docker container using commands like the following:
33994
33995 @example
33996 image_id="$(docker load < guix-system-docker-image.tar.gz)"
33997 container_id="$(docker create $image_id)"
33998 docker start $container_id
33999 @end example
34000
34001 This command starts a new Docker container from the specified image. It
34002 will boot the Guix system in the usual manner, which means it will
34003 start any services you have defined in the operating system
34004 configuration. You can get an interactive shell running in the container
34005 using @command{docker exec}:
34006
34007 @example
34008 docker exec -ti $container_id /run/current-system/profile/bin/bash --login
34009 @end example
34010
34011 Depending on what you run in the Docker container, it
34012 may be necessary to give the container additional permissions. For
34013 example, if you intend to build software using Guix inside of the Docker
34014 container, you may need to pass the @option{--privileged} option to
34015 @code{docker create}.
34016
34017 Last, the @option{--network} option applies to @command{guix system
34018 docker-image}: it produces an image where network is supposedly shared
34019 with the host, and thus without services like nscd or NetworkManager.
34020
34021 @item container
34022 Return a script to run the operating system declared in @var{file}
34023 within a container. Containers are a set of lightweight isolation
34024 mechanisms provided by the kernel Linux-libre. Containers are
34025 substantially less resource-demanding than full virtual machines since
34026 the kernel, shared objects, and other resources can be shared with the
34027 host system; this also means they provide thinner isolation.
34028
34029 Currently, the script must be run as root in order to support more than
34030 a single user and group. The container shares its store with the host
34031 system.
34032
34033 As with the @code{vm} action (@pxref{guix system vm}), additional file
34034 systems to be shared between the host and container can be specified
34035 using the @option{--share} and @option{--expose} options:
34036
34037 @example
34038 guix system container my-config.scm \
34039 --expose=$HOME --share=$HOME/tmp=/exchange
34040 @end example
34041
34042 @quotation Note
34043 This option requires Linux-libre 3.19 or newer.
34044 @end quotation
34045
34046 @end table
34047
34048 @var{options} can contain any of the common build options (@pxref{Common
34049 Build Options}). In addition, @var{options} can contain one of the
34050 following:
34051
34052 @table @option
34053 @item --expression=@var{expr}
34054 @itemx -e @var{expr}
34055 Consider the operating-system @var{expr} evaluates to.
34056 This is an alternative to specifying a file which evaluates to an
34057 operating system.
34058 This is used to generate the Guix system installer @pxref{Building the
34059 Installation Image}).
34060
34061 @item --system=@var{system}
34062 @itemx -s @var{system}
34063 Attempt to build for @var{system} instead of the host system type.
34064 This works as per @command{guix build} (@pxref{Invoking guix build}).
34065
34066 @item --derivation
34067 @itemx -d
34068 Return the derivation file name of the given operating system without
34069 building anything.
34070
34071 @cindex provenance tracking, of the operating system
34072 @item --save-provenance
34073 As discussed above, @command{guix system init} and @command{guix system
34074 reconfigure} always save provenance information @i{via} a dedicated
34075 service (@pxref{Service Reference, @code{provenance-service-type}}).
34076 However, other commands don't do that by default. If you wish to, say,
34077 create a virtual machine image that contains provenance information, you
34078 can run:
34079
34080 @example
34081 guix system image -t qcow2 --save-provenance config.scm
34082 @end example
34083
34084 That way, the resulting image will effectively ``embed its own source''
34085 in the form of meta-data in @file{/run/current-system}. With that
34086 information, one can rebuild the image to make sure it really contains
34087 what it pretends to contain; or they could use that to derive a variant
34088 of the image.
34089
34090 @item --image-type=@var{type}
34091 @itemx -t @var{type}
34092 For the @code{image} action, create an image with given @var{type}.
34093
34094 When this option is omitted, @command{guix system} uses the
34095 @code{efi-raw} image type.
34096
34097 @cindex ISO-9660 format
34098 @cindex CD image format
34099 @cindex DVD image format
34100 @option{--image-type=iso9660} produces an ISO-9660 image, suitable
34101 for burning on CDs and DVDs.
34102
34103 @item --image-size=@var{size}
34104 For the @code{image} action, create an image of the given @var{size}.
34105 @var{size} may be a number of bytes, or it may include a unit as a
34106 suffix (@pxref{Block size, size specifications,, coreutils, GNU
34107 Coreutils}).
34108
34109 When this option is omitted, @command{guix system} computes an estimate
34110 of the image size as a function of the size of the system declared in
34111 @var{file}.
34112
34113 @item --network
34114 @itemx -N
34115 For the @code{container} action, allow containers to access the host network,
34116 that is, do not create a network namespace.
34117
34118 @item --root=@var{file}
34119 @itemx -r @var{file}
34120 Make @var{file} a symlink to the result, and register it as a garbage
34121 collector root.
34122
34123 @item --skip-checks
34124 Skip pre-installation safety checks.
34125
34126 By default, @command{guix system init} and @command{guix system
34127 reconfigure} perform safety checks: they make sure the file systems that
34128 appear in the @code{operating-system} declaration actually exist
34129 (@pxref{File Systems}), and that any Linux kernel modules that may be
34130 needed at boot time are listed in @code{initrd-modules} (@pxref{Initial
34131 RAM Disk}). Passing this option skips these tests altogether.
34132
34133 @item --allow-downgrades
34134 Instruct @command{guix system reconfigure} to allow system downgrades.
34135
34136 By default, @command{reconfigure} prevents you from downgrading your
34137 system. It achieves that by comparing the provenance info of your
34138 system (shown by @command{guix system describe}) with that of your
34139 @command{guix} command (shown by @command{guix describe}). If the
34140 commits for @command{guix} are not descendants of those used for your
34141 system, @command{guix system reconfigure} errors out. Passing
34142 @option{--allow-downgrades} allows you to bypass these checks.
34143
34144 @quotation Note
34145 Make sure you understand its security implications before using
34146 @option{--allow-downgrades}.
34147 @end quotation
34148
34149 @cindex on-error
34150 @cindex on-error strategy
34151 @cindex error strategy
34152 @item --on-error=@var{strategy}
34153 Apply @var{strategy} when an error occurs when reading @var{file}.
34154 @var{strategy} may be one of the following:
34155
34156 @table @code
34157 @item nothing-special
34158 Report the error concisely and exit. This is the default strategy.
34159
34160 @item backtrace
34161 Likewise, but also display a backtrace.
34162
34163 @item debug
34164 Report the error and enter Guile's debugger. From there, you can run
34165 commands such as @code{,bt} to get a backtrace, @code{,locals} to
34166 display local variable values, and more generally inspect the state of the
34167 program. @xref{Debug Commands,,, guile, GNU Guile Reference Manual}, for
34168 a list of available debugging commands.
34169 @end table
34170 @end table
34171
34172 Once you have built, configured, re-configured, and re-re-configured
34173 your Guix installation, you may find it useful to list the operating
34174 system generations available on disk---and that you can choose from the
34175 bootloader boot menu:
34176
34177 @table @code
34178
34179 @item describe
34180 Describe the current system generation: its file name, the kernel and
34181 bootloader used, etc., as well as provenance information when available.
34182
34183 @item list-generations
34184 List a summary of each generation of the operating system available on
34185 disk, in a human-readable way. This is similar to the
34186 @option{--list-generations} option of @command{guix package}
34187 (@pxref{Invoking guix package}).
34188
34189 Optionally, one can specify a pattern, with the same syntax that is used
34190 in @command{guix package --list-generations}, to restrict the list of
34191 generations displayed. For instance, the following command displays
34192 generations that are up to 10 days old:
34193
34194 @example
34195 $ guix system list-generations 10d
34196 @end example
34197
34198 @end table
34199
34200 The @command{guix system} command has even more to offer! The following
34201 sub-commands allow you to visualize how your system services relate to
34202 each other:
34203
34204 @anchor{system-extension-graph}
34205 @table @code
34206
34207 @item extension-graph
34208 Emit to standard output the @dfn{service
34209 extension graph} of the operating system defined in @var{file}
34210 (@pxref{Service Composition}, for more information on service
34211 extensions). By default the output is in Dot/Graphviz format, but you
34212 can choose a different format with @option{--graph-backend}, as with
34213 @command{guix graph} (@pxref{Invoking guix graph, @option{--backend}}):
34214
34215 The command:
34216
34217 @example
34218 $ guix system extension-graph @var{file} | xdot -
34219 @end example
34220
34221 shows the extension relations among services.
34222
34223 @anchor{system-shepherd-graph}
34224 @item shepherd-graph
34225 Emit to standard output the @dfn{dependency
34226 graph} of shepherd services of the operating system defined in
34227 @var{file}. @xref{Shepherd Services}, for more information and for an
34228 example graph.
34229
34230 Again, the default output format is Dot/Graphviz, but you can pass
34231 @option{--graph-backend} to select a different one.
34232
34233 @end table
34234
34235 @node Invoking guix deploy
34236 @section Invoking @code{guix deploy}
34237
34238 We've already seen @code{operating-system} declarations used to manage a
34239 machine's configuration locally. Suppose you need to configure multiple
34240 machines, though---perhaps you're managing a service on the web that's
34241 comprised of several servers. @command{guix deploy} enables you to use those
34242 same @code{operating-system} declarations to manage multiple remote hosts at
34243 once as a logical ``deployment''.
34244
34245 @quotation Note
34246 The functionality described in this section is still under development
34247 and is subject to change. Get in touch with us on
34248 @email{guix-devel@@gnu.org}!
34249 @end quotation
34250
34251 @example
34252 guix deploy @var{file}
34253 @end example
34254
34255 Such an invocation will deploy the machines that the code within @var{file}
34256 evaluates to. As an example, @var{file} might contain a definition like this:
34257
34258 @lisp
34259 ;; This is a Guix deployment of a "bare bones" setup, with
34260 ;; no X11 display server, to a machine with an SSH daemon
34261 ;; listening on localhost:2222. A configuration such as this
34262 ;; may be appropriate for virtual machine with ports
34263 ;; forwarded to the host's loopback interface.
34264
34265 (use-service-modules networking ssh)
34266 (use-package-modules bootloaders)
34267
34268 (define %system
34269 (operating-system
34270 (host-name "gnu-deployed")
34271 (timezone "Etc/UTC")
34272 (bootloader (bootloader-configuration
34273 (bootloader grub-bootloader)
34274 (targets '("/dev/vda"))
34275 (terminal-outputs '(console))))
34276 (file-systems (cons (file-system
34277 (mount-point "/")
34278 (device "/dev/vda1")
34279 (type "ext4"))
34280 %base-file-systems))
34281 (services
34282 (append (list (service dhcp-client-service-type)
34283 (service openssh-service-type
34284 (openssh-configuration
34285 (permit-root-login #t)
34286 (allow-empty-passwords? #t))))
34287 %base-services))))
34288
34289 (list (machine
34290 (operating-system %system)
34291 (environment managed-host-environment-type)
34292 (configuration (machine-ssh-configuration
34293 (host-name "localhost")
34294 (system "x86_64-linux")
34295 (user "alice")
34296 (identity "./id_rsa")
34297 (port 2222)))))
34298 @end lisp
34299
34300 The file should evaluate to a list of @var{machine} objects. This example,
34301 upon being deployed, will create a new generation on the remote system
34302 realizing the @code{operating-system} declaration @code{%system}.
34303 @code{environment} and @code{configuration} specify how the machine should be
34304 provisioned---that is, how the computing resources should be created and
34305 managed. The above example does not create any resources, as a
34306 @code{'managed-host} is a machine that is already running the Guix system and
34307 available over the network. This is a particularly simple case; a more
34308 complex deployment may involve, for example, starting virtual machines through
34309 a Virtual Private Server (VPS) provider. In such a case, a different
34310 @var{environment} type would be used.
34311
34312 Do note that you first need to generate a key pair on the coordinator machine
34313 to allow the daemon to export signed archives of files from the store
34314 (@pxref{Invoking guix archive}), though this step is automatic on Guix
34315 System:
34316
34317 @example
34318 # guix archive --generate-key
34319 @end example
34320
34321 @noindent
34322 Each target machine must authorize the key of the master machine so that it
34323 accepts store items it receives from the coordinator:
34324
34325 @example
34326 # guix archive --authorize < coordinator-public-key.txt
34327 @end example
34328
34329 @code{user}, in this example, specifies the name of the user account to log in
34330 as to perform the deployment. Its default value is @code{root}, but root
34331 login over SSH may be forbidden in some cases. To work around this,
34332 @command{guix deploy} can log in as an unprivileged user and employ
34333 @code{sudo} to escalate privileges. This will only work if @code{sudo} is
34334 currently installed on the remote and can be invoked non-interactively as
34335 @code{user}. That is, the line in @code{sudoers} granting @code{user} the
34336 ability to use @code{sudo} must contain the @code{NOPASSWD} tag. This can
34337 be accomplished with the following operating system configuration snippet:
34338
34339 @lisp
34340 (use-modules ...
34341 (gnu system)) ;for %sudoers-specification
34342
34343 (define %user "username")
34344
34345 (operating-system
34346 ...
34347 (sudoers-file
34348 (plain-file "sudoers"
34349 (string-append (plain-file-content %sudoers-specification)
34350 (format #f "~a ALL = NOPASSWD: ALL~%"
34351 %user)))))
34352
34353 @end lisp
34354
34355 For more information regarding the format of the @file{sudoers} file,
34356 consult @command{man sudoers}.
34357
34358 @deftp {Data Type} machine
34359 This is the data type representing a single machine in a heterogeneous Guix
34360 deployment.
34361
34362 @table @asis
34363 @item @code{operating-system}
34364 The object of the operating system configuration to deploy.
34365
34366 @item @code{environment}
34367 An @code{environment-type} describing how the machine should be provisioned.
34368
34369 @item @code{configuration} (default: @code{#f})
34370 An object describing the configuration for the machine's @code{environment}.
34371 If the @code{environment} has a default configuration, @code{#f} may be used.
34372 If @code{#f} is used for an environment with no default configuration,
34373 however, an error will be thrown.
34374 @end table
34375 @end deftp
34376
34377 @deftp {Data Type} machine-ssh-configuration
34378 This is the data type representing the SSH client parameters for a machine
34379 with an @code{environment} of @code{managed-host-environment-type}.
34380
34381 @table @asis
34382 @item @code{host-name}
34383 @item @code{build-locally?} (default: @code{#t})
34384 If false, system derivations will be built on the machine being deployed to.
34385 @item @code{system}
34386 The system type describing the architecture of the machine being deployed
34387 to---e.g., @code{"x86_64-linux"}.
34388 @item @code{authorize?} (default: @code{#t})
34389 If true, the coordinator's signing key will be added to the remote's ACL
34390 keyring.
34391 @item @code{port} (default: @code{22})
34392 @item @code{user} (default: @code{"root"})
34393 @item @code{identity} (default: @code{#f})
34394 If specified, the path to the SSH private key to use to authenticate with the
34395 remote host.
34396
34397 @item @code{host-key} (default: @code{#f})
34398 This should be the SSH host key of the machine, which looks like this:
34399
34400 @example
34401 ssh-ed25519 AAAAC3Nz@dots{} root@@example.org
34402 @end example
34403
34404 When @code{host-key} is @code{#f}, the server is authenticated against
34405 the @file{~/.ssh/known_hosts} file, just like the OpenSSH @command{ssh}
34406 client does.
34407
34408 @item @code{allow-downgrades?} (default: @code{#f})
34409 Whether to allow potential downgrades.
34410
34411 Like @command{guix system reconfigure}, @command{guix deploy} compares
34412 the channel commits currently deployed on the remote host (as returned
34413 by @command{guix system describe}) to those currently in use (as
34414 returned by @command{guix describe}) to determine whether commits
34415 currently in use are descendants of those deployed. When this is not
34416 the case and @code{allow-downgrades?} is false, it raises an error.
34417 This ensures you do not accidentally downgrade remote machines.
34418 @end table
34419 @end deftp
34420
34421 @deftp {Data Type} digital-ocean-configuration
34422 This is the data type describing the Droplet that should be created for a
34423 machine with an @code{environment} of @code{digital-ocean-environment-type}.
34424
34425 @table @asis
34426 @item @code{ssh-key}
34427 The path to the SSH private key to use to authenticate with the remote
34428 host. In the future, this field may not exist.
34429 @item @code{tags}
34430 A list of string ``tags'' that uniquely identify the machine. Must be given
34431 such that no two machines in the deployment have the same set of tags.
34432 @item @code{region}
34433 A Digital Ocean region slug, such as @code{"nyc3"}.
34434 @item @code{size}
34435 A Digital Ocean size slug, such as @code{"s-1vcpu-1gb"}
34436 @item @code{enable-ipv6?}
34437 Whether or not the droplet should be created with IPv6 networking.
34438 @end table
34439 @end deftp
34440
34441 @node Running Guix in a VM
34442 @section Running Guix in a Virtual Machine
34443
34444 @cindex virtual machine
34445 To run Guix in a virtual machine (VM), one can use the pre-built Guix VM
34446 image distributed at
34447 @url{@value{BASE-URL}/guix-system-vm-image-@value{VERSION}.x86_64-linux.qcow2}.
34448 This image is a compressed image in QCOW format. You can pass it to an
34449 emulator such as @uref{https://qemu.org/, QEMU} (see below for details).
34450
34451 This image boots the Xfce graphical environment and it contains some
34452 commonly used tools. You can install more software in the image by running
34453 @command{guix package} in a terminal (@pxref{Invoking guix package}). You can
34454 also reconfigure the system based on its initial configuration file available
34455 as @file{/run/current-system/configuration.scm} (@pxref{Using the
34456 Configuration System}).
34457
34458 Instead of using this pre-built image, one can also build their own
34459 image using @command{guix system image} (@pxref{Invoking guix system}).
34460
34461 @cindex QEMU
34462 If you built your own image, you must copy it out of the store
34463 (@pxref{The Store}) and give yourself permission to write to the copy
34464 before you can use it. When invoking QEMU, you must choose a system
34465 emulator that is suitable for your hardware platform. Here is a minimal
34466 QEMU invocation that will boot the result of @command{guix system
34467 image -t qcow2} on x86_64 hardware:
34468
34469 @example
34470 $ qemu-system-x86_64 \
34471 -nic user,model=virtio-net-pci \
34472 -enable-kvm -m 1024 \
34473 -device virtio-blk,drive=myhd \
34474 -drive if=none,file=/tmp/qemu-image,id=myhd
34475 @end example
34476
34477 Here is what each of these options means:
34478
34479 @table @code
34480 @item qemu-system-x86_64
34481 This specifies the hardware platform to emulate. This should match the
34482 host.
34483
34484 @item -nic user,model=virtio-net-pci
34485 Enable the unprivileged user-mode network stack. The guest OS can
34486 access the host but not vice versa. This is the simplest way to get the
34487 guest OS online. @code{model} specifies which network device to emulate:
34488 @code{virtio-net-pci} is a special device made for virtualized operating
34489 systems and recommended for most uses. Assuming your hardware platform is
34490 x86_64, you can get a list of available NIC models by running
34491 @command{qemu-system-x86_64 -nic model=help}.
34492
34493 @item -enable-kvm
34494 If your system has hardware virtualization extensions, enabling the
34495 virtual machine support (KVM) of the Linux kernel will make things run
34496 faster.
34497
34498 @c To run Xfce + 'guix pull', we need at least 1G of RAM.
34499 @item -m 1024
34500 RAM available to the guest OS, in mebibytes. Defaults to 128@tie{}MiB,
34501 which may be insufficient for some operations.
34502
34503 @item -device virtio-blk,drive=myhd
34504 Create a @code{virtio-blk} drive called ``myhd''. @code{virtio-blk} is a
34505 ``paravirtualization'' mechanism for block devices that allows QEMU to achieve
34506 better performance than if it were emulating a complete disk drive. See the
34507 QEMU and KVM documentation for more info.
34508
34509 @item -drive if=none,file=/tmp/qemu-image,id=myhd
34510 Use our QCOW image, the @file{/tmp/qemu-image} file, as the backing
34511 store of the ``myhd'' drive.
34512 @end table
34513
34514 The default @command{run-vm.sh} script that is returned by an invocation of
34515 @command{guix system vm} does not add a @command{-nic user} flag by default.
34516 To get network access from within the vm add the @code{(dhcp-client-service)}
34517 to your system definition and start the VM using
34518 @command{$(guix system vm config.scm) -nic user}. An important caveat of using
34519 @command{-nic user} for networking is that @command{ping} will not work, because
34520 it uses the ICMP protocol. You'll have to use a different command to check for
34521 network connectivity, for example @command{guix download}.
34522
34523 @subsection Connecting Through SSH
34524
34525 @cindex SSH
34526 @cindex SSH server
34527 To enable SSH inside a VM you need to add an SSH server like
34528 @code{openssh-service-type} to your VM (@pxref{Networking Services,
34529 @code{openssh-service-type}}). In addition you need to forward the SSH port,
34530 22 by default, to the host. You can do this with
34531
34532 @example
34533 $(guix system vm config.scm) -nic user,model=virtio-net-pci,hostfwd=tcp::10022-:22
34534 @end example
34535
34536 To connect to the VM you can run
34537
34538 @example
34539 ssh -o UserKnownHostsFile=/dev/null -o StrictHostKeyChecking=no -p 10022 localhost
34540 @end example
34541
34542 The @command{-p} tells @command{ssh} the port you want to connect to.
34543 @command{-o UserKnownHostsFile=/dev/null} prevents @command{ssh} from complaining
34544 every time you modify your @command{config.scm} file and the
34545 @command{-o StrictHostKeyChecking=no} prevents you from having to allow a
34546 connection to an unknown host every time you connect.
34547
34548 @quotation Note
34549 If you find the above @samp{hostfwd} example not to be working (e.g.,
34550 your SSH client hangs attempting to connect to the mapped port of your
34551 VM), make sure that your Guix System VM has networking support, such as
34552 by using the @code{dhcp-client-service-type} service type.
34553 @end quotation
34554
34555 @subsection Using @command{virt-viewer} with Spice
34556
34557 As an alternative to the default @command{qemu} graphical client you can
34558 use the @command{remote-viewer} from the @command{virt-viewer} package. To
34559 connect pass the @command{-spice port=5930,disable-ticketing} flag to
34560 @command{qemu}. See previous section for further information on how to do this.
34561
34562 Spice also allows you to do some nice stuff like share your clipboard with your
34563 VM@. To enable that you'll also have to pass the following flags to @command{qemu}:
34564
34565 @example
34566 -device virtio-serial-pci,id=virtio-serial0,max_ports=16,bus=pci.0,addr=0x5
34567 -chardev spicevmc,name=vdagent,id=vdagent
34568 -device virtserialport,nr=1,bus=virtio-serial0.0,chardev=vdagent,
34569 name=com.redhat.spice.0
34570 @end example
34571
34572 You'll also need to add the @code{(spice-vdagent-service)} to your
34573 system definition (@pxref{Miscellaneous Services, Spice service}).
34574
34575 @node Defining Services
34576 @section Defining Services
34577
34578 The previous sections show the available services and how one can combine
34579 them in an @code{operating-system} declaration. But how do we define
34580 them in the first place? And what is a service anyway?
34581
34582 @menu
34583 * Service Composition:: The model for composing services.
34584 * Service Types and Services:: Types and services.
34585 * Service Reference:: API reference.
34586 * Shepherd Services:: A particular type of service.
34587 @end menu
34588
34589 @node Service Composition
34590 @subsection Service Composition
34591
34592 @cindex services
34593 @cindex daemons
34594 Here we define a @dfn{service} as, broadly, something that extends the
34595 functionality of the operating system. Often a service is a process---a
34596 @dfn{daemon}---started when the system boots: a secure shell server, a
34597 Web server, the Guix build daemon, etc. Sometimes a service is a daemon
34598 whose execution can be triggered by another daemon---e.g., an FTP server
34599 started by @command{inetd} or a D-Bus service activated by
34600 @command{dbus-daemon}. Occasionally, a service does not map to a
34601 daemon. For instance, the ``account'' service collects user accounts
34602 and makes sure they exist when the system runs; the ``udev'' service
34603 collects device management rules and makes them available to the eudev
34604 daemon; the @file{/etc} service populates the @file{/etc} directory
34605 of the system.
34606
34607 @cindex service extensions
34608 Guix system services are connected by @dfn{extensions}. For instance, the
34609 secure shell service @emph{extends} the Shepherd---the
34610 initialization system, running as PID@tie{}1---by giving it the command
34611 lines to start and stop the secure shell daemon (@pxref{Networking
34612 Services, @code{openssh-service-type}}); the UPower service extends the D-Bus
34613 service by passing it its @file{.service} specification, and extends the
34614 udev service by passing it device management rules (@pxref{Desktop
34615 Services, @code{upower-service}}); the Guix daemon service extends the
34616 Shepherd by passing it the command lines to start and stop the daemon,
34617 and extends the account service by passing it a list of required build
34618 user accounts (@pxref{Base Services}).
34619
34620 All in all, services and their ``extends'' relations form a directed
34621 acyclic graph (DAG). If we represent services as boxes and extensions
34622 as arrows, a typical system might provide something like this:
34623
34624 @image{images/service-graph,,5in,Typical service extension graph.}
34625
34626 @cindex system service
34627 At the bottom, we see the @dfn{system service}, which produces the
34628 directory containing everything to run and boot the system, as returned
34629 by the @command{guix system build} command. @xref{Service Reference},
34630 to learn about the other service types shown here.
34631 @xref{system-extension-graph, the @command{guix system extension-graph}
34632 command}, for information on how to generate this representation for a
34633 particular operating system definition.
34634
34635 @cindex service types
34636 Technically, developers can define @dfn{service types} to express these
34637 relations. There can be any number of services of a given type on the
34638 system---for instance, a system running two instances of the GNU secure
34639 shell server (lsh) has two instances of @code{lsh-service-type}, with
34640 different parameters.
34641
34642 The following section describes the programming interface for service
34643 types and services.
34644
34645 @node Service Types and Services
34646 @subsection Service Types and Services
34647
34648 A @dfn{service type} is a node in the DAG described above. Let us start
34649 with a simple example, the service type for the Guix build daemon
34650 (@pxref{Invoking guix-daemon}):
34651
34652 @lisp
34653 (define guix-service-type
34654 (service-type
34655 (name 'guix)
34656 (extensions
34657 (list (service-extension shepherd-root-service-type guix-shepherd-service)
34658 (service-extension account-service-type guix-accounts)
34659 (service-extension activation-service-type guix-activation)))
34660 (default-value (guix-configuration))))
34661 @end lisp
34662
34663 @noindent
34664 It defines three things:
34665
34666 @enumerate
34667 @item
34668 A name, whose sole purpose is to make inspection and debugging easier.
34669
34670 @item
34671 A list of @dfn{service extensions}, where each extension designates the
34672 target service type and a procedure that, given the parameters of the
34673 service, returns a list of objects to extend the service of that type.
34674
34675 Every service type has at least one service extension. The only
34676 exception is the @dfn{boot service type}, which is the ultimate service.
34677
34678 @item
34679 Optionally, a default value for instances of this type.
34680 @end enumerate
34681
34682 In this example, @code{guix-service-type} extends three services:
34683
34684 @table @code
34685 @item shepherd-root-service-type
34686 The @code{guix-shepherd-service} procedure defines how the Shepherd
34687 service is extended. Namely, it returns a @code{<shepherd-service>}
34688 object that defines how @command{guix-daemon} is started and stopped
34689 (@pxref{Shepherd Services}).
34690
34691 @item account-service-type
34692 This extension for this service is computed by @code{guix-accounts},
34693 which returns a list of @code{user-group} and @code{user-account}
34694 objects representing the build user accounts (@pxref{Invoking
34695 guix-daemon}).
34696
34697 @item activation-service-type
34698 Here @code{guix-activation} is a procedure that returns a gexp, which is
34699 a code snippet to run at ``activation time''---e.g., when the service is
34700 booted.
34701 @end table
34702
34703 A service of this type is instantiated like this:
34704
34705 @lisp
34706 (service guix-service-type
34707 (guix-configuration
34708 (build-accounts 5)
34709 (extra-options '("--gc-keep-derivations"))))
34710 @end lisp
34711
34712 The second argument to the @code{service} form is a value representing
34713 the parameters of this specific service instance.
34714 @xref{guix-configuration-type, @code{guix-configuration}}, for
34715 information about the @code{guix-configuration} data type. When the
34716 value is omitted, the default value specified by
34717 @code{guix-service-type} is used:
34718
34719 @lisp
34720 (service guix-service-type)
34721 @end lisp
34722
34723 @code{guix-service-type} is quite simple because it extends other
34724 services but is not extensible itself.
34725
34726 @c @subsubsubsection Extensible Service Types
34727
34728 The service type for an @emph{extensible} service looks like this:
34729
34730 @lisp
34731 (define udev-service-type
34732 (service-type (name 'udev)
34733 (extensions
34734 (list (service-extension shepherd-root-service-type
34735 udev-shepherd-service)))
34736
34737 (compose concatenate) ;concatenate the list of rules
34738 (extend (lambda (config rules)
34739 (match config
34740 (($ <udev-configuration> udev initial-rules)
34741 (udev-configuration
34742 (udev udev) ;the udev package to use
34743 (rules (append initial-rules rules)))))))))
34744 @end lisp
34745
34746 This is the service type for the
34747 @uref{https://wiki.gentoo.org/wiki/Project:Eudev, eudev device
34748 management daemon}. Compared to the previous example, in addition to an
34749 extension of @code{shepherd-root-service-type}, we see two new fields:
34750
34751 @table @code
34752 @item compose
34753 This is the procedure to @dfn{compose} the list of extensions to
34754 services of this type.
34755
34756 Services can extend the udev service by passing it lists of rules; we
34757 compose those extensions simply by concatenating them.
34758
34759 @item extend
34760 This procedure defines how the value of the service is @dfn{extended} with
34761 the composition of the extensions.
34762
34763 Udev extensions are composed into a list of rules, but the udev service
34764 value is itself a @code{<udev-configuration>} record. So here, we
34765 extend that record by appending the list of rules it contains to the
34766 list of contributed rules.
34767
34768 @item description
34769 This is a string giving an overview of the service type. The string can
34770 contain Texinfo markup (@pxref{Overview,,, texinfo, GNU Texinfo}). The
34771 @command{guix system search} command searches these strings and displays
34772 them (@pxref{Invoking guix system}).
34773 @end table
34774
34775 There can be only one instance of an extensible service type such as
34776 @code{udev-service-type}. If there were more, the
34777 @code{service-extension} specifications would be ambiguous.
34778
34779 Still here? The next section provides a reference of the programming
34780 interface for services.
34781
34782 @node Service Reference
34783 @subsection Service Reference
34784
34785 We have seen an overview of service types (@pxref{Service Types and
34786 Services}). This section provides a reference on how to manipulate
34787 services and service types. This interface is provided by the
34788 @code{(gnu services)} module.
34789
34790 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} service @var{type} [@var{value}]
34791 Return a new service of @var{type}, a @code{<service-type>} object (see
34792 below). @var{value} can be any object; it represents the parameters of
34793 this particular service instance.
34794
34795 When @var{value} is omitted, the default value specified by @var{type}
34796 is used; if @var{type} does not specify a default value, an error is
34797 raised.
34798
34799 For instance, this:
34800
34801 @lisp
34802 (service openssh-service-type)
34803 @end lisp
34804
34805 @noindent
34806 is equivalent to this:
34807
34808 @lisp
34809 (service openssh-service-type
34810 (openssh-configuration))
34811 @end lisp
34812
34813 In both cases the result is an instance of @code{openssh-service-type}
34814 with the default configuration.
34815 @end deffn
34816
34817 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} service? @var{obj}
34818 Return true if @var{obj} is a service.
34819 @end deffn
34820
34821 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} service-kind @var{service}
34822 Return the type of @var{service}---i.e., a @code{<service-type>} object.
34823 @end deffn
34824
34825 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} service-value @var{service}
34826 Return the value associated with @var{service}. It represents its
34827 parameters.
34828 @end deffn
34829
34830 Here is an example of how a service is created and manipulated:
34831
34832 @lisp
34833 (define s
34834 (service nginx-service-type
34835 (nginx-configuration
34836 (nginx nginx)
34837 (log-directory log-directory)
34838 (run-directory run-directory)
34839 (file config-file))))
34840
34841 (service? s)
34842 @result{} #t
34843
34844 (eq? (service-kind s) nginx-service-type)
34845 @result{} #t
34846 @end lisp
34847
34848 The @code{modify-services} form provides a handy way to change the
34849 parameters of some of the services of a list such as
34850 @code{%base-services} (@pxref{Base Services, @code{%base-services}}). It
34851 evaluates to a list of services. Of course, you could always use
34852 standard list combinators such as @code{map} and @code{fold} to do that
34853 (@pxref{SRFI-1, List Library,, guile, GNU Guile Reference Manual});
34854 @code{modify-services} simply provides a more concise form for this
34855 common pattern.
34856
34857 @deffn {Scheme Syntax} modify-services @var{services} @
34858 (@var{type} @var{variable} => @var{body}) @dots{}
34859
34860 Modify the services listed in @var{services} according to the given
34861 clauses. Each clause has the form:
34862
34863 @example
34864 (@var{type} @var{variable} => @var{body})
34865 @end example
34866
34867 where @var{type} is a service type---e.g.,
34868 @code{guix-service-type}---and @var{variable} is an identifier that is
34869 bound within the @var{body} to the service parameters---e.g., a
34870 @code{guix-configuration} instance---of the original service of that
34871 @var{type}.
34872
34873 The @var{body} should evaluate to the new service parameters, which will
34874 be used to configure the new service. This new service will replace the
34875 original in the resulting list. Because a service's service parameters
34876 are created using @code{define-record-type*}, you can write a succinct
34877 @var{body} that evaluates to the new service parameters by using the
34878 @code{inherit} feature that @code{define-record-type*} provides.
34879
34880 @xref{Using the Configuration System}, for example usage.
34881
34882 @end deffn
34883
34884 Next comes the programming interface for service types. This is
34885 something you want to know when writing new service definitions, but not
34886 necessarily when simply looking for ways to customize your
34887 @code{operating-system} declaration.
34888
34889 @deftp {Data Type} service-type
34890 @cindex service type
34891 This is the representation of a @dfn{service type} (@pxref{Service Types
34892 and Services}).
34893
34894 @table @asis
34895 @item @code{name}
34896 This is a symbol, used only to simplify inspection and debugging.
34897
34898 @item @code{extensions}
34899 A non-empty list of @code{<service-extension>} objects (see below).
34900
34901 @item @code{compose} (default: @code{#f})
34902 If this is @code{#f}, then the service type denotes services that cannot
34903 be extended---i.e., services that do not receive ``values'' from other
34904 services.
34905
34906 Otherwise, it must be a one-argument procedure. The procedure is called
34907 by @code{fold-services} and is passed a list of values collected from
34908 extensions. It may return any single value.
34909
34910 @item @code{extend} (default: @code{#f})
34911 If this is @code{#f}, services of this type cannot be extended.
34912
34913 Otherwise, it must be a two-argument procedure: @code{fold-services}
34914 calls it, passing it the initial value of the service as the first
34915 argument and the result of applying @code{compose} to the extension
34916 values as the second argument. It must return a value that is a valid
34917 parameter value for the service instance.
34918
34919 @item @code{description}
34920 This is a string, possibly using Texinfo markup, describing in a couple
34921 of sentences what the service is about. This string allows users to
34922 find about the service through @command{guix system search}
34923 (@pxref{Invoking guix system}).
34924
34925 @item @code{default-value} (default: @code{&no-default-value})
34926 The default value associated for instances of this service type. This
34927 allows users to use the @code{service} form without its second argument:
34928
34929 @lisp
34930 (service @var{type})
34931 @end lisp
34932
34933 The returned service in this case has the default value specified by
34934 @var{type}.
34935 @end table
34936
34937 @xref{Service Types and Services}, for examples.
34938 @end deftp
34939
34940 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} service-extension @var{target-type} @
34941 @var{compute}
34942 Return a new extension for services of type @var{target-type}.
34943 @var{compute} must be a one-argument procedure: @code{fold-services}
34944 calls it, passing it the value associated with the service that provides
34945 the extension; it must return a valid value for the target service.
34946 @end deffn
34947
34948 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} service-extension? @var{obj}
34949 Return true if @var{obj} is a service extension.
34950 @end deffn
34951
34952 Occasionally, you might want to simply extend an existing service. This
34953 involves creating a new service type and specifying the extension of
34954 interest, which can be verbose; the @code{simple-service} procedure
34955 provides a shorthand for this.
34956
34957 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} simple-service @var{name} @var{target} @var{value}
34958 Return a service that extends @var{target} with @var{value}. This works
34959 by creating a singleton service type @var{name}, of which the returned
34960 service is an instance.
34961
34962 For example, this extends mcron (@pxref{Scheduled Job Execution}) with
34963 an additional job:
34964
34965 @lisp
34966 (simple-service 'my-mcron-job mcron-service-type
34967 #~(job '(next-hour (3)) "guix gc -F 2G"))
34968 @end lisp
34969 @end deffn
34970
34971 At the core of the service abstraction lies the @code{fold-services}
34972 procedure, which is responsible for ``compiling'' a list of services
34973 down to a single directory that contains everything needed to boot and
34974 run the system---the directory shown by the @command{guix system build}
34975 command (@pxref{Invoking guix system}). In essence, it propagates
34976 service extensions down the service graph, updating each node parameters
34977 on the way, until it reaches the root node.
34978
34979 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} fold-services @var{services} @
34980 [#:target-type @var{system-service-type}]
34981 Fold @var{services} by propagating their extensions down to the root of
34982 type @var{target-type}; return the root service adjusted accordingly.
34983 @end deffn
34984
34985 Lastly, the @code{(gnu services)} module also defines several essential
34986 service types, some of which are listed below.
34987
34988 @defvr {Scheme Variable} system-service-type
34989 This is the root of the service graph. It produces the system directory
34990 as returned by the @command{guix system build} command.
34991 @end defvr
34992
34993 @defvr {Scheme Variable} boot-service-type
34994 The type of the ``boot service'', which produces the @dfn{boot script}.
34995 The boot script is what the initial RAM disk runs when booting.
34996 @end defvr
34997
34998 @defvr {Scheme Variable} etc-service-type
34999 The type of the @file{/etc} service. This service is used to create
35000 files under @file{/etc} and can be extended by
35001 passing it name/file tuples such as:
35002
35003 @lisp
35004 (list `("issue" ,(plain-file "issue" "Welcome!\n")))
35005 @end lisp
35006
35007 In this example, the effect would be to add an @file{/etc/issue} file
35008 pointing to the given file.
35009 @end defvr
35010
35011 @defvr {Scheme Variable} setuid-program-service-type
35012 Type for the ``setuid-program service''. This service collects lists of
35013 executable file names, passed as gexps, and adds them to the set of
35014 setuid-root programs on the system (@pxref{Setuid Programs}).
35015 @end defvr
35016
35017 @defvr {Scheme Variable} profile-service-type
35018 Type of the service that populates the @dfn{system profile}---i.e., the
35019 programs under @file{/run/current-system/profile}. Other services can
35020 extend it by passing it lists of packages to add to the system profile.
35021 @end defvr
35022
35023 @cindex provenance tracking, of the operating system
35024 @anchor{provenance-service-type}
35025 @defvr {Scheme Variable} provenance-service-type
35026 This is the type of the service that records @dfn{provenance meta-data}
35027 in the system itself. It creates several files under
35028 @file{/run/current-system}:
35029
35030 @table @file
35031 @item channels.scm
35032 This is a ``channel file'' that can be passed to @command{guix pull -C}
35033 or @command{guix time-machine -C}, and which describes the channels used
35034 to build the system, if that information was available
35035 (@pxref{Channels}).
35036
35037 @item configuration.scm
35038 This is the file that was passed as the value for this
35039 @code{provenance-service-type} service. By default, @command{guix
35040 system reconfigure} automatically passes the OS configuration file it
35041 received on the command line.
35042
35043 @item provenance
35044 This contains the same information as the two other files but in a
35045 format that is more readily processable.
35046 @end table
35047
35048 In general, these two pieces of information (channels and configuration
35049 file) are enough to reproduce the operating system ``from source''.
35050
35051 @quotation Caveats
35052 This information is necessary to rebuild your operating system, but it
35053 is not always sufficient. In particular, @file{configuration.scm}
35054 itself is insufficient if it is not self-contained---if it refers to
35055 external Guile modules or to extra files. If you want
35056 @file{configuration.scm} to be self-contained, we recommend that modules
35057 or files it refers to be part of a channel.
35058
35059 Besides, provenance meta-data is ``silent'' in the sense that it does
35060 not change the bits contained in your system, @emph{except for the
35061 meta-data bits themselves}. Two different OS configurations or sets of
35062 channels can lead to the same system, bit-for-bit; when
35063 @code{provenance-service-type} is used, these two systems will have
35064 different meta-data and thus different store file names, which makes
35065 comparison less trivial.
35066 @end quotation
35067
35068 This service is automatically added to your operating system
35069 configuration when you use @command{guix system reconfigure},
35070 @command{guix system init}, or @command{guix deploy}.
35071 @end defvr
35072
35073 @defvr {Scheme Variable} linux-loadable-module-service-type
35074 Type of the service that collects lists of packages containing
35075 kernel-loadable modules, and adds them to the set of kernel-loadable
35076 modules.
35077
35078 This service type is intended to be extended by other service types,
35079 such as below:
35080
35081 @lisp
35082 (simple-service 'installing-module
35083 linux-loadable-module-service-type
35084 (list module-to-install-1
35085 module-to-install-2))
35086 @end lisp
35087
35088 This does not actually load modules at bootup, only adds it to the
35089 kernel profile so that it @emph{can} be loaded by other means.
35090 @end defvr
35091
35092 @node Shepherd Services
35093 @subsection Shepherd Services
35094
35095 @cindex shepherd services
35096 @cindex PID 1
35097 @cindex init system
35098 The @code{(gnu services shepherd)} module provides a way to define
35099 services managed by the GNU@tie{}Shepherd, which is the
35100 initialization system---the first process that is started when the
35101 system boots, also known as PID@tie{}1
35102 (@pxref{Introduction,,, shepherd, The GNU Shepherd Manual}).
35103
35104 Services in the Shepherd can depend on each other. For instance, the
35105 SSH daemon may need to be started after the syslog daemon has been
35106 started, which in turn can only happen once all the file systems have
35107 been mounted. The simple operating system defined earlier (@pxref{Using
35108 the Configuration System}) results in a service graph like this:
35109
35110 @image{images/shepherd-graph,,5in,Typical shepherd service graph.}
35111
35112 You can actually generate such a graph for any operating system
35113 definition using the @command{guix system shepherd-graph} command
35114 (@pxref{system-shepherd-graph, @command{guix system shepherd-graph}}).
35115
35116 The @code{%shepherd-root-service} is a service object representing
35117 PID@tie{}1, of type @code{shepherd-root-service-type}; it can be extended
35118 by passing it lists of @code{<shepherd-service>} objects.
35119
35120 @deftp {Data Type} shepherd-service
35121 The data type representing a service managed by the Shepherd.
35122
35123 @table @asis
35124 @item @code{provision}
35125 This is a list of symbols denoting what the service provides.
35126
35127 These are the names that may be passed to @command{herd start},
35128 @command{herd status}, and similar commands (@pxref{Invoking herd,,,
35129 shepherd, The GNU Shepherd Manual}). @xref{Slots of services, the
35130 @code{provides} slot,, shepherd, The GNU Shepherd Manual}, for details.
35131
35132 @item @code{requirement} (default: @code{'()})
35133 List of symbols denoting the Shepherd services this one depends on.
35134
35135 @cindex one-shot services, for the Shepherd
35136 @item @code{one-shot?} (default: @code{#f})
35137 Whether this service is @dfn{one-shot}. One-shot services stop immediately
35138 after their @code{start} action has completed. @xref{Slots of services,,,
35139 shepherd, The GNU Shepherd Manual}, for more info.
35140
35141 @item @code{respawn?} (default: @code{#t})
35142 Whether to restart the service when it stops, for instance when the
35143 underlying process dies.
35144
35145 @item @code{start}
35146 @itemx @code{stop} (default: @code{#~(const #f)})
35147 The @code{start} and @code{stop} fields refer to the Shepherd's
35148 facilities to start and stop processes (@pxref{Service De- and
35149 Constructors,,, shepherd, The GNU Shepherd Manual}). They are given as
35150 G-expressions that get expanded in the Shepherd configuration file
35151 (@pxref{G-Expressions}).
35152
35153 @item @code{actions} (default: @code{'()})
35154 @cindex actions, of Shepherd services
35155 This is a list of @code{shepherd-action} objects (see below) defining
35156 @dfn{actions} supported by the service, in addition to the standard
35157 @code{start} and @code{stop} actions. Actions listed here become available as
35158 @command{herd} sub-commands:
35159
35160 @example
35161 herd @var{action} @var{service} [@var{arguments}@dots{}]
35162 @end example
35163
35164 @item @code{auto-start?} (default: @code{#t})
35165 Whether this service should be started automatically by the Shepherd. If it
35166 is @code{#f} the service has to be started manually with @code{herd start}.
35167
35168 @item @code{documentation}
35169 A documentation string, as shown when running:
35170
35171 @example
35172 herd doc @var{service-name}
35173 @end example
35174
35175 where @var{service-name} is one of the symbols in @code{provision}
35176 (@pxref{Invoking herd,,, shepherd, The GNU Shepherd Manual}).
35177
35178 @item @code{modules} (default: @code{%default-modules})
35179 This is the list of modules that must be in scope when @code{start} and
35180 @code{stop} are evaluated.
35181
35182 @end table
35183 @end deftp
35184
35185 The example below defines a Shepherd service that spawns
35186 @command{syslogd}, the system logger from the GNU Networking Utilities
35187 (@pxref{syslogd invocation, @command{syslogd},, inetutils, GNU
35188 Inetutils}):
35189
35190 @example
35191 (let ((config (plain-file "syslogd.conf" "@dots{}")))
35192 (shepherd-service
35193 (documentation "Run the syslog daemon (syslogd).")
35194 (provision '(syslogd))
35195 (requirement '(user-processes))
35196 (start #~(make-forkexec-constructor
35197 (list #$(file-append inetutils "/libexec/syslogd")
35198 "--rcfile" #$config)
35199 #:pid-file "/var/run/syslog.pid"))
35200 (stop #~(make-kill-destructor))))
35201 @end example
35202
35203 Key elements in this example are the @code{start} and @code{stop}
35204 fields: they are @dfn{staged} code snippets that use the
35205 @code{make-forkexec-constructor} procedure provided by the Shepherd and
35206 its dual, @code{make-kill-destructor} (@pxref{Service De- and
35207 Constructors,,, shepherd, The GNU Shepherd Manual}). The @code{start}
35208 field will have @command{shepherd} spawn @command{syslogd} with the
35209 given option; note that we pass @code{config} after @option{--rcfile},
35210 which is a configuration file declared above (contents of this file are
35211 omitted). Likewise, the @code{stop} field tells how this service is to
35212 be stopped; in this case, it is stopped by making the @code{kill} system
35213 call on its PID@. Code staging is achieved using G-expressions:
35214 @code{#~} stages code, while @code{#$} ``escapes'' back to host code
35215 (@pxref{G-Expressions}).
35216
35217 @deftp {Data Type} shepherd-action
35218 This is the data type that defines additional actions implemented by a
35219 Shepherd service (see above).
35220
35221 @table @code
35222 @item name
35223 Symbol naming the action.
35224
35225 @item documentation
35226 This is a documentation string for the action. It can be viewed by running:
35227
35228 @example
35229 herd doc @var{service} action @var{action}
35230 @end example
35231
35232 @item procedure
35233 This should be a gexp that evaluates to a procedure of at least one argument,
35234 which is the ``running value'' of the service (@pxref{Slots of services,,,
35235 shepherd, The GNU Shepherd Manual}).
35236 @end table
35237
35238 The following example defines an action called @code{say-hello} that kindly
35239 greets the user:
35240
35241 @lisp
35242 (shepherd-action
35243 (name 'say-hello)
35244 (documentation "Say hi!")
35245 (procedure #~(lambda (running . args)
35246 (format #t "Hello, friend! arguments: ~s\n"
35247 args)
35248 #t)))
35249 @end lisp
35250
35251 Assuming this action is added to the @code{example} service, then you can do:
35252
35253 @example
35254 # herd say-hello example
35255 Hello, friend! arguments: ()
35256 # herd say-hello example a b c
35257 Hello, friend! arguments: ("a" "b" "c")
35258 @end example
35259
35260 This, as you can see, is a fairly sophisticated way to say hello.
35261 @xref{Service Convenience,,, shepherd, The GNU Shepherd Manual}, for more
35262 info on actions.
35263 @end deftp
35264
35265 @defvr {Scheme Variable} shepherd-root-service-type
35266 The service type for the Shepherd ``root service''---i.e., PID@tie{}1.
35267
35268 This is the service type that extensions target when they want to create
35269 shepherd services (@pxref{Service Types and Services}, for an example).
35270 Each extension must pass a list of @code{<shepherd-service>}. Its
35271 value must be a @code{shepherd-configuration}, as described below.
35272 @end defvr
35273
35274 @deftp {Data Type} shepherd-configuration
35275 This data type represents the Shepherd's configuration.
35276
35277 @table @code
35278 @item shepherd (default: @code{shepherd})
35279 The Shepherd package to use.
35280
35281 @item services (default: @code{'()})
35282 A list of @code{<shepherd-service>} to start.
35283 You should probably use the service extension
35284 mechanism instead (@pxref{Shepherd Services}).
35285 @end table
35286 @end deftp
35287
35288 The following example specifies the Shepherd package for the operating
35289 system:
35290
35291 @lisp
35292 (operating-system
35293 ;; ...
35294 (services (append (list openssh-service-type))
35295 ;; ...
35296 %desktop-services)
35297 ;; ...
35298 ;; Use own Shepherd package.
35299 (essential-services
35300 (modify-services (operating-system-default-essential-services
35301 this-operating-system)
35302 (shepherd-root-service-type config => (shepherd-configuration
35303 (inherit config)
35304 (shepherd my-shepherd))))))
35305 @end lisp
35306
35307 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %shepherd-root-service
35308 This service represents PID@tie{}1.
35309 @end defvr
35310
35311
35312 @node Documentation
35313 @chapter Documentation
35314
35315 @cindex documentation, searching for
35316 @cindex searching for documentation
35317 @cindex Info, documentation format
35318 @cindex man pages
35319 @cindex manual pages
35320 In most cases packages installed with Guix come with documentation.
35321 There are two main documentation formats: ``Info'', a browsable
35322 hypertext format used for GNU software, and ``manual pages'' (or ``man
35323 pages''), the linear documentation format traditionally found on Unix.
35324 Info manuals are accessed with the @command{info} command or with Emacs,
35325 and man pages are accessed using @command{man}.
35326
35327 You can look for documentation of software installed on your system by
35328 keyword. For example, the following command searches for information
35329 about ``TLS'' in Info manuals:
35330
35331 @example
35332 $ info -k TLS
35333 "(emacs)Network Security" -- STARTTLS
35334 "(emacs)Network Security" -- TLS
35335 "(gnutls)Core TLS API" -- gnutls_certificate_set_verify_flags
35336 "(gnutls)Core TLS API" -- gnutls_certificate_set_verify_function
35337 @dots{}
35338 @end example
35339
35340 @noindent
35341 The command below searches for the same keyword in man pages:
35342
35343 @example
35344 $ man -k TLS
35345 SSL (7) - OpenSSL SSL/TLS library
35346 certtool (1) - GnuTLS certificate tool
35347 @dots {}
35348 @end example
35349
35350 These searches are purely local to your computer so you have the
35351 guarantee that documentation you find corresponds to what you have
35352 actually installed, you can access it off-line, and your privacy is
35353 respected.
35354
35355 Once you have these results, you can view the relevant documentation by
35356 running, say:
35357
35358 @example
35359 $ info "(gnutls)Core TLS API"
35360 @end example
35361
35362 @noindent
35363 or:
35364
35365 @example
35366 $ man certtool
35367 @end example
35368
35369 Info manuals contain sections and indices as well as hyperlinks like
35370 those found in Web pages. The @command{info} reader (@pxref{Top, Info
35371 reader,, info-stnd, Stand-alone GNU Info}) and its Emacs counterpart
35372 (@pxref{Misc Help,,, emacs, The GNU Emacs Manual}) provide intuitive key
35373 bindings to navigate manuals. @xref{Getting Started,,, info, Info: An
35374 Introduction}, for an introduction to Info navigation.
35375
35376 @node Installing Debugging Files
35377 @chapter Installing Debugging Files
35378
35379 @cindex debugging files
35380 Program binaries, as produced by the GCC compilers for instance, are
35381 typically written in the ELF format, with a section containing
35382 @dfn{debugging information}. Debugging information is what allows the
35383 debugger, GDB, to map binary code to source code; it is required to
35384 debug a compiled program in good conditions.
35385
35386 This chapter explains how to use separate debug info when packages
35387 provide it, and how to rebuild packages with debug info when it's
35388 missing.
35389
35390 @menu
35391 * Separate Debug Info:: Installing 'debug' outputs.
35392 * Rebuilding Debug Info:: Building missing debug info.
35393 @end menu
35394
35395 @node Separate Debug Info
35396 @section Separate Debug Info
35397
35398 The problem with debugging information is that is takes up a fair amount
35399 of disk space. For example, debugging information for the GNU C Library
35400 weighs in at more than 60 MiB@. Thus, as a user, keeping all the
35401 debugging info of all the installed programs is usually not an option.
35402 Yet, space savings should not come at the cost of an impediment to
35403 debugging---especially in the GNU system, which should make it easier
35404 for users to exert their computing freedom (@pxref{GNU Distribution}).
35405
35406 Thankfully, the GNU Binary Utilities (Binutils) and GDB provide a
35407 mechanism that allows users to get the best of both worlds: debugging
35408 information can be stripped from the binaries and stored in separate
35409 files. GDB is then able to load debugging information from those files,
35410 when they are available (@pxref{Separate Debug Files,,, gdb, Debugging
35411 with GDB}).
35412
35413 The GNU distribution takes advantage of this by storing debugging
35414 information in the @code{lib/debug} sub-directory of a separate package
35415 output unimaginatively called @code{debug} (@pxref{Packages with
35416 Multiple Outputs}). Users can choose to install the @code{debug} output
35417 of a package when they need it. For instance, the following command
35418 installs the debugging information for the GNU C Library and for GNU
35419 Guile:
35420
35421 @example
35422 guix install glibc:debug guile:debug
35423 @end example
35424
35425 GDB must then be told to look for debug files in the user's profile, by
35426 setting the @code{debug-file-directory} variable (consider setting it
35427 from the @file{~/.gdbinit} file, @pxref{Startup,,, gdb, Debugging with
35428 GDB}):
35429
35430 @example
35431 (gdb) set debug-file-directory ~/.guix-profile/lib/debug
35432 @end example
35433
35434 From there on, GDB will pick up debugging information from the
35435 @file{.debug} files under @file{~/.guix-profile/lib/debug}.
35436
35437 In addition, you will most likely want GDB to be able to show the source
35438 code being debugged. To do that, you will have to unpack the source
35439 code of the package of interest (obtained with @code{guix build
35440 --source}, @pxref{Invoking guix build}), and to point GDB to that source
35441 directory using the @code{directory} command (@pxref{Source Path,
35442 @code{directory},, gdb, Debugging with GDB}).
35443
35444 @c XXX: keep me up-to-date
35445 The @code{debug} output mechanism in Guix is implemented by the
35446 @code{gnu-build-system} (@pxref{Build Systems}). Currently, it is
35447 opt-in---debugging information is available only for the packages with
35448 definitions explicitly declaring a @code{debug} output. To check
35449 whether a package has a @code{debug} output, use @command{guix package
35450 --list-available} (@pxref{Invoking guix package}).
35451
35452 Read on for how to deal with packages lacking a @code{debug} output.
35453
35454 @node Rebuilding Debug Info
35455 @section Rebuilding Debug Info
35456
35457 @cindex debugging info, rebuilding
35458 As we saw above, some packages, but not all, provide debugging info in a
35459 @code{debug} output. What can you do when debugging info is missing?
35460 The @option{--with-debug-info} option provides a solution to that: it
35461 allows you to rebuild the package(s) for which debugging info is
35462 missing---and only those---and to graft those onto the application
35463 you're debugging. Thus, while it's not as fast as installing a
35464 @code{debug} output, it is relatively inexpensive.
35465
35466 Let's illustrate that. Suppose you're experiencing a bug in Inkscape
35467 and would like to see what's going on in GLib, a library that's deep
35468 down in its dependency graph. As it turns out, GLib does not have a
35469 @code{debug} output and the backtrace GDB shows is all sadness:
35470
35471 @example
35472 (gdb) bt
35473 #0 0x00007ffff5f92190 in g_getenv ()
35474 from /gnu/store/@dots{}-glib-2.62.6/lib/libglib-2.0.so.0
35475 #1 0x00007ffff608a7d6 in gobject_init_ctor ()
35476 from /gnu/store/@dots{}-glib-2.62.6/lib/libgobject-2.0.so.0
35477 #2 0x00007ffff7fe275a in call_init (l=<optimized out>, argc=argc@@entry=1, argv=argv@@entry=0x7fffffffcfd8,
35478 env=env@@entry=0x7fffffffcfe8) at dl-init.c:72
35479 #3 0x00007ffff7fe2866 in call_init (env=0x7fffffffcfe8, argv=0x7fffffffcfd8, argc=1, l=<optimized out>)
35480 at dl-init.c:118
35481 @end example
35482
35483 To address that, you install Inkscape linked against a variant GLib that
35484 contains debug info:
35485
35486 @example
35487 guix install inkscape --with-debug-info=glib
35488 @end example
35489
35490 This time, debugging will be a whole lot nicer:
35491
35492 @example
35493 $ gdb --args sh -c 'exec inkscape'
35494 @dots{}
35495 (gdb) b g_getenv
35496 Function "g_getenv" not defined.
35497 Make breakpoint pending on future shared library load? (y or [n]) y
35498 Breakpoint 1 (g_getenv) pending.
35499 (gdb) r
35500 Starting program: /gnu/store/@dots{}-profile/bin/sh -c exec\ inkscape
35501 @dots{}
35502 (gdb) bt
35503 #0 g_getenv (variable=variable@@entry=0x7ffff60c7a2e "GOBJECT_DEBUG") at ../glib-2.62.6/glib/genviron.c:252
35504 #1 0x00007ffff608a7d6 in gobject_init () at ../glib-2.62.6/gobject/gtype.c:4380
35505 #2 gobject_init_ctor () at ../glib-2.62.6/gobject/gtype.c:4493
35506 #3 0x00007ffff7fe275a in call_init (l=<optimized out>, argc=argc@@entry=3, argv=argv@@entry=0x7fffffffd088,
35507 env=env@@entry=0x7fffffffd0a8) at dl-init.c:72
35508 @dots{}
35509 @end example
35510
35511 Much better!
35512
35513 Note that there can be packages for which @option{--with-debug-info}
35514 will not have the desired effect. @xref{Package Transformation Options,
35515 @option{--with-debug-info}}, for more information.
35516
35517 @node Security Updates
35518 @chapter Security Updates
35519
35520 @cindex security updates
35521 @cindex security vulnerabilities
35522 Occasionally, important security vulnerabilities are discovered in software
35523 packages and must be patched. Guix developers try hard to keep track of
35524 known vulnerabilities and to apply fixes as soon as possible in the
35525 @code{master} branch of Guix (we do not yet provide a ``stable'' branch
35526 containing only security updates). The @command{guix lint} tool helps
35527 developers find out about vulnerable versions of software packages in the
35528 distribution:
35529
35530 @smallexample
35531 $ guix lint -c cve
35532 gnu/packages/base.scm:652:2: glibc@@2.21: probably vulnerable to CVE-2015-1781, CVE-2015-7547
35533 gnu/packages/gcc.scm:334:2: gcc@@4.9.3: probably vulnerable to CVE-2015-5276
35534 gnu/packages/image.scm:312:2: openjpeg@@2.1.0: probably vulnerable to CVE-2016-1923, CVE-2016-1924
35535 @dots{}
35536 @end smallexample
35537
35538 @xref{Invoking guix lint}, for more information.
35539
35540 Guix follows a functional
35541 package management discipline (@pxref{Introduction}), which implies
35542 that, when a package is changed, @emph{every package that depends on it}
35543 must be rebuilt. This can significantly slow down the deployment of
35544 fixes in core packages such as libc or Bash, since basically the whole
35545 distribution would need to be rebuilt. Using pre-built binaries helps
35546 (@pxref{Substitutes}), but deployment may still take more time than
35547 desired.
35548
35549 @cindex grafts
35550 To address this, Guix implements @dfn{grafts}, a mechanism that allows
35551 for fast deployment of critical updates without the costs associated
35552 with a whole-distribution rebuild. The idea is to rebuild only the
35553 package that needs to be patched, and then to ``graft'' it onto packages
35554 explicitly installed by the user and that were previously referring to
35555 the original package. The cost of grafting is typically very low, and
35556 order of magnitudes lower than a full rebuild of the dependency chain.
35557
35558 @cindex replacements of packages, for grafts
35559 For instance, suppose a security update needs to be applied to Bash.
35560 Guix developers will provide a package definition for the ``fixed''
35561 Bash, say @code{bash-fixed}, in the usual way (@pxref{Defining
35562 Packages}). Then, the original package definition is augmented with a
35563 @code{replacement} field pointing to the package containing the bug fix:
35564
35565 @lisp
35566 (define bash
35567 (package
35568 (name "bash")
35569 ;; @dots{}
35570 (replacement bash-fixed)))
35571 @end lisp
35572
35573 From there on, any package depending directly or indirectly on Bash---as
35574 reported by @command{guix gc --requisites} (@pxref{Invoking guix
35575 gc})---that is installed is automatically ``rewritten'' to refer to
35576 @code{bash-fixed} instead of @code{bash}. This grafting process takes
35577 time proportional to the size of the package, usually less than a
35578 minute for an ``average'' package on a recent machine. Grafting is
35579 recursive: when an indirect dependency requires grafting, then grafting
35580 ``propagates'' up to the package that the user is installing.
35581
35582 Currently, the length of the name and version of the graft and that of
35583 the package it replaces (@code{bash-fixed} and @code{bash} in the example
35584 above) must be equal. This restriction mostly comes from the fact that
35585 grafting works by patching files, including binary files, directly.
35586 Other restrictions may apply: for instance, when adding a graft to a
35587 package providing a shared library, the original shared library and its
35588 replacement must have the same @code{SONAME} and be binary-compatible.
35589
35590 The @option{--no-grafts} command-line option allows you to forcefully
35591 avoid grafting (@pxref{Common Build Options, @option{--no-grafts}}).
35592 Thus, the command:
35593
35594 @example
35595 guix build bash --no-grafts
35596 @end example
35597
35598 @noindent
35599 returns the store file name of the original Bash, whereas:
35600
35601 @example
35602 guix build bash
35603 @end example
35604
35605 @noindent
35606 returns the store file name of the ``fixed'', replacement Bash. This
35607 allows you to distinguish between the two variants of Bash.
35608
35609 To verify which Bash your whole profile refers to, you can run
35610 (@pxref{Invoking guix gc}):
35611
35612 @example
35613 guix gc -R $(readlink -f ~/.guix-profile) | grep bash
35614 @end example
35615
35616 @noindent
35617 @dots{} and compare the store file names that you get with those above.
35618 Likewise for a complete Guix system generation:
35619
35620 @example
35621 guix gc -R $(guix system build my-config.scm) | grep bash
35622 @end example
35623
35624 Lastly, to check which Bash running processes are using, you can use the
35625 @command{lsof} command:
35626
35627 @example
35628 lsof | grep /gnu/store/.*bash
35629 @end example
35630
35631
35632 @node Bootstrapping
35633 @chapter Bootstrapping
35634
35635 @c Adapted from the ELS 2013 paper.
35636
35637 @cindex bootstrapping
35638
35639 Bootstrapping in our context refers to how the distribution gets built
35640 ``from nothing''. Remember that the build environment of a derivation
35641 contains nothing but its declared inputs (@pxref{Introduction}). So
35642 there's an obvious chicken-and-egg problem: how does the first package
35643 get built? How does the first compiler get compiled?
35644
35645 It is tempting to think of this question as one that only die-hard
35646 hackers may care about. However, while the answer to that question is
35647 technical in nature, its implications are wide-ranging. How the
35648 distribution is bootstrapped defines the extent to which we, as
35649 individuals and as a collective of users and hackers, can trust the
35650 software we run. It is a central concern from the standpoint of
35651 @emph{security} and from a @emph{user freedom} viewpoint.
35652
35653 @cindex bootstrap binaries
35654 The GNU system is primarily made of C code, with libc at its core. The
35655 GNU build system itself assumes the availability of a Bourne shell and
35656 command-line tools provided by GNU Coreutils, Awk, Findutils, `sed', and
35657 `grep'. Furthermore, build programs---programs that run
35658 @code{./configure}, @code{make}, etc.---are written in Guile Scheme
35659 (@pxref{Derivations}). Consequently, to be able to build anything at
35660 all, from scratch, Guix relies on pre-built binaries of Guile, GCC,
35661 Binutils, libc, and the other packages mentioned above---the
35662 @dfn{bootstrap binaries}.
35663
35664 These bootstrap binaries are ``taken for granted'', though we can also
35665 re-create them if needed (@pxref{Preparing to Use the Bootstrap
35666 Binaries}).
35667
35668 @menu
35669 * Reduced Binary Seed Bootstrap:: A Bootstrap worthy of GNU.
35670 * Preparing to Use the Bootstrap Binaries:: Building that what matters most.
35671 @end menu
35672
35673 @node Reduced Binary Seed Bootstrap
35674 @section The Reduced Binary Seed Bootstrap
35675
35676 Guix---like other GNU/Linux distributions---is traditionally bootstrapped from
35677 a set of bootstrap binaries: Bourne shell, command-line tools provided by GNU
35678 Coreutils, Awk, Findutils, `sed', and `grep' and Guile, GCC, Binutils, and the
35679 GNU C Library (@pxref{Bootstrapping}). Usually, these bootstrap binaries are
35680 ``taken for granted.''
35681
35682 Taking the bootstrap binaries for granted means that we consider them to
35683 be a correct and trustworthy ``seed'' for building the complete system.
35684 Therein lies a problem: the combined size of these bootstrap binaries is
35685 about 250MB (@pxref{Bootstrappable Builds,,, mes, GNU Mes}). Auditing
35686 or even inspecting these is next to impossible.
35687
35688 For @code{i686-linux} and @code{x86_64-linux}, Guix now features a
35689 ``Reduced Binary Seed'' bootstrap @footnote{We would like to say: ``Full
35690 Source Bootstrap'' and while we are working towards that goal it would
35691 be hyperbole to use that term for what we do now.}.
35692
35693 The Reduced Binary Seed bootstrap removes the most critical tools---from a
35694 trust perspective---from the bootstrap binaries: GCC, Binutils and the GNU C
35695 Library are replaced by: @code{bootstrap-mescc-tools} (a tiny assembler and
35696 linker) and @code{bootstrap-mes} (a small Scheme Interpreter and a C compiler
35697 written in Scheme and the Mes C Library, built for TinyCC and for GCC).
35698
35699 Using these new binary seeds the ``missing'' Binutils, GCC, and the GNU
35700 C Library are built from source. From here on the more traditional
35701 bootstrap process resumes. This approach has reduced the bootstrap
35702 binaries in size to about 145MB in Guix v1.1.
35703
35704 The next step that Guix has taken is to replace the shell and all its
35705 utilities with implementations in Guile Scheme, the @emph{Scheme-only
35706 bootstrap}. Gash (@pxref{Gash,,, gash, The Gash manual}) is a
35707 POSIX-compatible shell that replaces Bash, and it comes with Gash Utils
35708 which has minimalist replacements for Awk, the GNU Core Utilities, Grep,
35709 Gzip, Sed, and Tar. The rest of the bootstrap binary seeds that were
35710 removed are now built from source.
35711
35712 Building the GNU System from source is currently only possible by adding
35713 some historical GNU packages as intermediate steps@footnote{Packages
35714 such as @code{gcc-2.95.3}, @code{binutils-2.14}, @code{glibc-2.2.5},
35715 @code{gzip-1.2.4}, @code{tar-1.22}, and some others. For details, see
35716 @file{gnu/packages/commencement.scm}.}. As Gash and Gash Utils mature,
35717 and GNU packages become more bootstrappable again (e.g., new releases of
35718 GNU Sed will also ship as gzipped tarballs again, as alternative to the
35719 hard to bootstrap @code{xz}-compression), this set of added packages can
35720 hopefully be reduced again.
35721
35722 The graph below shows the resulting dependency graph for
35723 @code{gcc-core-mesboot0}, the bootstrap compiler used for the
35724 traditional bootstrap of the rest of the Guix System.
35725
35726 @c ./pre-inst-env guix graph -e '(@@ (gnu packages commencement) gcc-core-mesboot0)' | sed -re 's,((bootstrap-mescc-tools|bootstrap-mes|guile-bootstrap).*shape =) box,\1 ellipse,' > doc/images/gcc-core-mesboot0-graph.dot
35727 @image{images/gcc-core-mesboot0-graph,6in,,Dependency graph of gcc-core-mesboot0}
35728
35729 The only significant binary bootstrap seeds that remain@footnote{
35730 Ignoring the 68KB @code{mescc-tools}; that will be removed later,
35731 together with @code{mes}.} are a Scheme interpreter and a Scheme
35732 compiler: GNU Mes and GNU Guile@footnote{Not shown in this graph are the
35733 static binaries for @file{bash}, @code{tar}, and @code{xz} that are used
35734 to get Guile running.}.
35735
35736 This further reduction has brought down the size of the binary seed to
35737 about 60MB for @code{i686-linux} and @code{x86_64-linux}.
35738
35739 Work is ongoing to remove all binary blobs from our free software
35740 bootstrap stack, working towards a Full Source Bootstrap. Also ongoing
35741 is work to bring these bootstraps to the @code{arm-linux} and
35742 @code{aarch64-linux} architectures and to the Hurd.
35743
35744 If you are interested, join us on @samp{#bootstrappable} on the Freenode
35745 IRC network or discuss on @email{bug-mes@@gnu.org} or
35746 @email{gash-devel@@nongnu.org}.
35747
35748 @node Preparing to Use the Bootstrap Binaries
35749 @section Preparing to Use the Bootstrap Binaries
35750
35751 @c As of Emacs 24.3, Info-mode displays the image, but since it's a
35752 @c large image, it's hard to scroll. Oh well.
35753 @image{images/bootstrap-graph,6in,,Dependency graph of the early bootstrap derivations}
35754
35755 The figure above shows the very beginning of the dependency graph of the
35756 distribution, corresponding to the package definitions of the @code{(gnu
35757 packages bootstrap)} module. A similar figure can be generated with
35758 @command{guix graph} (@pxref{Invoking guix graph}), along the lines of:
35759
35760 @example
35761 guix graph -t derivation \
35762 -e '(@@@@ (gnu packages bootstrap) %bootstrap-gcc)' \
35763 | dot -Tps > gcc.ps
35764 @end example
35765
35766 or, for the further Reduced Binary Seed bootstrap
35767
35768 @example
35769 guix graph -t derivation \
35770 -e '(@@@@ (gnu packages bootstrap) %bootstrap-mes)' \
35771 | dot -Tps > mes.ps
35772 @end example
35773
35774 At this level of detail, things are
35775 slightly complex. First, Guile itself consists of an ELF executable,
35776 along with many source and compiled Scheme files that are dynamically
35777 loaded when it runs. This gets stored in the @file{guile-2.0.7.tar.xz}
35778 tarball shown in this graph. This tarball is part of Guix's ``source''
35779 distribution, and gets inserted into the store with @code{add-to-store}
35780 (@pxref{The Store}).
35781
35782 But how do we write a derivation that unpacks this tarball and adds it
35783 to the store? To solve this problem, the @code{guile-bootstrap-2.0.drv}
35784 derivation---the first one that gets built---uses @code{bash} as its
35785 builder, which runs @code{build-bootstrap-guile.sh}, which in turn calls
35786 @code{tar} to unpack the tarball. Thus, @file{bash}, @file{tar},
35787 @file{xz}, and @file{mkdir} are statically-linked binaries, also part of
35788 the Guix source distribution, whose sole purpose is to allow the Guile
35789 tarball to be unpacked.
35790
35791 Once @code{guile-bootstrap-2.0.drv} is built, we have a functioning
35792 Guile that can be used to run subsequent build programs. Its first task
35793 is to download tarballs containing the other pre-built binaries---this
35794 is what the @file{.tar.xz.drv} derivations do. Guix modules such as
35795 @code{ftp-client.scm} are used for this purpose. The
35796 @code{module-import.drv} derivations import those modules in a directory
35797 in the store, using the original layout. The
35798 @code{module-import-compiled.drv} derivations compile those modules, and
35799 write them in an output directory with the right layout. This
35800 corresponds to the @code{#:modules} argument of
35801 @code{build-expression->derivation} (@pxref{Derivations}).
35802
35803 Finally, the various tarballs are unpacked by the derivations
35804 @code{gcc-bootstrap-0.drv}, @code{glibc-bootstrap-0.drv}, or
35805 @code{bootstrap-mes-0.drv} and @code{bootstrap-mescc-tools-0.drv}, at which
35806 point we have a working C tool chain.
35807
35808 @unnumberedsec Building the Build Tools
35809
35810 Bootstrapping is complete when we have a full tool chain that does not
35811 depend on the pre-built bootstrap tools discussed above. This
35812 no-dependency requirement is verified by checking whether the files of
35813 the final tool chain contain references to the @file{/gnu/store}
35814 directories of the bootstrap inputs. The process that leads to this
35815 ``final'' tool chain is described by the package definitions found in
35816 the @code{(gnu packages commencement)} module.
35817
35818 The @command{guix graph} command allows us to ``zoom out'' compared to
35819 the graph above, by looking at the level of package objects instead of
35820 individual derivations---remember that a package may translate to
35821 several derivations, typically one derivation to download its source,
35822 one to build the Guile modules it needs, and one to actually build the
35823 package from source. The command:
35824
35825 @example
35826 guix graph -t bag \
35827 -e '(@@@@ (gnu packages commencement)
35828 glibc-final-with-bootstrap-bash)' | xdot -
35829 @end example
35830
35831 @noindent
35832 displays the dependency graph leading to the ``final'' C
35833 library@footnote{You may notice the @code{glibc-intermediate} label,
35834 suggesting that it is not @emph{quite} final, but as a good
35835 approximation, we will consider it final.}, depicted below.
35836
35837 @image{images/bootstrap-packages,6in,,Dependency graph of the early packages}
35838
35839 @c See <https://lists.gnu.org/archive/html/gnu-system-discuss/2012-10/msg00000.html>.
35840 The first tool that gets built with the bootstrap binaries is
35841 GNU@tie{}Make---noted @code{make-boot0} above---which is a prerequisite
35842 for all the following packages. From there Findutils and Diffutils get
35843 built.
35844
35845 Then come the first-stage Binutils and GCC, built as pseudo cross
35846 tools---i.e., with @option{--target} equal to @option{--host}. They are
35847 used to build libc. Thanks to this cross-build trick, this libc is
35848 guaranteed not to hold any reference to the initial tool chain.
35849
35850 From there the final Binutils and GCC (not shown above) are built. GCC
35851 uses @command{ld} from the final Binutils, and links programs against
35852 the just-built libc. This tool chain is used to build the other
35853 packages used by Guix and by the GNU Build System: Guile, Bash,
35854 Coreutils, etc.
35855
35856 And voilà! At this point we have the complete set of build tools that
35857 the GNU Build System expects. These are in the @code{%final-inputs}
35858 variable of the @code{(gnu packages commencement)} module, and are
35859 implicitly used by any package that uses @code{gnu-build-system}
35860 (@pxref{Build Systems, @code{gnu-build-system}}).
35861
35862
35863 @unnumberedsec Building the Bootstrap Binaries
35864
35865 @cindex bootstrap binaries
35866 Because the final tool chain does not depend on the bootstrap binaries,
35867 those rarely need to be updated. Nevertheless, it is useful to have an
35868 automated way to produce them, should an update occur, and this is what
35869 the @code{(gnu packages make-bootstrap)} module provides.
35870
35871 The following command builds the tarballs containing the bootstrap binaries
35872 (Binutils, GCC, glibc, for the traditional bootstrap and linux-libre-headers,
35873 bootstrap-mescc-tools, bootstrap-mes for the Reduced Binary Seed bootstrap,
35874 and Guile, and a tarball containing a mixture of Coreutils and other basic
35875 command-line tools):
35876
35877 @example
35878 guix build bootstrap-tarballs
35879 @end example
35880
35881 The generated tarballs are those that should be referred to in the
35882 @code{(gnu packages bootstrap)} module mentioned at the beginning of
35883 this section.
35884
35885 Still here? Then perhaps by now you've started to wonder: when do we
35886 reach a fixed point? That is an interesting question! The answer is
35887 unknown, but if you would like to investigate further (and have
35888 significant computational and storage resources to do so), then let us
35889 know.
35890
35891 @unnumberedsec Reducing the Set of Bootstrap Binaries
35892
35893 Our traditional bootstrap includes GCC, GNU Libc, Guile, etc. That's a lot of
35894 binary code! Why is that a problem? It's a problem because these big chunks
35895 of binary code are practically non-auditable, which makes it hard to establish
35896 what source code produced them. Every unauditable binary also leaves us
35897 vulnerable to compiler backdoors as described by Ken Thompson in the 1984
35898 paper @emph{Reflections on Trusting Trust}.
35899
35900 This is mitigated by the fact that our bootstrap binaries were generated
35901 from an earlier Guix revision. Nevertheless it lacks the level of
35902 transparency that we get in the rest of the package dependency graph,
35903 where Guix always gives us a source-to-binary mapping. Thus, our goal
35904 is to reduce the set of bootstrap binaries to the bare minimum.
35905
35906 The @uref{https://bootstrappable.org, Bootstrappable.org web site} lists
35907 on-going projects to do that. One of these is about replacing the
35908 bootstrap GCC with a sequence of assemblers, interpreters, and compilers
35909 of increasing complexity, which could be built from source starting from
35910 a simple and auditable assembler.
35911
35912 Our first major achievement is the replacement of of GCC, the GNU C Library
35913 and Binutils by MesCC-Tools (a simple hex linker and macro assembler) and Mes
35914 (@pxref{Top, GNU Mes Reference Manual,, mes, GNU Mes}, a Scheme interpreter
35915 and C compiler in Scheme). Neither MesCC-Tools nor Mes can be fully
35916 bootstrapped yet and thus we inject them as binary seeds. We call this the
35917 Reduced Binary Seed bootstrap, as it has halved the size of our bootstrap
35918 binaries! Also, it has eliminated the C compiler binary; i686-linux and
35919 x86_64-linux Guix packages are now bootstrapped without any binary C compiler.
35920
35921 Work is ongoing to make MesCC-Tools and Mes fully bootstrappable and we are
35922 also looking at any other bootstrap binaries. Your help is welcome!
35923
35924 @node Porting
35925 @chapter Porting to a New Platform
35926
35927 As discussed above, the GNU distribution is self-contained, and
35928 self-containment is achieved by relying on pre-built ``bootstrap
35929 binaries'' (@pxref{Bootstrapping}). These binaries are specific to an
35930 operating system kernel, CPU architecture, and application binary
35931 interface (ABI). Thus, to port the distribution to a platform that is
35932 not yet supported, one must build those bootstrap binaries, and update
35933 the @code{(gnu packages bootstrap)} module to use them on that platform.
35934
35935 Fortunately, Guix can @emph{cross compile} those bootstrap binaries.
35936 When everything goes well, and assuming the GNU tool chain supports the
35937 target platform, this can be as simple as running a command like this
35938 one:
35939
35940 @example
35941 guix build --target=armv5tel-linux-gnueabi bootstrap-tarballs
35942 @end example
35943
35944 For this to work, the @code{glibc-dynamic-linker} procedure in
35945 @code{(gnu packages bootstrap)} must be augmented to return the right
35946 file name for libc's dynamic linker on that platform; likewise,
35947 @code{system->linux-architecture} in @code{(gnu packages linux)} must be
35948 taught about the new platform.
35949
35950 Once these are built, the @code{(gnu packages bootstrap)} module needs
35951 to be updated to refer to these binaries on the target platform. That
35952 is, the hashes and URLs of the bootstrap tarballs for the new platform
35953 must be added alongside those of the currently supported platforms. The
35954 bootstrap Guile tarball is treated specially: it is expected to be
35955 available locally, and @file{gnu/local.mk} has rules to download it for
35956 the supported architectures; a rule for the new platform must be added
35957 as well.
35958
35959 In practice, there may be some complications. First, it may be that the
35960 extended GNU triplet that specifies an ABI (like the @code{eabi} suffix
35961 above) is not recognized by all the GNU tools. Typically, glibc
35962 recognizes some of these, whereas GCC uses an extra @option{--with-abi}
35963 configure flag (see @code{gcc.scm} for examples of how to handle this).
35964 Second, some of the required packages could fail to build for that
35965 platform. Lastly, the generated binaries could be broken for some
35966 reason.
35967
35968 @c *********************************************************************
35969 @include contributing.texi
35970
35971 @c *********************************************************************
35972 @node Acknowledgments
35973 @chapter Acknowledgments
35974
35975 Guix is based on the @uref{https://nixos.org/nix/, Nix package manager},
35976 which was designed and
35977 implemented by Eelco Dolstra, with contributions from other people (see
35978 the @file{nix/AUTHORS} file in Guix). Nix pioneered functional package
35979 management, and promoted unprecedented features, such as transactional
35980 package upgrades and rollbacks, per-user profiles, and referentially
35981 transparent build processes. Without this work, Guix would not exist.
35982
35983 The Nix-based software distributions, Nixpkgs and NixOS, have also been
35984 an inspiration for Guix.
35985
35986 GNU@tie{}Guix itself is a collective work with contributions from a
35987 number of people. See the @file{AUTHORS} file in Guix for more
35988 information on these fine people. The @file{THANKS} file lists people
35989 who have helped by reporting bugs, taking care of the infrastructure,
35990 providing artwork and themes, making suggestions, and more---thank you!
35991
35992
35993 @c *********************************************************************
35994 @node GNU Free Documentation License
35995 @appendix GNU Free Documentation License
35996 @cindex license, GNU Free Documentation License
35997 @include fdl-1.3.texi
35998
35999 @c *********************************************************************
36000 @node Concept Index
36001 @unnumbered Concept Index
36002 @printindex cp
36003
36004 @node Programming Index
36005 @unnumbered Programming Index
36006 @syncodeindex tp fn
36007 @syncodeindex vr fn
36008 @printindex fn
36009
36010 @bye
36011
36012 @c Local Variables:
36013 @c ispell-local-dictionary: "american";
36014 @c End: